1 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2 . This is the primary source of the Exim Manual. It is an xfpt document that is
3 . converted into DocBook XML for subsequent conversion into printing and online
4 . formats. The markup used herein is "standard" xfpt markup, with some extras.
5 . The markup is summarized in a file called Markup.txt.
7 . WARNING: When you use the .new macro, make sure it appears *before* any
8 . adjacent index items; otherwise you get an empty "paragraph" which causes
9 . unwanted vertical space.
10 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
15 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16 . This outputs the standard DocBook boilerplate.
17 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
23 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
24 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
26 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
31 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
32 toc_chapter_blanks="yes,yes"
33 table_warn_overflow="overprint"
37 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38 . This generate the outermost <book> element that wraps then entire document.
39 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
43 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
44 . These definitions set some parameters and save some typing.
45 . Update the Copyright year (only) when changing content.
46 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
48 .set previousversion "4.80"
49 .include ./local_params
51 .set ACL "access control lists (ACLs)"
52 .set I " "
58 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
59 . Additional xfpt markup used by this document, over and above the default
60 . provided in the xfpt library.
61 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
63 . --- Override the &$ flag to automatically insert a $ with the variable name
65 .flag &$ $& "<varname>$" "</varname>"
67 . --- Short flags for daggers in option headings. They will always be inside
68 . --- an italic string, but we want the daggers to be roman.
70 .flag &!! "</emphasis>†<emphasis>"
71 .flag &!? "</emphasis>‡<emphasis>"
73 . --- A macro for an Exim option definition heading, generating a one-line
74 . --- table with four columns. For cases when the option name is given with
75 . --- a space, so that it can be split, a fifth argument is used for the
85 .itable all 0 0 4 8* left 6* center 6* center 6* right
86 .row "&%$1%&" "Use: &'$2'&" "Type: &'$3'&" "Default: &'$4'&"
90 . --- A macro for the common 2-column tables. The width of the first column
91 . --- is suitable for the many tables at the start of the main options chapter;
92 . --- the small number of other 2-column tables override it.
94 .macro table2 196pt 254pt
95 .itable none 0 0 2 $1 left $2 left
98 . --- A macro that generates .row, but puts &I; at the start of the first
99 . --- argument, thus indenting it. Assume a minimum of two arguments, and
100 . --- allow up to four arguments, which is as many as we'll ever need.
104 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3" "$4"
108 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3"
116 . --- Macros for option, variable, and concept index entries. For a "range"
117 . --- style of entry, use .scindex for the start and .ecindex for the end. The
118 . --- first argument of .scindex and the only argument of .ecindex must be the
119 . --- ID that ties them together.
122 &<indexterm role="concept">&
123 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
125 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
131 &<indexterm role="concept" id="$1" class="startofrange">&
132 &<primary>&$2&</primary>&
134 &<secondary>&$3&</secondary>&
140 &<indexterm role="concept" startref="$1" class="endofrange"/>&
144 &<indexterm role="option">&
145 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
147 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
153 &<indexterm role="variable">&
154 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
156 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
162 .echo "** Don't use .index; use .cindex or .oindex or .vindex"
164 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
167 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
168 . The <bookinfo> element is removed from the XML before processing for Ascii
170 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
174 <title>Specification of the Exim Mail Transfer Agent</title>
175 <titleabbrev>The Exim MTA</titleabbrev>
179 <author><firstname>Exim</firstname><surname>Maintainers</surname></author>
180 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
181 <revhistory><revision>
183 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
184 </revision></revhistory>
187 </year><holder>University of Cambridge</holder></copyright>
192 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
193 . This chunk of literal XML implements index entries of the form "x, see y" and
194 . "x, see also y". However, the DocBook DTD doesn't allow <indexterm> entries
195 . at the top level, so we have to put the .chapter directive first.
196 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
198 .chapter "Introduction" "CHID1"
201 <indexterm role="variable">
202 <primary>$1, $2, etc.</primary>
203 <see><emphasis>numerical variables</emphasis></see>
205 <indexterm role="concept">
206 <primary>address</primary>
207 <secondary>rewriting</secondary>
208 <see><emphasis>rewriting</emphasis></see>
210 <indexterm role="concept">
211 <primary>Bounce Address Tag Validation</primary>
212 <see><emphasis>BATV</emphasis></see>
214 <indexterm role="concept">
215 <primary>Client SMTP Authorization</primary>
216 <see><emphasis>CSA</emphasis></see>
218 <indexterm role="concept">
219 <primary>CR character</primary>
220 <see><emphasis>carriage return</emphasis></see>
222 <indexterm role="concept">
223 <primary>CRL</primary>
224 <see><emphasis>certificate revocation list</emphasis></see>
226 <indexterm role="concept">
227 <primary>delivery</primary>
228 <secondary>failure report</secondary>
229 <see><emphasis>bounce message</emphasis></see>
231 <indexterm role="concept">
232 <primary>dialup</primary>
233 <see><emphasis>intermittently connected hosts</emphasis></see>
235 <indexterm role="concept">
236 <primary>exiscan</primary>
237 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
239 <indexterm role="concept">
240 <primary>failover</primary>
241 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
243 <indexterm role="concept">
244 <primary>fallover</primary>
245 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
247 <indexterm role="concept">
248 <primary>filter</primary>
249 <secondary>Sieve</secondary>
250 <see><emphasis>Sieve filter</emphasis></see>
252 <indexterm role="concept">
253 <primary>ident</primary>
254 <see><emphasis>RFC 1413</emphasis></see>
256 <indexterm role="concept">
257 <primary>LF character</primary>
258 <see><emphasis>linefeed</emphasis></see>
260 <indexterm role="concept">
261 <primary>maximum</primary>
262 <seealso><emphasis>limit</emphasis></seealso>
264 <indexterm role="concept">
265 <primary>monitor</primary>
266 <see><emphasis>Exim monitor</emphasis></see>
268 <indexterm role="concept">
269 <primary>no_<emphasis>xxx</emphasis></primary>
270 <see>entry for xxx</see>
272 <indexterm role="concept">
273 <primary>NUL</primary>
274 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
276 <indexterm role="concept">
277 <primary>passwd file</primary>
278 <see><emphasis>/etc/passwd</emphasis></see>
280 <indexterm role="concept">
281 <primary>process id</primary>
282 <see><emphasis>pid</emphasis></see>
284 <indexterm role="concept">
285 <primary>RBL</primary>
286 <see><emphasis>DNS list</emphasis></see>
288 <indexterm role="concept">
289 <primary>redirection</primary>
290 <see><emphasis>address redirection</emphasis></see>
292 <indexterm role="concept">
293 <primary>return path</primary>
294 <seealso><emphasis>envelope sender</emphasis></seealso>
296 <indexterm role="concept">
297 <primary>scanning</primary>
298 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
300 <indexterm role="concept">
301 <primary>SSL</primary>
302 <see><emphasis>TLS</emphasis></see>
304 <indexterm role="concept">
305 <primary>string</primary>
306 <secondary>expansion</secondary>
307 <see><emphasis>expansion</emphasis></see>
309 <indexterm role="concept">
310 <primary>top bit</primary>
311 <see><emphasis>8-bit characters</emphasis></see>
313 <indexterm role="concept">
314 <primary>variables</primary>
315 <see><emphasis>expansion, variables</emphasis></see>
317 <indexterm role="concept">
318 <primary>zero, binary</primary>
319 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
325 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
326 . This is the real start of the first chapter. See the comment above as to why
327 . we can't have the .chapter line here.
328 . chapter "Introduction"
329 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
331 Exim is a mail transfer agent (MTA) for hosts that are running Unix or
332 Unix-like operating systems. It was designed on the assumption that it would be
333 run on hosts that are permanently connected to the Internet. However, it can be
334 used on intermittently connected hosts with suitable configuration adjustments.
336 Configuration files currently exist for the following operating systems: AIX,
337 BSD/OS (aka BSDI), Darwin (Mac OS X), DGUX, Dragonfly, FreeBSD, GNU/Hurd,
338 GNU/Linux, HI-OSF (Hitachi), HI-UX, HP-UX, IRIX, MIPS RISCOS, NetBSD, OpenBSD,
339 OpenUNIX, QNX, SCO, SCO SVR4.2 (aka UNIX-SV), Solaris (aka SunOS5), SunOS4,
340 Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX, formerly DEC-OSF1), Ultrix, and Unixware.
341 Some of these operating systems are no longer current and cannot easily be
342 tested, so the configuration files may no longer work in practice.
344 There are also configuration files for compiling Exim in the Cygwin environment
345 that can be installed on systems running Windows. However, this document does
346 not contain any information about running Exim in the Cygwin environment.
348 The terms and conditions for the use and distribution of Exim are contained in
349 the file &_NOTICE_&. Exim is distributed under the terms of the GNU General
350 Public Licence, a copy of which may be found in the file &_LICENCE_&.
352 The use, supply or promotion of Exim for the purpose of sending bulk,
353 unsolicited electronic mail is incompatible with the basic aims of the program,
354 which revolve around the free provision of a service that enhances the quality
355 of personal communications. The author of Exim regards indiscriminate
356 mass-mailing as an antisocial, irresponsible abuse of the Internet.
358 Exim owes a great deal to Smail 3 and its author, Ron Karr. Without the
359 experience of running and working on the Smail 3 code, I could never have
360 contemplated starting to write a new MTA. Many of the ideas and user interfaces
361 were originally taken from Smail 3, though the actual code of Exim is entirely
362 new, and has developed far beyond the initial concept.
364 Many people, both in Cambridge and around the world, have contributed to the
365 development and the testing of Exim, and to porting it to various operating
366 systems. I am grateful to them all. The distribution now contains a file called
367 &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_&, in which I have started recording the names of
371 .section "Exim documentation" "SECID1"
372 . Keep this example change bar when updating the documentation!
375 .cindex "documentation"
376 This edition of the Exim specification applies to version &version() of Exim.
377 Substantive changes from the &previousversion; edition are marked in some
378 renditions of the document; this paragraph is so marked if the rendition is
379 capable of showing a change indicator.
382 This document is very much a reference manual; it is not a tutorial. The reader
383 is expected to have some familiarity with the SMTP mail transfer protocol and
384 with general Unix system administration. Although there are some discussions
385 and examples in places, the information is mostly organized in a way that makes
386 it easy to look up, rather than in a natural order for sequential reading.
387 Furthermore, the manual aims to cover every aspect of Exim in detail, including
388 a number of rarely-used, special-purpose features that are unlikely to be of
391 .cindex "books about Exim"
392 An &"easier"& discussion of Exim which provides more in-depth explanatory,
393 introductory, and tutorial material can be found in a book entitled &'The Exim
394 SMTP Mail Server'& (second edition, 2007), published by UIT Cambridge
395 (&url(http://www.uit.co.uk/exim-book/)).
397 This book also contains a chapter that gives a general introduction to SMTP and
398 Internet mail. Inevitably, however, the book is unlikely to be fully up-to-date
399 with the latest release of Exim. (Note that the earlier book about Exim,
400 published by O'Reilly, covers Exim 3, and many things have changed in Exim 4.)
402 .cindex "Debian" "information sources"
403 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you will find information about
404 Debian-specific features in the file
405 &_/usr/share/doc/exim4-base/README.Debian_&.
406 The command &(man update-exim.conf)& is another source of Debian-specific
409 .cindex "&_doc/NewStuff_&"
410 .cindex "&_doc/ChangeLog_&"
412 As the program develops, there may be features in newer versions that have not
413 yet made it into this document, which is updated only when the most significant
414 digit of the fractional part of the version number changes. Specifications of
415 new features that are not yet in this manual are placed in the file
416 &_doc/NewStuff_& in the Exim distribution.
418 Some features may be classified as &"experimental"&. These may change
419 incompatibly while they are developing, or even be withdrawn. For this reason,
420 they are not documented in this manual. Information about experimental features
421 can be found in the file &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
423 All changes to the program (whether new features, bug fixes, or other kinds of
424 change) are noted briefly in the file called &_doc/ChangeLog_&.
426 .cindex "&_doc/spec.txt_&"
427 This specification itself is available as an ASCII file in &_doc/spec.txt_& so
428 that it can easily be searched with a text editor. Other files in the &_doc_&
432 .row &_OptionLists.txt_& "list of all options in alphabetical order"
433 .row &_dbm.discuss.txt_& "discussion about DBM libraries"
434 .row &_exim.8_& "a man page of Exim's command line options"
435 .row &_experimental.txt_& "documentation of experimental features"
436 .row &_filter.txt_& "specification of the filter language"
437 .row &_Exim3.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 2 to release 3"
438 .row &_Exim4.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 3 to release 4"
441 The main specification and the specification of the filtering language are also
442 available in other formats (HTML, PostScript, PDF, and Texinfo). Section
443 &<<SECTavail>>& below tells you how to get hold of these.
447 .section "FTP and web sites" "SECID2"
450 The primary site for Exim source distributions is currently the University of
451 Cambridge's FTP site, whose contents are described in &'Where to find the Exim
452 distribution'& below. In addition, there is a web site and an FTP site at
453 &%exim.org%&. These are now also hosted at the University of Cambridge. The
454 &%exim.org%& site was previously hosted for a number of years by Energis
455 Squared, formerly Planet Online Ltd, whose support I gratefully acknowledge.
459 As well as Exim distribution tar files, the Exim web site contains a number of
460 differently formatted versions of the documentation. A recent addition to the
461 online information is the Exim wiki (&url(http://wiki.exim.org)),
462 which contains what used to be a separate FAQ, as well as various other
463 examples, tips, and know-how that have been contributed by Exim users.
466 An Exim Bugzilla exists at &url(http://bugs.exim.org). You can use
467 this to report bugs, and also to add items to the wish list. Please search
468 first to check that you are not duplicating a previous entry.
472 .section "Mailing lists" "SECID3"
473 .cindex "mailing lists" "for Exim users"
474 The following Exim mailing lists exist:
477 .row &'exim-announce@exim.org'& "Moderated, low volume announcements list"
478 .row &'exim-users@exim.org'& "General discussion list"
479 .row &'exim-dev@exim.org'& "Discussion of bugs, enhancements, etc."
480 .row &'exim-cvs@exim.org'& "Automated commit messages from the VCS"
483 You can subscribe to these lists, change your existing subscriptions, and view
484 or search the archives via the mailing lists link on the Exim home page.
485 .cindex "Debian" "mailing list for"
486 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you may wish to subscribe to
487 the Debian-specific mailing list &'pkg-exim4-users@lists.alioth.debian.org'&
490 &url(http://lists.alioth.debian.org/mailman/listinfo/pkg-exim4-users)
492 Please ask Debian-specific questions on this list and not on the general Exim
495 .section "Exim training" "SECID4"
496 .cindex "training courses"
497 Training courses in Cambridge (UK) used to be run annually by the author of
498 Exim, before he retired. At the time of writing, there are no plans to run
499 further Exim courses in Cambridge. However, if that changes, relevant
500 information will be posted at &url(http://www-tus.csx.cam.ac.uk/courses/exim/).
502 .section "Bug reports" "SECID5"
503 .cindex "bug reports"
504 .cindex "reporting bugs"
505 Reports of obvious bugs can be emailed to &'bugs@exim.org'& or reported
506 via the Bugzilla (&url(http://bugs.exim.org)). However, if you are unsure
507 whether some behaviour is a bug or not, the best thing to do is to post a
508 message to the &'exim-dev'& mailing list and have it discussed.
512 .section "Where to find the Exim distribution" "SECTavail"
514 .cindex "distribution" "ftp site"
515 The master ftp site for the Exim distribution is
517 &*ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/email/exim*&
521 &*ftp://ftp.exim.org/pub/exim*&
523 The file references that follow are relative to the &_exim_& directories at
524 these sites. There are now quite a number of independent mirror sites around
525 the world. Those that I know about are listed in the file called &_Mirrors_&.
527 Within the &_exim_& directory there are subdirectories called &_exim3_& (for
528 previous Exim 3 distributions), &_exim4_& (for the latest Exim 4
529 distributions), and &_Testing_& for testing versions. In the &_exim4_&
530 subdirectory, the current release can always be found in files called
533 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2_&
535 where &'n.nn'& is the highest such version number in the directory. The two
536 files contain identical data; the only difference is the type of compression.
537 The &_.bz2_& file is usually a lot smaller than the &_.gz_& file.
539 .cindex "distribution" "signing details"
540 .cindex "distribution" "public key"
541 .cindex "public key for signed distribution"
543 The distributions will be PGP signed by an individual key of the Release
544 Coordinator. This key will have a uid containing an email address in the
545 &'exim.org'& domain and will have signatures from other people, including
546 other Exim maintainers. We expect that the key will be in the "strong set" of
547 PGP keys. There should be a trust path to that key from Nigel Metheringham's
548 PGP key, a version of which can be found in the release directory in the file
549 &_nigel-pubkey.asc_&. All keys used will be available in public keyserver pools,
550 such as &'pool.sks-keyservers.net'&.
552 At time of last update, releases were being made by Phil Pennock and signed with
553 key &'0x403043153903637F'&, although that key is expected to be replaced in 2013.
554 A trust path from Nigel's key to Phil's can be observed at
555 &url(https://www.security.spodhuis.org/exim-trustpath).
558 The signatures for the tar bundles are in:
560 &_exim-n.nn.tar.gz.asc_&
561 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2.asc_&
563 For each released version, the log of changes is made separately available in a
564 separate file in the directory &_ChangeLogs_& so that it is possible to
565 find out what has changed without having to download the entire distribution.
567 .cindex "documentation" "available formats"
568 The main distribution contains ASCII versions of this specification and other
569 documentation; other formats of the documents are available in separate files
570 inside the &_exim4_& directory of the FTP site:
572 &_exim-html-n.nn.tar.gz_&
573 &_exim-pdf-n.nn.tar.gz_&
574 &_exim-postscript-n.nn.tar.gz_&
575 &_exim-texinfo-n.nn.tar.gz_&
577 These tar files contain only the &_doc_& directory, not the complete
578 distribution, and are also available in &_.bz2_& as well as &_.gz_& forms.
581 .section "Limitations" "SECID6"
583 .cindex "limitations of Exim"
584 .cindex "bang paths" "not handled by Exim"
585 Exim is designed for use as an Internet MTA, and therefore handles addresses in
586 RFC 2822 domain format only. It cannot handle UUCP &"bang paths"&, though
587 simple two-component bang paths can be converted by a straightforward rewriting
588 configuration. This restriction does not prevent Exim from being interfaced to
589 UUCP as a transport mechanism, provided that domain addresses are used.
591 .cindex "domainless addresses"
592 .cindex "address" "without domain"
593 Exim insists that every address it handles has a domain attached. For incoming
594 local messages, domainless addresses are automatically qualified with a
595 configured domain value. Configuration options specify from which remote
596 systems unqualified addresses are acceptable. These are then qualified on
599 .cindex "transport" "external"
600 .cindex "external transports"
601 The only external transport mechanisms that are currently implemented are SMTP
602 and LMTP over a TCP/IP network (including support for IPv6). However, a pipe
603 transport is available, and there are facilities for writing messages to files
604 and pipes, optionally in &'batched SMTP'& format; these facilities can be used
605 to send messages to other transport mechanisms such as UUCP, provided they can
606 handle domain-style addresses. Batched SMTP input is also catered for.
608 Exim is not designed for storing mail for dial-in hosts. When the volumes of
609 such mail are large, it is better to get the messages &"delivered"& into files
610 (that is, off Exim's queue) and subsequently passed on to the dial-in hosts by
613 Although Exim does have basic facilities for scanning incoming messages, these
614 are not comprehensive enough to do full virus or spam scanning. Such operations
615 are best carried out using additional specialized software packages. If you
616 compile Exim with the content-scanning extension, straightforward interfaces to
617 a number of common scanners are provided.
621 .section "Run time configuration" "SECID7"
622 Exim's run time configuration is held in a single text file that is divided
623 into a number of sections. The entries in this file consist of keywords and
624 values, in the style of Smail 3 configuration files. A default configuration
625 file which is suitable for simple online installations is provided in the
626 distribution, and is described in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& below.
629 .section "Calling interface" "SECID8"
630 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "command line interface"
631 Like many MTAs, Exim has adopted the Sendmail command line interface so that it
632 can be a straight replacement for &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& or
633 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& when sending mail, but you do not need to know anything
634 about Sendmail in order to run Exim. For actions other than sending messages,
635 Sendmail-compatible options also exist, but those that produce output (for
636 example, &%-bp%&, which lists the messages on the queue) do so in Exim's own
637 format. There are also some additional options that are compatible with Smail
638 3, and some further options that are new to Exim. Chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&
639 documents all Exim's command line options. This information is automatically
640 made into the man page that forms part of the Exim distribution.
642 Control of messages on the queue can be done via certain privileged command
643 line options. There is also an optional monitor program called &'eximon'&,
644 which displays current information in an X window, and which contains a menu
645 interface to Exim's command line administration options.
649 .section "Terminology" "SECID9"
650 .cindex "terminology definitions"
651 .cindex "body of message" "definition of"
652 The &'body'& of a message is the actual data that the sender wants to transmit.
653 It is the last part of a message, and is separated from the &'header'& (see
654 below) by a blank line.
656 .cindex "bounce message" "definition of"
657 When a message cannot be delivered, it is normally returned to the sender in a
658 delivery failure message or a &"non-delivery report"& (NDR). The term
659 &'bounce'& is commonly used for this action, and the error reports are often
660 called &'bounce messages'&. This is a convenient shorthand for &"delivery
661 failure error report"&. Such messages have an empty sender address in the
662 message's &'envelope'& (see below) to ensure that they cannot themselves give
663 rise to further bounce messages.
665 The term &'default'& appears frequently in this manual. It is used to qualify a
666 value which is used in the absence of any setting in the configuration. It may
667 also qualify an action which is taken unless a configuration setting specifies
670 The term &'defer'& is used when the delivery of a message to a specific
671 destination cannot immediately take place for some reason (a remote host may be
672 down, or a user's local mailbox may be full). Such deliveries are &'deferred'&
675 The word &'domain'& is sometimes used to mean all but the first component of a
676 host's name. It is &'not'& used in that sense here, where it normally refers to
677 the part of an email address following the @ sign.
679 .cindex "envelope, definition of"
680 .cindex "sender" "definition of"
681 A message in transit has an associated &'envelope'&, as well as a header and a
682 body. The envelope contains a sender address (to which bounce messages should
683 be delivered), and any number of recipient addresses. References to the
684 sender or the recipients of a message usually mean the addresses in the
685 envelope. An MTA uses these addresses for delivery, and for returning bounce
686 messages, not the addresses that appear in the header lines.
688 .cindex "message" "header, definition of"
689 .cindex "header section" "definition of"
690 The &'header'& of a message is the first part of a message's text, consisting
691 of a number of lines, each of which has a name such as &'From:'&, &'To:'&,
692 &'Subject:'&, etc. Long header lines can be split over several text lines by
693 indenting the continuations. The header is separated from the body by a blank
696 .cindex "local part" "definition of"
697 .cindex "domain" "definition of"
698 The term &'local part'&, which is taken from RFC 2822, is used to refer to that
699 part of an email address that precedes the @ sign. The part that follows the
700 @ sign is called the &'domain'& or &'mail domain'&.
702 .cindex "local delivery" "definition of"
703 .cindex "remote delivery, definition of"
704 The terms &'local delivery'& and &'remote delivery'& are used to distinguish
705 delivery to a file or a pipe on the local host from delivery by SMTP over
706 TCP/IP to another host. As far as Exim is concerned, all hosts other than the
707 host it is running on are &'remote'&.
709 .cindex "return path" "definition of"
710 &'Return path'& is another name that is used for the sender address in a
713 .cindex "queue" "definition of"
714 The term &'queue'& is used to refer to the set of messages awaiting delivery,
715 because this term is in widespread use in the context of MTAs. However, in
716 Exim's case the reality is more like a pool than a queue, because there is
717 normally no ordering of waiting messages.
719 .cindex "queue runner" "definition of"
720 The term &'queue runner'& is used to describe a process that scans the queue
721 and attempts to deliver those messages whose retry times have come. This term
722 is used by other MTAs, and also relates to the command &%runq%&, but in Exim
723 the waiting messages are normally processed in an unpredictable order.
725 .cindex "spool directory" "definition of"
726 The term &'spool directory'& is used for a directory in which Exim keeps the
727 messages on its queue &-- that is, those that it is in the process of
728 delivering. This should not be confused with the directory in which local
729 mailboxes are stored, which is called a &"spool directory"& by some people. In
730 the Exim documentation, &"spool"& is always used in the first sense.
737 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
738 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
740 .chapter "Incorporated code" "CHID2"
741 .cindex "incorporated code"
742 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
745 A number of pieces of external code are included in the Exim distribution.
748 Regular expressions are supported in the main Exim program and in the
749 Exim monitor using the freely-distributable PCRE library, copyright
750 © University of Cambridge. The source to PCRE is no longer shipped with
751 Exim, so you will need to use the version of PCRE shipped with your system,
752 or obtain and install the full version of the library from
753 &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre).
755 .cindex "cdb" "acknowledgment"
756 Support for the cdb (Constant DataBase) lookup method is provided by code
757 contributed by Nigel Metheringham of (at the time he contributed it) Planet
758 Online Ltd. The implementation is completely contained within the code of Exim.
759 It does not link against an external cdb library. The code contains the
760 following statements:
763 Copyright © 1998 Nigel Metheringham, Planet Online Ltd
765 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
766 the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free Software
767 Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or (at your option) any later
769 This code implements Dan Bernstein's Constant DataBase (cdb) spec. Information,
770 the spec and sample code for cdb can be obtained from
771 &url(http://www.pobox.com/~djb/cdb.html). This implementation borrows
772 some code from Dan Bernstein's implementation (which has no license
773 restrictions applied to it).
776 .cindex "SPA authentication"
777 .cindex "Samba project"
778 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
779 Client support for Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& is provided
780 by code contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux. Server support was contributed by
781 Tom Kistner. This includes code taken from the Samba project, which is released
785 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
786 .cindex "&'pwauthd'& daemon"
787 Support for calling the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& and &'saslauthd'& daemons is provided
788 by code taken from the Cyrus-SASL library and adapted by Alexander S.
789 Sabourenkov. The permission notice appears below, in accordance with the
790 conditions expressed therein.
793 Copyright © 2001 Carnegie Mellon University. All rights reserved.
795 Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
796 modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
800 Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
801 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
803 Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
804 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in
805 the documentation and/or other materials provided with the
808 The name &"Carnegie Mellon University"& must not be used to
809 endorse or promote products derived from this software without
810 prior written permission. For permission or any other legal
811 details, please contact
813 Office of Technology Transfer
814 Carnegie Mellon University
816 Pittsburgh, PA 15213-3890
817 (412) 268-4387, fax: (412) 268-7395
818 tech-transfer@andrew.cmu.edu
821 Redistributions of any form whatsoever must retain the following
824 &"This product includes software developed by Computing Services
825 at Carnegie Mellon University (&url(http://www.cmu.edu/computing/)."&
827 CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO
828 THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY
829 AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY BE LIABLE
830 FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR ANY DAMAGES
831 WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER IN
832 AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION, ARISING
833 OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS SOFTWARE.
838 .cindex "Exim monitor" "acknowledgment"
841 The Exim Monitor program, which is an X-Window application, includes
842 modified versions of the Athena StripChart and TextPop widgets.
843 This code is copyright by DEC and MIT, and their permission notice appears
844 below, in accordance with the conditions expressed therein.
847 Copyright 1987, 1988 by Digital Equipment Corporation, Maynard, Massachusetts,
848 and the Massachusetts Institute of Technology, Cambridge, Massachusetts.
852 Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software and its
853 documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby granted,
854 provided that the above copyright notice appear in all copies and that
855 both that copyright notice and this permission notice appear in
856 supporting documentation, and that the names of Digital or MIT not be
857 used in advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the
858 software without specific, written prior permission.
860 DIGITAL DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING
861 ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL
862 DIGITAL BE LIABLE FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR
863 ANY DAMAGES WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS,
864 WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION,
865 ARISING OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS
870 .cindex "opendmarc" "acknowledgment"
871 The DMARC implementation uses the OpenDMARC library which is Copyrighted by
872 The Trusted Domain Project. Portions of Exim source which use OpenDMARC
873 derived code are indicated in the respective source files. The full OpenDMARC
874 license is provided in the LICENSE.opendmarc file contained in the distributed
878 Many people have contributed code fragments, some large, some small, that were
879 not covered by any specific licence requirements. It is assumed that the
880 contributors are happy to see their code incorporated into Exim under the GPL.
887 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
888 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
890 .chapter "How Exim receives and delivers mail" "CHID11" &&&
891 "Receiving and delivering mail"
894 .section "Overall philosophy" "SECID10"
895 .cindex "design philosophy"
896 Exim is designed to work efficiently on systems that are permanently connected
897 to the Internet and are handling a general mix of mail. In such circumstances,
898 most messages can be delivered immediately. Consequently, Exim does not
899 maintain independent queues of messages for specific domains or hosts, though
900 it does try to send several messages in a single SMTP connection after a host
901 has been down, and it also maintains per-host retry information.
904 .section "Policy control" "SECID11"
905 .cindex "policy control" "overview"
906 Policy controls are now an important feature of MTAs that are connected to the
907 Internet. Perhaps their most important job is to stop MTAs being abused as
908 &"open relays"& by misguided individuals who send out vast amounts of
909 unsolicited junk, and want to disguise its source. Exim provides flexible
910 facilities for specifying policy controls on incoming mail:
913 .cindex "&ACL;" "introduction"
914 Exim 4 (unlike previous versions of Exim) implements policy controls on
915 incoming mail by means of &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs). Each list is a
916 series of statements that may either grant or deny access. ACLs can be used at
917 several places in the SMTP dialogue while receiving a message from a remote
918 host. However, the most common places are after each RCPT command, and at the
919 very end of the message. The sysadmin can specify conditions for accepting or
920 rejecting individual recipients or the entire message, respectively, at these
921 two points (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). Denial of access results in an SMTP
924 An ACL is also available for locally generated, non-SMTP messages. In this
925 case, the only available actions are to accept or deny the entire message.
927 When Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension, facilities are
928 provided in the ACL mechanism for passing the message to external virus and/or
929 spam scanning software. The result of such a scan is passed back to the ACL,
930 which can then use it to decide what to do with the message.
932 When a message has been received, either from a remote host or from the local
933 host, but before the final acknowledgment has been sent, a locally supplied C
934 function called &[local_scan()]& can be run to inspect the message and decide
935 whether to accept it or not (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). If the message
936 is accepted, the list of recipients can be modified by the function.
938 Using the &[local_scan()]& mechanism is another way of calling external scanner
939 software. The &%SA-Exim%& add-on package works this way. It does not require
940 Exim to be compiled with the content-scanning extension.
942 After a message has been accepted, a further checking mechanism is available in
943 the form of the &'system filter'& (see chapter &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&). This
944 runs at the start of every delivery process.
949 .section "User filters" "SECID12"
950 .cindex "filter" "introduction"
951 .cindex "Sieve filter"
952 In a conventional Exim configuration, users are able to run private filters by
953 setting up appropriate &_.forward_& files in their home directories. See
954 chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& (about the &(redirect)& router) for the
955 configuration needed to support this, and the separate document entitled
956 &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'& for user details. Two different kinds
957 of filtering are available:
960 Sieve filters are written in the standard filtering language that is defined
963 Exim filters are written in a syntax that is unique to Exim, but which is more
964 powerful than Sieve, which it pre-dates.
967 User filters are run as part of the routing process, described below.
971 .section "Message identification" "SECTmessiden"
972 .cindex "message ids" "details of format"
973 .cindex "format" "of message id"
974 .cindex "id of message"
979 Every message handled by Exim is given a &'message id'& which is sixteen
980 characters long. It is divided into three parts, separated by hyphens, for
981 example &`16VDhn-0001bo-D3`&. Each part is a sequence of letters and digits,
982 normally encoding numbers in base 62. However, in the Darwin operating
983 system (Mac OS X) and when Exim is compiled to run under Cygwin, base 36
984 (avoiding the use of lower case letters) is used instead, because the message
985 id is used to construct file names, and the names of files in those systems are
986 not always case-sensitive.
988 .cindex "pid (process id)" "re-use of"
989 The detail of the contents of the message id have changed as Exim has evolved.
990 Earlier versions relied on the operating system not re-using a process id (pid)
991 within one second. On modern operating systems, this assumption can no longer
992 be made, so the algorithm had to be changed. To retain backward compatibility,
993 the format of the message id was retained, which is why the following rules are
997 The first six characters of the message id are the time at which the message
998 started to be received, to a granularity of one second. That is, this field
999 contains the number of seconds since the start of the epoch (the normal Unix
1000 way of representing the date and time of day).
1002 After the first hyphen, the next six characters are the id of the process that
1003 received the message.
1005 There are two different possibilities for the final two characters:
1007 .oindex "&%localhost_number%&"
1008 If &%localhost_number%& is not set, this value is the fractional part of the
1009 time of reception, normally in units of 1/2000 of a second, but for systems
1010 that must use base 36 instead of base 62 (because of case-insensitive file
1011 systems), the units are 1/1000 of a second.
1013 If &%localhost_number%& is set, it is multiplied by 200 (100) and added to
1014 the fractional part of the time, which in this case is in units of 1/200
1015 (1/100) of a second.
1019 After a message has been received, Exim waits for the clock to tick at the
1020 appropriate resolution before proceeding, so that if another message is
1021 received by the same process, or by another process with the same (re-used)
1022 pid, it is guaranteed that the time will be different. In most cases, the clock
1023 will already have ticked while the message was being received.
1026 .section "Receiving mail" "SECID13"
1027 .cindex "receiving mail"
1028 .cindex "message" "reception"
1029 The only way Exim can receive mail from another host is using SMTP over
1030 TCP/IP, in which case the sender and recipient addresses are transferred using
1031 SMTP commands. However, from a locally running process (such as a user's MUA),
1032 there are several possibilities:
1035 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bm%& option, the message is read
1036 non-interactively (usually via a pipe), with the recipients taken from the
1037 command line, or from the body of the message if &%-t%& is also used.
1039 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bS%& option, the message is also read
1040 non-interactively, but in this case the recipients are listed at the start of
1041 the message in a series of SMTP RCPT commands, terminated by a DATA
1042 command. This is so-called &"batch SMTP"& format,
1043 but it isn't really SMTP. The SMTP commands are just another way of passing
1044 envelope addresses in a non-interactive submission.
1046 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bs%& option, the message is read
1047 interactively, using the SMTP protocol. A two-way pipe is normally used for
1048 passing data between the local process and the Exim process.
1049 This is &"real"& SMTP and is handled in the same way as SMTP over TCP/IP. For
1050 example, the ACLs for SMTP commands are used for this form of submission.
1052 A local process may also make a TCP/IP call to the host's loopback address
1053 (127.0.0.1) or any other of its IP addresses. When receiving messages, Exim
1054 does not treat the loopback address specially. It treats all such connections
1055 in the same way as connections from other hosts.
1059 .cindex "message sender, constructed by Exim"
1060 .cindex "sender" "constructed by Exim"
1061 In the three cases that do not involve TCP/IP, the sender address is
1062 constructed from the login name of the user that called Exim and a default
1063 qualification domain (which can be set by the &%qualify_domain%& configuration
1064 option). For local or batch SMTP, a sender address that is passed using the
1065 SMTP MAIL command is ignored. However, the system administrator may allow
1066 certain users (&"trusted users"&) to specify a different sender address
1067 unconditionally, or all users to specify certain forms of different sender
1068 address. The &%-f%& option or the SMTP MAIL command is used to specify these
1069 different addresses. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of trusted
1070 users, and the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of allowing untrusted
1071 users to change sender addresses.
1073 Messages received by either of the non-interactive mechanisms are subject to
1074 checking by the non-SMTP ACL, if one is defined. Messages received using SMTP
1075 (either over TCP/IP, or interacting with a local process) can be checked by a
1076 number of ACLs that operate at different times during the SMTP session. Either
1077 individual recipients, or the entire message, can be rejected if local policy
1078 requirements are not met. The &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
1079 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) is run for all incoming messages.
1081 Exim can be configured not to start a delivery process when a message is
1082 received; this can be unconditional, or depend on the number of incoming SMTP
1083 connections or the system load. In these situations, new messages wait on the
1084 queue until a queue runner process picks them up. However, in standard
1085 configurations under normal conditions, delivery is started as soon as a
1086 message is received.
1092 .section "Handling an incoming message" "SECID14"
1093 .cindex "spool directory" "files that hold a message"
1094 .cindex "file" "how a message is held"
1095 When Exim accepts a message, it writes two files in its spool directory. The
1096 first contains the envelope information, the current status of the message, and
1097 the header lines, and the second contains the body of the message. The names of
1098 the two spool files consist of the message id, followed by &`-H`& for the
1099 file containing the envelope and header, and &`-D`& for the data file.
1101 .cindex "spool directory" "&_input_& sub-directory"
1102 By default all these message files are held in a single directory called
1103 &_input_& inside the general Exim spool directory. Some operating systems do
1104 not perform very well if the number of files in a directory gets large; to
1105 improve performance in such cases, the &%split_spool_directory%& option can be
1106 used. This causes Exim to split up the input files into 62 sub-directories
1107 whose names are single letters or digits. When this is done, the queue is
1108 processed one sub-directory at a time instead of all at once, which can improve
1109 overall performance even when there are not enough files in each directory to
1110 affect file system performance.
1112 The envelope information consists of the address of the message's sender and
1113 the addresses of the recipients. This information is entirely separate from
1114 any addresses contained in the header lines. The status of the message includes
1115 a list of recipients who have already received the message. The format of the
1116 first spool file is described in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>&.
1118 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
1119 Address rewriting that is specified in the rewrite section of the configuration
1120 (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&) is done once and for all on incoming addresses,
1121 both in the header lines and the envelope, at the time the message is accepted.
1122 If during the course of delivery additional addresses are generated (for
1123 example, via aliasing), these new addresses are rewritten as soon as they are
1124 generated. At the time a message is actually delivered (transported) further
1125 rewriting can take place; because this is a transport option, it can be
1126 different for different forms of delivery. It is also possible to specify the
1127 addition or removal of certain header lines at the time the message is
1128 delivered (see chapters &<<CHAProutergeneric>>& and
1129 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
1133 .section "Life of a message" "SECID15"
1134 .cindex "message" "life of"
1135 .cindex "message" "frozen"
1136 A message remains in the spool directory until it is completely delivered to
1137 its recipients or to an error address, or until it is deleted by an
1138 administrator or by the user who originally created it. In cases when delivery
1139 cannot proceed &-- for example, when a message can neither be delivered to its
1140 recipients nor returned to its sender, the message is marked &"frozen"& on the
1141 spool, and no more deliveries are attempted.
1143 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
1144 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
1145 An administrator can &"thaw"& such messages when the problem has been
1146 corrected, and can also freeze individual messages by hand if necessary. In
1147 addition, an administrator can force a delivery error, causing a bounce message
1150 .oindex "&%timeout_frozen_after%&"
1151 .oindex "&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&"
1152 There are options called &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& and
1153 &%timeout_frozen_after%&, which discard frozen messages after a certain time.
1154 The first applies only to frozen bounces, the second to any frozen messages.
1156 .cindex "message" "log file for"
1157 .cindex "log" "file for each message"
1158 While Exim is working on a message, it writes information about each delivery
1159 attempt to its main log file. This includes successful, unsuccessful, and
1160 delayed deliveries for each recipient (see chapter &<<CHAPlog>>&). The log
1161 lines are also written to a separate &'message log'& file for each message.
1162 These logs are solely for the benefit of the administrator, and are normally
1163 deleted along with the spool files when processing of a message is complete.
1164 The use of individual message logs can be disabled by setting
1165 &%no_message_logs%&; this might give an improvement in performance on very busy
1168 .cindex "journal file"
1169 .cindex "file" "journal"
1170 All the information Exim itself needs to set up a delivery is kept in the first
1171 spool file, along with the header lines. When a successful delivery occurs, the
1172 address is immediately written at the end of a journal file, whose name is the
1173 message id followed by &`-J`&. At the end of a delivery run, if there are some
1174 addresses left to be tried again later, the first spool file (the &`-H`& file)
1175 is updated to indicate which these are, and the journal file is then deleted.
1176 Updating the spool file is done by writing a new file and renaming it, to
1177 minimize the possibility of data loss.
1179 Should the system or the program crash after a successful delivery but before
1180 the spool file has been updated, the journal is left lying around. The next
1181 time Exim attempts to deliver the message, it reads the journal file and
1182 updates the spool file before proceeding. This minimizes the chances of double
1183 deliveries caused by crashes.
1187 .section "Processing an address for delivery" "SECTprocaddress"
1188 .cindex "drivers" "definition of"
1189 .cindex "router" "definition of"
1190 .cindex "transport" "definition of"
1191 The main delivery processing elements of Exim are called &'routers'& and
1192 &'transports'&, and collectively these are known as &'drivers'&. Code for a
1193 number of them is provided in the source distribution, and compile-time options
1194 specify which ones are included in the binary. Run time options specify which
1195 ones are actually used for delivering messages.
1197 .cindex "drivers" "instance definition"
1198 Each driver that is specified in the run time configuration is an &'instance'&
1199 of that particular driver type. Multiple instances are allowed; for example,
1200 you can set up several different &(smtp)& transports, each with different
1201 option values that might specify different ports or different timeouts. Each
1202 instance has its own identifying name. In what follows we will normally use the
1203 instance name when discussing one particular instance (that is, one specific
1204 configuration of the driver), and the generic driver name when discussing
1205 the driver's features in general.
1207 A &'router'& is a driver that operates on an address, either determining how
1208 its delivery should happen, by assigning it to a specific transport, or
1209 converting the address into one or more new addresses (for example, via an
1210 alias file). A router may also explicitly choose to fail an address, causing it
1213 A &'transport'& is a driver that transmits a copy of the message from Exim's
1214 spool to some destination. There are two kinds of transport: for a &'local'&
1215 transport, the destination is a file or a pipe on the local host, whereas for a
1216 &'remote'& transport the destination is some other host. A message is passed
1217 to a specific transport as a result of successful routing. If a message has
1218 several recipients, it may be passed to a number of different transports.
1220 .cindex "preconditions" "definition of"
1221 An address is processed by passing it to each configured router instance in
1222 turn, subject to certain preconditions, until a router accepts the address or
1223 specifies that it should be bounced. We will describe this process in more
1224 detail shortly. First, as a simple example, we consider how each recipient
1225 address in a message is processed in a small configuration of three routers.
1227 To make this a more concrete example, it is described in terms of some actual
1228 routers, but remember, this is only an example. You can configure Exim's
1229 routers in many different ways, and there may be any number of routers in a
1232 The first router that is specified in a configuration is often one that handles
1233 addresses in domains that are not recognized specially by the local host. These
1234 are typically addresses for arbitrary domains on the Internet. A precondition
1235 is set up which looks for the special domains known to the host (for example,
1236 its own domain name), and the router is run for addresses that do &'not'&
1237 match. Typically, this is a router that looks up domains in the DNS in order to
1238 find the hosts to which this address routes. If it succeeds, the address is
1239 assigned to a suitable SMTP transport; if it does not succeed, the router is
1240 configured to fail the address.
1242 The second router is reached only when the domain is recognized as one that
1243 &"belongs"& to the local host. This router does redirection &-- also known as
1244 aliasing and forwarding. When it generates one or more new addresses from the
1245 original, each of them is routed independently from the start. Otherwise, the
1246 router may cause an address to fail, or it may simply decline to handle the
1247 address, in which case the address is passed to the next router.
1249 The final router in many configurations is one that checks to see if the
1250 address belongs to a local mailbox. The precondition may involve a check to
1251 see if the local part is the name of a login account, or it may look up the
1252 local part in a file or a database. If its preconditions are not met, or if
1253 the router declines, we have reached the end of the routers. When this happens,
1254 the address is bounced.
1258 .section "Processing an address for verification" "SECID16"
1259 .cindex "router" "for verification"
1260 .cindex "verifying address" "overview"
1261 As well as being used to decide how to deliver to an address, Exim's routers
1262 are also used for &'address verification'&. Verification can be requested as
1263 one of the checks to be performed in an ACL for incoming messages, on both
1264 sender and recipient addresses, and it can be tested using the &%-bv%& and
1265 &%-bvs%& command line options.
1267 When an address is being verified, the routers are run in &"verify mode"&. This
1268 does not affect the way the routers work, but it is a state that can be
1269 detected. By this means, a router can be skipped or made to behave differently
1270 when verifying. A common example is a configuration in which the first router
1271 sends all messages to a message-scanning program, unless they have been
1272 previously scanned. Thus, the first router accepts all addresses without any
1273 checking, making it useless for verifying. Normally, the &%no_verify%& option
1274 would be set for such a router, causing it to be skipped in verify mode.
1279 .section "Running an individual router" "SECTrunindrou"
1280 .cindex "router" "running details"
1281 .cindex "preconditions" "checking"
1282 .cindex "router" "result of running"
1283 As explained in the example above, a number of preconditions are checked before
1284 running a router. If any are not met, the router is skipped, and the address is
1285 passed to the next router. When all the preconditions on a router &'are'& met,
1286 the router is run. What happens next depends on the outcome, which is one of
1290 &'accept'&: The router accepts the address, and either assigns it to a
1291 transport, or generates one or more &"child"& addresses. Processing the
1292 original address ceases,
1293 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
1294 unless the &%unseen%& option is set on the router. This option
1295 can be used to set up multiple deliveries with different routing (for example,
1296 for keeping archive copies of messages). When &%unseen%& is set, the address is
1297 passed to the next router. Normally, however, an &'accept'& return marks the
1300 Any child addresses generated by the router are processed independently,
1301 starting with the first router by default. It is possible to change this by
1302 setting the &%redirect_router%& option to specify which router to start at for
1303 child addresses. Unlike &%pass_router%& (see below) the router specified by
1304 &%redirect_router%& may be anywhere in the router configuration.
1306 &'pass'&: The router recognizes the address, but cannot handle it itself. It
1307 requests that the address be passed to another router. By default the address
1308 is passed to the next router, but this can be changed by setting the
1309 &%pass_router%& option. However, (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router
1310 must be below the current router (to avoid loops).
1312 &'decline'&: The router declines to accept the address because it does not
1313 recognize it at all. By default, the address is passed to the next router, but
1314 this can be prevented by setting the &%no_more%& option. When &%no_more%& is
1315 set, all the remaining routers are skipped. In effect, &%no_more%& converts
1316 &'decline'& into &'fail'&.
1318 &'fail'&: The router determines that the address should fail, and queues it for
1319 the generation of a bounce message. There is no further processing of the
1320 original address unless &%unseen%& is set on the router.
1322 &'defer'&: The router cannot handle the address at the present time. (A
1323 database may be offline, or a DNS lookup may have timed out.) No further
1324 processing of the address happens in this delivery attempt. It is tried again
1325 next time the message is considered for delivery.
1327 &'error'&: There is some error in the router (for example, a syntax error in
1328 its configuration). The action is as for defer.
1331 If an address reaches the end of the routers without having been accepted by
1332 any of them, it is bounced as unrouteable. The default error message in this
1333 situation is &"unrouteable address"&, but you can set your own message by
1334 making use of the &%cannot_route_message%& option. This can be set for any
1335 router; the value from the last router that &"saw"& the address is used.
1337 Sometimes while routing you want to fail a delivery when some conditions are
1338 met but others are not, instead of passing the address on for further routing.
1339 You can do this by having a second router that explicitly fails the delivery
1340 when the relevant conditions are met. The &(redirect)& router has a &"fail"&
1341 facility for this purpose.
1344 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECID17"
1345 .cindex "case of local parts"
1346 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
1347 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
1348 Once routing is complete, Exim scans the addresses that are assigned to local
1349 and remote transports, and discards any duplicates that it finds. During this
1350 check, local parts are treated as case-sensitive. This happens only when
1351 actually delivering a message; when testing routers with &%-bt%&, all the
1352 routed addresses are shown.
1356 .section "Router preconditions" "SECTrouprecon"
1357 .cindex "router" "preconditions, order of processing"
1358 .cindex "preconditions" "order of processing"
1359 The preconditions that are tested for each router are listed below, in the
1360 order in which they are tested. The individual configuration options are
1361 described in more detail in chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&.
1364 The &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& options can specify that
1365 the local parts handled by the router may or must have certain prefixes and/or
1366 suffixes. If a mandatory affix (prefix or suffix) is not present, the router is
1367 skipped. These conditions are tested first. When an affix is present, it is
1368 removed from the local part before further processing, including the evaluation
1369 of any other conditions.
1371 Routers can be designated for use only when not verifying an address, that is,
1372 only when routing it for delivery (or testing its delivery routing). If the
1373 &%verify%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is verifying an
1375 Setting the &%verify%& option actually sets two options, &%verify_sender%& and
1376 &%verify_recipient%&, which independently control the use of the router for
1377 sender and recipient verification. You can set these options directly if
1378 you want a router to be used for only one type of verification.
1379 Note that cutthrough delivery is classed as a recipient verification
1382 If the &%address_test%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is
1383 run with the &%-bt%& option to test an address routing. This can be helpful
1384 when the first router sends all new messages to a scanner of some sort; it
1385 makes it possible to use &%-bt%& to test subsequent delivery routing without
1386 having to simulate the effect of the scanner.
1388 Routers can be designated for use only when verifying an address, as
1389 opposed to routing it for delivery. The &%verify_only%& option controls this.
1390 Again, cutthrough delibery counts as a verification.
1392 Individual routers can be explicitly skipped when running the routers to
1393 check an address given in the SMTP EXPN command (see the &%expn%& option).
1395 If the &%domains%& option is set, the domain of the address must be in the set
1396 of domains that it defines.
1398 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
1399 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
1400 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
1401 If the &%local_parts%& option is set, the local part of the address must be in
1402 the set of local parts that it defines. If &%local_part_prefix%& or
1403 &%local_part_suffix%& is in use, the prefix or suffix is removed from the local
1404 part before this check. If you want to do precondition tests on local parts
1405 that include affixes, you can do so by using a &%condition%& option (see below)
1406 that uses the variables &$local_part$&, &$local_part_prefix$&, and
1407 &$local_part_suffix$& as necessary.
1409 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
1410 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
1412 If the &%check_local_user%& option is set, the local part must be the name of
1413 an account on the local host. If this check succeeds, the uid and gid of the
1414 local user are placed in &$local_user_uid$& and &$local_user_gid$& and the
1415 user's home directory is placed in &$home$&; these values can be used in the
1416 remaining preconditions.
1418 If the &%router_home_directory%& option is set, it is expanded at this point,
1419 because it overrides the value of &$home$&. If this expansion were left till
1420 later, the value of &$home$& as set by &%check_local_user%& would be used in
1421 subsequent tests. Having two different values of &$home$& in the same router
1422 could lead to confusion.
1424 If the &%senders%& option is set, the envelope sender address must be in the
1425 set of addresses that it defines.
1427 If the &%require_files%& option is set, the existence or non-existence of
1428 specified files is tested.
1430 .cindex "customizing" "precondition"
1431 If the &%condition%& option is set, it is evaluated and tested. This option
1432 uses an expanded string to allow you to set up your own custom preconditions.
1433 Expanded strings are described in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
1437 Note that &%require_files%& comes near the end of the list, so you cannot use
1438 it to check for the existence of a file in which to lookup up a domain, local
1439 part, or sender. However, as these options are all expanded, you can use the
1440 &%exists%& expansion condition to make such tests within each condition. The
1441 &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files that the router may be
1442 going to use internally, or which are needed by a specific transport (for
1443 example, &_.procmailrc_&).
1447 .section "Delivery in detail" "SECID18"
1448 .cindex "delivery" "in detail"
1449 When a message is to be delivered, the sequence of events is as follows:
1452 If a system-wide filter file is specified, the message is passed to it. The
1453 filter may add recipients to the message, replace the recipients, discard the
1454 message, cause a new message to be generated, or cause the message delivery to
1455 fail. The format of the system filter file is the same as for Exim user filter
1456 files, described in the separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail
1458 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
1459 (&*Note*&: Sieve cannot be used for system filter files.)
1461 Some additional features are available in system filters &-- see chapter
1462 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>& for details. Note that a message is passed to the system
1463 filter only once per delivery attempt, however many recipients it has. However,
1464 if there are several delivery attempts because one or more addresses could not
1465 be immediately delivered, the system filter is run each time. The filter
1466 condition &%first_delivery%& can be used to detect the first run of the system
1469 Each recipient address is offered to each configured router in turn, subject to
1470 its preconditions, until one is able to handle it. If no router can handle the
1471 address, that is, if they all decline, the address is failed. Because routers
1472 can be targeted at particular domains, several locally handled domains can be
1473 processed entirely independently of each other.
1475 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
1476 .cindex "loop" "while routing"
1477 A router that accepts an address may assign it to a local or a remote
1478 transport. However, the transport is not run at this time. Instead, the address
1479 is placed on a list for the particular transport, which will be run later.
1480 Alternatively, the router may generate one or more new addresses (typically
1481 from alias, forward, or filter files). New addresses are fed back into this
1482 process from the top, but in order to avoid loops, a router ignores any address
1483 which has an identically-named ancestor that was processed by itself.
1485 When all the routing has been done, addresses that have been successfully
1486 handled are passed to their assigned transports. When local transports are
1487 doing real local deliveries, they handle only one address at a time, but if a
1488 local transport is being used as a pseudo-remote transport (for example, to
1489 collect batched SMTP messages for transmission by some other means) multiple
1490 addresses can be handled. Remote transports can always handle more than one
1491 address at a time, but can be configured not to do so, or to restrict multiple
1492 addresses to the same domain.
1494 Each local delivery to a file or a pipe runs in a separate process under a
1495 non-privileged uid, and these deliveries are run one at a time. Remote
1496 deliveries also run in separate processes, normally under a uid that is private
1497 to Exim (&"the Exim user"&), but in this case, several remote deliveries can be
1498 run in parallel. The maximum number of simultaneous remote deliveries for any
1499 one message is set by the &%remote_max_parallel%& option.
1500 The order in which deliveries are done is not defined, except that all local
1501 deliveries happen before any remote deliveries.
1503 .cindex "queue runner"
1504 When it encounters a local delivery during a queue run, Exim checks its retry
1505 database to see if there has been a previous temporary delivery failure for the
1506 address before running the local transport. If there was a previous failure,
1507 Exim does not attempt a new delivery until the retry time for the address is
1508 reached. However, this happens only for delivery attempts that are part of a
1509 queue run. Local deliveries are always attempted when delivery immediately
1510 follows message reception, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for
1511 better behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example,
1512 causing quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file).
1514 .cindex "delivery" "retry in remote transports"
1515 Remote transports do their own retry handling, since an address may be
1516 deliverable to one of a number of hosts, each of which may have a different
1517 retry time. If there have been previous temporary failures and no host has
1518 reached its retry time, no delivery is attempted, whether in a queue run or
1519 not. See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for details of retry strategies.
1521 If there were any permanent errors, a bounce message is returned to an
1522 appropriate address (the sender in the common case), with details of the error
1523 for each failing address. Exim can be configured to send copies of bounce
1524 messages to other addresses.
1526 .cindex "delivery" "deferral"
1527 If one or more addresses suffered a temporary failure, the message is left on
1528 the queue, to be tried again later. Delivery of these addresses is said to be
1531 When all the recipient addresses have either been delivered or bounced,
1532 handling of the message is complete. The spool files and message log are
1533 deleted, though the message log can optionally be preserved if required.
1539 .section "Retry mechanism" "SECID19"
1540 .cindex "delivery" "retry mechanism"
1541 .cindex "retry" "description of mechanism"
1542 .cindex "queue runner"
1543 Exim's mechanism for retrying messages that fail to get delivered at the first
1544 attempt is the queue runner process. You must either run an Exim daemon that
1545 uses the &%-q%& option with a time interval to start queue runners at regular
1546 intervals, or use some other means (such as &'cron'&) to start them. If you do
1547 not arrange for queue runners to be run, messages that fail temporarily at the
1548 first attempt will remain on your queue for ever. A queue runner process works
1549 its way through the queue, one message at a time, trying each delivery that has
1550 passed its retry time.
1551 You can run several queue runners at once.
1553 Exim uses a set of configured rules to determine when next to retry the failing
1554 address (see chapter &<<CHAPretry>>&). These rules also specify when Exim
1555 should give up trying to deliver to the address, at which point it generates a
1556 bounce message. If no retry rules are set for a particular host, address, and
1557 error combination, no retries are attempted, and temporary errors are treated
1562 .section "Temporary delivery failure" "SECID20"
1563 .cindex "delivery" "temporary failure"
1564 There are many reasons why a message may not be immediately deliverable to a
1565 particular address. Failure to connect to a remote machine (because it, or the
1566 connection to it, is down) is one of the most common. Temporary failures may be
1567 detected during routing as well as during the transport stage of delivery.
1568 Local deliveries may be delayed if NFS files are unavailable, or if a mailbox
1569 is on a file system where the user is over quota. Exim can be configured to
1570 impose its own quotas on local mailboxes; where system quotas are set they will
1573 If a host is unreachable for a period of time, a number of messages may be
1574 waiting for it by the time it recovers, and sending them in a single SMTP
1575 connection is clearly beneficial. Whenever a delivery to a remote host is
1577 .cindex "hints database"
1578 Exim makes a note in its hints database, and whenever a successful
1579 SMTP delivery has happened, it looks to see if any other messages are waiting
1580 for the same host. If any are found, they are sent over the same SMTP
1581 connection, subject to a configuration limit as to the maximum number in any
1586 .section "Permanent delivery failure" "SECID21"
1587 .cindex "delivery" "permanent failure"
1588 .cindex "bounce message" "when generated"
1589 When a message cannot be delivered to some or all of its intended recipients, a
1590 bounce message is generated. Temporary delivery failures turn into permanent
1591 errors when their timeout expires. All the addresses that fail in a given
1592 delivery attempt are listed in a single message. If the original message has
1593 many recipients, it is possible for some addresses to fail in one delivery
1594 attempt and others to fail subsequently, giving rise to more than one bounce
1595 message. The wording of bounce messages can be customized by the administrator.
1596 See chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>& for details.
1598 .cindex "&'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line"
1599 Bounce messages contain an &'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line that lists the
1600 failed addresses, for the benefit of programs that try to analyse such messages
1603 .cindex "bounce message" "recipient of"
1604 A bounce message is normally sent to the sender of the original message, as
1605 obtained from the message's envelope. For incoming SMTP messages, this is the
1606 address given in the MAIL command. However, when an address is expanded via a
1607 forward or alias file, an alternative address can be specified for delivery
1608 failures of the generated addresses. For a mailing list expansion (see section
1609 &<<SECTmailinglists>>&) it is common to direct bounce messages to the manager
1614 .section "Failures to deliver bounce messages" "SECID22"
1615 .cindex "bounce message" "failure to deliver"
1616 If a bounce message (either locally generated or received from a remote host)
1617 itself suffers a permanent delivery failure, the message is left on the queue,
1618 but it is frozen, awaiting the attention of an administrator. There are options
1619 that can be used to make Exim discard such failed messages, or to keep them
1620 for only a short time (see &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
1621 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
1627 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1628 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1630 .chapter "Building and installing Exim" "CHID3"
1631 .scindex IIDbuex "building Exim"
1633 .section "Unpacking" "SECID23"
1634 Exim is distributed as a gzipped or bzipped tar file which, when unpacked,
1635 creates a directory with the name of the current release (for example,
1636 &_exim-&version()_&) into which the following files are placed:
1639 .irow &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_& "contains some acknowledgments"
1640 .irow &_CHANGES_& "contains a reference to where changes are &&&
1642 .irow &_LICENCE_& "the GNU General Public Licence"
1643 .irow &_Makefile_& "top-level make file"
1644 .irow &_NOTICE_& "conditions for the use of Exim"
1645 .irow &_README_& "list of files, directories and simple build &&&
1649 Other files whose names begin with &_README_& may also be present. The
1650 following subdirectories are created:
1653 .irow &_Local_& "an empty directory for local configuration files"
1654 .irow &_OS_& "OS-specific files"
1655 .irow &_doc_& "documentation files"
1656 .irow &_exim_monitor_& "source files for the Exim monitor"
1657 .irow &_scripts_& "scripts used in the build process"
1658 .irow &_src_& "remaining source files"
1659 .irow &_util_& "independent utilities"
1662 The main utility programs are contained in the &_src_& directory, and are built
1663 with the Exim binary. The &_util_& directory contains a few optional scripts
1664 that may be useful to some sites.
1667 .section "Multiple machine architectures and operating systems" "SECID24"
1668 .cindex "building Exim" "multiple OS/architectures"
1669 The building process for Exim is arranged to make it easy to build binaries for
1670 a number of different architectures and operating systems from the same set of
1671 source files. Compilation does not take place in the &_src_& directory.
1672 Instead, a &'build directory'& is created for each architecture and operating
1674 .cindex "symbolic link" "to build directory"
1675 Symbolic links to the sources are installed in this directory, which is where
1676 the actual building takes place. In most cases, Exim can discover the machine
1677 architecture and operating system for itself, but the defaults can be
1678 overridden if necessary.
1681 .section "PCRE library" "SECTpcre"
1682 .cindex "PCRE library"
1683 Exim no longer has an embedded PCRE library as the vast majority of
1684 modern systems include PCRE as a system library, although you may need
1685 to install the PCRE or PCRE development package for your operating
1686 system. If your system has a normal PCRE installation the Exim build
1687 process will need no further configuration. If the library or the
1688 headers are in an unusual location you will need to either set the PCRE_LIBS
1689 and INCLUDE directives appropriately,
1690 or set PCRE_CONFIG=yes to use the installed &(pcre-config)& command.
1691 If your operating system has no
1692 PCRE support then you will need to obtain and build the current PCRE
1693 from &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre/).
1694 More information on PCRE is available at &url(http://www.pcre.org/).
1696 .section "DBM libraries" "SECTdb"
1697 .cindex "DBM libraries" "discussion of"
1698 .cindex "hints database" "DBM files used for"
1699 Even if you do not use any DBM files in your configuration, Exim still needs a
1700 DBM library in order to operate, because it uses indexed files for its hints
1701 databases. Unfortunately, there are a number of DBM libraries in existence, and
1702 different operating systems often have different ones installed.
1704 .cindex "Solaris" "DBM library for"
1705 .cindex "IRIX, DBM library for"
1706 .cindex "BSD, DBM library for"
1707 .cindex "Linux, DBM library for"
1708 If you are using Solaris, IRIX, one of the modern BSD systems, or a modern
1709 Linux distribution, the DBM configuration should happen automatically, and you
1710 may be able to ignore this section. Otherwise, you may have to learn more than
1711 you would like about DBM libraries from what follows.
1713 .cindex "&'ndbm'& DBM library"
1714 Licensed versions of Unix normally contain a library of DBM functions operating
1715 via the &'ndbm'& interface, and this is what Exim expects by default. Free
1716 versions of Unix seem to vary in what they contain as standard. In particular,
1717 some early versions of Linux have no default DBM library, and different
1718 distributors have chosen to bundle different libraries with their packaged
1719 versions. However, the more recent releases seem to have standardized on the
1720 Berkeley DB library.
1722 Different DBM libraries have different conventions for naming the files they
1723 use. When a program opens a file called &_dbmfile_&, there are several
1727 A traditional &'ndbm'& implementation, such as that supplied as part of
1728 Solaris, operates on two files called &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&.
1730 .cindex "&'gdbm'& DBM library"
1731 The GNU library, &'gdbm'&, operates on a single file. If used via its &'ndbm'&
1732 compatibility interface it makes two different hard links to it with names
1733 &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&, but if used via its native interface, the
1734 file name is used unmodified.
1736 .cindex "Berkeley DB library"
1737 The Berkeley DB package, if called via its &'ndbm'& compatibility interface,
1738 operates on a single file called &_dbmfile.db_&, but otherwise looks to the
1739 programmer exactly the same as the traditional &'ndbm'& implementation.
1741 If the Berkeley package is used in its native mode, it operates on a single
1742 file called &_dbmfile_&; the programmer's interface is somewhat different to
1743 the traditional &'ndbm'& interface.
1745 To complicate things further, there are several very different versions of the
1746 Berkeley DB package. Version 1.85 was stable for a very long time, releases
1747 2.&'x'& and 3.&'x'& were current for a while, but the latest versions are now
1748 numbered 4.&'x'&. Maintenance of some of the earlier releases has ceased. All
1749 versions of Berkeley DB can be obtained from
1750 &url(http://www.sleepycat.com/).
1752 .cindex "&'tdb'& DBM library"
1753 Yet another DBM library, called &'tdb'&, is available from
1754 &url(http://download.sourceforge.net/tdb). It has its own interface, and also
1755 operates on a single file.
1759 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
1760 Exim and its utilities can be compiled to use any of these interfaces. In order
1761 to use any version of the Berkeley DB package in native mode, you must set
1762 USE_DB in an appropriate configuration file (typically
1763 &_Local/Makefile_&). For example:
1767 Similarly, for gdbm you set USE_GDBM, and for tdb you set USE_TDB. An
1768 error is diagnosed if you set more than one of these.
1770 At the lowest level, the build-time configuration sets none of these options,
1771 thereby assuming an interface of type (1). However, some operating system
1772 configuration files (for example, those for the BSD operating systems and
1773 Linux) assume type (4) by setting USE_DB as their default, and the
1774 configuration files for Cygwin set USE_GDBM. Anything you set in
1775 &_Local/Makefile_&, however, overrides these system defaults.
1777 As well as setting USE_DB, USE_GDBM, or USE_TDB, it may also be
1778 necessary to set DBMLIB, to cause inclusion of the appropriate library, as
1779 in one of these lines:
1784 Settings like that will work if the DBM library is installed in the standard
1785 place. Sometimes it is not, and the library's header file may also not be in
1786 the default path. You may need to set INCLUDE to specify where the header
1787 file is, and to specify the path to the library more fully in DBMLIB, as in
1790 INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/include/db-4.1
1791 DBMLIB=/usr/local/lib/db-4.1/libdb.a
1793 There is further detailed discussion about the various DBM libraries in the
1794 file &_doc/dbm.discuss.txt_& in the Exim distribution.
1798 .section "Pre-building configuration" "SECID25"
1799 .cindex "building Exim" "pre-building configuration"
1800 .cindex "configuration for building Exim"
1801 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
1802 .cindex "&_src/EDITME_&"
1803 Before building Exim, a local configuration file that specifies options
1804 independent of any operating system has to be created with the name
1805 &_Local/Makefile_&. A template for this file is supplied as the file
1806 &_src/EDITME_&, and it contains full descriptions of all the option settings
1807 therein. These descriptions are therefore not repeated here. If you are
1808 building Exim for the first time, the simplest thing to do is to copy
1809 &_src/EDITME_& to &_Local/Makefile_&, then read it and edit it appropriately.
1811 There are three settings that you must supply, because Exim will not build
1812 without them. They are the location of the run time configuration file
1813 (CONFIGURE_FILE), the directory in which Exim binaries will be installed
1814 (BIN_DIRECTORY), and the identity of the Exim user (EXIM_USER and
1815 maybe EXIM_GROUP as well). The value of CONFIGURE_FILE can in fact be
1816 a colon-separated list of file names; Exim uses the first of them that exists.
1818 There are a few other parameters that can be specified either at build time or
1819 at run time, to enable the same binary to be used on a number of different
1820 machines. However, if the locations of Exim's spool directory and log file
1821 directory (if not within the spool directory) are fixed, it is recommended that
1822 you specify them in &_Local/Makefile_& instead of at run time, so that errors
1823 detected early in Exim's execution (such as a malformed configuration file) can
1826 .cindex "content scanning" "specifying at build time"
1827 Exim's interfaces for calling virus and spam scanning software directly from
1828 access control lists are not compiled by default. If you want to include these
1829 facilities, you need to set
1831 WITH_CONTENT_SCAN=yes
1833 in your &_Local/Makefile_&. For details of the facilities themselves, see
1834 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
1837 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
1838 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
1839 If you are going to build the Exim monitor, a similar configuration process is
1840 required. The file &_exim_monitor/EDITME_& must be edited appropriately for
1841 your installation and saved under the name &_Local/eximon.conf_&. If you are
1842 happy with the default settings described in &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&,
1843 &_Local/eximon.conf_& can be empty, but it must exist.
1845 This is all the configuration that is needed in straightforward cases for known
1846 operating systems. However, the building process is set up so that it is easy
1847 to override options that are set by default or by operating-system-specific
1848 configuration files, for example to change the name of the C compiler, which
1849 defaults to &%gcc%&. See section &<<SECToverride>>& below for details of how to
1854 .section "Support for iconv()" "SECID26"
1855 .cindex "&[iconv()]& support"
1857 The contents of header lines in messages may be encoded according to the rules
1858 described RFC 2047. This makes it possible to transmit characters that are not
1859 in the ASCII character set, and to label them as being in a particular
1860 character set. When Exim is inspecting header lines by means of the &%$h_%&
1861 mechanism, it decodes them, and translates them into a specified character set
1862 (default ISO-8859-1). The translation is possible only if the operating system
1863 supports the &[iconv()]& function.
1865 However, some of the operating systems that supply &[iconv()]& do not support
1866 very many conversions. The GNU &%libiconv%& library (available from
1867 &url(http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv/)) can be installed on such
1868 systems to remedy this deficiency, as well as on systems that do not supply
1869 &[iconv()]& at all. After installing &%libiconv%&, you should add
1873 to your &_Local/Makefile_& and rebuild Exim.
1877 .section "Including TLS/SSL encryption support" "SECTinctlsssl"
1878 .cindex "TLS" "including support for TLS"
1879 .cindex "encryption" "including support for"
1880 .cindex "SUPPORT_TLS"
1881 .cindex "OpenSSL" "building Exim with"
1882 .cindex "GnuTLS" "building Exim with"
1883 Exim can be built to support encrypted SMTP connections, using the STARTTLS
1884 command as per RFC 2487. It can also support legacy clients that expect to
1885 start a TLS session immediately on connection to a non-standard port (see the
1886 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& runtime option and the &%-tls-on-connect%& command
1889 If you want to build Exim with TLS support, you must first install either the
1890 OpenSSL or GnuTLS library. There is no cryptographic code in Exim itself for
1893 If OpenSSL is installed, you should set
1896 TLS_LIBS=-lssl -lcrypto
1898 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You may also need to specify the locations of the
1899 OpenSSL library and include files. For example:
1902 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/local/openssl/lib -lssl -lcrypto
1903 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/openssl/include/
1905 .cindex "pkg-config" "OpenSSL"
1906 If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1909 USE_OPENSSL_PC=openssl
1911 .cindex "USE_GNUTLS"
1912 If GnuTLS is installed, you should set
1916 TLS_LIBS=-lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1918 in &_Local/Makefile_&, and again you may need to specify the locations of the
1919 library and include files. For example:
1923 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/gnu/lib -lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1924 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/gnu/include
1926 .cindex "pkg-config" "GnuTLS"
1927 If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1931 USE_GNUTLS_PC=gnutls
1934 You do not need to set TLS_INCLUDE if the relevant directory is already
1935 specified in INCLUDE. Details of how to configure Exim to make use of TLS are
1936 given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
1941 .section "Use of tcpwrappers" "SECID27"
1943 .cindex "tcpwrappers, building Exim to support"
1944 .cindex "USE_TCP_WRAPPERS"
1945 .cindex "TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME"
1946 .cindex "tcp_wrappers_daemon_name"
1947 Exim can be linked with the &'tcpwrappers'& library in order to check incoming
1948 SMTP calls using the &'tcpwrappers'& control files. This may be a convenient
1949 alternative to Exim's own checking facilities for installations that are
1950 already making use of &'tcpwrappers'& for other purposes. To do this, you
1951 should set USE_TCP_WRAPPERS in &_Local/Makefile_&, arrange for the file
1952 &_tcpd.h_& to be available at compile time, and also ensure that the library
1953 &_libwrap.a_& is available at link time, typically by including &%-lwrap%& in
1954 EXTRALIBS_EXIM. For example, if &'tcpwrappers'& is installed in &_/usr/local_&,
1957 USE_TCP_WRAPPERS=yes
1958 CFLAGS=-O -I/usr/local/include
1959 EXTRALIBS_EXIM=-L/usr/local/lib -lwrap
1961 in &_Local/Makefile_&. The daemon name to use in the &'tcpwrappers'& control
1962 files is &"exim"&. For example, the line
1964 exim : LOCAL 192.168.1. .friendly.domain.example
1966 in your &_/etc/hosts.allow_& file allows connections from the local host, from
1967 the subnet 192.168.1.0/24, and from all hosts in &'friendly.domain.example'&.
1968 All other connections are denied. The daemon name used by &'tcpwrappers'&
1969 can be changed at build time by setting TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME in
1970 &_Local/Makefile_&, or by setting tcp_wrappers_daemon_name in the
1971 configure file. Consult the &'tcpwrappers'& documentation for
1975 .section "Including support for IPv6" "SECID28"
1976 .cindex "IPv6" "including support for"
1977 Exim contains code for use on systems that have IPv6 support. Setting
1978 &`HAVE_IPV6=YES`& in &_Local/Makefile_& causes the IPv6 code to be included;
1979 it may also be necessary to set IPV6_INCLUDE and IPV6_LIBS on systems
1980 where the IPv6 support is not fully integrated into the normal include and
1983 Two different types of DNS record for handling IPv6 addresses have been
1984 defined. AAAA records (analogous to A records for IPv4) are in use, and are
1985 currently seen as the mainstream. Another record type called A6 was proposed
1986 as better than AAAA because it had more flexibility. However, it was felt to be
1987 over-complex, and its status was reduced to &"experimental"&. It is not known
1988 if anyone is actually using A6 records. Exim has support for A6 records, but
1989 this is included only if you set &`SUPPORT_A6=YES`& in &_Local/Makefile_&. The
1990 support has not been tested for some time.
1994 .section "Dynamically loaded lookup module support" "SECTdynamicmodules"
1995 .cindex "lookup modules"
1996 .cindex "dynamic modules"
1997 .cindex ".so building"
1998 On some platforms, Exim supports not compiling all lookup types directly into
1999 the main binary, instead putting some into external modules which can be loaded
2001 This permits packagers to build Exim with support for lookups with extensive
2002 library dependencies without requiring all users to install all of those
2004 Most, but not all, lookup types can be built this way.
2006 Set &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& to the directory into which the modules will be
2007 installed; Exim will only load modules from that directory, as a security
2008 measure. You will need to set &`CFLAGS_DYNAMIC`& if not already defined
2009 for your OS; see &_OS/Makefile-Linux_& for an example.
2010 Some other requirements for adjusting &`EXTRALIBS`& may also be necessary,
2011 see &_src/EDITME_& for details.
2013 Then, for each module to be loaded dynamically, define the relevant
2014 &`LOOKUP_`&<&'lookup_type'&> flags to have the value "2" instead of "yes".
2015 For example, this will build in lsearch but load sqlite and mysql support
2024 .section "The building process" "SECID29"
2025 .cindex "build directory"
2026 Once &_Local/Makefile_& (and &_Local/eximon.conf_&, if required) have been
2027 created, run &'make'& at the top level. It determines the architecture and
2028 operating system types, and creates a build directory if one does not exist.
2029 For example, on a Sun system running Solaris 8, the directory
2030 &_build-SunOS5-5.8-sparc_& is created.
2031 .cindex "symbolic link" "to source files"
2032 Symbolic links to relevant source files are installed in the build directory.
2034 &*Warning*&: The &%-j%& (parallel) flag must not be used with &'make'&; the
2035 building process fails if it is set.
2037 If this is the first time &'make'& has been run, it calls a script that builds
2038 a make file inside the build directory, using the configuration files from the
2039 &_Local_& directory. The new make file is then passed to another instance of
2040 &'make'&. This does the real work, building a number of utility scripts, and
2041 then compiling and linking the binaries for the Exim monitor (if configured), a
2042 number of utility programs, and finally Exim itself. The command &`make
2043 makefile`& can be used to force a rebuild of the make file in the build
2044 directory, should this ever be necessary.
2046 If you have problems building Exim, check for any comments there may be in the
2047 &_README_& file concerning your operating system, and also take a look at the
2048 FAQ, where some common problems are covered.
2052 .section 'Output from &"make"&' "SECID283"
2053 The output produced by the &'make'& process for compile lines is often very
2054 unreadable, because these lines can be very long. For this reason, the normal
2055 output is suppressed by default, and instead output similar to that which
2056 appears when compiling the 2.6 Linux kernel is generated: just a short line for
2057 each module that is being compiled or linked. However, it is still possible to
2058 get the full output, by calling &'make'& like this:
2062 The value of FULLECHO defaults to &"@"&, the flag character that suppresses
2063 command reflection in &'make'&. When you ask for the full output, it is
2064 given in addition to the short output.
2068 .section "Overriding build-time options for Exim" "SECToverride"
2069 .cindex "build-time options, overriding"
2070 The main make file that is created at the beginning of the building process
2071 consists of the concatenation of a number of files which set configuration
2072 values, followed by a fixed set of &'make'& instructions. If a value is set
2073 more than once, the last setting overrides any previous ones. This provides a
2074 convenient way of overriding defaults. The files that are concatenated are, in
2077 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2078 &_OS/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2080 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2081 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'archtype'&>
2082 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2083 &_OS/Makefile-Base_&
2085 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
2086 .cindex "building Exim" "operating system type"
2087 .cindex "building Exim" "architecture type"
2088 where <&'ostype'&> is the operating system type and <&'archtype'&> is the
2089 architecture type. &_Local/Makefile_& is required to exist, and the building
2090 process fails if it is absent. The other three &_Local_& files are optional,
2091 and are often not needed.
2093 The values used for <&'ostype'&> and <&'archtype'&> are obtained from scripts
2094 called &_scripts/os-type_& and &_scripts/arch-type_& respectively. If either of
2095 the environment variables EXIM_OSTYPE or EXIM_ARCHTYPE is set, their
2096 values are used, thereby providing a means of forcing particular settings.
2097 Otherwise, the scripts try to get values from the &%uname%& command. If this
2098 fails, the shell variables OSTYPE and ARCHTYPE are inspected. A number
2099 of &'ad hoc'& transformations are then applied, to produce the standard names
2100 that Exim expects. You can run these scripts directly from the shell in order
2101 to find out what values are being used on your system.
2104 &_OS/Makefile-Default_& contains comments about the variables that are set
2105 therein. Some (but not all) are mentioned below. If there is something that
2106 needs changing, review the contents of this file and the contents of the make
2107 file for your operating system (&_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&) to see what the
2111 .cindex "building Exim" "overriding default settings"
2112 If you need to change any of the values that are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2113 or in &_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&, or to add any new definitions, you do not
2114 need to change the original files. Instead, you should make the changes by
2115 putting the new values in an appropriate &_Local_& file. For example,
2116 .cindex "Tru64-Unix build-time settings"
2117 when building Exim in many releases of the Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX,
2118 formerly DEC-OSF1) operating system, it is necessary to specify that the C
2119 compiler is called &'cc'& rather than &'gcc'&. Also, the compiler must be
2120 called with the option &%-std1%&, to make it recognize some of the features of
2121 Standard C that Exim uses. (Most other compilers recognize Standard C by
2122 default.) To do this, you should create a file called &_Local/Makefile-OSF1_&
2123 containing the lines
2128 If you are compiling for just one operating system, it may be easier to put
2129 these lines directly into &_Local/Makefile_&.
2131 Keeping all your local configuration settings separate from the distributed
2132 files makes it easy to transfer them to new versions of Exim simply by copying
2133 the contents of the &_Local_& directory.
2136 .cindex "NIS lookup type" "including support for"
2137 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type" "including support for"
2138 .cindex "LDAP" "including support for"
2139 .cindex "lookup" "inclusion in binary"
2140 Exim contains support for doing LDAP, NIS, NIS+, and other kinds of file
2141 lookup, but not all systems have these components installed, so the default is
2142 not to include the relevant code in the binary. All the different kinds of file
2143 and database lookup that Exim supports are implemented as separate code modules
2144 which are included only if the relevant compile-time options are set. In the
2145 case of LDAP, NIS, and NIS+, the settings for &_Local/Makefile_& are:
2151 and similar settings apply to the other lookup types. They are all listed in
2152 &_src/EDITME_&. In many cases the relevant include files and interface
2153 libraries need to be installed before compiling Exim.
2154 .cindex "cdb" "including support for"
2155 However, there are some optional lookup types (such as cdb) for which
2156 the code is entirely contained within Exim, and no external include
2157 files or libraries are required. When a lookup type is not included in the
2158 binary, attempts to configure Exim to use it cause run time configuration
2161 .cindex "pkg-config" "lookups"
2162 .cindex "pkg-config" "authenticators"
2163 Many systems now use a tool called &'pkg-config'& to encapsulate information
2164 about how to compile against a library; Exim has some initial support for
2165 being able to use pkg-config for lookups and authenticators. For any given
2166 makefile variable which starts &`LOOKUP_`& or &`AUTH_`&, you can add a new
2167 variable with the &`_PC`& suffix in the name and assign as the value the
2168 name of the package to be queried. The results of querying via the
2169 &'pkg-config'& command will be added to the appropriate Makefile variables
2170 with &`+=`& directives, so your version of &'make'& will need to support that
2171 syntax. For instance:
2174 LOOKUP_SQLITE_PC=sqlite3
2176 AUTH_GSASL_PC=libgsasl
2177 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
2178 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI_PC=heimdal-gssapi
2181 .cindex "Perl" "including support for"
2182 Exim can be linked with an embedded Perl interpreter, allowing Perl
2183 subroutines to be called during string expansion. To enable this facility,
2187 must be defined in &_Local/Makefile_&. Details of this facility are given in
2188 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
2190 .cindex "X11 libraries, location of"
2191 The location of the X11 libraries is something that varies a lot between
2192 operating systems, and there may be different versions of X11 to cope
2193 with. Exim itself makes no use of X11, but if you are compiling the Exim
2194 monitor, the X11 libraries must be available.
2195 The following three variables are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&:
2198 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2199 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib
2201 These are overridden in some of the operating-system configuration files. For
2202 example, in &_OS/Makefile-SunOS5_& there is
2205 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2206 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib -R$(X11)/lib
2208 If you need to override the default setting for your operating system, place a
2209 definition of all three of these variables into your
2210 &_Local/Makefile-<ostype>_& file.
2213 If you need to add any extra libraries to the link steps, these can be put in a
2214 variable called EXTRALIBS, which appears in all the link commands, but by
2215 default is not defined. In contrast, EXTRALIBS_EXIM is used only on the
2216 command for linking the main Exim binary, and not for any associated utilities.
2218 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
2219 There is also DBMLIB, which appears in the link commands for binaries that
2220 use DBM functions (see also section &<<SECTdb>>&). Finally, there is
2221 EXTRALIBS_EXIMON, which appears only in the link step for the Exim monitor
2222 binary, and which can be used, for example, to include additional X11
2225 .cindex "configuration file" "editing"
2226 The make file copes with rebuilding Exim correctly if any of the configuration
2227 files are edited. However, if an optional configuration file is deleted, it is
2228 necessary to touch the associated non-optional file (that is,
2229 &_Local/Makefile_& or &_Local/eximon.conf_&) before rebuilding.
2232 .section "OS-specific header files" "SECID30"
2234 .cindex "building Exim" "OS-specific C header files"
2235 The &_OS_& directory contains a number of files with names of the form
2236 &_os.h-<ostype>_&. These are system-specific C header files that should not
2237 normally need to be changed. There is a list of macro settings that are
2238 recognized in the file &_OS/os.configuring_&, which should be consulted if you
2239 are porting Exim to a new operating system.
2243 .section "Overriding build-time options for the monitor" "SECID31"
2244 .cindex "building Eximon"
2245 A similar process is used for overriding things when building the Exim monitor,
2246 where the files that are involved are
2248 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_&
2249 &_OS/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2250 &_Local/eximon.conf_&
2251 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2252 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'archtype'&>
2253 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2255 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
2256 As with Exim itself, the final three files need not exist, and in this case the
2257 &_OS/eximon.conf-<ostype>_& file is also optional. The default values in
2258 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_& can be overridden dynamically by setting environment
2259 variables of the same name, preceded by EXIMON_. For example, setting
2260 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH in the environment overrides the value of
2261 LOG_DEPTH at run time.
2265 .section "Installing Exim binaries and scripts" "SECID32"
2266 .cindex "installing Exim"
2267 .cindex "BIN_DIRECTORY"
2268 The command &`make install`& runs the &(exim_install)& script with no
2269 arguments. The script copies binaries and utility scripts into the directory
2270 whose name is specified by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting in &_Local/Makefile_&.
2271 .cindex "setuid" "installing Exim with"
2272 The install script copies files only if they are newer than the files they are
2273 going to replace. The Exim binary is required to be owned by root and have the
2274 &'setuid'& bit set, for normal configurations. Therefore, you must run &`make
2275 install`& as root so that it can set up the Exim binary in this way. However, in
2276 some special situations (for example, if a host is doing no local deliveries)
2277 it may be possible to run Exim without making the binary setuid root (see
2278 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for details).
2280 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
2281 Exim's run time configuration file is named by the CONFIGURE_FILE setting
2282 in &_Local/Makefile_&. If this names a single file, and the file does not
2283 exist, the default configuration file &_src/configure.default_& is copied there
2284 by the installation script. If a run time configuration file already exists, it
2285 is left alone. If CONFIGURE_FILE is a colon-separated list, naming several
2286 alternative files, no default is installed.
2288 .cindex "system aliases file"
2289 .cindex "&_/etc/aliases_&"
2290 One change is made to the default configuration file when it is installed: the
2291 default configuration contains a router that references a system aliases file.
2292 The path to this file is set to the value specified by
2293 SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& (&_/etc/aliases_& by default).
2294 If the system aliases file does not exist, the installation script creates it,
2295 and outputs a comment to the user.
2297 The created file contains no aliases, but it does contain comments about the
2298 aliases a site should normally have. Mail aliases have traditionally been
2299 kept in &_/etc/aliases_&. However, some operating systems are now using
2300 &_/etc/mail/aliases_&. You should check if yours is one of these, and change
2301 Exim's configuration if necessary.
2303 The default configuration uses the local host's name as the only local domain,
2304 and is set up to do local deliveries into the shared directory &_/var/mail_&,
2305 running as the local user. System aliases and &_.forward_& files in users' home
2306 directories are supported, but no NIS or NIS+ support is configured. Domains
2307 other than the name of the local host are routed using the DNS, with delivery
2310 It is possible to install Exim for special purposes (such as building a binary
2311 distribution) in a private part of the file system. You can do this by a
2314 make DESTDIR=/some/directory/ install
2316 This has the effect of pre-pending the specified directory to all the file
2317 paths, except the name of the system aliases file that appears in the default
2318 configuration. (If a default alias file is created, its name &'is'& modified.)
2319 For backwards compatibility, ROOT is used if DESTDIR is not set,
2320 but this usage is deprecated.
2322 .cindex "installing Exim" "what is not installed"
2323 Running &'make install'& does not copy the Exim 4 conversion script
2324 &'convert4r4'&. You will probably run this only once if you are
2325 upgrading from Exim 3. None of the documentation files in the &_doc_&
2326 directory are copied, except for the info files when you have set
2327 INFO_DIRECTORY, as described in section &<<SECTinsinfdoc>>& below.
2329 For the utility programs, old versions are renamed by adding the suffix &_.O_&
2330 to their names. The Exim binary itself, however, is handled differently. It is
2331 installed under a name that includes the version number and the compile number,
2332 for example &_exim-&version()-1_&. The script then arranges for a symbolic link
2333 called &_exim_& to point to the binary. If you are updating a previous version
2334 of Exim, the script takes care to ensure that the name &_exim_& is never absent
2335 from the directory (as seen by other processes).
2337 .cindex "installing Exim" "testing the script"
2338 If you want to see what the &'make install'& will do before running it for
2339 real, you can pass the &%-n%& option to the installation script by this
2342 make INSTALL_ARG=-n install
2344 The contents of the variable INSTALL_ARG are passed to the installation
2345 script. You do not need to be root to run this test. Alternatively, you can run
2346 the installation script directly, but this must be from within the build
2347 directory. For example, from the top-level Exim directory you could use this
2350 (cd build-SunOS5-5.5.1-sparc; ../scripts/exim_install -n)
2352 .cindex "installing Exim" "install script options"
2353 There are two other options that can be supplied to the installation script.
2356 &%-no_chown%& bypasses the call to change the owner of the installed binary
2357 to root, and the call to make it a setuid binary.
2359 &%-no_symlink%& bypasses the setting up of the symbolic link &_exim_& to the
2363 INSTALL_ARG can be used to pass these options to the script. For example:
2365 make INSTALL_ARG=-no_symlink install
2367 The installation script can also be given arguments specifying which files are
2368 to be copied. For example, to install just the Exim binary, and nothing else,
2369 without creating the symbolic link, you could use:
2371 make INSTALL_ARG='-no_symlink exim' install
2376 .section "Installing info documentation" "SECTinsinfdoc"
2377 .cindex "installing Exim" "&'info'& documentation"
2378 Not all systems use the GNU &'info'& system for documentation, and for this
2379 reason, the Texinfo source of Exim's documentation is not included in the main
2380 distribution. Instead it is available separately from the ftp site (see section
2383 If you have defined INFO_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_& and the Texinfo
2384 source of the documentation is found in the source tree, running &`make
2385 install`& automatically builds the info files and installs them.
2389 .section "Setting up the spool directory" "SECID33"
2390 .cindex "spool directory" "creating"
2391 When it starts up, Exim tries to create its spool directory if it does not
2392 exist. The Exim uid and gid are used for the owner and group of the spool
2393 directory. Sub-directories are automatically created in the spool directory as
2399 .section "Testing" "SECID34"
2400 .cindex "testing" "installation"
2401 Having installed Exim, you can check that the run time configuration file is
2402 syntactically valid by running the following command, which assumes that the
2403 Exim binary directory is within your PATH environment variable:
2407 If there are any errors in the configuration file, Exim outputs error messages.
2408 Otherwise it outputs the version number and build date,
2409 the DBM library that is being used, and information about which drivers and
2410 other optional code modules are included in the binary.
2411 Some simple routing tests can be done by using the address testing option. For
2414 &`exim -bt`& <&'local username'&>
2416 should verify that it recognizes a local mailbox, and
2418 &`exim -bt`& <&'remote address'&>
2420 a remote one. Then try getting it to deliver mail, both locally and remotely.
2421 This can be done by passing messages directly to Exim, without going through a
2422 user agent. For example:
2424 exim -v postmaster@your.domain.example
2425 From: user@your.domain.example
2426 To: postmaster@your.domain.example
2427 Subject: Testing Exim
2429 This is a test message.
2432 The &%-v%& option causes Exim to output some verification of what it is doing.
2433 In this case you should see copies of three log lines, one for the message's
2434 arrival, one for its delivery, and one containing &"Completed"&.
2436 .cindex "delivery" "problems with"
2437 If you encounter problems, look at Exim's log files (&'mainlog'& and
2438 &'paniclog'&) to see if there is any relevant information there. Another source
2439 of information is running Exim with debugging turned on, by specifying the
2440 &%-d%& option. If a message is stuck on Exim's spool, you can force a delivery
2441 with debugging turned on by a command of the form
2443 &`exim -d -M`& <&'exim-message-id'&>
2445 You must be root or an &"admin user"& in order to do this. The &%-d%& option
2446 produces rather a lot of output, but you can cut this down to specific areas.
2447 For example, if you use &%-d-all+route%& only the debugging information
2448 relevant to routing is included. (See the &%-d%& option in chapter
2449 &<<CHAPcommandline>>& for more details.)
2451 .cindex '&"sticky"& bit'
2452 .cindex "lock files"
2453 One specific problem that has shown up on some sites is the inability to do
2454 local deliveries into a shared mailbox directory, because it does not have the
2455 &"sticky bit"& set on it. By default, Exim tries to create a lock file before
2456 writing to a mailbox file, and if it cannot create the lock file, the delivery
2457 is deferred. You can get round this either by setting the &"sticky bit"& on the
2458 directory, or by setting a specific group for local deliveries and allowing
2459 that group to create files in the directory (see the comments above the
2460 &(local_delivery)& transport in the default configuration file). Another
2461 approach is to configure Exim not to use lock files, but just to rely on
2462 &[fcntl()]& locking instead. However, you should do this only if all user
2463 agents also use &[fcntl()]& locking. For further discussion of locking issues,
2464 see chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
2466 One thing that cannot be tested on a system that is already running an MTA is
2467 the receipt of incoming SMTP mail on the standard SMTP port. However, the
2468 &%-oX%& option can be used to run an Exim daemon that listens on some other
2469 port, or &'inetd'& can be used to do this. The &%-bh%& option and the
2470 &'exim_checkaccess'& utility can be used to check out policy controls on
2473 Testing a new version on a system that is already running Exim can most easily
2474 be done by building a binary with a different CONFIGURE_FILE setting. From
2475 within the run time configuration, all other file and directory names
2476 that Exim uses can be altered, in order to keep it entirely clear of the
2480 .section "Replacing another MTA with Exim" "SECID35"
2481 .cindex "replacing another MTA"
2482 Building and installing Exim for the first time does not of itself put it in
2483 general use. The name by which the system's MTA is called by mail user agents
2484 is either &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&, or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& (depending on the
2485 operating system), and it is necessary to make this name point to the &'exim'&
2486 binary in order to get the user agents to pass messages to Exim. This is
2487 normally done by renaming any existing file and making &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&
2488 or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&
2489 .cindex "symbolic link" "to &'exim'& binary"
2490 a symbolic link to the &'exim'& binary. It is a good idea to remove any setuid
2491 privilege and executable status from the old MTA. It is then necessary to stop
2492 and restart the mailer daemon, if one is running.
2494 .cindex "FreeBSD, MTA indirection"
2495 .cindex "&_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&"
2496 Some operating systems have introduced alternative ways of switching MTAs. For
2497 example, if you are running FreeBSD, you need to edit the file
2498 &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_& instead of setting up a symbolic link as just
2499 described. A typical example of the contents of this file for running Exim is
2502 sendmail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2503 send-mail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2504 mailq /usr/exim/bin/exim -bp
2505 newaliases /usr/bin/true
2507 Once you have set up the symbolic link, or edited &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&,
2508 your Exim installation is &"live"&. Check it by sending a message from your
2509 favourite user agent.
2511 You should consider what to tell your users about the change of MTA. Exim may
2512 have different capabilities to what was previously running, and there are
2513 various operational differences such as the text of messages produced by
2514 command line options and in bounce messages. If you allow your users to make
2515 use of Exim's filtering capabilities, you should make the document entitled
2516 &'Exim's interface to mail filtering'& available to them.
2520 .section "Upgrading Exim" "SECID36"
2521 .cindex "upgrading Exim"
2522 If you are already running Exim on your host, building and installing a new
2523 version automatically makes it available to MUAs, or any other programs that
2524 call the MTA directly. However, if you are running an Exim daemon, you do need
2525 to send it a HUP signal, to make it re-execute itself, and thereby pick up the
2526 new binary. You do not need to stop processing mail in order to install a new
2527 version of Exim. The install script does not modify an existing runtime
2533 .section "Stopping the Exim daemon on Solaris" "SECID37"
2534 .cindex "Solaris" "stopping Exim on"
2535 The standard command for stopping the mailer daemon on Solaris is
2537 /etc/init.d/sendmail stop
2539 If &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& has been turned into a symbolic link, this script
2540 fails to stop Exim because it uses the command &'ps -e'& and greps the output
2541 for the text &"sendmail"&; this is not present because the actual program name
2542 (that is, &"exim"&) is given by the &'ps'& command with these options. A
2543 solution is to replace the line that finds the process id with something like
2545 pid=`cat /var/spool/exim/exim-daemon.pid`
2547 to obtain the daemon's pid directly from the file that Exim saves it in.
2549 Note, however, that stopping the daemon does not &"stop Exim"&. Messages can
2550 still be received from local processes, and if automatic delivery is configured
2551 (the normal case), deliveries will still occur.
2556 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2557 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2559 .chapter "The Exim command line" "CHAPcommandline"
2560 .scindex IIDclo1 "command line" "options"
2561 .scindex IIDclo2 "options" "command line"
2562 Exim's command line takes the standard Unix form of a sequence of options,
2563 each starting with a hyphen character, followed by a number of arguments. The
2564 options are compatible with the main options of Sendmail, and there are also
2565 some additional options, some of which are compatible with Smail 3. Certain
2566 combinations of options do not make sense, and provoke an error if used.
2567 The form of the arguments depends on which options are set.
2570 .section "Setting options by program name" "SECID38"
2572 If Exim is called under the name &'mailq'&, it behaves as if the option &%-bp%&
2573 were present before any other options.
2574 The &%-bp%& option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
2576 This feature is for compatibility with some systems that contain a command of
2577 that name in one of the standard libraries, symbolically linked to
2578 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&.
2581 If Exim is called under the name &'rsmtp'& it behaves as if the option &%-bS%&
2582 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The
2583 &%-bS%& option is used for reading in a number of messages in batched SMTP
2587 If Exim is called under the name &'rmail'& it behaves as if the &%-i%& and
2588 &%-oee%& options were present before any other options, for compatibility with
2589 Smail. The name &'rmail'& is used as an interface by some UUCP systems.
2592 .cindex "queue runner"
2593 If Exim is called under the name &'runq'& it behaves as if the option &%-q%&
2594 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The &%-q%&
2595 option causes a single queue runner process to be started.
2597 .cindex "&'newaliases'&"
2598 .cindex "alias file" "building"
2599 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "calling Exim as &'newaliases'&"
2600 If Exim is called under the name &'newaliases'& it behaves as if the option
2601 &%-bi%& were present before any other options, for compatibility with Sendmail.
2602 This option is used for rebuilding Sendmail's alias file. Exim does not have
2603 the concept of a single alias file, but can be configured to run a given
2604 command if called with the &%-bi%& option.
2607 .section "Trusted and admin users" "SECTtrustedadmin"
2608 Some Exim options are available only to &'trusted users'& and others are
2609 available only to &'admin users'&. In the description below, the phrases &"Exim
2610 user"& and &"Exim group"& mean the user and group defined by EXIM_USER and
2611 EXIM_GROUP in &_Local/Makefile_& or set by the &%exim_user%& and
2612 &%exim_group%& options. These do not necessarily have to use the name &"exim"&.
2615 .cindex "trusted users" "definition of"
2616 .cindex "user" "trusted definition of"
2617 The trusted users are root, the Exim user, any user listed in the
2618 &%trusted_users%& configuration option, and any user whose current group or any
2619 supplementary group is one of those listed in the &%trusted_groups%&
2620 configuration option. Note that the Exim group is not automatically trusted.
2622 .cindex '&"From"& line'
2623 .cindex "envelope sender"
2624 Trusted users are always permitted to use the &%-f%& option or a leading
2625 &"From&~"& line to specify the envelope sender of a message that is passed to
2626 Exim through the local interface (see the &%-bm%& and &%-f%& options below).
2627 See the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of permitting non-trusted
2628 users to set envelope senders.
2630 .cindex "&'From:'& header line"
2631 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
2632 For a trusted user, there is never any check on the contents of the &'From:'&
2633 header line, and a &'Sender:'& line is never added. Furthermore, any existing
2634 &'Sender:'& line in incoming local (non-TCP/IP) messages is not removed.
2636 Trusted users may also specify a host name, host address, interface address,
2637 protocol name, ident value, and authentication data when submitting a message
2638 locally. Thus, they are able to insert messages into Exim's queue locally that
2639 have the characteristics of messages received from a remote host. Untrusted
2640 users may in some circumstances use &%-f%&, but can never set the other values
2641 that are available to trusted users.
2643 .cindex "user" "admin definition of"
2644 .cindex "admin user" "definition of"
2645 The admin users are root, the Exim user, and any user that is a member of the
2646 Exim group or of any group listed in the &%admin_groups%& configuration option.
2647 The current group does not have to be one of these groups.
2649 Admin users are permitted to list the queue, and to carry out certain
2650 operations on messages, for example, to force delivery failures. It is also
2651 necessary to be an admin user in order to see the full information provided by
2652 the Exim monitor, and full debugging output.
2654 By default, the use of the &%-M%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options to cause
2655 Exim to attempt delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users.
2656 However, this restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%prod_requires_admin%&
2657 option false (that is, specifying &%no_prod_requires_admin%&).
2659 Similarly, the use of the &%-bp%& option to list all the messages in the queue
2660 is restricted to admin users unless &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set
2665 &*Warning*&: If you configure your system so that admin users are able to
2666 edit Exim's configuration file, you are giving those users an easy way of
2667 getting root. There is further discussion of this issue at the start of chapter
2673 .section "Command line options" "SECID39"
2674 Exim's command line options are described in alphabetical order below. If none
2675 of the options that specifies a specific action (such as starting the daemon or
2676 a queue runner, or testing an address, or receiving a message in a specific
2677 format, or listing the queue) are present, and there is at least one argument
2678 on the command line, &%-bm%& (accept a local message on the standard input,
2679 with the arguments specifying the recipients) is assumed. Otherwise, Exim
2680 outputs a brief message about itself and exits.
2682 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2683 . Insert a stylized XML comment here, to identify the start of the command line
2684 . options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
2685 . creates a man page for the options.
2686 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2689 <!-- === Start of command line options === -->
2696 .cindex "options" "command line; terminating"
2697 This is a pseudo-option whose only purpose is to terminate the options and
2698 therefore to cause subsequent command line items to be treated as arguments
2699 rather than options, even if they begin with hyphens.
2702 .oindex "&%--help%&"
2703 This option causes Exim to output a few sentences stating what it is.
2704 The same output is generated if the Exim binary is called with no options and
2707 .vitem &%--version%&
2708 .oindex "&%--version%&"
2709 This option is an alias for &%-bV%& and causes version information to be
2717 These options are used by Sendmail for selecting configuration files and are
2721 .vitem &%-B%&<&'type'&>
2723 .cindex "8-bit characters"
2724 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "8-bit characters"
2725 This is a Sendmail option for selecting 7 or 8 bit processing. Exim is 8-bit
2726 clean; it ignores this option.
2731 .cindex "SMTP" "listener"
2732 .cindex "queue runner"
2733 This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections. Usually
2734 the &%-bd%& option is combined with the &%-q%&<&'time'&> option, to specify
2735 that the daemon should also initiate periodic queue runs.
2737 The &%-bd%& option can be used only by an admin user. If either of the &%-d%&
2738 (debugging) or &%-v%& (verifying) options are set, the daemon does not
2739 disconnect from the controlling terminal. When running this way, it can be
2740 stopped by pressing ctrl-C.
2742 By default, Exim listens for incoming connections to the standard SMTP port on
2743 all the host's running interfaces. However, it is possible to listen on other
2744 ports, on multiple ports, and only on specific interfaces. Chapter
2745 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a description of the options that control this.
2747 When a listening daemon
2748 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
2749 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
2750 is started without the use of &%-oX%& (that is, without overriding the normal
2751 configuration), it writes its process id to a file called &_exim-daemon.pid_&
2752 in Exim's spool directory. This location can be overridden by setting
2753 PID_FILE_PATH in &_Local/Makefile_&. The file is written while Exim is still
2756 When &%-oX%& is used on the command line to start a listening daemon, the
2757 process id is not written to the normal pid file path. However, &%-oP%& can be
2758 used to specify a path on the command line if a pid file is required.
2762 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
2763 can be used to cause the daemon to re-execute itself. This should be done
2764 whenever Exim's configuration file, or any file that is incorporated into it by
2765 means of the &%.include%& facility, is changed, and also whenever a new version
2766 of Exim is installed. It is not necessary to do this when other files that are
2767 referenced from the configuration (for example, alias files) are changed,
2768 because these are reread each time they are used.
2772 This option has the same effect as &%-bd%& except that it never disconnects
2773 from the controlling terminal, even when no debugging is specified.
2777 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2778 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2779 Run Exim in expansion testing mode. Exim discards its root privilege, to
2780 prevent ordinary users from using this mode to read otherwise inaccessible
2781 files. If no arguments are given, Exim runs interactively, prompting for lines
2782 of data. Otherwise, it processes each argument in turn.
2784 If Exim was built with USE_READLINE=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&, it tries
2785 to load the &%libreadline%& library dynamically whenever the &%-be%& option is
2786 used without command line arguments. If successful, it uses the &[readline()]&
2787 function, which provides extensive line-editing facilities, for reading the
2788 test data. A line history is supported.
2790 Long expansion expressions can be split over several lines by using backslash
2791 continuations. As in Exim's run time configuration, white space at the start of
2792 continuation lines is ignored. Each argument or data line is passed through the
2793 string expansion mechanism, and the result is output. Variable values from the
2794 configuration file (for example, &$qualify_domain$&) are available, but no
2795 message-specific values (such as &$sender_domain$&) are set, because no message
2796 is being processed (but see &%-bem%& and &%-Mset%&).
2798 &*Note*&: If you use this mechanism to test lookups, and you change the data
2799 files or databases you are using, you must exit and restart Exim before trying
2800 the same lookup again. Otherwise, because each Exim process caches the results
2801 of lookups, you will just get the same result as before.
2803 .vitem &%-bem%&&~<&'filename'&>
2805 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2806 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2807 This option operates like &%-be%& except that it must be followed by the name
2808 of a file. For example:
2810 exim -bem /tmp/testmessage
2812 The file is read as a message (as if receiving a locally-submitted non-SMTP
2813 message) before any of the test expansions are done. Thus, message-specific
2814 variables such as &$message_size$& and &$header_from:$& are available. However,
2815 no &'Received:'& header is added to the message. If the &%-t%& option is set,
2816 recipients are read from the headers in the normal way, and are shown in the
2817 &$recipients$& variable. Note that recipients cannot be given on the command
2818 line, because further arguments are taken as strings to expand (just like
2821 .vitem &%-bF%&&~<&'filename'&>
2823 .cindex "system filter" "testing"
2824 .cindex "testing" "system filter"
2825 This option is the same as &%-bf%& except that it assumes that the filter being
2826 tested is a system filter. The additional commands that are available only in
2827 system filters are recognized.
2829 .vitem &%-bf%&&~<&'filename'&>
2831 .cindex "filter" "testing"
2832 .cindex "testing" "filter file"
2833 .cindex "forward file" "testing"
2834 .cindex "testing" "forward file"
2835 .cindex "Sieve filter" "testing"
2836 This option runs Exim in user filter testing mode; the file is the filter file
2837 to be tested, and a test message must be supplied on the standard input. If
2838 there are no message-dependent tests in the filter, an empty file can be
2841 If you want to test a system filter file, use &%-bF%& instead of &%-bf%&. You
2842 can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command, in order to test a system
2843 filter and a user filter in the same run. For example:
2845 exim -bF /system/filter -bf /user/filter </test/message
2847 This is helpful when the system filter adds header lines or sets filter
2848 variables that are used by the user filter.
2850 If the test filter file does not begin with one of the special lines
2855 it is taken to be a normal &_.forward_& file, and is tested for validity under
2856 that interpretation. See sections &<<SECTitenonfilred>>& to
2857 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for a description of the possible contents of non-filter
2860 The result of an Exim command that uses &%-bf%&, provided no errors are
2861 detected, is a list of the actions that Exim would try to take if presented
2862 with the message for real. More details of filter testing are given in the
2863 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
2865 When testing a filter file,
2866 .cindex "&""From""& line"
2867 .cindex "envelope sender"
2868 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for filter testing"
2869 the envelope sender can be set by the &%-f%& option,
2870 or by a &"From&~"& line at the start of the test message. Various parameters
2871 that would normally be taken from the envelope recipient address of the message
2872 can be set by means of additional command line options (see the next four
2875 .vitem &%-bfd%&&~<&'domain'&>
2877 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
2878 This sets the domain of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2879 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the value of
2882 .vitem &%-bfl%&&~<&'local&~part'&>
2884 This sets the local part of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2885 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the username of the
2886 process that calls Exim. A local part should be specified with any prefix or
2887 suffix stripped, because that is how it appears to the filter when a message is
2888 actually being delivered.
2890 .vitem &%-bfp%&&~<&'prefix'&>
2892 This sets the prefix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2893 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2896 .vitem &%-bfs%&&~<&'suffix'&>
2898 This sets the suffix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2899 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2902 .vitem &%-bh%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2904 .cindex "testing" "incoming SMTP"
2905 .cindex "SMTP" "testing incoming"
2906 .cindex "testing" "relay control"
2907 .cindex "relaying" "testing configuration"
2908 .cindex "policy control" "testing"
2909 .cindex "debugging" "&%-bh%& option"
2910 This option runs a fake SMTP session as if from the given IP address, using the
2911 standard input and output. The IP address may include a port number at the end,
2912 after a full stop. For example:
2914 exim -bh 10.9.8.7.1234
2915 exim -bh fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678
2917 When an IPv6 address is given, it is converted into canonical form. In the case
2918 of the second example above, the value of &$sender_host_address$& after
2919 conversion to the canonical form is
2920 &`fe80:0000:0000:0a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678`&.
2922 Comments as to what is going on are written to the standard error file. These
2923 include lines beginning with &"LOG"& for anything that would have been logged.
2924 This facility is provided for testing configuration options for incoming
2925 messages, to make sure they implement the required policy. For example, you can
2926 test your relay controls using &%-bh%&.
2930 You can test features of the configuration that rely on ident (RFC 1413)
2931 information by using the &%-oMt%& option. However, Exim cannot actually perform
2932 an ident callout when testing using &%-bh%& because there is no incoming SMTP
2935 &*Warning 2*&: Address verification callouts (see section &<<SECTcallver>>&)
2936 are also skipped when testing using &%-bh%&. If you want these callouts to
2937 occur, use &%-bhc%& instead.
2939 Messages supplied during the testing session are discarded, and nothing is
2940 written to any of the real log files. There may be pauses when DNS (and other)
2941 lookups are taking place, and of course these may time out. The &%-oMi%& option
2942 can be used to specify a specific IP interface and port if this is important,
2943 and &%-oMaa%& and &%-oMai%& can be used to set parameters as if the SMTP
2944 session were authenticated.
2946 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%& whose
2947 output just states whether a given recipient address from a given host is
2948 acceptable or not. See section &<<SECTcheckaccess>>&.
2950 Features such as authentication and encryption, where the client input is not
2951 plain text, cannot easily be tested with &%-bh%&. Instead, you should use a
2952 specialized SMTP test program such as
2953 &url(http://jetmore.org/john/code/#swaks,swaks).
2955 .vitem &%-bhc%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2957 This option operates in the same way as &%-bh%&, except that address
2958 verification callouts are performed if required. This includes consulting and
2959 updating the callout cache database.
2963 .cindex "alias file" "building"
2964 .cindex "building alias file"
2965 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-bi%& option"
2966 Sendmail interprets the &%-bi%& option as a request to rebuild its alias file.
2967 Exim does not have the concept of a single alias file, and so it cannot mimic
2968 this behaviour. However, calls to &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& with the &%-bi%& option
2969 tend to appear in various scripts such as NIS make files, so the option must be
2972 If &%-bi%& is encountered, the command specified by the &%bi_command%&
2973 configuration option is run, under the uid and gid of the caller of Exim. If
2974 the &%-oA%& option is used, its value is passed to the command as an argument.
2975 The command set by &%bi_command%& may not contain arguments. The command can
2976 use the &'exim_dbmbuild'& utility, or some other means, to rebuild alias files
2977 if this is required. If the &%bi_command%& option is not set, calling Exim with
2981 . // Keep :help first, then the rest in alphabetical order
2983 .oindex "&%-bI:help%&"
2984 .cindex "querying exim information"
2985 We shall provide various options starting &`-bI:`& for querying Exim for
2986 information. The output of many of these will be intended for machine
2987 consumption. This one is not. The &%-bI:help%& option asks Exim for a
2988 synopsis of supported options beginning &`-bI:`&. Use of any of these
2989 options shall cause Exim to exit after producing the requested output.
2992 .oindex "&%-bI:dscp%&"
2993 .cindex "DSCP" "values"
2994 This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all
2995 recognised DSCP names.
2997 .vitem &%-bI:sieve%&
2998 .oindex "&%-bI:sieve%&"
2999 .cindex "Sieve filter" "capabilities"
3000 This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all supported
3001 Sieve protocol extensions on stdout, one per line. This is anticipated to be
3002 useful for ManageSieve (RFC 5804) implementations, in providing that protocol's
3003 &`SIEVE`& capability response line. As the precise list may depend upon
3004 compile-time build options, which this option will adapt to, this is the only
3005 way to guarantee a correct response.
3010 .cindex "local message reception"
3011 This option runs an Exim receiving process that accepts an incoming,
3012 locally-generated message on the standard input. The recipients are given as the
3013 command arguments (except when &%-t%& is also present &-- see below). Each
3014 argument can be a comma-separated list of RFC 2822 addresses. This is the
3015 default option for selecting the overall action of an Exim call; it is assumed
3016 if no other conflicting option is present.
3018 If any addresses in the message are unqualified (have no domain), they are
3019 qualified by the values of the &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&
3020 options, as appropriate. The &%-bnq%& option (see below) provides a way of
3021 suppressing this for special cases.
3023 Policy checks on the contents of local messages can be enforced by means of
3024 the non-SMTP ACL. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details.
3026 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bm%&"
3027 The return code is zero if the message is successfully accepted. Otherwise, the
3028 action is controlled by the &%-oe%&&'x'& option setting &-- see below.
3031 .cindex "message" "format"
3032 .cindex "format" "message"
3033 .cindex "&""From""& line"
3034 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
3035 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
3036 of the message must be as defined in RFC 2822, except that, for
3037 compatibility with Sendmail and Smail, a line in one of the forms
3039 From sender Fri Jan 5 12:55 GMT 1997
3040 From sender Fri, 5 Jan 97 12:55:01
3042 (with the weekday optional, and possibly with additional text after the date)
3043 is permitted to appear at the start of the message. There appears to be no
3044 authoritative specification of the format of this line. Exim recognizes it by
3045 matching against the regular expression defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%&
3046 option, which can be changed if necessary.
3048 .oindex "&%-f%&" "overriding &""From""& line"
3049 The specified sender is treated as if it were given as the argument to the
3050 &%-f%& option, but if a &%-f%& option is also present, its argument is used in
3051 preference to the address taken from the message. The caller of Exim must be a
3052 trusted user for the sender of a message to be set in this way.
3054 .vitem &%-bmalware%&&~<&'filename'&>
3055 .oindex "&%-bmalware%&"
3056 .cindex "testing", "malware"
3057 .cindex "malware scan test"
3058 This debugging option causes Exim to scan the given file,
3059 using the malware scanning framework. The option of &%av_scanner%& influences
3060 this option, so if &%av_scanner%&'s value is dependent upon an expansion then
3061 the expansion should have defaults which apply to this invocation. ACLs are
3062 not invoked, so if &%av_scanner%& references an ACL variable then that variable
3063 will never be populated and &%-bmalware%& will fail.
3065 Exim will have changed working directory before resolving the filename, so
3066 using fully qualified pathnames is advisable. Exim will be running as the Exim
3067 user when it tries to open the file, rather than as the invoking user.
3068 This option requires admin privileges.
3070 The &%-bmalware%& option will not be extended to be more generally useful,
3071 there are better tools for file-scanning. This option exists to help
3072 administrators verify their Exim and AV scanner configuration.
3076 .cindex "address qualification, suppressing"
3077 By default, Exim automatically qualifies unqualified addresses (those
3078 without domains) that appear in messages that are submitted locally (that
3079 is, not over TCP/IP). This qualification applies both to addresses in
3080 envelopes, and addresses in header lines. Sender addresses are qualified using
3081 &%qualify_domain%&, and recipient addresses using &%qualify_recipient%& (which
3082 defaults to the value of &%qualify_domain%&).
3084 Sometimes, qualification is not wanted. For example, if &%-bS%& (batch SMTP) is
3085 being used to re-submit messages that originally came from remote hosts after
3086 content scanning, you probably do not want to qualify unqualified addresses in
3087 header lines. (Such lines will be present only if you have not enabled a header
3088 syntax check in the appropriate ACL.)
3090 The &%-bnq%& option suppresses all qualification of unqualified addresses in
3091 messages that originate on the local host. When this is used, unqualified
3092 addresses in the envelope provoke errors (causing message rejection) and
3093 unqualified addresses in header lines are left alone.
3098 .cindex "configuration options" "extracting"
3099 .cindex "options" "configuration &-- extracting"
3100 If this option is given with no arguments, it causes the values of all Exim's
3101 main configuration options to be written to the standard output. The values
3102 of one or more specific options can be requested by giving their names as
3103 arguments, for example:
3105 exim -bP qualify_domain hold_domains
3107 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
3108 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
3109 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
3110 However, any option setting that is preceded by the word &"hide"& in the
3111 configuration file is not shown in full, except to an admin user. For other
3112 users, the output is as in this example:
3114 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
3116 If &%configure_file%& is given as an argument, the name of the run time
3117 configuration file is output.
3118 If a list of configuration files was supplied, the value that is output here
3119 is the name of the file that was actually used.
3122 .cindex "options" "hiding name of"
3123 If the &%-n%& flag is given, then for most modes of &%-bP%& operation the
3124 name will not be output.
3127 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
3128 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
3129 If &%log_file_path%& or &%pid_file_path%& are given, the names of the
3130 directories where log files and daemon pid files are written are output,
3131 respectively. If these values are unset, log files are written in a
3132 sub-directory of the spool directory called &%log%&, and the pid file is
3133 written directly into the spool directory.
3135 If &%-bP%& is followed by a name preceded by &`+`&, for example,
3137 exim -bP +local_domains
3139 it searches for a matching named list of any type (domain, host, address, or
3140 local part) and outputs what it finds.
3142 .cindex "options" "router &-- extracting"
3143 .cindex "options" "transport &-- extracting"
3144 .cindex "options" "authenticator &-- extracting"
3145 If one of the words &%router%&, &%transport%&, or &%authenticator%& is given,
3146 followed by the name of an appropriate driver instance, the option settings for
3147 that driver are output. For example:
3149 exim -bP transport local_delivery
3151 The generic driver options are output first, followed by the driver's private
3152 options. A list of the names of drivers of a particular type can be obtained by
3153 using one of the words &%router_list%&, &%transport_list%&, or
3154 &%authenticator_list%&, and a complete list of all drivers with their option
3155 settings can be obtained by using &%routers%&, &%transports%&, or
3158 .cindex "options" "macro &-- extracting"
3159 If invoked by an admin user, then &%macro%&, &%macro_list%& and &%macros%&
3160 are available, similarly to the drivers. Because macros are sometimes used
3161 for storing passwords, this option is restricted.
3162 The output format is one item per line.
3166 .cindex "queue" "listing messages on"
3167 .cindex "listing" "messages on the queue"
3168 This option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
3169 standard output. If the &%-bp%& option is followed by a list of message ids,
3170 just those messages are listed. By default, this option can be used only by an
3171 admin user. However, the &%queue_list_requires_admin%& option can be set false
3172 to allow any user to see the queue.
3174 Each message on the queue is displayed as in the following example:
3176 25m 2.9K 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 <alice@wonderland.fict.example>
3177 red.king@looking-glass.fict.example
3180 .cindex "message" "size in queue listing"
3181 .cindex "size" "of message"
3182 The first line contains the length of time the message has been on the queue
3183 (in this case 25 minutes), the size of the message (2.9K), the unique local
3184 identifier for the message, and the message sender, as contained in the
3185 envelope. For bounce messages, the sender address is empty, and appears as
3186 &"<>"&. If the message was submitted locally by an untrusted user who overrode
3187 the default sender address, the user's login name is shown in parentheses
3188 before the sender address.
3190 .cindex "frozen messages" "in queue listing"
3191 If the message is frozen (attempts to deliver it are suspended) then the text
3192 &"*** frozen ***"& is displayed at the end of this line.
3194 The recipients of the message (taken from the envelope, not the headers) are
3195 displayed on subsequent lines. Those addresses to which the message has already
3196 been delivered are marked with the letter D. If an original address gets
3197 expanded into several addresses via an alias or forward file, the original is
3198 displayed with a D only when deliveries for all of its child addresses are
3204 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but in addition it shows delivered addresses
3205 that were generated from the original top level address(es) in each message by
3206 alias or forwarding operations. These addresses are flagged with &"+D"& instead
3212 .cindex "queue" "count of messages on"
3213 This option counts the number of messages on the queue, and writes the total
3214 to the standard output. It is restricted to admin users, unless
3215 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false.
3220 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but the output is not sorted into
3221 chronological order of message arrival. This can speed it up when there are
3222 lots of messages on the queue, and is particularly useful if the output is
3223 going to be post-processed in a way that doesn't need the sorting.
3227 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpa%&.
3231 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpu%&.
3236 This option operates like &%-bp%& but shows only undelivered top-level
3237 addresses for each message displayed. Addresses generated by aliasing or
3238 forwarding are not shown, unless the message was deferred after processing by a
3239 router with the &%one_time%& option set.
3244 .cindex "testing" "retry configuration"
3245 .cindex "retry" "configuration testing"
3246 This option is for testing retry rules, and it must be followed by up to three
3247 arguments. It causes Exim to look for a retry rule that matches the values
3248 and to write it to the standard output. For example:
3250 exim -brt bach.comp.mus.example
3251 Retry rule: *.comp.mus.example F,2h,15m; F,4d,30m;
3253 See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for a description of Exim's retry rules. The first
3254 argument, which is required, can be a complete address in the form
3255 &'local_part@domain'&, or it can be just a domain name. If the second argument
3256 contains a dot, it is interpreted as an optional second domain name; if no
3257 retry rule is found for the first argument, the second is tried. This ties in
3258 with Exim's behaviour when looking for retry rules for remote hosts &-- if no
3259 rule is found that matches the host, one that matches the mail domain is
3260 sought. Finally, an argument that is the name of a specific delivery error, as
3261 used in setting up retry rules, can be given. For example:
3263 exim -brt haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d
3264 Retry rule: *@haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d F,1h,15m
3269 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
3270 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
3271 This option is for testing address rewriting rules, and it must be followed by
3272 a single argument, consisting of either a local part without a domain, or a
3273 complete address with a fully qualified domain. Exim outputs how this address
3274 would be rewritten for each possible place it might appear. See chapter
3275 &<<CHAPrewrite>>& for further details.
3279 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
3280 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
3281 This option is used for batched SMTP input, which is an alternative interface
3282 for non-interactive local message submission. A number of messages can be
3283 submitted in a single run. However, despite its name, this is not really SMTP
3284 input. Exim reads each message's envelope from SMTP commands on the standard
3285 input, but generates no responses. If the caller is trusted, or
3286 &%untrusted_set_sender%& is set, the senders in the SMTP MAIL commands are
3287 believed; otherwise the sender is always the caller of Exim.
3289 The message itself is read from the standard input, in SMTP format (leading
3290 dots doubled), terminated by a line containing just a single dot. An error is
3291 provoked if the terminating dot is missing. A further message may then follow.
3293 As for other local message submissions, the contents of incoming batch SMTP
3294 messages can be checked using the non-SMTP ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&).
3295 Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using &%qualify_domain%& and
3296 &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the &%-bnq%& option is used.
3298 Some other SMTP commands are recognized in the input. HELO and EHLO act
3299 as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN, and HELP act as NOOP;
3300 QUIT quits, ignoring the rest of the standard input.
3302 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bS%&"
3303 If any error is encountered, reports are written to the standard output and
3304 error streams, and Exim gives up immediately. The return code is 0 if no error
3305 was detected; it is 1 if one or more messages were accepted before the error
3306 was detected; otherwise it is 2.
3308 More details of input using batched SMTP are given in section
3309 &<<SECTincomingbatchedSMTP>>&.
3313 .cindex "SMTP" "local input"
3314 .cindex "local SMTP input"
3315 This option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by reading SMTP commands
3316 on the standard input, and producing SMTP replies on the standard output. SMTP
3317 policy controls, as defined in ACLs (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) are applied.
3318 Some user agents use this interface as a way of passing locally-generated
3319 messages to the MTA.
3322 .cindex "sender" "source of"
3323 this usage, if the caller of Exim is trusted, or &%untrusted_set_sender%& is
3324 set, the senders of messages are taken from the SMTP MAIL commands.
3325 Otherwise the content of these commands is ignored and the sender is set up as
3326 the calling user. Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using
3327 &%qualify_domain%& and &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the
3328 &%-bnq%& option is used.
3332 &%-bs%& option is also used to run Exim from &'inetd'&, as an alternative to
3333 using a listening daemon. Exim can distinguish the two cases by checking
3334 whether the standard input is a TCP/IP socket. When Exim is called from
3335 &'inetd'&, the source of the mail is assumed to be remote, and the comments
3336 above concerning senders and qualification do not apply. In this situation,
3337 Exim behaves in exactly the same way as it does when receiving a message via
3338 the listening daemon.
3342 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
3343 .cindex "address" "testing"
3344 This option runs Exim in address testing mode, in which each argument is taken
3345 as a recipient address to be tested for deliverability. The results are
3346 written to the standard output. If a test fails, and the caller is not an admin
3347 user, no details of the failure are output, because these might contain
3348 sensitive information such as usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3350 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3351 right angle bracket for addresses to be tested.
3353 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3354 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'root'& and there are
3357 Each address is handled as if it were the recipient address of a message
3358 (compare the &%-bv%& option). It is passed to the routers and the result is
3359 written to the standard output. However, any router that has
3360 &%no_address_test%& set is bypassed. This can make &%-bt%& easier to use for
3361 genuine routing tests if your first router passes everything to a scanner
3364 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bt%&"
3365 The return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3366 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3367 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3369 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
3370 &*Note*&: When actually delivering a message, Exim removes duplicate recipient
3371 addresses after routing is complete, so that only one delivery takes place.
3372 This does not happen when testing with &%-bt%&; the full results of routing are
3375 &*Warning*&: &%-bt%& can only do relatively simple testing. If any of the
3376 routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender address of a
3378 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for address testing"
3379 you can use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate sender when running
3380 &%-bt%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the calling user at the
3381 default qualifying domain. However, if you have set up (for example) routers
3382 whose behaviour depends on the contents of an incoming message, you cannot test
3383 those conditions using &%-bt%&. The &%-N%& option provides a possible way of
3388 .cindex "version number of Exim"
3389 This option causes Exim to write the current version number, compilation
3390 number, and compilation date of the &'exim'& binary to the standard output.
3391 It also lists the DBM library that is being used, the optional modules (such as
3392 specific lookup types), the drivers that are included in the binary, and the
3393 name of the run time configuration file that is in use.
3395 As part of its operation, &%-bV%& causes Exim to read and syntax check its
3396 configuration file. However, this is a static check only. It cannot check
3397 values that are to be expanded. For example, although a misspelt ACL verb is
3398 detected, an error in the verb's arguments is not. You cannot rely on &%-bV%&
3399 alone to discover (for example) all the typos in the configuration; some
3400 realistic testing is needed. The &%-bh%& and &%-N%& options provide more
3401 dynamic testing facilities.
3405 .cindex "verifying address" "using &%-bv%&"
3406 .cindex "address" "verification"
3407 This option runs Exim in address verification mode, in which each argument is
3408 taken as a recipient address to be verified by the routers. (This does
3409 not involve any verification callouts). During normal operation, verification
3410 happens mostly as a consequence processing a &%verify%& condition in an ACL
3411 (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). If you want to test an entire ACL, possibly
3412 including callouts, see the &%-bh%& and &%-bhc%& options.
3414 If verification fails, and the caller is not an admin user, no details of the
3415 failure are output, because these might contain sensitive information such as
3416 usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3418 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3419 right angle bracket for addresses to be verified.
3421 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3422 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'exim'& and there are
3425 Verification differs from address testing (the &%-bt%& option) in that routers
3426 that have &%no_verify%& set are skipped, and if the address is accepted by a
3427 router that has &%fail_verify%& set, verification fails. The address is
3428 verified as a recipient if &%-bv%& is used; to test verification for a sender
3429 address, &%-bvs%& should be used.
3431 If the &%-v%& option is not set, the output consists of a single line for each
3432 address, stating whether it was verified or not, and giving a reason in the
3433 latter case. Without &%-v%&, generating more than one address by redirection
3434 causes verification to end successfully, without considering the generated
3435 addresses. However, if just one address is generated, processing continues,
3436 and the generated address must verify successfully for the overall verification
3439 When &%-v%& is set, more details are given of how the address has been handled,
3440 and in the case of address redirection, all the generated addresses are also
3441 considered. Verification may succeed for some and fail for others.
3444 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bv%&"
3445 return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3446 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3447 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3449 If any of the routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender
3450 address of a message, you should use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate
3451 sender when running &%-bv%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the
3452 calling user at the default qualifying domain.
3456 This option acts like &%-bv%&, but verifies the address as a sender rather
3457 than a recipient address. This affects any rewriting and qualification that
3464 .cindex "inetd" "wait mode"
3465 This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections,
3466 similarly to the &%-bd%& option. All port specifications on the command-line
3467 and in the configuration file are ignored. Queue-running may not be specified.
3469 In this mode, Exim expects to be passed a socket as fd 0 (stdin) which is
3470 listening for connections. This permits the system to start up and have
3471 inetd (or equivalent) listen on the SMTP ports, starting an Exim daemon for
3472 each port only when the first connection is received.
3474 If the option is given as &%-bw%&<&'time'&> then the time is a timeout, after
3475 which the daemon will exit, which should cause inetd to listen once more.
3477 .vitem &%-C%&&~<&'filelist'&>
3479 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
3480 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
3481 .cindex "alternate configuration file"
3482 This option causes Exim to find the run time configuration file from the given
3483 list instead of from the list specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE
3484 compile-time setting. Usually, the list will consist of just a single file
3485 name, but it can be a colon-separated list of names. In this case, the first
3486 file that exists is used. Failure to open an existing file stops Exim from
3487 proceeding any further along the list, and an error is generated.
3489 When this option is used by a caller other than root, and the list is different
3490 from the compiled-in list, Exim gives up its root privilege immediately, and
3491 runs with the real and effective uid and gid set to those of the caller.
3492 However, if a TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, that
3493 file contains a list of full pathnames, one per line, for configuration files
3494 which are trusted. Root privilege is retained for any configuration file so
3495 listed, as long as the caller is the Exim user (or the user specified in the
3496 CONFIGURE_OWNER option, if any), and as long as the configuration file is
3497 not writeable by inappropriate users or groups.
3499 Leaving TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST unset precludes the possibility of testing a
3500 configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and delivery,
3501 even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time, Exim is
3502 running as the Exim user, so when it re-executes to regain privilege for the
3503 delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root can
3504 test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a message
3505 on the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using &%-M%&).
3507 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
3508 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option
3509 must start. In addition, the file name must not contain the sequence &`/../`&.
3510 However, if the value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of
3511 CONFIGURE_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as
3512 usual. There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is
3513 unset, any file name can be used with &%-C%&.
3515 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be used to confine alternative configuration files
3516 to a directory to which only root has access. This prevents someone who has
3517 broken into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
3520 The &%-C%& facility is useful for ensuring that configuration files are
3521 syntactically correct, but cannot be used for test deliveries, unless the
3522 caller is privileged, or unless it is an exotic configuration that does not
3523 require privilege. No check is made on the owner or group of the files
3524 specified by this option.
3527 .vitem &%-D%&<&'macro'&>=<&'value'&>
3529 .cindex "macro" "setting on command line"
3530 This option can be used to override macro definitions in the configuration file
3531 (see section &<<SECTmacrodefs>>&). However, like &%-C%&, if it is used by an
3532 unprivileged caller, it causes Exim to give up its root privilege.
3533 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
3534 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
3536 If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_& then it should be a
3537 colon-separated list of macros which are considered safe and, if &%-D%& only
3538 supplies macros from this list, and the values are acceptable, then Exim will
3539 not give up root privilege if the caller is root, the Exim run-time user, or
3540 the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a transition mechanism and is expected
3541 to be removed in the future. Acceptable values for the macros satisfy the
3542 regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
3544 The entire option (including equals sign if present) must all be within one
3545 command line item. &%-D%& can be used to set the value of a macro to the empty
3546 string, in which case the equals sign is optional. These two commands are
3552 To include spaces in a macro definition item, quotes must be used. If you use
3553 quotes, spaces are permitted around the macro name and the equals sign. For
3556 exim '-D ABC = something' ...
3558 &%-D%& may be repeated up to 10 times on a command line.
3561 .vitem &%-d%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3563 .cindex "debugging" "list of selectors"
3564 .cindex "debugging" "&%-d%& option"
3565 This option causes debugging information to be written to the standard
3566 error stream. It is restricted to admin users because debugging output may show
3567 database queries that contain password information. Also, the details of users'
3568 filter files should be protected. If a non-admin user uses &%-d%&, Exim
3569 writes an error message to the standard error stream and exits with a non-zero
3572 When &%-d%& is used, &%-v%& is assumed. If &%-d%& is given on its own, a lot of
3573 standard debugging data is output. This can be reduced, or increased to include
3574 some more rarely needed information, by directly following &%-d%& with a string
3575 made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. These add or remove sets
3576 of debugging data, respectively. For example, &%-d+filter%& adds filter
3577 debugging, whereas &%-d-all+filter%& selects only filter debugging. Note that
3578 no spaces are allowed in the debug setting. The available debugging categories
3581 &`acl `& ACL interpretation
3582 &`auth `& authenticators
3583 &`deliver `& general delivery logic
3584 &`dns `& DNS lookups (see also resolver)
3585 &`dnsbl `& DNS black list (aka RBL) code
3586 &`exec `& arguments for &[execv()]& calls
3587 &`expand `& detailed debugging for string expansions
3588 &`filter `& filter handling
3589 &`hints_lookup `& hints data lookups
3590 &`host_lookup `& all types of name-to-IP address handling
3591 &`ident `& ident lookup
3592 &`interface `& lists of local interfaces
3593 &`lists `& matching things in lists
3594 &`load `& system load checks
3595 &`local_scan `& can be used by &[local_scan()]& (see chapter &&&
3596 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&)
3597 &`lookup `& general lookup code and all lookups
3598 &`memory `& memory handling
3599 &`pid `& add pid to debug output lines
3600 &`process_info `& setting info for the process log
3601 &`queue_run `& queue runs
3602 &`receive `& general message reception logic
3603 &`resolver `& turn on the DNS resolver's debugging output
3604 &`retry `& retry handling
3605 &`rewrite `& address rewriting
3606 &`route `& address routing
3607 &`timestamp `& add timestamp to debug output lines
3609 &`transport `& transports
3610 &`uid `& changes of uid/gid and looking up uid/gid
3611 &`verify `& address verification logic
3612 &`all `& almost all of the above (see below), and also &%-v%&
3614 The &`all`& option excludes &`memory`& when used as &`+all`&, but includes it
3615 for &`-all`&. The reason for this is that &`+all`& is something that people
3616 tend to use when generating debug output for Exim maintainers. If &`+memory`&
3617 is included, an awful lot of output that is very rarely of interest is
3618 generated, so it now has to be explicitly requested. However, &`-all`& does
3619 turn everything off.
3621 .cindex "resolver, debugging output"
3622 .cindex "DNS resolver, debugging output"
3623 The &`resolver`& option produces output only if the DNS resolver was compiled
3624 with DEBUG enabled. This is not the case in some operating systems. Also,
3625 unfortunately, debugging output from the DNS resolver is written to stdout
3628 The default (&%-d%& with no argument) omits &`expand`&, &`filter`&,
3629 &`interface`&, &`load`&, &`memory`&, &`pid`&, &`resolver`&, and &`timestamp`&.
3630 However, the &`pid`& selector is forced when debugging is turned on for a
3631 daemon, which then passes it on to any re-executed Exims. Exim also
3632 automatically adds the pid to debug lines when several remote deliveries are
3635 The &`timestamp`& selector causes the current time to be inserted at the start
3636 of all debug output lines. This can be useful when trying to track down delays
3639 If the &%debug_print%& option is set in any driver, it produces output whenever
3640 any debugging is selected, or if &%-v%& is used.
3642 .vitem &%-dd%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3644 This option behaves exactly like &%-d%& except when used on a command that
3645 starts a daemon process. In that case, debugging is turned off for the
3646 subprocesses that the daemon creates. Thus, it is useful for monitoring the
3647 behaviour of the daemon without creating as much output as full debugging does.
3650 .oindex "&%-dropcr%&"
3651 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
3652 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
3653 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
3657 .cindex "bounce message" "generating"
3658 This option specifies that an incoming message is a locally-generated delivery
3659 failure report. It is used internally by Exim when handling delivery failures
3660 and is not intended for external use. Its only effect is to stop Exim
3661 generating certain messages to the postmaster, as otherwise message cascades
3662 could occur in some situations. As part of the same option, a message id may
3663 follow the characters &%-E%&. If it does, the log entry for the receipt of the
3664 new message contains the id, following &"R="&, as a cross-reference.
3667 .oindex "&%-e%&&'x'&"
3668 There are a number of Sendmail options starting with &%-oe%& which seem to be
3669 called by various programs without the leading &%o%& in the option. For
3670 example, the &%vacation%& program uses &%-eq%&. Exim treats all options of the
3671 form &%-e%&&'x'& as synonymous with the corresponding &%-oe%&&'x'& options.
3673 .vitem &%-F%&&~<&'string'&>
3675 .cindex "sender" "name"
3676 .cindex "name" "of sender"
3677 This option sets the sender's full name for use when a locally-generated
3678 message is being accepted. In the absence of this option, the user's &'gecos'&
3679 entry from the password data is used. As users are generally permitted to alter
3680 their &'gecos'& entries, no security considerations are involved. White space
3681 between &%-F%& and the <&'string'&> is optional.
3683 .vitem &%-f%&&~<&'address'&>
3685 .cindex "sender" "address"
3686 .cindex "address" "sender"
3687 .cindex "trusted users"
3688 .cindex "envelope sender"
3689 .cindex "user" "trusted"
3690 This option sets the address of the envelope sender of a locally-generated
3691 message (also known as the return path). The option can normally be used only
3692 by a trusted user, but &%untrusted_set_sender%& can be set to allow untrusted
3695 Processes running as root or the Exim user are always trusted. Other
3696 trusted users are defined by the &%trusted_users%& or &%trusted_groups%&
3697 options. In the absence of &%-f%&, or if the caller is not trusted, the sender
3698 of a local message is set to the caller's login name at the default qualify
3701 There is one exception to the restriction on the use of &%-f%&: an empty sender
3702 can be specified by any user, trusted or not, to create a message that can
3703 never provoke a bounce. An empty sender can be specified either as an empty
3704 string, or as a pair of angle brackets with nothing between them, as in these
3705 examples of shell commands:
3707 exim -f '<>' user@domain
3708 exim -f "" user@domain
3710 In addition, the use of &%-f%& is not restricted when testing a filter file
3711 with &%-bf%& or when testing or verifying addresses using the &%-bt%& or
3714 Allowing untrusted users to change the sender address does not of itself make
3715 it possible to send anonymous mail. Exim still checks that the &'From:'& header
3716 refers to the local user, and if it does not, it adds a &'Sender:'& header,
3717 though this can be overridden by setting &%no_local_from_check%&.
3720 .cindex "&""From""& line"
3721 space between &%-f%& and the <&'address'&> is optional (that is, they can be
3722 given as two arguments or one combined argument). The sender of a
3723 locally-generated message can also be set (when permitted) by an initial
3724 &"From&~"& line in the message &-- see the description of &%-bm%& above &-- but
3725 if &%-f%& is also present, it overrides &"From&~"&.
3729 .cindex "submission fixups, suppressing (command-line)"
3731 This option is equivalent to an ACL applying:
3733 control = suppress_local_fixups
3735 for every message received. Note that Sendmail will complain about such
3736 bad formatting, where Exim silently just does not fix it up. This may change
3739 As this affects audit information, the caller must be a trusted user to use
3743 .vitem &%-h%&&~<&'number'&>
3745 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-h%& option ignored"
3746 This option is accepted for compatibility with Sendmail, but has no effect. (In
3747 Sendmail it overrides the &"hop count"& obtained by counting &'Received:'&
3752 .cindex "Solaris" "&'mail'& command"
3753 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
3754 This option, which has the same effect as &%-oi%&, specifies that a dot on a
3755 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. I can find
3756 no documentation for this option in Solaris 2.4 Sendmail, but the &'mailx'&
3757 command in Solaris 2.4 uses it. See also &%-ti%&.
3760 .vitem &%-L%&&~<&'tag'&>
3762 .cindex "syslog" "process name; set with flag"
3763 This option is equivalent to setting &%syslog_processname%& in the config
3764 file and setting &%log_file_path%& to &`syslog`&.
3765 Its use is restricted to administrators. The configuration file has to be
3766 read and parsed, to determine access rights, before this is set and takes
3767 effect, so early configuration file errors will not honour this flag.
3769 The tag should not be longer than 32 characters.
3772 .vitem &%-M%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3774 .cindex "forcing delivery"
3775 .cindex "delivery" "forcing attempt"
3776 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
3777 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn. If
3778 any of the messages are frozen, they are automatically thawed before the
3779 delivery attempt. The settings of &%queue_domains%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
3780 and &%hold_domains%& are ignored.
3783 .cindex "hints database" "overriding retry hints"
3784 hints for any of the addresses are overridden &-- Exim tries to deliver even if
3785 the normal retry time has not yet been reached. This option requires the caller
3786 to be an admin user. However, there is an option called &%prod_requires_admin%&
3787 which can be set false to relax this restriction (and also the same requirement
3788 for the &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options).
3790 The deliveries happen synchronously, that is, the original Exim process does
3791 not terminate until all the delivery attempts have finished. No output is
3792 produced unless there is a serious error. If you want to see what is happening,
3793 use the &%-v%& option as well, or inspect Exim's main log.
3795 .vitem &%-Mar%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3797 .cindex "message" "adding recipients"
3798 .cindex "recipient" "adding"
3799 This option requests Exim to add the addresses to the list of recipients of the
3800 message (&"ar"& for &"add recipients"&). The first argument must be a message
3801 id, and the remaining ones must be email addresses. However, if the message is
3802 active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), it is not altered. This option
3803 can be used only by an admin user.
3805 .vitem "&%-MC%&&~<&'transport'&>&~<&'hostname'&>&~<&'sequence&~number'&>&&&
3806 &~<&'message&~id'&>"
3808 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
3809 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
3810 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
3811 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3812 by Exim to invoke another instance of itself to deliver a waiting message using
3813 an existing SMTP connection, which is passed as the standard input. Details are
3814 given in chapter &<<CHAPSMTP>>&. This must be the final option, and the caller
3815 must be root or the Exim user in order to use it.
3819 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3820 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3821 connection to the remote host has been authenticated.
3825 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3826 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the server to
3827 which Exim is connected supports pipelining.
3829 .vitem &%-MCQ%&&~<&'process&~id'&>&~<&'pipe&~fd'&>
3831 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3832 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option when the original delivery was
3833 started by a queue runner. It passes on the process id of the queue runner,
3834 together with the file descriptor number of an open pipe. Closure of the pipe
3835 signals the final completion of the sequence of processes that are passing
3836 messages through the same SMTP connection.
3840 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3841 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3842 SMTP SIZE option should be used on messages delivered down the existing
3847 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3848 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3849 host to which Exim is connected supports TLS encryption.
3851 .vitem &%-Mc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3853 .cindex "hints database" "not overridden by &%-Mc%&"
3854 .cindex "delivery" "manually started &-- not forced"
3855 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn,
3856 but unlike the &%-M%& option, it does check for retry hints, and respects any
3857 that are found. This option is not very useful to external callers. It is
3858 provided mainly for internal use by Exim when it needs to re-invoke itself in
3859 order to regain root privilege for a delivery (see chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&).
3860 However, &%-Mc%& can be useful when testing, in order to run a delivery that
3861 respects retry times and other options such as &%hold_domains%& that are
3862 overridden when &%-M%& is used. Such a delivery does not count as a queue run.
3863 If you want to run a specific delivery as if in a queue run, you should use
3864 &%-q%& with a message id argument. A distinction between queue run deliveries
3865 and other deliveries is made in one or two places.
3867 .vitem &%-Mes%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>
3869 .cindex "message" "changing sender"
3870 .cindex "sender" "changing"
3871 This option requests Exim to change the sender address in the message to the
3872 given address, which must be a fully qualified address or &"<>"& (&"es"& for
3873 &"edit sender"&). There must be exactly two arguments. The first argument must
3874 be a message id, and the second one an email address. However, if the message
3875 is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered.
3876 This option can be used only by an admin user.
3878 .vitem &%-Mf%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3880 .cindex "freezing messages"
3881 .cindex "message" "manually freezing"
3882 This option requests Exim to mark each listed message as &"frozen"&. This
3883 prevents any delivery attempts taking place until the message is &"thawed"&,
3884 either manually or as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& configuration option.
3885 However, if any of the messages are active (in the middle of a delivery
3886 attempt), their status is not altered. This option can be used only by an admin
3889 .vitem &%-Mg%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3891 .cindex "giving up on messages"
3892 .cindex "message" "abandoning delivery attempts"
3893 .cindex "delivery" "abandoning further attempts"
3894 This option requests Exim to give up trying to deliver the listed messages,
3895 including any that are frozen. However, if any of the messages are active,
3896 their status is not altered. For non-bounce messages, a delivery error message
3897 is sent to the sender, containing the text &"cancelled by administrator"&.
3898 Bounce messages are just discarded. This option can be used only by an admin
3901 .vitem &%-Mmad%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3903 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling all"
3904 This option requests Exim to mark all the recipient addresses in the messages
3905 as already delivered (&"mad"& for &"mark all delivered"&). However, if any
3906 message is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not
3907 altered. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3909 .vitem &%-Mmd%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3911 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling by address"
3912 .cindex "recipient" "removing"
3913 .cindex "removing recipients"
3914 This option requests Exim to mark the given addresses as already delivered
3915 (&"md"& for &"mark delivered"&). The first argument must be a message id, and
3916 the remaining ones must be email addresses. These are matched to recipient
3917 addresses in the message in a case-sensitive manner. If the message is active
3918 (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered. This option
3919 can be used only by an admin user.
3921 .vitem &%-Mrm%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3923 .cindex "removing messages"
3924 .cindex "abandoning mail"
3925 .cindex "message" "manually discarding"
3926 This option requests Exim to remove the given messages from the queue. No
3927 bounce messages are sent; each message is simply forgotten. However, if any of
3928 the messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used
3929 only by an admin user or by the user who originally caused the message to be
3930 placed on the queue.
3932 .vitem &%-Mset%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3934 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
3935 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
3936 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-be%& (that is, when testing
3937 string expansions). Exim loads the given message from its spool before doing
3938 the test expansions, thus setting message-specific variables such as
3939 &$message_size$& and the header variables. The &$recipients$& variable is made
3940 available. This feature is provided to make it easier to test expansions that
3941 make use of these variables. However, this option can be used only by an admin
3942 user. See also &%-bem%&.
3944 .vitem &%-Mt%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3946 .cindex "thawing messages"
3947 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
3948 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
3949 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
3950 This option requests Exim to &"thaw"& any of the listed messages that are
3951 &"frozen"&, so that delivery attempts can resume. However, if any of the
3952 messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used only
3955 .vitem &%-Mvb%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3957 .cindex "listing" "message body"
3958 .cindex "message" "listing body of"
3959 This option causes the contents of the message body (-D) spool file to be
3960 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3962 .vitem &%-Mvc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3964 .cindex "message" "listing in RFC 2822 format"
3965 .cindex "listing" "message in RFC 2822 format"
3966 This option causes a copy of the complete message (header lines plus body) to
3967 be written to the standard output in RFC 2822 format. This option can be used
3968 only by an admin user.
3970 .vitem &%-Mvh%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3972 .cindex "listing" "message headers"
3973 .cindex "header lines" "listing"
3974 .cindex "message" "listing header lines"
3975 This option causes the contents of the message headers (-H) spool file to be
3976 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3978 .vitem &%-Mvl%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3980 .cindex "listing" "message log"
3981 .cindex "message" "listing message log"
3982 This option causes the contents of the message log spool file to be written to
3983 the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3987 This is apparently a synonym for &%-om%& that is accepted by Sendmail, so Exim
3988 treats it that way too.
3992 .cindex "debugging" "&%-N%& option"
3993 .cindex "debugging" "suppressing delivery"
3994 This is a debugging option that inhibits delivery of a message at the transport
3995 level. It implies &%-v%&. Exim goes through many of the motions of delivery &--
3996 it just doesn't actually transport the message, but instead behaves as if it
3997 had successfully done so. However, it does not make any updates to the retry
3998 database, and the log entries for deliveries are flagged with &"*>"& rather
4001 Because &%-N%& discards any message to which it applies, only root or the Exim
4002 user are allowed to use it with &%-bd%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%& or &%-M%&. In other
4003 words, an ordinary user can use it only when supplying an incoming message to
4004 which it will apply. Although transportation never fails when &%-N%& is set, an
4005 address may be deferred because of a configuration problem on a transport, or a
4006 routing problem. Once &%-N%& has been used for a delivery attempt, it sticks to
4007 the message, and applies to any subsequent delivery attempts that may happen
4012 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &"no aliasing"&.
4013 For normal modes of operation, it is ignored by Exim.
4014 When combined with &%-bP%& it suppresses the name of an option from being output.
4016 .vitem &%-O%&&~<&'data'&>
4018 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &`set option`&. It is ignored by
4021 .vitem &%-oA%&&~<&'file&~name'&>
4023 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oA%& option"
4024 This option is used by Sendmail in conjunction with &%-bi%& to specify an
4025 alternative alias file name. Exim handles &%-bi%& differently; see the
4028 .vitem &%-oB%&&~<&'n'&>
4030 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4031 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4032 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4033 This is a debugging option which limits the maximum number of messages that can
4034 be delivered down one SMTP connection, overriding the value set in any &(smtp)&
4035 transport. If <&'n'&> is omitted, the limit is set to 1.
4039 .cindex "background delivery"
4040 .cindex "delivery" "in the background"
4041 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4042 including the listening daemon. It requests &"background"& delivery of such
4043 messages, which means that the accepting process automatically starts a
4044 delivery process for each message received, but does not wait for the delivery
4045 processes to finish.
4047 When all the messages have been received, the reception process exits,
4048 leaving the delivery processes to finish in their own time. The standard output
4049 and error streams are closed at the start of each delivery process.
4050 This is the default action if none of the &%-od%& options are present.
4052 If one of the queueing options in the configuration file
4053 (&%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%&, for example) is in effect, &%-odb%&
4054 overrides it if &%queue_only_override%& is set true, which is the default
4055 setting. If &%queue_only_override%& is set false, &%-odb%& has no effect.
4059 .cindex "foreground delivery"
4060 .cindex "delivery" "in the foreground"
4061 This option requests &"foreground"& (synchronous) delivery when Exim has
4062 accepted a locally-generated message. (For the daemon it is exactly the same as
4063 &%-odb%&.) A delivery process is automatically started to deliver the message,
4064 and Exim waits for it to complete before proceeding.
4066 The original Exim reception process does not finish until the delivery
4067 process for the final message has ended. The standard error stream is left open
4070 However, like &%-odb%&, this option has no effect if &%queue_only_override%& is
4071 false and one of the queueing options in the configuration file is in effect.
4073 If there is a temporary delivery error during foreground delivery, the
4074 message is left on the queue for later delivery, and the original reception
4075 process exits. See chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>& for a way of setting up a
4076 restricted configuration that never queues messages.
4081 This option is synonymous with &%-odf%&. It is provided for compatibility with
4086 .cindex "non-immediate delivery"
4087 .cindex "delivery" "suppressing immediate"
4088 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
4089 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4090 including the listening daemon. It specifies that the accepting process should
4091 not automatically start a delivery process for each message received. Messages
4092 are placed on the queue, and remain there until a subsequent queue runner
4093 process encounters them. There are several configuration options (such as
4094 &%queue_only%&) that can be used to queue incoming messages under certain
4095 conditions. This option overrides all of them and also &%-odqs%&. It always
4100 .cindex "SMTP" "delaying delivery"
4101 This option is a hybrid between &%-odb%&/&%-odi%& and &%-odq%&.
4102 However, like &%-odb%& and &%-odi%&, this option has no effect if
4103 &%queue_only_override%& is false and one of the queueing options in the
4104 configuration file is in effect.
4106 When &%-odqs%& does operate, a delivery process is started for each incoming
4107 message, in the background by default, but in the foreground if &%-odi%& is
4108 also present. The recipient addresses are routed, and local deliveries are done
4109 in the normal way. However, if any SMTP deliveries are required, they are not
4110 done at this time, so the message remains on the queue until a subsequent queue
4111 runner process encounters it. Because routing was done, Exim knows which
4112 messages are waiting for which hosts, and so a number of messages for the same
4113 host can be sent in a single SMTP connection. The &%queue_smtp_domains%&
4114 configuration option has the same effect for specific domains. See also the
4119 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4120 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received (for
4121 example, a malformed address), the error is reported to the sender in a mail
4124 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oee%&"
4126 this error message is successfully sent, the Exim receiving process
4127 exits with a return code of zero. If not, the return code is 2 if the problem
4128 is that the original message has no recipients, or 1 for any other error.
4129 This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option if Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4133 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4134 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oem%&"
4135 This is the same as &%-oee%&, except that Exim always exits with a non-zero
4136 return code, whether or not the error message was successfully sent.
4137 This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option, unless Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4141 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4142 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received, the
4143 error is reported by writing a message to the standard error file (stderr).
4144 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oep%&"
4145 The return code is 1 for all errors.
4149 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4150 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4155 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4156 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4161 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
4162 This option, which has the same effect as &%-i%&, specifies that a dot on a
4163 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. Otherwise, a
4164 single dot does terminate, though Exim does no special processing for other
4165 lines that start with a dot. This option is set by default if Exim is called as
4166 &'rmail'&. See also &%-ti%&.
4169 .oindex "&%-oitrue%&"
4170 This option is treated as synonymous with &%-oi%&.
4172 .vitem &%-oMa%&&~<&'host&~address'&>
4174 .cindex "sender" "host address, specifying for local message"
4175 A number of options starting with &%-oM%& can be used to set values associated
4176 with remote hosts on locally-submitted messages (that is, messages not received
4177 over TCP/IP). These options can be used by any caller in conjunction with the
4178 &%-bh%&, &%-be%&, &%-bf%&, &%-bF%&, &%-bt%&, or &%-bv%& testing options. In
4179 other circumstances, they are ignored unless the caller is trusted.
4181 The &%-oMa%& option sets the sender host address. This may include a port
4182 number at the end, after a full stop (period). For example:
4184 exim -bs -oMa 10.9.8.7.1234
4186 An alternative syntax is to enclose the IP address in square brackets,
4187 followed by a colon and the port number:
4189 exim -bs -oMa [10.9.8.7]:1234
4191 The IP address is placed in the &$sender_host_address$& variable, and the
4192 port, if present, in &$sender_host_port$&. If both &%-oMa%& and &%-bh%&
4193 are present on the command line, the sender host IP address is taken from
4194 whichever one is last.
4196 .vitem &%-oMaa%&&~<&'name'&>
4198 .cindex "authentication" "name, specifying for local message"
4199 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMaa%&
4200 option sets the value of &$sender_host_authenticated$& (the authenticator
4201 name). See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of SMTP authentication.
4202 This option can be used with &%-bh%& and &%-bs%& to set up an
4203 authenticated SMTP session without actually using the SMTP AUTH command.
4205 .vitem &%-oMai%&&~<&'string'&>
4207 .cindex "authentication" "id, specifying for local message"
4208 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMai%&
4209 option sets the value of &$authenticated_id$& (the id that was authenticated).
4210 This overrides the default value (the caller's login id, except with &%-bh%&,
4211 where there is no default) for messages from local sources. See chapter
4212 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated ids.
4214 .vitem &%-oMas%&&~<&'address'&>
4216 .cindex "authentication" "sender, specifying for local message"
4217 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMas%&
4218 option sets the authenticated sender value in &$authenticated_sender$&. It
4219 overrides the sender address that is created from the caller's login id for
4220 messages from local sources, except when &%-bh%& is used, when there is no
4221 default. For both &%-bh%& and &%-bs%&, an authenticated sender that is
4222 specified on a MAIL command overrides this value. See chapter
4223 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated senders.
4225 .vitem &%-oMi%&&~<&'interface&~address'&>
4227 .cindex "interface" "address, specifying for local message"
4228 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMi%&
4229 option sets the IP interface address value. A port number may be included,
4230 using the same syntax as for &%-oMa%&. The interface address is placed in
4231 &$received_ip_address$& and the port number, if present, in &$received_port$&.
4233 .vitem &%-oMr%&&~<&'protocol&~name'&>
4235 .cindex "protocol, specifying for local message"
4236 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
4237 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMr%&
4238 option sets the received protocol value that is stored in
4239 &$received_protocol$&. However, it does not apply (and is ignored) when &%-bh%&
4240 or &%-bs%& is used. For &%-bh%&, the protocol is forced to one of the standard
4241 SMTP protocol names (see the description of &$received_protocol$& in section
4242 &<<SECTexpvar>>&). For &%-bs%&, the protocol is always &"local-"& followed by
4243 one of those same names. For &%-bS%& (batched SMTP) however, the protocol can
4246 .vitem &%-oMs%&&~<&'host&~name'&>
4248 .cindex "sender" "host name, specifying for local message"
4249 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMs%&
4250 option sets the sender host name in &$sender_host_name$&. When this option is
4251 present, Exim does not attempt to look up a host name from an IP address; it
4252 uses the name it is given.
4254 .vitem &%-oMt%&&~<&'ident&~string'&>
4256 .cindex "sender" "ident string, specifying for local message"
4257 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMt%&
4258 option sets the sender ident value in &$sender_ident$&. The default setting for
4259 local callers is the login id of the calling process, except when &%-bh%& is
4260 used, when there is no default.
4264 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-om%& option ignored"
4265 In Sendmail, this option means &"me too"&, indicating that the sender of a
4266 message should receive a copy of the message if the sender appears in an alias
4267 expansion. Exim always does this, so the option does nothing.
4271 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oo%& option ignored"
4272 This option is ignored. In Sendmail it specifies &"old style headers"&,
4273 whatever that means.
4275 .vitem &%-oP%&&~<&'path'&>
4277 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
4278 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
4279 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-bd%& or &%-q%& with a time
4280 value. The option specifies the file to which the process id of the daemon is
4281 written. When &%-oX%& is used with &%-bd%&, or when &%-q%& with a time is used
4282 without &%-bd%&, this is the only way of causing Exim to write a pid file,
4283 because in those cases, the normal pid file is not used.
4285 .vitem &%-or%&&~<&'time'&>
4287 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
4288 This option sets a timeout value for incoming non-SMTP messages. If it is not
4289 set, Exim will wait forever for the standard input. The value can also be set
4290 by the &%receive_timeout%& option. The format used for specifying times is
4291 described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4293 .vitem &%-os%&&~<&'time'&>
4295 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
4296 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
4297 This option sets a timeout value for incoming SMTP messages. The timeout
4298 applies to each SMTP command and block of data. The value can also be set by
4299 the &%smtp_receive_timeout%& option; it defaults to 5 minutes. The format used
4300 for specifying times is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4304 This option has exactly the same effect as &%-v%&.
4306 .vitem &%-oX%&&~<&'number&~or&~string'&>
4308 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
4309 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
4310 .cindex "port" "receiving TCP/IP"
4311 This option is relevant only when the &%-bd%& (start listening daemon) option
4312 is also given. It controls which ports and interfaces the daemon uses. Details
4313 of the syntax, and how it interacts with configuration file options, are given
4314 in chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&. When &%-oX%& is used to start a daemon, no pid
4315 file is written unless &%-oP%& is also present to specify a pid file name.
4319 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4320 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4321 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4322 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to be delayed until it is
4327 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4328 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4329 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4330 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to occur as soon as Exim is
4333 .vitem &%-p%&<&'rval'&>:<&'sval'&>
4335 For compatibility with Sendmail, this option is equivalent to
4337 &`-oMr`& <&'rval'&> &`-oMs`& <&'sval'&>
4339 It sets the incoming protocol and host name (for trusted callers). The
4340 host name and its colon can be omitted when only the protocol is to be set.
4341 Note the Exim already has two private options, &%-pd%& and &%-ps%&, that refer
4342 to embedded Perl. It is therefore impossible to set a protocol value of &`d`&
4343 or &`s`& using this option (but that does not seem a real limitation).
4347 .cindex "queue runner" "starting manually"
4348 This option is normally restricted to admin users. However, there is a
4349 configuration option called &%prod_requires_admin%& which can be set false to
4350 relax this restriction (and also the same requirement for the &%-M%&, &%-R%&,
4351 and &%-S%& options).
4353 .cindex "queue runner" "description of operation"
4354 The &%-q%& option starts one queue runner process. This scans the queue of
4355 waiting messages, and runs a delivery process for each one in turn. It waits
4356 for each delivery process to finish before starting the next one. A delivery
4357 process may not actually do any deliveries if the retry times for the addresses
4358 have not been reached. Use &%-qf%& (see below) if you want to override this.
4361 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4362 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4363 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4364 the delivery process spawns other processes to deliver other messages down
4365 passed SMTP connections, the queue runner waits for these to finish before
4368 When all the queued messages have been considered, the original queue runner
4369 process terminates. In other words, a single pass is made over the waiting
4370 mail, one message at a time. Use &%-q%& with a time (see below) if you want
4371 this to be repeated periodically.
4373 Exim processes the waiting messages in an unpredictable order. It isn't very
4374 random, but it is likely to be different each time, which is all that matters.
4375 If one particular message screws up a remote MTA, other messages to the same
4376 MTA have a chance of getting through if they get tried first.
4378 It is possible to cause the messages to be processed in lexical message id
4379 order, which is essentially the order in which they arrived, by setting the
4380 &%queue_run_in_order%& option, but this is not recommended for normal use.
4382 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>
4383 The &%-q%& option may be followed by one or more flag letters that change its
4384 behaviour. They are all optional, but if more than one is present, they must
4385 appear in the correct order. Each flag is described in a separate item below.
4389 .cindex "queue" "double scanning"
4390 .cindex "queue" "routing"
4391 .cindex "routing" "whole queue before delivery"
4392 An option starting with &%-qq%& requests a two-stage queue run. In the first
4393 stage, the queue is scanned as if the &%queue_smtp_domains%& option matched
4394 every domain. Addresses are routed, local deliveries happen, but no remote
4397 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
4398 The hints database that remembers which messages are waiting for specific hosts
4399 is updated, as if delivery to those hosts had been deferred. After this is
4400 complete, a second, normal queue scan happens, with routing and delivery taking
4401 place as normal. Messages that are routed to the same host should mostly be
4402 delivered down a single SMTP
4403 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4404 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4405 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4406 connection because of the hints that were set up during the first queue scan.
4407 This option may be useful for hosts that are connected to the Internet
4410 .vitem &%-q[q]i...%&
4412 .cindex "queue" "initial delivery"
4413 If the &'i'& flag is present, the queue runner runs delivery processes only for
4414 those messages that haven't previously been tried. (&'i'& stands for &"initial
4415 delivery"&.) This can be helpful if you are putting messages on the queue using
4416 &%-odq%& and want a queue runner just to process the new messages.
4418 .vitem &%-q[q][i]f...%&
4420 .cindex "queue" "forcing delivery"
4421 .cindex "delivery" "forcing in queue run"
4422 If one &'f'& flag is present, a delivery attempt is forced for each non-frozen
4423 message, whereas without &'f'& only those non-frozen addresses that have passed
4424 their retry times are tried.
4426 .vitem &%-q[q][i]ff...%&
4428 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4429 If &'ff'& is present, a delivery attempt is forced for every message, whether
4432 .vitem &%-q[q][i][f[f]]l%&
4434 .cindex "queue" "local deliveries only"
4435 The &'l'& (the letter &"ell"&) flag specifies that only local deliveries are to
4436 be done. If a message requires any remote deliveries, it remains on the queue
4439 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>&~<&'start&~id'&>&~<&'end&~id'&>
4440 .cindex "queue" "delivering specific messages"
4441 When scanning the queue, Exim can be made to skip over messages whose ids are
4442 lexically less than a given value by following the &%-q%& option with a
4443 starting message id. For example:
4445 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4447 Messages that arrived earlier than &`0t5C6f-0000c8-00`& are not inspected. If a
4448 second message id is given, messages whose ids are lexically greater than it
4449 are also skipped. If the same id is given twice, for example,
4451 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4453 just one delivery process is started, for that message. This differs from
4454 &%-M%& in that retry data is respected, and it also differs from &%-Mc%& in
4455 that it counts as a delivery from a queue run. Note that the selection
4456 mechanism does not affect the order in which the messages are scanned. There
4457 are also other ways of selecting specific sets of messages for delivery in a
4458 queue run &-- see &%-R%& and &%-S%&.
4460 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&><&'time'&>
4461 .cindex "queue runner" "starting periodically"
4462 .cindex "periodic queue running"
4463 When a time value is present, the &%-q%& option causes Exim to run as a daemon,
4464 starting a queue runner process at intervals specified by the given time value
4465 (whose format is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&). This form of the
4466 &%-q%& option is commonly combined with the &%-bd%& option, in which case a
4467 single daemon process handles both functions. A common way of starting up a
4468 combined daemon at system boot time is to use a command such as
4470 /usr/exim/bin/exim -bd -q30m
4472 Such a daemon listens for incoming SMTP calls, and also starts a queue runner
4473 process every 30 minutes.
4475 When a daemon is started by &%-q%& with a time value, but without &%-bd%&, no
4476 pid file is written unless one is explicitly requested by the &%-oP%& option.
4478 .vitem &%-qR%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4480 This option is synonymous with &%-R%&. It is provided for Sendmail
4483 .vitem &%-qS%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4485 This option is synonymous with &%-S%&.
4487 .vitem &%-R%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4489 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific recipients"
4490 .cindex "delivery" "to given domain"
4491 .cindex "domain" "delivery to"
4492 The <&'rsflags'&> may be empty, in which case the white space before the string
4493 is optional, unless the string is &'f'&, &'ff'&, &'r'&, &'rf'&, or &'rff'&,
4494 which are the possible values for <&'rsflags'&>. White space is required if
4495 <&'rsflags'&> is not empty.
4497 This option is similar to &%-q%& with no time value, that is, it causes Exim to
4498 perform a single queue run, except that, when scanning the messages on the
4499 queue, Exim processes only those that have at least one undelivered recipient
4500 address containing the given string, which is checked in a case-independent
4501 way. If the <&'rsflags'&> start with &'r'&, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a
4502 regular expression; otherwise it is a literal string.
4504 If you want to do periodic queue runs for messages with specific recipients,
4505 you can combine &%-R%& with &%-q%& and a time value. For example:
4507 exim -q25m -R @special.domain.example
4509 This example does a queue run for messages with recipients in the given domain
4510 every 25 minutes. Any additional flags that are specified with &%-q%& are
4511 applied to each queue run.
4513 Once a message is selected for delivery by this mechanism, all its addresses
4514 are processed. For the first selected message, Exim overrides any retry
4515 information and forces a delivery attempt for each undelivered address. This
4516 means that if delivery of any address in the first message is successful, any
4517 existing retry information is deleted, and so delivery attempts for that
4518 address in subsequently selected messages (which are processed without forcing)
4519 will run. However, if delivery of any address does not succeed, the retry
4520 information is updated, and in subsequently selected messages, the failing
4521 address will be skipped.
4523 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4524 If the <&'rsflags'&> contain &'f'& or &'ff'&, the delivery forcing applies to
4525 all selected messages, not just the first; frozen messages are included when
4528 The &%-R%& option makes it straightforward to initiate delivery of all messages
4529 to a given domain after a host has been down for some time. When the SMTP
4530 command ETRN is accepted by its ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), its default
4531 effect is to run Exim with the &%-R%& option, but it can be configured to run
4532 an arbitrary command instead.
4536 This is a documented (for Sendmail) obsolete alternative name for &%-f%&.
4538 .vitem &%-S%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4540 .cindex "delivery" "from given sender"
4541 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific senders"
4542 This option acts like &%-R%& except that it checks the string against each
4543 message's sender instead of against the recipients. If &%-R%& is also set, both
4544 conditions must be met for a message to be selected. If either of the options
4545 has &'f'& or &'ff'& in its flags, the associated action is taken.
4547 .vitem &%-Tqt%&&~<&'times'&>
4549 This is an option that is exclusively for use by the Exim testing suite. It is not
4550 recognized when Exim is run normally. It allows for the setting up of explicit
4551 &"queue times"& so that various warning/retry features can be tested.
4555 .cindex "recipient" "extracting from header lines"
4556 .cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
4557 .cindex "&'Cc:'& header line"
4558 .cindex "&'To:'& header line"
4559 When Exim is receiving a locally-generated, non-SMTP message on its standard
4560 input, the &%-t%& option causes the recipients of the message to be obtained
4561 from the &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'& header lines in the message instead of
4562 from the command arguments. The addresses are extracted before any rewriting
4563 takes place and the &'Bcc:'& header line, if present, is then removed.
4565 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
4566 If the command has any arguments, they specify addresses to which the message
4567 is &'not'& to be delivered. That is, the argument addresses are removed from
4568 the recipients list obtained from the headers. This is compatible with Smail 3
4569 and in accordance with the documented behaviour of several versions of
4570 Sendmail, as described in man pages on a number of operating systems (e.g.
4571 Solaris 8, IRIX 6.5, HP-UX 11). However, some versions of Sendmail &'add'&
4572 argument addresses to those obtained from the headers, and the O'Reilly
4573 Sendmail book documents it that way. Exim can be made to add argument addresses
4574 instead of subtracting them by setting the option
4575 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& false.
4577 .cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines" "with &%-t%&"
4578 If there are any &%Resent-%& header lines in the message, Exim extracts
4579 recipients from all &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&, and &'Resent-Bcc:'& header
4580 lines instead of from &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'&. This is for compatibility
4581 with Sendmail and other MTAs. (Prior to release 4.20, Exim gave an error if
4582 &%-t%& was used in conjunction with &%Resent-%& header lines.)
4584 RFC 2822 talks about different sets of &%Resent-%& header lines (for when a
4585 message is resent several times). The RFC also specifies that they should be
4586 added at the front of the message, and separated by &'Received:'& lines. It is
4587 not at all clear how &%-t%& should operate in the present of multiple sets,
4588 nor indeed exactly what constitutes a &"set"&.
4589 In practice, it seems that MUAs do not follow the RFC. The &%Resent-%& lines
4590 are often added at the end of the header, and if a message is resent more than
4591 once, it is common for the original set of &%Resent-%& headers to be renamed as
4592 &%X-Resent-%& when a new set is added. This removes any possible ambiguity.
4596 This option is exactly equivalent to &%-t%& &%-i%&. It is provided for
4597 compatibility with Sendmail.
4599 .vitem &%-tls-on-connect%&
4600 .oindex "&%-tls-on-connect%&"
4601 .cindex "TLS" "use without STARTTLS"
4602 .cindex "TLS" "automatic start"
4603 This option is available when Exim is compiled with TLS support. It forces all
4604 incoming SMTP connections to behave as if the incoming port is listed in the
4605 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option. See section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>& and chapter
4606 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
4611 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-U%& option ignored"
4612 Sendmail uses this option for &"initial message submission"&, and its
4613 documentation states that in future releases, it may complain about
4614 syntactically invalid messages rather than fixing them when this flag is not
4615 set. Exim ignores this option.
4619 This option causes Exim to write information to the standard error stream,
4620 describing what it is doing. In particular, it shows the log lines for
4621 receiving and delivering a message, and if an SMTP connection is made, the SMTP
4622 dialogue is shown. Some of the log lines shown may not actually be written to
4623 the log if the setting of &%log_selector%& discards them. Any relevant
4624 selectors are shown with each log line. If none are shown, the logging is
4629 AIX uses &%-x%& for a private purpose (&"mail from a local mail program has
4630 National Language Support extended characters in the body of the mail item"&).
4631 It sets &%-x%& when calling the MTA from its &%mail%& command. Exim ignores
4635 .vitem &%-X%&&~<&'logfile'&>
4637 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to cause debug information to be sent
4638 to the named file. It is ignored by Exim.
4646 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4647 . Insert a stylized DocBook comment here, to identify the end of the command
4648 . line options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
4649 . creates a man page for the options.
4650 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4653 <!-- === End of command line options === -->
4660 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4661 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4664 .chapter "The Exim run time configuration file" "CHAPconf" &&&
4665 "The runtime configuration file"
4667 .cindex "run time configuration"
4668 .cindex "configuration file" "general description"
4669 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
4670 .cindex "configuration file" "errors in"
4671 .cindex "error" "in configuration file"
4672 .cindex "return code" "for bad configuration"
4673 Exim uses a single run time configuration file that is read whenever an Exim
4674 binary is executed. Note that in normal operation, this happens frequently,
4675 because Exim is designed to operate in a distributed manner, without central
4678 If a syntax error is detected while reading the configuration file, Exim
4679 writes a message on the standard error, and exits with a non-zero return code.
4680 The message is also written to the panic log. &*Note*&: Only simple syntax
4681 errors can be detected at this time. The values of any expanded options are
4682 not checked until the expansion happens, even when the expansion does not
4683 actually alter the string.
4685 The name of the configuration file is compiled into the binary for security
4686 reasons, and is specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE compilation option. In
4687 most configurations, this specifies a single file. However, it is permitted to
4688 give a colon-separated list of file names, in which case Exim uses the first
4689 existing file in the list.
4692 .cindex "EXIM_GROUP"
4693 .cindex "CONFIGURE_OWNER"
4694 .cindex "CONFIGURE_GROUP"
4695 .cindex "configuration file" "ownership"
4696 .cindex "ownership" "configuration file"
4697 The run time configuration file must be owned by root or by the user that is
4698 specified at compile time by the CONFIGURE_OWNER option (if set). The
4699 configuration file must not be world-writeable, or group-writeable unless its
4700 group is the root group or the one specified at compile time by the
4701 CONFIGURE_GROUP option.
4703 &*Warning*&: In a conventional configuration, where the Exim binary is setuid
4704 to root, anybody who is able to edit the run time configuration file has an
4705 easy way to run commands as root. If you specify a user or group in the
4706 CONFIGURE_OWNER or CONFIGURE_GROUP options, then that user and/or any users
4707 who are members of that group will trivially be able to obtain root privileges.
4709 Up to Exim version 4.72, the run time configuration file was also permitted to
4710 be writeable by the Exim user and/or group. That has been changed in Exim 4.73
4711 since it offered a simple privilege escalation for any attacker who managed to
4712 compromise the Exim user account.
4714 A default configuration file, which will work correctly in simple situations,
4715 is provided in the file &_src/configure.default_&. If CONFIGURE_FILE
4716 defines just one file name, the installation process copies the default
4717 configuration to a new file of that name if it did not previously exist. If
4718 CONFIGURE_FILE is a list, no default is automatically installed. Chapter
4719 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& is a &"walk-through"& discussion of the default
4724 .section "Using a different configuration file" "SECID40"
4725 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
4726 A one-off alternate configuration can be specified by the &%-C%& command line
4727 option, which may specify a single file or a list of files. However, when
4728 &%-C%& is used, Exim gives up its root privilege, unless called by root (or
4729 unless the argument for &%-C%& is identical to the built-in value from
4730 CONFIGURE_FILE), or is listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file and the caller
4731 is the Exim user or the user specified in the CONFIGURE_OWNER setting. &%-C%&
4732 is useful mainly for checking the syntax of configuration files before
4733 installing them. No owner or group checks are done on a configuration file
4734 specified by &%-C%&, if root privilege has been dropped.
4736 Even the Exim user is not trusted to specify an arbitrary configuration file
4737 with the &%-C%& option to be used with root privileges, unless that file is
4738 listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file. This locks out the possibility of
4739 testing a configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and
4740 delivery, even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time,
4741 Exim is running as the Exim user, so when it re-execs to regain privilege for
4742 the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root
4743 can test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a
4744 message on the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using
4747 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
4748 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option must
4749 start. In addition, the file name must not contain the sequence &"&`/../`&"&.
4750 There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is unset, any file
4751 name can be used with &%-C%&.
4753 One-off changes to a configuration can be specified by the &%-D%& command line
4754 option, which defines and overrides values for macros used inside the
4755 configuration file. However, like &%-C%&, the use of this option by a
4756 non-privileged user causes Exim to discard its root privilege.
4757 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
4758 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
4760 The WHITELIST_D_MACROS option in &_Local/Makefile_& permits the binary builder
4761 to declare certain macro names trusted, such that root privilege will not
4762 necessarily be discarded.
4763 WHITELIST_D_MACROS defines a colon-separated list of macros which are
4764 considered safe and, if &%-D%& only supplies macros from this list, and the
4765 values are acceptable, then Exim will not give up root privilege if the caller
4766 is root, the Exim run-time user, or the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a
4767 transition mechanism and is expected to be removed in the future. Acceptable
4768 values for the macros satisfy the regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
4770 Some sites may wish to use the same Exim binary on different machines that
4771 share a file system, but to use different configuration files on each machine.
4772 If CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_NODE is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim first
4773 looks for a file whose name is the configuration file name followed by a dot
4774 and the machine's node name, as obtained from the &[uname()]& function. If this
4775 file does not exist, the standard name is tried. This processing occurs for
4776 each file name in the list given by CONFIGURE_FILE or &%-C%&.
4778 In some esoteric situations different versions of Exim may be run under
4779 different effective uids and the CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_EUID is defined to
4780 help with this. See the comments in &_src/EDITME_& for details.
4784 .section "Configuration file format" "SECTconffilfor"
4785 .cindex "configuration file" "format of"
4786 .cindex "format" "configuration file"
4787 Exim's configuration file is divided into a number of different parts. General
4788 option settings must always appear at the start of the file. The other parts
4789 are all optional, and may appear in any order. Each part other than the first
4790 is introduced by the word &"begin"& followed by the name of the part. The
4794 &'ACL'&: Access control lists for controlling incoming SMTP mail (see chapter
4797 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
4798 &'authenticators'&: Configuration settings for the authenticator drivers. These
4799 are concerned with the SMTP AUTH command (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&).
4801 &'routers'&: Configuration settings for the router drivers. Routers process
4802 addresses and determine how the message is to be delivered (see chapters
4803 &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPredirect>>&).
4805 &'transports'&: Configuration settings for the transport drivers. Transports
4806 define mechanisms for copying messages to destinations (see chapters
4807 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPsmtptrans>>&).
4809 &'retry'&: Retry rules, for use when a message cannot be delivered immediately.
4810 If there is no retry section, or if it is empty (that is, no retry rules are
4811 defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. In this situation, temporary errors
4812 are treated the same as permanent errors. Retry rules are discussed in chapter
4815 &'rewrite'&: Global address rewriting rules, for use when a message arrives and
4816 when new addresses are generated during delivery. Rewriting is discussed in
4817 chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&.
4819 &'local_scan'&: Private options for the &[local_scan()]& function. If you
4820 want to use this feature, you must set
4822 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
4824 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. Details of the &[local_scan()]&
4825 facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&.
4828 .cindex "configuration file" "leading white space in"
4829 .cindex "configuration file" "trailing white space in"
4830 .cindex "white space" "in configuration file"
4831 Leading and trailing white space in configuration lines is always ignored.
4833 Blank lines in the file, and lines starting with a # character (ignoring
4834 leading white space) are treated as comments and are ignored. &*Note*&: A
4835 # character other than at the beginning of a line is not treated specially,
4836 and does not introduce a comment.
4838 Any non-comment line can be continued by ending it with a backslash. Note that
4839 the general rule for white space means that trailing white space after the
4840 backslash and leading white space at the start of continuation
4841 lines is ignored. Comment lines beginning with # (but not empty lines) may
4842 appear in the middle of a sequence of continuation lines.
4844 A convenient way to create a configuration file is to start from the
4845 default, which is supplied in &_src/configure.default_&, and add, delete, or
4846 change settings as required.
4848 The ACLs, retry rules, and rewriting rules have their own syntax which is
4849 described in chapters &<<CHAPACL>>&, &<<CHAPretry>>&, and &<<CHAPrewrite>>&,
4850 respectively. The other parts of the configuration file have some syntactic
4851 items in common, and these are described below, from section &<<SECTcos>>&
4852 onwards. Before that, the inclusion, macro, and conditional facilities are
4857 .section "File inclusions in the configuration file" "SECID41"
4858 .cindex "inclusions in configuration file"
4859 .cindex "configuration file" "including other files"
4860 .cindex "&`.include`& in configuration file"
4861 .cindex "&`.include_if_exists`& in configuration file"
4862 You can include other files inside Exim's run time configuration file by
4865 &`.include`& <&'file name'&>
4866 &`.include_if_exists`& <&'file name'&>
4868 on a line by itself. Double quotes round the file name are optional. If you use
4869 the first form, a configuration error occurs if the file does not exist; the
4870 second form does nothing for non-existent files. In all cases, an absolute file
4873 Includes may be nested to any depth, but remember that Exim reads its
4874 configuration file often, so it is a good idea to keep them to a minimum.
4875 If you change the contents of an included file, you must HUP the daemon,
4876 because an included file is read only when the configuration itself is read.
4878 The processing of inclusions happens early, at a physical line level, so, like
4879 comment lines, an inclusion can be used in the middle of an option setting,
4882 hosts_lookup = a.b.c \
4885 Include processing happens after macro processing (see below). Its effect is to
4886 process the lines of the included file as if they occurred inline where the
4891 .section "Macros in the configuration file" "SECTmacrodefs"
4892 .cindex "macro" "description of"
4893 .cindex "configuration file" "macros"
4894 If a line in the main part of the configuration (that is, before the first
4895 &"begin"& line) begins with an upper case letter, it is taken as a macro
4896 definition, and must be of the form
4898 <&'name'&> = <&'rest of line'&>
4900 The name must consist of letters, digits, and underscores, and need not all be
4901 in upper case, though that is recommended. The rest of the line, including any
4902 continuations, is the replacement text, and has leading and trailing white
4903 space removed. Quotes are not removed. The replacement text can never end with
4904 a backslash character, but this doesn't seem to be a serious limitation.
4906 Macros may also be defined between router, transport, authenticator, or ACL
4907 definitions. They may not, however, be defined within an individual driver or
4908 ACL, or in the &%local_scan%&, retry, or rewrite sections of the configuration.
4910 .section "Macro substitution" "SECID42"
4911 Once a macro is defined, all subsequent lines in the file (and any included
4912 files) are scanned for the macro name; if there are several macros, the line is
4913 scanned for each in turn, in the order in which the macros are defined. The
4914 replacement text is not re-scanned for the current macro, though it is scanned
4915 for subsequently defined macros. For this reason, a macro name may not contain
4916 the name of a previously defined macro as a substring. You could, for example,
4919 &`ABCD_XYZ = `&<&'something'&>
4920 &`ABCD = `&<&'something else'&>
4922 but putting the definitions in the opposite order would provoke a configuration
4923 error. Macro expansion is applied to individual physical lines from the file,
4924 before checking for line continuation or file inclusion (see above). If a line
4925 consists solely of a macro name, and the expansion of the macro is empty, the
4926 line is ignored. A macro at the start of a line may turn the line into a
4927 comment line or a &`.include`& line.
4930 .section "Redefining macros" "SECID43"
4931 Once defined, the value of a macro can be redefined later in the configuration
4932 (or in an included file). Redefinition is specified by using &'=='& instead of
4937 MAC == updated value
4939 Redefinition does not alter the order in which the macros are applied to the
4940 subsequent lines of the configuration file. It is still the same order in which
4941 the macros were originally defined. All that changes is the macro's value.
4942 Redefinition makes it possible to accumulate values. For example:
4946 MAC == MAC and something added
4948 This can be helpful in situations where the configuration file is built
4949 from a number of other files.
4951 .section "Overriding macro values" "SECID44"
4952 The values set for macros in the configuration file can be overridden by the
4953 &%-D%& command line option, but Exim gives up its root privilege when &%-D%& is
4954 used, unless called by root or the Exim user. A definition on the command line
4955 using the &%-D%& option causes all definitions and redefinitions within the
4960 .section "Example of macro usage" "SECID45"
4961 As an example of macro usage, consider a configuration where aliases are looked
4962 up in a MySQL database. It helps to keep the file less cluttered if long
4963 strings such as SQL statements are defined separately as macros, for example:
4965 ALIAS_QUERY = select mailbox from user where \
4966 login='${quote_mysql:$local_part}';
4968 This can then be used in a &(redirect)& router setting like this:
4970 data = ${lookup mysql{ALIAS_QUERY}}
4972 In earlier versions of Exim macros were sometimes used for domain, host, or
4973 address lists. In Exim 4 these are handled better by named lists &-- see
4974 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
4977 .section "Conditional skips in the configuration file" "SECID46"
4978 .cindex "configuration file" "conditional skips"
4979 .cindex "&`.ifdef`&"
4980 You can use the directives &`.ifdef`&, &`.ifndef`&, &`.elifdef`&,
4981 &`.elifndef`&, &`.else`&, and &`.endif`& to dynamically include or exclude
4982 portions of the configuration file. The processing happens whenever the file is
4983 read (that is, when an Exim binary starts to run).
4985 The implementation is very simple. Instances of the first four directives must
4986 be followed by text that includes the names of one or macros. The condition
4987 that is tested is whether or not any macro substitution has taken place in the
4991 message_size_limit = 50M
4993 message_size_limit = 100M
4996 sets a message size limit of 50M if the macro &`AAA`& is defined, and 100M
4997 otherwise. If there is more than one macro named on the line, the condition
4998 is true if any of them are defined. That is, it is an &"or"& condition. To
4999 obtain an &"and"& condition, you need to use nested &`.ifdef`&s.
5001 Although you can use a macro expansion to generate one of these directives,
5002 it is not very useful, because the condition &"there was a macro substitution
5003 in this line"& will always be true.
5005 Text following &`.else`& and &`.endif`& is ignored, and can be used as comment
5006 to clarify complicated nestings.
5010 .section "Common option syntax" "SECTcos"
5011 .cindex "common option syntax"
5012 .cindex "syntax of common options"
5013 .cindex "configuration file" "common option syntax"
5014 For the main set of options, driver options, and &[local_scan()]& options,
5015 each setting is on a line by itself, and starts with a name consisting of
5016 lower-case letters and underscores. Many options require a data value, and in
5017 these cases the name must be followed by an equals sign (with optional white
5018 space) and then the value. For example:
5020 qualify_domain = mydomain.example.com
5022 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
5023 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
5024 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
5025 Some option settings may contain sensitive data, for example, passwords for
5026 accessing databases. To stop non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& command
5027 line option to read these values, you can precede the option settings with the
5028 word &"hide"&. For example:
5030 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/admin/secret-password
5032 For non-admin users, such options are displayed like this:
5034 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
5036 If &"hide"& is used on a driver option, it hides the value of that option on
5037 all instances of the same driver.
5039 The following sections describe the syntax used for the different data types
5040 that are found in option settings.
5043 .section "Boolean options" "SECID47"
5044 .cindex "format" "boolean"
5045 .cindex "boolean configuration values"
5046 .oindex "&%no_%&&'xxx'&"
5047 .oindex "&%not_%&&'xxx'&"
5048 Options whose type is given as boolean are on/off switches. There are two
5049 different ways of specifying such options: with and without a data value. If
5050 the option name is specified on its own without data, the switch is turned on;
5051 if it is preceded by &"no_"& or &"not_"& the switch is turned off. However,
5052 boolean options may be followed by an equals sign and one of the words
5053 &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"&, or &"no"&, as an alternative syntax. For example,
5054 the following two settings have exactly the same effect:
5059 The following two lines also have the same (opposite) effect:
5064 You can use whichever syntax you prefer.
5069 .section "Integer values" "SECID48"
5070 .cindex "integer configuration values"
5071 .cindex "format" "integer"
5072 If an option's type is given as &"integer"&, the value can be given in decimal,
5073 hexadecimal, or octal. If it starts with a digit greater than zero, a decimal
5074 number is assumed. Otherwise, it is treated as an octal number unless it starts
5075 with the characters &"0x"&, in which case the remainder is interpreted as a
5078 If an integer value is followed by the letter K, it is multiplied by 1024; if
5079 it is followed by the letter M, it is multiplied by 1024x1024. When the values
5080 of integer option settings are output, values which are an exact multiple of
5081 1024 or 1024x1024 are sometimes, but not always, printed using the letters K
5082 and M. The printing style is independent of the actual input format that was
5086 .section "Octal integer values" "SECID49"
5087 .cindex "integer format"
5088 .cindex "format" "octal integer"
5089 If an option's type is given as &"octal integer"&, its value is always
5090 interpreted as an octal number, whether or not it starts with the digit zero.
5091 Such options are always output in octal.
5094 .section "Fixed point numbers" "SECID50"
5095 .cindex "fixed point configuration values"
5096 .cindex "format" "fixed point"
5097 If an option's type is given as &"fixed-point"&, its value must be a decimal
5098 integer, optionally followed by a decimal point and up to three further digits.
5102 .section "Time intervals" "SECTtimeformat"
5103 .cindex "time interval" "specifying in configuration"
5104 .cindex "format" "time interval"
5105 A time interval is specified as a sequence of numbers, each followed by one of
5106 the following letters, with no intervening white space:
5116 For example, &"3h50m"& specifies 3 hours and 50 minutes. The values of time
5117 intervals are output in the same format. Exim does not restrict the values; it
5118 is perfectly acceptable, for example, to specify &"90m"& instead of &"1h30m"&.
5122 .section "String values" "SECTstrings"
5123 .cindex "string" "format of configuration values"
5124 .cindex "format" "string"
5125 If an option's type is specified as &"string"&, the value can be specified with
5126 or without double-quotes. If it does not start with a double-quote, the value
5127 consists of the remainder of the line plus any continuation lines, starting at
5128 the first character after any leading white space, with trailing white space
5129 removed, and with no interpretation of the characters in the string. Because
5130 Exim removes comment lines (those beginning with #) at an early stage, they can
5131 appear in the middle of a multi-line string. The following two settings are
5132 therefore equivalent:
5134 trusted_users = uucp:mail
5135 trusted_users = uucp:\
5136 # This comment line is ignored
5139 .cindex "string" "quoted"
5140 .cindex "escape characters in quoted strings"
5141 If a string does start with a double-quote, it must end with a closing
5142 double-quote, and any backslash characters other than those used for line
5143 continuation are interpreted as escape characters, as follows:
5146 .irow &`\\`& "single backslash"
5147 .irow &`\n`& "newline"
5148 .irow &`\r`& "carriage return"
5150 .irow "&`\`&<&'octal digits'&>" "up to 3 octal digits specify one character"
5151 .irow "&`\x`&<&'hex digits'&>" "up to 2 hexadecimal digits specify one &&&
5155 If a backslash is followed by some other character, including a double-quote
5156 character, that character replaces the pair.
5158 Quoting is necessary only if you want to make use of the backslash escapes to
5159 insert special characters, or if you need to specify a value with leading or
5160 trailing spaces. These cases are rare, so quoting is almost never needed in
5161 current versions of Exim. In versions of Exim before 3.14, quoting was required
5162 in order to continue lines, so you may come across older configuration files
5163 and examples that apparently quote unnecessarily.
5166 .section "Expanded strings" "SECID51"
5167 .cindex "expansion" "definition of"
5168 Some strings in the configuration file are subjected to &'string expansion'&,
5169 by which means various parts of the string may be changed according to the
5170 circumstances (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). The input syntax for such strings
5171 is as just described; in particular, the handling of backslashes in quoted
5172 strings is done as part of the input process, before expansion takes place.
5173 However, backslash is also an escape character for the expander, so any
5174 backslashes that are required for that reason must be doubled if they are
5175 within a quoted configuration string.
5178 .section "User and group names" "SECID52"
5179 .cindex "user name" "format of"
5180 .cindex "format" "user name"
5181 .cindex "groups" "name format"
5182 .cindex "format" "group name"
5183 User and group names are specified as strings, using the syntax described
5184 above, but the strings are interpreted specially. A user or group name must
5185 either consist entirely of digits, or be a name that can be looked up using the
5186 &[getpwnam()]& or &[getgrnam()]& function, as appropriate.
5189 .section "List construction" "SECTlistconstruct"
5190 .cindex "list" "syntax of in configuration"
5191 .cindex "format" "list item in configuration"
5192 .cindex "string" "list, definition of"
5193 The data for some configuration options is a list of items, with colon as the
5194 default separator. Many of these options are shown with type &"string list"& in
5195 the descriptions later in this document. Others are listed as &"domain list"&,
5196 &"host list"&, &"address list"&, or &"local part list"&. Syntactically, they
5197 are all the same; however, those other than &"string list"& are subject to
5198 particular kinds of interpretation, as described in chapter
5199 &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
5201 In all these cases, the entire list is treated as a single string as far as the
5202 input syntax is concerned. The &%trusted_users%& setting in section
5203 &<<SECTstrings>>& above is an example. If a colon is actually needed in an item
5204 in a list, it must be entered as two colons. Leading and trailing white space
5205 on each item in a list is ignored. This makes it possible to include items that
5206 start with a colon, and in particular, certain forms of IPv6 address. For
5209 local_interfaces = 127.0.0.1 : ::::1
5211 contains two IP addresses, the IPv4 address 127.0.0.1 and the IPv6 address ::1.
5213 &*Note*&: Although leading and trailing white space is ignored in individual
5214 list items, it is not ignored when parsing the list. The space after the first
5215 colon in the example above is necessary. If it were not there, the list would
5216 be interpreted as the two items 127.0.0.1:: and 1.
5218 .section "Changing list separators" "SECID53"
5219 .cindex "list separator" "changing"
5220 .cindex "IPv6" "addresses in lists"
5221 Doubling colons in IPv6 addresses is an unwelcome chore, so a mechanism was
5222 introduced to allow the separator character to be changed. If a list begins
5223 with a left angle bracket, followed by any punctuation character, that
5224 character is used instead of colon as the list separator. For example, the list
5225 above can be rewritten to use a semicolon separator like this:
5227 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1
5229 This facility applies to all lists, with the exception of the list in
5230 &%log_file_path%&. It is recommended that the use of non-colon separators be
5231 confined to circumstances where they really are needed.
5233 .cindex "list separator" "newline as"
5234 .cindex "newline" "as list separator"
5235 It is also possible to use newline and other control characters (those with
5236 code values less than 32, plus DEL) as separators in lists. Such separators
5237 must be provided literally at the time the list is processed. For options that
5238 are string-expanded, you can write the separator using a normal escape
5239 sequence. This will be processed by the expander before the string is
5240 interpreted as a list. For example, if a newline-separated list of domains is
5241 generated by a lookup, you can process it directly by a line such as this:
5243 domains = <\n ${lookup mysql{.....}}
5245 This avoids having to change the list separator in such data. You are unlikely
5246 to want to use a control character as a separator in an option that is not
5247 expanded, because the value is literal text. However, it can be done by giving
5248 the value in quotes. For example:
5250 local_interfaces = "<\n 127.0.0.1 \n ::1"
5252 Unlike printing character separators, which can be included in list items by
5253 doubling, it is not possible to include a control character as data when it is
5254 set as the separator. Two such characters in succession are interpreted as
5255 enclosing an empty list item.
5259 .section "Empty items in lists" "SECTempitelis"
5260 .cindex "list" "empty item in"
5261 An empty item at the end of a list is always ignored. In other words, trailing
5262 separator characters are ignored. Thus, the list in
5264 senders = user@domain :
5266 contains only a single item. If you want to include an empty string as one item
5267 in a list, it must not be the last item. For example, this list contains three
5268 items, the second of which is empty:
5270 senders = user1@domain : : user2@domain
5272 &*Note*&: There must be white space between the two colons, as otherwise they
5273 are interpreted as representing a single colon data character (and the list
5274 would then contain just one item). If you want to specify a list that contains
5275 just one, empty item, you can do it as in this example:
5279 In this case, the first item is empty, and the second is discarded because it
5280 is at the end of the list.
5285 .section "Format of driver configurations" "SECTfordricon"
5286 .cindex "drivers" "configuration format"
5287 There are separate parts in the configuration for defining routers, transports,
5288 and authenticators. In each part, you are defining a number of driver
5289 instances, each with its own set of options. Each driver instance is defined by
5290 a sequence of lines like this:
5292 <&'instance name'&>:
5297 In the following example, the instance name is &(localuser)&, and it is
5298 followed by three options settings:
5303 transport = local_delivery
5305 For each driver instance, you specify which Exim code module it uses &-- by the
5306 setting of the &%driver%& option &-- and (optionally) some configuration
5307 settings. For example, in the case of transports, if you want a transport to
5308 deliver with SMTP you would use the &(smtp)& driver; if you want to deliver to
5309 a local file you would use the &(appendfile)& driver. Each of the drivers is
5310 described in detail in its own separate chapter later in this manual.
5312 You can have several routers, transports, or authenticators that are based on
5313 the same underlying driver (each must have a different instance name).
5315 The order in which routers are defined is important, because addresses are
5316 passed to individual routers one by one, in order. The order in which
5317 transports are defined does not matter at all. The order in which
5318 authenticators are defined is used only when Exim, as a client, is searching
5319 them to find one that matches an authentication mechanism offered by the
5322 .cindex "generic options"
5323 .cindex "options" "generic &-- definition of"
5324 Within a driver instance definition, there are two kinds of option: &'generic'&
5325 and &'private'&. The generic options are those that apply to all drivers of the
5326 same type (that is, all routers, all transports or all authenticators). The
5327 &%driver%& option is a generic option that must appear in every definition.
5328 .cindex "private options"
5329 The private options are special for each driver, and none need appear, because
5330 they all have default values.
5332 The options may appear in any order, except that the &%driver%& option must
5333 precede any private options, since these depend on the particular driver. For
5334 this reason, it is recommended that &%driver%& always be the first option.
5336 Driver instance names, which are used for reference in log entries and
5337 elsewhere, can be any sequence of letters, digits, and underscores (starting
5338 with a letter) and must be unique among drivers of the same type. A router and
5339 a transport (for example) can each have the same name, but no two router
5340 instances can have the same name. The name of a driver instance should not be
5341 confused with the name of the underlying driver module. For example, the
5342 configuration lines:
5347 create an instance of the &(smtp)& transport driver whose name is
5348 &(remote_smtp)&. The same driver code can be used more than once, with
5349 different instance names and different option settings each time. A second
5350 instance of the &(smtp)& transport, with different options, might be defined
5356 command_timeout = 10s
5358 The names &(remote_smtp)& and &(special_smtp)& would be used to reference
5359 these transport instances from routers, and these names would appear in log
5362 Comment lines may be present in the middle of driver specifications. The full
5363 list of option settings for any particular driver instance, including all the
5364 defaulted values, can be extracted by making use of the &%-bP%& command line
5372 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5373 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5375 .chapter "The default configuration file" "CHAPdefconfil"
5376 .scindex IIDconfiwal "configuration file" "default &""walk through""&"
5377 .cindex "default" "configuration file &""walk through""&"
5378 The default configuration file supplied with Exim as &_src/configure.default_&
5379 is sufficient for a host with simple mail requirements. As an introduction to
5380 the way Exim is configured, this chapter &"walks through"& the default
5381 configuration, giving brief explanations of the settings. Detailed descriptions
5382 of the options are given in subsequent chapters. The default configuration file
5383 itself contains extensive comments about ways you might want to modify the
5384 initial settings. However, note that there are many options that are not
5385 mentioned at all in the default configuration.
5389 .section "Main configuration settings" "SECTdefconfmain"
5390 The main (global) configuration option settings must always come first in the
5391 file. The first thing you'll see in the file, after some initial comments, is
5394 # primary_hostname =
5396 This is a commented-out setting of the &%primary_hostname%& option. Exim needs
5397 to know the official, fully qualified name of your host, and this is where you
5398 can specify it. However, in most cases you do not need to set this option. When
5399 it is unset, Exim uses the &[uname()]& system function to obtain the host name.
5401 The first three non-comment configuration lines are as follows:
5403 domainlist local_domains = @
5404 domainlist relay_to_domains =
5405 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 127.0.0.1
5407 These are not, in fact, option settings. They are definitions of two named
5408 domain lists and one named host list. Exim allows you to give names to lists of
5409 domains, hosts, and email addresses, in order to make it easier to manage the
5410 configuration file (see section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&).
5412 The first line defines a domain list called &'local_domains'&; this is used
5413 later in the configuration to identify domains that are to be delivered
5416 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
5417 There is just one item in this list, the string &"@"&. This is a special form
5418 of entry which means &"the name of the local host"&. Thus, if the local host is
5419 called &'a.host.example'&, mail to &'any.user@a.host.example'& is expected to
5420 be delivered locally. Because the local host's name is referenced indirectly,
5421 the same configuration file can be used on different hosts.
5423 The second line defines a domain list called &'relay_to_domains'&, but the
5424 list itself is empty. Later in the configuration we will come to the part that
5425 controls mail relaying through the local host; it allows relaying to any
5426 domains in this list. By default, therefore, no relaying on the basis of a mail
5427 domain is permitted.
5429 The third line defines a host list called &'relay_from_hosts'&. This list is
5430 used later in the configuration to permit relaying from any host or IP address
5431 that matches the list. The default contains just the IP address of the IPv4
5432 loopback interface, which means that processes on the local host are able to
5433 submit mail for relaying by sending it over TCP/IP to that interface. No other
5434 hosts are permitted to submit messages for relaying.
5436 Just to be sure there's no misunderstanding: at this point in the configuration
5437 we aren't actually setting up any controls. We are just defining some domains
5438 and hosts that will be used in the controls that are specified later.
5440 The next two configuration lines are genuine option settings:
5442 acl_smtp_rcpt = acl_check_rcpt
5443 acl_smtp_data = acl_check_data
5445 These options specify &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs) that are to be used
5446 during an incoming SMTP session for every recipient of a message (every RCPT
5447 command), and after the contents of the message have been received,
5448 respectively. The names of the lists are &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5449 &'acl_check_data'&, and we will come to their definitions below, in the ACL
5450 section of the configuration. The RCPT ACL controls which recipients are
5451 accepted for an incoming message &-- if a configuration does not provide an ACL
5452 to check recipients, no SMTP mail can be accepted. The DATA ACL allows the
5453 contents of a message to be checked.
5455 Two commented-out option settings are next:
5457 # av_scanner = clamd:/tmp/clamd
5458 # spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 783
5460 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with the
5461 content-scanning extension. The first specifies the interface to the virus
5462 scanner, and the second specifies the interface to SpamAssassin. Further
5463 details are given in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
5465 Three more commented-out option settings follow:
5467 # tls_advertise_hosts = *
5468 # tls_certificate = /etc/ssl/exim.crt
5469 # tls_privatekey = /etc/ssl/exim.pem
5471 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with
5472 support for TLS (aka SSL) as described in section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&. The
5473 first one specifies the list of clients that are allowed to use TLS when
5474 connecting to this server; in this case the wildcard means all clients. The
5475 other options specify where Exim should find its TLS certificate and private
5476 key, which together prove the server's identity to any clients that connect.
5477 More details are given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
5479 Another two commented-out option settings follow:
5481 # daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 465 : 587
5482 # tls_on_connect_ports = 465
5484 .cindex "port" "465 and 587"
5485 .cindex "port" "for message submission"
5486 .cindex "message" "submission, ports for"
5487 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
5488 .cindex "smtps protocol"
5489 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
5490 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
5491 These options provide better support for roaming users who wish to use this
5492 server for message submission. They are not much use unless you have turned on
5493 TLS (as described in the previous paragraph) and authentication (about which
5494 more in section &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&). The usual SMTP port 25 is often blocked
5495 on end-user networks, so RFC 4409 specifies that message submission should use
5496 port 587 instead. However some software (notably Microsoft Outlook) cannot be
5497 configured to use port 587 correctly, so these settings also enable the
5498 non-standard &"smtps"& (aka &"ssmtp"&) port 465 (see section
5499 &<<SECTsupobssmt>>&).
5501 Two more commented-out options settings follow:
5504 # qualify_recipient =
5506 The first of these specifies a domain that Exim uses when it constructs a
5507 complete email address from a local login name. This is often needed when Exim
5508 receives a message from a local process. If you do not set &%qualify_domain%&,
5509 the value of &%primary_hostname%& is used. If you set both of these options,
5510 you can have different qualification domains for sender and recipient
5511 addresses. If you set only the first one, its value is used in both cases.
5513 .cindex "domain literal" "recognizing format"
5514 The following line must be uncommented if you want Exim to recognize
5515 addresses of the form &'user@[10.11.12.13]'& that is, with a &"domain literal"&
5516 (an IP address within square brackets) instead of a named domain.
5518 # allow_domain_literals
5520 The RFCs still require this form, but many people think that in the modern
5521 Internet it makes little sense to permit mail to be sent to specific hosts by
5522 quoting their IP addresses. This ancient format has been used by people who
5523 try to abuse hosts by using them for unwanted relaying. However, some
5524 people believe there are circumstances (for example, messages addressed to
5525 &'postmaster'&) where domain literals are still useful.
5527 The next configuration line is a kind of trigger guard:
5531 It specifies that no delivery must ever be run as the root user. The normal
5532 convention is to set up &'root'& as an alias for the system administrator. This
5533 setting is a guard against slips in the configuration.
5534 The list of users specified by &%never_users%& is not, however, the complete
5535 list; the build-time configuration in &_Local/Makefile_& has an option called
5536 FIXED_NEVER_USERS specifying a list that cannot be overridden. The
5537 contents of &%never_users%& are added to this list. By default
5538 FIXED_NEVER_USERS also specifies root.
5540 When a remote host connects to Exim in order to send mail, the only information
5541 Exim has about the host's identity is its IP address. The next configuration
5546 specifies that Exim should do a reverse DNS lookup on all incoming connections,
5547 in order to get a host name. This improves the quality of the logging
5548 information, but if you feel it is too expensive, you can remove it entirely,
5549 or restrict the lookup to hosts on &"nearby"& networks.
5550 Note that it is not always possible to find a host name from an IP address,
5551 because not all DNS reverse zones are maintained, and sometimes DNS servers are
5554 The next two lines are concerned with &'ident'& callbacks, as defined by RFC
5555 1413 (hence their names):
5558 rfc1413_query_timeout = 5s
5560 These settings cause Exim to make ident callbacks for all incoming SMTP calls.
5561 You can limit the hosts to which these calls are made, or change the timeout
5562 that is used. If you set the timeout to zero, all ident calls are disabled.
5563 Although they are cheap and can provide useful information for tracing problem
5564 messages, some hosts and firewalls have problems with ident calls. This can
5565 result in a timeout instead of an immediate refused connection, leading to
5566 delays on starting up an incoming SMTP session.
5568 When Exim receives messages over SMTP connections, it expects all addresses to
5569 be fully qualified with a domain, as required by the SMTP definition. However,
5570 if you are running a server to which simple clients submit messages, you may
5571 find that they send unqualified addresses. The two commented-out options:
5573 # sender_unqualified_hosts =
5574 # recipient_unqualified_hosts =
5576 show how you can specify hosts that are permitted to send unqualified sender
5577 and recipient addresses, respectively.
5579 The &%percent_hack_domains%& option is also commented out:
5581 # percent_hack_domains =
5583 It provides a list of domains for which the &"percent hack"& is to operate.
5584 This is an almost obsolete form of explicit email routing. If you do not know
5585 anything about it, you can safely ignore this topic.
5587 The last two settings in the main part of the default configuration are
5588 concerned with messages that have been &"frozen"& on Exim's queue. When a
5589 message is frozen, Exim no longer continues to try to deliver it. Freezing
5590 occurs when a bounce message encounters a permanent failure because the sender
5591 address of the original message that caused the bounce is invalid, so the
5592 bounce cannot be delivered. This is probably the most common case, but there
5593 are also other conditions that cause freezing, and frozen messages are not
5594 always bounce messages.
5596 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 2d
5597 timeout_frozen_after = 7d
5599 The first of these options specifies that failing bounce messages are to be
5600 discarded after 2 days on the queue. The second specifies that any frozen
5601 message (whether a bounce message or not) is to be timed out (and discarded)
5602 after a week. In this configuration, the first setting ensures that no failing
5603 bounce message ever lasts a week.
5607 .section "ACL configuration" "SECID54"
5608 .cindex "default" "ACLs"
5609 .cindex "&ACL;" "default configuration"
5610 In the default configuration, the ACL section follows the main configuration.
5611 It starts with the line
5615 and it contains the definitions of two ACLs, called &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5616 &'acl_check_data'&, that were referenced in the settings of &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
5617 and &%acl_smtp_data%& above.
5619 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
5620 The first ACL is used for every RCPT command in an incoming SMTP message. Each
5621 RCPT command specifies one of the message's recipients. The ACL statements
5622 are considered in order, until the recipient address is either accepted or
5623 rejected. The RCPT command is then accepted or rejected, according to the
5624 result of the ACL processing.
5628 This line, consisting of a name terminated by a colon, marks the start of the
5633 This ACL statement accepts the recipient if the sending host matches the list.
5634 But what does that strange list mean? It doesn't actually contain any host
5635 names or IP addresses. The presence of the colon puts an empty item in the
5636 list; Exim matches this only if the incoming message did not come from a remote
5637 host, because in that case, the remote hostname is empty. The colon is
5638 important. Without it, the list itself is empty, and can never match anything.
5640 What this statement is doing is to accept unconditionally all recipients in
5641 messages that are submitted by SMTP from local processes using the standard
5642 input and output (that is, not using TCP/IP). A number of MUAs operate in this
5645 deny message = Restricted characters in address
5646 domains = +local_domains
5647 local_parts = ^[.] : ^.*[@%!/|]
5649 deny message = Restricted characters in address
5650 domains = !+local_domains
5651 local_parts = ^[./|] : ^.*[@%!] : ^.*/\\.\\./
5653 These statements are concerned with local parts that contain any of the
5654 characters &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&, &"|"&, or dots in unusual places.
5655 Although these characters are entirely legal in local parts (in the case of
5656 &"@"& and leading dots, only if correctly quoted), they do not commonly occur
5657 in Internet mail addresses.
5659 The first three have in the past been associated with explicitly routed
5660 addresses (percent is still sometimes used &-- see the &%percent_hack_domains%&
5661 option). Addresses containing these characters are regularly tried by spammers
5662 in an attempt to bypass relaying restrictions, and also by open relay testing
5663 programs. Unless you really need them it is safest to reject these characters
5664 at this early stage. This configuration is heavy-handed in rejecting these
5665 characters for all messages it accepts from remote hosts. This is a deliberate
5666 policy of being as safe as possible.
5668 The first rule above is stricter, and is applied to messages that are addressed
5669 to one of the local domains handled by this host. This is implemented by the
5670 first condition, which restricts it to domains that are listed in the
5671 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5672 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5673 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5675 The second condition on the first statement uses two regular expressions to
5676 block local parts that begin with a dot or contain &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&,
5677 or &"|"&. If you have local accounts that include these characters, you will
5678 have to modify this rule.
5680 Empty components (two dots in a row) are not valid in RFC 2822, but Exim
5681 allows them because they have been encountered in practice. (Consider the
5682 common convention of local parts constructed as
5683 &"&'first-initial.second-initial.family-name'&"& when applied to someone like
5684 the author of Exim, who has no second initial.) However, a local part starting
5685 with a dot or containing &"/../"& can cause trouble if it is used as part of a
5686 file name (for example, for a mailing list). This is also true for local parts
5687 that contain slashes. A pipe symbol can also be troublesome if the local part
5688 is incorporated unthinkingly into a shell command line.
5690 The second rule above applies to all other domains, and is less strict. This
5691 allows your own users to send outgoing messages to sites that use slashes
5692 and vertical bars in their local parts. It blocks local parts that begin
5693 with a dot, slash, or vertical bar, but allows these characters within the
5694 local part. However, the sequence &"/../"& is barred. The use of &"@"&, &"%"&,
5695 and &"!"& is blocked, as before. The motivation here is to prevent your users
5696 (or your users' viruses) from mounting certain kinds of attack on remote sites.
5698 accept local_parts = postmaster
5699 domains = +local_domains
5701 This statement, which has two conditions, accepts an incoming address if the
5702 local part is &'postmaster'& and the domain is one of those listed in the
5703 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5704 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5705 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5707 The presence of this statement means that mail to postmaster is never blocked
5708 by any of the subsequent tests. This can be helpful while sorting out problems
5709 in cases where the subsequent tests are incorrectly denying access.
5711 require verify = sender
5713 This statement requires the sender address to be verified before any subsequent
5714 ACL statement can be used. If verification fails, the incoming recipient
5715 address is refused. Verification consists of trying to route the address, to
5716 see if a bounce message could be delivered to it. In the case of remote
5717 addresses, basic verification checks only the domain, but &'callouts'& can be
5718 used for more verification if required. Section &<<SECTaddressverification>>&
5719 discusses the details of address verification.
5721 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
5722 control = submission
5724 This statement accepts the address if the message is coming from one of the
5725 hosts that are defined as being allowed to relay through this host. Recipient
5726 verification is omitted here, because in many cases the clients are dumb MUAs
5727 that do not cope well with SMTP error responses. For the same reason, the
5728 second line specifies &"submission mode"& for messages that are accepted. This
5729 is described in detail in section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>&; it causes Exim to fix
5730 messages that are deficient in some way, for example, because they lack a
5731 &'Date:'& header line. If you are actually relaying out from MTAs, you should
5732 probably add recipient verification here, and disable submission mode.
5734 accept authenticated = *
5735 control = submission
5737 This statement accepts the address if the client host has authenticated itself.
5738 Submission mode is again specified, on the grounds that such messages are most
5739 likely to come from MUAs. The default configuration does not define any
5740 authenticators, though it does include some nearly complete commented-out
5741 examples described in &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&. This means that no client can in
5742 fact authenticate until you complete the authenticator definitions.
5744 require message = relay not permitted
5745 domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
5747 This statement rejects the address if its domain is neither a local domain nor
5748 one of the domains for which this host is a relay.
5750 require verify = recipient
5752 This statement requires the recipient address to be verified; if verification
5753 fails, the address is rejected.
5755 # deny message = rejected because $sender_host_address \
5756 # is in a black list at $dnslist_domain\n\
5758 # dnslists = black.list.example
5760 # warn dnslists = black.list.example
5761 # add_header = X-Warning: $sender_host_address is in \
5762 # a black list at $dnslist_domain
5763 # log_message = found in $dnslist_domain
5765 These commented-out lines are examples of how you could configure Exim to check
5766 sending hosts against a DNS black list. The first statement rejects messages
5767 from blacklisted hosts, whereas the second just inserts a warning header
5770 # require verify = csa
5772 This commented-out line is an example of how you could turn on client SMTP
5773 authorization (CSA) checking. Such checks do DNS lookups for special SRV
5778 The final statement in the first ACL unconditionally accepts any recipient
5779 address that has successfully passed all the previous tests.
5783 This line marks the start of the second ACL, and names it. Most of the contents
5784 of this ACL are commented out:
5787 # message = This message contains a virus \
5790 These lines are examples of how to arrange for messages to be scanned for
5791 viruses when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension, and a
5792 suitable virus scanner is installed. If the message is found to contain a
5793 virus, it is rejected with the given custom error message.
5795 # warn spam = nobody
5796 # message = X-Spam_score: $spam_score\n\
5797 # X-Spam_score_int: $spam_score_int\n\
5798 # X-Spam_bar: $spam_bar\n\
5799 # X-Spam_report: $spam_report
5801 These lines are an example of how to arrange for messages to be scanned by
5802 SpamAssassin when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension,
5803 and SpamAssassin has been installed. The SpamAssassin check is run with
5804 &`nobody`& as its user parameter, and the results are added to the message as a
5805 series of extra header line. In this case, the message is not rejected,
5806 whatever the spam score.
5810 This final line in the DATA ACL accepts the message unconditionally.
5813 .section "Router configuration" "SECID55"
5814 .cindex "default" "routers"
5815 .cindex "routers" "default"
5816 The router configuration comes next in the default configuration, introduced
5821 Routers are the modules in Exim that make decisions about where to send
5822 messages. An address is passed to each router in turn, until it is either
5823 accepted, or failed. This means that the order in which you define the routers
5824 matters. Each router is fully described in its own chapter later in this
5825 manual. Here we give only brief overviews.
5828 # driver = ipliteral
5829 # domains = !+local_domains
5830 # transport = remote_smtp
5832 .cindex "domain literal" "default router"
5833 This router is commented out because the majority of sites do not want to
5834 support domain literal addresses (those of the form &'user@[10.9.8.7]'&). If
5835 you uncomment this router, you also need to uncomment the setting of
5836 &%allow_domain_literals%& in the main part of the configuration.
5840 domains = ! +local_domains
5841 transport = remote_smtp
5842 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.0/8
5845 The first uncommented router handles addresses that do not involve any local
5846 domains. This is specified by the line
5848 domains = ! +local_domains
5850 The &%domains%& option lists the domains to which this router applies, but the
5851 exclamation mark is a negation sign, so the router is used only for domains
5852 that are not in the domain list called &'local_domains'& (which was defined at
5853 the start of the configuration). The plus sign before &'local_domains'&
5854 indicates that it is referring to a named list. Addresses in other domains are
5855 passed on to the following routers.
5857 The name of the router driver is &(dnslookup)&,
5858 and is specified by the &%driver%& option. Do not be confused by the fact that
5859 the name of this router instance is the same as the name of the driver. The
5860 instance name is arbitrary, but the name set in the &%driver%& option must be
5861 one of the driver modules that is in the Exim binary.
5863 The &(dnslookup)& router routes addresses by looking up their domains in the
5864 DNS in order to obtain a list of hosts to which the address is routed. If the
5865 router succeeds, the address is queued for the &(remote_smtp)& transport, as
5866 specified by the &%transport%& option. If the router does not find the domain
5867 in the DNS, no further routers are tried because of the &%no_more%& setting, so
5868 the address fails and is bounced.
5870 The &%ignore_target_hosts%& option specifies a list of IP addresses that are to
5871 be entirely ignored. This option is present because a number of cases have been
5872 encountered where MX records in the DNS point to host names
5873 whose IP addresses are 0.0.0.0 or are in the 127 subnet (typically 127.0.0.1).
5874 Completely ignoring these IP addresses causes Exim to fail to route the
5875 email address, so it bounces. Otherwise, Exim would log a routing problem, and
5876 continue to try to deliver the message periodically until the address timed
5883 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
5885 file_transport = address_file
5886 pipe_transport = address_pipe
5888 Control reaches this and subsequent routers only for addresses in the local
5889 domains. This router checks to see whether the local part is defined as an
5890 alias in the &_/etc/aliases_& file, and if so, redirects it according to the
5891 data that it looks up from that file. If no data is found for the local part,
5892 the value of the &%data%& option is empty, causing the address to be passed to
5895 &_/etc/aliases_& is a conventional name for the system aliases file that is
5896 often used. That is why it is referenced by from the default configuration
5897 file. However, you can change this by setting SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in
5898 &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim.
5903 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
5904 # local_part_suffix_optional
5905 file = $home/.forward
5910 file_transport = address_file
5911 pipe_transport = address_pipe
5912 reply_transport = address_reply
5914 This is the most complicated router in the default configuration. It is another
5915 redirection router, but this time it is looking for forwarding data set up by
5916 individual users. The &%check_local_user%& setting specifies a check that the
5917 local part of the address is the login name of a local user. If it is not, the
5918 router is skipped. The two commented options that follow &%check_local_user%&,
5921 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
5922 # local_part_suffix_optional
5924 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
5925 show how you can specify the recognition of local part suffixes. If the first
5926 is uncommented, a suffix beginning with either a plus or a minus sign, followed
5927 by any sequence of characters, is removed from the local part and placed in the
5928 variable &$local_part_suffix$&. The second suffix option specifies that the
5929 presence of a suffix in the local part is optional. When a suffix is present,
5930 the check for a local login uses the local part with the suffix removed.
5932 When a local user account is found, the file called &_.forward_& in the user's
5933 home directory is consulted. If it does not exist, or is empty, the router
5934 declines. Otherwise, the contents of &_.forward_& are interpreted as
5935 redirection data (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& for more details).
5937 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling in default router"
5938 Traditional &_.forward_& files contain just a list of addresses, pipes, or
5939 files. Exim supports this by default. However, if &%allow_filter%& is set (it
5940 is commented out by default), the contents of the file are interpreted as a set
5941 of Exim or Sieve filtering instructions, provided the file begins with &"#Exim
5942 filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, respectively. User filtering is discussed in the
5943 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
5945 The &%no_verify%& and &%no_expn%& options mean that this router is skipped when
5946 verifying addresses, or when running as a consequence of an SMTP EXPN command.
5947 There are two reasons for doing this:
5950 Whether or not a local user has a &_.forward_& file is not really relevant when
5951 checking an address for validity; it makes sense not to waste resources doing
5954 More importantly, when Exim is verifying addresses or handling an EXPN
5955 command during an SMTP session, it is running as the Exim user, not as root.
5956 The group is the Exim group, and no additional groups are set up.
5957 It may therefore not be possible for Exim to read users' &_.forward_& files at
5961 The setting of &%check_ancestor%& prevents the router from generating a new
5962 address that is the same as any previous address that was redirected. (This
5963 works round a problem concerning a bad interaction between aliasing and
5964 forwarding &-- see section &<<SECTredlocmai>>&).
5966 The final three option settings specify the transports that are to be used when
5967 forwarding generates a direct delivery to a file, or to a pipe, or sets up an
5968 auto-reply, respectively. For example, if a &_.forward_& file contains
5970 a.nother@elsewhere.example, /home/spqr/archive
5972 the delivery to &_/home/spqr/archive_& is done by running the &%address_file%&
5978 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
5979 # local_part_suffix_optional
5980 transport = local_delivery
5982 The final router sets up delivery into local mailboxes, provided that the local
5983 part is the name of a local login, by accepting the address and assigning it to
5984 the &(local_delivery)& transport. Otherwise, we have reached the end of the
5985 routers, so the address is bounced. The commented suffix settings fulfil the
5986 same purpose as they do for the &(userforward)& router.
5989 .section "Transport configuration" "SECID56"
5990 .cindex "default" "transports"
5991 .cindex "transports" "default"
5992 Transports define mechanisms for actually delivering messages. They operate
5993 only when referenced from routers, so the order in which they are defined does
5994 not matter. The transports section of the configuration starts with
5998 One remote transport and four local transports are defined.
6003 This transport is used for delivering messages over SMTP connections. All its
6004 options are defaulted. The list of remote hosts comes from the router.
6008 file = /var/mail/$local_part
6015 This &(appendfile)& transport is used for local delivery to user mailboxes in
6016 traditional BSD mailbox format. By default it runs under the uid and gid of the
6017 local user, which requires the sticky bit to be set on the &_/var/mail_&
6018 directory. Some systems use the alternative approach of running mail deliveries
6019 under a particular group instead of using the sticky bit. The commented options
6020 show how this can be done.
6022 Exim adds three headers to the message as it delivers it: &'Delivery-date:'&,
6023 &'Envelope-to:'& and &'Return-path:'&. This action is requested by the three
6024 similarly-named options above.
6030 This transport is used for handling deliveries to pipes that are generated by
6031 redirection (aliasing or users' &_.forward_& files). The &%return_output%&
6032 option specifies that any output generated by the pipe is to be returned to the
6041 This transport is used for handling deliveries to files that are generated by
6042 redirection. The name of the file is not specified in this instance of
6043 &(appendfile)&, because it comes from the &(redirect)& router.
6048 This transport is used for handling automatic replies generated by users'
6053 .section "Default retry rule" "SECID57"
6054 .cindex "retry" "default rule"
6055 .cindex "default" "retry rule"
6056 The retry section of the configuration file contains rules which affect the way
6057 Exim retries deliveries that cannot be completed at the first attempt. It is
6058 introduced by the line
6062 In the default configuration, there is just one rule, which applies to all
6065 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
6067 This causes any temporarily failing address to be retried every 15 minutes for
6068 2 hours, then at intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
6069 1.5 until 16 hours have passed, then every 6 hours up to 4 days. If an address
6070 is not delivered after 4 days of temporary failure, it is bounced.
6072 If the retry section is removed from the configuration, or is empty (that is,
6073 if no retry rules are defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. This turns
6074 temporary errors into permanent errors.
6077 .section "Rewriting configuration" "SECID58"
6078 The rewriting section of the configuration, introduced by
6082 contains rules for rewriting addresses in messages as they arrive. There are no
6083 rewriting rules in the default configuration file.
6087 .section "Authenticators configuration" "SECTdefconfauth"
6088 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
6089 The authenticators section of the configuration, introduced by
6091 begin authenticators
6093 defines mechanisms for the use of the SMTP AUTH command. The default
6094 configuration file contains two commented-out example authenticators
6095 which support plaintext username/password authentication using the
6096 standard PLAIN mechanism and the traditional but non-standard LOGIN
6097 mechanism, with Exim acting as the server. PLAIN and LOGIN are enough
6098 to support most MUA software.
6100 The example PLAIN authenticator looks like this:
6103 # driver = plaintext
6104 # server_set_id = $auth2
6105 # server_prompts = :
6106 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6107 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6109 And the example LOGIN authenticator looks like this:
6112 # driver = plaintext
6113 # server_set_id = $auth1
6114 # server_prompts = <| Username: | Password:
6115 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6116 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6119 The &%server_set_id%& option makes Exim remember the authenticated username
6120 in &$authenticated_id$&, which can be used later in ACLs or routers. The
6121 &%server_prompts%& option configures the &(plaintext)& authenticator so
6122 that it implements the details of the specific authentication mechanism,
6123 i.e. PLAIN or LOGIN. The &%server_advertise_condition%& setting controls
6124 when Exim offers authentication to clients; in the examples, this is only
6125 when TLS or SSL has been started, so to enable the authenticators you also
6126 need to add support for TLS as described in section &<<SECTdefconfmain>>&.
6128 The &%server_condition%& setting defines how to verify that the username and
6129 password are correct. In the examples it just produces an error message.
6130 To make the authenticators work, you can use a string expansion
6131 expression like one of the examples in chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>&.
6133 Beware that the sequence of the parameters to PLAIN and LOGIN differ; the
6134 usercode and password are in different positions.
6135 Chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& covers both.
6137 .ecindex IIDconfiwal
6141 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6142 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6144 .chapter "Regular expressions" "CHAPregexp"
6146 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
6148 Exim supports the use of regular expressions in many of its options. It
6149 uses the PCRE regular expression library; this provides regular expression
6150 matching that is compatible with Perl 5. The syntax and semantics of
6151 regular expressions is discussed in many Perl reference books, and also in
6152 Jeffrey Friedl's &'Mastering Regular Expressions'&, which is published by
6153 O'Reilly (see &url(http://www.oreilly.com/catalog/regex2/)).
6155 The documentation for the syntax and semantics of the regular expressions that
6156 are supported by PCRE is included in the PCRE distribution, and no further
6157 description is included here. The PCRE functions are called from Exim using
6158 the default option settings (that is, with no PCRE options set), except that
6159 the PCRE_CASELESS option is set when the matching is required to be
6162 In most cases, when a regular expression is required in an Exim configuration,
6163 it has to start with a circumflex, in order to distinguish it from plain text
6164 or an &"ends with"& wildcard. In this example of a configuration setting, the
6165 second item in the colon-separated list is a regular expression.
6167 domains = a.b.c : ^\\d{3} : *.y.z : ...
6169 The doubling of the backslash is required because of string expansion that
6170 precedes interpretation &-- see section &<<SECTlittext>>& for more discussion
6171 of this issue, and a way of avoiding the need for doubling backslashes. The
6172 regular expression that is eventually used in this example contains just one
6173 backslash. The circumflex is included in the regular expression, and has the
6174 normal effect of &"anchoring"& it to the start of the string that is being
6177 There are, however, two cases where a circumflex is not required for the
6178 recognition of a regular expression: these are the &%match%& condition in a
6179 string expansion, and the &%matches%& condition in an Exim filter file. In
6180 these cases, the relevant string is always treated as a regular expression; if
6181 it does not start with a circumflex, the expression is not anchored, and can
6182 match anywhere in the subject string.
6184 In all cases, if you want a regular expression to match at the end of a string,
6185 you must code the $ metacharacter to indicate this. For example:
6187 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example
6189 matches the domain &'123.example'&, but it also matches &'123.example.com'&.
6192 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example\$
6194 if you want &'example'& to be the top-level domain. The backslash before the
6195 $ is needed because string expansion also interprets dollar characters.
6199 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6200 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6202 .chapter "File and database lookups" "CHAPfdlookup"
6203 .scindex IIDfidalo1 "file" "lookups"
6204 .scindex IIDfidalo2 "database" "lookups"
6205 .cindex "lookup" "description of"
6206 Exim can be configured to look up data in files or databases as it processes
6207 messages. Two different kinds of syntax are used:
6210 A string that is to be expanded may contain explicit lookup requests. These
6211 cause parts of the string to be replaced by data that is obtained from the
6212 lookup. Lookups of this type are conditional expansion items. Different results
6213 can be defined for the cases of lookup success and failure. See chapter
6214 &<<CHAPexpand>>&, where string expansions are described in detail.
6216 Lists of domains, hosts, and email addresses can contain lookup requests as a
6217 way of avoiding excessively long linear lists. In this case, the data that is
6218 returned by the lookup is often (but not always) discarded; whether the lookup
6219 succeeds or fails is what really counts. These kinds of list are described in
6220 chapter &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
6223 String expansions, lists, and lookups interact with each other in such a way
6224 that there is no order in which to describe any one of them that does not
6225 involve references to the others. Each of these three chapters makes more sense
6226 if you have read the other two first. If you are reading this for the first
6227 time, be aware that some of it will make a lot more sense after you have read
6228 chapters &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>& and &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
6230 .section "Examples of different lookup syntax" "SECID60"
6231 It is easy to confuse the two different kinds of lookup, especially as the
6232 lists that may contain the second kind are always expanded before being
6233 processed as lists. Therefore, they may also contain lookups of the first kind.
6234 Be careful to distinguish between the following two examples:
6236 domains = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch{/some/file}}
6237 domains = lsearch;/some/file
6239 The first uses a string expansion, the result of which must be a domain list.
6240 No strings have been specified for a successful or a failing lookup; the
6241 defaults in this case are the looked-up data and an empty string, respectively.
6242 The expansion takes place before the string is processed as a list, and the
6243 file that is searched could contain lines like this:
6245 192.168.3.4: domain1:domain2:...
6246 192.168.1.9: domain3:domain4:...
6248 When the lookup succeeds, the result of the expansion is a list of domains (and
6249 possibly other types of item that are allowed in domain lists).
6251 In the second example, the lookup is a single item in a domain list. It causes
6252 Exim to use a lookup to see if the domain that is being processed can be found
6253 in the file. The file could contains lines like this:
6258 Any data that follows the keys is not relevant when checking that the domain
6259 matches the list item.
6261 It is possible, though no doubt confusing, to use both kinds of lookup at once.
6262 Consider a file containing lines like this:
6264 192.168.5.6: lsearch;/another/file
6266 If the value of &$sender_host_address$& is 192.168.5.6, expansion of the
6267 first &%domains%& setting above generates the second setting, which therefore
6268 causes a second lookup to occur.
6270 The rest of this chapter describes the different lookup types that are
6271 available. Any of them can be used in any part of the configuration where a
6272 lookup is permitted.
6275 .section "Lookup types" "SECID61"
6276 .cindex "lookup" "types of"
6277 .cindex "single-key lookup" "definition of"
6278 Two different types of data lookup are implemented:
6281 The &'single-key'& type requires the specification of a file in which to look,
6282 and a single key to search for. The key must be a non-empty string for the
6283 lookup to succeed. The lookup type determines how the file is searched.
6285 .cindex "query-style lookup" "definition of"
6286 The &'query-style'& type accepts a generalized database query. No particular
6287 key value is assumed by Exim for query-style lookups. You can use whichever
6288 Exim variables you need to construct the database query.
6291 The code for each lookup type is in a separate source file that is included in
6292 the binary of Exim only if the corresponding compile-time option is set. The
6293 default settings in &_src/EDITME_& are:
6298 which means that only linear searching and DBM lookups are included by default.
6299 For some types of lookup (e.g. SQL databases), you need to install appropriate
6300 libraries and header files before building Exim.
6305 .section "Single-key lookup types" "SECTsinglekeylookups"
6306 .cindex "lookup" "single-key types"
6307 .cindex "single-key lookup" "list of types"
6308 The following single-key lookup types are implemented:
6311 .cindex "cdb" "description of"
6312 .cindex "lookup" "cdb"
6313 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6314 &(cdb)&: The given file is searched as a Constant DataBase file, using the key
6315 string without a terminating binary zero. The cdb format is designed for
6316 indexed files that are read frequently and never updated, except by total
6317 re-creation. As such, it is particularly suitable for large files containing
6318 aliases or other indexed data referenced by an MTA. Information about cdb can
6319 be found in several places:
6321 &url(http://www.pobox.com/~djb/cdb.html)
6322 &url(ftp://ftp.corpit.ru/pub/tinycdb/)
6323 &url(http://packages.debian.org/stable/utils/freecdb.html)
6325 A cdb distribution is not needed in order to build Exim with cdb support,
6326 because the code for reading cdb files is included directly in Exim itself.
6327 However, no means of building or testing cdb files is provided with Exim, so
6328 you need to obtain a cdb distribution in order to do this.
6330 .cindex "DBM" "lookup type"
6331 .cindex "lookup" "dbm"
6332 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6333 &(dbm)&: Calls to DBM library functions are used to extract data from the given
6334 DBM file by looking up the record with the given key. A terminating binary
6335 zero is included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. See section
6336 &<<SECTdb>>& for a discussion of DBM libraries.
6338 .cindex "Berkeley DB library" "file format"
6339 For all versions of Berkeley DB, Exim uses the DB_HASH style of database
6340 when building DBM files using the &%exim_dbmbuild%& utility. However, when
6341 using Berkeley DB versions 3 or 4, it opens existing databases for reading with
6342 the DB_UNKNOWN option. This enables it to handle any of the types of database
6343 that the library supports, and can be useful for accessing DBM files created by
6344 other applications. (For earlier DB versions, DB_HASH is always used.)
6346 .cindex "lookup" "dbmjz"
6347 .cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- embedded NULs"
6349 .cindex "dbmjz lookup type"
6350 &(dbmjz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that the lookup key is
6351 interpreted as an Exim list; the elements of the list are joined together with
6352 ASCII NUL characters to form the lookup key. An example usage would be to
6353 authenticate incoming SMTP calls using the passwords from Cyrus SASL's
6354 &_/etc/sasldb2_& file with the &(gsasl)& authenticator or Exim's own
6355 &(cram_md5)& authenticator.
6357 .cindex "lookup" "dbmnz"
6358 .cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- terminating zero"
6359 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6361 .cindex "&_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_&"
6362 .cindex "dbmnz lookup type"
6363 &(dbmnz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that a terminating binary zero
6364 is not included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. You may need this
6365 if you want to look up data in files that are created by or shared with some
6366 other application that does not use terminating zeros. For example, you need to
6367 use &(dbmnz)& rather than &(dbm)& if you want to authenticate incoming SMTP
6368 calls using the passwords from Courier's &_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_& file. Exim's
6369 utility program for creating DBM files (&'exim_dbmbuild'&) includes the zeros
6370 by default, but has an option to omit them (see section &<<SECTdbmbuild>>&).
6372 .cindex "lookup" "dsearch"
6373 .cindex "dsearch lookup type"
6374 &(dsearch)&: The given file must be a directory; this is searched for an entry
6375 whose name is the key by calling the &[lstat()]& function. The key may not
6376 contain any forward slash characters. If &[lstat()]& succeeds, the result of
6377 the lookup is the name of the entry, which may be a file, directory,
6378 symbolic link, or any other kind of directory entry. An example of how this
6379 lookup can be used to support virtual domains is given in section
6380 &<<SECTvirtualdomains>>&.
6382 .cindex "lookup" "iplsearch"
6383 .cindex "iplsearch lookup type"
6384 &(iplsearch)&: The given file is a text file containing keys and data. A key is
6385 terminated by a colon or white space or the end of the line. The keys in the
6386 file must be IP addresses, or IP addresses with CIDR masks. Keys that involve
6387 IPv6 addresses must be enclosed in quotes to prevent the first internal colon
6388 being interpreted as a key terminator. For example:
6390 1.2.3.4: data for 1.2.3.4
6391 192.168.0.0/16: data for 192.168.0.0/16
6392 "abcd::cdab": data for abcd::cdab
6393 "abcd:abcd::/32" data for abcd:abcd::/32
6395 The key for an &(iplsearch)& lookup must be an IP address (without a mask). The
6396 file is searched linearly, using the CIDR masks where present, until a matching
6397 key is found. The first key that matches is used; there is no attempt to find a
6398 &"best"& match. Apart from the way the keys are matched, the processing for
6399 &(iplsearch)& is the same as for &(lsearch)&.
6401 &*Warning 1*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6402 &(iplsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6403 lookup types support only literal keys.
6405 &*Warning 2*&: In a host list, you must always use &(net-iplsearch)& so that
6406 the implicit key is the host's IP address rather than its name (see section
6407 &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&).
6409 .cindex "linear search"
6410 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch"
6411 .cindex "lsearch lookup type"
6412 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in lsearch lookup"
6413 &(lsearch)&: The given file is a text file that is searched linearly for a
6414 line beginning with the search key, terminated by a colon or white space or the
6415 end of the line. The search is case-insensitive; that is, upper and lower case
6416 letters are treated as the same. The first occurrence of the key that is found
6417 in the file is used.
6419 White space between the key and the colon is permitted. The remainder of the
6420 line, with leading and trailing white space removed, is the data. This can be
6421 continued onto subsequent lines by starting them with any amount of white
6422 space, but only a single space character is included in the data at such a
6423 junction. If the data begins with a colon, the key must be terminated by a
6428 Empty lines and lines beginning with # are ignored, even if they occur in the
6429 middle of an item. This is the traditional textual format of alias files. Note
6430 that the keys in an &(lsearch)& file are literal strings. There is no
6431 wildcarding of any kind.
6433 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch &-- colons in keys"
6434 .cindex "white space" "in lsearch key"
6435 In most &(lsearch)& files, keys are not required to contain colons or #
6436 characters, or white space. However, if you need this feature, it is available.
6437 If a key begins with a doublequote character, it is terminated only by a
6438 matching quote (or end of line), and the normal escaping rules apply to its
6439 contents (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&). An optional colon is permitted after
6440 quoted keys (exactly as for unquoted keys). There is no special handling of
6441 quotes for the data part of an &(lsearch)& line.
6444 .cindex "NIS lookup type"
6445 .cindex "lookup" "NIS"
6446 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6447 &(nis)&: The given file is the name of a NIS map, and a NIS lookup is done with
6448 the given key, without a terminating binary zero. There is a variant called
6449 &(nis0)& which does include the terminating binary zero in the key. This is
6450 reportedly needed for Sun-style alias files. Exim does not recognize NIS
6451 aliases; the full map names must be used.
6454 .cindex "wildlsearch lookup type"
6455 .cindex "lookup" "wildlsearch"
6456 .cindex "nwildlsearch lookup type"
6457 .cindex "lookup" "nwildlsearch"
6458 &(wildlsearch)& or &(nwildlsearch)&: These search a file linearly, like
6459 &(lsearch)&, but instead of being interpreted as a literal string, each key in
6460 the file may be wildcarded. The difference between these two lookup types is
6461 that for &(wildlsearch)&, each key in the file is string-expanded before being
6462 used, whereas for &(nwildlsearch)&, no expansion takes place.
6464 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in (n)wildlsearch lookup"
6465 Like &(lsearch)&, the testing is done case-insensitively. However, keys in the
6466 file that are regular expressions can be made case-sensitive by the use of
6467 &`(-i)`& within the pattern. The following forms of wildcard are recognized:
6469 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
6470 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
6473 The string may begin with an asterisk to mean &"ends with"&. For example:
6475 *.a.b.c data for anything.a.b.c
6476 *fish data for anythingfish
6479 The string may begin with a circumflex to indicate a regular expression. For
6480 example, for &(wildlsearch)&:
6482 ^\N\d+\.a\.b\N data for <digits>.a.b
6484 Note the use of &`\N`& to disable expansion of the contents of the regular
6485 expression. If you are using &(nwildlsearch)&, where the keys are not
6486 string-expanded, the equivalent entry is:
6488 ^\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6490 The case-insensitive flag is set at the start of compiling the regular
6491 expression, but it can be turned off by using &`(-i)`& at an appropriate point.
6492 For example, to make the entire pattern case-sensitive:
6494 ^(?-i)\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6497 If the regular expression contains white space or colon characters, you must
6498 either quote it (see &(lsearch)& above), or represent these characters in other
6499 ways. For example, &`\s`& can be used for white space and &`\x3A`& for a
6500 colon. This may be easier than quoting, because if you quote, you have to
6501 escape all the backslashes inside the quotes.
6503 &*Note*&: It is not possible to capture substrings in a regular expression
6504 match for later use, because the results of all lookups are cached. If a lookup
6505 is repeated, the result is taken from the cache, and no actual pattern matching
6506 takes place. The values of all the numeric variables are unset after a
6507 &((n)wildlsearch)& match.
6510 Although I cannot see it being of much use, the general matching function that
6511 is used to implement &((n)wildlsearch)& means that the string may begin with a
6512 lookup name terminated by a semicolon, and followed by lookup data. For
6515 cdb;/some/file data for keys that match the file
6517 The data that is obtained from the nested lookup is discarded.
6520 Keys that do not match any of these patterns are interpreted literally. The
6521 continuation rules for the data are the same as for &(lsearch)&, and keys may
6522 be followed by optional colons.
6524 &*Warning*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6525 &((n)wildlsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6526 lookup types support only literal keys.
6530 .section "Query-style lookup types" "SECID62"
6531 .cindex "lookup" "query-style types"
6532 .cindex "query-style lookup" "list of types"
6533 The supported query-style lookup types are listed below. Further details about
6534 many of them are given in later sections.
6537 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
6538 .cindex "lookup" "DNS"
6539 &(dnsdb)&: This does a DNS search for one or more records whose domain names
6540 are given in the supplied query. The resulting data is the contents of the
6541 records. See section &<<SECTdnsdb>>&.
6543 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
6544 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
6545 &(ibase)&: This does a lookup in an InterBase database.
6547 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup type"
6548 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
6549 &(ldap)&: This does an LDAP lookup using a query in the form of a URL, and
6550 returns attributes from a single entry. There is a variant called &(ldapm)&
6551 that permits values from multiple entries to be returned. A third variant
6552 called &(ldapdn)& returns the Distinguished Name of a single entry instead of
6553 any attribute values. See section &<<SECTldap>>&.
6555 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
6556 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
6557 &(mysql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6558 MySQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6560 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
6561 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
6562 &(nisplus)&: This does a NIS+ lookup using a query that can specify the name of
6563 the field to be returned. See section &<<SECTnisplus>>&.
6565 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
6566 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
6567 &(oracle)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to an
6568 Oracle database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6570 .cindex "lookup" "passwd"
6571 .cindex "passwd lookup type"
6572 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
6573 &(passwd)& is a query-style lookup with queries that are just user names. The
6574 lookup calls &[getpwnam()]& to interrogate the system password data, and on
6575 success, the result string is the same as you would get from an &(lsearch)&
6576 lookup on a traditional &_/etc/passwd file_&, though with &`*`& for the
6577 password value. For example:
6579 *:42:42:King Rat:/home/kr:/bin/bash
6582 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
6583 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
6584 &(pgsql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6585 PostgreSQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6588 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
6589 .cindex "lookup" "sqlite"
6590 &(sqlite)&: The format of the query is a file name followed by an SQL statement
6591 that is passed to an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>&.
6594 &(testdb)&: This is a lookup type that is used for testing Exim. It is
6595 not likely to be useful in normal operation.
6597 .cindex "whoson lookup type"
6598 .cindex "lookup" "whoson"
6599 &(whoson)&: &'Whoson'& (&url(http://whoson.sourceforge.net)) is a protocol that
6600 allows a server to check whether a particular (dynamically allocated) IP
6601 address is currently allocated to a known (trusted) user and, optionally, to
6602 obtain the identity of the said user. For SMTP servers, &'Whoson'& was popular
6603 at one time for &"POP before SMTP"& authentication, but that approach has been
6604 superseded by SMTP authentication. In Exim, &'Whoson'& can be used to implement
6605 &"POP before SMTP"& checking using ACL statements such as
6607 require condition = \
6608 ${lookup whoson {$sender_host_address}{yes}{no}}
6610 The query consists of a single IP address. The value returned is the name of
6611 the authenticated user, which is stored in the variable &$value$&. However, in
6612 this example, the data in &$value$& is not used; the result of the lookup is
6613 one of the fixed strings &"yes"& or &"no"&.
6618 .section "Temporary errors in lookups" "SECID63"
6619 .cindex "lookup" "temporary error in"
6620 Lookup functions can return temporary error codes if the lookup cannot be
6621 completed. For example, an SQL or LDAP database might be unavailable. For this
6622 reason, it is not advisable to use a lookup that might do this for critical
6623 options such as a list of local domains.
6625 When a lookup cannot be completed in a router or transport, delivery
6626 of the message (to the relevant address) is deferred, as for any other
6627 temporary error. In other circumstances Exim may assume the lookup has failed,
6628 or may give up altogether.
6632 .section "Default values in single-key lookups" "SECTdefaultvaluelookups"
6633 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
6634 .cindex "lookup" "default values"
6635 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
6636 .cindex "lookup" "* added to type"
6637 .cindex "default" "in single-key lookups"
6638 In this context, a &"default value"& is a value specified by the administrator
6639 that is to be used if a lookup fails.
6641 &*Note:*& This section applies only to single-key lookups. For query-style
6642 lookups, the facilities of the query language must be used. An attempt to
6643 specify a default for a query-style lookup provokes an error.
6645 If &"*"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example, &%lsearch*%&)
6646 and the initial lookup fails, the key &"*"& is looked up in the file to
6647 provide a default value. See also the section on partial matching below.
6649 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
6650 .cindex "lookup" "*@ added to type"
6651 .cindex "alias file" "per-domain default"
6652 Alternatively, if &"*@"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example
6653 &%dbm*@%&) then, if the initial lookup fails and the key contains an @
6654 character, a second lookup is done with everything before the last @ replaced
6655 by *. This makes it possible to provide per-domain defaults in alias files
6656 that include the domains in the keys. If the second lookup fails (or doesn't
6657 take place because there is no @ in the key), &"*"& is looked up.
6658 For example, a &(redirect)& router might contain:
6660 data = ${lookup{$local_part@$domain}lsearch*@{/etc/mix-aliases}}
6662 Suppose the address that is being processed is &'jane@eyre.example'&. Exim
6663 looks up these keys, in this order:
6669 The data is taken from whichever key it finds first. &*Note*&: In an
6670 &(lsearch)& file, this does not mean the first of these keys in the file. A
6671 complete scan is done for each key, and only if it is not found at all does
6672 Exim move on to try the next key.
6676 .section "Partial matching in single-key lookups" "SECTpartiallookup"
6677 .cindex "partial matching"
6678 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
6679 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching"
6680 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
6681 .cindex "asterisk" "in search type"
6682 The normal operation of a single-key lookup is to search the file for an exact
6683 match with the given key. However, in a number of situations where domains are
6684 being looked up, it is useful to be able to do partial matching. In this case,
6685 information in the file that has a key starting with &"*."& is matched by any
6686 domain that ends with the components that follow the full stop. For example, if
6687 a key in a DBM file is
6689 *.dates.fict.example
6691 then when partial matching is enabled this is matched by (amongst others)
6692 &'2001.dates.fict.example'& and &'1984.dates.fict.example'&. It is also matched
6693 by &'dates.fict.example'&, if that does not appear as a separate key in the
6696 &*Note*&: Partial matching is not available for query-style lookups. It is
6697 also not available for any lookup items in address lists (see section
6698 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&).
6700 Partial matching is implemented by doing a series of separate lookups using
6701 keys constructed by modifying the original subject key. This means that it can
6702 be used with any of the single-key lookup types, provided that
6703 partial matching keys
6704 beginning with a special prefix (default &"*."&) are included in the data file.
6705 Keys in the file that do not begin with the prefix are matched only by
6706 unmodified subject keys when partial matching is in use.
6708 Partial matching is requested by adding the string &"partial-"& to the front of
6709 the name of a single-key lookup type, for example, &%partial-dbm%&. When this
6710 is done, the subject key is first looked up unmodified; if that fails, &"*."&
6711 is added at the start of the subject key, and it is looked up again. If that
6712 fails, further lookups are tried with dot-separated components removed from the
6713 start of the subject key, one-by-one, and &"*."& added on the front of what
6716 A minimum number of two non-* components are required. This can be adjusted
6717 by including a number before the hyphen in the search type. For example,
6718 &%partial3-lsearch%& specifies a minimum of three non-* components in the
6719 modified keys. Omitting the number is equivalent to &"partial2-"&. If the
6720 subject key is &'2250.dates.fict.example'& then the following keys are looked
6721 up when the minimum number of non-* components is two:
6723 2250.dates.fict.example
6724 *.2250.dates.fict.example
6725 *.dates.fict.example
6728 As soon as one key in the sequence is successfully looked up, the lookup
6731 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching &-- changing prefix"
6732 .cindex "prefix" "for partial matching"
6733 The use of &"*."& as the partial matching prefix is a default that can be
6734 changed. The motivation for this feature is to allow Exim to operate with file
6735 formats that are used by other MTAs. A different prefix can be supplied in
6736 parentheses instead of the hyphen after &"partial"&. For example:
6738 domains = partial(.)lsearch;/some/file
6740 In this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
6741 &`a.b.c`&, &`.a.b.c`&, and &`.b.c`& (the default minimum of 2 non-wild
6742 components is unchanged). The prefix may consist of any punctuation characters
6743 other than a closing parenthesis. It may be empty, for example:
6745 domains = partial1()cdb;/some/file
6747 For this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
6748 &`a.b.c`&, &`b.c`&, and &`c`&.
6750 If &"partial0"& is specified, what happens at the end (when the lookup with
6751 just one non-wild component has failed, and the original key is shortened right
6752 down to the null string) depends on the prefix:
6755 If the prefix has zero length, the whole lookup fails.
6757 If the prefix has length 1, a lookup for just the prefix is done. For
6758 example, the final lookup for &"partial0(.)"& is for &`.`& alone.
6760 Otherwise, if the prefix ends in a dot, the dot is removed, and the
6761 remainder is looked up. With the default prefix, therefore, the final lookup is
6762 for &"*"& on its own.
6764 Otherwise, the whole prefix is looked up.
6768 If the search type ends in &"*"& or &"*@"& (see section
6769 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& above), the search for an ultimate default that
6770 this implies happens after all partial lookups have failed. If &"partial0"& is
6771 specified, adding &"*"& to the search type has no effect with the default
6772 prefix, because the &"*"& key is already included in the sequence of partial
6773 lookups. However, there might be a use for lookup types such as
6774 &"partial0(.)lsearch*"&.
6776 The use of &"*"& in lookup partial matching differs from its use as a wildcard
6777 in domain lists and the like. Partial matching works only in terms of
6778 dot-separated components; a key such as &`*fict.example`&
6779 in a database file is useless, because the asterisk in a partial matching
6780 subject key is always followed by a dot.
6785 .section "Lookup caching" "SECID64"
6786 .cindex "lookup" "caching"
6787 .cindex "caching" "lookup data"
6788 Exim caches all lookup results in order to avoid needless repetition of
6789 lookups. However, because (apart from the daemon) Exim operates as a collection
6790 of independent, short-lived processes, this caching applies only within a
6791 single Exim process. There is no inter-process lookup caching facility.
6793 For single-key lookups, Exim keeps the relevant files open in case there is
6794 another lookup that needs them. In some types of configuration this can lead to
6795 many files being kept open for messages with many recipients. To avoid hitting
6796 the operating system limit on the number of simultaneously open files, Exim
6797 closes the least recently used file when it needs to open more files than its
6798 own internal limit, which can be changed via the &%lookup_open_max%& option.
6800 The single-key lookup files are closed and the lookup caches are flushed at
6801 strategic points during delivery &-- for example, after all routing is
6807 .section "Quoting lookup data" "SECID65"
6808 .cindex "lookup" "quoting"
6809 .cindex "quoting" "in lookups"
6810 When data from an incoming message is included in a query-style lookup, there
6811 is the possibility of special characters in the data messing up the syntax of
6812 the query. For example, a NIS+ query that contains
6816 will be broken if the local part happens to contain a closing square bracket.
6817 For NIS+, data can be enclosed in double quotes like this:
6819 [name="$local_part"]
6821 but this still leaves the problem of a double quote in the data. The rule for
6822 NIS+ is that double quotes must be doubled. Other lookup types have different
6823 rules, and to cope with the differing requirements, an expansion operator
6824 of the following form is provided:
6826 ${quote_<lookup-type>:<string>}
6828 For example, the safest way to write the NIS+ query is
6830 [name="${quote_nisplus:$local_part}"]
6832 See chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>& for full coverage of string expansions. The quote
6833 operator can be used for all lookup types, but has no effect for single-key
6834 lookups, since no quoting is ever needed in their key strings.
6839 .section "More about dnsdb" "SECTdnsdb"
6840 .cindex "dnsdb lookup"
6841 .cindex "lookup" "dnsdb"
6842 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
6843 The &(dnsdb)& lookup type uses the DNS as its database. A simple query consists
6844 of a record type and a domain name, separated by an equals sign. For example,
6845 an expansion string could contain:
6847 ${lookup dnsdb{mx=a.b.example}{$value}fail}
6849 If the lookup succeeds, the result is placed in &$value$&, which in this case
6850 is used on its own as the result. If the lookup does not succeed, the
6851 &`fail`& keyword causes a &'forced expansion failure'& &-- see section
6852 &<<SECTforexpfai>>& for an explanation of what this means.
6854 The supported DNS record types are A, CNAME, MX, NS, PTR, SPF, SRV, and TXT,
6855 and, when Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, AAAA (and A6 if that is also
6856 configured). If no type is given, TXT is assumed. When the type is PTR,
6857 the data can be an IP address, written as normal; inversion and the addition of
6858 &%in-addr.arpa%& or &%ip6.arpa%& happens automatically. For example:
6860 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=192.168.4.5}{$value}fail}
6862 If the data for a PTR record is not a syntactically valid IP address, it is not
6863 altered and nothing is added.
6865 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6866 .cindex "SRV record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6867 For an MX lookup, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
6868 each record, separated by a space. For an SRV lookup, the priority, weight,
6869 port, and host name are returned for each record, separated by spaces.
6871 For any record type, if multiple records are found (or, for A6 lookups, if a
6872 single record leads to multiple addresses), the data is returned as a
6873 concatenation, with newline as the default separator. The order, of course,
6874 depends on the DNS resolver. You can specify a different separator character
6875 between multiple records by putting a right angle-bracket followed immediately
6876 by the new separator at the start of the query. For example:
6878 ${lookup dnsdb{>: a=host1.example}}
6880 It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
6881 white space is ignored.
6883 .cindex "TXT record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6884 .cindex "SPF record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6885 For TXT records with multiple items of data, only the first item is returned,
6886 unless a separator for them is specified using a comma after the separator
6887 character followed immediately by the TXT record item separator. To concatenate
6888 items without a separator, use a semicolon instead. For SPF records the
6889 default behaviour is to concatenate multiple items without using a separator.
6891 ${lookup dnsdb{>\n,: txt=a.b.example}}
6892 ${lookup dnsdb{>\n; txt=a.b.example}}
6893 ${lookup dnsdb{spf=example.org}}
6895 It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
6896 white space is ignored.
6898 .section "Pseudo dnsdb record types" "SECID66"
6899 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6900 By default, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
6901 each MX record, separated by a space. If you want only host names, you can use
6902 the pseudo-type MXH:
6904 ${lookup dnsdb{mxh=a.b.example}}
6906 In this case, the preference values are omitted, and just the host names are
6909 .cindex "name server for enclosing domain"
6910 Another pseudo-type is ZNS (for &"zone NS"&). It performs a lookup for NS
6911 records on the given domain, but if none are found, it removes the first
6912 component of the domain name, and tries again. This process continues until NS
6913 records are found or there are no more components left (or there is a DNS
6914 error). In other words, it may return the name servers for a top-level domain,
6915 but it never returns the root name servers. If there are no NS records for the
6916 top-level domain, the lookup fails. Consider these examples:
6918 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.quercite.com}}
6919 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.edu}}
6921 Assuming that in each case there are no NS records for the full domain name,
6922 the first returns the name servers for &%quercite.com%&, and the second returns
6923 the name servers for &%edu%&.
6925 You should be careful about how you use this lookup because, unless the
6926 top-level domain does not exist, the lookup always returns some host names. The
6927 sort of use to which this might be put is for seeing if the name servers for a
6928 given domain are on a blacklist. You can probably assume that the name servers
6929 for the high-level domains such as &%com%& or &%co.uk%& are not going to be on
6932 .cindex "CSA" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6933 A third pseudo-type is CSA (Client SMTP Authorization). This looks up SRV
6934 records according to the CSA rules, which are described in section
6935 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&. Although &(dnsdb)& supports SRV lookups directly, this is
6936 not sufficient because of the extra parent domain search behaviour of CSA. The
6937 result of a successful lookup such as:
6939 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
6941 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
6942 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
6943 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
6945 .cindex "A+" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6946 The pseudo-type A+ performs an A6 lookup (if configured) followed by an AAAA
6947 and then an A lookup. All results are returned; defer processing
6948 (see below) is handled separately for each lookup. Example:
6950 ${lookup dnsdb {>; a+=$sender_helo_name}}
6954 .section "Multiple dnsdb lookups" "SECID67"
6955 In the previous sections, &(dnsdb)& lookups for a single domain are described.
6956 However, you can specify a list of domains or IP addresses in a single
6957 &(dnsdb)& lookup. The list is specified in the normal Exim way, with colon as
6958 the default separator, but with the ability to change this. For example:
6960 ${lookup dnsdb{one.domain.com:two.domain.com}}
6961 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
6962 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr = <; 1.2.3.4 ; 4.5.6.8}}
6964 In order to retain backwards compatibility, there is one special case: if
6965 the lookup type is PTR and no change of separator is specified, Exim looks
6966 to see if the rest of the string is precisely one IPv6 address. In this
6967 case, it does not treat it as a list.
6969 The data from each lookup is concatenated, with newline separators by default,
6970 in the same way that multiple DNS records for a single item are handled. A
6971 different separator can be specified, as described above.
6973 The &(dnsdb)& lookup fails only if all the DNS lookups fail. If there is a
6974 temporary DNS error for any of them, the behaviour is controlled by
6975 an optional keyword followed by a comma that may appear before the record
6976 type. The possible keywords are &"defer_strict"&, &"defer_never"&, and
6977 &"defer_lax"&. With &"strict"& behaviour, any temporary DNS error causes the
6978 whole lookup to defer. With &"never"& behaviour, a temporary DNS error is
6979 ignored, and the behaviour is as if the DNS lookup failed to find anything.
6980 With &"lax"& behaviour, all the queries are attempted, but a temporary DNS
6981 error causes the whole lookup to defer only if none of the other lookups
6982 succeed. The default is &"lax"&, so the following lookups are equivalent:
6984 ${lookup dnsdb{defer_lax,a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
6985 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
6987 Thus, in the default case, as long as at least one of the DNS lookups
6988 yields some data, the lookup succeeds.
6993 .section "More about LDAP" "SECTldap"
6994 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup, more about"
6995 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
6996 .cindex "Solaris" "LDAP"
6997 The original LDAP implementation came from the University of Michigan; this has
6998 become &"Open LDAP"&, and there are now two different releases. Another
6999 implementation comes from Netscape, and Solaris 7 and subsequent releases
7000 contain inbuilt LDAP support. Unfortunately, though these are all compatible at
7001 the lookup function level, their error handling is different. For this reason
7002 it is necessary to set a compile-time variable when building Exim with LDAP, to
7003 indicate which LDAP library is in use. One of the following should appear in
7004 your &_Local/Makefile_&:
7006 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=UMICHIGAN
7007 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP1
7008 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP2
7009 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=NETSCAPE
7010 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=SOLARIS
7012 If LDAP_LIB_TYPE is not set, Exim assumes &`OPENLDAP1`&, which has the
7013 same interface as the University of Michigan version.
7015 There are three LDAP lookup types in Exim. These behave slightly differently in
7016 the way they handle the results of a query:
7019 &(ldap)& requires the result to contain just one entry; if there are more, it
7022 &(ldapdn)& also requires the result to contain just one entry, but it is the
7023 Distinguished Name that is returned rather than any attribute values.
7025 &(ldapm)& permits the result to contain more than one entry; the attributes
7026 from all of them are returned.
7030 For &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, if a query finds only entries with no attributes,
7031 Exim behaves as if the entry did not exist, and the lookup fails. The format of
7032 the data returned by a successful lookup is described in the next section.
7033 First we explain how LDAP queries are coded.
7036 .section "Format of LDAP queries" "SECTforldaque"
7037 .cindex "LDAP" "query format"
7038 An LDAP query takes the form of a URL as defined in RFC 2255. For example, in
7039 the configuration of a &(redirect)& router one might have this setting:
7041 data = ${lookup ldap \
7042 {ldap:///cn=$local_part,o=University%20of%20Cambridge,\
7043 c=UK?mailbox?base?}}
7045 .cindex "LDAP" "with TLS"
7046 The URL may begin with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& if your LDAP library supports
7047 secure (encrypted) LDAP connections. The second of these ensures that an
7048 encrypted TLS connection is used.
7050 With sufficiently modern LDAP libraries, Exim supports forcing TLS over regular
7051 LDAP connections, rather than the SSL-on-connect &`ldaps`&.
7052 See the &%ldap_start_tls%& option.
7055 .section "LDAP quoting" "SECID68"
7056 .cindex "LDAP" "quoting"
7057 Two levels of quoting are required in LDAP queries, the first for LDAP itself
7058 and the second because the LDAP query is represented as a URL. Furthermore,
7059 within an LDAP query, two different kinds of quoting are required. For this
7060 reason, there are two different LDAP-specific quoting operators.
7062 The &%quote_ldap%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7063 filter specifications. Conceptually, it first does the following conversions on
7071 in accordance with RFC 2254. The resulting string is then quoted according
7072 to the rules for URLs, that is, all non-alphanumeric characters except
7076 are converted to their hex values, preceded by a percent sign. For example:
7078 ${quote_ldap: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7082 %20a%5C28bc%5C29%5C2A%2C%20a%3Cyz%3E%3B%20
7084 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a leading and a trailing space):
7086 a\28bc\29\2A, a<yz>;
7088 The &%quote_ldap_dn%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7089 base DN specifications in queries. Conceptually, it first converts the string
7090 by inserting a backslash in front of any of the following characters:
7094 It also inserts a backslash before any leading spaces or # characters, and
7095 before any trailing spaces. (These rules are in RFC 2253.) The resulting string
7096 is then quoted according to the rules for URLs. For example:
7098 ${quote_ldap_dn: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7102 %5C%20a(bc)*%5C%2C%20a%5C%3Cyz%5C%3E%5C%3B%5C%20
7104 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a trailing space):
7106 \ a(bc)*\, a\<yz\>\;\
7108 There are some further comments about quoting in the section on LDAP
7109 authentication below.
7112 .section "LDAP connections" "SECID69"
7113 .cindex "LDAP" "connections"
7114 The connection to an LDAP server may either be over TCP/IP, or, when OpenLDAP
7115 is in use, via a Unix domain socket. The example given above does not specify
7116 an LDAP server. A server that is reached by TCP/IP can be specified in a query
7119 ldap://<hostname>:<port>/...
7121 If the port (and preceding colon) are omitted, the standard LDAP port (389) is
7122 used. When no server is specified in a query, a list of default servers is
7123 taken from the &%ldap_default_servers%& configuration option. This supplies a
7124 colon-separated list of servers which are tried in turn until one successfully
7125 handles a query, or there is a serious error. Successful handling either
7126 returns the requested data, or indicates that it does not exist. Serious errors
7127 are syntactical, or multiple values when only a single value is expected.
7128 Errors which cause the next server to be tried are connection failures, bind
7129 failures, and timeouts.
7131 For each server name in the list, a port number can be given. The standard way
7132 of specifying a host and port is to use a colon separator (RFC 1738). Because
7133 &%ldap_default_servers%& is a colon-separated list, such colons have to be
7134 doubled. For example
7136 ldap_default_servers = ldap1.example.com::145:ldap2.example.com
7138 If &%ldap_default_servers%& is unset, a URL with no server name is passed
7139 to the LDAP library with no server name, and the library's default (normally
7140 the local host) is used.
7142 If you are using the OpenLDAP library, you can connect to an LDAP server using
7143 a Unix domain socket instead of a TCP/IP connection. This is specified by using
7144 &`ldapi`& instead of &`ldap`& in LDAP queries. What follows here applies only
7145 to OpenLDAP. If Exim is compiled with a different LDAP library, this feature is
7148 For this type of connection, instead of a host name for the server, a pathname
7149 for the socket is required, and the port number is not relevant. The pathname
7150 can be specified either as an item in &%ldap_default_servers%&, or inline in
7151 the query. In the former case, you can have settings such as
7153 ldap_default_servers = /tmp/ldap.sock : backup.ldap.your.domain
7155 When the pathname is given in the query, you have to escape the slashes as
7156 &`%2F`& to fit in with the LDAP URL syntax. For example:
7158 ${lookup ldap {ldapi://%2Ftmp%2Fldap.sock/o=...
7160 When Exim processes an LDAP lookup and finds that the &"hostname"& is really
7161 a pathname, it uses the Unix domain socket code, even if the query actually
7162 specifies &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`&. In particular, no encryption is used for a
7163 socket connection. This behaviour means that you can use a setting of
7164 &%ldap_default_servers%& such as in the example above with traditional &`ldap`&
7165 or &`ldaps`& queries, and it will work. First, Exim tries a connection via
7166 the Unix domain socket; if that fails, it tries a TCP/IP connection to the
7169 If an explicit &`ldapi`& type is given in a query when a host name is
7170 specified, an error is diagnosed. However, if there are more items in
7171 &%ldap_default_servers%&, they are tried. In other words:
7174 Using a pathname with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& forces the use of the Unix domain
7177 Using &`ldapi`& with a host name causes an error.
7181 Using &`ldapi`& with no host or path in the query, and no setting of
7182 &%ldap_default_servers%&, does whatever the library does by default.
7186 .section "LDAP authentication and control information" "SECID70"
7187 .cindex "LDAP" "authentication"
7188 The LDAP URL syntax provides no way of passing authentication and other control
7189 information to the server. To make this possible, the URL in an LDAP query may
7190 be preceded by any number of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> settings, separated by
7191 spaces. If a value contains spaces it must be enclosed in double quotes, and
7192 when double quotes are used, backslash is interpreted in the usual way inside
7193 them. The following names are recognized:
7195 &`DEREFERENCE`& set the dereferencing parameter
7196 &`NETTIME `& set a timeout for a network operation
7197 &`USER `& set the DN, for authenticating the LDAP bind
7198 &`PASS `& set the password, likewise
7199 &`REFERRALS `& set the referrals parameter
7200 &`SIZE `& set the limit for the number of entries returned
7201 &`TIME `& set the maximum waiting time for a query
7203 The value of the DEREFERENCE parameter must be one of the words &"never"&,
7204 &"searching"&, &"finding"&, or &"always"&. The value of the REFERRALS parameter
7205 must be &"follow"& (the default) or &"nofollow"&. The latter stops the LDAP
7206 library from trying to follow referrals issued by the LDAP server.
7208 The name CONNECT is an obsolete name for NETTIME, retained for
7209 backwards compatibility. This timeout (specified as a number of seconds) is
7210 enforced from the client end for operations that can be carried out over a
7211 network. Specifically, it applies to network connections and calls to the
7212 &'ldap_result()'& function. If the value is greater than zero, it is used if
7213 LDAP_OPT_NETWORK_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (OpenLDAP), or
7214 if LDAP_X_OPT_CONNECT_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (Netscape
7215 SDK 4.1). A value of zero forces an explicit setting of &"no timeout"& for
7216 Netscape SDK; for OpenLDAP no action is taken.
7218 The TIME parameter (also a number of seconds) is passed to the server to
7219 set a server-side limit on the time taken to complete a search.
7222 Here is an example of an LDAP query in an Exim lookup that uses some of these
7223 values. This is a single line, folded to fit on the page:
7226 {user="cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK" pass=secret
7227 ldap:///o=University%20of%20Cambridge,c=UK?sn?sub?(cn=foo)}
7230 The encoding of spaces as &`%20`& is a URL thing which should not be done for
7231 any of the auxiliary data. Exim configuration settings that include lookups
7232 which contain password information should be preceded by &"hide"& to prevent
7233 non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& option to see their values.
7235 The auxiliary data items may be given in any order. The default is no
7236 connection timeout (the system timeout is used), no user or password, no limit
7237 on the number of entries returned, and no time limit on queries.
7239 When a DN is quoted in the USER= setting for LDAP authentication, Exim
7240 removes any URL quoting that it may contain before passing it LDAP. Apparently
7241 some libraries do this for themselves, but some do not. Removing the URL
7242 quoting has two advantages:
7245 It makes it possible to use the same &%quote_ldap_dn%& expansion for USER=
7246 DNs as with DNs inside actual queries.
7248 It permits spaces inside USER= DNs.
7251 For example, a setting such as
7253 USER=cn=${quote_ldap_dn:$1}
7255 should work even if &$1$& contains spaces.
7257 Expanded data for the PASS= value should be quoted using the &%quote%&
7258 expansion operator, rather than the LDAP quote operators. The only reason this
7259 field needs quoting is to ensure that it conforms to the Exim syntax, which
7260 does not allow unquoted spaces. For example:
7264 The LDAP authentication mechanism can be used to check passwords as part of
7265 SMTP authentication. See the &%ldapauth%& expansion string condition in chapter
7270 .section "Format of data returned by LDAP" "SECID71"
7271 .cindex "LDAP" "returned data formats"
7272 The &(ldapdn)& lookup type returns the Distinguished Name from a single entry
7273 as a sequence of values, for example
7275 cn=manager, o=University of Cambridge, c=UK
7277 The &(ldap)& lookup type generates an error if more than one entry matches the
7278 search filter, whereas &(ldapm)& permits this case, and inserts a newline in
7279 the result between the data from different entries. It is possible for multiple
7280 values to be returned for both &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, but in the former case
7281 you know that whatever values are returned all came from a single entry in the
7284 In the common case where you specify a single attribute in your LDAP query, the
7285 result is not quoted, and does not contain the attribute name. If the attribute
7286 has multiple values, they are separated by commas.
7288 If you specify multiple attributes, the result contains space-separated, quoted
7289 strings, each preceded by the attribute name and an equals sign. Within the
7290 quotes, the quote character, backslash, and newline are escaped with
7291 backslashes, and commas are used to separate multiple values for the attribute.
7292 Apart from the escaping, the string within quotes takes the same form as the
7293 output when a single attribute is requested. Specifying no attributes is the
7294 same as specifying all of an entry's attributes.
7296 Here are some examples of the output format. The first line of each pair is an
7297 LDAP query, and the second is the data that is returned. The attribute called
7298 &%attr1%& has two values, whereas &%attr2%& has only one value:
7300 ldap:///o=base?attr1?sub?(uid=fred)
7303 ldap:///o=base?attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7306 ldap:///o=base?attr1,attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7307 attr1="value1.1, value1.2" attr2="value two"
7309 ldap:///o=base??sub?(uid=fred)
7310 objectClass="top" attr1="value1.1, value1.2" attr2="value two"
7312 The &%extract%& operator in string expansions can be used to pick out
7313 individual fields from data that consists of &'key'&=&'value'& pairs. You can
7314 make use of Exim's &%-be%& option to run expansion tests and thereby check the
7315 results of LDAP lookups.
7320 .section "More about NIS+" "SECTnisplus"
7321 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
7322 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
7323 NIS+ queries consist of a NIS+ &'indexed name'& followed by an optional colon
7324 and field name. If this is given, the result of a successful query is the
7325 contents of the named field; otherwise the result consists of a concatenation
7326 of &'field-name=field-value'& pairs, separated by spaces. Empty values and
7327 values containing spaces are quoted. For example, the query
7329 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir
7331 might return the string
7333 name=mg1456 passwd="" uid=999 gid=999 gcos="Martin Guerre"
7334 home=/home/mg1456 shell=/bin/bash shadow=""
7336 (split over two lines here to fit on the page), whereas
7338 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir:gcos
7344 with no quotes. A NIS+ lookup fails if NIS+ returns more than one table entry
7345 for the given indexed key. The effect of the &%quote_nisplus%& expansion
7346 operator is to double any quote characters within the text.
7350 .section "SQL lookups" "SECTsql"
7351 .cindex "SQL lookup types"
7352 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7353 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7354 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7355 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7356 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7357 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7358 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7359 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7360 Exim can support lookups in InterBase, MySQL, Oracle, PostgreSQL, and SQLite
7361 databases. Queries for these databases contain SQL statements, so an example
7364 ${lookup mysql{select mailbox from users where id='userx'}\
7367 If the result of the query contains more than one field, the data for each
7368 field in the row is returned, preceded by its name, so the result of
7370 ${lookup pgsql{select home,name from users where id='userx'}\
7375 home=/home/userx name="Mister X"
7377 Empty values and values containing spaces are double quoted, with embedded
7378 quotes escaped by a backslash. If the result of the query contains just one
7379 field, the value is passed back verbatim, without a field name, for example:
7383 If the result of the query yields more than one row, it is all concatenated,
7384 with a newline between the data for each row.
7387 .section "More about MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, and InterBase" "SECID72"
7388 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7389 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7390 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7391 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7392 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7393 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7394 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7395 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7396 If any MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, or InterBase lookups are used, the
7397 &%mysql_servers%&, &%pgsql_servers%&, &%oracle_servers%&, or &%ibase_servers%&
7398 option (as appropriate) must be set to a colon-separated list of server
7400 (For MySQL and PostgreSQL only, the global option need not be set if all
7401 queries contain their own server information &-- see section
7402 &<<SECTspeserque>>&.) Each item in the list is a slash-separated list of four
7403 items: host name, database name, user name, and password. In the case of
7404 Oracle, the host name field is used for the &"service name"&, and the database
7405 name field is not used and should be empty. For example:
7407 hide oracle_servers = oracle.plc.example//userx/abcdwxyz
7409 Because password data is sensitive, you should always precede the setting with
7410 &"hide"&, to prevent non-admin users from obtaining the setting via the &%-bP%&
7411 option. Here is an example where two MySQL servers are listed:
7413 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/root/secret:\
7414 otherhost/users/root/othersecret
7416 For MySQL and PostgreSQL, a host may be specified as <&'name'&>:<&'port'&> but
7417 because this is a colon-separated list, the colon has to be doubled. For each
7418 query, these parameter groups are tried in order until a connection is made and
7419 a query is successfully processed. The result of a query may be that no data is
7420 found, but that is still a successful query. In other words, the list of
7421 servers provides a backup facility, not a list of different places to look.
7423 The &%quote_mysql%&, &%quote_pgsql%&, and &%quote_oracle%& expansion operators
7424 convert newline, tab, carriage return, and backspace to \n, \t, \r, and \b
7425 respectively, and the characters single-quote, double-quote, and backslash
7426 itself are escaped with backslashes. The &%quote_pgsql%& expansion operator, in
7427 addition, escapes the percent and underscore characters. This cannot be done
7428 for MySQL because these escapes are not recognized in contexts where these
7429 characters are not special.
7431 .section "Specifying the server in the query" "SECTspeserque"
7432 For MySQL and PostgreSQL lookups (but not currently for Oracle and InterBase),
7433 it is possible to specify a list of servers with an individual query. This is
7434 done by starting the query with
7436 &`servers=`&&'server1:server2:server3:...'&&`;`&
7438 Each item in the list may take one of two forms:
7440 If it contains no slashes it is assumed to be just a host name. The appropriate
7441 global option (&%mysql_servers%& or &%pgsql_servers%&) is searched for a host
7442 of the same name, and the remaining parameters (database, user, password) are
7445 If it contains any slashes, it is taken as a complete parameter set.
7447 The list of servers is used in exactly the same way as the global list.
7448 Once a connection to a server has happened and a query has been
7449 successfully executed, processing of the lookup ceases.
7451 This feature is intended for use in master/slave situations where updates
7452 are occurring and you want to update the master rather than a slave. If the
7453 master is in the list as a backup for reading, you might have a global setting
7456 mysql_servers = slave1/db/name/pw:\
7460 In an updating lookup, you could then write:
7462 ${lookup mysql{servers=master; UPDATE ...} }
7464 That query would then be sent only to the master server. If, on the other hand,
7465 the master is not to be used for reading, and so is not present in the global
7466 option, you can still update it by a query of this form:
7468 ${lookup pgsql{servers=master/db/name/pw; UPDATE ...} }
7472 .section "Special MySQL features" "SECID73"
7473 For MySQL, an empty host name or the use of &"localhost"& in &%mysql_servers%&
7474 causes a connection to the server on the local host by means of a Unix domain
7475 socket. An alternate socket can be specified in parentheses. The full syntax of
7476 each item in &%mysql_servers%& is:
7478 <&'hostname'&>::<&'port'&>(<&'socket name'&>)/<&'database'&>/&&&
7479 <&'user'&>/<&'password'&>
7481 Any of the three sub-parts of the first field can be omitted. For normal use on
7482 the local host it can be left blank or set to just &"localhost"&.
7484 No database need be supplied &-- but if it is absent here, it must be given in
7487 If a MySQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert, update,
7488 or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows affected.
7490 &*Warning*&: This can be misleading. If an update does not actually change
7491 anything (for example, setting a field to the value it already has), the result
7492 is zero because no rows are affected.
7495 .section "Special PostgreSQL features" "SECID74"
7496 PostgreSQL lookups can also use Unix domain socket connections to the database.
7497 This is usually faster and costs less CPU time than a TCP/IP connection.
7498 However it can be used only if the mail server runs on the same machine as the
7499 database server. A configuration line for PostgreSQL via Unix domain sockets
7502 hide pgsql_servers = (/tmp/.s.PGSQL.5432)/db/user/password : ...
7504 In other words, instead of supplying a host name, a path to the socket is
7505 given. The path name is enclosed in parentheses so that its slashes aren't
7506 visually confused with the delimiters for the other server parameters.
7508 If a PostgreSQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert,
7509 update, or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows
7512 .section "More about SQLite" "SECTsqlite"
7513 .cindex "lookup" "SQLite"
7514 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
7515 SQLite is different to the other SQL lookups because a file name is required in
7516 addition to the SQL query. An SQLite database is a single file, and there is no
7517 daemon as in the other SQL databases. The interface to Exim requires the name
7518 of the file, as an absolute path, to be given at the start of the query. It is
7519 separated from the query by white space. This means that the path name cannot
7520 contain white space. Here is a lookup expansion example:
7522 ${lookup sqlite {/some/thing/sqlitedb \
7523 select name from aliases where id='userx';}}
7525 In a list, the syntax is similar. For example:
7527 domainlist relay_to_domains = sqlite;/some/thing/sqlitedb \
7528 select * from relays where ip='$sender_host_address';
7530 The only character affected by the &%quote_sqlite%& operator is a single
7531 quote, which it doubles.
7533 The SQLite library handles multiple simultaneous accesses to the database
7534 internally. Multiple readers are permitted, but only one process can
7535 update at once. Attempts to access the database while it is being updated
7536 are rejected after a timeout period, during which the SQLite library
7537 waits for the lock to be released. In Exim, the default timeout is set
7538 to 5 seconds, but it can be changed by means of the &%sqlite_lock_timeout%&
7544 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
7545 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
7547 .chapter "Domain, host, address, and local part lists" &&&
7548 "CHAPdomhosaddlists" &&&
7549 "Domain, host, and address lists"
7550 .scindex IIDdohoadli "lists of domains; hosts; etc."
7551 A number of Exim configuration options contain lists of domains, hosts,
7552 email addresses, or local parts. For example, the &%hold_domains%& option
7553 contains a list of domains whose delivery is currently suspended. These lists
7554 are also used as data in ACL statements (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), and as
7555 arguments to expansion conditions such as &%match_domain%&.
7557 Each item in one of these lists is a pattern to be matched against a domain,
7558 host, email address, or local part, respectively. In the sections below, the
7559 different types of pattern for each case are described, but first we cover some
7560 general facilities that apply to all four kinds of list.
7564 .section "Expansion of lists" "SECID75"
7565 .cindex "expansion" "of lists"
7566 Each list is expanded as a single string before it is used. The result of
7567 expansion must be a list, possibly containing empty items, which is split up
7568 into separate items for matching. By default, colon is the separator character,
7569 but this can be varied if necessary. See sections &<<SECTlistconstruct>>& and
7570 &<<SECTempitelis>>& for details of the list syntax; the second of these
7571 discusses the way to specify empty list items.
7574 If the string expansion is forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the item it is
7575 testing (domain, host, address, or local part) is not in the list. Other
7576 expansion failures cause temporary errors.
7578 If an item in a list is a regular expression, backslashes, dollars and possibly
7579 other special characters in the expression must be protected against
7580 misinterpretation by the string expander. The easiest way to do this is to use
7581 the &`\N`& expansion feature to indicate that the contents of the regular
7582 expression should not be expanded. For example, in an ACL you might have:
7584 deny senders = \N^\d{8}\w@.*\.baddomain\.example$\N : \
7585 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/badsenders/bydomain}}
7587 The first item is a regular expression that is protected from expansion by
7588 &`\N`&, whereas the second uses the expansion to obtain a list of unwanted
7589 senders based on the receiving domain.
7594 .section "Negated items in lists" "SECID76"
7595 .cindex "list" "negation"
7596 .cindex "negation" "in lists"
7597 Items in a list may be positive or negative. Negative items are indicated by a
7598 leading exclamation mark, which may be followed by optional white space. A list
7599 defines a set of items (domains, etc). When Exim processes one of these lists,
7600 it is trying to find out whether a domain, host, address, or local part
7601 (respectively) is in the set that is defined by the list. It works like this:
7603 The list is scanned from left to right. If a positive item is matched, the
7604 subject that is being checked is in the set; if a negative item is matched, the
7605 subject is not in the set. If the end of the list is reached without the
7606 subject having matched any of the patterns, it is in the set if the last item
7607 was a negative one, but not if it was a positive one. For example, the list in
7609 domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c : *.b.c
7611 matches any domain ending in &'.b.c'& except for &'a.b.c'&. Domains that match
7612 neither &'a.b.c'& nor &'*.b.c'& do not match, because the last item in the
7613 list is positive. However, if the setting were
7615 domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c
7617 then all domains other than &'a.b.c'& would match because the last item in the
7618 list is negative. In other words, a list that ends with a negative item behaves
7619 as if it had an extra item &`:*`& on the end.
7621 Another way of thinking about positive and negative items in lists is to read
7622 the connector as &"or"& after a positive item and as &"and"& after a negative
7627 .section "File names in lists" "SECTfilnamlis"
7628 .cindex "list" "file name in"
7629 If an item in a domain, host, address, or local part list is an absolute file
7630 name (beginning with a slash character), each line of the file is read and
7631 processed as if it were an independent item in the list, except that further
7632 file names are not allowed,
7633 and no expansion of the data from the file takes place.
7634 Empty lines in the file are ignored, and the file may also contain comment
7638 For domain and host lists, if a # character appears anywhere in a line of the
7639 file, it and all following characters are ignored.
7641 Because local parts may legitimately contain # characters, a comment in an
7642 address list or local part list file is recognized only if # is preceded by
7643 white space or the start of the line. For example:
7645 not#comment@x.y.z # but this is a comment
7649 Putting a file name in a list has the same effect as inserting each line of the
7650 file as an item in the list (blank lines and comments excepted). However, there
7651 is one important difference: the file is read each time the list is processed,
7652 so if its contents vary over time, Exim's behaviour changes.
7654 If a file name is preceded by an exclamation mark, the sense of any match
7655 within the file is inverted. For example, if
7657 hold_domains = !/etc/nohold-domains
7659 and the file contains the lines
7664 then &'a.b.c'& is in the set of domains defined by &%hold_domains%&, whereas
7665 any domain matching &`*.b.c`& is not.
7669 .section "An lsearch file is not an out-of-line list" "SECID77"
7670 As will be described in the sections that follow, lookups can be used in lists
7671 to provide indexed methods of checking list membership. There has been some
7672 confusion about the way &(lsearch)& lookups work in lists. Because
7673 an &(lsearch)& file contains plain text and is scanned sequentially, it is
7674 sometimes thought that it is allowed to contain wild cards and other kinds of
7675 non-constant pattern. This is not the case. The keys in an &(lsearch)& file are
7676 always fixed strings, just as for any other single-key lookup type.
7678 If you want to use a file to contain wild-card patterns that form part of a
7679 list, just give the file name on its own, without a search type, as described
7680 in the previous section. You could also use the &(wildlsearch)& or
7681 &(nwildlsearch)&, but there is no advantage in doing this.
7686 .section "Named lists" "SECTnamedlists"
7687 .cindex "named lists"
7688 .cindex "list" "named"
7689 A list of domains, hosts, email addresses, or local parts can be given a name
7690 which is then used to refer to the list elsewhere in the configuration. This is
7691 particularly convenient if the same list is required in several different
7692 places. It also allows lists to be given meaningful names, which can improve
7693 the readability of the configuration. For example, it is conventional to define
7694 a domain list called &'local_domains'& for all the domains that are handled
7695 locally on a host, using a configuration line such as
7697 domainlist local_domains = localhost:my.dom.example
7699 Named lists are referenced by giving their name preceded by a plus sign, so,
7700 for example, a router that is intended to handle local domains would be
7701 configured with the line
7703 domains = +local_domains
7705 The first router in a configuration is often one that handles all domains
7706 except the local ones, using a configuration with a negated item like this:
7710 domains = ! +local_domains
7711 transport = remote_smtp
7714 The four kinds of named list are created by configuration lines starting with
7715 the words &%domainlist%&, &%hostlist%&, &%addresslist%&, or &%localpartlist%&,
7716 respectively. Then there follows the name that you are defining, followed by an
7717 equals sign and the list itself. For example:
7719 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.23.0/24 : my.friend.example
7720 addresslist bad_senders = cdb;/etc/badsenders
7722 A named list may refer to other named lists:
7724 domainlist dom1 = first.example : second.example
7725 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : third.example
7726 domainlist dom3 = fourth.example : +dom2 : fifth.example
7728 &*Warning*&: If the last item in a referenced list is a negative one, the
7729 effect may not be what you intended, because the negation does not propagate
7730 out to the higher level. For example, consider:
7732 domainlist dom1 = !a.b
7733 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : *.b
7735 The second list specifies &"either in the &%dom1%& list or &'*.b'&"&. The first
7736 list specifies just &"not &'a.b'&"&, so the domain &'x.y'& matches it. That
7737 means it matches the second list as well. The effect is not the same as
7739 domainlist dom2 = !a.b : *.b
7741 where &'x.y'& does not match. It's best to avoid negation altogether in
7742 referenced lists if you can.
7744 Named lists may have a performance advantage. When Exim is routing an
7745 address or checking an incoming message, it caches the result of tests on named
7746 lists. So, if you have a setting such as
7748 domains = +local_domains
7750 on several of your routers
7751 or in several ACL statements,
7752 the actual test is done only for the first one. However, the caching works only
7753 if there are no expansions within the list itself or any sublists that it
7754 references. In other words, caching happens only for lists that are known to be
7755 the same each time they are referenced.
7757 By default, there may be up to 16 named lists of each type. This limit can be
7758 extended by changing a compile-time variable. The use of domain and host lists
7759 is recommended for concepts such as local domains, relay domains, and relay
7760 hosts. The default configuration is set up like this.
7764 .section "Named lists compared with macros" "SECID78"
7765 .cindex "list" "named compared with macro"
7766 .cindex "macro" "compared with named list"
7767 At first sight, named lists might seem to be no different from macros in the
7768 configuration file. However, macros are just textual substitutions. If you
7771 ALIST = host1 : host2
7772 auth_advertise_hosts = !ALIST
7774 it probably won't do what you want, because that is exactly the same as
7776 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : host2
7778 Notice that the second host name is not negated. However, if you use a host
7781 hostlist alist = host1 : host2
7782 auth_advertise_hosts = ! +alist
7784 the negation applies to the whole list, and so that is equivalent to
7786 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : !host2
7790 .section "Named list caching" "SECID79"
7791 .cindex "list" "caching of named"
7792 .cindex "caching" "named lists"
7793 While processing a message, Exim caches the result of checking a named list if
7794 it is sure that the list is the same each time. In practice, this means that
7795 the cache operates only if the list contains no $ characters, which guarantees
7796 that it will not change when it is expanded. Sometimes, however, you may have
7797 an expanded list that you know will be the same each time within a given
7798 message. For example:
7800 domainlist special_domains = \
7801 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}cdb{/some/file}}
7803 This provides a list of domains that depends only on the sending host's IP
7804 address. If this domain list is referenced a number of times (for example,
7805 in several ACL lines, or in several routers) the result of the check is not
7806 cached by default, because Exim does not know that it is going to be the
7807 same list each time.
7809 By appending &`_cache`& to &`domainlist`& you can tell Exim to go ahead and
7810 cache the result anyway. For example:
7812 domainlist_cache special_domains = ${lookup{...
7814 If you do this, you should be absolutely sure that caching is going to do
7815 the right thing in all cases. When in doubt, leave it out.
7819 .section "Domain lists" "SECTdomainlist"
7820 .cindex "domain list" "patterns for"
7821 .cindex "list" "domain list"
7822 Domain lists contain patterns that are to be matched against a mail domain.
7823 The following types of item may appear in domain lists:
7826 .cindex "primary host name"
7827 .cindex "host name" "matched in domain list"
7828 .oindex "&%primary_hostname%&"
7829 .cindex "domain list" "matching primary host name"
7830 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
7831 If a pattern consists of a single @ character, it matches the local host name,
7832 as set by the &%primary_hostname%& option (or defaulted). This makes it
7833 possible to use the same configuration file on several different hosts that
7834 differ only in their names.
7836 .cindex "@[] in a domain list"
7837 .cindex "domain list" "matching local IP interfaces"
7838 .cindex "domain literal"
7839 If a pattern consists of the string &`@[]`& it matches an IP address enclosed
7840 in square brackets (as in an email address that contains a domain literal), but
7841 only if that IP address is recognized as local for email routing purposes. The
7842 &%local_interfaces%& and &%extra_local_interfaces%& options can be used to
7843 control which of a host's several IP addresses are treated as local.
7844 In today's Internet, the use of domain literals is controversial.
7847 .cindex "@mx_primary"
7848 .cindex "@mx_secondary"
7849 .cindex "domain list" "matching MX pointers to local host"
7850 If a pattern consists of the string &`@mx_any`& it matches any domain that
7851 has an MX record pointing to the local host or to any host that is listed in
7852 .oindex "&%hosts_treat_as_local%&"
7853 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&. The items &`@mx_primary`& and &`@mx_secondary`&
7854 are similar, except that the first matches only when a primary MX target is the
7855 local host, and the second only when no primary MX target is the local host,
7856 but a secondary MX target is. &"Primary"& means an MX record with the lowest
7857 preference value &-- there may of course be more than one of them.
7859 The MX lookup that takes place when matching a pattern of this type is
7860 performed with the resolver options for widening names turned off. Thus, for
7861 example, a single-component domain will &'not'& be expanded by adding the
7862 resolver's default domain. See the &%qualify_single%& and &%search_parents%&
7863 options of the &(dnslookup)& router for a discussion of domain widening.
7865 Sometimes you may want to ignore certain IP addresses when using one of these
7866 patterns. You can specify this by following the pattern with &`/ignore=`&<&'ip
7867 list'&>, where <&'ip list'&> is a list of IP addresses. These addresses are
7868 ignored when processing the pattern (compare the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option
7869 on a router). For example:
7871 domains = @mx_any/ignore=127.0.0.1
7873 This example matches any domain that has an MX record pointing to one of
7874 the local host's IP addresses other than 127.0.0.1.
7876 The list of IP addresses is in fact processed by the same code that processes
7877 host lists, so it may contain CIDR-coded network specifications and it may also
7878 contain negative items.
7880 Because the list of IP addresses is a sublist within a domain list, you have to
7881 be careful about delimiters if there is more than one address. Like any other
7882 list, the default delimiter can be changed. Thus, you might have:
7884 domains = @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;0.0.0.0 : \
7885 an.other.domain : ...
7887 so that the sublist uses semicolons for delimiters. When IPv6 addresses are
7888 involved, it is easiest to change the delimiter for the main list as well:
7890 domains = <? @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;::1 ? \
7891 an.other.domain ? ...
7894 .cindex "asterisk" "in domain list"
7895 .cindex "domain list" "asterisk in"
7896 .cindex "domain list" "matching &""ends with""&"
7897 If a pattern starts with an asterisk, the remaining characters of the pattern
7898 are compared with the terminating characters of the domain. The use of &"*"& in
7899 domain lists differs from its use in partial matching lookups. In a domain
7900 list, the character following the asterisk need not be a dot, whereas partial
7901 matching works only in terms of dot-separated components. For example, a domain
7902 list item such as &`*key.ex`& matches &'donkey.ex'& as well as
7906 .cindex "regular expressions" "in domain list"
7907 .cindex "domain list" "matching regular expression"
7908 If a pattern starts with a circumflex character, it is treated as a regular
7909 expression, and matched against the domain using a regular expression matching
7910 function. The circumflex is treated as part of the regular expression.
7911 Email domains are case-independent, so this regular expression match is by
7912 default case-independent, but you can make it case-dependent by starting it
7913 with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the syntax of regular expressions
7914 are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&.
7916 &*Warning*&: Because domain lists are expanded before being processed, you
7917 must escape any backslash and dollar characters in the regular expression, or
7918 use the special &`\N`& sequence (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&) to specify that
7919 it is not to be expanded (unless you really do want to build a regular
7920 expression by expansion, of course).
7922 .cindex "lookup" "in domain list"
7923 .cindex "domain list" "matching by lookup"
7924 If a pattern starts with the name of a single-key lookup type followed by a
7925 semicolon (for example, &"dbm;"& or &"lsearch;"&), the remainder of the pattern
7926 must be a file name in a suitable format for the lookup type. For example, for
7927 &"cdb;"& it must be an absolute path:
7929 domains = cdb;/etc/mail/local_domains.cdb
7931 The appropriate type of lookup is done on the file using the domain name as the
7932 key. In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used; Exim is interested
7933 only in whether or not the key is present in the file. However, when a lookup
7934 is used for the &%domains%& option on a router
7935 or a &%domains%& condition in an ACL statement, the data is preserved in the
7936 &$domain_data$& variable and can be referred to in other router options or
7937 other statements in the same ACL.
7940 Any of the single-key lookup type names may be preceded by
7941 &`partial`&<&'n'&>&`-`&, where the <&'n'&> is optional, for example,
7943 domains = partial-dbm;/partial/domains
7945 This causes partial matching logic to be invoked; a description of how this
7946 works is given in section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&.
7949 .cindex "asterisk" "in lookup type"
7950 Any of the single-key lookup types may be followed by an asterisk. This causes
7951 a default lookup for a key consisting of a single asterisk to be done if the
7952 original lookup fails. This is not a useful feature when using a domain list to
7953 select particular domains (because any domain would match), but it might have
7954 value if the result of the lookup is being used via the &$domain_data$&
7957 If the pattern starts with the name of a query-style lookup type followed by a
7958 semicolon (for example, &"nisplus;"& or &"ldap;"&), the remainder of the
7959 pattern must be an appropriate query for the lookup type, as described in
7960 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example:
7962 hold_domains = mysql;select domain from holdlist \
7963 where domain = '${quote_mysql:$domain}';
7965 In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used (so for an SQL query, for
7966 example, it doesn't matter what field you select). Exim is interested only in
7967 whether or not the query succeeds. However, when a lookup is used for the
7968 &%domains%& option on a router, the data is preserved in the &$domain_data$&
7969 variable and can be referred to in other options.
7971 .cindex "domain list" "matching literal domain name"
7972 If none of the above cases apply, a caseless textual comparison is made
7973 between the pattern and the domain.
7976 Here is an example that uses several different kinds of pattern:
7978 domainlist funny_domains = \
7981 *.foundation.fict.example : \
7982 \N^[1-2]\d{3}\.fict\.example$\N : \
7983 partial-dbm;/opt/data/penguin/book : \
7984 nis;domains.byname : \
7985 nisplus;[name=$domain,status=local],domains.org_dir
7987 There are obvious processing trade-offs among the various matching modes. Using
7988 an asterisk is faster than a regular expression, and listing a few names
7989 explicitly probably is too. The use of a file or database lookup is expensive,
7990 but may be the only option if hundreds of names are required. Because the
7991 patterns are tested in order, it makes sense to put the most commonly matched
7996 .section "Host lists" "SECThostlist"
7997 .cindex "host list" "patterns in"
7998 .cindex "list" "host list"
7999 Host lists are used to control what remote hosts are allowed to do. For
8000 example, some hosts may be allowed to use the local host as a relay, and some
8001 may be permitted to use the SMTP ETRN command. Hosts can be identified in
8002 two different ways, by name or by IP address. In a host list, some types of
8003 pattern are matched to a host name, and some are matched to an IP address.
8004 You need to be particularly careful with this when single-key lookups are
8005 involved, to ensure that the right value is being used as the key.
8008 .section "Special host list patterns" "SECID80"
8009 .cindex "empty item in hosts list"
8010 .cindex "host list" "empty string in"
8011 If a host list item is the empty string, it matches only when no remote host is
8012 involved. This is the case when a message is being received from a local
8013 process using SMTP on the standard input, that is, when a TCP/IP connection is
8016 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
8017 The special pattern &"*"& in a host list matches any host or no host. Neither
8018 the IP address nor the name is actually inspected.
8022 .section "Host list patterns that match by IP address" "SECThoslispatip"
8023 .cindex "host list" "matching IP addresses"
8024 If an IPv4 host calls an IPv6 host and the call is accepted on an IPv6 socket,
8025 the incoming address actually appears in the IPv6 host as
8026 &`::ffff:`&<&'v4address'&>. When such an address is tested against a host
8027 list, it is converted into a traditional IPv4 address first. (Not all operating
8028 systems accept IPv4 calls on IPv6 sockets, as there have been some security
8031 The following types of pattern in a host list check the remote host by
8032 inspecting its IP address:
8035 If the pattern is a plain domain name (not a regular expression, not starting
8036 with *, not a lookup of any kind), Exim calls the operating system function
8037 to find the associated IP address(es). Exim uses the newer
8038 &[getipnodebyname()]& function when available, otherwise &[gethostbyname()]&.
8039 This typically causes a forward DNS lookup of the name. The result is compared
8040 with the IP address of the subject host.
8042 If there is a temporary problem (such as a DNS timeout) with the host name
8043 lookup, a temporary error occurs. For example, if the list is being used in an
8044 ACL condition, the ACL gives a &"defer"& response, usually leading to a
8045 temporary SMTP error code. If no IP address can be found for the host name,
8046 what happens is described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8049 .cindex "@ in a host list"
8050 If the pattern is &"@"&, the primary host name is substituted and used as a
8051 domain name, as just described.
8054 If the pattern is an IP address, it is matched against the IP address of the
8055 subject host. IPv4 addresses are given in the normal &"dotted-quad"& notation.
8056 IPv6 addresses can be given in colon-separated format, but the colons have to
8057 be doubled so as not to be taken as item separators when the default list
8058 separator is used. IPv6 addresses are recognized even when Exim is compiled
8059 without IPv6 support. This means that if they appear in a host list on an
8060 IPv4-only host, Exim will not treat them as host names. They are just addresses
8061 that can never match a client host.
8064 .cindex "@[] in a host list"
8065 If the pattern is &"@[]"&, it matches the IP address of any IP interface on
8066 the local host. For example, if the local host is an IPv4 host with one
8067 interface address 10.45.23.56, these two ACL statements have the same effect:
8069 accept hosts = 127.0.0.1 : 10.45.23.56
8073 .cindex "CIDR notation"
8074 If the pattern is an IP address followed by a slash and a mask length (for
8075 example 10.11.42.0/24), it is matched against the IP address of the subject
8076 host under the given mask. This allows, an entire network of hosts to be
8077 included (or excluded) by a single item. The mask uses CIDR notation; it
8078 specifies the number of address bits that must match, starting from the most
8079 significant end of the address.
8081 &*Note*&: The mask is &'not'& a count of addresses, nor is it the high number
8082 of a range of addresses. It is the number of bits in the network portion of the
8083 address. The above example specifies a 24-bit netmask, so it matches all 256
8084 addresses in the 10.11.42.0 network. An item such as
8088 matches just two addresses, 192.168.23.236 and 192.168.23.237. A mask value of
8089 32 for an IPv4 address is the same as no mask at all; just a single address
8092 Here is another example which shows an IPv4 and an IPv6 network:
8094 recipient_unqualified_hosts = 192.168.0.0/16: \
8095 3ffe::ffff::836f::::/48
8097 The doubling of list separator characters applies only when these items
8098 appear inline in a host list. It is not required when indirecting via a file.
8101 recipient_unqualified_hosts = /opt/exim/unqualnets
8103 could make use of a file containing
8108 to have exactly the same effect as the previous example. When listing IPv6
8109 addresses inline, it is usually more convenient to use the facility for
8110 changing separator characters. This list contains the same two networks:
8112 recipient_unqualified_hosts = <; 172.16.0.0/12; \
8115 The separator is changed to semicolon by the leading &"<;"& at the start of the
8121 .section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host address" &&&
8122 "SECThoslispatsikey"
8123 .cindex "host list" "lookup of IP address"
8124 When a host is to be identified by a single-key lookup of its complete IP
8125 address, the pattern takes this form:
8127 &`net-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8131 hosts_lookup = net-cdb;/hosts-by-ip.db
8133 The text form of the IP address of the subject host is used as the lookup key.
8134 IPv6 addresses are converted to an unabbreviated form, using lower case
8135 letters, with dots as separators because colon is the key terminator in
8136 &(lsearch)& files. [Colons can in fact be used in keys in &(lsearch)& files by
8137 quoting the keys, but this is a facility that was added later.] The data
8138 returned by the lookup is not used.
8140 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
8141 .cindex "host list" "masked IP address"
8142 Single-key lookups can also be performed using masked IP addresses, using
8143 patterns of this form:
8145 &`net<`&&'number'&&`>-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8149 net24-dbm;/networks.db
8151 The IP address of the subject host is masked using <&'number'&> as the mask
8152 length. A textual string is constructed from the masked value, followed by the
8153 mask, and this is used as the lookup key. For example, if the host's IP address
8154 is 192.168.34.6, the key that is looked up for the above example is
8155 &"192.168.34.0/24"&.
8157 When an IPv6 address is converted to a string, dots are normally used instead
8158 of colons, so that keys in &(lsearch)& files need not contain colons (which
8159 terminate &(lsearch)& keys). This was implemented some time before the ability
8160 to quote keys was made available in &(lsearch)& files. However, the more
8161 recently implemented &(iplsearch)& files do require colons in IPv6 keys
8162 (notated using the quoting facility) so as to distinguish them from IPv4 keys.
8163 For this reason, when the lookup type is &(iplsearch)&, IPv6 addresses are
8164 converted using colons and not dots. In all cases, full, unabbreviated IPv6
8165 addresses are always used.
8167 Ideally, it would be nice to tidy up this anomalous situation by changing to
8168 colons in all cases, given that quoting is now available for &(lsearch)&.
8169 However, this would be an incompatible change that might break some existing
8172 &*Warning*&: Specifying &%net32-%& (for an IPv4 address) or &%net128-%& (for an
8173 IPv6 address) is not the same as specifying just &%net-%& without a number. In
8174 the former case the key strings include the mask value, whereas in the latter
8175 case the IP address is used on its own.
8179 .section "Host list patterns that match by host name" "SECThoslispatnam"
8180 .cindex "host" "lookup failures"
8181 .cindex "unknown host name"
8182 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8183 There are several types of pattern that require Exim to know the name of the
8184 remote host. These are either wildcard patterns or lookups by name. (If a
8185 complete hostname is given without any wildcarding, it is used to find an IP
8186 address to match against, as described in section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&
8189 If the remote host name is not already known when Exim encounters one of these
8190 patterns, it has to be found from the IP address.
8191 Although many sites on the Internet are conscientious about maintaining reverse
8192 DNS data for their hosts, there are also many that do not do this.
8193 Consequently, a name cannot always be found, and this may lead to unwanted
8194 effects. Take care when configuring host lists with wildcarded name patterns.
8195 Consider what will happen if a name cannot be found.
8197 Because of the problems of determining host names from IP addresses, matching
8198 against host names is not as common as matching against IP addresses.
8200 By default, in order to find a host name, Exim first does a reverse DNS lookup;
8201 if no name is found in the DNS, the system function (&[gethostbyaddr()]& or
8202 &[getipnodebyaddr()]& if available) is tried. The order in which these lookups
8203 are done can be changed by setting the &%host_lookup_order%& option. For
8204 security, once Exim has found one or more names, it looks up the IP addresses
8205 for these names and compares them with the IP address that it started with.
8206 Only those names whose IP addresses match are accepted. Any other names are
8207 discarded. If no names are left, Exim behaves as if the host name cannot be
8208 found. In the most common case there is only one name and one IP address.
8210 There are some options that control what happens if a host name cannot be
8211 found. These are described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8213 .cindex "host" "alias for"
8214 .cindex "alias for host"
8215 As a result of aliasing, hosts may have more than one name. When processing any
8216 of the following types of pattern, all the host's names are checked:
8219 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
8220 If a pattern starts with &"*"& the remainder of the item must match the end of
8221 the host name. For example, &`*.b.c`& matches all hosts whose names end in
8222 &'.b.c'&. This special simple form is provided because this is a very common
8223 requirement. Other kinds of wildcarding require the use of a regular
8226 .cindex "regular expressions" "in host list"
8227 .cindex "host list" "regular expression in"
8228 If the item starts with &"^"& it is taken to be a regular expression which is
8229 matched against the host name. Host names are case-independent, so this regular
8230 expression match is by default case-independent, but you can make it
8231 case-dependent by starting it with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the
8232 syntax of regular expressions are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&. For
8237 is a regular expression that matches either of the two hosts &'a.c.d'& or
8238 &'b.c.d'&. When a regular expression is used in a host list, you must take care
8239 that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted as part of the
8240 string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`& to mark that
8241 part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
8243 sender_unqualified_hosts = \N^(a|b)\.c\.d$\N : ....
8245 &*Warning*&: If you want to match a complete host name, you must include the
8246 &`$`& terminating metacharacter in the regular expression, as in the above
8247 example. Without it, a match at the start of the host name is all that is
8254 .section "Behaviour when an IP address or name cannot be found" "SECTbehipnot"
8255 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, permanent"
8256 While processing a host list, Exim may need to look up an IP address from a
8257 name (see section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&), or it may need to look up a host name
8258 from an IP address (see section &<<SECThoslispatnam>>&). In either case, the
8259 behaviour when it fails to find the information it is seeking is the same.
8261 &*Note*&: This section applies to permanent lookup failures. It does &'not'&
8262 apply to temporary DNS errors, whose handling is described in the next section.
8264 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
8265 .cindex "&`+ignore_unknown`&"
8266 Exim parses a host list from left to right. If it encounters a permanent
8267 lookup failure in any item in the host list before it has found a match,
8268 Exim treats it as a failure and the default behavior is as if the host
8269 does not match the list. This may not always be what you want to happen.
8270 To change Exim's behaviour, the special items &`+include_unknown`& or
8271 &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the list (at top level &-- they are
8272 not recognized in an indirected file).
8275 If any item that follows &`+include_unknown`& requires information that
8276 cannot found, Exim behaves as if the host does match the list. For example,
8278 host_reject_connection = +include_unknown:*.enemy.ex
8280 rejects connections from any host whose name matches &`*.enemy.ex`&, and also
8281 any hosts whose name it cannot find.
8284 If any item that follows &`+ignore_unknown`& requires information that cannot
8285 be found, Exim ignores that item and proceeds to the rest of the list. For
8288 accept hosts = +ignore_unknown : friend.example : \
8291 accepts from any host whose name is &'friend.example'& and from 192.168.4.5,
8292 whether or not its host name can be found. Without &`+ignore_unknown`&, if no
8293 name can be found for 192.168.4.5, it is rejected.
8296 Both &`+include_unknown`& and &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the same
8297 list. The effect of each one lasts until the next, or until the end of the
8300 To explain the host/ip processing logic a different way for the same ACL:
8303 If you have name lookups or wildcarded host names and
8304 IP addresses in the same host list, you should normally put the IP
8305 addresses first. For example, in an ACL you could have:
8307 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : *.friend.example
8309 The reason you normally would order it this way lies in the
8310 left-to-right way that Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses
8311 without doing any DNS lookups, but when it reaches an item that requires
8312 a host name, it fails if it cannot find a host name to compare with the
8313 pattern. If the above list is given in the opposite order, the
8314 &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be found, even
8315 if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
8318 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
8319 address, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
8321 accept hosts = *.friend.example
8322 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
8324 If the first &%accept%& fails, Exim goes on to try the second one. See chapter
8325 &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs. Alternatively, you can use
8326 &`+ignore_unknown`&, which was discussed in depth in the first example in
8332 .section "Temporary DNS errors when looking up host information" &&&
8334 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, temporary"
8335 .cindex "&`+include_defer`&"
8336 .cindex "&`+ignore_defer`&"
8337 A temporary DNS lookup failure normally causes a defer action (except when
8338 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& converts it into a permanent error). However,
8339 host lists can include &`+ignore_defer`& and &`+include_defer`&, analagous to
8340 &`+ignore_unknown`& and &`+include_unknown`&, as described in the previous
8341 section. These options should be used with care, probably only in non-critical
8342 host lists such as whitelists.
8346 .section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host name" &&&
8347 "SECThoslispatnamsk"
8348 .cindex "unknown host name"
8349 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8350 If a pattern is of the form
8352 <&'single-key-search-type'&>;<&'search-data'&>
8356 dbm;/host/accept/list
8358 a single-key lookup is performed, using the host name as its key. If the
8359 lookup succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual data that is looked up
8362 &*Reminder*&: With this kind of pattern, you must have host &'names'& as
8363 keys in the file, not IP addresses. If you want to do lookups based on IP
8364 addresses, you must precede the search type with &"net-"& (see section
8365 &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&). There is, however, no reason why you could not use
8366 two items in the same list, one doing an address lookup and one doing a name
8367 lookup, both using the same file.
8371 .section "Host list patterns for query-style lookups" "SECID81"
8372 If a pattern is of the form
8374 <&'query-style-search-type'&>;<&'query'&>
8376 the query is obeyed, and if it succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual
8377 data that is looked up is not used. The variables &$sender_host_address$& and
8378 &$sender_host_name$& can be used in the query. For example:
8380 hosts_lookup = pgsql;\
8381 select ip from hostlist where ip='$sender_host_address'
8383 The value of &$sender_host_address$& for an IPv6 address contains colons. You
8384 can use the &%sg%& expansion item to change this if you need to. If you want to
8385 use masked IP addresses in database queries, you can use the &%mask%& expansion
8388 If the query contains a reference to &$sender_host_name$&, Exim automatically
8389 looks up the host name if it has not already done so. (See section
8390 &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& for comments on finding host names.)
8392 Historical note: prior to release 4.30, Exim would always attempt to find a
8393 host name before running the query, unless the search type was preceded by
8394 &`net-`&. This is no longer the case. For backwards compatibility, &`net-`& is
8395 still recognized for query-style lookups, but its presence or absence has no
8396 effect. (Of course, for single-key lookups, &`net-`& &'is'& important.
8397 See section &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&.)
8401 .section "Mixing wildcarded host names and addresses in host lists" &&&
8403 .cindex "host list" "mixing names and addresses in"
8404 If you have name lookups or wildcarded host names and IP addresses in the same
8405 host list, you should normally put the IP addresses first. For example, in an
8408 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : *.friend.example
8410 The reason for this lies in the left-to-right way that Exim processes lists.
8411 It can test IP addresses without doing any DNS lookups, but when it reaches an
8412 item that requires a host name, it fails if it cannot find a host name to
8413 compare with the pattern. If the above list is given in the opposite order, the
8414 &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be found, even if its
8415 IP address is 10.9.8.7.
8417 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
8418 address, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
8420 accept hosts = *.friend.example
8421 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
8423 If the first &%accept%& fails, Exim goes on to try the second one. See chapter
8424 &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs.
8430 .section "Address lists" "SECTaddresslist"
8431 .cindex "list" "address list"
8432 .cindex "address list" "empty item"
8433 .cindex "address list" "patterns"
8434 Address lists contain patterns that are matched against mail addresses. There
8435 is one special case to be considered: the sender address of a bounce message is
8436 always empty. You can test for this by providing an empty item in an address
8437 list. For example, you can set up a router to process bounce messages by
8438 using this option setting:
8442 The presence of the colon creates an empty item. If you do not provide any
8443 data, the list is empty and matches nothing. The empty sender can also be
8444 detected by a regular expression that matches an empty string,
8445 and by a query-style lookup that succeeds when &$sender_address$& is empty.
8447 Non-empty items in an address list can be straightforward email addresses. For
8450 senders = jbc@askone.example : hs@anacreon.example
8452 A certain amount of wildcarding is permitted. If a pattern contains an @
8453 character, but is not a regular expression and does not begin with a
8454 semicolon-terminated lookup type (described below), the local part of the
8455 subject address is compared with the local part of the pattern, which may start
8456 with an asterisk. If the local parts match, the domain is checked in exactly
8457 the same way as for a pattern in a domain list. For example, the domain can be
8458 wildcarded, refer to a named list, or be a lookup:
8460 deny senders = *@*.spamming.site:\
8461 *@+hostile_domains:\
8462 bozo@partial-lsearch;/list/of/dodgy/sites:\
8463 *@dbm;/bad/domains.db
8465 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
8466 .cindex "address list" "local part starting with !"
8467 If a local part that begins with an exclamation mark is required, it has to be
8468 specified using a regular expression, because otherwise the exclamation mark is
8469 treated as a sign of negation, as is standard in lists.
8471 If a non-empty pattern that is not a regular expression or a lookup does not
8472 contain an @ character, it is matched against the domain part of the subject
8473 address. The only two formats that are recognized this way are a literal
8474 domain, or a domain pattern that starts with *. In both these cases, the effect
8475 is the same as if &`*@`& preceded the pattern. For example:
8477 deny senders = enemy.domain : *.enemy.domain
8480 The following kinds of more complicated address list pattern can match any
8481 address, including the empty address that is characteristic of bounce message
8485 .cindex "regular expressions" "in address list"
8486 .cindex "address list" "regular expression in"
8487 If (after expansion) a pattern starts with &"^"&, a regular expression match is
8488 done against the complete address, with the pattern as the regular expression.
8489 You must take care that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted
8490 as part of the string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`&
8491 to mark that part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
8493 deny senders = \N^.*this.*@example\.com$\N : \
8494 \N^\d{8}.+@spamhaus.example$\N : ...
8496 The &`\N`& sequences are removed by the expansion, so these items do indeed
8497 start with &"^"& by the time they are being interpreted as address patterns.
8500 .cindex "address list" "lookup for complete address"
8501 Complete addresses can be looked up by using a pattern that starts with a
8502 lookup type terminated by a semicolon, followed by the data for the lookup. For
8505 deny senders = cdb;/etc/blocked.senders : \
8506 mysql;select address from blocked where \
8507 address='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'
8509 Both query-style and single-key lookup types can be used. For a single-key
8510 lookup type, Exim uses the complete address as the key. However, empty keys are
8511 not supported for single-key lookups, so a match against the empty address
8512 always fails. This restriction does not apply to query-style lookups.
8514 Partial matching for single-key lookups (section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&)
8515 cannot be used, and is ignored if specified, with an entry being written to the
8517 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
8518 However, you can configure lookup defaults, as described in section
8519 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&, but this is useful only for the &"*@"& type of
8520 default. For example, with this lookup:
8522 accept senders = lsearch*@;/some/file
8524 the file could contains lines like this:
8526 user1@domain1.example
8529 and for the sender address &'nimrod@jaeger.example'&, the sequence of keys
8532 nimrod@jaeger.example
8536 &*Warning 1*&: Do not include a line keyed by &"*"& in the file, because that
8537 would mean that every address matches, thus rendering the test useless.
8539 &*Warning 2*&: Do not confuse these two kinds of item:
8541 deny recipients = dbm*@;/some/file
8542 deny recipients = *@dbm;/some/file
8544 The first does a whole address lookup, with defaulting, as just described,
8545 because it starts with a lookup type. The second matches the local part and
8546 domain independently, as described in a bullet point below.
8550 The following kinds of address list pattern can match only non-empty addresses.
8551 If the subject address is empty, a match against any of these pattern types
8556 .cindex "@@ with single-key lookup"
8557 .cindex "address list" "@@ lookup type"
8558 .cindex "address list" "split local part and domain"
8559 If a pattern starts with &"@@"& followed by a single-key lookup item
8560 (for example, &`@@lsearch;/some/file`&), the address that is being checked is
8561 split into a local part and a domain. The domain is looked up in the file. If
8562 it is not found, there is no match. If it is found, the data that is looked up
8563 from the file is treated as a colon-separated list of local part patterns, each
8564 of which is matched against the subject local part in turn.
8566 .cindex "asterisk" "in address list"
8567 The lookup may be a partial one, and/or one involving a search for a default
8568 keyed by &"*"& (see section &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&). The local part
8569 patterns that are looked up can be regular expressions or begin with &"*"&, or
8570 even be further lookups. They may also be independently negated. For example,
8573 deny senders = @@dbm;/etc/reject-by-domain
8575 the data from which the DBM file is built could contain lines like
8577 baddomain.com: !postmaster : *
8579 to reject all senders except &%postmaster%& from that domain.
8581 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
8582 If a local part that actually begins with an exclamation mark is required, it
8583 has to be specified using a regular expression. In &(lsearch)& files, an entry
8584 may be split over several lines by indenting the second and subsequent lines,
8585 but the separating colon must still be included at line breaks. White space
8586 surrounding the colons is ignored. For example:
8588 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer2 : ^[0-9]+$ :
8591 As in all colon-separated lists in Exim, a colon can be included in an item by
8594 If the last item in the list starts with a right angle-bracket, the remainder
8595 of the item is taken as a new key to look up in order to obtain a continuation
8596 list of local parts. The new key can be any sequence of characters. Thus one
8597 might have entries like
8599 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer 2 : >*
8600 xyz.com: spammer3 : >*
8603 in a file that was searched with &%@@dbm*%&, to specify a match for 8-digit
8604 local parts for all domains, in addition to the specific local parts listed for
8605 each domain. Of course, using this feature costs another lookup each time a
8606 chain is followed, but the effort needed to maintain the data is reduced.
8608 .cindex "loop" "in lookups"
8609 It is possible to construct loops using this facility, and in order to catch
8610 them, the chains may be no more than fifty items long.
8613 The @@<&'lookup'&> style of item can also be used with a query-style
8614 lookup, but in this case, the chaining facility is not available. The lookup
8615 can only return a single list of local parts.
8618 &*Warning*&: There is an important difference between the address list items
8619 in these two examples:
8622 senders = *@+my_list
8624 In the first one, &`my_list`& is a named address list, whereas in the second
8625 example it is a named domain list.
8630 .section "Case of letters in address lists" "SECTcasletadd"
8631 .cindex "case of local parts"
8632 .cindex "address list" "case forcing"
8633 .cindex "case forcing in address lists"
8634 Domains in email addresses are always handled caselessly, but for local parts
8635 case may be significant on some systems (see &%caseful_local_part%& for how
8636 Exim deals with this when routing addresses). However, RFC 2505 (&'Anti-Spam
8637 Recommendations for SMTP MTAs'&) suggests that matching of addresses to
8638 blocking lists should be done in a case-independent manner. Since most address
8639 lists in Exim are used for this kind of control, Exim attempts to do this by
8642 The domain portion of an address is always lowercased before matching it to an
8643 address list. The local part is lowercased by default, and any string
8644 comparisons that take place are done caselessly. This means that the data in
8645 the address list itself, in files included as plain file names, and in any file
8646 that is looked up using the &"@@"& mechanism, can be in any case. However, the
8647 keys in files that are looked up by a search type other than &(lsearch)& (which
8648 works caselessly) must be in lower case, because these lookups are not
8651 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
8652 To allow for the possibility of caseful address list matching, if an item in
8653 an address list is the string &"+caseful"&, the original case of the local
8654 part is restored for any comparisons that follow, and string comparisons are no
8655 longer case-independent. This does not affect the domain, which remains in
8656 lower case. However, although independent matches on the domain alone are still
8657 performed caselessly, regular expressions that match against an entire address
8658 become case-sensitive after &"+caseful"& has been seen.
8662 .section "Local part lists" "SECTlocparlis"
8663 .cindex "list" "local part list"
8664 .cindex "local part" "list"
8665 Case-sensitivity in local part lists is handled in the same way as for address
8666 lists, as just described. The &"+caseful"& item can be used if required. In a
8667 setting of the &%local_parts%& option in a router with &%caseful_local_part%&
8668 set false, the subject is lowercased and the matching is initially
8669 case-insensitive. In this case, &"+caseful"& will restore case-sensitive
8670 matching in the local part list, but not elsewhere in the router. If
8671 &%caseful_local_part%& is set true in a router, matching in the &%local_parts%&
8672 option is case-sensitive from the start.
8674 If a local part list is indirected to a file (see section &<<SECTfilnamlis>>&),
8675 comments are handled in the same way as address lists &-- they are recognized
8676 only if the # is preceded by white space or the start of the line.
8677 Otherwise, local part lists are matched in the same way as domain lists, except
8678 that the special items that refer to the local host (&`@`&, &`@[]`&,
8679 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`&) are not recognized.
8680 Refer to section &<<SECTdomainlist>>& for details of the other available item
8682 .ecindex IIDdohoadli
8687 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8688 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8690 .chapter "String expansions" "CHAPexpand"
8691 .scindex IIDstrexp "expansion" "of strings"
8692 Many strings in Exim's run time configuration are expanded before use. Some of
8693 them are expanded every time they are used; others are expanded only once.
8695 When a string is being expanded it is copied verbatim from left to right except
8696 when a dollar or backslash character is encountered. A dollar specifies the
8697 start of a portion of the string that is interpreted and replaced as described
8698 below in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& onwards. Backslash is used as an
8699 escape character, as described in the following section.
8701 Whether a string is expanded depends upon the context. Usually this is solely
8702 dependent upon the option for which a value is sought; in this documentation,
8703 options for which string expansion is performed are marked with † after
8704 the data type. ACL rules always expand strings. A couple of expansion
8705 conditions do not expand some of the brace-delimited branches, for security
8710 .section "Literal text in expanded strings" "SECTlittext"
8711 .cindex "expansion" "including literal text"
8712 An uninterpreted dollar can be included in an expanded string by putting a
8713 backslash in front of it. A backslash can be used to prevent any special
8714 character being treated specially in an expansion, including backslash itself.
8715 If the string appears in quotes in the configuration file, two backslashes are
8716 required because the quotes themselves cause interpretation of backslashes when
8717 the string is read in (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&).
8719 .cindex "expansion" "non-expandable substrings"
8720 A portion of the string can specified as non-expandable by placing it between
8721 two occurrences of &`\N`&. This is particularly useful for protecting regular
8722 expressions, which often contain backslashes and dollar signs. For example:
8724 deny senders = \N^\d{8}[a-z]@some\.site\.example$\N
8726 On encountering the first &`\N`&, the expander copies subsequent characters
8727 without interpretation until it reaches the next &`\N`& or the end of the
8732 .section "Character escape sequences in expanded strings" "SECID82"
8733 .cindex "expansion" "escape sequences"
8734 A backslash followed by one of the letters &"n"&, &"r"&, or &"t"& in an
8735 expanded string is recognized as an escape sequence for the character newline,
8736 carriage return, or tab, respectively. A backslash followed by up to three
8737 octal digits is recognized as an octal encoding for a single character, and a
8738 backslash followed by &"x"& and up to two hexadecimal digits is a hexadecimal
8741 These escape sequences are also recognized in quoted strings when they are read
8742 in. Their interpretation in expansions as well is useful for unquoted strings,
8743 and for other cases such as looked-up strings that are then expanded.
8746 .section "Testing string expansions" "SECID83"
8747 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
8748 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
8750 Many expansions can be tested by calling Exim with the &%-be%& option. This
8751 takes the command arguments, or lines from the standard input if there are no
8752 arguments, runs them through the string expansion code, and writes the results
8753 to the standard output. Variables based on configuration values are set up, but
8754 since no message is being processed, variables such as &$local_part$& have no
8755 value. Nevertheless the &%-be%& option can be useful for checking out file and
8756 database lookups, and the use of expansion operators such as &%sg%&, &%substr%&
8759 Exim gives up its root privilege when it is called with the &%-be%& option, and
8760 instead runs under the uid and gid it was called with, to prevent users from
8761 using &%-be%& for reading files to which they do not have access.
8764 If you want to test expansions that include variables whose values are taken
8765 from a message, there are two other options that can be used. The &%-bem%&
8766 option is like &%-be%& except that it is followed by a file name. The file is
8767 read as a message before doing the test expansions. For example:
8769 exim -bem /tmp/test.message '$h_subject:'
8771 The &%-Mset%& option is used in conjunction with &%-be%& and is followed by an
8772 Exim message identifier. For example:
8774 exim -be -Mset 1GrA8W-0004WS-LQ '$recipients'
8776 This loads the message from Exim's spool before doing the test expansions, and
8777 is therefore restricted to admin users.
8780 .section "Forced expansion failure" "SECTforexpfai"
8781 .cindex "expansion" "forced failure"
8782 A number of expansions that are described in the following section have
8783 alternative &"true"& and &"false"& substrings, enclosed in brace characters
8784 (which are sometimes called &"curly brackets"&). Which of the two strings is
8785 used depends on some condition that is evaluated as part of the expansion. If,
8786 instead of a &"false"& substring, the word &"fail"& is used (not in braces),
8787 the entire string expansion fails in a way that can be detected by the code
8788 that requested the expansion. This is called &"forced expansion failure"&, and
8789 its consequences depend on the circumstances. In some cases it is no different
8790 from any other expansion failure, but in others a different action may be
8791 taken. Such variations are mentioned in the documentation of the option that is
8797 .section "Expansion items" "SECTexpansionitems"
8798 The following items are recognized in expanded strings. White space may be used
8799 between sub-items that are keywords or substrings enclosed in braces inside an
8800 outer set of braces, to improve readability. &*Warning*&: Within braces,
8801 white space is significant.
8804 .vitem &*$*&<&'variable&~name'&>&~or&~&*${*&<&'variable&~name'&>&*}*&
8805 .cindex "expansion" "variables"
8806 Substitute the contents of the named variable, for example:
8811 The second form can be used to separate the name from subsequent alphanumeric
8812 characters. This form (using braces) is available only for variables; it does
8813 &'not'& apply to message headers. The names of the variables are given in
8814 section &<<SECTexpvar>>& below. If the name of a non-existent variable is
8815 given, the expansion fails.
8817 .vitem &*${*&<&'op'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
8818 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
8819 The string is first itself expanded, and then the operation specified by
8820 <&'op'&> is applied to it. For example:
8824 The string starts with the first character after the colon, which may be
8825 leading white space. A list of operators is given in section &<<SECTexpop>>&
8826 below. The operator notation is used for simple expansion items that have just
8827 one argument, because it reduces the number of braces and therefore makes the
8828 string easier to understand.
8830 .vitem &*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
8831 This item inserts &"basic"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
8832 expansion item below.
8835 .vitem "&*${acl{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
8836 .cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
8837 .cindex "&%acl%&" "call from expansion"
8838 The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
8839 arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
8840 Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
8841 arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
8842 and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
8843 are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
8844 a value using a "message =" modifier and returns accept or deny, the value becomes
8845 the result of the expansion.
8846 If no message is set and the ACL returns accept or deny
8847 the expansion result is an empty string.
8848 If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail. Otherwise the expansion fails.
8851 .vitem "&*${dlfunc{*&<&'file'&>&*}{*&<&'function'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}&&&
8852 {*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
8854 This expansion dynamically loads and then calls a locally-written C function.
8855 This functionality is available only if Exim is compiled with
8859 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Once loaded, Exim remembers the dynamically loaded
8860 object so that it doesn't reload the same object file in the same Exim process
8861 (but of course Exim does start new processes frequently).
8863 There may be from zero to eight arguments to the function. When compiling
8864 a local function that is to be called in this way, &_local_scan.h_& should be
8865 included. The Exim variables and functions that are defined by that API
8866 are also available for dynamically loaded functions. The function itself
8867 must have the following type:
8869 int dlfunction(uschar **yield, int argc, uschar *argv[])
8871 Where &`uschar`& is a typedef for &`unsigned char`& in &_local_scan.h_&. The
8872 function should return one of the following values:
8874 &`OK`&: Success. The string that is placed in the variable &'yield'& is put
8875 into the expanded string that is being built.
8877 &`FAIL`&: A non-forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message taken
8878 from &'yield'&, if it is set.
8880 &`FAIL_FORCED`&: A forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message
8881 taken from &'yield'& if it is set.
8883 &`ERROR`&: Same as &`FAIL`&, except that a panic log entry is written.
8885 When compiling a function that is to be used in this way with gcc,
8886 you need to add &%-shared%& to the gcc command. Also, in the Exim build-time
8887 configuration, you must add &%-export-dynamic%& to EXTRALIBS.
8889 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
8890 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
8891 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by key"
8892 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by key"
8893 The key and <&'string1'&> are first expanded separately. Leading and trailing
8894 white space is removed from the key (but not from any of the strings). The key
8895 must not consist entirely of digits. The expanded <&'string1'&> must be of the
8898 <&'key1'&> = <&'value1'&> <&'key2'&> = <&'value2'&> ...
8901 where the equals signs and spaces (but not both) are optional. If any of the
8902 values contain white space, they must be enclosed in double quotes, and any
8903 values that are enclosed in double quotes are subject to escape processing as
8904 described in section &<<SECTstrings>>&. The expanded <&'string1'&> is searched
8905 for the value that corresponds to the key. The search is case-insensitive. If
8906 the key is found, <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
8907 otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
8908 variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
8909 is restored to any previous value it might have had.
8911 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
8912 key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
8913 extracted is used. Thus, for example, these two expansions are identical, and
8916 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}}
8917 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}{$value}}
8919 Instead of {<&'string3'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
8920 appear, for example:
8922 ${extract{Z}{A=... B=...}{$value} fail }
8924 This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
8925 {<&'string2'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
8928 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'number'&>&*}{*&<&'separators'&>&*}&&&
8929 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
8930 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by number"
8931 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by number"
8932 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
8933 apart from leading and trailing white space, which is ignored.
8934 This is what distinguishes this form of &%extract%& from the previous kind. It
8935 behaves in the same way, except that, instead of extracting a named field, it
8936 extracts from <&'string1'&> the field whose number is given as the first
8937 argument. You can use &$value$& in <&'string2'&> or &`fail`& instead of
8938 <&'string3'&> as before.
8940 The fields in the string are separated by any one of the characters in the
8941 separator string. These may include space or tab characters.
8942 The first field is numbered one. If the number is negative, the fields are
8943 counted from the end of the string, with the rightmost one numbered -1. If the
8944 number given is zero, the entire string is returned. If the modulus of the
8945 number is greater than the number of fields in the string, the result is the
8946 expansion of <&'string3'&>, or the empty string if <&'string3'&> is not
8947 provided. For example:
8949 ${extract{2}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
8953 ${extract{-4}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
8955 yields &"99"&. Two successive separators mean that the field between them is
8956 empty (for example, the fifth field above).
8959 .vitem &*${filter{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'condition'&>&*}}*&
8960 .cindex "list" "selecting by condition"
8961 .cindex "expansion" "selecting from list by condition"
8963 After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
8964 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way. For each item
8965 in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then the condition is
8966 evaluated. If the condition is true, &$item$& is added to the output as an
8967 item in a new list; if the condition is false, the item is discarded. The
8968 separator used for the output list is the same as the one used for the
8969 input, but a separator setting is not included in the output. For example:
8971 ${filter{a:b:c}{!eq{$item}{b}}
8973 yields &`a:c`&. At the end of the expansion, the value of &$item$& is restored
8974 to what it was before. See also the &*map*& and &*reduce*& expansion items.
8977 .vitem &*${hash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
8978 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
8979 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
8980 This is a textual hashing function, and was the first to be implemented in
8981 early versions of Exim. In current releases, there are other hashing functions
8982 (numeric, MD5, and SHA-1), which are described below.
8984 The first two strings, after expansion, must be numbers. Call them <&'m'&> and
8985 <&'n'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is, if
8986 <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you can
8987 use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
8989 ${hash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
8991 The second number is optional (in both notations). If <&'n'&> is greater than
8992 or equal to the length of the string, the expansion item returns the string.
8993 Otherwise it computes a new string of length <&'n'&> by applying a hashing
8994 function to the string. The new string consists of characters taken from the
8995 first <&'m'&> characters of the string
8997 abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyzABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQWRSTUVWXYZ0123456789
8999 If <&'m'&> is not present the value 26 is used, so that only lower case
9000 letters appear. For example:
9002 &`$hash{3}{monty}} `& yields &`jmg`&
9003 &`$hash{5}{monty}} `& yields &`monty`&
9004 &`$hash{4}{62}{monty python}}`& yields &`fbWx`&
9007 .vitem "&*$header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9008 &*$h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
9009 "&*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9010 &*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
9011 "&*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9012 &*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
9013 .cindex "expansion" "header insertion"
9014 .vindex "&$header_$&"
9015 .vindex "&$bheader_$&"
9016 .vindex "&$rheader_$&"
9017 .cindex "header lines" "in expansion strings"
9018 .cindex "header lines" "character sets"
9019 .cindex "header lines" "decoding"
9020 Substitute the contents of the named message header line, for example
9024 The newline that terminates a header line is not included in the expansion, but
9025 internal newlines (caused by splitting the header line over several physical
9026 lines) may be present.
9028 The difference between &%rheader%&, &%bheader%&, and &%header%& is in the way
9029 the data in the header line is interpreted.
9032 .cindex "white space" "in header lines"
9033 &%rheader%& gives the original &"raw"& content of the header line, with no
9034 processing at all, and without the removal of leading and trailing white space.
9037 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in header lines"
9038 &%bheader%& removes leading and trailing white space, and then decodes base64
9039 or quoted-printable MIME &"words"& within the header text, but does no
9040 character set translation. If decoding of what looks superficially like a MIME
9041 &"word"& fails, the raw string is returned. If decoding
9042 .cindex "binary zero" "in header line"
9043 produces a binary zero character, it is replaced by a question mark &-- this is
9044 what Exim does for binary zeros that are actually received in header lines.
9047 &%header%& tries to translate the string as decoded by &%bheader%& to a
9048 standard character set. This is an attempt to produce the same string as would
9049 be displayed on a user's MUA. If translation fails, the &%bheader%& string is
9050 returned. Translation is attempted only on operating systems that support the
9051 &[iconv()]& function. This is indicated by the compile-time macro HAVE_ICONV in
9052 a system Makefile or in &_Local/Makefile_&.
9055 In a filter file, the target character set for &%header%& can be specified by a
9056 command of the following form:
9058 headers charset "UTF-8"
9060 This command affects all references to &$h_$& (or &$header_$&) expansions in
9061 subsequently obeyed filter commands. In the absence of this command, the target
9062 character set in a filter is taken from the setting of the &%headers_charset%&
9063 option in the runtime configuration. The value of this option defaults to the
9064 value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The ultimate default is
9067 Header names follow the syntax of RFC 2822, which states that they may contain
9068 any printing characters except space and colon. Consequently, curly brackets
9069 &'do not'& terminate header names, and should not be used to enclose them as
9070 if they were variables. Attempting to do so causes a syntax error.
9072 Only header lines that are common to all copies of a message are visible to
9073 this mechanism. These are the original header lines that are received with the
9074 message, and any that are added by an ACL statement or by a system
9075 filter. Header lines that are added to a particular copy of a message by a
9076 router or transport are not accessible.
9078 For incoming SMTP messages, no header lines are visible in ACLs that are obeyed
9079 before the DATA ACL, because the header structure is not set up until the
9080 message is received. Header lines that are added in a RCPT ACL (for example)
9081 are saved until the message's incoming header lines are available, at which
9082 point they are added. When a DATA ACL is running, however, header lines added
9083 by earlier ACLs are visible.
9085 Upper case and lower case letters are synonymous in header names. If the
9086 following character is white space, the terminating colon may be omitted, but
9087 this is not recommended, because you may then forget it when it is needed. When
9088 white space terminates the header name, it is included in the expanded string.
9089 If the message does not contain the given header, the expansion item is
9090 replaced by an empty string. (See the &%def%& condition in section
9091 &<<SECTexpcond>>& for a means of testing for the existence of a header.)
9093 If there is more than one header with the same name, they are all concatenated
9094 to form the substitution string, up to a maximum length of 64K. Unless
9095 &%rheader%& is being used, leading and trailing white space is removed from
9096 each header before concatenation, and a completely empty header is ignored. A
9097 newline character is then inserted between non-empty headers, but there is no
9098 newline at the very end. For the &%header%& and &%bheader%& expansion, for
9099 those headers that contain lists of addresses, a comma is also inserted at the
9100 junctions between headers. This does not happen for the &%rheader%& expansion.
9103 .vitem &*${hmac{*&<&'hashname'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&
9104 .cindex "expansion" "hmac hashing"
9106 This function uses cryptographic hashing (either MD5 or SHA-1) to convert a
9107 shared secret and some text into a message authentication code, as specified in
9108 RFC 2104. This differs from &`${md5:secret_text...}`& or
9109 &`${sha1:secret_text...}`& in that the hmac step adds a signature to the
9110 cryptographic hash, allowing for authentication that is not possible with MD5
9111 or SHA-1 alone. The hash name must expand to either &`md5`& or &`sha1`& at
9112 present. For example:
9114 ${hmac{md5}{somesecret}{$primary_hostname $tod_log}}
9116 For the hostname &'mail.example.com'& and time 2002-10-17 11:30:59, this
9119 dd97e3ba5d1a61b5006108f8c8252953
9121 As an example of how this might be used, you might put in the main part of
9122 an Exim configuration:
9124 SPAMSCAN_SECRET=cohgheeLei2thahw
9126 In a router or a transport you could then have:
9129 X-Spam-Scanned: ${primary_hostname} ${message_exim_id} \
9130 ${hmac{md5}{SPAMSCAN_SECRET}\
9131 {${primary_hostname},${message_exim_id},$h_message-id:}}
9133 Then given a message, you can check where it was scanned by looking at the
9134 &'X-Spam-Scanned:'& header line. If you know the secret, you can check that
9135 this header line is authentic by recomputing the authentication code from the
9136 host name, message ID and the &'Message-id:'& header line. This can be done
9137 using Exim's &%-be%& option, or by other means, for example by using the
9138 &'hmac_md5_hex()'& function in Perl.
9141 .vitem &*${if&~*&<&'condition'&>&*&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9142 .cindex "expansion" "conditional"
9143 .cindex "&%if%&, expansion item"
9144 If <&'condition'&> is true, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the whole
9145 item; otherwise <&'string2'&> is used. The available conditions are described
9146 in section &<<SECTexpcond>>& below. For example:
9148 ${if eq {$local_part}{postmaster} {yes}{no} }
9150 The second string need not be present; if it is not and the condition is not
9151 true, the item is replaced with nothing. Alternatively, the word &"fail"& may
9152 be present instead of the second string (without any curly brackets). In this
9153 case, the expansion is forced to fail if the condition is not true (see section
9154 &<<SECTforexpfai>>&).
9156 If both strings are omitted, the result is the string &`true`& if the condition
9157 is true, and the empty string if the condition is false. This makes it less
9158 cumbersome to write custom ACL and router conditions. For example, instead of
9160 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}{true}{false}}
9164 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}}
9167 .vitem &*${length{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9168 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
9169 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
9170 The &%length%& item is used to extract the initial portion of a string. Both
9171 strings are expanded, and the first one must yield a number, <&'n'&>, say. If
9172 you are using a fixed value for the number, that is, if <&'string1'&> does not
9173 change when expanded, you can use the simpler operator notation that avoids
9176 ${length_<n>:<string>}
9178 The result of this item is either the first <&'n'&> characters or the whole
9179 of <&'string2'&>, whichever is the shorter. Do not confuse &%length%& with
9180 &%strlen%&, which gives the length of a string.
9183 .vitem "&*${lookup{*&<&'key'&>&*}&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~&&&
9184 {*&<&'file'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9185 This is the first of one of two different types of lookup item, which are both
9186 described in the next item.
9188 .vitem "&*${lookup&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~{*&<&'query'&>&*}&~&&&
9189 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9190 .cindex "expansion" "lookup in"
9191 .cindex "file" "lookups"
9192 .cindex "lookup" "in expanded string"
9193 The two forms of lookup item specify data lookups in files and databases, as
9194 discussed in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. The first form is used for single-key
9195 lookups, and the second is used for query-style lookups. The <&'key'&>,
9196 <&'file'&>, and <&'query'&> strings are expanded before use.
9198 If there is any white space in a lookup item which is part of a filter command,
9199 a retry or rewrite rule, a routing rule for the &(manualroute)& router, or any
9200 other place where white space is significant, the lookup item must be enclosed
9201 in double quotes. The use of data lookups in users' filter files may be locked
9202 out by the system administrator.
9205 If the lookup succeeds, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the entire item.
9206 During its expansion, the variable &$value$& contains the data returned by the
9207 lookup. Afterwards it reverts to the value it had previously (at the outer
9208 level it is empty). If the lookup fails, <&'string2'&> is expanded and replaces
9209 the entire item. If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted, the replacement is the empty
9210 string on failure. If <&'string2'&> is provided, it can itself be a nested
9211 lookup, thus providing a mechanism for looking up a default value when the
9212 original lookup fails.
9214 If a nested lookup is used as part of <&'string1'&>, &$value$& contains the
9215 data for the outer lookup while the parameters of the second lookup are
9216 expanded, and also while <&'string2'&> of the second lookup is expanded, should
9217 the second lookup fail. Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& can
9218 appear, and in this case, if the lookup fails, the entire expansion is forced
9219 to fail (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&). If both {<&'string1'&>} and
9220 {<&'string2'&>} are omitted, the result is the looked up value in the case of a
9221 successful lookup, and nothing in the case of failure.
9223 For single-key lookups, the string &"partial"& is permitted to precede the
9224 search type in order to do partial matching, and * or *@ may follow a search
9225 type to request default lookups if the key does not match (see sections
9226 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& and &<<SECTpartiallookup>>& for details).
9228 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in lookup expansion"
9229 If a partial search is used, the variables &$1$& and &$2$& contain the wild
9230 and non-wild parts of the key during the expansion of the replacement text.
9231 They return to their previous values at the end of the lookup item.
9233 This example looks up the postmaster alias in the conventional alias file:
9235 ${lookup {postmaster} lsearch {/etc/aliases} {$value}}
9237 This example uses NIS+ to look up the full name of the user corresponding to
9238 the local part of an address, forcing the expansion to fail if it is not found:
9240 ${lookup nisplus {[name=$local_part],passwd.org_dir:gcos} \
9245 .vitem &*${map{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9246 .cindex "expansion" "list creation"
9248 After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9249 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way. For each item
9250 in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then <&'string2'&> is
9251 expanded and added to the output as an item in a new list. The separator used
9252 for the output list is the same as the one used for the input, but a separator
9253 setting is not included in the output. For example:
9255 ${map{a:b:c}{[$item]}} ${map{<- x-y-z}{($item)}}
9257 expands to &`[a]:[b]:[c] (x)-(y)-(z)`&. At the end of the expansion, the
9258 value of &$item$& is restored to what it was before. See also the &*filter*&
9259 and &*reduce*& expansion items.
9261 .vitem &*${nhash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9262 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
9263 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
9264 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
9265 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
9266 if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
9267 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9269 ${nhash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9271 The second number is optional (in both notations). If there is only one number,
9272 the result is a number in the range 0&--<&'n'&>-1. Otherwise, the string is
9273 processed by a div/mod hash function that returns two numbers, separated by a
9274 slash, in the ranges 0 to <&'n'&>-1 and 0 to <&'m'&>-1, respectively. For
9277 ${nhash{8}{64}{supercalifragilisticexpialidocious}}
9279 returns the string &"6/33"&.
9283 .vitem &*${perl{*&<&'subroutine'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&
9284 .cindex "Perl" "use in expanded string"
9285 .cindex "expansion" "calling Perl from"
9286 This item is available only if Exim has been built to include an embedded Perl
9287 interpreter. The subroutine name and the arguments are first separately
9288 expanded, and then the Perl subroutine is called with those arguments. No
9289 additional arguments need be given; the maximum number permitted, including the
9290 name of the subroutine, is nine.
9292 The return value of the subroutine is inserted into the expanded string, unless
9293 the return value is &%undef%&. In that case, the expansion fails in the same
9294 way as an explicit &"fail"& on a lookup item. The return value is a scalar.
9295 Whatever you return is evaluated in a scalar context. For example, if you
9296 return the name of a Perl vector, the return value is the size of the vector,
9299 If the subroutine exits by calling Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails
9300 with the error message that was passed to &%die%&. More details of the embedded
9301 Perl facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
9303 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_perl%& which locks
9304 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9307 .vitem &*${prvs{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'keynumber'&>&*}}*&
9308 .cindex "&%prvs%& expansion item"
9309 The first argument is a complete email address and the second is secret
9310 keystring. The third argument, specifying a key number, is optional. If absent,
9311 it defaults to 0. The result of the expansion is a prvs-signed email address,
9312 to be typically used with the &%return_path%& option on an &(smtp)& transport
9313 as part of a bounce address tag validation (BATV) scheme. For more discussion
9314 and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
9316 .vitem "&*${prvscheck{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}&&&
9317 {*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&"
9318 .cindex "&%prvscheck%& expansion item"
9319 This expansion item is the complement of the &%prvs%& item. It is used for
9320 checking prvs-signed addresses. If the expansion of the first argument does not
9321 yield a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the whole item expands to the
9322 empty string. When the first argument does expand to a syntactically valid
9323 prvs-signed address, the second argument is expanded, with the prvs-decoded
9324 version of the address and the key number extracted from the address in the
9325 variables &$prvscheck_address$& and &$prvscheck_keynum$&, respectively.
9327 These two variables can be used in the expansion of the second argument to
9328 retrieve the secret. The validity of the prvs-signed address is then checked
9329 against the secret. The result is stored in the variable &$prvscheck_result$&,
9330 which is empty for failure or &"1"& for success.
9332 The third argument is optional; if it is missing, it defaults to an empty
9333 string. This argument is now expanded. If the result is an empty string, the
9334 result of the expansion is the decoded version of the address. This is the case
9335 whether or not the signature was valid. Otherwise, the result of the expansion
9336 is the expansion of the third argument.
9338 All three variables can be used in the expansion of the third argument.
9339 However, once the expansion is complete, only &$prvscheck_result$& remains set.
9340 For more discussion and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
9342 .vitem &*${readfile{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}}*&
9343 .cindex "expansion" "inserting an entire file"
9344 .cindex "file" "inserting into expansion"
9345 .cindex "&%readfile%& expansion item"
9346 The file name and end-of-line string are first expanded separately. The file is
9347 then read, and its contents replace the entire item. All newline characters in
9348 the file are replaced by the end-of-line string if it is present. Otherwise,
9349 newlines are left in the string.
9350 String expansion is not applied to the contents of the file. If you want this,
9351 you must wrap the item in an &%expand%& operator. If the file cannot be read,
9352 the string expansion fails.
9354 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readfile%& which
9355 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9359 .vitem "&*${readsocket{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'request'&>&*}&&&
9360 {*&<&'timeout'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}{*&<&'fail&~string'&>&*}}*&"
9361 .cindex "expansion" "inserting from a socket"
9362 .cindex "socket, use of in expansion"
9363 .cindex "&%readsocket%& expansion item"
9364 This item inserts data from a Unix domain or Internet socket into the expanded
9365 string. The minimal way of using it uses just two arguments, as in these
9368 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}}
9369 ${readsocket{inet:some.host:1234}{request string}}
9371 For a Unix domain socket, the first substring must be the path to the socket.
9372 For an Internet socket, the first substring must contain &`inet:`& followed by
9373 a host name or IP address, followed by a colon and a port, which can be a
9374 number or the name of a TCP port in &_/etc/services_&. An IP address may
9375 optionally be enclosed in square brackets. This is best for IPv6 addresses. For
9378 ${readsocket{inet:[::1]:1234}{request string}}
9380 Only a single host name may be given, but if looking it up yields more than
9381 one IP address, they are each tried in turn until a connection is made. For
9382 both kinds of socket, Exim makes a connection, writes the request string
9383 (unless it is an empty string) and reads from the socket until an end-of-file
9384 is read. A timeout of 5 seconds is applied. Additional, optional arguments
9385 extend what can be done. Firstly, you can vary the timeout. For example:
9387 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}}
9389 A fourth argument allows you to change any newlines that are in the data
9390 that is read, in the same way as for &%readfile%& (see above). This example
9391 turns them into spaces:
9393 ${readsocket{inet:127.0.0.1:3294}{request string}{3s}{ }}
9395 As with all expansions, the substrings are expanded before the processing
9396 happens. Errors in these sub-expansions cause the expansion to fail. In
9397 addition, the following errors can occur:
9400 Failure to create a socket file descriptor;
9402 Failure to connect the socket;
9404 Failure to write the request string;
9406 Timeout on reading from the socket.
9409 By default, any of these errors causes the expansion to fail. However, if
9410 you supply a fifth substring, it is expanded and used when any of the above
9411 errors occurs. For example:
9413 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}{\n}\
9416 You can test for the existence of a Unix domain socket by wrapping this
9417 expansion in &`${if exists`&, but there is a race condition between that test
9418 and the actual opening of the socket, so it is safer to use the fifth argument
9419 if you want to be absolutely sure of avoiding an expansion error for a
9420 non-existent Unix domain socket, or a failure to connect to an Internet socket.
9422 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readsocket%& which
9423 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9426 .vitem &*${reduce{*&<&'string1'&>}{<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9427 .cindex "expansion" "reducing a list to a scalar"
9428 .cindex "list" "reducing to a scalar"
9431 This operation reduces a list to a single, scalar string. After expansion,
9432 <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by default, but the
9433 separator can be changed in the usual way. Then <&'string2'&> is expanded and
9434 assigned to the &$value$& variable. After this, each item in the <&'string1'&>
9435 list is assigned to &$item$& in turn, and <&'string3'&> is expanded for each of
9436 them. The result of that expansion is assigned to &$value$& before the next
9437 iteration. When the end of the list is reached, the final value of &$value$& is
9438 added to the expansion output. The &*reduce*& expansion item can be used in a
9439 number of ways. For example, to add up a list of numbers:
9441 ${reduce {<, 1,2,3}{0}{${eval:$value+$item}}}
9443 The result of that expansion would be &`6`&. The maximum of a list of numbers
9446 ${reduce {3:0:9:4:6}{0}{${if >{$item}{$value}{$item}{$value}}}}
9448 At the end of a &*reduce*& expansion, the values of &$item$& and &$value$& are
9449 restored to what they were before. See also the &*filter*& and &*map*&
9452 .vitem &*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
9453 This item inserts &"raw"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
9454 expansion item above.
9456 .vitem "&*${run{*&<&'command'&>&*&~*&<&'args'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&&&
9457 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9458 .cindex "expansion" "running a command"
9459 .cindex "&%run%& expansion item"
9460 The command and its arguments are first expanded separately, and then the
9461 command is run in a separate process, but under the same uid and gid. As in
9462 other command executions from Exim, a shell is not used by default. If you want
9463 a shell, you must explicitly code it.
9465 The standard input for the command exists, but is empty. The standard output
9466 and standard error are set to the same file descriptor.
9467 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
9469 If the command succeeds (gives a zero return code) <&'string1'&> is expanded
9470 and replaces the entire item; during this expansion, the standard output/error
9471 from the command is in the variable &$value$&. If the command fails,
9472 <&'string2'&>, if present, is expanded and used. Once again, during the
9473 expansion, the standard output/error from the command is in the variable
9476 If <&'string2'&> is absent, the result is empty. Alternatively, <&'string2'&>
9477 can be the word &"fail"& (not in braces) to force expansion failure if the
9478 command does not succeed. If both strings are omitted, the result is contents
9479 of the standard output/error on success, and nothing on failure.
9481 .vindex "&$run_in_acl$&"
9482 The standard output/error of the command is put in the variable &$value$&.
9483 In this ACL example, the output of a command is logged for the admin to
9486 warn condition = ${run{/usr/bin/id}{yes}{no}}
9487 log_message = Output of id: $value
9489 If the command requires shell idioms, such as the > redirect operator, the
9490 shell must be invoked directly, such as with:
9492 ${run{/bin/bash -c "/usr/bin/id >/tmp/id"}{yes}{yes}}
9496 The return code from the command is put in the variable &$runrc$&, and this
9497 remains set afterwards, so in a filter file you can do things like this:
9499 if "${run{x y z}{}}$runrc" is 1 then ...
9500 elif $runrc is 2 then ...
9504 If execution of the command fails (for example, the command does not exist),
9505 the return code is 127 &-- the same code that shells use for non-existent
9508 &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot assume the order in which
9509 option values are expanded, except for those preconditions whose order of
9510 testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot reliably expect to set &$runrc$&
9511 by the expansion of one option, and use it in another.
9513 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_run%& which locks
9514 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9517 .vitem &*${sg{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'regex'&>&*}{*&<&'replacement'&>&*}}*&
9518 .cindex "expansion" "string substitution"
9519 .cindex "&%sg%& expansion item"
9520 This item works like Perl's substitution operator (s) with the global (/g)
9521 option; hence its name. However, unlike the Perl equivalent, Exim does not
9522 modify the subject string; instead it returns the modified string for insertion
9523 into the overall expansion. The item takes three arguments: the subject string,
9524 a regular expression, and a substitution string. For example:
9526 ${sg{abcdefabcdef}{abc}{xyz}}
9528 yields &"xyzdefxyzdef"&. Because all three arguments are expanded before use,
9529 if any $ or \ characters are required in the regular expression or in the
9530 substitution string, they have to be escaped. For example:
9532 ${sg{abcdef}{^(...)(...)\$}{\$2\$1}}
9534 yields &"defabc"&, and
9536 ${sg{1=A 4=D 3=C}{\N(\d+)=\N}{K\$1=}}
9538 yields &"K1=A K4=D K3=C"&. Note the use of &`\N`& to protect the contents of
9539 the regular expression from string expansion.
9543 .vitem &*${substr{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9544 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
9545 .cindex "substring extraction"
9546 .cindex "expansion" "substring extraction"
9547 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
9548 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
9549 if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
9550 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9552 ${substr_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9554 The second number is optional (in both notations).
9555 If it is absent in the simpler format, the preceding underscore must also be
9558 The &%substr%& item can be used to extract more general substrings than
9559 &%length%&. The first number, <&'n'&>, is a starting offset, and <&'m'&> is the
9560 length required. For example
9562 ${substr{3}{2}{$local_part}}
9564 If the starting offset is greater than the string length the result is the
9565 null string; if the length plus starting offset is greater than the string
9566 length, the result is the right-hand part of the string, starting from the
9567 given offset. The first character in the string has offset zero.
9569 The &%substr%& expansion item can take negative offset values to count
9570 from the right-hand end of its operand. The last character is offset -1, the
9571 second-last is offset -2, and so on. Thus, for example,
9573 ${substr{-5}{2}{1234567}}
9575 yields &"34"&. If the absolute value of a negative offset is greater than the
9576 length of the string, the substring starts at the beginning of the string, and
9577 the length is reduced by the amount of overshoot. Thus, for example,
9579 ${substr{-5}{2}{12}}
9581 yields an empty string, but
9583 ${substr{-3}{2}{12}}
9587 When the second number is omitted from &%substr%&, the remainder of the string
9588 is taken if the offset is positive. If it is negative, all characters in the
9589 string preceding the offset point are taken. For example, an offset of -1 and
9590 no length, as in these semantically identical examples:
9593 ${substr{-1}{abcde}}
9595 yields all but the last character of the string, that is, &"abcd"&.
9599 .vitem "&*${tr{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'characters'&>&*}&&&
9600 {*&<&'replacements'&>&*}}*&"
9601 .cindex "expansion" "character translation"
9602 .cindex "&%tr%& expansion item"
9603 This item does single-character translation on its subject string. The second
9604 argument is a list of characters to be translated in the subject string. Each
9605 matching character is replaced by the corresponding character from the
9606 replacement list. For example
9608 ${tr{abcdea}{ac}{13}}
9610 yields &`1b3de1`&. If there are duplicates in the second character string, the
9611 last occurrence is used. If the third string is shorter than the second, its
9612 last character is replicated. However, if it is empty, no translation takes
9618 .section "Expansion operators" "SECTexpop"
9619 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
9620 For expansion items that perform transformations on a single argument string,
9621 the &"operator"& notation is used because it is simpler and uses fewer braces.
9622 The substring is first expanded before the operation is applied to it. The
9623 following operations can be performed:
9626 .vitem &*${address:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9627 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
9628 .cindex "&%address%& expansion item"
9629 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address, as it might appear in a
9630 header line, and the effective address is extracted from it. If the string does
9631 not parse successfully, the result is empty.
9634 .vitem &*${addresses:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9635 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
9636 .cindex "&%addresses%& expansion item"
9637 The string (after expansion) is interpreted as a list of addresses in RFC
9638 2822 format, such as can be found in a &'To:'& or &'Cc:'& header line. The
9639 operative address (&'local-part@domain'&) is extracted from each item, and the
9640 result of the expansion is a colon-separated list, with appropriate
9641 doubling of colons should any happen to be present in the email addresses.
9642 Syntactically invalid RFC2822 address items are omitted from the output.
9644 It is possible to specify a character other than colon for the output
9645 separator by starting the string with > followed by the new separator
9646 character. For example:
9648 ${addresses:>& Chief <ceo@up.stairs>, sec@base.ment (dogsbody)}
9650 expands to &`ceo@up.stairs&&sec@base.ment`&. Compare the &*address*& (singular)
9651 expansion item, which extracts the working address from a single RFC2822
9652 address. See the &*filter*&, &*map*&, and &*reduce*& items for ways of
9655 To clarify "list of addresses in RFC 2822 format" mentioned above, Exim follows
9656 a strict interpretation of header line formatting. Exim parses the bare,
9657 unquoted portion of an email address and if it finds a comma, treats it as an
9658 email address seperator. For the example header line:
9660 From: =?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>
9662 The first example below demonstrates that Q-encoded email addresses are parsed
9663 properly if it is given the raw header (in this example, &`$rheader_from:`&).
9664 It does not see the comma because it's still encoded as "=2C". The second
9665 example below is passed the contents of &`$header_from:`&, meaning it gets
9666 de-mimed. Exim sees the decoded "," so it treats it as &*two*& email addresses.
9667 The third example shows that the presence of a comma is skipped when it is
9670 # exim -be '${addresses:From: \
9671 =?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>}'
9673 # exim -be '${addresses:From: Last, First <user@example.com>}'
9674 Last:user@example.com
9675 # exim -be '${addresses:From: "Last, First" <user@example.com>}'
9679 .vitem &*${base62:*&<&'digits'&>&*}*&
9680 .cindex "&%base62%& expansion item"
9681 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
9682 The string must consist entirely of decimal digits. The number is converted to
9683 base 62 and output as a string of six characters, including leading zeros. In
9684 the few operating environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for
9685 its message identifiers (because those systems do not have case-sensitive file
9686 names), base 36 is used by this operator, despite its name. &*Note*&: Just to
9687 be absolutely clear: this is &'not'& base64 encoding.
9689 .vitem &*${base62d:*&<&'base-62&~digits'&>&*}*&
9690 .cindex "&%base62d%& expansion item"
9691 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
9692 The string must consist entirely of base-62 digits, or, in operating
9693 environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for its message
9694 identifiers, base-36 digits. The number is converted to decimal and output as a
9698 .vitem &*${domain:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9699 .cindex "domain" "extraction"
9700 .cindex "expansion" "domain extraction"
9701 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the domain is extracted
9702 from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is empty.
9705 .vitem &*${escape:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9706 .cindex "expansion" "escaping non-printing characters"
9707 .cindex "&%escape%& expansion item"
9708 If the string contains any non-printing characters, they are converted to
9709 escape sequences starting with a backslash. Whether characters with the most
9710 significant bit set (so-called &"8-bit characters"&) count as printing or not
9711 is controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& option.
9714 .vitem &*${eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${eval10:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9715 .cindex "expansion" "expression evaluation"
9716 .cindex "expansion" "arithmetic expression"
9717 .cindex "&%eval%& expansion item"
9718 These items supports simple arithmetic and bitwise logical operations in
9719 expansion strings. The string (after expansion) must be a conventional
9720 arithmetic expression, but it is limited to basic arithmetic operators, bitwise
9721 logical operators, and parentheses. All operations are carried out using
9722 integer arithmetic. The operator priorities are as follows (the same as in the
9723 C programming language):
9725 .irow &'highest:'& "not (~), negate (-)"
9726 .irow "" "multiply (*), divide (/), remainder (%)"
9727 .irow "" "plus (+), minus (-)"
9728 .irow "" "shift-left (<<), shift-right (>>)"
9731 .irow &'lowest:'& "or (|)"
9733 Binary operators with the same priority are evaluated from left to right. White
9734 space is permitted before or after operators.
9736 For &%eval%&, numbers may be decimal, octal (starting with &"0"&) or
9737 hexadecimal (starting with &"0x"&). For &%eval10%&, all numbers are taken as
9738 decimal, even if they start with a leading zero; hexadecimal numbers are not
9739 permitted. This can be useful when processing numbers extracted from dates or
9740 times, which often do have leading zeros.
9742 A number may be followed by &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& to multiply it by 1024, 1024*1024
9744 respectively. Negative numbers are supported. The result of the computation is
9745 a decimal representation of the answer (without &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"&). For example:
9748 &`${eval:1+1} `& yields 2
9749 &`${eval:1+2*3} `& yields 7
9750 &`${eval:(1+2)*3} `& yields 9
9751 &`${eval:2+42%5} `& yields 4
9752 &`${eval:0xc&5} `& yields 4
9753 &`${eval:0xc|5} `& yields 13
9754 &`${eval:0xc^5} `& yields 9
9755 &`${eval:0xc>>1} `& yields 6
9756 &`${eval:0xc<<1} `& yields 24
9757 &`${eval:~255&0x1234} `& yields 4608
9758 &`${eval:-(~255&0x1234)} `& yields -4608
9761 As a more realistic example, in an ACL you might have
9763 deny message = Too many bad recipients
9766 {>{$rcpt_count}{10}} \
9769 {$recipients_count} \
9770 {${eval:$rcpt_count/2}} \
9774 The condition is true if there have been more than 10 RCPT commands and
9775 fewer than half of them have resulted in a valid recipient.
9778 .vitem &*${expand:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9779 .cindex "expansion" "re-expansion of substring"
9780 The &%expand%& operator causes a string to be expanded for a second time. For
9783 ${expand:${lookup{$domain}dbm{/some/file}{$value}}}
9785 first looks up a string in a file while expanding the operand for &%expand%&,
9786 and then re-expands what it has found.
9789 .vitem &*${from_utf8:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9791 .cindex "UTF-8" "conversion from"
9792 .cindex "expansion" "UTF-8 conversion"
9793 .cindex "&%from_utf8%& expansion item"
9794 The world is slowly moving towards Unicode, although there are no standards for
9795 email yet. However, other applications (including some databases) are starting
9796 to store data in Unicode, using UTF-8 encoding. This operator converts from a
9797 UTF-8 string to an ISO-8859-1 string. UTF-8 code values greater than 255 are
9798 converted to underscores. The input must be a valid UTF-8 string. If it is not,
9799 the result is an undefined sequence of bytes.
9801 Unicode code points with values less than 256 are compatible with ASCII and
9802 ISO-8859-1 (also known as Latin-1).
9803 For example, character 169 is the copyright symbol in both cases, though the
9804 way it is encoded is different. In UTF-8, more than one byte is needed for
9805 characters with code values greater than 127, whereas ISO-8859-1 is a
9806 single-byte encoding (but thereby limited to 256 characters). This makes
9807 translation from UTF-8 to ISO-8859-1 straightforward.
9810 .vitem &*${hash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9811 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
9812 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
9813 The &%hash%& operator is a simpler interface to the hashing function that can
9814 be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings that
9815 change when expanded). The effect is the same as
9817 ${hash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
9819 See the description of the general &%hash%& item above for details. The
9820 abbreviation &%h%& can be used when &%hash%& is used as an operator.
9824 .vitem &*${hex2b64:*&<&'hexstring'&>&*}*&
9825 .cindex "base64 encoding" "conversion from hex"
9826 .cindex "expansion" "hex to base64"
9827 .cindex "&%hex2b64%& expansion item"
9828 This operator converts a hex string into one that is base64 encoded. This can
9829 be useful for processing the output of the MD5 and SHA-1 hashing functions.
9833 .vitem &*${hexquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9834 .cindex "quoting" "hex-encoded unprintable characters"
9835 .cindex "&%hexquote%& expansion item"
9836 This operator converts non-printable characters in a string into a hex
9837 escape form. Byte values between 33 (!) and 126 (~) inclusive are left
9838 as is, and other byte values are converted to &`\xNN`&, for example a
9839 byt value 127 is converted to &`\x7f`&.
9842 .vitem &*${lc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9843 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
9844 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
9845 .cindex "lower casing"
9846 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
9847 .cindex "&%lc%& expansion item"
9848 This forces the letters in the string into lower-case, for example:
9853 .vitem &*${length_*&<&'number'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9854 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
9855 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
9856 The &%length%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%length%& function that
9857 can be used when the parameter is a fixed number (as opposed to a string that
9858 changes when expanded). The effect is the same as
9860 ${length{<number>}{<string>}}
9862 See the description of the general &%length%& item above for details. Note that
9863 &%length%& is not the same as &%strlen%&. The abbreviation &%l%& can be used
9864 when &%length%& is used as an operator.
9867 .vitem &*${listcount:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9868 .cindex "expansion" "list item count"
9869 .cindex "list" "item count"
9870 .cindex "list" "count of items"
9871 .cindex "&%listcount%& expansion item"
9872 The string is interpreted as a list and the number of items is returned.
9875 .vitem &*${listnamed:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${list_*&<&'type'&>&*name*&>&*}*&
9876 .cindex "expansion" "named list"
9877 .cindex "&%listnamed%& expansion item"
9878 The name is interpreted as a named list and the content of the list is returned,
9879 expanding any referenced lists, re-quoting as needed for colon-separation.
9880 If the optional type if given it must be one of "a", "d", "h" or "l"
9881 and selects address-, domain-, host- or localpart- lists to search among respectively.
9882 Otherwise all types are searched in an undefined order and the first
9883 matching list is returned.
9886 .vitem &*${local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9887 .cindex "expansion" "local part extraction"
9888 .cindex "&%local_part%& expansion item"
9889 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the local part is
9890 extracted from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is
9894 .vitem &*${mask:*&<&'IP&~address'&>&*/*&<&'bit&~count'&>&*}*&
9895 .cindex "masked IP address"
9896 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
9897 .cindex "CIDR notation"
9898 .cindex "expansion" "IP address masking"
9899 .cindex "&%mask%& expansion item"
9900 If the form of the string to be operated on is not an IP address followed by a
9901 slash and an integer (that is, a network address in CIDR notation), the
9902 expansion fails. Otherwise, this operator converts the IP address to binary,
9903 masks off the least significant bits according to the bit count, and converts
9904 the result back to text, with mask appended. For example,
9906 ${mask:10.111.131.206/28}
9908 returns the string &"10.111.131.192/28"&. Since this operation is expected to
9909 be mostly used for looking up masked addresses in files, the result for an IPv6
9910 address uses dots to separate components instead of colons, because colon
9911 terminates a key string in lsearch files. So, for example,
9913 ${mask:3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031/99}
9917 3ffe.ffff.836f.0a00.000a.0800.2000.0000/99
9919 Letters in IPv6 addresses are always output in lower case.
9922 .vitem &*${md5:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9924 .cindex "expansion" "MD5 hash"
9925 .cindex "&%md5%& expansion item"
9926 The &%md5%& operator computes the MD5 hash value of the string, and returns it
9927 as a 32-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in lower case.
9930 .vitem &*${nhash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9931 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
9932 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
9933 The &%nhash%& operator is a simpler interface to the numeric hashing function
9934 that can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to
9935 strings that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
9937 ${nhash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
9939 See the description of the general &%nhash%& item above for details.
9942 .vitem &*${quote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9943 .cindex "quoting" "in string expansions"
9944 .cindex "expansion" "quoting"
9945 .cindex "&%quote%& expansion item"
9946 The &%quote%& operator puts its argument into double quotes if it
9947 is an empty string or
9948 contains anything other than letters, digits, underscores, dots, and hyphens.
9949 Any occurrences of double quotes and backslashes are escaped with a backslash.
9950 Newlines and carriage returns are converted to &`\n`& and &`\r`&,
9951 respectively For example,
9959 The place where this is useful is when the argument is a substitution from a
9960 variable or a message header.
9962 .vitem &*${quote_local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9963 .cindex "&%quote_local_part%& expansion item"
9964 This operator is like &%quote%&, except that it quotes the string only if
9965 required to do so by the rules of RFC 2822 for quoting local parts. For
9966 example, a plus sign would not cause quoting (but it would for &%quote%&).
9967 If you are creating a new email address from the contents of &$local_part$&
9968 (or any other unknown data), you should always use this operator.
9971 .vitem &*${quote_*&<&'lookup-type'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9972 .cindex "quoting" "lookup-specific"
9973 This operator applies lookup-specific quoting rules to the string. Each
9974 query-style lookup type has its own quoting rules which are described with
9975 the lookups in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example,
9977 ${quote_ldap:two * two}
9983 For single-key lookup types, no quoting is ever necessary and this operator
9984 yields an unchanged string.
9987 .vitem &*${randint:*&<&'n'&>&*}*&
9988 .cindex "random number"
9989 This operator returns a somewhat random number which is less than the
9990 supplied number and is at least 0. The quality of this randomness depends
9991 on how Exim was built; the values are not suitable for keying material.
9992 If Exim is linked against OpenSSL then RAND_pseudo_bytes() is used.
9993 If Exim is linked against GnuTLS then gnutls_rnd(GNUTLS_RND_NONCE) is used,
9994 for versions of GnuTLS with that function.
9995 Otherwise, the implementation may be arc4random(), random() seeded by
9996 srandomdev() or srandom(), or a custom implementation even weaker than
10000 .vitem &*${reverse_ip:*&<&'ipaddr'&>&*}*&
10001 .cindex "expansion" "IP address"
10002 This operator reverses an IP address; for IPv4 addresses, the result is in
10003 dotted-quad decimal form, while for IPv6 addreses the result is in
10004 dotted-nibble hexadecimal form. In both cases, this is the "natural" form
10005 for DNS. For example,
10007 ${reverse_ip:192.0.2.4}
10008 ${reverse_ip:2001:0db8:c42:9:1:abcd:192.0.2.127}
10013 f.7.2.0.0.0.0.c.d.c.b.a.1.0.0.0.9.0.0.0.2.4.c.0.8.b.d.0.1.0.0.2
10017 .vitem &*${rfc2047:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10018 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
10019 .cindex "RFC 2047" "expansion operator"
10020 .cindex "&%rfc2047%& expansion item"
10021 This operator encodes text according to the rules of RFC 2047. This is an
10022 encoding that is used in header lines to encode non-ASCII characters. It is
10023 assumed that the input string is in the encoding specified by the
10024 &%headers_charset%& option, which defaults to ISO-8859-1. If the string
10025 contains only characters in the range 33&--126, and no instances of the
10028 ? = ( ) < > @ , ; : \ " . [ ] _
10030 it is not modified. Otherwise, the result is the RFC 2047 encoding of the
10031 string, using as many &"encoded words"& as necessary to encode all the
10035 .vitem &*${rfc2047d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10036 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
10037 .cindex "RFC 2047" "decoding"
10038 .cindex "&%rfc2047d%& expansion item"
10039 This operator decodes strings that are encoded as per RFC 2047. Binary zero
10040 bytes are replaced by question marks. Characters are converted into the
10041 character set defined by &%headers_charset%&. Overlong RFC 2047 &"words"& are
10042 not recognized unless &%check_rfc2047_length%& is set false.
10044 &*Note*&: If you use &%$header%&_&'xxx'&&*:*& (or &%$h%&_&'xxx'&&*:*&) to
10045 access a header line, RFC 2047 decoding is done automatically. You do not need
10046 to use this operator as well.
10050 .vitem &*${rxquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10051 .cindex "quoting" "in regular expressions"
10052 .cindex "regular expressions" "quoting"
10053 .cindex "&%rxquote%& expansion item"
10054 The &%rxquote%& operator inserts a backslash before any non-alphanumeric
10055 characters in its argument. This is useful when substituting the values of
10056 variables or headers inside regular expressions.
10059 .vitem &*${sha1:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10060 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
10061 .cindex "expansion" "SHA-1 hashing"
10062 .cindex "&%sha2%& expansion item"
10063 The &%sha1%& operator computes the SHA-1 hash value of the string, and returns
10064 it as a 40-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
10067 .vitem &*${stat:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10068 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
10069 .cindex "file" "extracting characteristics"
10070 .cindex "&%stat%& expansion item"
10071 The string, after expansion, must be a file path. A call to the &[stat()]&
10072 function is made for this path. If &[stat()]& fails, an error occurs and the
10073 expansion fails. If it succeeds, the data from the stat replaces the item, as a
10074 series of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> pairs, where the values are all numerical,
10075 except for the value of &"smode"&. The names are: &"mode"& (giving the mode as
10076 a 4-digit octal number), &"smode"& (giving the mode in symbolic format as a
10077 10-character string, as for the &'ls'& command), &"inode"&, &"device"&,
10078 &"links"&, &"uid"&, &"gid"&, &"size"&, &"atime"&, &"mtime"&, and &"ctime"&. You
10079 can extract individual fields using the &%extract%& expansion item.
10081 The use of the &%stat%& expansion in users' filter files can be locked out by
10082 the system administrator. &*Warning*&: The file size may be incorrect on 32-bit
10083 systems for files larger than 2GB.
10085 .vitem &*${str2b64:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10086 .cindex "expansion" "base64 encoding"
10087 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in string expansion"
10088 .cindex "&%str2b64%& expansion item"
10089 This operator converts a string into one that is base64 encoded.
10093 .vitem &*${strlen:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10094 .cindex "expansion" "string length"
10095 .cindex "string" "length in expansion"
10096 .cindex "&%strlen%& expansion item"
10097 The item is replace by the length of the expanded string, expressed as a
10098 decimal number. &*Note*&: Do not confuse &%strlen%& with &%length%&.
10101 .vitem &*${substr_*&<&'start'&>&*_*&<&'length'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10102 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
10103 .cindex "substring extraction"
10104 .cindex "expansion" "substring expansion"
10105 The &%substr%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%substr%& function that
10106 can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings
10107 that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10109 ${substr{<start>}{<length>}{<string>}}
10111 See the description of the general &%substr%& item above for details. The
10112 abbreviation &%s%& can be used when &%substr%& is used as an operator.
10114 .vitem &*${time_eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10115 .cindex "&%time_eval%& expansion item"
10116 .cindex "time interval" "decoding"
10117 This item converts an Exim time interval such as &`2d4h5m`& into a number of
10120 .vitem &*${time_interval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10121 .cindex "&%time_interval%& expansion item"
10122 .cindex "time interval" "formatting"
10123 The argument (after sub-expansion) must be a sequence of decimal digits that
10124 represents an interval of time as a number of seconds. It is converted into a
10125 number of larger units and output in Exim's normal time format, for example,
10128 .vitem &*${uc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10129 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
10130 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
10131 .cindex "upper casing"
10132 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
10133 .cindex "&%uc%& expansion item"
10134 This forces the letters in the string into upper-case.
10142 .section "Expansion conditions" "SECTexpcond"
10143 .scindex IIDexpcond "expansion" "conditions"
10144 The following conditions are available for testing by the &%${if%& construct
10145 while expanding strings:
10148 .vitem &*!*&<&'condition'&>
10149 .cindex "expansion" "negating a condition"
10150 .cindex "negation" "in expansion condition"
10151 Preceding any condition with an exclamation mark negates the result of the
10154 .vitem <&'symbolic&~operator'&>&~&*{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10155 .cindex "numeric comparison"
10156 .cindex "expansion" "numeric comparison"
10157 There are a number of symbolic operators for doing numeric comparisons. They
10163 &`>= `& greater or equal
10165 &`<= `& less or equal
10169 ${if >{$message_size}{10M} ...
10171 Note that the general negation operator provides for inequality testing. The
10172 two strings must take the form of optionally signed decimal integers,
10173 optionally followed by one of the letters &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& (in either upper or
10174 lower case), signifying multiplication by 1024, 1024*1024 or 1024*1024*1024, respectively.
10175 As a special case, the numerical value of an empty string is taken as
10178 In all cases, a relative comparator OP is testing if <&'string1'&> OP
10179 <&'string2'&>; the above example is checking if &$message_size$& is larger than
10180 10M, not if 10M is larger than &$message_size$&.
10183 .vitem &*acl&~{{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg1'&>&*}&&&
10184 {*&<&'arg2'&>&*}...}*&
10185 .cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
10186 .cindex "&%acl%&" "expansion condition"
10187 The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
10188 arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
10189 Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
10190 arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
10191 and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
10192 are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
10193 a value using a "message =" modifier the variable $value becomes
10194 the result of the expansion, otherwise it is empty.
10195 If the ACL returns accept the condition is true; if deny, false.
10196 If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail.
10198 .vitem &*bool&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10199 .cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
10200 .cindex "&%bool%& expansion condition"
10201 This condition turns a string holding a true or false representation into
10202 a boolean state. It parses &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"& and &"no"&
10203 (case-insensitively); also positive integer numbers map to true if non-zero,
10205 An empty string is treated as false.
10206 Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored;
10207 thus a string consisting only of whitespace is false.
10208 All other string values will result in expansion failure.
10210 When combined with ACL variables, this expansion condition will let you
10211 make decisions in one place and act on those decisions in another place.
10214 ${if bool{$acl_m_privileged_sender} ...
10218 .vitem &*bool_lax&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10219 .cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
10220 .cindex "&%bool_lax%& expansion condition"
10221 Like &%bool%&, this condition turns a string into a boolean state. But
10222 where &%bool%& accepts a strict set of strings, &%bool_lax%& uses the same
10223 loose definition that the Router &%condition%& option uses. The empty string
10224 and the values &"false"&, &"no"& and &"0"& map to false, all others map to
10225 true. Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored.
10227 Note that where &"bool{00}"& is false, &"bool_lax{00}"& is true.
10229 .vitem &*crypteq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10230 .cindex "expansion" "encrypted comparison"
10231 .cindex "encrypted strings, comparing"
10232 .cindex "&%crypteq%& expansion condition"
10233 This condition is included in the Exim binary if it is built to support any
10234 authentication mechanisms (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). Otherwise, it is
10235 necessary to define SUPPORT_CRYPTEQ in &_Local/Makefile_& to get &%crypteq%&
10236 included in the binary.
10238 The &%crypteq%& condition has two arguments. The first is encrypted and
10239 compared against the second, which is already encrypted. The second string may
10240 be in the LDAP form for storing encrypted strings, which starts with the
10241 encryption type in curly brackets, followed by the data. If the second string
10242 does not begin with &"{"& it is assumed to be encrypted with &[crypt()]& or
10243 &[crypt16()]& (see below), since such strings cannot begin with &"{"&.
10244 Typically this will be a field from a password file. An example of an encrypted
10245 string in LDAP form is:
10247 {md5}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==
10249 If such a string appears directly in an expansion, the curly brackets have to
10250 be quoted, because they are part of the expansion syntax. For example:
10252 ${if crypteq {test}{\{md5\}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==}{yes}{no}}
10254 The following encryption types (whose names are matched case-independently) are
10259 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in encrypted password"
10260 &%{md5}%& computes the MD5 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
10261 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
10262 length of the comparison string is 24, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded
10263 (as in the above example). If the length is 32, Exim assumes that it is a
10264 hexadecimal encoding of the MD5 digest. If the length not 24 or 32, the
10268 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
10269 &%{sha1}%& computes the SHA-1 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
10270 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
10271 length of the comparison string is 28, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded.
10272 If the length is 40, Exim assumes that it is a hexadecimal encoding of the
10273 SHA-1 digest. If the length is not 28 or 40, the comparison fails.
10276 .cindex "&[crypt()]&"
10277 &%{crypt}%& calls the &[crypt()]& function, which traditionally used to use
10278 only the first eight characters of the password. However, in modern operating
10279 systems this is no longer true, and in many cases the entire password is used,
10280 whatever its length.
10283 .cindex "&[crypt16()]&"
10284 &%{crypt16}%& calls the &[crypt16()]& function, which was originally created to
10285 use up to 16 characters of the password in some operating systems. Again, in
10286 modern operating systems, more characters may be used.
10288 Exim has its own version of &[crypt16()]&, which is just a double call to
10289 &[crypt()]&. For operating systems that have their own version, setting
10290 HAVE_CRYPT16 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim causes it to use the
10291 operating system version instead of its own. This option is set by default in
10292 the OS-dependent &_Makefile_& for those operating systems that are known to
10293 support &[crypt16()]&.
10295 Some years after Exim's &[crypt16()]& was implemented, a user discovered that
10296 it was not using the same algorithm as some operating systems' versions. It
10297 turns out that as well as &[crypt16()]& there is a function called
10298 &[bigcrypt()]& in some operating systems. This may or may not use the same
10299 algorithm, and both of them may be different to Exim's built-in &[crypt16()]&.
10301 However, since there is now a move away from the traditional &[crypt()]&
10302 functions towards using SHA1 and other algorithms, tidying up this area of
10303 Exim is seen as very low priority.
10305 If you do not put a encryption type (in curly brackets) in a &%crypteq%&
10306 comparison, the default is usually either &`{crypt}`& or &`{crypt16}`&, as
10307 determined by the setting of DEFAULT_CRYPT in &_Local/Makefile_&. The default
10308 default is &`{crypt}`&. Whatever the default, you can always use either
10309 function by specifying it explicitly in curly brackets.
10311 .vitem &*def:*&<&'variable&~name'&>
10312 .cindex "expansion" "checking for empty variable"
10313 .cindex "&%def%& expansion condition"
10314 The &%def%& condition must be followed by the name of one of the expansion
10315 variables defined in section &<<SECTexpvar>>&. The condition is true if the
10316 variable does not contain the empty string. For example:
10318 ${if def:sender_ident {from $sender_ident}}
10320 Note that the variable name is given without a leading &%$%& character. If the
10321 variable does not exist, the expansion fails.
10323 .vitem "&*def:header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~&~or&~&&&
10324 &~&*def:h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
10325 .cindex "expansion" "checking header line existence"
10326 This condition is true if a message is being processed and the named header
10327 exists in the message. For example,
10329 ${if def:header_reply-to:{$h_reply-to:}{$h_from:}}
10331 &*Note*&: No &%$%& appears before &%header_%& or &%h_%& in the condition, and
10332 the header name must be terminated by a colon if white space does not follow.
10334 .vitem &*eq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10335 &*eqi&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10336 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10337 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10338 .cindex "&%eq%& expansion condition"
10339 .cindex "&%eqi%& expansion condition"
10340 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the two
10341 resulting strings are identical. For &%eq%& the comparison includes the case of
10342 letters, whereas for &%eqi%& the comparison is case-independent.
10344 .vitem &*exists&~{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}*&
10345 .cindex "expansion" "file existence test"
10346 .cindex "file" "existence test"
10347 .cindex "&%exists%&, expansion condition"
10348 The substring is first expanded and then interpreted as an absolute path. The
10349 condition is true if the named file (or directory) exists. The existence test
10350 is done by calling the &[stat()]& function. The use of the &%exists%& test in
10351 users' filter files may be locked out by the system administrator.
10353 .vitem &*first_delivery*&
10354 .cindex "delivery" "first"
10355 .cindex "first delivery"
10356 .cindex "expansion" "first delivery test"
10357 .cindex "&%first_delivery%& expansion condition"
10358 This condition, which has no data, is true during a message's first delivery
10359 attempt. It is false during any subsequent delivery attempts.
10362 .vitem "&*forall{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
10363 "&*forany{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&"
10364 .cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
10365 .cindex "expansion" "&*forall*& condition"
10366 .cindex "expansion" "&*forany*& condition"
10368 These conditions iterate over a list. The first argument is expanded to form
10369 the list. By default, the list separator is a colon, but it can be changed by
10370 the normal method. The second argument is interpreted as a condition that is to
10371 be applied to each item in the list in turn. During the interpretation of the
10372 condition, the current list item is placed in a variable called &$item$&.
10374 For &*forany*&, interpretation stops if the condition is true for any item, and
10375 the result of the whole condition is true. If the condition is false for all
10376 items in the list, the overall condition is false.
10378 For &*forall*&, interpretation stops if the condition is false for any item,
10379 and the result of the whole condition is false. If the condition is true for
10380 all items in the list, the overall condition is true.
10382 Note that negation of &*forany*& means that the condition must be false for all
10383 items for the overall condition to succeed, and negation of &*forall*& means
10384 that the condition must be false for at least one item. In this example, the
10385 list separator is changed to a comma:
10387 ${if forany{<, $recipients}{match{$item}{^user3@}}{yes}{no}}
10389 The value of &$item$& is saved and restored while &*forany*& or &*forall*& is
10390 being processed, to enable these expansion items to be nested.
10392 To scan a named list, expand it with the &*listnamed*& operator.
10395 .vitem &*ge&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10396 &*gei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10397 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10398 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10399 .cindex "&%ge%& expansion condition"
10400 .cindex "&%gei%& expansion condition"
10401 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10402 string is lexically greater than or equal to the second string. For &%ge%& the
10403 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gei%& the comparison is
10406 .vitem &*gt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10407 &*gti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10408 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10409 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10410 .cindex "&%gt%& expansion condition"
10411 .cindex "&%gti%& expansion condition"
10412 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10413 string is lexically greater than the second string. For &%gt%& the comparison
10414 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gti%& the comparison is
10417 .vitem &*inlist&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10418 &*inlisti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10419 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10420 .cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
10421 Both strings are expanded; the second string is treated as a list of simple
10422 strings; if the first string is a member of the second, then the condition
10425 These are simpler to use versions of the more powerful &*forany*& condition.
10426 Examples, and the &*forany*& equivalents:
10428 ${if inlist{needle}{foo:needle:bar}}
10429 ${if forany{foo:needle:bar}{eq{$item}{needle}}}
10430 ${if inlisti{Needle}{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}}
10431 ${if forany{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}{eqi{$item}{Needle}}}
10434 .vitem &*isip&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
10435 &*isip4&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
10436 &*isip6&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10437 .cindex "IP address" "testing string format"
10438 .cindex "string" "testing for IP address"
10439 .cindex "&%isip%& expansion condition"
10440 .cindex "&%isip4%& expansion condition"
10441 .cindex "&%isip6%& expansion condition"
10442 The substring is first expanded, and then tested to see if it has the form of
10443 an IP address. Both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses are valid for &%isip%&, whereas
10444 &%isip4%& and &%isip6%& test specifically for IPv4 or IPv6 addresses.
10446 For an IPv4 address, the test is for four dot-separated components, each of
10447 which consists of from one to three digits. For an IPv6 address, up to eight
10448 colon-separated components are permitted, each containing from one to four
10449 hexadecimal digits. There may be fewer than eight components if an empty
10450 component (adjacent colons) is present. Only one empty component is permitted.
10452 &*Note*&: The checks are just on the form of the address; actual numerical
10453 values are not considered. Thus, for example, 999.999.999.999 passes the IPv4
10454 check. The main use of these tests is to distinguish between IP addresses and
10455 host names, or between IPv4 and IPv6 addresses. For example, you could use
10457 ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}...
10459 to test which IP version an incoming SMTP connection is using.
10461 .vitem &*ldapauth&~{*&<&'ldap&~query'&>&*}*&
10462 .cindex "LDAP" "use for authentication"
10463 .cindex "expansion" "LDAP authentication test"
10464 .cindex "&%ldapauth%& expansion condition"
10465 This condition supports user authentication using LDAP. See section
10466 &<<SECTldap>>& for details of how to use LDAP in lookups and the syntax of
10467 queries. For this use, the query must contain a user name and password. The
10468 query itself is not used, and can be empty. The condition is true if the
10469 password is not empty, and the user name and password are accepted by the LDAP
10470 server. An empty password is rejected without calling LDAP because LDAP binds
10471 with an empty password are considered anonymous regardless of the username, and
10472 will succeed in most configurations. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details
10473 of SMTP authentication, and chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& for an example of how
10477 .vitem &*le&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10478 &*lei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10479 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10480 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10481 .cindex "&%le%& expansion condition"
10482 .cindex "&%lei%& expansion condition"
10483 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10484 string is lexically less than or equal to the second string. For &%le%& the
10485 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lei%& the comparison is
10488 .vitem &*lt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10489 &*lti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10490 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10491 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10492 .cindex "&%lt%& expansion condition"
10493 .cindex "&%lti%& expansion condition"
10494 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10495 string is lexically less than the second string. For &%lt%& the comparison
10496 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lti%& the comparison is
10500 .vitem &*match&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10501 .cindex "expansion" "regular expression comparison"
10502 .cindex "regular expressions" "match in expanded string"
10503 .cindex "&%match%& expansion condition"
10504 The two substrings are first expanded. The second is then treated as a regular
10505 expression and applied to the first. Because of the pre-expansion, if the
10506 regular expression contains dollar, or backslash characters, they must be
10507 escaped. Care must also be taken if the regular expression contains braces
10508 (curly brackets). A closing brace must be escaped so that it is not taken as a
10509 premature termination of <&'string2'&>. The easiest approach is to use the
10510 &`\N`& feature to disable expansion of the regular expression.
10513 ${if match {$local_part}{\N^\d{3}\N} ...
10515 If the whole expansion string is in double quotes, further escaping of
10516 backslashes is also required.
10518 The condition is true if the regular expression match succeeds.
10519 The regular expression is not required to begin with a circumflex
10520 metacharacter, but if there is no circumflex, the expression is not anchored,
10521 and it may match anywhere in the subject, not just at the start. If you want
10522 the pattern to match at the end of the subject, you must include the &`$`&
10523 metacharacter at an appropriate point.
10525 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%if%& expansion"
10526 At the start of an &%if%& expansion the values of the numeric variable
10527 substitutions &$1$& etc. are remembered. Obeying a &%match%& condition that
10528 succeeds causes them to be reset to the substrings of that condition and they
10529 will have these values during the expansion of the success string. At the end
10530 of the &%if%& expansion, the previous values are restored. After testing a
10531 combination of conditions using &%or%&, the subsequent values of the numeric
10532 variables are those of the condition that succeeded.
10534 .vitem &*match_address&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10535 .cindex "&%match_address%& expansion condition"
10536 See &*match_local_part*&.
10538 .vitem &*match_domain&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10539 .cindex "&%match_domain%& expansion condition"
10540 See &*match_local_part*&.
10542 .vitem &*match_ip&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10543 .cindex "&%match_ip%& expansion condition"
10544 This condition matches an IP address to a list of IP address patterns. It must
10545 be followed by two argument strings. The first (after expansion) must be an IP
10546 address or an empty string. The second (not expanded) is a restricted host
10547 list that can match only an IP address, not a host name. For example:
10549 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{1.2.3.4:5.6.7.8}{...}{...}}
10551 The specific types of host list item that are permitted in the list are:
10554 An IP address, optionally with a CIDR mask.
10556 A single asterisk, which matches any IP address.
10558 An empty item, which matches only if the IP address is empty. This could be
10559 useful for testing for a locally submitted message or one from specific hosts
10560 in a single test such as
10561 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
10562 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. This comment applies to
10563 . ==== the use of xmlto plus fop. There's no problem when formatting with
10564 . ==== sdop, with or without the extra indent.
10566 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{:4.3.2.1:...}{...}{...}}
10568 where the first item in the list is the empty string.
10570 The item @[] matches any of the local host's interface addresses.
10572 Single-key lookups are assumed to be like &"net-"& style lookups in host lists,
10573 even if &`net-`& is not specified. There is never any attempt to turn the IP
10574 address into a host name. The most common type of linear search for
10575 &*match_ip*& is likely to be &*iplsearch*&, in which the file can contain CIDR
10576 masks. For example:
10578 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{iplsearch;/some/file}...
10580 It is of course possible to use other kinds of lookup, and in such a case, you
10581 do need to specify the &`net-`& prefix if you want to specify a specific
10582 address mask, for example:
10584 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{net24-dbm;/some/file}...
10586 However, unless you are combining a &%match_ip%& condition with others, it is
10587 just as easy to use the fact that a lookup is itself a condition, and write:
10589 ${lookup{${mask:$sender_host_address/24}}dbm{/a/file}...
10593 Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
10594 Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
10596 Consult section &<<SECThoslispatip>>& for further details of these patterns.
10598 .vitem &*match_local_part&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10599 .cindex "domain list" "in expansion condition"
10600 .cindex "address list" "in expansion condition"
10601 .cindex "local part" "list, in expansion condition"
10602 .cindex "&%match_local_part%& expansion condition"
10603 This condition, together with &%match_address%& and &%match_domain%&, make it
10604 possible to test domain, address, and local part lists within expansions. Each
10605 condition requires two arguments: an item and a list to match. A trivial
10608 ${if match_domain{a.b.c}{x.y.z:a.b.c:p.q.r}{yes}{no}}
10610 In each case, the second argument may contain any of the allowable items for a
10611 list of the appropriate type. Also, because the second argument (after
10612 expansion) is a standard form of list, it is possible to refer to a named list.
10613 Thus, you can use conditions like this:
10615 ${if match_domain{$domain}{+local_domains}{...
10617 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
10618 For address lists, the matching starts off caselessly, but the &`+caseful`&
10619 item can be used, as in all address lists, to cause subsequent items to
10620 have their local parts matched casefully. Domains are always matched
10623 Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
10624 Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
10626 &*Note*&: Host lists are &'not'& supported in this way. This is because
10627 hosts have two identities: a name and an IP address, and it is not clear
10628 how to specify cleanly how such a test would work. However, IP addresses can be
10629 matched using &%match_ip%&.
10631 .vitem &*pam&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*:...}*&
10632 .cindex "PAM authentication"
10633 .cindex "AUTH" "with PAM"
10634 .cindex "Solaris" "PAM support"
10635 .cindex "expansion" "PAM authentication test"
10636 .cindex "&%pam%& expansion condition"
10637 &'Pluggable Authentication Modules'&
10638 (&url(http://www.kernel.org/pub/linux/libs/pam/)) are a facility that is
10639 available in the latest releases of Solaris and in some GNU/Linux
10640 distributions. The Exim support, which is intended for use in conjunction with
10641 the SMTP AUTH command, is available only if Exim is compiled with
10645 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You probably need to add &%-lpam%& to EXTRALIBS, and
10646 in some releases of GNU/Linux &%-ldl%& is also needed.
10648 The argument string is first expanded, and the result must be a
10649 colon-separated list of strings. Leading and trailing white space is ignored.
10650 The PAM module is initialized with the service name &"exim"& and the user name
10651 taken from the first item in the colon-separated data string (<&'string1'&>).
10652 The remaining items in the data string are passed over in response to requests
10653 from the authentication function. In the simple case there will only be one
10654 request, for a password, so the data consists of just two strings.
10656 There can be problems if any of the strings are permitted to contain colon
10657 characters. In the usual way, these have to be doubled to avoid being taken as
10658 separators. If the data is being inserted from a variable, the &%sg%& expansion
10659 item can be used to double any existing colons. For example, the configuration
10660 of a LOGIN authenticator might contain this setting:
10662 server_condition = ${if pam{$auth1:${sg{$auth2}{:}{::}}}}
10664 For a PLAIN authenticator you could use:
10666 server_condition = ${if pam{$auth2:${sg{$auth3}{:}{::}}}}
10668 In some operating systems, PAM authentication can be done only from a process
10669 running as root. Since Exim is running as the Exim user when receiving
10670 messages, this means that PAM cannot be used directly in those systems.
10671 A patched version of the &'pam_unix'& module that comes with the
10672 Linux PAM package is available from &url(http://www.e-admin.de/pam_exim/).
10673 The patched module allows one special uid/gid combination, in addition to root,
10674 to authenticate. If you build the patched module to allow the Exim user and
10675 group, PAM can then be used from an Exim authenticator.
10678 .vitem &*pwcheck&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10679 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
10681 .cindex "expansion" "&'pwcheck'& authentication test"
10682 .cindex "&%pwcheck%& expansion condition"
10683 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& daemon.
10684 This is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked by a process
10685 that is not running as root. &*Note*&: The use of &'pwcheck'& is now
10686 deprecated. Its replacement is &'saslauthd'& (see below).
10688 The pwcheck support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
10689 the location of the pwcheck daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
10690 building Exim. For example:
10692 CYRUS_PWCHECK_SOCKET=/var/pwcheck/pwcheck
10694 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
10695 the pwcheck daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
10696 from the Cyrus SASL library. Ensure that &'exim'& is the only user that has
10697 access to the &_/var/pwcheck_& directory.
10699 The &%pwcheck%& condition takes one argument, which must be the user name and
10700 password, separated by a colon. For example, in a LOGIN authenticator
10701 configuration, you might have this:
10703 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth1:$auth2}}
10705 Again, for a PLAIN authenticator configuration, this would be:
10707 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth2:$auth3}}
10709 .vitem &*queue_running*&
10710 .cindex "queue runner" "detecting when delivering from"
10711 .cindex "expansion" "queue runner test"
10712 .cindex "&%queue_running%& expansion condition"
10713 This condition, which has no data, is true during delivery attempts that are
10714 initiated by queue runner processes, and false otherwise.
10717 .vitem &*radius&~{*&<&'authentication&~string'&>&*}*&
10719 .cindex "expansion" "Radius authentication"
10720 .cindex "&%radius%& expansion condition"
10721 Radius authentication (RFC 2865) is supported in a similar way to PAM. You must
10722 set RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& to specify the location of
10723 the Radius client configuration file in order to build Exim with Radius
10726 With just that one setting, Exim expects to be linked with the &%radiusclient%&
10727 library, using the original API. If you are using release 0.4.0 or later of
10728 this library, you need to set
10730 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADIUSCLIENTNEW
10732 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim. You can also link Exim with the
10733 &%libradius%& library that comes with FreeBSD. To do this, set
10735 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADLIB
10737 in &_Local/Makefile_&, in addition to setting RADIUS_CONFIGURE_FILE.
10738 You may also have to supply a suitable setting in EXTRALIBS so that the
10739 Radius library can be found when Exim is linked.
10741 The string specified by RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE is expanded and passed to the
10742 Radius client library, which calls the Radius server. The condition is true if
10743 the authentication is successful. For example:
10745 server_condition = ${if radius{<arguments>}}
10749 .vitem "&*saslauthd&~{{*&<&'user'&>&*}{*&<&'password'&>&*}&&&
10750 {*&<&'service'&>&*}{*&<&'realm'&>&*}}*&"
10751 .cindex "&'saslauthd'& daemon"
10753 .cindex "expansion" "&'saslauthd'& authentication test"
10754 .cindex "&%saslauthd%& expansion condition"
10755 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'saslauthd'&
10756 daemon. This replaces the older &'pwcheck'& daemon, which is now deprecated.
10757 Using this daemon is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked
10758 by a process that is not running as root.
10760 The saslauthd support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
10761 the location of the saslauthd daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
10762 building Exim. For example:
10764 CYRUS_SASLAUTHD_SOCKET=/var/state/saslauthd/mux
10766 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
10767 the saslauthd daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
10768 from the Cyrus SASL library.
10770 Up to four arguments can be supplied to the &%saslauthd%& condition, but only
10771 two are mandatory. For example:
10773 server_condition = ${if saslauthd{{$auth1}{$auth2}}}
10775 The service and the realm are optional (which is why the arguments are enclosed
10776 in their own set of braces). For details of the meaning of the service and
10777 realm, and how to run the daemon, consult the Cyrus documentation.
10782 .section "Combining expansion conditions" "SECID84"
10783 .cindex "expansion" "combining conditions"
10784 Several conditions can be tested at once by combining them using the &%and%&
10785 and &%or%& combination conditions. Note that &%and%& and &%or%& are complete
10786 conditions on their own, and precede their lists of sub-conditions. Each
10787 sub-condition must be enclosed in braces within the overall braces that contain
10788 the list. No repetition of &%if%& is used.
10792 .vitem &*or&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
10793 .cindex "&""or""& expansion condition"
10794 .cindex "expansion" "&""or""& of conditions"
10795 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
10796 any one of the sub-conditions is true.
10799 ${if or {{eq{$local_part}{spqr}}{eq{$domain}{testing.com}}}...
10801 When a true sub-condition is found, the following ones are parsed but not
10802 evaluated. If there are several &"match"& sub-conditions the values of the
10803 numeric variables afterwards are taken from the first one that succeeds.
10805 .vitem &*and&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
10806 .cindex "&""and""& expansion condition"
10807 .cindex "expansion" "&""and""& of conditions"
10808 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
10809 all of the sub-conditions are true. If there are several &"match"&
10810 sub-conditions, the values of the numeric variables afterwards are taken from
10811 the last one. When a false sub-condition is found, the following ones are
10812 parsed but not evaluated.
10814 .ecindex IIDexpcond
10819 .section "Expansion variables" "SECTexpvar"
10820 .cindex "expansion" "variables, list of"
10821 This section contains an alphabetical list of all the expansion variables. Some
10822 of them are available only when Exim is compiled with specific options such as
10823 support for TLS or the content scanning extension.
10826 .vitem "&$0$&, &$1$&, etc"
10827 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)"
10828 When a &%match%& expansion condition succeeds, these variables contain the
10829 captured substrings identified by the regular expression during subsequent
10830 processing of the success string of the containing &%if%& expansion item.
10831 However, they do not retain their values afterwards; in fact, their previous
10832 values are restored at the end of processing an &%if%& item. The numerical
10833 variables may also be set externally by some other matching process which
10834 precedes the expansion of the string. For example, the commands available in
10835 Exim filter files include an &%if%& command with its own regular expression
10836 matching condition.
10838 .vitem "&$acl_c...$&"
10839 Values can be placed in these variables by the &%set%& modifier in an ACL. They
10840 can be given any name that starts with &$acl_c$& and is at least six characters
10841 long, but the sixth character must be either a digit or an underscore. For
10842 example: &$acl_c5$&, &$acl_c_mycount$&. The values of the &$acl_c...$&
10843 variables persist throughout the lifetime of an SMTP connection. They can be
10844 used to pass information between ACLs and between different invocations of the
10845 same ACL. When a message is received, the values of these variables are saved
10846 with the message, and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports
10847 during subsequent delivery.
10849 .vitem "&$acl_m...$&"
10850 These variables are like the &$acl_c...$& variables, except that their values
10851 are reset after a message has been received. Thus, if several messages are
10852 received in one SMTP connection, &$acl_m...$& values are not passed on from one
10853 message to the next, as &$acl_c...$& values are. The &$acl_m...$& variables are
10854 also reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting a TLS session. When a
10855 message is received, the values of these variables are saved with the message,
10856 and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports during subsequent
10859 .vitem &$acl_verify_message$&
10860 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
10861 After an address verification has failed, this variable contains the failure
10862 message. It retains its value for use in subsequent modifiers. The message can
10863 be preserved by coding like this:
10865 warn !verify = sender
10866 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
10868 You can use &$acl_verify_message$& during the expansion of the &%message%& or
10869 &%log_message%& modifiers, to include information about the verification
10872 .vitem &$address_data$&
10873 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
10874 This variable is set by means of the &%address_data%& option in routers. The
10875 value then remains with the address while it is processed by subsequent routers
10876 and eventually a transport. If the transport is handling multiple addresses,
10877 the value from the first address is used. See chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&
10878 for more details. &*Note*&: The contents of &$address_data$& are visible in
10881 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify
10882 a recipient address, the final value is still in the variable for subsequent
10883 conditions and modifiers of the ACL statement. If routing the address caused it
10884 to be redirected to just one address, the child address is also routed as part
10885 of the verification, and in this case the final value of &$address_data$& is
10886 from the child's routing.
10888 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
10889 sender address, the final value is also preserved, but this time in
10890 &$sender_address_data$&, to distinguish it from data from a recipient
10893 In both cases (recipient and sender verification), the value does not persist
10894 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve
10895 these values for longer, you can save them in ACL variables.
10897 .vitem &$address_file$&
10898 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
10899 When, as a result of aliasing, forwarding, or filtering, a message is directed
10900 to a specific file, this variable holds the name of the file when the transport
10901 is running. At other times, the variable is empty. For example, using the
10902 default configuration, if user &%r2d2%& has a &_.forward_& file containing
10904 /home/r2d2/savemail
10906 then when the &(address_file)& transport is running, &$address_file$&
10907 contains the text string &`/home/r2d2/savemail`&.
10908 .cindex "Sieve filter" "value of &$address_file$&"
10909 For Sieve filters, the value may be &"inbox"& or a relative folder name. It is
10910 then up to the transport configuration to generate an appropriate absolute path
10911 to the relevant file.
10913 .vitem &$address_pipe$&
10914 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
10915 When, as a result of aliasing or forwarding, a message is directed to a pipe,
10916 this variable holds the pipe command when the transport is running.
10918 .vitem "&$auth1$& &-- &$auth3$&"
10919 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
10920 These variables are used in SMTP authenticators (see chapters
10921 &<<CHAPplaintext>>&&--&<<CHAPspa>>&). Elsewhere, they are empty.
10923 .vitem &$authenticated_id$&
10924 .cindex "authentication" "id"
10925 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
10926 When a server successfully authenticates a client it may be configured to
10927 preserve some of the authentication information in the variable
10928 &$authenticated_id$& (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). For example, a
10929 user/password authenticator configuration might preserve the user name for use
10930 in the routers. Note that this is not the same information that is saved in
10931 &$sender_host_authenticated$&.
10932 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection)
10933 the value of &$authenticated_id$& is normally the login name of the calling
10934 process. However, a trusted user can override this by means of the &%-oMai%&
10935 command line option.
10937 .vitem &$authenticated_fail_id$&
10938 .cindex "authentication" "fail" "id"
10939 .vindex "&$authenticated_fail_id$&"
10940 When an authentication attempt fails, the variable &$authenticated_fail_id$&
10941 will contain the failed authentication id. If more than one authentication
10942 id is attempted, it will contain only the last one. The variable is
10943 available for processing in the ACL's, generally the quit or notquit ACL.
10944 A message to a local recipient could still be accepted without requiring
10945 authentication, which means this variable could also be visible in all of
10950 .vitem &$authenticated_sender$&
10951 .cindex "sender" "authenticated"
10952 .cindex "authentication" "sender"
10953 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
10954 .vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
10955 When acting as a server, Exim takes note of the AUTH= parameter on an incoming
10956 SMTP MAIL command if it believes the sender is sufficiently trusted, as
10957 described in section &<<SECTauthparamail>>&. Unless the data is the string
10958 &"<>"&, it is set as the authenticated sender of the message, and the value is
10959 available during delivery in the &$authenticated_sender$& variable. If the
10960 sender is not trusted, Exim accepts the syntax of AUTH=, but ignores the data.
10962 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
10963 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection), the
10964 value of &$authenticated_sender$& is an address constructed from the login
10965 name of the calling process and &$qualify_domain$&, except that a trusted user
10966 can override this by means of the &%-oMas%& command line option.
10969 .vitem &$authentication_failed$&
10970 .cindex "authentication" "failure"
10971 .vindex "&$authentication_failed$&"
10972 This variable is set to &"1"& in an Exim server if a client issues an AUTH
10973 command that does not succeed. Otherwise it is set to &"0"&. This makes it
10974 possible to distinguish between &"did not try to authenticate"&
10975 (&$sender_host_authenticated$& is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to
10976 &"0"&) and &"tried to authenticate but failed"& (&$sender_host_authenticated$&
10977 is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to &"1"&). Failure includes any
10978 negative response to an AUTH command, including (for example) an attempt to use
10979 an undefined mechanism.
10981 .vitem &$av_failed$&
10982 .cindex "content scanning" "AV scanner failure"
10983 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
10984 extension. It is set to &"0"& by default, but will be set to &"1"& if any
10985 problem occurs with the virus scanner (specified by &%av_scanner%&) during
10986 the ACL malware condition.
10988 .vitem &$body_linecount$&
10989 .cindex "message body" "line count"
10990 .cindex "body of message" "line count"
10991 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
10992 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
10993 number of lines in the message's body. See also &$message_linecount$&.
10995 .vitem &$body_zerocount$&
10996 .cindex "message body" "binary zero count"
10997 .cindex "body of message" "binary zero count"
10998 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
10999 .vindex "&$body_zerocount$&"
11000 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
11001 number of binary zero bytes (ASCII NULs) in the message's body.
11003 .vitem &$bounce_recipient$&
11004 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
11005 This is set to the recipient address of a bounce message while Exim is creating
11006 it. It is useful if a customized bounce message text file is in use (see
11007 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
11009 .vitem &$bounce_return_size_limit$&
11010 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
11011 This contains the value set in the &%bounce_return_size_limit%& option, rounded
11012 up to a multiple of 1000. It is useful when a customized error message text
11013 file is in use (see chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
11015 .vitem &$caller_gid$&
11016 .cindex "gid (group id)" "caller"
11017 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
11018 The real group id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
11019 not the same as the group id of the originator of a message (see
11020 &$originator_gid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
11021 incarnation normally contains the Exim gid.
11023 .vitem &$caller_uid$&
11024 .cindex "uid (user id)" "caller"
11025 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
11026 The real user id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
11027 not the same as the user id of the originator of a message (see
11028 &$originator_uid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
11029 incarnation normally contains the Exim uid.
11031 .vitem &$compile_date$&
11032 .vindex "&$compile_date$&"
11033 The date on which the Exim binary was compiled.
11035 .vitem &$compile_number$&
11036 .vindex "&$compile_number$&"
11037 The building process for Exim keeps a count of the number
11038 of times it has been compiled. This serves to distinguish different
11039 compilations of the same version of the program.
11041 .vitem &$demime_errorlevel$&
11042 .vindex "&$demime_errorlevel$&"
11043 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with
11044 the content-scanning extension and the obsolete &%demime%& condition. For
11045 details, see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
11047 .vitem &$demime_reason$&
11048 .vindex "&$demime_reason$&"
11049 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
11050 content-scanning extension and the obsolete &%demime%& condition. For details,
11051 see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
11053 .vitem &$dnslist_domain$& &&&
11054 &$dnslist_matched$& &&&
11055 &$dnslist_text$& &&&
11057 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
11058 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
11059 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
11060 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
11061 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
11062 When a DNS (black) list lookup succeeds, these variables are set to contain
11063 the following data from the lookup: the list's domain name, the key that was
11064 looked up, the contents of any associated TXT record, and the value from the
11065 main A record. See section &<<SECID204>>& for more details.
11068 .vindex "&$domain$&"
11069 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this variable
11070 contains the domain. Uppercase letters in the domain are converted into lower
11071 case for &$domain$&.
11073 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
11074 &$domain$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting. &$domain$&
11075 is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering, because a
11076 message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just once.
11078 When more than one address is being delivered at once (for example, several
11079 RCPT commands in one SMTP delivery), &$domain$& is set only if they all
11080 have the same domain. Transports can be restricted to handling only one domain
11081 at a time if the value of &$domain$& is required at transport time &-- this is
11082 the default for local transports. For further details of the environment in
11083 which local transports are run, see chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
11085 .oindex "&%delay_warning_condition%&"
11086 At the end of a delivery, if all deferred addresses have the same domain, it is
11087 set in &$domain$& during the expansion of &%delay_warning_condition%&.
11089 The &$domain$& variable is also used in some other circumstances:
11092 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$domain$& contains the domain of
11093 the recipient address. The domain of the &'sender'& address is in
11094 &$sender_address_domain$& at both MAIL time and at RCPT time. &$domain$& is not
11095 normally set during the running of the MAIL ACL. However, if the sender address
11096 is verified with a callout during the MAIL ACL, the sender domain is placed in
11097 &$domain$& during the expansions of &%hosts%&, &%interface%&, and &%port%& in
11098 the &(smtp)& transport.
11101 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
11102 &$domain$& contains the domain portion of the address that is being rewritten;
11103 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example, to
11104 rewrite domains by file lookup.
11107 With one important exception, whenever a domain list is being scanned,
11108 &$domain$& contains the subject domain. &*Exception*&: When a domain list in
11109 a &%sender_domains%& condition in an ACL is being processed, the subject domain
11110 is in &$sender_address_domain$& and not in &$domain$&. It works this way so
11111 that, in a RCPT ACL, the sender domain list can be dependent on the
11112 recipient domain (which is what is in &$domain$& at this time).
11115 .cindex "ETRN" "value of &$domain$&"
11116 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
11117 When the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option is being expanded, &$domain$& contains
11118 the complete argument of the ETRN command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&).
11122 .vitem &$domain_data$&
11123 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
11124 When the &%domains%& option on a router matches a domain by
11125 means of a lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running
11126 of the router as &$domain_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the
11127 address to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the
11128 transport is handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is
11131 &$domain_data$& is also set when the &%domains%& condition in an ACL matches a
11132 domain by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is available during
11133 the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this variable expands
11136 .vitem &$exim_gid$&
11137 .vindex "&$exim_gid$&"
11138 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim group id.
11140 .vitem &$exim_path$&
11141 .vindex "&$exim_path$&"
11142 This variable contains the path to the Exim binary.
11144 .vitem &$exim_uid$&
11145 .vindex "&$exim_uid$&"
11146 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim user id.
11148 .vitem &$found_extension$&
11149 .vindex "&$found_extension$&"
11150 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
11151 content-scanning extension and the obsolete &%demime%& condition. For details,
11152 see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
11154 .vitem &$header_$&<&'name'&>
11155 This is not strictly an expansion variable. It is expansion syntax for
11156 inserting the message header line with the given name. Note that the name must
11157 be terminated by colon or white space, because it may contain a wide variety of
11158 characters. Note also that braces must &'not'& be used.
11160 .vitem &$headers_added$&
11161 .vindex "&$headers_added$&"
11162 Within an ACL this variable contains the headers added so far by
11163 the ACL modifier add_header (section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
11164 The headers are a newline-separated list.
11168 When the &%check_local_user%& option is set for a router, the user's home
11169 directory is placed in &$home$& when the check succeeds. In particular, this
11170 means it is set during the running of users' filter files. A router may also
11171 explicitly set a home directory for use by a transport; this can be overridden
11172 by a setting on the transport itself.
11174 When running a filter test via the &%-bf%& option, &$home$& is set to the value
11175 of the environment variable HOME.
11179 If a router assigns an address to a transport (any transport), and passes a
11180 list of hosts with the address, the value of &$host$& when the transport starts
11181 to run is the name of the first host on the list. Note that this applies both
11182 to local and remote transports.
11184 .cindex "transport" "filter"
11185 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
11186 For the &(smtp)& transport, if there is more than one host, the value of
11187 &$host$& changes as the transport works its way through the list. In
11188 particular, when the &(smtp)& transport is expanding its options for encryption
11189 using TLS, or for specifying a transport filter (see chapter
11190 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the host to which it
11193 When used in the client part of an authenticator configuration (see chapter
11194 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the server to which the
11195 client is connected.
11198 .vitem &$host_address$&
11199 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
11200 This variable is set to the remote host's IP address whenever &$host$& is set
11201 for a remote connection. It is also set to the IP address that is being checked
11202 when the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option is being processed.
11204 .vitem &$host_data$&
11205 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
11206 If a &%hosts%& condition in an ACL is satisfied by means of a lookup, the
11207 result of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
11208 allows you, for example, to do things like this:
11210 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
11211 message = $host_data
11213 .vitem &$host_lookup_deferred$&
11214 .cindex "host name" "lookup, failure of"
11215 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
11216 This variable normally contains &"0"&, as does &$host_lookup_failed$&. When a
11217 message comes from a remote host and there is an attempt to look up the host's
11218 name from its IP address, and the attempt is not successful, one of these
11219 variables is set to &"1"&.
11222 If the lookup receives a definite negative response (for example, a DNS lookup
11223 succeeded, but no records were found), &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
11226 If there is any kind of problem during the lookup, such that Exim cannot
11227 tell whether or not the host name is defined (for example, a timeout for a DNS
11228 lookup), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&.
11231 Looking up a host's name from its IP address consists of more than just a
11232 single reverse lookup. Exim checks that a forward lookup of at least one of the
11233 names it receives from a reverse lookup yields the original IP address. If this
11234 is not the case, Exim does not accept the looked up name(s), and
11235 &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&. Thus, being able to find a name from an
11236 IP address (for example, the existence of a PTR record in the DNS) is not
11237 sufficient on its own for the success of a host name lookup. If the reverse
11238 lookup succeeds, but there is a lookup problem such as a timeout when checking
11239 the result, the name is not accepted, and &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to
11240 &"1"&. See also &$sender_host_name$&.
11242 .vitem &$host_lookup_failed$&
11243 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
11244 See &$host_lookup_deferred$&.
11248 .vindex "&$inode$&"
11249 The only time this variable is set is while expanding the &%directory_file%&
11250 option in the &(appendfile)& transport. The variable contains the inode number
11251 of the temporary file which is about to be renamed. It can be used to construct
11252 a unique name for the file.
11254 .vitem &$interface_address$&
11255 .vindex "&$interface_address$&"
11256 This is an obsolete name for &$received_ip_address$&.
11258 .vitem &$interface_port$&
11259 .vindex "&$interface_port$&"
11260 This is an obsolete name for &$received_port$&.
11264 This variable is used during the expansion of &*forall*& and &*forany*&
11265 conditions (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&), and &*filter*&, &*map*&, and
11266 &*reduce*& items (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&). In other circumstances, it is
11270 .vindex "&$ldap_dn$&"
11271 This variable, which is available only when Exim is compiled with LDAP support,
11272 contains the DN from the last entry in the most recently successful LDAP
11275 .vitem &$load_average$&
11276 .vindex "&$load_average$&"
11277 This variable contains the system load average, multiplied by 1000 so that it
11278 is an integer. For example, if the load average is 0.21, the value of the
11279 variable is 210. The value is recomputed every time the variable is referenced.
11281 .vitem &$local_part$&
11282 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
11283 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this
11284 variable contains the local part. When a number of addresses are being
11285 delivered together (for example, multiple RCPT commands in an SMTP
11286 session), &$local_part$& is not set.
11288 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
11289 &$local_part$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting.
11290 &$local_part$& is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering,
11291 because a message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just
11294 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
11295 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
11296 If a local part prefix or suffix has been recognized, it is not included in the
11297 value of &$local_part$& during routing and subsequent delivery. The values of
11298 any prefix or suffix are in &$local_part_prefix$& and
11299 &$local_part_suffix$&, respectively.
11301 When a message is being delivered to a file, pipe, or autoreply transport as a
11302 result of aliasing or forwarding, &$local_part$& is set to the local part of
11303 the parent address, not to the file name or command (see &$address_file$& and
11306 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$local_part$& contains the
11307 local part of the recipient address.
11309 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
11310 &$local_part$& contains the local part of the address that is being rewritten;
11311 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example.
11313 In all cases, all quoting is removed from the local part. For example, for both
11316 "abc:xyz"@test.example
11317 abc\:xyz@test.example
11319 the value of &$local_part$& is
11323 If you use &$local_part$& to create another address, you should always wrap it
11324 inside a quoting operator. For example, in a &(redirect)& router you could
11327 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@new.domain.example
11329 &*Note*&: The value of &$local_part$& is normally lower cased. If you want
11330 to process local parts in a case-dependent manner in a router, you can set the
11331 &%caseful_local_part%& option (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&).
11333 .vitem &$local_part_data$&
11334 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
11335 When the &%local_parts%& option on a router matches a local part by means of a
11336 lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running of the
11337 router as &$local_part_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the address
11338 to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the transport is
11339 handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is used.
11341 &$local_part_data$& is also set when the &%local_parts%& condition in an ACL
11342 matches a local part by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is
11343 available during the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this
11344 variable expands to nothing.
11346 .vitem &$local_part_prefix$&
11347 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
11348 When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
11349 specific prefix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
11350 variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
11352 .vitem &$local_part_suffix$&
11353 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
11354 When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
11355 specific suffix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
11356 variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
11358 .vitem &$local_scan_data$&
11359 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
11360 This variable contains the text returned by the &[local_scan()]& function when
11361 a message is received. See chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>& for more details.
11363 .vitem &$local_user_gid$&
11364 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
11365 See &$local_user_uid$&.
11367 .vitem &$local_user_uid$&
11368 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
11369 This variable and &$local_user_gid$& are set to the uid and gid after the
11370 &%check_local_user%& router precondition succeeds. This means that their values
11371 are available for the remaining preconditions (&%senders%&, &%require_files%&,
11372 and &%condition%&), for the &%address_data%& expansion, and for any
11373 router-specific expansions. At all other times, the values in these variables
11374 are &`(uid_t)(-1)`& and &`(gid_t)(-1)`&, respectively.
11376 .vitem &$localhost_number$&
11377 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
11378 This contains the expanded value of the
11379 &%localhost_number%& option. The expansion happens after the main options have
11382 .vitem &$log_inodes$&
11383 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
11384 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's
11385 log files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is
11386 referenced. If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes,
11387 the value of is -1. See also the &%check_log_inodes%& option.
11389 .vitem &$log_space$&
11390 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
11391 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk
11392 partition where Exim's log files are being written. The value is recalculated
11393 whenever the variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the
11394 ability to find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems),
11395 the space value is -1. See also the &%check_log_space%& option.
11398 .vitem &$mailstore_basename$&
11399 .vindex "&$mailstore_basename$&"
11400 This variable is set only when doing deliveries in &"mailstore"& format in the
11401 &(appendfile)& transport. During the expansion of the &%mailstore_prefix%&,
11402 &%mailstore_suffix%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& options, it
11403 contains the basename of the files that are being written, that is, the name
11404 without the &".tmp"&, &".env"&, or &".msg"& suffix. At all other times, this
11407 .vitem &$malware_name$&
11408 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
11409 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
11410 content-scanning extension. It is set to the name of the virus that was found
11411 when the ACL &%malware%& condition is true (see section &<<SECTscanvirus>>&).
11413 .vitem &$max_received_linelength$&
11414 .vindex "&$max_received_linelength$&"
11415 .cindex "maximum" "line length"
11416 .cindex "line length" "maximum"
11417 This variable contains the number of bytes in the longest line that was
11418 received as part of the message, not counting the line termination
11421 .vitem &$message_age$&
11422 .cindex "message" "age of"
11423 .vindex "&$message_age$&"
11424 This variable is set at the start of a delivery attempt to contain the number
11425 of seconds since the message was received. It does not change during a single
11428 .vitem &$message_body$&
11429 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
11430 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
11431 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
11432 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
11433 .oindex "&%message_body_visible%&"
11434 This variable contains the initial portion of a message's body while it is
11435 being delivered, and is intended mainly for use in filter files. The maximum
11436 number of characters of the body that are put into the variable is set by the
11437 &%message_body_visible%& configuration option; the default is 500.
11439 .oindex "&%message_body_newlines%&"
11440 By default, newlines are converted into spaces in &$message_body$&, to make it
11441 easier to search for phrases that might be split over a line break. However,
11442 this can be disabled by setting &%message_body_newlines%& to be true. Binary
11443 zeros are always converted into spaces.
11445 .vitem &$message_body_end$&
11446 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
11447 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
11448 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
11449 This variable contains the final portion of a message's
11450 body while it is being delivered. The format and maximum size are as for
11453 .vitem &$message_body_size$&
11454 .cindex "body of message" "size"
11455 .cindex "message body" "size"
11456 .vindex "&$message_body_size$&"
11457 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the size of the body
11458 in bytes. The count starts from the character after the blank line that
11459 separates the body from the header. Newlines are included in the count. See
11460 also &$message_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
11462 .vitem &$message_exim_id$&
11463 .vindex "&$message_exim_id$&"
11464 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
11465 unique message id that is generated and used by Exim to identify the message.
11466 An id is not created for a message until after its header has been successfully
11467 received. &*Note*&: This is &'not'& the contents of the &'Message-ID:'& header
11468 line; it is the local id that Exim assigns to the message, for example:
11469 &`1BXTIK-0001yO-VA`&.
11471 .vitem &$message_headers$&
11472 .vindex &$message_headers$&
11473 This variable contains a concatenation of all the header lines when a message
11474 is being processed, except for lines added by routers or transports. The header
11475 lines are separated by newline characters. Their contents are decoded in the
11476 same way as a header line that is inserted by &%bheader%&.
11478 .vitem &$message_headers_raw$&
11479 .vindex &$message_headers_raw$&
11480 This variable is like &$message_headers$& except that no processing of the
11481 contents of header lines is done.
11483 .vitem &$message_id$&
11484 This is an old name for &$message_exim_id$&, which is now deprecated.
11486 .vitem &$message_linecount$&
11487 .vindex "&$message_linecount$&"
11488 This variable contains the total number of lines in the header and body of the
11489 message. Compare &$body_linecount$&, which is the count for the body only.
11490 During the DATA and content-scanning ACLs, &$message_linecount$& contains the
11491 number of lines received. Before delivery happens (that is, before filters,
11492 routers, and transports run) the count is increased to include the
11493 &'Received:'& header line that Exim standardly adds, and also any other header
11494 lines that are added by ACLs. The blank line that separates the message header
11495 from the body is not counted.
11497 As with the special case of &$message_size$&, during the expansion of the
11498 appendfile transport's maildir_tag option in maildir format, the value of
11499 &$message_linecount$& is the precise size of the number of newlines in the
11500 file that has been written (minus one for the blank line between the
11501 header and the body).
11503 Here is an example of the use of this variable in a DATA ACL:
11505 deny message = Too many lines in message header
11507 ${if <{250}{${eval:$message_linecount - $body_linecount}}}
11509 In the MAIL and RCPT ACLs, the value is zero because at that stage the
11510 message has not yet been received.
11512 .vitem &$message_size$&
11513 .cindex "size" "of message"
11514 .cindex "message" "size"
11515 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
11516 When a message is being processed, this variable contains its size in bytes. In
11517 most cases, the size includes those headers that were received with the
11518 message, but not those (such as &'Envelope-to:'&) that are added to individual
11519 deliveries as they are written. However, there is one special case: during the
11520 expansion of the &%maildir_tag%& option in the &(appendfile)& transport while
11521 doing a delivery in maildir format, the value of &$message_size$& is the
11522 precise size of the file that has been written. See also
11523 &$message_body_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
11525 .cindex "RCPT" "value of &$message_size$&"
11526 While running a per message ACL (mail/rcpt/predata), &$message_size$&
11527 contains the size supplied on the MAIL command, or -1 if no size was given. The
11528 value may not, of course, be truthful.
11530 .vitem &$mime_$&&'xxx'&
11531 A number of variables whose names start with &$mime$& are
11532 available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For
11533 details, see section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>&.
11535 .vitem "&$n0$& &-- &$n9$&"
11536 These variables are counters that can be incremented by means
11537 of the &%add%& command in filter files.
11539 .vitem &$original_domain$&
11540 .vindex "&$domain$&"
11541 .vindex "&$original_domain$&"
11542 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
11543 same value as &$domain$&. However, if a &"child"& address (for example,
11544 generated by an alias, forward, or filter file) is being processed, this
11545 variable contains the domain of the original address (lower cased). This
11546 differs from &$parent_domain$& only when there is more than one level of
11547 aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being delivered in a
11548 single transport run, &$original_domain$& is not set.
11550 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
11551 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
11552 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
11554 .vitem &$original_local_part$&
11555 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
11556 .vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
11557 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
11558 same value as &$local_part$&, unless a prefix or suffix was removed from the
11559 local part, because &$original_local_part$& always contains the full local
11560 part. When a &"child"& address (for example, generated by an alias, forward, or
11561 filter file) is being processed, this variable contains the full local part of
11562 the original address.
11564 If the router that did the redirection processed the local part
11565 case-insensitively, the value in &$original_local_part$& is in lower case.
11566 This variable differs from &$parent_local_part$& only when there is more than
11567 one level of aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being
11568 delivered in a single transport run, &$original_local_part$& is not set.
11570 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
11571 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
11572 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
11574 .vitem &$originator_gid$&
11575 .cindex "gid (group id)" "of originating user"
11576 .cindex "sender" "gid"
11577 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
11578 .vindex "&$originator_gid$&"
11579 This variable contains the value of &$caller_gid$& that was set when the
11580 message was received. For messages received via the command line, this is the
11581 gid of the sending user. For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is
11582 normally the gid of the Exim user.
11584 .vitem &$originator_uid$&
11585 .cindex "uid (user id)" "of originating user"
11586 .cindex "sender" "uid"
11587 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
11588 .vindex "&$originaltor_uid$&"
11589 The value of &$caller_uid$& that was set when the message was received. For
11590 messages received via the command line, this is the uid of the sending user.
11591 For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is normally the uid of the Exim
11594 .vitem &$parent_domain$&
11595 .vindex "&$parent_domain$&"
11596 This variable is similar to &$original_domain$& (see
11597 above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
11599 .vitem &$parent_local_part$&
11600 .vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
11601 This variable is similar to &$original_local_part$&
11602 (see above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
11605 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of current process"
11607 This variable contains the current process id.
11609 .vitem &$pipe_addresses$&
11610 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
11611 .cindex "transport" "filter"
11612 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
11613 This is not an expansion variable, but is mentioned here because the string
11614 &`$pipe_addresses`& is handled specially in the command specification for the
11615 &(pipe)& transport (chapter &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&) and in transport filters
11616 (described under &%transport_filter%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
11617 It cannot be used in general expansion strings, and provokes an &"unknown
11618 variable"& error if encountered.
11620 .vitem &$primary_hostname$&
11621 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
11622 This variable contains the value set by &%primary_hostname%& in the
11623 configuration file, or read by the &[uname()]& function. If &[uname()]& returns
11624 a single-component name, Exim calls &[gethostbyname()]& (or
11625 &[getipnodebyname()]& where available) in an attempt to acquire a fully
11626 qualified host name. See also &$smtp_active_hostname$&.
11629 .vitem &$prvscheck_address$&
11630 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
11631 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
11632 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
11634 .vitem &$prvscheck_keynum$&
11635 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
11636 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
11637 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
11639 .vitem &$prvscheck_result$&
11640 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
11641 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
11642 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
11644 .vitem &$qualify_domain$&
11645 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
11646 The value set for the &%qualify_domain%& option in the configuration file.
11648 .vitem &$qualify_recipient$&
11649 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
11650 The value set for the &%qualify_recipient%& option in the configuration file,
11651 or if not set, the value of &$qualify_domain$&.
11653 .vitem &$rcpt_count$&
11654 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
11655 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
11656 RCPT commands received for the current message. If this variable is used in a
11657 RCPT ACL, its value includes the current command.
11659 .vitem &$rcpt_defer_count$&
11660 .vindex "&$rcpt_defer_count$&"
11661 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "count of"
11662 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
11663 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
11664 temporary (4&'xx'&) response.
11666 .vitem &$rcpt_fail_count$&
11667 .vindex "&$rcpt_fail_count$&"
11668 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
11669 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
11670 permanent (5&'xx'&) response.
11672 .vitem &$received_count$&
11673 .vindex "&$received_count$&"
11674 This variable contains the number of &'Received:'& header lines in the message,
11675 including the one added by Exim (so its value is always greater than zero). It
11676 is available in the DATA ACL, the non-SMTP ACL, and while routing and
11679 .vitem &$received_for$&
11680 .vindex "&$received_for$&"
11681 If there is only a single recipient address in an incoming message, this
11682 variable contains that address when the &'Received:'& header line is being
11683 built. The value is copied after recipient rewriting has happened, but before
11684 the &[local_scan()]& function is run.
11686 .vitem &$received_ip_address$&
11687 .vindex "&$received_ip_address$&"
11688 As soon as an Exim server starts processing an incoming TCP/IP connection, this
11689 variable is set to the address of the local IP interface, and &$received_port$&
11690 is set to the local port number. (The remote IP address and port are in
11691 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.) When testing with &%-bh%&,
11692 the port value is -1 unless it has been set using the &%-oMi%& command line
11695 As well as being useful in ACLs (including the &"connect"& ACL), these variable
11696 could be used, for example, to make the file name for a TLS certificate depend
11697 on which interface and/or port is being used for the incoming connection. The
11698 values of &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$& are saved with any
11699 messages that are received, thus making these variables available at delivery
11702 &*Note:*& There are no equivalent variables for outgoing connections, because
11703 the values are unknown (unless they are explicitly set by options of the
11704 &(smtp)& transport).
11706 .vitem &$received_port$&
11707 .vindex "&$received_port$&"
11708 See &$received_ip_address$&.
11710 .vitem &$received_protocol$&
11711 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
11712 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the name of the
11713 protocol by which it was received. Most of the names used by Exim are defined
11714 by RFCs 821, 2821, and 3848. They start with &"smtp"& (the client used HELO) or
11715 &"esmtp"& (the client used EHLO). This can be followed by &"s"& for secure
11716 (encrypted) and/or &"a"& for authenticated. Thus, for example, if the protocol
11717 is set to &"esmtpsa"&, the message was received over an encrypted SMTP
11718 connection and the client was successfully authenticated.
11720 Exim uses the protocol name &"smtps"& for the case when encryption is
11721 automatically set up on connection without the use of STARTTLS (see
11722 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&), and the client uses HELO to initiate the
11723 encrypted SMTP session. The name &"smtps"& is also used for the rare situation
11724 where the client initially uses EHLO, sets up an encrypted connection using
11725 STARTTLS, and then uses HELO afterwards.
11727 The &%-oMr%& option provides a way of specifying a custom protocol name for
11728 messages that are injected locally by trusted callers. This is commonly used to
11729 identify messages that are being re-injected after some kind of scanning.
11731 .vitem &$received_time$&
11732 .vindex "&$received_time$&"
11733 This variable contains the date and time when the current message was received,
11734 as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
11736 .vitem &$recipient_data$&
11737 .vindex "&$recipient_data$&"
11738 This variable is set after an indexing lookup success in an ACL &%recipients%&
11739 condition. It contains the data from the lookup, and the value remains set
11740 until the next &%recipients%& test. Thus, you can do things like this:
11742 &`require recipients = cdb*@;/some/file`&
11743 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$recipient_data`&
11745 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
11746 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
11747 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
11748 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
11750 .vitem &$recipient_verify_failure$&
11751 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
11752 In an ACL, when a recipient verification fails, this variable contains
11753 information about the failure. It is set to one of the following words:
11756 &"qualify"&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
11757 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
11760 &"route"&: Routing failed.
11763 &"mail"&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection occurred at
11764 or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial connection, HELO, or
11768 &"recipient"&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
11771 &"postmaster"&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
11774 The main use of this variable is expected to be to distinguish between
11775 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT.
11777 .vitem &$recipients$&
11778 .vindex "&$recipients$&"
11779 This variable contains a list of envelope recipients for a message. A comma and
11780 a space separate the addresses in the replacement text. However, the variable
11781 is not generally available, to prevent exposure of Bcc recipients in
11782 unprivileged users' filter files. You can use &$recipients$& only in these
11786 In a system filter file.
11788 In the ACLs associated with the DATA command and with non-SMTP messages, that
11789 is, the ACLs defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&,
11790 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_not_smtp_start%&, &%acl_not_smtp%&, and
11791 &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&.
11793 From within a &[local_scan()]& function.
11797 .vitem &$recipients_count$&
11798 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
11799 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the number of
11800 envelope recipients that came with the message. Duplicates are not excluded
11801 from the count. While a message is being received over SMTP, the number
11802 increases for each accepted recipient. It can be referenced in an ACL.
11805 .vitem &$regex_match_string$&
11806 .vindex "&$regex_match_string$&"
11807 This variable is set to contain the matching regular expression after a
11808 &%regex%& ACL condition has matched (see section &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
11811 .vitem &$reply_address$&
11812 .vindex "&$reply_address$&"
11813 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the contents of the
11814 &'Reply-To:'& header line if one exists and it is not empty, or otherwise the
11815 contents of the &'From:'& header line. Apart from the removal of leading
11816 white space, the value is not processed in any way. In particular, no RFC 2047
11817 decoding or character code translation takes place.
11819 .vitem &$return_path$&
11820 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
11821 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the return path &--
11822 the sender field that will be sent as part of the envelope. It is not enclosed
11823 in <> characters. At the start of routing an address, &$return_path$& has the
11824 same value as &$sender_address$&, but if, for example, an incoming message to a
11825 mailing list has been expanded by a router which specifies a different address
11826 for bounce messages, &$return_path$& subsequently contains the new bounce
11827 address, whereas &$sender_address$& always contains the original sender address
11828 that was received with the message. In other words, &$sender_address$& contains
11829 the incoming envelope sender, and &$return_path$& contains the outgoing
11832 .vitem &$return_size_limit$&
11833 .vindex "&$return_size_limit$&"
11834 This is an obsolete name for &$bounce_return_size_limit$&.
11836 .vitem &$router_name$&
11837 .cindex "router" "name"
11838 .cindex "name" "of router"
11839 .vindex "&$router_name$&"
11840 During the running of a router this variable contains its name.
11843 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
11844 .vindex "&$runrc$&"
11845 This variable contains the return code from a command that is run by the
11846 &%${run...}%& expansion item. &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot
11847 assume the order in which option values are expanded, except for those
11848 preconditions whose order of testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot
11849 reliably expect to set &$runrc$& by the expansion of one option, and use it in
11852 .vitem &$self_hostname$&
11853 .oindex "&%self%&" "value of host name"
11854 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
11855 When an address is routed to a supposedly remote host that turns out to be the
11856 local host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& generic router option.
11857 One of its values causes the address to be passed to another router. When this
11858 happens, &$self_hostname$& is set to the name of the local host that the
11859 original router encountered. In other circumstances its contents are null.
11861 .vitem &$sender_address$&
11862 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
11863 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the sender's address
11864 that was received in the message's envelope. The case of letters in the address
11865 is retained, in both the local part and the domain. For bounce messages, the
11866 value of this variable is the empty string. See also &$return_path$&.
11868 .vitem &$sender_address_data$&
11869 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
11870 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
11871 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
11872 sender address, the final value is preserved in &$sender_address_data$&, to
11873 distinguish it from data from a recipient address. The value does not persist
11874 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve it for
11875 longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
11877 .vitem &$sender_address_domain$&
11878 .vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
11879 The domain portion of &$sender_address$&.
11881 .vitem &$sender_address_local_part$&
11882 .vindex "&$sender_address_local_part$&"
11883 The local part portion of &$sender_address$&.
11885 .vitem &$sender_data$&
11886 .vindex "&$sender_data$&"
11887 This variable is set after a lookup success in an ACL &%senders%& condition or
11888 in a router &%senders%& option. It contains the data from the lookup, and the
11889 value remains set until the next &%senders%& test. Thus, you can do things like
11892 &`require senders = cdb*@;/some/file`&
11893 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$sender_data`&
11895 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
11896 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
11897 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
11898 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
11900 .vitem &$sender_fullhost$&
11901 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
11902 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the host
11903 name and IP address in a single string. It ends with the IP address in square
11904 brackets, followed by a colon and a port number if the logging of ports is
11905 enabled. The format of the rest of the string depends on whether the host
11906 issued a HELO or EHLO SMTP command, and whether the host name was verified by
11907 looking up its IP address. (Looking up the IP address can be forced by the
11908 &%host_lookup%& option, independent of verification.) A plain host name at the
11909 start of the string is a verified host name; if this is not present,
11910 verification either failed or was not requested. A host name in parentheses is
11911 the argument of a HELO or EHLO command. This is omitted if it is identical to
11912 the verified host name or to the host's IP address in square brackets.
11914 .vitem &$sender_helo_name$&
11915 .vindex "&$sender_helo_name$&"
11916 When a message is received from a remote host that has issued a HELO or EHLO
11917 command, the argument of that command is placed in this variable. It is also
11918 set if HELO or EHLO is used when a message is received using SMTP locally via
11919 the &%-bs%& or &%-bS%& options.
11921 .vitem &$sender_host_address$&
11922 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
11923 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains that
11924 host's IP address. For locally submitted messages, it is empty.
11926 .vitem &$sender_host_authenticated$&
11927 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
11928 This variable contains the name (not the public name) of the authenticator
11929 driver that successfully authenticated the client from which the message was
11930 received. It is empty if there was no successful authentication. See also
11931 &$authenticated_id$&.
11934 .vitem &$sender_host_dnssec$&
11935 .vindex "&$sender_host_dnssec$&"
11936 If &$sender_host_name$& has been populated (by reference, &%hosts_lookup%& or
11937 otherwise) then this boolean will have been set true if, and only if, the
11938 resolver library states that the reverse DNS was authenticated data. At all
11939 other times, this variable is false.
11941 It is likely that you will need to coerce DNSSEC support on in the resolver
11942 library, by setting:
11947 Exim does not perform DNSSEC validation itself, instead leaving that to a
11948 validating resolver (eg, unbound, or bind with suitable configuration).
11950 Exim does not (currently) check to see if the forward DNS was also secured
11951 with DNSSEC, only the reverse DNS.
11953 If you have changed &%host_lookup_order%& so that &`bydns`& is not the first
11954 mechanism in the list, then this variable will be false.
11958 .vitem &$sender_host_name$&
11959 .vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
11960 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
11961 host's name as obtained by looking up its IP address. For messages received by
11962 other means, this variable is empty.
11964 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
11965 If the host name has not previously been looked up, a reference to
11966 &$sender_host_name$& triggers a lookup (for messages from remote hosts).
11967 A looked up name is accepted only if it leads back to the original IP address
11968 via a forward lookup. If either the reverse or the forward lookup fails to find
11969 any data, or if the forward lookup does not yield the original IP address,
11970 &$sender_host_name$& remains empty, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
11972 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
11973 However, if either of the lookups cannot be completed (for example, there is a
11974 DNS timeout), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&, and
11975 &$host_lookup_failed$& remains set to &"0"&.
11977 Once &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&, Exim does not try to look up the
11978 host name again if there is a subsequent reference to &$sender_host_name$&
11979 in the same Exim process, but it does try again if &$host_lookup_deferred$&
11982 Exim does not automatically look up every calling host's name. If you want
11983 maximum efficiency, you should arrange your configuration so that it avoids
11984 these lookups altogether. The lookup happens only if one or more of the
11985 following are true:
11988 A string containing &$sender_host_name$& is expanded.
11990 The calling host matches the list in &%host_lookup%&. In the default
11991 configuration, this option is set to *, so it must be changed if lookups are
11992 to be avoided. (In the code, the default for &%host_lookup%& is unset.)
11994 Exim needs the host name in order to test an item in a host list. The items
11995 that require this are described in sections &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& and
11996 &<<SECThoslispatnamsk>>&.
11998 The calling host matches &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&.
11999 In this case, the host name is required to compare with the name quoted in any
12000 EHLO or HELO commands that the client issues.
12002 The remote host issues a EHLO or HELO command that quotes one of the
12003 domains in &%helo_lookup_domains%&. The default value of this option is
12004 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
12005 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
12007 helo_lookup_domains = @ : @[]
12009 which causes a lookup if a remote host (incorrectly) gives the server's name or
12010 IP address in an EHLO or HELO command.
12014 .vitem &$sender_host_port$&
12015 .vindex "&$sender_host_port$&"
12016 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the port
12017 number that was used on the remote host.
12019 .vitem &$sender_ident$&
12020 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
12021 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
12022 identification received in response to an RFC 1413 request. When a message has
12023 been received locally, this variable contains the login name of the user that
12026 .vitem &$sender_rate_$&&'xxx'&
12027 A number of variables whose names begin &$sender_rate_$& are set as part of the
12028 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. Details are given in section
12029 &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
12031 .vitem &$sender_rcvhost$&
12032 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
12033 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
12034 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
12035 This is provided specifically for use in &'Received:'& headers. It starts with
12036 either the verified host name (as obtained from a reverse DNS lookup) or, if
12037 there is no verified host name, the IP address in square brackets. After that
12038 there may be text in parentheses. When the first item is a verified host name,
12039 the first thing in the parentheses is the IP address in square brackets,
12040 followed by a colon and a port number if port logging is enabled. When the
12041 first item is an IP address, the port is recorded as &"port=&'xxxx'&"& inside
12044 There may also be items of the form &"helo=&'xxxx'&"& if HELO or EHLO
12045 was used and its argument was not identical to the real host name or IP
12046 address, and &"ident=&'xxxx'&"& if an RFC 1413 ident string is available. If
12047 all three items are present in the parentheses, a newline and tab are inserted
12048 into the string, to improve the formatting of the &'Received:'& header.
12050 .vitem &$sender_verify_failure$&
12051 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
12052 In an ACL, when a sender verification fails, this variable contains information
12053 about the failure. The details are the same as for
12054 &$recipient_verify_failure$&.
12056 .vitem &$sending_ip_address$&
12057 .vindex "&$sending_ip_address$&"
12058 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
12059 been set up. It contains the IP address of the local interface that is being
12060 used. This is useful if a host that has more than one IP address wants to take
12061 on different personalities depending on which one is being used. For incoming
12062 connections, see &$received_ip_address$&.
12064 .vitem &$sending_port$&
12065 .vindex "&$sending_port$&"
12066 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
12067 been set up. It contains the local port that is being used. For incoming
12068 connections, see &$received_port$&.
12070 .vitem &$smtp_active_hostname$&
12071 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
12072 During an incoming SMTP session, this variable contains the value of the active
12073 host name, as specified by the &%smtp_active_hostname%& option. The value of
12074 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is saved with any message that is received, so its
12075 value can be consulted during routing and delivery.
12077 .vitem &$smtp_command$&
12078 .vindex "&$smtp_command$&"
12079 During the processing of an incoming SMTP command, this variable contains the
12080 entire command. This makes it possible to distinguish between HELO and EHLO in
12081 the HELO ACL, and also to distinguish between commands such as these:
12086 For a MAIL command, extra parameters such as SIZE can be inspected. For a RCPT
12087 command, the address in &$smtp_command$& is the original address before any
12088 rewriting, whereas the values in &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are taken from
12089 the address after SMTP-time rewriting.
12091 .vitem &$smtp_command_argument$&
12092 .cindex "SMTP" "command, argument for"
12093 .vindex "&$smtp_command_argument$&"
12094 While an ACL is running to check an SMTP command, this variable contains the
12095 argument, that is, the text that follows the command name, with leading white
12096 space removed. Following the introduction of &$smtp_command$&, this variable is
12097 somewhat redundant, but is retained for backwards compatibility.
12099 .vitem &$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&
12100 .vindex "&$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&"
12101 This variable is set greater than zero only in processes spawned by the Exim
12102 daemon for handling incoming SMTP connections. The name is deliberately long,
12103 in order to emphasize what the contents are. When the daemon accepts a new
12104 connection, it increments this variable. A copy of the variable is passed to
12105 the child process that handles the connection, but its value is fixed, and
12106 never changes. It is only an approximation of how many incoming connections
12107 there actually are, because many other connections may come and go while a
12108 single connection is being processed. When a child process terminates, the
12109 daemon decrements its copy of the variable.
12111 .vitem "&$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$&"
12112 These variables are copies of the values of the &$n0$& &-- &$n9$& accumulators
12113 that were current at the end of the system filter file. This allows a system
12114 filter file to set values that can be tested in users' filter files. For
12115 example, a system filter could set a value indicating how likely it is that a
12116 message is junk mail.
12118 .vitem &$spam_$&&'xxx'&
12119 A number of variables whose names start with &$spam$& are available when Exim
12120 is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For details, see section
12121 &<<SECTscanspamass>>&.
12124 .vitem &$spool_directory$&
12125 .vindex "&$spool_directory$&"
12126 The name of Exim's spool directory.
12128 .vitem &$spool_inodes$&
12129 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
12130 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's spool files are
12131 being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is referenced.
12132 If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes, the value of
12133 is -1. See also the &%check_spool_inodes%& option.
12135 .vitem &$spool_space$&
12136 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
12137 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk partition where
12138 Exim's spool files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the
12139 variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the ability to
12140 find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems), the space
12141 value is -1. For example, to check in an ACL that there is at least 50
12142 megabytes free on the spool, you could write:
12144 condition = ${if > {$spool_space}{50000}}
12146 See also the &%check_spool_space%& option.
12149 .vitem &$thisaddress$&
12150 .vindex "&$thisaddress$&"
12151 This variable is set only during the processing of the &%foranyaddress%&
12152 command in a filter file. Its use is explained in the description of that
12153 command, which can be found in the separate document entitled &'Exim's
12154 interfaces to mail filtering'&.
12156 .vitem &$tls_in_bits$&
12157 .vindex "&$tls_in_bits$&"
12158 Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
12159 on the inbound connection; the meaning of
12160 this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
12161 If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
12162 The value of this is automatically fed into the Cyrus SASL authenticator
12163 when acting as a server, to specify the "external SSF" (a SASL term).
12165 The deprecated &$tls_bits$& variable refers to the inbound side
12166 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
12169 .vitem &$tls_out_bits$&
12170 .vindex "&$tls_out_bits$&"
12171 Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
12172 on an outbound SMTP connection; the meaning of
12173 this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
12174 If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
12176 .vitem &$tls_in_certificate_verified$&
12177 .vindex "&$tls_in_certificate_verified$&"
12178 This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when the
12179 message was received, and &"0"& otherwise.
12181 The deprecated &$tls_certificate_verfied$& variable refers to the inbound side
12182 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
12185 .vitem &$tls_out_certificate_verified$&
12186 .vindex "&$tls_out_certificate_verified$&"
12187 This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when an
12188 outbound SMTP connection was made,
12189 and &"0"& otherwise.
12191 .vitem &$tls_in_cipher$&
12192 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
12193 .vindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
12194 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
12195 connection, this variable is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated, for
12196 example DES-CBC3-SHA. In other circumstances, in particular, for message
12197 received over unencrypted connections, the variable is empty. Testing
12198 &$tls_cipher$& for emptiness is one way of distinguishing between encrypted and
12199 non-encrypted connections during ACL processing.
12201 The deprecated &$tls_cipher$& variable is the same as &$tls_in_cipher$& during message reception,
12202 but in the context of an outward SMTP delivery taking place via the &(smtp)& transport
12203 becomes the same as &$tls_out_cipher$&.
12205 .vitem &$tls_out_cipher$&
12206 .vindex "&$tls_out_cipher$&"
12208 cleared before any outgoing SMTP connection is made,
12209 and then set to the outgoing cipher suite if one is negotiated. See chapter
12210 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS support and chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for
12211 details of the &(smtp)& transport.
12213 .vitem &$tls_in_peerdn$&
12214 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
12215 .vindex "&$tls_peerdn$&"
12216 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
12217 connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the client,
12218 the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
12219 &$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
12221 The deprecated &$tls_peerdn$& variable refers to the inbound side
12222 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
12225 .vitem &$tls_out_peerdn$&
12226 .vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
12227 When a message is being delivered to a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
12228 connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the server,
12229 the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
12230 &$tls_out_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
12232 .vitem &$tls_in_sni$&
12233 .vindex "&$tls_in_sni$&"
12234 .vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
12235 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
12236 When a TLS session is being established, if the client sends the Server
12237 Name Indication extension, the value will be placed in this variable.
12238 If the variable appears in &%tls_certificate%& then this option and
12239 some others, described in &<<SECTtlssni>>&,
12240 will be re-expanded early in the TLS session, to permit
12241 a different certificate to be presented (and optionally a different key to be
12242 used) to the client, based upon the value of the SNI extension.
12244 The deprecated &$tls_sni$& variable refers to the inbound side
12245 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
12248 .vitem &$tls_out_sni$&
12249 .vindex "&$tls_out_sni$&"
12250 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
12252 SMTP deliveries, this variable reflects the value of the &%tls_sni%& option on
12255 .vitem &$tod_bsdinbox$&
12256 .vindex "&$tod_bsdinbox$&"
12257 The time of day and the date, in the format required for BSD-style mailbox
12258 files, for example: Thu Oct 17 17:14:09 1995.
12260 .vitem &$tod_epoch$&
12261 .vindex "&$tod_epoch$&"
12262 The time and date as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
12264 .vitem &$tod_epoch_l$&
12265 .vindex "&$tod_epoch_l$&"
12266 The time and date as a number of microseconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
12268 .vitem &$tod_full$&
12269 .vindex "&$tod_full$&"
12270 A full version of the time and date, for example: Wed, 16 Oct 1995 09:51:40
12271 +0100. The timezone is always given as a numerical offset from UTC, with
12272 positive values used for timezones that are ahead (east) of UTC, and negative
12273 values for those that are behind (west).
12276 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
12277 The time and date in the format used for writing Exim's log files, for example:
12278 1995-10-12 15:32:29, but without a timezone.
12280 .vitem &$tod_logfile$&
12281 .vindex "&$tod_logfile$&"
12282 This variable contains the date in the format yyyymmdd. This is the format that
12283 is used for datestamping log files when &%log_file_path%& contains the &`%D`&
12286 .vitem &$tod_zone$&
12287 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
12288 This variable contains the numerical value of the local timezone, for example:
12291 .vitem &$tod_zulu$&
12292 .vindex "&$tod_zulu$&"
12293 This variable contains the UTC date and time in &"Zulu"& format, as specified
12294 by ISO 8601, for example: 20030221154023Z.
12296 .vitem &$transport_name$&
12297 .cindex "transport" "name"
12298 .cindex "name" "of transport"
12299 .vindex "&$transport_name$&"
12300 During the running of a transport, this variable contains its name.
12303 .vindex "&$value$&"
12304 This variable contains the result of an expansion lookup, extraction operation,
12305 or external command, as described above. It is also used during a
12306 &*reduce*& expansion.
12308 .vitem &$version_number$&
12309 .vindex "&$version_number$&"
12310 The version number of Exim.
12312 .vitem &$warn_message_delay$&
12313 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
12314 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
12315 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
12317 .vitem &$warn_message_recipients$&
12318 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
12319 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
12320 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
12326 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12327 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12329 .chapter "Embedded Perl" "CHAPperl"
12330 .scindex IIDperl "Perl" "calling from Exim"
12331 Exim can be built to include an embedded Perl interpreter. When this is done,
12332 Perl subroutines can be called as part of the string expansion process. To make
12333 use of the Perl support, you need version 5.004 or later of Perl installed on
12334 your system. To include the embedded interpreter in the Exim binary, include
12339 in your &_Local/Makefile_& and then build Exim in the normal way.
12342 .section "Setting up so Perl can be used" "SECID85"
12343 .oindex "&%perl_startup%&"
12344 Access to Perl subroutines is via a global configuration option called
12345 &%perl_startup%& and an expansion string operator &%${perl ...}%&. If there is
12346 no &%perl_startup%& option in the Exim configuration file then no Perl
12347 interpreter is started and there is almost no overhead for Exim (since none of
12348 the Perl library will be paged in unless used). If there is a &%perl_startup%&
12349 option then the associated value is taken to be Perl code which is executed in
12350 a newly created Perl interpreter.
12352 The value of &%perl_startup%& is not expanded in the Exim sense, so you do not
12353 need backslashes before any characters to escape special meanings. The option
12354 should usually be something like
12356 perl_startup = do '/etc/exim.pl'
12358 where &_/etc/exim.pl_& is Perl code which defines any subroutines you want to
12359 use from Exim. Exim can be configured either to start up a Perl interpreter as
12360 soon as it is entered, or to wait until the first time it is needed. Starting
12361 the interpreter at the beginning ensures that it is done while Exim still has
12362 its setuid privilege, but can impose an unnecessary overhead if Perl is not in
12363 fact used in a particular run. Also, note that this does not mean that Exim is
12364 necessarily running as root when Perl is called at a later time. By default,
12365 the interpreter is started only when it is needed, but this can be changed in
12369 .oindex "&%perl_at_start%&"
12370 Setting &%perl_at_start%& (a boolean option) in the configuration requests
12371 a startup when Exim is entered.
12373 The command line option &%-ps%& also requests a startup when Exim is entered,
12374 overriding the setting of &%perl_at_start%&.
12377 There is also a command line option &%-pd%& (for delay) which suppresses the
12378 initial startup, even if &%perl_at_start%& is set.
12381 .section "Calling Perl subroutines" "SECID86"
12382 When the configuration file includes a &%perl_startup%& option you can make use
12383 of the string expansion item to call the Perl subroutines that are defined
12384 by the &%perl_startup%& code. The operator is used in any of the following
12388 ${perl{foo}{argument}}
12389 ${perl{foo}{argument1}{argument2} ... }
12391 which calls the subroutine &%foo%& with the given arguments. A maximum of eight
12392 arguments may be passed. Passing more than this results in an expansion failure
12393 with an error message of the form
12395 Too many arguments passed to Perl subroutine "foo" (max is 8)
12397 The return value of the Perl subroutine is evaluated in a scalar context before
12398 it is passed back to Exim to be inserted into the expanded string. If the
12399 return value is &'undef'&, the expansion is forced to fail in the same way as
12400 an explicit &"fail"& on an &%if%& or &%lookup%& item. If the subroutine aborts
12401 by obeying Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails with the error message
12402 that was passed to &%die%&.
12405 .section "Calling Exim functions from Perl" "SECID87"
12406 Within any Perl code called from Exim, the function &'Exim::expand_string()'&
12407 is available to call back into Exim's string expansion function. For example,
12410 my $lp = Exim::expand_string('$local_part');
12412 makes the current Exim &$local_part$& available in the Perl variable &$lp$&.
12413 Note those are single quotes and not double quotes to protect against
12414 &$local_part$& being interpolated as a Perl variable.
12416 If the string expansion is forced to fail by a &"fail"& item, the result of
12417 &'Exim::expand_string()'& is &%undef%&. If there is a syntax error in the
12418 expansion string, the Perl call from the original expansion string fails with
12419 an appropriate error message, in the same way as if &%die%& were used.
12421 .cindex "debugging" "from embedded Perl"
12422 .cindex "log" "writing from embedded Perl"
12423 Two other Exim functions are available for use from within Perl code.
12424 &'Exim::debug_write()'& writes a string to the standard error stream if Exim's
12425 debugging is enabled. If you want a newline at the end, you must supply it.
12426 &'Exim::log_write()'& writes a string to Exim's main log, adding a leading
12427 timestamp. In this case, you should not supply a terminating newline.
12430 .section "Use of standard output and error by Perl" "SECID88"
12431 .cindex "Perl" "standard output and error"
12432 You should not write to the standard error or output streams from within your
12433 Perl code, as it is not defined how these are set up. In versions of Exim
12434 before 4.50, it is possible for the standard output or error to refer to the
12435 SMTP connection during message reception via the daemon. Writing to this stream
12436 is certain to cause chaos. From Exim 4.50 onwards, the standard output and
12437 error streams are connected to &_/dev/null_& in the daemon. The chaos is
12438 avoided, but the output is lost.
12440 .cindex "Perl" "use of &%warn%&"
12441 The Perl &%warn%& statement writes to the standard error stream by default.
12442 Calls to &%warn%& may be embedded in Perl modules that you use, but over which
12443 you have no control. When Exim starts up the Perl interpreter, it arranges for
12444 output from the &%warn%& statement to be written to the Exim main log. You can
12445 change this by including appropriate Perl magic somewhere in your Perl code.
12446 For example, to discard &%warn%& output completely, you need this:
12448 $SIG{__WARN__} = sub { };
12450 Whenever a &%warn%& is obeyed, the anonymous subroutine is called. In this
12451 example, the code for the subroutine is empty, so it does nothing, but you can
12452 include any Perl code that you like. The text of the &%warn%& message is passed
12453 as the first subroutine argument.
12457 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12458 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12460 .chapter "Starting the daemon and the use of network interfaces" &&&
12461 "CHAPinterfaces" &&&
12462 "Starting the daemon"
12463 .cindex "daemon" "starting"
12464 .cindex "interface" "listening"
12465 .cindex "network interface"
12466 .cindex "interface" "network"
12467 .cindex "IP address" "for listening"
12468 .cindex "daemon" "listening IP addresses"
12469 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
12470 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
12471 A host that is connected to a TCP/IP network may have one or more physical
12472 hardware network interfaces. Each of these interfaces may be configured as one
12473 or more &"logical"& interfaces, which are the entities that a program actually
12474 works with. Each of these logical interfaces is associated with an IP address.
12475 In addition, TCP/IP software supports &"loopback"& interfaces (127.0.0.1 in
12476 IPv4 and ::1 in IPv6), which do not use any physical hardware. Exim requires
12477 knowledge about the host's interfaces for use in three different circumstances:
12480 When a listening daemon is started, Exim needs to know which interfaces
12481 and ports to listen on.
12483 When Exim is routing an address, it needs to know which IP addresses
12484 are associated with local interfaces. This is required for the correct
12485 processing of MX lists by removing the local host and others with the
12486 same or higher priority values. Also, Exim needs to detect cases
12487 when an address is routed to an IP address that in fact belongs to the
12488 local host. Unless the &%self%& router option or the &%allow_localhost%&
12489 option of the smtp transport is set (as appropriate), this is treated
12490 as an error situation.
12492 When Exim connects to a remote host, it may need to know which interface to use
12493 for the outgoing connection.
12497 Exim's default behaviour is likely to be appropriate in the vast majority
12498 of cases. If your host has only one interface, and you want all its IP
12499 addresses to be treated in the same way, and you are using only the
12500 standard SMTP port, you should not need to take any special action. The
12501 rest of this chapter does not apply to you.
12503 In a more complicated situation you may want to listen only on certain
12504 interfaces, or on different ports, and for this reason there are a number of
12505 options that can be used to influence Exim's behaviour. The rest of this
12506 chapter describes how they operate.
12508 When a message is received over TCP/IP, the interface and port that were
12509 actually used are set in &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$&.
12513 .section "Starting a listening daemon" "SECID89"
12514 When a listening daemon is started (by means of the &%-bd%& command line
12515 option), the interfaces and ports on which it listens are controlled by the
12519 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& contains a list of default ports. (For backward
12520 compatibility, this option can also be specified in the singular.)
12522 &%local_interfaces%& contains list of interface IP addresses on which to
12523 listen. Each item may optionally also specify a port.
12526 The default list separator in both cases is a colon, but this can be changed as
12527 described in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. When IPv6 addresses are involved,
12528 it is usually best to change the separator to avoid having to double all the
12529 colons. For example:
12531 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; \
12534 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
12536 There are two different formats for specifying a port along with an IP address
12537 in &%local_interfaces%&:
12540 The port is added onto the address with a dot separator. For example, to listen
12541 on port 1234 on two different IP addresses:
12543 local_interfaces = <; 192.168.23.65.1234 ; \
12544 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061.1234
12547 The IP address is enclosed in square brackets, and the port is added
12548 with a colon separator, for example:
12550 local_interfaces = <; [192.168.23.65]:1234 ; \
12551 [3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061]:1234
12555 When a port is not specified, the value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is used. The
12556 default setting contains just one port:
12558 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
12560 If more than one port is listed, each interface that does not have its own port
12561 specified listens on all of them. Ports that are listed in
12562 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& can be identified either by name (defined in
12563 &_/etc/services_&) or by number. However, when ports are given with individual
12564 IP addresses in &%local_interfaces%&, only numbers (not names) can be used.
12568 .section "Special IP listening addresses" "SECID90"
12569 The addresses 0.0.0.0 and ::0 are treated specially. They are interpreted
12570 as &"all IPv4 interfaces"& and &"all IPv6 interfaces"&, respectively. In each
12571 case, Exim tells the TCP/IP stack to &"listen on all IPv&'x'& interfaces"&
12572 instead of setting up separate listening sockets for each interface. The
12573 default value of &%local_interfaces%& is
12575 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
12577 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is:
12579 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
12581 Thus, by default, Exim listens on all available interfaces, on the SMTP port.
12585 .section "Overriding local_interfaces and daemon_smtp_ports" "SECID91"
12586 The &%-oX%& command line option can be used to override the values of
12587 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& and/or &%local_interfaces%& for a particular daemon
12588 instance. Another way of doing this would be to use macros and the &%-D%&
12589 option. However, &%-oX%& can be used by any admin user, whereas modification of
12590 the runtime configuration by &%-D%& is allowed only when the caller is root or
12593 The value of &%-oX%& is a list of items. The default colon separator can be
12594 changed in the usual way if required. If there are any items that do not
12595 contain dots or colons (that is, are not IP addresses), the value of
12596 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is replaced by the list of those items. If there are any
12597 items that do contain dots or colons, the value of &%local_interfaces%& is
12598 replaced by those items. Thus, for example,
12602 overrides &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, but leaves &%local_interfaces%& unchanged,
12605 -oX 192.168.34.5.1125
12607 overrides &%local_interfaces%&, leaving &%daemon_smtp_ports%& unchanged.
12608 (However, since &%local_interfaces%& now contains no items without ports, the
12609 value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is no longer relevant in this example.)
12613 .section "Support for the obsolete SSMTP (or SMTPS) protocol" "SECTsupobssmt"
12614 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
12615 .cindex "smtps protocol"
12616 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
12617 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
12618 Exim supports the obsolete SSMTP protocol (also known as SMTPS) that was used
12619 before the STARTTLS command was standardized for SMTP. Some legacy clients
12620 still use this protocol. If the &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option is set to a
12621 list of port numbers, connections to those ports must use SSMTP. The most
12622 common use of this option is expected to be
12624 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
12626 because 465 is the usual port number used by the legacy clients. There is also
12627 a command line option &%-tls-on-connect%&, which forces all ports to behave in
12628 this way when a daemon is started.
12630 &*Warning*&: Setting &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not of itself cause the
12631 daemon to listen on those ports. You must still specify them in
12632 &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%local_interfaces%&, or the &%-oX%& option. (This is
12633 because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& applies to &%inetd%& connections as well as to
12634 connections via the daemon.)
12639 .section "IPv6 address scopes" "SECID92"
12640 .cindex "IPv6" "address scopes"
12641 IPv6 addresses have &"scopes"&, and a host with multiple hardware interfaces
12642 can, in principle, have the same link-local IPv6 address on different
12643 interfaces. Thus, additional information is needed, over and above the IP
12644 address, to distinguish individual interfaces. A convention of using a
12645 percent sign followed by something (often the interface name) has been
12646 adopted in some cases, leading to addresses like this:
12648 fe80::202:b3ff:fe03:45c1%eth0
12650 To accommodate this usage, a percent sign followed by an arbitrary string is
12651 allowed at the end of an IPv6 address. By default, Exim calls &[getaddrinfo()]&
12652 to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use. This function recognizes the
12653 percent convention in operating systems that support it, and it processes the
12654 address appropriately. Unfortunately, some older libraries have problems with
12655 &[getaddrinfo()]&. If
12657 IPV6_USE_INET_PTON=yes
12659 is set in &_Local/Makefile_& (or an OS-dependent Makefile) when Exim is built,
12660 Exim uses &'inet_pton()'& to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use,
12661 instead of &[getaddrinfo()]&. (Before version 4.14, it always used this
12662 function.) Of course, this means that the additional functionality of
12663 &[getaddrinfo()]& &-- recognizing scoped addresses &-- is lost.
12665 .section "Disabling IPv6" "SECID93"
12666 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
12667 Sometimes it happens that an Exim binary that was compiled with IPv6 support is
12668 run on a host whose kernel does not support IPv6. The binary will fall back to
12669 using IPv4, but it may waste resources looking up AAAA records, and trying to
12670 connect to IPv6 addresses, causing delays to mail delivery. If you set the
12671 .oindex "&%disable_ipv6%&"
12672 &%disable_ipv6%& option true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
12673 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
12674 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &(manualroute)& router,
12675 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
12676 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
12678 On the other hand, when IPv6 is in use, there may be times when you want to
12679 disable it for certain hosts or domains. You can use the &%dns_ipv4_lookup%&
12680 option to globally suppress the lookup of AAAA records for specified domains,
12681 and you can use the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic router option to ignore
12682 IPv6 addresses in an individual router.
12686 .section "Examples of starting a listening daemon" "SECID94"
12687 The default case in an IPv6 environment is
12689 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
12690 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
12692 This specifies listening on the smtp port on all IPv6 and IPv4 interfaces.
12693 Either one or two sockets may be used, depending on the characteristics of
12694 the TCP/IP stack. (This is complicated and messy; for more information,
12695 read the comments in the &_daemon.c_& source file.)
12697 To specify listening on ports 25 and 26 on all interfaces:
12699 daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 26
12701 (leaving &%local_interfaces%& at the default setting) or, more explicitly:
12703 local_interfaces = <; ::0.25 ; ::0.26 \
12704 0.0.0.0.25 ; 0.0.0.0.26
12706 To listen on the default port on all IPv4 interfaces, and on port 26 on the
12707 IPv4 loopback address only:
12709 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.1.26
12711 To specify listening on the default port on specific interfaces only:
12713 local_interfaces = 10.0.0.67 : 192.168.34.67
12715 &*Warning*&: Such a setting excludes listening on the loopback interfaces.
12719 .section "Recognizing the local host" "SECTreclocipadd"
12720 The &%local_interfaces%& option is also used when Exim needs to determine
12721 whether or not an IP address refers to the local host. That is, the IP
12722 addresses of all the interfaces on which a daemon is listening are always
12725 For this usage, port numbers in &%local_interfaces%& are ignored. If either of
12726 the items 0.0.0.0 or ::0 are encountered, Exim gets a complete list of
12727 available interfaces from the operating system, and extracts the relevant
12728 (that is, IPv4 or IPv6) addresses to use for checking.
12730 Some systems set up large numbers of virtual interfaces in order to provide
12731 many virtual web servers. In this situation, you may want to listen for
12732 email on only a few of the available interfaces, but nevertheless treat all
12733 interfaces as local when routing. You can do this by setting
12734 &%extra_local_interfaces%& to a list of IP addresses, possibly including the
12735 &"all"& wildcard values. These addresses are recognized as local, but are not
12736 used for listening. Consider this example:
12738 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1 ; \
12740 3ffe:2101:12:1:a00:20ff:fe86:a061
12742 extra_local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
12744 The daemon listens on the loopback interfaces and just one IPv4 and one IPv6
12745 address, but all available interface addresses are treated as local when
12748 In some environments the local host name may be in an MX list, but with an IP
12749 address that is not assigned to any local interface. In other cases it may be
12750 desirable to treat other host names as if they referred to the local host. Both
12751 these cases can be handled by setting the &%hosts_treat_as_local%& option.
12752 This contains host names rather than IP addresses. When a host is referenced
12753 during routing, either via an MX record or directly, it is treated as the local
12754 host if its name matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, or if any of its IP
12755 addresses match &%local_interfaces%& or &%extra_local_interfaces%&.
12759 .section "Delivering to a remote host" "SECID95"
12760 Delivery to a remote host is handled by the smtp transport. By default, it
12761 allows the system's TCP/IP functions to choose which interface to use (if
12762 there is more than one) when connecting to a remote host. However, the
12763 &%interface%& option can be set to specify which interface is used. See the
12764 description of the smtp transport in chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for more
12770 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12771 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12773 .chapter "Main configuration" "CHAPmainconfig"
12774 .scindex IIDconfima "configuration file" "main section"
12775 .scindex IIDmaiconf "main configuration"
12776 The first part of the run time configuration file contains three types of item:
12779 Macro definitions: These lines start with an upper case letter. See section
12780 &<<SECTmacrodefs>>& for details of macro processing.
12782 Named list definitions: These lines start with one of the words &"domainlist"&,
12783 &"hostlist"&, &"addresslist"&, or &"localpartlist"&. Their use is described in
12784 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
12786 Main configuration settings: Each setting occupies one line of the file
12787 (with possible continuations). If any setting is preceded by the word
12788 &"hide"&, the &%-bP%& command line option displays its value to admin users
12789 only. See section &<<SECTcos>>& for a description of the syntax of these option
12793 This chapter specifies all the main configuration options, along with their
12794 types and default values. For ease of finding a particular option, they appear
12795 in alphabetical order in section &<<SECTalomo>>& below. However, because there
12796 are now so many options, they are first listed briefly in functional groups, as
12797 an aid to finding the name of the option you are looking for. Some options are
12798 listed in more than one group.
12800 .section "Miscellaneous" "SECID96"
12802 .row &%bi_command%& "to run for &%-bi%& command line option"
12803 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
12804 .row &%keep_malformed%& "for broken files &-- should not happen"
12805 .row &%localhost_number%& "for unique message ids in clusters"
12806 .row &%message_body_newlines%& "retain newlines in &$message_body$&"
12807 .row &%message_body_visible%& "how much to show in &$message_body$&"
12808 .row &%mua_wrapper%& "run in &""MUA wrapper""& mode"
12809 .row &%print_topbitchars%& "top-bit characters are printing"
12810 .row &%timezone%& "force time zone"
12814 .section "Exim parameters" "SECID97"
12816 .row &%exim_group%& "override compiled-in value"
12817 .row &%exim_path%& "override compiled-in value"
12818 .row &%exim_user%& "override compiled-in value"
12819 .row &%primary_hostname%& "default from &[uname()]&"
12820 .row &%split_spool_directory%& "use multiple directories"
12821 .row &%spool_directory%& "override compiled-in value"
12826 .section "Privilege controls" "SECID98"
12828 .row &%admin_groups%& "groups that are Exim admin users"
12829 .row &%deliver_drop_privilege%& "drop root for delivery processes"
12830 .row &%local_from_check%& "insert &'Sender:'& if necessary"
12831 .row &%local_from_prefix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
12832 .row &%local_from_suffix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
12833 .row &%local_sender_retain%& "keep &'Sender:'& from untrusted user"
12834 .row &%never_users%& "do not run deliveries as these"
12835 .row &%prod_requires_admin%& "forced delivery requires admin user"
12836 .row &%queue_list_requires_admin%& "queue listing requires admin user"
12837 .row &%trusted_groups%& "groups that are trusted"
12838 .row &%trusted_users%& "users that are trusted"
12843 .section "Logging" "SECID99"
12845 .row &%hosts_connection_nolog%& "exemption from connect logging"
12846 .row &%log_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
12847 .row &%log_selector%& "set/unset optional logging"
12848 .row &%log_timezone%& "add timezone to log lines"
12849 .row &%message_logs%& "create per-message logs"
12850 .row &%preserve_message_logs%& "after message completion"
12851 .row &%process_log_path%& "for SIGUSR1 and &'exiwhat'&"
12852 .row &%syslog_duplication%& "controls duplicate log lines on syslog"
12853 .row &%syslog_facility%& "set syslog &""facility""& field"
12854 .row &%syslog_processname%& "set syslog &""ident""& field"
12855 .row &%syslog_timestamp%& "timestamp syslog lines"
12856 .row &%write_rejectlog%& "control use of message log"
12861 .section "Frozen messages" "SECID100"
12863 .row &%auto_thaw%& "sets time for retrying frozen messages"
12864 .row &%freeze_tell%& "send message when freezing"
12865 .row &%move_frozen_messages%& "to another directory"
12866 .row &%timeout_frozen_after%& "keep frozen messages only so long"
12871 .section "Data lookups" "SECID101"
12873 .row &%ibase_servers%& "InterBase servers"
12874 .row &%ldap_ca_cert_dir%& "dir of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
12875 .row &%ldap_ca_cert_file%& "file of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
12876 .row &%ldap_cert_file%& "client cert file for LDAP"
12877 .row &%ldap_cert_key%& "client key file for LDAP"
12878 .row &%ldap_cipher_suite%& "TLS negotiation preference control"
12879 .row &%ldap_default_servers%& "used if no server in query"
12880 .row &%ldap_require_cert%& "action to take without LDAP server cert"
12881 .row &%ldap_start_tls%& "require TLS within LDAP"
12882 .row &%ldap_version%& "set protocol version"
12883 .row &%lookup_open_max%& "lookup files held open"
12884 .row &%mysql_servers%& "default MySQL servers"
12885 .row &%oracle_servers%& "Oracle servers"
12886 .row &%pgsql_servers%& "default PostgreSQL servers"
12887 .row &%sqlite_lock_timeout%& "as it says"
12892 .section "Message ids" "SECID102"
12894 .row &%message_id_header_domain%& "used to build &'Message-ID:'& header"
12895 .row &%message_id_header_text%& "ditto"
12900 .section "Embedded Perl Startup" "SECID103"
12902 .row &%perl_at_start%& "always start the interpreter"
12903 .row &%perl_startup%& "code to obey when starting Perl"
12908 .section "Daemon" "SECID104"
12910 .row &%daemon_smtp_ports%& "default ports"
12911 .row &%daemon_startup_retries%& "number of times to retry"
12912 .row &%daemon_startup_sleep%& "time to sleep between tries"
12913 .row &%extra_local_interfaces%& "not necessarily listened on"
12914 .row &%local_interfaces%& "on which to listen, with optional ports"
12915 .row &%pid_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
12916 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
12921 .section "Resource control" "SECID105"
12923 .row &%check_log_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
12924 .row &%check_log_space%& "before accepting a message"
12925 .row &%check_spool_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
12926 .row &%check_spool_space%& "before accepting a message"
12927 .row &%deliver_queue_load_max%& "no queue deliveries if load high"
12928 .row &%queue_only_load%& "queue incoming if load high"
12929 .row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
12930 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
12931 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
12932 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
12933 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
12934 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
12935 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
12936 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
12937 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
12938 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
12940 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
12941 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
12942 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
12943 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "SMTP from reserved hosts if load high"
12944 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
12949 .section "Policy controls" "SECID106"
12951 .row &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
12952 .row &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
12953 .row &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL for start of non-SMTP message"
12954 .row &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
12955 .row &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for connection"
12956 .row &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL for DATA"
12957 .row &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for DKIM verification"
12958 .row &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
12959 .row &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
12960 .row &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for EHLO or HELO"
12961 .row &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
12962 .row &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for AUTH on MAIL command"
12963 .row &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for MIME parts"
12964 .row &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL for start of data"
12965 .row &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
12966 .row &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
12967 .row &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
12968 .row &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
12969 .row &%av_scanner%& "specify virus scanner"
12970 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
12972 .row &%dns_csa_search_limit%& "control CSA parent search depth"
12973 .row &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& "en/disable CSA IP reverse search"
12974 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
12975 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
12976 .row &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& "allow syntactic junk from these hosts"
12977 .row &%helo_allow_chars%& "allow illegal chars in HELO names"
12978 .row &%helo_lookup_domains%& "lookup hostname for these HELO names"
12979 .row &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& "HELO soft-checked for these hosts"
12980 .row &%helo_verify_hosts%& "HELO hard-checked for these hosts"
12981 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
12982 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
12983 .row &%host_reject_connection%& "reject connection from these hosts"
12984 .row &%hosts_treat_as_local%& "useful in some cluster configurations"
12985 .row &%local_scan_timeout%& "timeout for &[local_scan()]&"
12986 .row &%message_size_limit%& "for all messages"
12987 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
12988 .row &%spamd_address%& "set interface to SpamAssassin"
12989 .row &%strict_acl_vars%& "object to unset ACL variables"
12994 .section "Callout cache" "SECID107"
12996 .row &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative domain cache &&&
12998 .row &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive domain cache &&&
13000 .row &%callout_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative address cache item"
13001 .row &%callout_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive address cache item"
13002 .row &%callout_random_local_part%& "string to use for &""random""& testing"
13007 .section "TLS" "SECID108"
13009 .row &%gnutls_compat_mode%& "use GnuTLS compatibility mode"
13010 .row &%gnutls_enable_pkcs11%& "allow GnuTLS to autoload PKCS11 modules"
13011 .row &%openssl_options%& "adjust OpenSSL compatibility options"
13012 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
13013 .row &%tls_certificate%& "location of server certificate"
13014 .row &%tls_crl%& "certificate revocation list"
13015 .row &%tls_dh_max_bits%& "clamp D-H bit count suggestion"
13016 .row &%tls_dhparam%& "DH parameters for server"
13017 .row &%tls_on_connect_ports%& "specify SSMTP (SMTPS) ports"
13018 .row &%tls_privatekey%& "location of server private key"
13019 .row &%tls_remember_esmtp%& "don't reset after starting TLS"
13020 .row &%tls_require_ciphers%& "specify acceptable ciphers"
13021 .row &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& "try to verify client certificate"
13022 .row &%tls_verify_certificates%& "expected client certificates"
13023 .row &%tls_verify_hosts%& "insist on client certificate verify"
13028 .section "Local user handling" "SECID109"
13030 .row &%finduser_retries%& "useful in NIS environments"
13031 .row &%gecos_name%& "used when creating &'Sender:'&"
13032 .row &%gecos_pattern%& "ditto"
13033 .row &%max_username_length%& "for systems that truncate"
13034 .row &%unknown_login%& "used when no login name found"
13035 .row &%unknown_username%& "ditto"
13036 .row &%uucp_from_pattern%& "for recognizing &""From ""& lines"
13037 .row &%uucp_from_sender%& "ditto"
13042 .section "All incoming messages (SMTP and non-SMTP)" "SECID110"
13044 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
13045 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
13046 .row &%message_size_limit%& "applies to all messages"
13047 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
13048 .row &%received_header_text%& "expanded to make &'Received:'&"
13049 .row &%received_headers_max%& "for mail loop detection"
13050 .row &%recipients_max%& "limit per message"
13051 .row &%recipients_max_reject%& "permanently reject excess recipients"
13057 .section "Non-SMTP incoming messages" "SECID111"
13059 .row &%receive_timeout%& "for non-SMTP messages"
13066 .section "Incoming SMTP messages" "SECID112"
13067 See also the &'Policy controls'& section above.
13070 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
13071 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
13072 .row &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified recipients"
13073 .row &%rfc1413_hosts%& "make ident calls to these hosts"
13074 .row &%rfc1413_query_timeout%& "zero disables ident calls"
13075 .row &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified senders"
13076 .row &%smtp_accept_keepalive%& "some TCP/IP magic"
13077 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
13078 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
13079 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
13080 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
13081 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
13082 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
13083 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
13085 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
13086 .row &%smtp_active_hostname%& "host name to use in messages"
13087 .row &%smtp_banner%& "text for welcome banner"
13088 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
13089 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
13090 .row &%smtp_enforce_sync%& "of SMTP command/responses"
13091 .row &%smtp_etrn_command%& "what to run for ETRN"
13092 .row &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& "only one at once"
13093 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if this load"
13094 .row &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& "before dropping connection"
13095 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& "apply ratelimiting to these hosts"
13096 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& "ratelimit for MAIL commands"
13097 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& "ratelimit for RCPT commands"
13098 .row &%smtp_receive_timeout%& "per command or data line"
13099 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
13100 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
13105 .section "SMTP extensions" "SECID113"
13107 .row &%accept_8bitmime%& "advertise 8BITMIME"
13108 .row &%auth_advertise_hosts%& "advertise AUTH to these hosts"
13109 .row &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& "allow &""From ""& from these hosts"
13110 .row &%ignore_fromline_local%& "allow &""From ""& from local SMTP"
13111 .row &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%& "advertise pipelining to these hosts"
13112 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
13117 .section "Processing messages" "SECID114"
13119 .row &%allow_domain_literals%& "recognize domain literal syntax"
13120 .row &%allow_mx_to_ip%& "allow MX to point to IP address"
13121 .row &%allow_utf8_domains%& "in addresses"
13122 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
13124 .row &%delivery_date_remove%& "from incoming messages"
13125 .row &%envelope_to_remove%& "from incoming messages"
13126 .row &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& "affects &%-t%& processing"
13127 .row &%headers_charset%& "default for translations"
13128 .row &%qualify_domain%& "default for senders"
13129 .row &%qualify_recipient%& "default for recipients"
13130 .row &%return_path_remove%& "from incoming messages"
13131 .row &%strip_excess_angle_brackets%& "in addresses"
13132 .row &%strip_trailing_dot%& "at end of addresses"
13133 .row &%untrusted_set_sender%& "untrusted can set envelope sender"
13138 .section "System filter" "SECID115"
13140 .row &%system_filter%& "locate system filter"
13141 .row &%system_filter_directory_transport%& "transport for delivery to a &&&
13143 .row &%system_filter_file_transport%& "transport for delivery to a file"
13144 .row &%system_filter_group%& "group for filter running"
13145 .row &%system_filter_pipe_transport%& "transport for delivery to a pipe"
13146 .row &%system_filter_reply_transport%& "transport for autoreply delivery"
13147 .row &%system_filter_user%& "user for filter running"
13152 .section "Routing and delivery" "SECID116"
13154 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
13155 .row &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& "for broken domains"
13156 .row &%dns_check_names_pattern%& "pre-DNS syntax check"
13157 .row &%dns_ipv4_lookup%& "only v4 lookup for these domains"
13158 .row &%dns_retrans%& "parameter for resolver"
13159 .row &%dns_retry%& "parameter for resolver"
13160 .row &%dns_use_dnssec%& "parameter for resolver"
13161 .row &%dns_use_edns0%& "parameter for resolver"
13162 .row &%hold_domains%& "hold delivery for these domains"
13163 .row &%local_interfaces%& "for routing checks"
13164 .row &%queue_domains%& "no immediate delivery for these"
13165 .row &%queue_only%& "no immediate delivery at all"
13166 .row &%queue_only_file%& "no immediate delivery if file exists"
13167 .row &%queue_only_load%& "no immediate delivery if load is high"
13168 .row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
13169 .row &%queue_only_override%& "allow command line to override"
13170 .row &%queue_run_in_order%& "order of arrival"
13171 .row &%queue_run_max%& "of simultaneous queue runners"
13172 .row &%queue_smtp_domains%& "no immediate SMTP delivery for these"
13173 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
13174 .row &%remote_sort_domains%& "order of remote deliveries"
13175 .row &%retry_data_expire%& "timeout for retry data"
13176 .row &%retry_interval_max%& "safety net for retry rules"
13181 .section "Bounce and warning messages" "SECID117"
13183 .row &%bounce_message_file%& "content of bounce"
13184 .row &%bounce_message_text%& "content of bounce"
13185 .row &%bounce_return_body%& "include body if returning message"
13186 .row &%bounce_return_message%& "include original message in bounce"
13187 .row &%bounce_return_size_limit%& "limit on returned message"
13188 .row &%bounce_sender_authentication%& "send authenticated sender with bounce"
13189 .row &%dsn_from%& "set &'From:'& contents in bounces"
13190 .row &%errors_copy%& "copy bounce messages"
13191 .row &%errors_reply_to%& "&'Reply-to:'& in bounces"
13192 .row &%delay_warning%& "time schedule"
13193 .row &%delay_warning_condition%& "condition for warning messages"
13194 .row &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& "discard undeliverable bounces"
13195 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
13196 .row &%warn_message_file%& "content of warning message"
13201 .section "Alphabetical list of main options" "SECTalomo"
13202 Those options that undergo string expansion before use are marked with
13205 .option accept_8bitmime main boolean true
13207 .cindex "8-bit characters"
13208 .cindex "log" "selectors"
13209 .cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
13210 This option causes Exim to send 8BITMIME in its response to an SMTP
13211 EHLO command, and to accept the BODY= parameter on MAIL commands.
13212 However, though Exim is 8-bit clean, it is not a protocol converter, and it
13213 takes no steps to do anything special with messages received by this route.
13215 Historically Exim kept this option off by default, but the maintainers
13216 feel that in today's Internet, this causes more problems than it solves.
13217 It now defaults to true.
13218 A more detailed analysis of the issues is provided by Dan Bernstein:
13220 &url(http://cr.yp.to/smtp/8bitmime.html)
13223 To log received 8BITMIME status use
13225 log_selector = +8bitmime
13228 .option acl_not_smtp main string&!! unset
13229 .cindex "&ACL;" "for non-SMTP messages"
13230 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
13231 This option defines the ACL that is run when a non-SMTP message has been
13232 read and is on the point of being accepted. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
13235 .option acl_not_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
13236 This option defines the ACL that is run for individual MIME parts of non-SMTP
13237 messages. It operates in exactly the same way as &%acl_smtp_mime%& operates for
13240 .option acl_not_smtp_start main string&!! unset
13241 .cindex "&ACL;" "at start of non-SMTP message"
13242 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
13243 This option defines the ACL that is run before Exim starts reading a
13244 non-SMTP message. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13246 .option acl_smtp_auth main string&!! unset
13247 .cindex "&ACL;" "setting up for SMTP commands"
13248 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
13249 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP AUTH command is
13250 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13252 .option acl_smtp_connect main string&!! unset
13253 .cindex "&ACL;" "on SMTP connection"
13254 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP connection is received.
13255 See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13257 .option acl_smtp_data main string&!! unset
13258 .cindex "DATA" "ACL for"
13259 This option defines the ACL that is run after an SMTP DATA command has been
13260 processed and the message itself has been received, but before the final
13261 acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13263 .option acl_smtp_etrn main string&!! unset
13264 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
13265 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP ETRN command is
13266 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13268 .option acl_smtp_expn main string&!! unset
13269 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
13270 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EXPN command is
13271 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13273 .option acl_smtp_helo main string&!! unset
13274 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
13275 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
13276 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EHLO or HELO
13277 command is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13280 .option acl_smtp_mail main string&!! unset
13281 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
13282 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP MAIL command is
13283 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13285 .option acl_smtp_mailauth main string&!! unset
13286 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
13287 This option defines the ACL that is run when there is an AUTH parameter on
13288 a MAIL command. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs, and chapter
13289 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
13291 .option acl_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
13292 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
13293 This option is available when Exim is built with the content-scanning
13294 extension. It defines the ACL that is run for each MIME part in a message. See
13295 section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>& for details.
13297 .option acl_smtp_predata main string&!! unset
13298 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP DATA command is
13299 received, before the message itself is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
13302 .option acl_smtp_quit main string&!! unset
13303 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
13304 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP QUIT command is
13305 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13307 .option acl_smtp_rcpt main string&!! unset
13308 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
13309 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP RCPT command is
13310 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13312 .option acl_smtp_starttls main string&!! unset
13313 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
13314 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP STARTTLS command is
13315 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13317 .option acl_smtp_vrfy main string&!! unset
13318 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
13319 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP VRFY command is
13320 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13322 .option admin_groups main "string list&!!" unset
13323 .cindex "admin user"
13324 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If the
13325 current group or any of the supplementary groups of an Exim caller is in this
13326 colon-separated list, the caller has admin privileges. If all your system
13327 programmers are in a specific group, for example, you can give them all Exim
13328 admin privileges by putting that group in &%admin_groups%&. However, this does
13329 not permit them to read Exim's spool files (whose group owner is the Exim gid).
13330 To permit this, you have to add individuals to the Exim group.
13332 .option allow_domain_literals main boolean false
13333 .cindex "domain literal"
13334 If this option is set, the RFC 2822 domain literal format is permitted in
13335 email addresses. The option is not set by default, because the domain literal
13336 format is not normally required these days, and few people know about it. It
13337 has, however, been exploited by mail abusers.
13339 Unfortunately, it seems that some DNS black list maintainers are using this
13340 format to report black listing to postmasters. If you want to accept messages
13341 addressed to your hosts by IP address, you need to set
13342 &%allow_domain_literals%& true, and also to add &`@[]`& to the list of local
13343 domains (defined in the named domain list &%local_domains%& in the default
13344 configuration). This &"magic string"& matches the domain literal form of all
13345 the local host's IP addresses.
13348 .option allow_mx_to_ip main boolean false
13349 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to IP address"
13350 It appears that more and more DNS zone administrators are breaking the rules
13351 and putting domain names that look like IP addresses on the right hand side of
13352 MX records. Exim follows the rules and rejects this, giving an error message
13353 that explains the mis-configuration. However, some other MTAs support this
13354 practice, so to avoid &"Why can't Exim do this?"& complaints,
13355 &%allow_mx_to_ip%& exists, in order to enable this heinous activity. It is not
13356 recommended, except when you have no other choice.
13358 .option allow_utf8_domains main boolean false
13359 .cindex "domain" "UTF-8 characters in"
13360 .cindex "UTF-8" "in domain name"
13361 Lots of discussion is going on about internationalized domain names. One
13362 camp is strongly in favour of just using UTF-8 characters, and it seems
13363 that at least two other MTAs permit this. This option allows Exim users to
13364 experiment if they wish.
13366 If it is set true, Exim's domain parsing function allows valid
13367 UTF-8 multicharacters to appear in domain name components, in addition to
13368 letters, digits, and hyphens. However, just setting this option is not
13369 enough; if you want to look up these domain names in the DNS, you must also
13370 adjust the value of &%dns_check_names_pattern%& to match the extended form. A
13371 suitable setting is:
13373 dns_check_names_pattern = (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[a-z0-9\xc0-\xff]\
13374 (?>[-a-z0-9\x80-\xff]*[a-z0-9\x80-\xbf])?)+$
13376 Alternatively, you can just disable this feature by setting
13378 dns_check_names_pattern =
13380 That is, set the option to an empty string so that no check is done.
13383 .option auth_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
13384 .cindex "authentication" "advertising"
13385 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising"
13386 If any server authentication mechanisms are configured, Exim advertises them in
13387 response to an EHLO command only if the calling host matches this list.
13388 Otherwise, Exim does not advertise AUTH.
13389 Exim does not accept AUTH commands from clients to which it has not
13390 advertised the availability of AUTH. The advertising of individual
13391 authentication mechanisms can be controlled by the use of the
13392 &%server_advertise_condition%& generic authenticator option on the individual
13393 authenticators. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for further details.
13395 Certain mail clients (for example, Netscape) require the user to provide a name
13396 and password for authentication if AUTH is advertised, even though it may
13397 not be needed (the host may accept messages from hosts on its local LAN without
13398 authentication, for example). The &%auth_advertise_hosts%& option can be used
13399 to make these clients more friendly by excluding them from the set of hosts to
13400 which Exim advertises AUTH.
13402 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising when encrypted"
13403 If you want to advertise the availability of AUTH only when the connection
13404 is encrypted using TLS, you can make use of the fact that the value of this
13405 option is expanded, with a setting like this:
13407 auth_advertise_hosts = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{}{*}}
13409 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
13410 If &$tls_in_cipher$& is empty, the session is not encrypted, and the result of
13411 the expansion is empty, thus matching no hosts. Otherwise, the result of the
13412 expansion is *, which matches all hosts.
13415 .option auto_thaw main time 0s
13416 .cindex "thawing messages"
13417 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
13418 If this option is set to a time greater than zero, a queue runner will try a
13419 new delivery attempt on any frozen message, other than a bounce message, if
13420 this much time has passed since it was frozen. This may result in the message
13421 being re-frozen if nothing has changed since the last attempt. It is a way of
13422 saying &"keep on trying, even though there are big problems"&.
13424 &*Note*&: This is an old option, which predates &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
13425 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. It is retained for compatibility, but it is not
13426 thought to be very useful any more, and its use should probably be avoided.
13429 .option av_scanner main string "see below"
13430 This option is available if Exim is built with the content-scanning extension.
13431 It specifies which anti-virus scanner to use. The default value is:
13433 sophie:/var/run/sophie
13435 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
13436 before use. See section &<<SECTscanvirus>>& for further details.
13439 .option bi_command main string unset
13441 This option supplies the name of a command that is run when Exim is called with
13442 the &%-bi%& option (see chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&). The string value is
13443 just the command name, it is not a complete command line. If an argument is
13444 required, it must come from the &%-oA%& command line option.
13447 .option bounce_message_file main string unset
13448 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
13449 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
13450 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
13451 for constructing bounce messages. Details of the file's contents are given in
13452 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%warn_message_file%&.
13455 .option bounce_message_text main string unset
13456 When this option is set, its contents are included in the default bounce
13457 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
13458 delivery software."& It is not used if &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
13460 .option bounce_return_body main boolean true
13461 .cindex "bounce message" "including body"
13462 This option controls whether the body of an incoming message is included in a
13463 bounce message when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The default setting
13464 causes the entire message, both header and body, to be returned (subject to the
13465 value of &%bounce_return_size_limit%&). If this option is false, only the
13466 message header is included. In the case of a non-SMTP message containing an
13467 error that is detected during reception, only those header lines preceding the
13468 point at which the error was detected are returned.
13469 .cindex "bounce message" "including original"
13471 .option bounce_return_message main boolean true
13472 If this option is set false, none of the original message is included in
13473 bounce messages generated by Exim. See also &%bounce_return_size_limit%& and
13474 &%bounce_return_body%&.
13477 .option bounce_return_size_limit main integer 100K
13478 .cindex "size" "of bounce, limit"
13479 .cindex "bounce message" "size limit"
13480 .cindex "limit" "bounce message size"
13481 This option sets a limit in bytes on the size of messages that are returned to
13482 senders as part of bounce messages when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The
13483 limit should be less than the value of the global &%message_size_limit%& and of
13484 any &%message_size_limit%& settings on transports, to allow for the bounce text
13485 that Exim generates. If this option is set to zero there is no limit.
13487 When the body of any message that is to be included in a bounce message is
13488 greater than the limit, it is truncated, and a comment pointing this out is
13489 added at the top. The actual cutoff may be greater than the value given, owing
13490 to the use of buffering for transferring the message in chunks (typically 8K in
13491 size). The idea is to save bandwidth on those undeliverable 15-megabyte
13494 .option bounce_sender_authentication main string unset
13495 .cindex "bounce message" "sender authentication"
13496 .cindex "authentication" "bounce message"
13497 .cindex "AUTH" "on bounce message"
13498 This option provides an authenticated sender address that is sent with any
13499 bounce messages generated by Exim that are sent over an authenticated SMTP
13500 connection. A typical setting might be:
13502 bounce_sender_authentication = mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
13504 which would cause bounce messages to be sent using the SMTP command:
13506 MAIL FROM:<> AUTH=mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
13508 The value of &%bounce_sender_authentication%& must always be a complete email
13511 .option callout_domain_negative_expire main time 3h
13512 .cindex "caching" "callout timeouts"
13513 .cindex "callout" "caching timeouts"
13514 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for a
13515 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
13516 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
13519 .option callout_domain_positive_expire main time 7d
13520 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for a
13521 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
13522 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
13525 .option callout_negative_expire main time 2h
13526 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for an
13527 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
13528 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
13531 .option callout_positive_expire main time 24h
13532 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for an
13533 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
13534 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
13537 .option callout_random_local_part main string&!! "see below"
13538 This option defines the &"random"& local part that can be used as part of
13539 callout verification. The default value is
13541 $primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
13543 See section &<<CALLaddparcall>>& for details of how this value is used.
13546 .option check_log_inodes main integer 0
13547 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
13550 .option check_log_space main integer 0
13551 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
13553 .oindex "&%check_rfc2047_length%&"
13554 .cindex "RFC 2047" "disabling length check"
13555 .option check_rfc2047_length main boolean true
13556 RFC 2047 defines a way of encoding non-ASCII characters in headers using a
13557 system of &"encoded words"&. The RFC specifies a maximum length for an encoded
13558 word; strings to be encoded that exceed this length are supposed to use
13559 multiple encoded words. By default, Exim does not recognize encoded words that
13560 exceed the maximum length. However, it seems that some software, in violation
13561 of the RFC, generates overlong encoded words. If &%check_rfc2047_length%& is
13562 set false, Exim recognizes encoded words of any length.
13565 .option check_spool_inodes main integer 0
13566 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
13569 .option check_spool_space main integer 0
13570 .cindex "checking disk space"
13571 .cindex "disk space, checking"
13572 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
13573 The four &%check_...%& options allow for checking of disk resources before a
13574 message is accepted.
13576 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
13577 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
13578 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
13579 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
13580 When any of these options are set, they apply to all incoming messages. If you
13581 want to apply different checks to different kinds of message, you can do so by
13582 testing the variables &$log_inodes$&, &$log_space$&, &$spool_inodes$&, and
13583 &$spool_space$& in an ACL with appropriate additional conditions.
13586 &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_spool_inodes%& check the spool partition if
13587 either value is greater than zero, for example:
13589 check_spool_space = 10M
13590 check_spool_inodes = 100
13592 The spool partition is the one that contains the directory defined by
13593 SPOOL_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is used for holding messages in
13596 &%check_log_space%& and &%check_log_inodes%& check the partition in which log
13597 files are written if either is greater than zero. These should be set only if
13598 &%log_file_path%& and &%spool_directory%& refer to different partitions.
13600 If there is less space or fewer inodes than requested, Exim refuses to accept
13601 incoming mail. In the case of SMTP input this is done by giving a 452 temporary
13602 error response to the MAIL command. If ESMTP is in use and there was a
13603 SIZE parameter on the MAIL command, its value is added to the
13604 &%check_spool_space%& value, and the check is performed even if
13605 &%check_spool_space%& is zero, unless &%no_smtp_check_spool_space%& is set.
13607 The values for &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_log_space%& are held as a
13608 number of kilobytes. If a non-multiple of 1024 is specified, it is rounded up.
13610 For non-SMTP input and for batched SMTP input, the test is done at start-up; on
13611 failure a message is written to stderr and Exim exits with a non-zero code, as
13612 it obviously cannot send an error message of any kind.
13614 .option daemon_smtp_ports main string &`smtp`&
13615 .cindex "port" "for daemon"
13616 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
13617 This option specifies one or more default SMTP ports on which the Exim daemon
13618 listens. See chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& for details of how it is used. For
13619 backward compatibility, &%daemon_smtp_port%& (singular) is a synonym.
13621 .option daemon_startup_retries main integer 9
13622 .cindex "daemon startup, retrying"
13623 This option, along with &%daemon_startup_sleep%&, controls the retrying done by
13624 the daemon at startup when it cannot immediately bind a listening socket
13625 (typically because the socket is already in use): &%daemon_startup_retries%&
13626 defines the number of retries after the first failure, and
13627 &%daemon_startup_sleep%& defines the length of time to wait between retries.
13629 .option daemon_startup_sleep main time 30s
13630 See &%daemon_startup_retries%&.
13632 .option delay_warning main "time list" 24h
13633 .cindex "warning of delay"
13634 .cindex "delay warning, specifying"
13635 When a message is delayed, Exim sends a warning message to the sender at
13636 intervals specified by this option. The data is a colon-separated list of times
13637 after which to send warning messages. If the value of the option is an empty
13638 string or a zero time, no warnings are sent. Up to 10 times may be given. If a
13639 message has been on the queue for longer than the last time, the last interval
13640 between the times is used to compute subsequent warning times. For example,
13643 delay_warning = 4h:8h:24h
13645 the first message is sent after 4 hours, the second after 8 hours, and
13646 the third one after 24 hours. After that, messages are sent every 16 hours,
13647 because that is the interval between the last two times on the list. If you set
13648 just one time, it specifies the repeat interval. For example, with:
13652 messages are repeated every six hours. To stop warnings after a given time, set
13653 a very large time at the end of the list. For example:
13655 delay_warning = 2h:12h:99d
13658 .option delay_warning_condition main string&!! "see below"
13659 .vindex "&$domain$&"
13660 The string is expanded at the time a warning message might be sent. If all the
13661 deferred addresses have the same domain, it is set in &$domain$& during the
13662 expansion. Otherwise &$domain$& is empty. If the result of the expansion is a
13663 forced failure, an empty string, or a string matching any of &"0"&, &"no"& or
13664 &"false"& (the comparison being done caselessly) then the warning message is
13665 not sent. The default is:
13667 delay_warning_condition = ${if or {\
13668 { !eq{$h_list-id:$h_list-post:$h_list-subscribe:}{} }\
13669 { match{$h_precedence:}{(?i)bulk|list|junk} }\
13670 { match{$h_auto-submitted:}{(?i)auto-generated|auto-replied} }\
13673 This suppresses the sending of warnings for messages that contain &'List-ID:'&,
13674 &'List-Post:'&, or &'List-Subscribe:'& headers, or have &"bulk"&, &"list"& or
13675 &"junk"& in a &'Precedence:'& header, or have &"auto-generated"& or
13676 &"auto-replied"& in an &'Auto-Submitted:'& header.
13678 .option deliver_drop_privilege main boolean false
13679 .cindex "unprivileged delivery"
13680 .cindex "delivery" "unprivileged"
13681 If this option is set true, Exim drops its root privilege at the start of a
13682 delivery process, and runs as the Exim user throughout. This severely restricts
13683 the kinds of local delivery that are possible, but is viable in certain types
13684 of configuration. There is a discussion about the use of root privilege in
13685 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&.
13687 .option deliver_queue_load_max main fixed-point unset
13688 .cindex "load average"
13689 .cindex "queue runner" "abandoning"
13690 When this option is set, a queue run is abandoned if the system load average
13691 becomes greater than the value of the option. The option has no effect on
13692 ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average.
13693 See also &%queue_only_load%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
13696 .option delivery_date_remove main boolean true
13697 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
13698 Exim's transports have an option for adding a &'Delivery-date:'& header to a
13699 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
13700 handled. &'Delivery-date:'& records the actual time of delivery. Such headers
13701 should not be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be
13702 removed at the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might
13703 occur when a delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
13705 .option disable_fsync main boolean false
13706 .cindex "&[fsync()]&, disabling"
13707 This option is available only if Exim was built with the compile-time option
13708 ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC. When this is not set, a reference to &%disable_fsync%& in
13709 a runtime configuration generates an &"unknown option"& error. You should not
13710 build Exim with ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC or set &%disable_fsync%& unless you
13711 really, really, really understand what you are doing. &'No pre-compiled
13712 distributions of Exim should ever make this option available.'&
13714 When &%disable_fsync%& is set true, Exim no longer calls &[fsync()]& to force
13715 updated files' data to be written to disc before continuing. Unexpected events
13716 such as crashes and power outages may cause data to be lost or scrambled.
13717 Here be Dragons. &*Beware.*&
13720 .option disable_ipv6 main boolean false
13721 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
13722 If this option is set true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
13723 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
13724 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &%manualroute%& router,
13725 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
13726 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
13729 .option dns_again_means_nonexist main "domain list&!!" unset
13730 .cindex "DNS" "&""try again""& response; overriding"
13731 DNS lookups give a &"try again"& response for the DNS errors
13732 &"non-authoritative host not found"& and &"SERVERFAIL"&. This can cause Exim to
13733 keep trying to deliver a message, or to give repeated temporary errors to
13734 incoming mail. Sometimes the effect is caused by a badly set up name server and
13735 may persist for a long time. If a domain which exhibits this problem matches
13736 anything in &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, it is treated as if it did not exist.
13737 This option should be used with care. You can make it apply to reverse lookups
13738 by a setting such as this:
13740 dns_again_means_nonexist = *.in-addr.arpa
13742 This option applies to all DNS lookups that Exim does. It also applies when the
13743 &[gethostbyname()]& or &[getipnodebyname()]& functions give temporary errors,
13744 since these are most likely to be caused by DNS lookup problems. The
13745 &(dnslookup)& router has some options of its own for controlling what happens
13746 when lookups for MX or SRV records give temporary errors. These more specific
13747 options are applied after this global option.
13749 .option dns_check_names_pattern main string "see below"
13750 .cindex "DNS" "pre-check of name syntax"
13751 When this option is set to a non-empty string, it causes Exim to check domain
13752 names for characters that are not allowed in host names before handing them to
13753 the DNS resolver, because some resolvers give temporary errors for names that
13754 contain unusual characters. If a domain name contains any unwanted characters,
13755 a &"not found"& result is forced, and the resolver is not called. The check is
13756 done by matching the domain name against a regular expression, which is the
13757 value of this option. The default pattern is
13759 dns_check_names_pattern = \
13760 (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[^\W_](?>[a-z0-9/-]*[^\W_])?)+$
13762 which permits only letters, digits, slashes, and hyphens in components, but
13763 they must start and end with a letter or digit. Slashes are not, in fact,
13764 permitted in host names, but they are found in certain NS records (which can be
13765 accessed in Exim by using a &%dnsdb%& lookup). If you set
13766 &%allow_utf8_domains%&, you must modify this pattern, or set the option to an
13769 .option dns_csa_search_limit main integer 5
13770 This option controls the depth of parental searching for CSA SRV records in the
13771 DNS, as described in more detail in section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
13773 .option dns_csa_use_reverse main boolean true
13774 This option controls whether or not an IP address, given as a CSA domain, is
13775 reversed and looked up in the reverse DNS, as described in more detail in
13776 section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
13778 .option dns_ipv4_lookup main "domain list&!!" unset
13779 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS lookup for AAAA records"
13780 .cindex "DNS" "IPv6 lookup for AAAA records"
13781 When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support and &%disable_ipv6%& is not set, it
13782 looks for IPv6 address records (AAAA records) as well as IPv4 address records
13783 (A records) when trying to find IP addresses for hosts, unless the host's
13784 domain matches this list.
13786 This is a fudge to help with name servers that give big delays or otherwise do
13787 not work for the AAAA record type. In due course, when the world's name
13788 servers have all been upgraded, there should be no need for this option.
13791 .option dns_retrans main time 0s
13792 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
13793 The options &%dns_retrans%& and &%dns_retry%& can be used to set the
13794 retransmission and retry parameters for DNS lookups. Values of zero (the
13795 defaults) leave the system default settings unchanged. The first value is the
13796 time between retries, and the second is the number of retries. It isn't
13797 totally clear exactly how these settings affect the total time a DNS lookup may
13798 take. I haven't found any documentation about timeouts on DNS lookups; these
13799 parameter values are available in the external resolver interface structure,
13800 but nowhere does it seem to describe how they are used or what you might want
13804 .option dns_retry main integer 0
13805 See &%dns_retrans%& above.
13809 .option dns_use_dnssec main integer -1
13810 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
13811 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
13812 If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
13813 DNS resolver library to either use or not use DNSSEC, overriding the system
13814 default. A value of 0 coerces DNSSEC off, a value of 1 coerces DNSSEC on.
13816 If the resolver library does not support DNSSEC then this option has no effect.
13820 .option dns_use_edns0 main integer -1
13821 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
13822 .cindex "DNS" "EDNS0"
13823 If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
13824 DNS resolver library to either use or not use EDNS0 extensions, overriding
13825 the system default. A value of 0 coerces EDNS0 off, a value of 1 coerces EDNS0
13828 If the resolver library does not support EDNS0 then this option has no effect.
13831 .option drop_cr main boolean false
13832 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
13833 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
13834 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
13836 .option dsn_from main "string&!!" "see below"
13837 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "in bounces"
13838 .cindex "bounce messages" "&'From:'& line, specifying"
13839 This option can be used to vary the contents of &'From:'& header lines in
13840 bounces and other automatically generated messages (&"Delivery Status
13841 Notifications"& &-- hence the name of the option). The default setting is:
13843 dsn_from = Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@$qualify_domain>
13845 The value is expanded every time it is needed. If the expansion fails, a
13846 panic is logged, and the default value is used.
13848 .option envelope_to_remove main boolean true
13849 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
13850 Exim's transports have an option for adding an &'Envelope-to:'& header to a
13851 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
13852 handled. &'Envelope-to:'& records the original recipient address from the
13853 messages's envelope that caused the delivery to happen. Such headers should not
13854 be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be removed at
13855 the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might occur when a
13856 delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
13859 .option errors_copy main "string list&!!" unset
13860 .cindex "bounce message" "copy to other address"
13861 .cindex "copy of bounce message"
13862 Setting this option causes Exim to send bcc copies of bounce messages that it
13863 generates to other addresses. &*Note*&: This does not apply to bounce messages
13864 coming from elsewhere. The value of the option is a colon-separated list of
13865 items. Each item consists of a pattern, terminated by white space, followed by
13866 a comma-separated list of email addresses. If a pattern contains spaces, it
13867 must be enclosed in double quotes.
13869 Each pattern is processed in the same way as a single item in an address list
13870 (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). When a pattern matches the recipient of
13871 the bounce message, the message is copied to the addresses on the list. The
13872 items are scanned in order, and once a matching one is found, no further items
13873 are examined. For example:
13875 errors_copy = spqr@mydomain postmaster@mydomain.example :\
13876 rqps@mydomain hostmaster@mydomain.example,\
13877 postmaster@mydomain.example
13879 .vindex "&$domain$&"
13880 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
13881 The address list is expanded before use. The expansion variables &$local_part$&
13882 and &$domain$& are set from the original recipient of the error message, and if
13883 there was any wildcard matching in the pattern, the expansion
13884 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%errors_copy%&"
13885 variables &$0$&, &$1$&, etc. are set in the normal way.
13888 .option errors_reply_to main string unset
13889 .cindex "bounce message" "&'Reply-to:'& in"
13890 By default, Exim's bounce and delivery warning messages contain the header line
13892 &`From: Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@`&&'qualify-domain'&&`>`&
13894 .oindex &%quota_warn_message%&
13895 where &'qualify-domain'& is the value of the &%qualify_domain%& option.
13896 A warning message that is generated by the &%quota_warn_message%& option in an
13897 &(appendfile)& transport may contain its own &'From:'& header line that
13898 overrides the default.
13900 Experience shows that people reply to bounce messages. If the
13901 &%errors_reply_to%& option is set, a &'Reply-To:'& header is added to bounce
13902 and warning messages. For example:
13904 errors_reply_to = postmaster@my.domain.example
13906 The value of the option is not expanded. It must specify a valid RFC 2822
13907 address. However, if a warning message that is generated by the
13908 &%quota_warn_message%& option in an &(appendfile)& transport contain its
13909 own &'Reply-To:'& header line, the value of the &%errors_reply_to%& option is
13913 .option exim_group main string "compile-time configured"
13914 .cindex "gid (group id)" "Exim's own"
13915 .cindex "Exim group"
13916 This option changes the gid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
13917 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. The value of this
13918 option is used only when &%exim_user%& is also set. Unless it consists entirely
13919 of digits, the string is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&, and failure causes a
13920 configuration error. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of
13924 .option exim_path main string "see below"
13925 .cindex "Exim binary, path name"
13926 This option specifies the path name of the Exim binary, which is used when Exim
13927 needs to re-exec itself. The default is set up to point to the file &'exim'& in
13928 the directory configured at compile time by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting. It
13929 is necessary to change &%exim_path%& if, exceptionally, Exim is run from some
13931 &*Warning*&: Do not use a macro to define the value of this option, because
13932 you will break those Exim utilities that scan the configuration file to find
13933 where the binary is. (They then use the &%-bP%& option to extract option
13934 settings such as the value of &%spool_directory%&.)
13937 .option exim_user main string "compile-time configured"
13938 .cindex "uid (user id)" "Exim's own"
13939 .cindex "Exim user"
13940 This option changes the uid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
13941 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. Ownership of the run
13942 time configuration file and the use of the &%-C%& and &%-D%& command line
13943 options is checked against the values in the binary, not what is set here.
13945 Unless it consists entirely of digits, the string is looked up using
13946 &[getpwnam()]&, and failure causes a configuration error. If &%exim_group%& is
13947 not also supplied, the gid is taken from the result of &[getpwnam()]& if it is
13948 used. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of security issues.
13951 .option extra_local_interfaces main "string list" unset
13952 This option defines network interfaces that are to be considered local when
13953 routing, but which are not used for listening by the daemon. See section
13954 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>& for details.
13957 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
13958 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
13960 .option "extract_addresses_remove_ &~&~arguments" main boolean true &&&
13961 extract_addresses_remove_arguments
13963 .cindex "command line" "addresses with &%-t%&"
13964 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
13965 According to some Sendmail documentation (Sun, IRIX, HP-UX), if any addresses
13966 are present on the command line when the &%-t%& option is used to build an
13967 envelope from a message's &'To:'&, &'Cc:'& and &'Bcc:'& headers, the command
13968 line addresses are removed from the recipients list. This is also how Smail
13969 behaves. However, other Sendmail documentation (the O'Reilly book) states that
13970 command line addresses are added to those obtained from the header lines. When
13971 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& is true (the default), Exim subtracts
13972 argument headers. If it is set false, Exim adds rather than removes argument
13976 .option finduser_retries main integer 0
13977 .cindex "NIS, retrying user lookups"
13978 On systems running NIS or other schemes in which user and group information is
13979 distributed from a remote system, there can be times when &[getpwnam()]& and
13980 related functions fail, even when given valid data, because things time out.
13981 Unfortunately these failures cannot be distinguished from genuine &"not found"&
13982 errors. If &%finduser_retries%& is set greater than zero, Exim will try that
13983 many extra times to find a user or a group, waiting for one second between
13986 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&" "multiple reading of"
13987 You should not set this option greater than zero if your user information is in
13988 a traditional &_/etc/passwd_& file, because it will cause Exim needlessly to
13989 search the file multiple times for non-existent users, and also cause delay.
13993 .option freeze_tell main "string list, comma separated" unset
13994 .cindex "freezing messages" "sending a message when freezing"
13995 On encountering certain errors, or when configured to do so in a system filter,
13996 ACL, or special router, Exim freezes a message. This means that no further
13997 delivery attempts take place until an administrator thaws the message, or the
13998 &%auto_thaw%&, &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&, or &%timeout_frozen_after%&
13999 feature cause it to be processed. If &%freeze_tell%& is set, Exim generates a
14000 warning message whenever it freezes something, unless the message it is
14001 freezing is a locally-generated bounce message. (Without this exception there
14002 is the possibility of looping.) The warning message is sent to the addresses
14003 supplied as the comma-separated value of this option. If several of the
14004 message's addresses cause freezing, only a single message is sent. If the
14005 freezing was automatic, the reason(s) for freezing can be found in the message
14006 log. If you configure freezing in a filter or ACL, you must arrange for any
14007 logging that you require.
14010 .option gecos_name main string&!! unset
14012 .cindex "&""gecos""& field, parsing"
14013 Some operating systems, notably HP-UX, use the &"gecos"& field in the system
14014 password file to hold other information in addition to users' real names. Exim
14015 looks up this field for use when it is creating &'Sender:'& or &'From:'&
14016 headers. If either &%gecos_pattern%& or &%gecos_name%& are unset, the contents
14017 of the field are used unchanged, except that, if an ampersand is encountered,
14018 it is replaced by the user's login name with the first character forced to
14019 upper case, since this is a convention that is observed on many systems.
14021 When these options are set, &%gecos_pattern%& is treated as a regular
14022 expression that is to be applied to the field (again with && replaced by the
14023 login name), and if it matches, &%gecos_name%& is expanded and used as the
14026 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%gecos_name%&"
14027 Numeric variables such as &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. can be used in the expansion to
14028 pick up sub-fields that were matched by the pattern. In HP-UX, where the user's
14029 name terminates at the first comma, the following can be used:
14031 gecos_pattern = ([^,]*)
14035 .option gecos_pattern main string unset
14036 See &%gecos_name%& above.
14039 .option gnutls_compat_mode main boolean unset
14040 This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
14041 server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
14042 implementations of TLS.
14046 option gnutls_enable_pkcs11 main boolean unset
14047 This option will let GnuTLS (2.12.0 or later) autoload PKCS11 modules with
14048 the p11-kit configuration files in &_/etc/pkcs11/modules/_&.
14051 &url(http://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Smart-cards-and-HSMs)
14057 .option headers_charset main string "see below"
14058 This option sets a default character set for translating from encoded MIME
14059 &"words"& in header lines, when referenced by an &$h_xxx$& expansion item. The
14060 default is the value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The
14061 ultimate default is ISO-8859-1. For more details see the description of header
14062 insertions in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
14066 .option header_maxsize main integer "see below"
14067 .cindex "header section" "maximum size of"
14068 .cindex "limit" "size of message header section"
14069 This option controls the overall maximum size of a message's header
14070 section. The default is the value of HEADER_MAXSIZE in
14071 &_Local/Makefile_&; the default for that is 1M. Messages with larger header
14072 sections are rejected.
14075 .option header_line_maxsize main integer 0
14076 .cindex "header lines" "maximum size of"
14077 .cindex "limit" "size of one header line"
14078 This option limits the length of any individual header line in a message, after
14079 all the continuations have been joined together. Messages with individual
14080 header lines that are longer than the limit are rejected. The default value of
14081 zero means &"no limit"&.
14086 .option helo_accept_junk_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14087 .cindex "HELO" "accepting junk data"
14088 .cindex "EHLO" "accepting junk data"
14089 Exim checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands for incoming SMTP
14090 mail, and gives an error response for invalid data. Unfortunately, there are
14091 some SMTP clients that send syntactic junk. They can be accommodated by setting
14092 this option. Note that this is a syntax check only. See &%helo_verify_hosts%&
14093 if you want to do semantic checking.
14094 See also &%helo_allow_chars%& for a way of extending the permitted character
14098 .option helo_allow_chars main string unset
14099 .cindex "HELO" "underscores in"
14100 .cindex "EHLO" "underscores in"
14101 .cindex "underscore in EHLO/HELO"
14102 This option can be set to a string of rogue characters that are permitted in
14103 all EHLO and HELO names in addition to the standard letters, digits,
14104 hyphens, and dots. If you really must allow underscores, you can set
14106 helo_allow_chars = _
14108 Note that the value is one string, not a list.
14111 .option helo_lookup_domains main "domain list&!!" &`@:@[]`&
14112 .cindex "HELO" "forcing reverse lookup"
14113 .cindex "EHLO" "forcing reverse lookup"
14114 If the domain given by a client in a HELO or EHLO command matches this
14115 list, a reverse lookup is done in order to establish the host's true name. The
14116 default forces a lookup if the client host gives the server's name or any of
14117 its IP addresses (in brackets), something that broken clients have been seen to
14121 .option helo_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14122 .cindex "HELO verifying" "optional"
14123 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, optional"
14124 By default, Exim just checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands (see
14125 &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& and &%helo_allow_chars%&). However, some sites like
14126 to do more extensive checking of the data supplied by these commands. The ACL
14127 condition &`verify = helo`& is provided to make this possible.
14128 Formerly, it was necessary also to set this option (&%helo_try_verify_hosts%&)
14129 to force the check to occur. From release 4.53 onwards, this is no longer
14130 necessary. If the check has not been done before &`verify = helo`& is
14131 encountered, it is done at that time. Consequently, this option is obsolete.
14132 Its specification is retained here for backwards compatibility.
14134 When an EHLO or HELO command is received, if the calling host matches
14135 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, Exim checks that the host name given in the HELO or
14136 EHLO command either:
14139 is an IP literal matching the calling address of the host, or
14141 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
14142 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
14143 matches the host name that Exim obtains by doing a reverse lookup of the
14144 calling host address, or
14146 when looked up using &[gethostbyname()]& (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when
14147 available) yields the calling host address.
14150 However, the EHLO or HELO command is not rejected if any of the checks
14151 fail. Processing continues, but the result of the check is remembered, and can
14152 be detected later in an ACL by the &`verify = helo`& condition.
14154 .option helo_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14155 .cindex "HELO verifying" "mandatory"
14156 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, mandatory"
14157 Like &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, this option is obsolete, and retained only for
14158 backwards compatibility. For hosts that match this option, Exim checks the host
14159 name given in the HELO or EHLO in the same way as for
14160 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&. If the check fails, the HELO or EHLO command is
14161 rejected with a 550 error, and entries are written to the main and reject logs.
14162 If a MAIL command is received before EHLO or HELO, it is rejected with a 503
14165 .option hold_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
14166 .cindex "domain" "delaying delivery"
14167 .cindex "delivery" "delaying certain domains"
14168 This option allows mail for particular domains to be held on the queue
14169 manually. The option is overridden if a message delivery is forced with the
14170 &%-M%&, &%-qf%&, &%-Rf%& or &%-Sf%& options, and also while testing or
14171 verifying addresses using &%-bt%& or &%-bv%&. Otherwise, if a domain matches an
14172 item in &%hold_domains%&, no routing or delivery for that address is done, and
14173 it is deferred every time the message is looked at.
14175 This option is intended as a temporary operational measure for delaying the
14176 delivery of mail while some problem is being sorted out, or some new
14177 configuration tested. If you just want to delay the processing of some
14178 domains until a queue run occurs, you should use &%queue_domains%& or
14179 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, not &%hold_domains%&.
14181 A setting of &%hold_domains%& does not override Exim's code for removing
14182 messages from the queue if they have been there longer than the longest retry
14183 time in any retry rule. If you want to hold messages for longer than the normal
14184 retry times, insert a dummy retry rule with a long retry time.
14187 .option host_lookup main "host list&!!" unset
14188 .cindex "host name" "lookup, forcing"
14189 Exim does not look up the name of a calling host from its IP address unless it
14190 is required to compare against some host list, or the host matches
14191 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&, or the host matches this
14192 option (which normally contains IP addresses rather than host names). The
14193 default configuration file contains
14197 which causes a lookup to happen for all hosts. If the expense of these lookups
14198 is felt to be too great, the setting can be changed or removed.
14200 After a successful reverse lookup, Exim does a forward lookup on the name it
14201 has obtained, to verify that it yields the IP address that it started with. If
14202 this check fails, Exim behaves as if the name lookup failed.
14204 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
14205 .vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
14206 After any kind of failure, the host name (in &$sender_host_name$&) remains
14207 unset, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to the string &"1"&. See also
14208 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, &%helo_lookup_domains%&, and
14209 &`verify = reverse_host_lookup`& in ACLs.
14212 .option host_lookup_order main "string list" &`bydns:byaddr`&
14213 This option specifies the order of different lookup methods when Exim is trying
14214 to find a host name from an IP address. The default is to do a DNS lookup
14215 first, and then to try a local lookup (using &[gethostbyaddr()]& or equivalent)
14216 if that fails. You can change the order of these lookups, or omit one entirely,
14219 &*Warning*&: The &"byaddr"& method does not always yield aliases when there are
14220 multiple PTR records in the DNS and the IP address is not listed in
14221 &_/etc/hosts_&. Different operating systems give different results in this
14222 case. That is why the default tries a DNS lookup first.
14226 .option host_reject_connection main "host list&!!" unset
14227 .cindex "host" "rejecting connections from"
14228 If this option is set, incoming SMTP calls from the hosts listed are rejected
14229 as soon as the connection is made.
14230 This option is obsolete, and retained only for backward compatibility, because
14231 nowadays the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& can also reject incoming
14232 connections immediately.
14234 The ability to give an immediate rejection (either by this option or using an
14235 ACL) is provided for use in unusual cases. Many hosts will just try again,
14236 sometimes without much delay. Normally, it is better to use an ACL to reject
14237 incoming messages at a later stage, such as after RCPT commands. See
14238 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&.
14241 .option hosts_connection_nolog main "host list&!!" unset
14242 .cindex "host" "not logging connections from"
14243 This option defines a list of hosts for which connection logging does not
14244 happen, even though the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is set. For example,
14245 you might want not to log SMTP connections from local processes, or from
14246 127.0.0.1, or from your local LAN. This option is consulted in the main loop of
14247 the daemon; you should therefore strive to restrict its value to a short inline
14248 list of IP addresses and networks. To disable logging SMTP connections from
14249 local processes, you must create a host list with an empty item. For example:
14251 hosts_connection_nolog = :
14253 If the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is not set, this option has no effect.
14257 .option hosts_treat_as_local main "domain list&!!" unset
14258 .cindex "local host" "domains treated as"
14259 .cindex "host" "treated as local"
14260 If this option is set, any host names that match the domain list are treated as
14261 if they were the local host when Exim is scanning host lists obtained from MX
14263 or other sources. Note that the value of this option is a domain list, not a
14264 host list, because it is always used to check host names, not IP addresses.
14266 This option also applies when Exim is matching the special items
14267 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`& in a domain list (see
14268 section &<<SECTdomainlist>>&), and when checking the &%hosts%& option in the
14269 &(smtp)& transport for the local host (see the &%allow_localhost%& option in
14270 that transport). See also &%local_interfaces%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&, and
14271 chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&, which contains a discussion about local network
14272 interfaces and recognizing the local host.
14275 .option ibase_servers main "string list" unset
14276 .cindex "InterBase" "server list"
14277 This option provides a list of InterBase servers and associated connection data,
14278 to be used in conjunction with &(ibase)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
14279 The option is available only if Exim has been built with InterBase support.
14283 .option ignore_bounce_errors_after main time 10w
14284 .cindex "bounce message" "discarding"
14285 .cindex "discarding bounce message"
14286 This option affects the processing of bounce messages that cannot be delivered,
14287 that is, those that suffer a permanent delivery failure. (Bounce messages that
14288 suffer temporary delivery failures are of course retried in the usual way.)
14290 After a permanent delivery failure, bounce messages are frozen,
14291 because there is no sender to whom they can be returned. When a frozen bounce
14292 message has been on the queue for more than the given time, it is unfrozen at
14293 the next queue run, and a further delivery is attempted. If delivery fails
14294 again, the bounce message is discarded. This makes it possible to keep failed
14295 bounce messages around for a shorter time than the normal maximum retry time
14296 for frozen messages. For example,
14298 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 12h
14300 retries failed bounce message deliveries after 12 hours, discarding any further
14301 failures. If the value of this option is set to a zero time period, bounce
14302 failures are discarded immediately. Setting a very long time (as in the default
14303 value) has the effect of disabling this option. For ways of automatically
14304 dealing with other kinds of frozen message, see &%auto_thaw%& and
14305 &%timeout_frozen_after%&.
14308 .option ignore_fromline_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14309 .cindex "&""From""& line"
14310 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
14311 Some broken SMTP clients insist on sending a UUCP-like &"From&~"& line before
14312 the headers of a message. By default this is treated as the start of the
14313 message's body, which means that any following headers are not recognized as
14314 such. Exim can be made to ignore it by setting &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& to
14315 match those hosts that insist on sending it. If the sender is actually a local
14316 process rather than a remote host, and is using &%-bs%& to inject the messages,
14317 &%ignore_fromline_local%& must be set to achieve this effect.
14320 .option ignore_fromline_local main boolean false
14321 See &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& above.
14324 .option keep_malformed main time 4d
14325 This option specifies the length of time to keep messages whose spool files
14326 have been corrupted in some way. This should, of course, never happen. At the
14327 next attempt to deliver such a message, it gets removed. The incident is
14331 .option ldap_ca_cert_dir main string unset
14332 .cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate directory"
14333 This option indicates which directory contains CA certificates for verifying
14334 a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
14335 While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
14336 Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
14337 and constrained to be a directory.
14340 .option ldap_ca_cert_file main string unset
14341 .cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate file"
14342 This option indicates which file contains CA certificates for verifying
14343 a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
14344 While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
14345 Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
14346 and constrained to be a file.
14349 .option ldap_cert_file main string unset
14350 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS client certificate file"
14351 This option indicates which file contains an TLS client certificate which
14352 Exim should present to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
14353 Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_key%&.
14356 .option ldap_cert_key main string unset
14357 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS client key file"
14358 This option indicates which file contains the secret/private key to use
14359 to prove identity to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
14360 Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_file%&, which contains the
14361 identity to be proven.
14364 .option ldap_cipher_suite main string unset
14365 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS cipher suite"
14366 This controls the TLS cipher-suite negotiation during TLS negotiation with
14367 the LDAP server. See &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& for more details of the format of
14368 cipher-suite options with OpenSSL (as used by LDAP client libraries).
14371 .option ldap_default_servers main "string list" unset
14372 .cindex "LDAP" "default servers"
14373 This option provides a list of LDAP servers which are tried in turn when an
14374 LDAP query does not contain a server. See section &<<SECTforldaque>>& for
14375 details of LDAP queries. This option is available only when Exim has been built
14379 .option ldap_require_cert main string unset.
14380 .cindex "LDAP" "policy for LDAP server TLS cert presentation"
14381 This should be one of the values "hard", "demand", "allow", "try" or "never".
14382 A value other than one of these is interpreted as "never".
14383 See the entry "TLS_REQCERT" in your system man page for ldap.conf(5).
14384 Although Exim does not set a default, the LDAP library probably defaults
14388 .option ldap_start_tls main boolean false
14389 .cindex "LDAP" "whether or not to negotiate TLS"
14390 If set, Exim will attempt to negotiate TLS with the LDAP server when
14391 connecting on a regular LDAP port. This is the LDAP equivalent of SMTP's
14392 "STARTTLS". This is distinct from using "ldaps", which is the LDAP form
14394 In the event of failure to negotiate TLS, the action taken is controlled
14395 by &%ldap_require_cert%&.
14398 .option ldap_version main integer unset
14399 .cindex "LDAP" "protocol version, forcing"
14400 This option can be used to force Exim to set a specific protocol version for
14401 LDAP. If it option is unset, it is shown by the &%-bP%& command line option as
14402 -1. When this is the case, the default is 3 if LDAP_VERSION3 is defined in
14403 the LDAP headers; otherwise it is 2. This option is available only when Exim
14404 has been built with LDAP support.
14408 .option local_from_check main boolean true
14409 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "disabling addition of"
14410 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "disabling checking of"
14411 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
14412 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line, and
14413 checks that the &'From:'& header line matches the login of the calling user and
14414 the domain specified by &%qualify_domain%&.
14416 &*Note*&: An unqualified address (no domain) in the &'From:'& header in a
14417 locally submitted message is automatically qualified by Exim, unless the
14418 &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
14420 You can use &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& to permit affixes
14421 on the local part. If the &'From:'& header line does not match, Exim adds a
14422 &'Sender:'& header with an address constructed from the calling user's login
14423 and the default qualify domain.
14425 If &%local_from_check%& is set false, the &'From:'& header check is disabled,
14426 and no &'Sender:'& header is ever added. If, in addition, you want to retain
14427 &'Sender:'& header lines supplied by untrusted users, you must also set
14428 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true.
14430 .cindex "envelope sender"
14431 These options affect only the header lines in the message. The envelope sender
14432 is still forced to be the login id at the qualify domain unless
14433 &%untrusted_set_sender%& permits the user to supply an envelope sender.
14435 For messages received over TCP/IP, an ACL can specify &"submission mode"& to
14436 request similar header line checking. See section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&, which
14437 has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
14442 .option local_from_prefix main string unset
14443 When Exim checks the &'From:'& header line of locally submitted messages for
14444 matching the login id (see &%local_from_check%& above), it can be configured to
14445 ignore certain prefixes and suffixes in the local part of the address. This is
14446 done by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and/or &%local_from_suffix%& to
14447 appropriate lists, in the same form as the &%local_part_prefix%& and
14448 &%local_part_suffix%& router options (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). For
14451 local_from_prefix = *-
14453 is set, a &'From:'& line containing
14455 From: anything-user@your.domain.example
14457 will not cause a &'Sender:'& header to be added if &'user@your.domain.example'&
14458 matches the actual sender address that is constructed from the login name and
14462 .option local_from_suffix main string unset
14463 See &%local_from_prefix%& above.
14466 .option local_interfaces main "string list" "see below"
14467 This option controls which network interfaces are used by the daemon for
14468 listening; they are also used to identify the local host when routing. Chapter
14469 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a full description of this option and the related
14470 options &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&,
14471 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, and &%tls_on_connect_ports%&. The default value for
14472 &%local_interfaces%& is
14474 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
14476 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is
14478 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
14481 .option local_scan_timeout main time 5m
14482 .cindex "timeout" "for &[local_scan()]& function"
14483 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "timeout"
14484 This timeout applies to the &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
14485 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). Zero means &"no timeout"&. If the timeout is exceeded,
14486 the incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP
14487 message. For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a
14488 non-zero code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
14492 .option local_sender_retain main boolean false
14493 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "retaining from local submission"
14494 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
14495 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line. If you
14496 do not want this to happen, you must set &%local_sender_retain%&, and you must
14497 also set &%local_from_check%& to be false (Exim will complain if you do not).
14498 See also the ACL modifier &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&. Section
14499 &<<SECTthesenhea>>& has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
14504 .option localhost_number main string&!! unset
14505 .cindex "host" "locally unique number for"
14506 .cindex "message ids" "with multiple hosts"
14507 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
14508 Exim's message ids are normally unique only within the local host. If
14509 uniqueness among a set of hosts is required, each host must set a different
14510 value for the &%localhost_number%& option. The string is expanded immediately
14511 after reading the configuration file (so that a number can be computed from the
14512 host name, for example) and the result of the expansion must be a number in the
14513 range 0&--16 (or 0&--10 on operating systems with case-insensitive file
14514 systems). This is available in subsequent string expansions via the variable
14515 &$localhost_number$&. When &%localhost_number is set%&, the final two
14516 characters of the message id, instead of just being a fractional part of the
14517 time, are computed from the time and the local host number as described in
14518 section &<<SECTmessiden>>&.
14522 .option log_file_path main "string list&!!" "set at compile time"
14523 .cindex "log" "file path for"
14524 This option sets the path which is used to determine the names of Exim's log
14525 files, or indicates that logging is to be to syslog, or both. It is expanded
14526 when Exim is entered, so it can, for example, contain a reference to the host
14527 name. If no specific path is set for the log files at compile or run time, they
14528 are written in a sub-directory called &_log_& in Exim's spool directory.
14529 Chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& contains further details about Exim's logging, and
14530 section &<<SECTwhelogwri>>& describes how the contents of &%log_file_path%& are
14531 used. If this string is fixed at your installation (contains no expansion
14532 variables) it is recommended that you do not set this option in the
14533 configuration file, but instead supply the path using LOG_FILE_PATH in
14534 &_Local/Makefile_& so that it is available to Exim for logging errors detected
14535 early on &-- in particular, failure to read the configuration file.
14538 .option log_selector main string unset
14539 .cindex "log" "selectors"
14540 This option can be used to reduce or increase the number of things that Exim
14541 writes to its log files. Its argument is made up of names preceded by plus or
14542 minus characters. For example:
14544 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
14546 A list of possible names and what they control is given in the chapter on
14547 logging, in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&.
14550 .option log_timezone main boolean false
14551 .cindex "log" "timezone for entries"
14552 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
14553 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
14554 By default, the timestamps on log lines are in local time without the
14555 timezone. This means that if your timezone changes twice a year, the timestamps
14556 in log lines are ambiguous for an hour when the clocks go back. One way of
14557 avoiding this problem is to set the timezone to UTC. An alternative is to set
14558 &%log_timezone%& true. This turns on the addition of the timezone offset to
14559 timestamps in log lines. Turning on this option can add quite a lot to the size
14560 of log files because each line is extended by 6 characters. Note that the
14561 &$tod_log$& variable contains the log timestamp without the zone, but there is
14562 another variable called &$tod_zone$& that contains just the timezone offset.
14565 .option lookup_open_max main integer 25
14566 .cindex "too many open files"
14567 .cindex "open files, too many"
14568 .cindex "file" "too many open"
14569 .cindex "lookup" "maximum open files"
14570 .cindex "limit" "open files for lookups"
14571 This option limits the number of simultaneously open files for single-key
14572 lookups that use regular files (that is, &(lsearch)&, &(dbm)&, and &(cdb)&).
14573 Exim normally keeps these files open during routing, because often the same
14574 file is required several times. If the limit is reached, Exim closes the least
14575 recently used file. Note that if you are using the &'ndbm'& library, it
14576 actually opens two files for each logical DBM database, though it still counts
14577 as one for the purposes of &%lookup_open_max%&. If you are getting &"too many
14578 open files"& errors with NDBM, you need to reduce the value of
14579 &%lookup_open_max%&.
14582 .option max_username_length main integer 0
14583 .cindex "length of login name"
14584 .cindex "user name" "maximum length"
14585 .cindex "limit" "user name length"
14586 Some operating systems are broken in that they truncate long arguments to
14587 &[getpwnam()]& to eight characters, instead of returning &"no such user"&. If
14588 this option is set greater than zero, any attempt to call &[getpwnam()]& with
14589 an argument that is longer behaves as if &[getpwnam()]& failed.
14592 .option message_body_newlines main bool false
14593 .cindex "message body" "newlines in variables"
14594 .cindex "newline" "in message body variables"
14595 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
14596 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
14597 By default, newlines in the message body are replaced by spaces when setting
14598 the &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables. If this
14599 option is set true, this no longer happens.
14602 .option message_body_visible main integer 500
14603 .cindex "body of message" "visible size"
14604 .cindex "message body" "visible size"
14605 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
14606 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
14607 This option specifies how much of a message's body is to be included in the
14608 &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables.
14611 .option message_id_header_domain main string&!! unset
14612 .cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
14613 If this option is set, the string is expanded and used as the right hand side
14614 (domain) of the &'Message-ID:'& header that Exim creates if a
14615 locally-originated incoming message does not have one. &"Locally-originated"&
14616 means &"not received over TCP/IP."&
14617 Otherwise, the primary host name is used.
14618 Only letters, digits, dot and hyphen are accepted; any other characters are
14619 replaced by hyphens. If the expansion is forced to fail, or if the result is an
14620 empty string, the option is ignored.
14623 .option message_id_header_text main string&!! unset
14624 If this variable is set, the string is expanded and used to augment the text of
14625 the &'Message-id:'& header that Exim creates if a locally-originated incoming
14626 message does not have one. The text of this header is required by RFC 2822 to
14627 take the form of an address. By default, Exim uses its internal message id as
14628 the local part, and the primary host name as the domain. If this option is set,
14629 it is expanded, and provided the expansion is not forced to fail, and does not
14630 yield an empty string, the result is inserted into the header immediately
14631 before the @, separated from the internal message id by a dot. Any characters
14632 that are illegal in an address are automatically converted into hyphens. This
14633 means that variables such as &$tod_log$& can be used, because the spaces and
14634 colons will become hyphens.
14637 .option message_logs main boolean true
14638 .cindex "message logs" "disabling"
14639 .cindex "log" "message log; disabling"
14640 If this option is turned off, per-message log files are not created in the
14641 &_msglog_& spool sub-directory. This reduces the amount of disk I/O required by
14642 Exim, by reducing the number of files involved in handling a message from a
14643 minimum of four (header spool file, body spool file, delivery journal, and
14644 per-message log) to three. The other major I/O activity is Exim's main log,
14645 which is not affected by this option.
14648 .option message_size_limit main string&!! 50M
14649 .cindex "message" "size limit"
14650 .cindex "limit" "message size"
14651 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
14652 This option limits the maximum size of message that Exim will process. The
14653 value is expanded for each incoming connection so, for example, it can be made
14654 to depend on the IP address of the remote host for messages arriving via
14655 TCP/IP. After expansion, the value must be a sequence of decimal digits,
14656 optionally followed by K or M.
14658 &*Note*&: This limit cannot be made to depend on a message's sender or any
14659 other properties of an individual message, because it has to be advertised in
14660 the server's response to EHLO. String expansion failure causes a temporary
14661 error. A value of zero means no limit, but its use is not recommended. See also
14662 &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
14664 Incoming SMTP messages are failed with a 552 error if the limit is
14665 exceeded; locally-generated messages either get a stderr message or a delivery
14666 failure message to the sender, depending on the &%-oe%& setting. Rejection of
14667 an oversized message is logged in both the main and the reject logs. See also
14668 the generic transport option &%message_size_limit%&, which limits the size of
14669 message that an individual transport can process.
14671 If you use a virus-scanner and set this option to to a value larger than the
14672 maximum size that your virus-scanner is configured to support, you may get
14673 failures triggered by large mails. The right size to configure for the
14674 virus-scanner depends upon what data is passed and the options in use but it's
14675 probably safest to just set it to a little larger than this value. Eg, with a
14676 default Exim message size of 50M and a default ClamAV StreamMaxLength of 10M,
14677 some problems may result.
14679 A value of 0 will disable size limit checking; Exim will still advertise the
14680 SIZE extension in an EHLO response, but without a limit, so as to permit
14681 SMTP clients to still indicate the message size along with the MAIL verb.
14684 .option move_frozen_messages main boolean false
14685 .cindex "frozen messages" "moving"
14686 This option, which is available only if Exim has been built with the setting
14688 SUPPORT_MOVE_FROZEN_MESSAGES=yes
14690 in &_Local/Makefile_&, causes frozen messages and their message logs to be
14691 moved from the &_input_& and &_msglog_& directories on the spool to &_Finput_&
14692 and &_Fmsglog_&, respectively. There is currently no support in Exim or the
14693 standard utilities for handling such moved messages, and they do not show up in
14694 lists generated by &%-bp%& or by the Exim monitor.
14697 .option mua_wrapper main boolean false
14698 Setting this option true causes Exim to run in a very restrictive mode in which
14699 it passes messages synchronously to a smart host. Chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&
14700 contains a full description of this facility.
14704 .option mysql_servers main "string list" unset
14705 .cindex "MySQL" "server list"
14706 This option provides a list of MySQL servers and associated connection data, to
14707 be used in conjunction with &(mysql)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&). The
14708 option is available only if Exim has been built with MySQL support.
14711 .option never_users main "string list&!!" unset
14712 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. Local
14713 message deliveries are normally run in processes that are setuid to the
14714 recipient, and remote deliveries are normally run under Exim's own uid and gid.
14715 It is usually desirable to prevent any deliveries from running as root, as a
14718 When Exim is built, an option called FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a
14719 list of users that must not be used for local deliveries. This list is fixed in
14720 the binary and cannot be overridden by the configuration file. By default, it
14721 contains just the single user name &"root"&. The &%never_users%& runtime option
14722 can be used to add more users to the fixed list.
14724 If a message is to be delivered as one of the users on the fixed list or the
14725 &%never_users%& list, an error occurs, and delivery is deferred. A common
14728 never_users = root:daemon:bin
14730 Including root is redundant if it is also on the fixed list, but it does no
14731 harm. This option overrides the &%pipe_as_creator%& option of the &(pipe)&
14735 .option openssl_options main "string list" "+no_sslv2"
14736 .cindex "OpenSSL "compatibility options"
14737 This option allows an administrator to adjust the SSL options applied
14738 by OpenSSL to connections. It is given as a space-separated list of items,
14739 each one to be +added or -subtracted from the current value.
14741 This option is only available if Exim is built against OpenSSL. The values
14742 available for this option vary according to the age of your OpenSSL install.
14743 The &"all"& value controls a subset of flags which are available, typically
14744 the bug workaround options. The &'SSL_CTX_set_options'& man page will
14745 list the values known on your system and Exim should support all the
14746 &"bug workaround"& options and many of the &"modifying"& options. The Exim
14747 names lose the leading &"SSL_OP_"& and are lower-cased.
14749 Note that adjusting the options can have severe impact upon the security of
14750 SSL as used by Exim. It is possible to disable safety checks and shoot
14751 yourself in the foot in various unpleasant ways. This option should not be
14752 adjusted lightly. An unrecognised item will be detected at startup, by
14753 invoking Exim with the &%-bV%& flag.
14755 Historical note: prior to release 4.80, Exim defaulted this value to
14756 "+dont_insert_empty_fragments", which may still be needed for compatibility
14757 with some clients, but which lowers security by increasing exposure to
14758 some now infamous attacks.
14762 # Make both old MS and old Eudora happy:
14763 openssl_options = -all +microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer \
14764 +dont_insert_empty_fragments
14767 Possible options may include:
14771 &`allow_unsafe_legacy_renegotiation`&
14773 &`cipher_server_preference`&
14775 &`dont_insert_empty_fragments`&
14779 &`legacy_server_connect`&
14781 &`microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer`&
14783 &`microsoft_sess_id_bug`&
14785 &`msie_sslv2_rsa_padding`&
14787 &`netscape_challenge_bug`&
14789 &`netscape_reuse_cipher_change_bug`&
14793 &`no_session_resumption_on_renegotiation`&
14807 &`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`&
14811 &`single_ecdh_use`&
14813 &`ssleay_080_client_dh_bug`&
14815 &`sslref2_reuse_cert_type_bug`&
14817 &`tls_block_padding_bug`&
14821 &`tls_rollback_bug`&
14825 As an aside, the &`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`& item is a misnomer and affects
14826 all clients connecting using the MacOS SecureTransport TLS facility prior
14827 to MacOS 10.8.4, including email clients. If you see old MacOS clients failing
14828 to negotiate TLS then this option value might help, provided that your OpenSSL
14829 release is new enough to contain this work-around. This may be a situation
14830 where you have to upgrade OpenSSL to get buggy clients working.
14834 .option oracle_servers main "string list" unset
14835 .cindex "Oracle" "server list"
14836 This option provides a list of Oracle servers and associated connection data,
14837 to be used in conjunction with &(oracle)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
14838 The option is available only if Exim has been built with Oracle support.
14841 .option percent_hack_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
14842 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
14843 .cindex "source routing" "in email address"
14844 .cindex "address" "source-routed"
14845 The &"percent hack"& is the convention whereby a local part containing a
14846 percent sign is re-interpreted as a new email address, with the percent
14847 replaced by @. This is sometimes called &"source routing"&, though that term is
14848 also applied to RFC 2822 addresses that begin with an @ character. If this
14849 option is set, Exim implements the percent facility for those domains listed,
14850 but no others. This happens before an incoming SMTP address is tested against
14853 &*Warning*&: The &"percent hack"& has often been abused by people who are
14854 trying to get round relaying restrictions. For this reason, it is best avoided
14855 if at all possible. Unfortunately, a number of less security-conscious MTAs
14856 implement it unconditionally. If you are running Exim on a gateway host, and
14857 routing mail through to internal MTAs without processing the local parts, it is
14858 a good idea to reject recipient addresses with percent characters in their
14859 local parts. Exim's default configuration does this.
14862 .option perl_at_start main boolean false
14863 This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
14864 interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
14867 .option perl_startup main string unset
14868 This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
14869 interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
14872 .option pgsql_servers main "string list" unset
14873 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type" "server list"
14874 This option provides a list of PostgreSQL servers and associated connection
14875 data, to be used in conjunction with &(pgsql)& lookups (see section
14876 &<<SECID72>>&). The option is available only if Exim has been built with
14877 PostgreSQL support.
14880 .option pid_file_path main string&!! "set at compile time"
14881 .cindex "daemon" "pid file path"
14882 .cindex "pid file, path for"
14883 This option sets the name of the file to which the Exim daemon writes its
14884 process id. The string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, references
14887 pid_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim.pid
14889 If no path is set, the pid is written to the file &_exim-daemon.pid_& in Exim's
14891 The value set by the option can be overridden by the &%-oP%& command line
14892 option. A pid file is not written if a &"non-standard"& daemon is run by means
14893 of the &%-oX%& option, unless a path is explicitly supplied by &%-oP%&.
14896 .option pipelining_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
14897 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
14898 This option can be used to suppress the advertisement of the SMTP
14899 PIPELINING extension to specific hosts. See also the &*no_pipelining*&
14900 control in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. When PIPELINING is not advertised and
14901 &%smtp_enforce_sync%& is true, an Exim server enforces strict synchronization
14902 for each SMTP command and response. When PIPELINING is advertised, Exim assumes
14903 that clients will use it; &"out of order"& commands that are &"expected"& do
14904 not count as protocol errors (see &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%&).
14907 .option preserve_message_logs main boolean false
14908 .cindex "message logs" "preserving"
14909 If this option is set, message log files are not deleted when messages are
14910 completed. Instead, they are moved to a sub-directory of the spool directory
14911 called &_msglog.OLD_&, where they remain available for statistical or debugging
14912 purposes. This is a dangerous option to set on systems with any appreciable
14913 volume of mail. Use with care!
14916 .option primary_hostname main string "see below"
14917 .cindex "name" "of local host"
14918 .cindex "host" "name of local"
14919 .cindex "local host" "name of"
14920 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
14921 This specifies the name of the current host. It is used in the default EHLO or
14922 HELO command for outgoing SMTP messages (changeable via the &%helo_data%&
14923 option in the &(smtp)& transport), and as the default for &%qualify_domain%&.
14924 The value is also used by default in some SMTP response messages from an Exim
14925 server. This can be changed dynamically by setting &%smtp_active_hostname%&.
14927 If &%primary_hostname%& is not set, Exim calls &[uname()]& to find the host
14928 name. If this fails, Exim panics and dies. If the name returned by &[uname()]&
14929 contains only one component, Exim passes it to &[gethostbyname()]& (or
14930 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) in order to obtain the fully qualified
14931 version. The variable &$primary_hostname$& contains the host name, whether set
14932 explicitly by this option, or defaulted.
14935 .option print_topbitchars main boolean false
14936 .cindex "printing characters"
14937 .cindex "8-bit characters"
14938 By default, Exim considers only those characters whose codes lie in the range
14939 32&--126 to be printing characters. In a number of circumstances (for example,
14940 when writing log entries) non-printing characters are converted into escape
14941 sequences, primarily to avoid messing up the layout. If &%print_topbitchars%&
14942 is set, code values of 128 and above are also considered to be printing
14945 This option also affects the header syntax checks performed by the
14946 &(autoreply)& transport, and whether Exim uses RFC 2047 encoding of
14947 the user's full name when constructing From: and Sender: addresses (as
14948 described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&). Setting this option can cause
14949 Exim to generate eight bit message headers that do not conform to the
14953 .option process_log_path main string unset
14954 .cindex "process log path"
14955 .cindex "log" "process log"
14956 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
14957 This option sets the name of the file to which an Exim process writes its
14958 &"process log"& when sent a USR1 signal. This is used by the &'exiwhat'&
14959 utility script. If this option is unset, the file called &_exim-process.info_&
14960 in Exim's spool directory is used. The ability to specify the name explicitly
14961 can be useful in environments where two different Exims are running, using
14962 different spool directories.
14965 .option prod_requires_admin main boolean true
14969 The &%-M%&, &%-R%&, and &%-q%& command-line options require the caller to be an
14970 admin user unless &%prod_requires_admin%& is set false. See also
14971 &%queue_list_requires_admin%&.
14974 .option qualify_domain main string "see below"
14975 .cindex "domain" "for qualifying addresses"
14976 .cindex "address" "qualification"
14977 This option specifies the domain name that is added to any envelope sender
14978 addresses that do not have a domain qualification. It also applies to
14979 recipient addresses if &%qualify_recipient%& is not set. Unqualified addresses
14980 are accepted by default only for locally-generated messages. Qualification is
14981 also applied to addresses in header lines such as &'From:'& and &'To:'& for
14982 locally-generated messages, unless the &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
14984 Messages from external sources must always contain fully qualified addresses,
14985 unless the sending host matches &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or
14986 &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& (as appropriate), in which case incoming
14987 addresses are qualified with &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%& as
14988 necessary. Internally, Exim always works with fully qualified envelope
14989 addresses. If &%qualify_domain%& is not set, it defaults to the
14990 &%primary_hostname%& value.
14993 .option qualify_recipient main string "see below"
14994 This option allows you to specify a different domain for qualifying recipient
14995 addresses to the one that is used for senders. See &%qualify_domain%& above.
14999 .option queue_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15000 .cindex "domain" "specifying non-immediate delivery"
15001 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15002 .cindex "message" "queueing certain domains"
15003 This option lists domains for which immediate delivery is not required.
15004 A delivery process is started whenever a message is received, but only those
15005 domains that do not match are processed. All other deliveries wait until the
15006 next queue run. See also &%hold_domains%& and &%queue_smtp_domains%&.
15009 .option queue_list_requires_admin main boolean true
15011 The &%-bp%& command-line option, which lists the messages that are on the
15012 queue, requires the caller to be an admin user unless
15013 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false. See also &%prod_requires_admin%&.
15016 .option queue_only main boolean false
15017 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15018 .cindex "message" "queueing unconditionally"
15019 If &%queue_only%& is set, a delivery process is not automatically started
15020 whenever a message is received. Instead, the message waits on the queue for the
15021 next queue run. Even if &%queue_only%& is false, incoming messages may not get
15022 delivered immediately when certain conditions (such as heavy load) occur.
15024 The &%-odq%& command line has the same effect as &%queue_only%&. The &%-odb%&
15025 and &%-odi%& command line options override &%queue_only%& unless
15026 &%queue_only_override%& is set false. See also &%queue_only_file%&,
15027 &%queue_only_load%&, and &%smtp_accept_queue%&.
15030 .option queue_only_file main string unset
15031 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15032 .cindex "message" "queueing by file existence"
15033 This option can be set to a colon-separated list of absolute path names, each
15034 one optionally preceded by &"smtp"&. When Exim is receiving a message,
15035 it tests for the existence of each listed path using a call to &[stat()]&. For
15036 each path that exists, the corresponding queueing option is set.
15037 For paths with no prefix, &%queue_only%& is set; for paths prefixed by
15038 &"smtp"&, &%queue_smtp_domains%& is set to match all domains. So, for example,
15040 queue_only_file = smtp/some/file
15042 causes Exim to behave as if &%queue_smtp_domains%& were set to &"*"& whenever
15043 &_/some/file_& exists.
15046 .option queue_only_load main fixed-point unset
15047 .cindex "load average"
15048 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15049 .cindex "message" "queueing by load"
15050 If the system load average is higher than this value, incoming messages from
15051 all sources are queued, and no automatic deliveries are started. If this
15052 happens during local or remote SMTP input, all subsequent messages received on
15053 the same SMTP connection are queued by default, whatever happens to the load in
15054 the meantime, but this can be changed by setting &%queue_only_load_latch%&
15057 Deliveries will subsequently be performed by queue runner processes. This
15058 option has no effect on ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot
15059 determine the load average. See also &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and
15060 &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
15063 .option queue_only_load_latch main boolean true
15064 .cindex "load average" "re-evaluating per message"
15065 When this option is true (the default), once one message has been queued
15066 because the load average is higher than the value set by &%queue_only_load%&,
15067 all subsequent messages received on the same SMTP connection are also queued.
15068 This is a deliberate choice; even though the load average may fall below the
15069 threshold, it doesn't seem right to deliver later messages on the same
15070 connection when not delivering earlier ones. However, there are special
15071 circumstances such as very long-lived connections from scanning appliances
15072 where this is not the best strategy. In such cases, &%queue_only_load_latch%&
15073 should be set false. This causes the value of the load average to be
15074 re-evaluated for each message.
15077 .option queue_only_override main boolean true
15078 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15079 When this option is true, the &%-od%&&'x'& command line options override the
15080 setting of &%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%& in the configuration file. If
15081 &%queue_only_override%& is set false, the &%-od%&&'x'& options cannot be used
15082 to override; they are accepted, but ignored.
15085 .option queue_run_in_order main boolean false
15086 .cindex "queue runner" "processing messages in order"
15087 If this option is set, queue runs happen in order of message arrival instead of
15088 in an arbitrary order. For this to happen, a complete list of the entire queue
15089 must be set up before the deliveries start. When the queue is all held in a
15090 single directory (the default), a single list is created for both the ordered
15091 and the non-ordered cases. However, if &%split_spool_directory%& is set, a
15092 single list is not created when &%queue_run_in_order%& is false. In this case,
15093 the sub-directories are processed one at a time (in a random order), and this
15094 avoids setting up one huge list for the whole queue. Thus, setting
15095 &%queue_run_in_order%& with &%split_spool_directory%& may degrade performance
15096 when the queue is large, because of the extra work in setting up the single,
15097 large list. In most situations, &%queue_run_in_order%& should not be set.
15101 .option queue_run_max main integer 5
15102 .cindex "queue runner" "maximum number of"
15103 This controls the maximum number of queue runner processes that an Exim daemon
15104 can run simultaneously. This does not mean that it starts them all at once,
15105 but rather that if the maximum number are still running when the time comes to
15106 start another one, it refrains from starting another one. This can happen with
15107 very large queues and/or very sluggish deliveries. This option does not,
15108 however, interlock with other processes, so additional queue runners can be
15109 started by other means, or by killing and restarting the daemon.
15111 Setting this option to zero does not suppress queue runs; rather, it disables
15112 the limit, allowing any number of simultaneous queue runner processes to be
15113 run. If you do not want queue runs to occur, omit the &%-q%&&'xx'& setting on
15114 the daemon's command line.
15116 .option queue_smtp_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15117 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15118 .cindex "message" "queueing remote deliveries"
15119 When this option is set, a delivery process is started whenever a message is
15120 received, routing is performed, and local deliveries take place.
15121 However, if any SMTP deliveries are required for domains that match
15122 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, they are not immediately delivered, but instead the
15123 message waits on the queue for the next queue run. Since routing of the message
15124 has taken place, Exim knows to which remote hosts it must be delivered, and so
15125 when the queue run happens, multiple messages for the same host are delivered
15126 over a single SMTP connection. The &%-odqs%& command line option causes all
15127 SMTP deliveries to be queued in this way, and is equivalent to setting
15128 &%queue_smtp_domains%& to &"*"&. See also &%hold_domains%& and
15132 .option receive_timeout main time 0s
15133 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
15134 This option sets the timeout for accepting a non-SMTP message, that is, the
15135 maximum time that Exim waits when reading a message on the standard input. If
15136 the value is zero, it will wait for ever. This setting is overridden by the
15137 &%-or%& command line option. The timeout for incoming SMTP messages is
15138 controlled by &%smtp_receive_timeout%&.
15140 .option received_header_text main string&!! "see below"
15141 .cindex "customizing" "&'Received:'& header"
15142 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "customizing"
15143 This string defines the contents of the &'Received:'& message header that is
15144 added to each message, except for the timestamp, which is automatically added
15145 on at the end (preceded by a semicolon). The string is expanded each time it is
15146 used. If the expansion yields an empty string, no &'Received:'& header line is
15147 added to the message. Otherwise, the string should start with the text
15148 &"Received:"& and conform to the RFC 2822 specification for &'Received:'&
15149 header lines. The default setting is:
15152 received_header_text = Received: \
15153 ${if def:sender_rcvhost {from $sender_rcvhost\n\t}\
15154 {${if def:sender_ident \
15155 {from ${quote_local_part:$sender_ident} }}\
15156 ${if def:sender_helo_name {(helo=$sender_helo_name)\n\t}}}}\
15157 by $primary_hostname \
15158 ${if def:received_protocol {with $received_protocol}} \
15159 ${if def:tls_in_cipher {($tls_in_cipher)\n\t}}\
15160 (Exim $version_number)\n\t\
15161 ${if def:sender_address \
15162 {(envelope-from <$sender_address>)\n\t}}\
15163 id $message_exim_id\
15164 ${if def:received_for {\n\tfor $received_for}}
15167 The reference to the TLS cipher is omitted when Exim is built without TLS
15168 support. The use of conditional expansions ensures that this works for both
15169 locally generated messages and messages received from remote hosts, giving
15170 header lines such as the following:
15172 Received: from scrooge.carol.example ([192.168.12.25] ident=root)
15173 by marley.carol.example with esmtp (Exim 4.00)
15174 (envelope-from <bob@carol.example>)
15175 id 16IOWa-00019l-00
15176 for chas@dickens.example; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:44 +0000
15177 Received: by scrooge.carol.example with local (Exim 4.00)
15178 id 16IOWW-000083-00; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:41 +0000
15180 Until the body of the message has been received, the timestamp is the time when
15181 the message started to be received. Once the body has arrived, and all policy
15182 checks have taken place, the timestamp is updated to the time at which the
15183 message was accepted.
15186 .option received_headers_max main integer 30
15187 .cindex "loop" "prevention"
15188 .cindex "mail loop prevention"
15189 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "counting"
15190 When a message is to be delivered, the number of &'Received:'& headers is
15191 counted, and if it is greater than this parameter, a mail loop is assumed to
15192 have occurred, the delivery is abandoned, and an error message is generated.
15193 This applies to both local and remote deliveries.
15196 .option recipient_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15197 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
15198 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
15199 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
15200 recipient addresses in message envelopes. The addresses are made fully
15201 qualified by the addition of the &%qualify_recipient%& value. This option also
15202 affects message header lines. Exim does not reject unqualified recipient
15203 addresses in headers, but it qualifies them only if the message came from a
15204 host that matches &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
15205 or if the message was submitted locally (not using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%&
15206 option was not set.
15209 .option recipients_max main integer 0
15210 .cindex "limit" "number of recipients"
15211 .cindex "recipient" "maximum number"
15212 If this option is set greater than zero, it specifies the maximum number of
15213 original recipients for any message. Additional recipients that are generated
15214 by aliasing or forwarding do not count. SMTP messages get a 452 response for
15215 all recipients over the limit; earlier recipients are delivered as normal.
15216 Non-SMTP messages with too many recipients are failed, and no deliveries are
15219 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of incoming"
15220 &*Note*&: The RFCs specify that an SMTP server should accept at least 100
15221 RCPT commands in a single message.
15224 .option recipients_max_reject main boolean false
15225 If this option is set true, Exim rejects SMTP messages containing too many
15226 recipients by giving 552 errors to the surplus RCPT commands, and a 554
15227 error to the eventual DATA command. Otherwise (the default) it gives a 452
15228 error to the surplus RCPT commands and accepts the message on behalf of the
15229 initial set of recipients. The remote server should then re-send the message
15230 for the remaining recipients at a later time.
15233 .option remote_max_parallel main integer 2
15234 .cindex "delivery" "parallelism for remote"
15235 This option controls parallel delivery of one message to a number of remote
15236 hosts. If the value is less than 2, parallel delivery is disabled, and Exim
15237 does all the remote deliveries for a message one by one. Otherwise, if a single
15238 message has to be delivered to more than one remote host, or if several copies
15239 have to be sent to the same remote host, up to &%remote_max_parallel%&
15240 deliveries are done simultaneously. If more than &%remote_max_parallel%&
15241 deliveries are required, the maximum number of processes are started, and as
15242 each one finishes, another is begun. The order of starting processes is the
15243 same as if sequential delivery were being done, and can be controlled by the
15244 &%remote_sort_domains%& option. If parallel delivery takes place while running
15245 with debugging turned on, the debugging output from each delivery process is
15246 tagged with its process id.
15248 This option controls only the maximum number of parallel deliveries for one
15249 message in one Exim delivery process. Because Exim has no central queue
15250 manager, there is no way of controlling the total number of simultaneous
15251 deliveries if the configuration allows a delivery attempt as soon as a message
15254 .cindex "number of deliveries"
15255 .cindex "delivery" "maximum number of"
15256 If you want to control the total number of deliveries on the system, you
15257 need to set the &%queue_only%& option. This ensures that all incoming messages
15258 are added to the queue without starting a delivery process. Then set up an Exim
15259 daemon to start queue runner processes at appropriate intervals (probably
15260 fairly often, for example, every minute), and limit the total number of queue
15261 runners by setting the &%queue_run_max%& parameter. Because each queue runner
15262 delivers only one message at a time, the maximum number of deliveries that can
15263 then take place at once is &%queue_run_max%& multiplied by
15264 &%remote_max_parallel%&.
15266 If it is purely remote deliveries you want to control, use
15267 &%queue_smtp_domains%& instead of &%queue_only%&. This has the added benefit of
15268 doing the SMTP routing before queueing, so that several messages for the same
15269 host will eventually get delivered down the same connection.
15272 .option remote_sort_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15273 .cindex "sorting remote deliveries"
15274 .cindex "delivery" "sorting remote"
15275 When there are a number of remote deliveries for a message, they are sorted by
15276 domain into the order given by this list. For example,
15278 remote_sort_domains = *.cam.ac.uk:*.uk
15280 would attempt to deliver to all addresses in the &'cam.ac.uk'& domain first,
15281 then to those in the &%uk%& domain, then to any others.
15284 .option retry_data_expire main time 7d
15285 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
15286 This option sets a &"use before"& time on retry information in Exim's hints
15287 database. Any older retry data is ignored. This means that, for example, once a
15288 host has not been tried for 7 days, Exim behaves as if it has no knowledge of
15292 .option retry_interval_max main time 24h
15293 .cindex "retry" "limit on interval"
15294 .cindex "limit" "on retry interval"
15295 Chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& describes Exim's mechanisms for controlling the
15296 intervals between delivery attempts for messages that cannot be delivered
15297 straight away. This option sets an overall limit to the length of time between
15298 retries. It cannot be set greater than 24 hours; any attempt to do so forces
15302 .option return_path_remove main boolean true
15303 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line" "removing"
15304 RFC 2821, section 4.4, states that an SMTP server must insert a
15305 &'Return-path:'& header line into a message when it makes a &"final delivery"&.
15306 The &'Return-path:'& header preserves the sender address as received in the
15307 MAIL command. This description implies that this header should not be present
15308 in an incoming message. If &%return_path_remove%& is true, any existing
15309 &'Return-path:'& headers are removed from messages at the time they are
15310 received. Exim's transports have options for adding &'Return-path:'& headers at
15311 the time of delivery. They are normally used only for final local deliveries.
15314 .option return_size_limit main integer 100K
15315 This option is an obsolete synonym for &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
15318 .option rfc1413_hosts main "host list&!!" *
15320 .cindex "host" "for RFC 1413 calls"
15321 RFC 1413 identification calls are made to any client host which matches an item
15324 .option rfc1413_query_timeout main time 5s
15325 .cindex "RFC 1413" "query timeout"
15326 .cindex "timeout" "for RFC 1413 call"
15327 This sets the timeout on RFC 1413 identification calls. If it is set to zero,
15328 no RFC 1413 calls are ever made.
15331 .option sender_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15332 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
15333 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
15334 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
15335 sender addresses. The addresses are made fully qualified by the addition of
15336 &%qualify_domain%&. This option also affects message header lines. Exim does
15337 not reject unqualified addresses in headers that contain sender addresses, but
15338 it qualifies them only if the message came from a host that matches
15339 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%&, or if the message was submitted locally (not
15340 using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%& option was not set.
15343 .option smtp_accept_keepalive main boolean true
15344 .cindex "keepalive" "on incoming connection"
15345 This option controls the setting of the SO_KEEPALIVE option on incoming
15346 TCP/IP socket connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle
15347 connections periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The
15348 other end of the connection should send an acknowledgment if the connection is
15349 still okay or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing
15350 this is that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of
15351 connection that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without
15352 tidying up the TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several
15353 hours to detect unreachable hosts.
15357 .option smtp_accept_max main integer 20
15358 .cindex "limit" "incoming SMTP connections"
15359 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
15361 This option specifies the maximum number of simultaneous incoming SMTP calls
15362 that Exim will accept. It applies only to the listening daemon; there is no
15363 control (in Exim) when incoming SMTP is being handled by &'inetd'&. If the
15364 value is set to zero, no limit is applied. However, it is required to be
15365 non-zero if either &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& or &%smtp_accept_queue%& is
15366 set. See also &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
15368 A new SMTP connection is immediately rejected if the &%smtp_accept_max%& limit
15369 has been reached. If not, Exim first checks &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%&. If
15370 that limit has not been reached for the client host, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&
15371 and &%smtp_load_reserve%& are then checked before accepting the connection.
15374 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail main integer 10
15375 .cindex "limit" "non-mail SMTP commands"
15376 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting non-mail commands"
15377 Exim counts the number of &"non-mail"& commands in an SMTP session, and drops
15378 the connection if there are too many. This option defines &"too many"&. The
15379 check catches some denial-of-service attacks, repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
15380 client looping sending EHLO, for example. The check is applied only if the
15381 client host matches &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&.
15383 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
15384 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
15385 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
15386 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
15387 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
15388 counted. The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately
15389 following STARTTLS is not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than
15390 MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
15393 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts main "host list&!!" *
15394 You can control which hosts are subject to the &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
15395 check by setting this option. The default value makes it apply to all hosts. By
15396 changing the value, you can exclude any badly-behaved hosts that you have to
15400 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
15401 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
15402 . We insert " &~&~" which is both pretty nasty visually and results in
15403 . non-searchable text. HowItWorks.txt mentions an option for inserting
15404 . zero-width-space, which would be nicer visually and results in (at least)
15405 . html that Firefox will split on when it's forced to reflow (rather than
15406 . inserting a horizontal scrollbar). However, the text is still not
15407 . searchable. NM changed this occurrence for bug 1197 to no longer allow
15408 . the option name to split.
15410 .option "smtp_accept_max_per_connection" main integer 1000 &&&
15411 smtp_accept_max_per_connection
15412 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting incoming message count"
15413 .cindex "limit" "messages per SMTP connection"
15414 The value of this option limits the number of MAIL commands that Exim is
15415 prepared to accept over a single SMTP connection, whether or not each command
15416 results in the transfer of a message. After the limit is reached, a 421
15417 response is given to subsequent MAIL commands. This limit is a safety
15418 precaution against a client that goes mad (incidents of this type have been
15422 .option smtp_accept_max_per_host main string&!! unset
15423 .cindex "limit" "SMTP connections from one host"
15424 .cindex "host" "limiting SMTP connections from"
15425 This option restricts the number of simultaneous IP connections from a single
15426 host (strictly, from a single IP address) to the Exim daemon. The option is
15427 expanded, to enable different limits to be applied to different hosts by
15428 reference to &$sender_host_address$&. Once the limit is reached, additional
15429 connection attempts from the same host are rejected with error code 421. This
15430 is entirely independent of &%smtp_accept_reserve%&. The option's default value
15431 of zero imposes no limit. If this option is set greater than zero, it is
15432 required that &%smtp_accept_max%& be non-zero.
15434 &*Warning*&: When setting this option you should not use any expansion
15435 constructions that take an appreciable amount of time. The expansion and test
15436 happen in the main daemon loop, in order to reject additional connections
15437 without forking additional processes (otherwise a denial-of-service attack
15438 could cause a vast number or processes to be created). While the daemon is
15439 doing this processing, it cannot accept any other incoming connections.
15443 .option smtp_accept_queue main integer 0
15444 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
15445 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15446 .cindex "message" "queueing by SMTP connection count"
15447 If the number of simultaneous incoming SMTP connections being handled via the
15448 listening daemon exceeds this value, messages received by SMTP are just placed
15449 on the queue; no delivery processes are started automatically. The count is
15450 fixed at the start of an SMTP connection. It cannot be updated in the
15451 subprocess that receives messages, and so the queueing or not queueing applies
15452 to all messages received in the same connection.
15454 A value of zero implies no limit, and clearly any non-zero value is useful only
15455 if it is less than the &%smtp_accept_max%& value (unless that is zero). See
15456 also &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_load%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&, and the
15457 various &%-od%&&'x'& command line options.
15460 . See the comment on smtp_accept_max_per_connection
15462 .option "smtp_accept_queue_per_connection" main integer 10 &&&
15463 smtp_accept_queue_per_connection
15464 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15465 .cindex "message" "queueing by message count"
15466 This option limits the number of delivery processes that Exim starts
15467 automatically when receiving messages via SMTP, whether via the daemon or by
15468 the use of &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&. If the value of the option is greater than zero,
15469 and the number of messages received in a single SMTP session exceeds this
15470 number, subsequent messages are placed on the queue, but no delivery processes
15471 are started. This helps to limit the number of Exim processes when a server
15472 restarts after downtime and there is a lot of mail waiting for it on other
15473 systems. On large systems, the default should probably be increased, and on
15474 dial-in client systems it should probably be set to zero (that is, disabled).
15477 .option smtp_accept_reserve main integer 0
15478 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming call count"
15479 .cindex "host" "reserved"
15480 When &%smtp_accept_max%& is set greater than zero, this option specifies a
15481 number of SMTP connections that are reserved for connections from the hosts
15482 that are specified in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&. The value set in
15483 &%smtp_accept_max%& includes this reserve pool. The specified hosts are not
15484 restricted to this number of connections; the option specifies a minimum number
15485 of connection slots for them, not a maximum. It is a guarantee that this group
15486 of hosts can always get at least &%smtp_accept_reserve%& connections. However,
15487 the limit specified by &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& is still applied to each
15490 For example, if &%smtp_accept_max%& is set to 50 and &%smtp_accept_reserve%& is
15491 set to 5, once there are 45 active connections (from any hosts), new
15492 connections are accepted only from hosts listed in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&,
15493 provided the other criteria for acceptance are met.
15496 .option smtp_active_hostname main string&!! unset
15497 .cindex "host" "name in SMTP responses"
15498 .cindex "SMTP" "host name in responses"
15499 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
15500 This option is provided for multi-homed servers that want to masquerade as
15501 several different hosts. At the start of an incoming SMTP connection, its value
15502 is expanded and used instead of the value of &$primary_hostname$& in SMTP
15503 responses. For example, it is used as domain name in the response to an
15504 incoming HELO or EHLO command.
15506 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
15507 The active hostname is placed in the &$smtp_active_hostname$& variable, which
15508 is saved with any messages that are received. It is therefore available for use
15509 in routers and transports when the message is later delivered.
15511 If this option is unset, or if its expansion is forced to fail, or if the
15512 expansion results in an empty string, the value of &$primary_hostname$& is
15513 used. Other expansion failures cause a message to be written to the main and
15514 panic logs, and the SMTP command receives a temporary error. Typically, the
15515 value of &%smtp_active_hostname%& depends on the incoming interface address.
15518 smtp_active_hostname = ${if eq{$received_ip_address}{10.0.0.1}\
15519 {cox.mydomain}{box.mydomain}}
15522 Although &$smtp_active_hostname$& is primarily concerned with incoming
15523 messages, it is also used as the default for HELO commands in callout
15524 verification if there is no remote transport from which to obtain a
15525 &%helo_data%& value.
15527 .option smtp_banner main string&!! "see below"
15528 .cindex "SMTP" "welcome banner"
15529 .cindex "banner for SMTP"
15530 .cindex "welcome banner for SMTP"
15531 .cindex "customizing" "SMTP banner"
15532 This string, which is expanded every time it is used, is output as the initial
15533 positive response to an SMTP connection. The default setting is:
15535 smtp_banner = $smtp_active_hostname ESMTP Exim \
15536 $version_number $tod_full
15538 Failure to expand the string causes a panic error. If you want to create a
15539 multiline response to the initial SMTP connection, use &"\n"& in the string at
15540 appropriate points, but not at the end. Note that the 220 code is not included
15541 in this string. Exim adds it automatically (several times in the case of a
15542 multiline response).
15545 .option smtp_check_spool_space main boolean true
15546 .cindex "checking disk space"
15547 .cindex "disk space, checking"
15548 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
15549 When this option is set, if an incoming SMTP session encounters the SIZE
15550 option on a MAIL command, it checks that there is enough space in the
15551 spool directory's partition to accept a message of that size, while still
15552 leaving free the amount specified by &%check_spool_space%& (even if that value
15553 is zero). If there isn't enough space, a temporary error code is returned.
15556 .option smtp_connect_backlog main integer 20
15557 .cindex "connection backlog"
15558 .cindex "SMTP" "connection backlog"
15559 .cindex "backlog of connections"
15560 This option specifies a maximum number of waiting SMTP connections. Exim passes
15561 this value to the TCP/IP system when it sets up its listener. Once this number
15562 of connections are waiting for the daemon's attention, subsequent connection
15563 attempts are refused at the TCP/IP level. At least, that is what the manuals
15564 say; in some circumstances such connection attempts have been observed to time
15565 out instead. For large systems it is probably a good idea to increase the
15566 value (to 50, say). It also gives some protection against denial-of-service
15567 attacks by SYN flooding.
15570 .option smtp_enforce_sync main boolean true
15571 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
15572 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
15573 The SMTP protocol specification requires the client to wait for a response from
15574 the server at certain points in the dialogue. Without PIPELINING these
15575 synchronization points are after every command; with PIPELINING they are
15576 fewer, but they still exist.
15578 Some spamming sites send out a complete set of SMTP commands without waiting
15579 for any response. Exim protects against this by rejecting a message if the
15580 client has sent further input when it should not have. The error response &"554
15581 SMTP synchronization error"& is sent, and the connection is dropped. Testing
15582 for this error cannot be perfect because of transmission delays (unexpected
15583 input may be on its way but not yet received when Exim checks). However, it
15584 does detect many instances.
15586 The check can be globally disabled by setting &%smtp_enforce_sync%& false.
15587 If you want to disable the check selectively (for example, only for certain
15588 hosts), you can do so by an appropriate use of a &%control%& modifier in an ACL
15589 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&). See also &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
15593 .option smtp_etrn_command main string&!! unset
15594 .cindex "ETRN" "command to be run"
15595 .vindex "&$domain$&"
15596 If this option is set, the given command is run whenever an SMTP ETRN
15597 command is received from a host that is permitted to issue such commands (see
15598 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). The string is split up into separate arguments which
15599 are independently expanded. The expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the
15600 argument of the ETRN command, and no syntax checking is done on it. For
15603 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
15604 $sender_host_address
15606 A new process is created to run the command, but Exim does not wait for it to
15607 complete. Consequently, its status cannot be checked. If the command cannot be
15608 run, a line is written to the panic log, but the ETRN caller still receives
15609 a 250 success response. Exim is normally running under its own uid when
15610 receiving SMTP, so it is not possible for it to change the uid before running
15614 .option smtp_etrn_serialize main boolean true
15615 .cindex "ETRN" "serializing"
15616 When this option is set, it prevents the simultaneous execution of more than
15617 one identical command as a result of ETRN in an SMTP connection. See
15618 section &<<SECTETRN>>& for details.
15621 .option smtp_load_reserve main fixed-point unset
15622 .cindex "load average"
15623 If the system load average ever gets higher than this, incoming SMTP calls are
15624 accepted only from those hosts that match an entry in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&.
15625 If &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& is not set, no incoming SMTP calls are accepted when
15626 the load is over the limit. The option has no effect on ancient operating
15627 systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average. See also
15628 &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and &%queue_only_load%&.
15632 .option smtp_max_synprot_errors main integer 3
15633 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting syntax and protocol errors"
15634 .cindex "limit" "SMTP syntax and protocol errors"
15635 Exim rejects SMTP commands that contain syntax or protocol errors. In
15636 particular, a syntactically invalid email address, as in this command:
15638 RCPT TO:<abc xyz@a.b.c>
15640 causes immediate rejection of the command, before any other tests are done.
15641 (The ACL cannot be run if there is no valid address to set up for it.) An
15642 example of a protocol error is receiving RCPT before MAIL. If there are
15643 too many syntax or protocol errors in one SMTP session, the connection is
15644 dropped. The limit is set by this option.
15646 .cindex "PIPELINING" "expected errors"
15647 When the PIPELINING extension to SMTP is in use, some protocol errors are
15648 &"expected"&, for instance, a RCPT command after a rejected MAIL command.
15649 Exim assumes that PIPELINING will be used if it advertises it (see
15650 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&), and in this situation, &"expected"& errors do
15651 not count towards the limit.
15655 .option smtp_max_unknown_commands main integer 3
15656 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting unknown commands"
15657 .cindex "limit" "unknown SMTP commands"
15658 If there are too many unrecognized commands in an incoming SMTP session, an
15659 Exim server drops the connection. This is a defence against some kinds of abuse
15662 into making connections to SMTP ports; in these circumstances, a number of
15663 non-SMTP command lines are sent first.
15667 .option smtp_ratelimit_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15668 .cindex "SMTP" "rate limiting"
15669 .cindex "limit" "rate of message arrival"
15670 .cindex "RCPT" "rate limiting"
15671 Some sites find it helpful to be able to limit the rate at which certain hosts
15672 can send them messages, and the rate at which an individual message can specify
15675 Exim has two rate-limiting facilities. This section describes the older
15676 facility, which can limit rates within a single connection. The newer
15677 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can limit rates across all connections. See section
15678 &<<SECTratelimiting>>& for details of the newer facility.
15680 When a host matches &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%&, the values of
15681 &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& and &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& are used to control the
15682 rate of acceptance of MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session,
15683 respectively. Each option, if set, must contain a set of four comma-separated
15687 A threshold, before which there is no rate limiting.
15689 An initial time delay. Unlike other times in Exim, numbers with decimal
15690 fractional parts are allowed here.
15692 A factor by which to increase the delay each time.
15694 A maximum value for the delay. This should normally be less than 5 minutes,
15695 because after that time, the client is liable to timeout the SMTP command.
15698 For example, these settings have been used successfully at the site which
15699 first suggested this feature, for controlling mail from their customers:
15701 smtp_ratelimit_mail = 2,0.5s,1.05,4m
15702 smtp_ratelimit_rcpt = 4,0.25s,1.015,4m
15704 The first setting specifies delays that are applied to MAIL commands after
15705 two have been received over a single connection. The initial delay is 0.5
15706 seconds, increasing by a factor of 1.05 each time. The second setting applies
15707 delays to RCPT commands when more than four occur in a single message.
15710 .option smtp_ratelimit_mail main string unset
15711 See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
15714 .option smtp_ratelimit_rcpt main string unset
15715 See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
15718 .option smtp_receive_timeout main time 5m
15719 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
15720 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
15721 This sets a timeout value for SMTP reception. It applies to all forms of SMTP
15722 input, including batch SMTP. If a line of input (either an SMTP command or a
15723 data line) is not received within this time, the SMTP connection is dropped and
15724 the message is abandoned.
15725 A line is written to the log containing one of the following messages:
15727 SMTP command timeout on connection from...
15728 SMTP data timeout on connection from...
15730 The former means that Exim was expecting to read an SMTP command; the latter
15731 means that it was in the DATA phase, reading the contents of a message.
15735 The value set by this option can be overridden by the
15736 &%-os%& command-line option. A setting of zero time disables the timeout, but
15737 this should never be used for SMTP over TCP/IP. (It can be useful in some cases
15738 of local input using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.) For non-SMTP input, the reception
15739 timeout is controlled by &%receive_timeout%& and &%-or%&.
15742 .option smtp_reserve_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15743 This option defines hosts for which SMTP connections are reserved; see
15744 &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%& above.
15747 .option smtp_return_error_details main boolean false
15748 .cindex "SMTP" "details policy failures"
15749 .cindex "policy control" "rejection, returning details"
15750 In the default state, Exim uses bland messages such as
15751 &"Administrative prohibition"& when it rejects SMTP commands for policy
15752 reasons. Many sysadmins like this because it gives away little information
15753 to spammers. However, some other sysadmins who are applying strict checking
15754 policies want to give out much fuller information about failures. Setting
15755 &%smtp_return_error_details%& true causes Exim to be more forthcoming. For
15756 example, instead of &"Administrative prohibition"&, it might give:
15758 550-Rejected after DATA: '>' missing at end of address:
15759 550 failing address in "From" header is: <user@dom.ain
15762 .option spamd_address main string "see below"
15763 This option is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
15764 extension. It specifies how Exim connects to SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon.
15765 The default value is
15769 See section &<<SECTscanspamass>>& for more details.
15773 .option split_spool_directory main boolean false
15774 .cindex "multiple spool directories"
15775 .cindex "spool directory" "split"
15776 .cindex "directories, multiple"
15777 If this option is set, it causes Exim to split its input directory into 62
15778 subdirectories, each with a single alphanumeric character as its name. The
15779 sixth character of the message id is used to allocate messages to
15780 subdirectories; this is the least significant base-62 digit of the time of
15781 arrival of the message.
15783 Splitting up the spool in this way may provide better performance on systems
15784 where there are long mail queues, by reducing the number of files in any one
15785 directory. The msglog directory is also split up in a similar way to the input
15786 directory; however, if &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, all old msglog files
15787 are still placed in the single directory &_msglog.OLD_&.
15789 It is not necessary to take any special action for existing messages when
15790 changing &%split_spool_directory%&. Exim notices messages that are in the
15791 &"wrong"& place, and continues to process them. If the option is turned off
15792 after a period of being on, the subdirectories will eventually empty and be
15793 automatically deleted.
15795 When &%split_spool_directory%& is set, the behaviour of queue runner processes
15796 changes. Instead of creating a list of all messages in the queue, and then
15797 trying to deliver each one in turn, it constructs a list of those in one
15798 sub-directory and tries to deliver them, before moving on to the next
15799 sub-directory. The sub-directories are processed in a random order. This
15800 spreads out the scanning of the input directories, and uses less memory. It is
15801 particularly beneficial when there are lots of messages on the queue. However,
15802 if &%queue_run_in_order%& is set, none of this new processing happens. The
15803 entire queue has to be scanned and sorted before any deliveries can start.
15806 .option spool_directory main string&!! "set at compile time"
15807 .cindex "spool directory" "path to"
15808 This defines the directory in which Exim keeps its spool, that is, the messages
15809 it is waiting to deliver. The default value is taken from the compile-time
15810 configuration setting, if there is one. If not, this option must be set. The
15811 string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, a reference to
15812 &$primary_hostname$&.
15814 If the spool directory name is fixed on your installation, it is recommended
15815 that you set it at build time rather than from this option, particularly if the
15816 log files are being written to the spool directory (see &%log_file_path%&).
15817 Otherwise log files cannot be used for errors that are detected early on, such
15818 as failures in the configuration file.
15820 By using this option to override the compiled-in path, it is possible to run
15821 tests of Exim without using the standard spool.
15823 .option sqlite_lock_timeout main time 5s
15824 .cindex "sqlite lookup type" "lock timeout"
15825 This option controls the timeout that the &(sqlite)& lookup uses when trying to
15826 access an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>& for more details.
15828 .option strict_acl_vars main boolean false
15829 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables, handling unset"
15830 This option controls what happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL
15831 variable is referenced. If it is false (the default), an empty string
15832 is substituted; if it is true, an error is generated. See section
15833 &<<SECTaclvariables>>& for details of ACL variables.
15835 .option strip_excess_angle_brackets main boolean false
15836 .cindex "angle brackets, excess"
15837 If this option is set, redundant pairs of angle brackets round &"route-addr"&
15838 items in addresses are stripped. For example, &'<<xxx@a.b.c.d>>'& is
15839 treated as &'<xxx@a.b.c.d>'&. If this is in the envelope and the message is
15840 passed on to another MTA, the excess angle brackets are not passed on. If this
15841 option is not set, multiple pairs of angle brackets cause a syntax error.
15844 .option strip_trailing_dot main boolean false
15845 .cindex "trailing dot on domain"
15846 .cindex "dot" "trailing on domain"
15847 If this option is set, a trailing dot at the end of a domain in an address is
15848 ignored. If this is in the envelope and the message is passed on to another
15849 MTA, the dot is not passed on. If this option is not set, a dot at the end of a
15850 domain causes a syntax error.
15851 However, addresses in header lines are checked only when an ACL requests header
15855 .option syslog_duplication main boolean true
15856 .cindex "syslog" "duplicate log lines; suppressing"
15857 When Exim is logging to syslog, it writes the log lines for its three
15858 separate logs at different syslog priorities so that they can in principle
15859 be separated on the logging hosts. Some installations do not require this
15860 separation, and in those cases, the duplication of certain log lines is a
15861 nuisance. If &%syslog_duplication%& is set false, only one copy of any
15862 particular log line is written to syslog. For lines that normally go to
15863 both the main log and the reject log, the reject log version (possibly
15864 containing message header lines) is written, at LOG_NOTICE priority.
15865 Lines that normally go to both the main and the panic log are written at
15866 the LOG_ALERT priority.
15869 .option syslog_facility main string unset
15870 .cindex "syslog" "facility; setting"
15871 This option sets the syslog &"facility"& name, used when Exim is logging to
15872 syslog. The value must be one of the strings &"mail"&, &"user"&, &"news"&,
15873 &"uucp"&, &"daemon"&, or &"local&'x'&"& where &'x'& is a digit between 0 and 7.
15874 If this option is unset, &"mail"& is used. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
15875 details of Exim's logging.
15879 .option syslog_processname main string &`exim`&
15880 .cindex "syslog" "process name; setting"
15881 This option sets the syslog &"ident"& name, used when Exim is logging to
15882 syslog. The value must be no longer than 32 characters. See chapter
15883 &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of Exim's logging.
15887 .option syslog_timestamp main boolean true
15888 .cindex "syslog" "timestamps"
15889 If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on Exim's log lines are
15890 omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
15891 details of Exim's logging.
15894 .option system_filter main string&!! unset
15895 .cindex "filter" "system filter"
15896 .cindex "system filter" "specifying"
15897 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
15898 This option specifies an Exim filter file that is applied to all messages at
15899 the start of each delivery attempt, before any routing is done. System filters
15900 must be Exim filters; they cannot be Sieve filters. If the system filter
15901 generates any deliveries to files or pipes, or any new mail messages, the
15902 appropriate &%system_filter_..._transport%& option(s) must be set, to define
15903 which transports are to be used. Details of this facility are given in chapter
15904 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&.
15907 .option system_filter_directory_transport main string&!! unset
15908 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
15909 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the
15910 &%save%& command in a system message filter specifies a path ending in &"/"&,
15911 implying delivery of each message into a separate file in some directory.
15912 During the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
15915 .option system_filter_file_transport main string&!! unset
15916 .cindex "file" "transport for system filter"
15917 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the &%save%&
15918 command in a system message filter specifies a path not ending in &"/"&. During
15919 the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
15921 .option system_filter_group main string unset
15922 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
15923 This option is used only when &%system_filter_user%& is also set. It sets the
15924 gid under which the system filter is run, overriding any gid that is associated
15925 with the user. The value may be numerical or symbolic.
15927 .option system_filter_pipe_transport main string&!! unset
15928 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "for system filter"
15929 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
15930 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%pipe%& command
15931 is used in a system filter. During the delivery, the variable &$address_pipe$&
15932 contains the pipe command.
15935 .option system_filter_reply_transport main string&!! unset
15936 .cindex "&(autoreply)& transport" "for system filter"
15937 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%mail%& command
15938 is used in a system filter.
15941 .option system_filter_user main string unset
15942 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
15943 If this option is set to root, the system filter is run in the main Exim
15944 delivery process, as root. Otherwise, the system filter runs in a separate
15945 process, as the given user, defaulting to the Exim run-time user.
15946 Unless the string consists entirely of digits, it
15947 is looked up in the password data. Failure to find the named user causes a
15948 configuration error. The gid is either taken from the password data, or
15949 specified by &%system_filter_group%&. When the uid is specified numerically,
15950 &%system_filter_group%& is required to be set.
15952 If the system filter generates any pipe, file, or reply deliveries, the uid
15953 under which the filter is run is used when transporting them, unless a
15954 transport option overrides.
15957 .option tcp_nodelay main boolean true
15958 .cindex "daemon" "TCP_NODELAY on sockets"
15959 .cindex "Nagle algorithm"
15960 .cindex "TCP_NODELAY on listening sockets"
15961 If this option is set false, it stops the Exim daemon setting the
15962 TCP_NODELAY option on its listening sockets. Setting TCP_NODELAY
15963 turns off the &"Nagle algorithm"&, which is a way of improving network
15964 performance in interactive (character-by-character) situations. Turning it off
15965 should improve Exim's performance a bit, so that is what happens by default.
15966 However, it appears that some broken clients cannot cope, and time out. Hence
15967 this option. It affects only those sockets that are set up for listening by the
15968 daemon. Sockets created by the smtp transport for delivering mail always set
15972 .option timeout_frozen_after main time 0s
15973 .cindex "frozen messages" "timing out"
15974 .cindex "timeout" "frozen messages"
15975 If &%timeout_frozen_after%& is set to a time greater than zero, a frozen
15976 message of any kind that has been on the queue for longer than the given time
15977 is automatically cancelled at the next queue run. If the frozen message is a
15978 bounce message, it is just discarded; otherwise, a bounce is sent to the
15979 sender, in a similar manner to cancellation by the &%-Mg%& command line option.
15980 If you want to timeout frozen bounce messages earlier than other kinds of
15981 frozen message, see &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&.
15983 &*Note:*& the default value of zero means no timeouts; with this setting,
15984 frozen messages remain on the queue forever (except for any frozen bounce
15985 messages that are released by &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
15988 .option timezone main string unset
15989 .cindex "timezone, setting"
15990 The value of &%timezone%& is used to set the environment variable TZ while
15991 running Exim (if it is different on entry). This ensures that all timestamps
15992 created by Exim are in the required timezone. If you want all your timestamps
15993 to be in UTC (aka GMT) you should set
15997 The default value is taken from TIMEZONE_DEFAULT in &_Local/Makefile_&,
15998 or, if that is not set, from the value of the TZ environment variable when Exim
15999 is built. If &%timezone%& is set to the empty string, either at build or run
16000 time, any existing TZ variable is removed from the environment when Exim
16001 runs. This is appropriate behaviour for obtaining wall-clock time on some, but
16002 unfortunately not all, operating systems.
16005 .option tls_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16006 .cindex "TLS" "advertising"
16007 .cindex "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
16008 .cindex "SMTP" "encrypted connection"
16009 When Exim is built with support for TLS encrypted connections, the availability
16010 of the STARTTLS command to set up an encrypted session is advertised in
16011 response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
16012 chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of Exim's support for TLS.
16015 .option tls_certificate main string&!! unset
16016 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate; location of"
16017 .cindex "certificate" "server, location of"
16018 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to a
16019 file which contains the server's certificates. The server's private key is also
16020 assumed to be in this file if &%tls_privatekey%& is unset. See chapter
16021 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
16023 &*Note*&: The certificates defined by this option are used only when Exim is
16024 receiving incoming messages as a server. If you want to supply certificates for
16025 use when sending messages as a client, you must set the &%tls_certificate%&
16026 option in the relevant &(smtp)& transport.
16028 If the option contains &$tls_out_sni$& and Exim is built against OpenSSL, then
16029 if the OpenSSL build supports TLS extensions and the TLS client sends the
16030 Server Name Indication extension, then this option and others documented in
16031 &<<SECTtlssni>>& will be re-expanded.
16033 .option tls_crl main string&!! unset
16034 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate revocation list"
16035 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for server"
16036 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
16037 be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
16039 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
16042 .option tls_dh_max_bits main integer 2236
16043 .cindex "TLS" "D-H bit count"
16044 The number of bits used for Diffie-Hellman key-exchange may be suggested by
16045 the chosen TLS library. That value might prove to be too high for
16046 interoperability. This option provides a maximum clamp on the value
16047 suggested, trading off security for interoperability.
16049 The value must be at least 1024.
16051 The value 2236 was chosen because, at time of adding the option, it was the
16052 hard-coded maximum value supported by the NSS cryptographic library, as used
16053 by Thunderbird, while GnuTLS was suggesting 2432 bits as normal.
16055 If you prefer more security and are willing to break some clients, raise this
16058 Note that the value passed to GnuTLS for *generating* a new prime may be a
16059 little less than this figure, because GnuTLS is inexact and may produce a
16060 larger prime than requested.
16063 .option tls_dhparam main string&!! unset
16064 .cindex "TLS" "D-H parameters for server"
16065 The value of this option is expanded and indicates the source of DH parameters
16066 to be used by Exim.
16068 If it is a filename starting with a &`/`&, then it names a file from which DH
16069 parameters should be loaded. If the file exists, it should hold a PEM-encoded
16070 PKCS#3 representation of the DH prime. If the file does not exist, for
16071 OpenSSL it is an error. For GnuTLS, Exim will attempt to create the file and
16072 fill it with a generated DH prime. For OpenSSL, if the DH bit-count from
16073 loading the file is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then it will be ignored,
16074 and treated as though the &%tls_dhparam%& were set to "none".
16076 If this option expands to the string "none", then no DH parameters will be
16079 If this option expands to the string "historic" and Exim is using GnuTLS, then
16080 Exim will attempt to load a file from inside the spool directory. If the file
16081 does not exist, Exim will attempt to create it.
16082 See section &<<SECTgnutlsparam>>& for further details.
16084 If Exim is using OpenSSL and this option is empty or unset, then Exim will load
16085 a default DH prime; the default is the 2048 bit prime described in section
16086 2.2 of RFC 5114, "2048-bit MODP Group with 224-bit Prime Order Subgroup", which
16087 in IKE is assigned number 23.
16089 Otherwise, the option must expand to the name used by Exim for any of a number
16090 of DH primes specified in RFC 2409, RFC 3526 and RFC 5114. As names, Exim uses
16091 "ike" followed by the number used by IKE, of "default" which corresponds to
16094 The available primes are:
16095 &`ike1`&, &`ike2`&, &`ike5`&,
16096 &`ike14`&, &`ike15`&, &`ike16`&, &`ike17`&, &`ike18`&,
16097 &`ike22`&, &`ike23`& (aka &`default`&) and &`ike24`&.
16099 Some of these will be too small to be accepted by clients.
16100 Some may be too large to be accepted by clients.
16102 The TLS protocol does not negotiate an acceptable size for this; clients tend
16103 to hard-drop connections if what is offered by the server is unacceptable,
16104 whether too large or too small, and there's no provision for the client to
16105 tell the server what these constraints are. Thus, as a server operator, you
16106 need to make an educated guess as to what is most likely to work for your
16109 Some known size constraints suggest that a bit-size in the range 2048 to 2236
16110 is most likely to maximise interoperability. The upper bound comes from
16111 applications using the Mozilla Network Security Services (NSS) library, which
16112 used to set its &`DH_MAX_P_BITS`& upper-bound to 2236. This affects many
16113 mail user agents (MUAs). The lower bound comes from Debian installs of Exim4
16114 prior to the 4.80 release, as Debian used to patch Exim to raise the minimum
16115 acceptable bound from 1024 to 2048.
16118 .option tls_on_connect_ports main "string list" unset
16119 This option specifies a list of incoming SSMTP (aka SMTPS) ports that should
16120 operate the obsolete SSMTP (SMTPS) protocol, where a TLS session is immediately
16121 set up without waiting for the client to issue a STARTTLS command. For
16122 further details, see section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>&.
16126 .option tls_privatekey main string&!! unset
16127 .cindex "TLS" "server private key; location of"
16128 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to a
16129 file which contains the server's private key. If this option is unset, or if
16130 the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the private
16131 key is assumed to be in the same file as the server's certificates. See chapter
16132 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
16134 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
16137 .option tls_remember_esmtp main boolean false
16138 .cindex "TLS" "esmtp state; remembering"
16139 .cindex "TLS" "broken clients"
16140 If this option is set true, Exim violates the RFCs by remembering that it is in
16141 &"esmtp"& state after successfully negotiating a TLS session. This provides
16142 support for broken clients that fail to send a new EHLO after starting a
16146 .option tls_require_ciphers main string&!! unset
16147 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
16148 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
16149 This option controls which ciphers can be used for incoming TLS connections.
16150 The &(smtp)& transport has an option of the same name for controlling outgoing
16151 connections. This option is expanded for each connection, so can be varied for
16152 different clients if required. The value of this option must be a list of
16153 permitted cipher suites. The OpenSSL and GnuTLS libraries handle cipher control
16154 in somewhat different ways. If GnuTLS is being used, the client controls the
16155 preference order of the available ciphers. Details are given in sections
16156 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
16159 .option tls_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16160 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
16161 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
16162 See &%tls_verify_hosts%& below.
16165 .option tls_verify_certificates main string&!! unset
16166 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
16167 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
16168 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to
16169 a file containing permitted certificates for clients that
16170 match &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. Alternatively, if you
16171 are using OpenSSL, you can set &%tls_verify_certificates%& to the name of a
16172 directory containing certificate files. This does not work with GnuTLS; the
16173 option must be set to the name of a single file if you are using GnuTLS.
16175 These certificates should be for the certificate authorities trusted, rather
16176 than the public cert of individual clients. With both OpenSSL and GnuTLS, if
16177 the value is a file then the certificates are sent by Exim as a server to
16178 connecting clients, defining the list of accepted certificate authorities.
16179 Thus the values defined should be considered public data. To avoid this,
16180 use OpenSSL with a directory.
16182 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
16184 A forced expansion failure or setting to an empty string is equivalent to
16188 .option tls_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16189 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
16190 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
16191 This option, along with &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, controls the checking of
16192 certificates from clients. The expected certificates are defined by
16193 &%tls_verify_certificates%&, which must be set. A configuration error occurs if
16194 either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is set and
16195 &%tls_verify_certificates%& is not set.
16197 Any client that matches &%tls_verify_hosts%& is constrained by
16198 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. When the client initiates a TLS session, it must
16199 present one of the listed certificates. If it does not, the connection is
16200 aborted. &*Warning*&: Including a host in &%tls_verify_hosts%& does not require
16201 the host to use TLS. It can still send SMTP commands through unencrypted
16202 connections. Forcing a client to use TLS has to be done separately using an
16203 ACL to reject inappropriate commands when the connection is not encrypted.
16205 A weaker form of checking is provided by &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. If a client
16206 matches this option (but not &%tls_verify_hosts%&), Exim requests a
16207 certificate and checks it against &%tls_verify_certificates%&, but does not
16208 abort the connection if there is no certificate or if it does not match. This
16209 state can be detected in an ACL, which makes it possible to implement policies
16210 such as &"accept for relay only if a verified certificate has been received,
16211 but accept for local delivery if encrypted, even without a verified
16214 Client hosts that match neither of these lists are not asked to present
16218 .option trusted_groups main "string list&!!" unset
16219 .cindex "trusted groups"
16220 .cindex "groups" "trusted"
16221 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
16222 option is set, any process that is running in one of the listed groups, or
16223 which has one of them as a supplementary group, is trusted. The groups can be
16224 specified numerically or by name. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for
16225 details of what trusted callers are permitted to do. If neither
16226 &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the Exim user
16229 .option trusted_users main "string list&!!" unset
16230 .cindex "trusted users"
16231 .cindex "user" "trusted"
16232 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
16233 option is set, any process that is running as one of the listed users is
16234 trusted. The users can be specified numerically or by name. See section
16235 &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of what trusted callers are permitted to do.
16236 If neither &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the
16237 Exim user are trusted.
16239 .option unknown_login main string&!! unset
16240 .cindex "uid (user id)" "unknown caller"
16241 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
16242 This is a specialized feature for use in unusual configurations. By default, if
16243 the uid of the caller of Exim cannot be looked up using &[getpwuid()]&, Exim
16244 gives up. The &%unknown_login%& option can be used to set a login name to be
16245 used in this circumstance. It is expanded, so values like &%user$caller_uid%&
16246 can be set. When &%unknown_login%& is used, the value of &%unknown_username%&
16247 is used for the user's real name (gecos field), unless this has been set by the
16250 .option unknown_username main string unset
16251 See &%unknown_login%&.
16253 .option untrusted_set_sender main "address list&!!" unset
16254 .cindex "trusted users"
16255 .cindex "sender" "setting by untrusted user"
16256 .cindex "untrusted user setting sender"
16257 .cindex "user" "untrusted setting sender"
16258 .cindex "envelope sender"
16259 When an untrusted user submits a message to Exim using the standard input, Exim
16260 normally creates an envelope sender address from the user's login and the
16261 default qualification domain. Data from the &%-f%& option (for setting envelope
16262 senders on non-SMTP messages) or the SMTP MAIL command (if &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&
16263 is used) is ignored.
16265 However, untrusted users are permitted to set an empty envelope sender address,
16266 to declare that a message should never generate any bounces. For example:
16268 exim -f '<>' user@domain.example
16270 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
16271 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option allows you to permit untrusted users to set
16272 other envelope sender addresses in a controlled way. When it is set, untrusted
16273 users are allowed to set envelope sender addresses that match any of the
16274 patterns in the list. Like all address lists, the string is expanded. The
16275 identity of the user is in &$sender_ident$&, so you can, for example, restrict
16276 users to setting senders that start with their login ids
16277 followed by a hyphen
16278 by a setting like this:
16280 untrusted_set_sender = ^$sender_ident-
16282 If you want to allow untrusted users to set envelope sender addresses without
16283 restriction, you can use
16285 untrusted_set_sender = *
16287 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option applies to all forms of local input, but
16288 only to the setting of the envelope sender. It does not permit untrusted users
16289 to use the other options which trusted user can use to override message
16290 parameters. Furthermore, it does not stop Exim from removing an existing
16291 &'Sender:'& header in the message, or from adding a &'Sender:'& header if
16292 necessary. See &%local_sender_retain%& and &%local_from_check%& for ways of
16293 overriding these actions. The handling of the &'Sender:'& header is also
16294 described in section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&.
16296 The log line for a message's arrival shows the envelope sender following
16297 &"<="&. For local messages, the user's login always follows, after &"U="&. In
16298 &%-bp%& displays, and in the Exim monitor, if an untrusted user sets an
16299 envelope sender address, the user's login is shown in parentheses after the
16303 .option uucp_from_pattern main string "see below"
16304 .cindex "&""From""& line"
16305 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
16306 Some applications that pass messages to an MTA via a command line interface use
16307 an initial line starting with &"From&~"& to pass the envelope sender. In
16308 particular, this is used by UUCP software. Exim recognizes such a line by means
16309 of a regular expression that is set in &%uucp_from_pattern%&. When the pattern
16310 matches, the sender address is constructed by expanding the contents of
16311 &%uucp_from_sender%&, provided that the caller of Exim is a trusted user. The
16312 default pattern recognizes lines in the following two forms:
16314 From ph10 Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
16315 From ph10 Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
16317 The pattern can be seen by running
16319 exim -bP uucp_from_pattern
16321 It checks only up to the hours and minutes, and allows for a 2-digit or 4-digit
16322 year in the second case. The first word after &"From&~"& is matched in the
16323 regular expression by a parenthesized subpattern. The default value for
16324 &%uucp_from_sender%& is &"$1"&, which therefore just uses this first word
16325 (&"ph10"& in the example above) as the message's sender. See also
16326 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%&.
16329 .option uucp_from_sender main string&!! &`$1`&
16330 See &%uucp_from_pattern%& above.
16333 .option warn_message_file main string unset
16334 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
16335 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
16336 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
16337 for constructing the warning message which is sent by Exim when a message has
16338 been on the queue for a specified amount of time, as specified by
16339 &%delay_warning%&. Details of the file's contents are given in chapter
16340 &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%bounce_message_file%&.
16343 .option write_rejectlog main boolean true
16344 .cindex "reject log" "disabling"
16345 If this option is set false, Exim no longer writes anything to the reject log.
16346 See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of what Exim writes to its logs.
16347 .ecindex IIDconfima
16348 .ecindex IIDmaiconf
16353 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16354 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16356 .chapter "Generic options for routers" "CHAProutergeneric"
16357 .scindex IIDgenoprou1 "options" "generic; for routers"
16358 .scindex IIDgenoprou2 "generic options" "router"
16359 This chapter describes the generic options that apply to all routers.
16360 Those that are preconditions are marked with ‡ in the &"use"& field.
16362 For a general description of how a router operates, see sections
16363 &<<SECTrunindrou>>& and &<<SECTrouprecon>>&. The latter specifies the order in
16364 which the preconditions are tested. The order of expansion of the options that
16365 provide data for a transport is: &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&,
16366 &%headers_remove%&, &%transport%&.
16370 .option address_data routers string&!! unset
16371 .cindex "router" "data attached to address"
16372 The string is expanded just before the router is run, that is, after all the
16373 precondition tests have succeeded. If the expansion is forced to fail, the
16374 router declines, the value of &%address_data%& remains unchanged, and the
16375 &%more%& option controls what happens next. Other expansion failures cause
16376 delivery of the address to be deferred.
16378 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
16379 When the expansion succeeds, the value is retained with the address, and can be
16380 accessed using the variable &$address_data$& in the current router, subsequent
16381 routers, and the eventual transport.
16383 &*Warning*&: If the current or any subsequent router is a &(redirect)& router
16384 that runs a user's filter file, the contents of &$address_data$& are accessible
16385 in the filter. This is not normally a problem, because such data is usually
16386 either not confidential or it &"belongs"& to the current user, but if you do
16387 put confidential data into &$address_data$& you need to remember this point.
16389 Even if the router declines or passes, the value of &$address_data$& remains
16390 with the address, though it can be changed by another &%address_data%& setting
16391 on a subsequent router. If a router generates child addresses, the value of
16392 &$address_data$& propagates to them. This also applies to the special kind of
16393 &"child"& that is generated by a router with the &%unseen%& option.
16395 The idea of &%address_data%& is that you can use it to look up a lot of data
16396 for the address once, and then pick out parts of the data later. For example,
16397 you could use a single LDAP lookup to return a string of the form
16399 uid=1234 gid=5678 mailbox=/mail/xyz forward=/home/xyz/.forward
16401 In the transport you could pick out the mailbox by a setting such as
16403 file = ${extract{mailbox}{$address_data}}
16405 This makes the configuration file less messy, and also reduces the number of
16406 lookups (though Exim does cache lookups).
16408 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
16409 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
16410 The &%address_data%& facility is also useful as a means of passing information
16411 from one router to another, and from a router to a transport. In addition, if
16412 &$address_data$& is set by a router when verifying a recipient address from an
16413 ACL, it remains available for use in the rest of the ACL statement. After
16414 verifying a sender, the value is transferred to &$sender_address_data$&.
16418 .option address_test routers&!? boolean true
16420 .cindex "router" "skipping when address testing"
16421 If this option is set false, the router is skipped when routing is being tested
16422 by means of the &%-bt%& command line option. This can be a convenience when
16423 your first router sends messages to an external scanner, because it saves you
16424 having to set the &"already scanned"& indicator when testing real address
16429 .option cannot_route_message routers string&!! unset
16430 .cindex "router" "customizing &""cannot route""& message"
16431 .cindex "customizing" "&""cannot route""& message"
16432 This option specifies a text message that is used when an address cannot be
16433 routed because Exim has run out of routers. The default message is
16434 &"Unrouteable address"&. This option is useful only on routers that have
16435 &%more%& set false, or on the very last router in a configuration, because the
16436 value that is used is taken from the last router that is considered. This
16437 includes a router that is skipped because its preconditions are not met, as
16438 well as a router that declines. For example, using the default configuration,
16441 cannot_route_message = Remote domain not found in DNS
16443 on the first router, which is a &(dnslookup)& router with &%more%& set false,
16446 cannot_route_message = Unknown local user
16448 on the final router that checks for local users. If string expansion fails for
16449 this option, the default message is used. Unless the expansion failure was
16450 explicitly forced, a message about the failure is written to the main and panic
16451 logs, in addition to the normal message about the routing failure.
16454 .option caseful_local_part routers boolean false
16455 .cindex "case of local parts"
16456 .cindex "router" "case of local parts"
16457 By default, routers handle the local parts of addresses in a case-insensitive
16458 manner, though the actual case is preserved for transmission with the message.
16459 If you want the case of letters to be significant in a router, you must set
16460 this option true. For individual router options that contain address or local
16461 part lists (for example, &%local_parts%&), case-sensitive matching can be
16462 turned on by &"+caseful"& as a list item. See section &<<SECTcasletadd>>& for
16465 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
16466 .vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
16467 .vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
16468 The value of the &$local_part$& variable is forced to lower case while a
16469 router is running unless &%caseful_local_part%& is set. When a router assigns
16470 an address to a transport, the value of &$local_part$& when the transport runs
16471 is the same as it was in the router. Similarly, when a router generates child
16472 addresses by aliasing or forwarding, the values of &$original_local_part$&
16473 and &$parent_local_part$& are those that were used by the redirecting router.
16475 This option applies to the processing of an address by a router. When a
16476 recipient address is being processed in an ACL, there is a separate &%control%&
16477 modifier that can be used to specify case-sensitive processing within the ACL
16478 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&).
16482 .option check_local_user routers&!? boolean false
16483 .cindex "local user, checking in router"
16484 .cindex "router" "checking for local user"
16485 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
16487 When this option is true, Exim checks that the local part of the recipient
16488 address (with affixes removed if relevant) is the name of an account on the
16489 local system. The check is done by calling the &[getpwnam()]& function rather
16490 than trying to read &_/etc/passwd_& directly. This means that other methods of
16491 holding password data (such as NIS) are supported. If the local part is a local
16492 user, &$home$& is set from the password data, and can be tested in other
16493 preconditions that are evaluated after this one (the order of evaluation is
16494 given in section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). However, the value of &$home$& can be
16495 overridden by &%router_home_directory%&. If the local part is not a local user,
16496 the router is skipped.
16498 If you want to check that the local part is either the name of a local user
16499 or matches something else, you cannot combine &%check_local_user%& with a
16500 setting of &%local_parts%&, because that specifies the logical &'and'& of the
16501 two conditions. However, you can use a &(passwd)& lookup in a &%local_parts%&
16502 setting to achieve this. For example:
16504 local_parts = passwd;$local_part : lsearch;/etc/other/users
16506 Note, however, that the side effects of &%check_local_user%& (such as setting
16507 up a home directory) do not occur when a &(passwd)& lookup is used in a
16508 &%local_parts%& (or any other) precondition.
16512 .option condition routers&!? string&!! unset
16513 .cindex "router" "customized precondition"
16514 This option specifies a general precondition test that has to succeed for the
16515 router to be called. The &%condition%& option is the last precondition to be
16516 evaluated (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). The string is expanded, and if the
16517 result is a forced failure, or an empty string, or one of the strings &"0"& or
16518 &"no"& or &"false"& (checked without regard to the case of the letters), the
16519 router is skipped, and the address is offered to the next one.
16521 If the result is any other value, the router is run (as this is the last
16522 precondition to be evaluated, all the other preconditions must be true).
16524 This option is unusual in that multiple &%condition%& options may be present.
16525 All &%condition%& options must succeed.
16527 The &%condition%& option provides a means of applying custom conditions to the
16528 running of routers. Note that in the case of a simple conditional expansion,
16529 the default expansion values are exactly what is wanted. For example:
16531 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
16533 Because of the default behaviour of the string expansion, this is equivalent to
16535 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}{true}{}}
16538 A multiple condition example, which succeeds:
16540 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
16541 condition = ${if !eq{${lc:$local_part}}{postmaster}}
16545 If the expansion fails (other than forced failure) delivery is deferred. Some
16546 of the other precondition options are common special cases that could in fact
16547 be specified using &%condition%&.
16550 .option debug_print routers string&!! unset
16551 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
16552 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
16553 option) or in address-testing mode (see the &%-bt%& command line option),
16554 the string is expanded and included in the debugging output.
16555 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
16556 output, and Exim carries on processing.
16557 This option is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
16558 so on when debugging router configurations. For example, if a &%condition%&
16559 option appears not to be working, &%debug_print%& can be used to output the
16560 variables it references. The output happens after checks for &%domains%&,
16561 &%local_parts%&, and &%check_local_user%& but before any other preconditions
16562 are tested. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with one.
16563 The variable &$router_name$& contains the name of the router.
16567 .option disable_logging routers boolean false
16568 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any routing errors
16569 or for any deliveries caused by this router. You should not set this option
16570 unless you really, really know what you are doing. See also the generic
16571 transport option of the same name.
16574 .option domains routers&!? "domain list&!!" unset
16575 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific domains"
16576 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
16577 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the current domain matches
16578 the list. If the match is achieved by means of a file lookup, the data that the
16579 lookup returned for the domain is placed in &$domain_data$& for use in string
16580 expansions of the driver's private options. See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for
16581 a list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.
16585 .option driver routers string unset
16586 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available routers is
16591 .option errors_to routers string&!! unset
16592 .cindex "envelope sender"
16593 .cindex "router" "changing address for errors"
16594 If a router successfully handles an address, it may assign the address to a
16595 transport for delivery or it may generate child addresses. In both cases, if
16596 there is a delivery problem during later processing, the resulting bounce
16597 message is sent to the address that results from expanding this string,
16598 provided that the address verifies successfully. The &%errors_to%& option is
16599 expanded before &%headers_add%&, &%headers_remove%&, and &%transport%&.
16601 The &%errors_to%& setting associated with an address can be overridden if it
16602 subsequently passes through other routers that have their own &%errors_to%&
16603 settings, or if the message is delivered by a transport with a &%return_path%&
16606 If &%errors_to%& is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the result of
16607 the expansion fails to verify, the errors address associated with the incoming
16608 address is used. At top level, this is the envelope sender. A non-forced
16609 expansion failure causes delivery to be deferred.
16611 If an address for which &%errors_to%& has been set ends up being delivered over
16612 SMTP, the envelope sender for that delivery is the &%errors_to%& value, so that
16613 any bounces that are generated by other MTAs on the delivery route are also
16614 sent there. You can set &%errors_to%& to the empty string by either of these
16620 An expansion item that yields an empty string has the same effect. If you do
16621 this, a locally detected delivery error for addresses processed by this router
16622 no longer gives rise to a bounce message; the error is discarded. If the
16623 address is delivered to a remote host, the return path is set to &`<>`&, unless
16624 overridden by the &%return_path%& option on the transport.
16626 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
16627 If for some reason you want to discard local errors, but use a non-empty
16628 MAIL command for remote delivery, you can preserve the original return
16629 path in &$address_data$& in the router, and reinstate it in the transport by
16630 setting &%return_path%&.
16632 The most common use of &%errors_to%& is to direct mailing list bounces to the
16633 manager of the list, as described in section &<<SECTmailinglists>>&, or to
16634 implement VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) (see section &<<SECTverp>>&).
16638 .option expn routers&!? boolean true
16639 .cindex "address" "testing"
16640 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
16641 .cindex "EXPN" "router skipping"
16642 .cindex "router" "skipping for EXPN"
16643 If this option is turned off, the router is skipped when testing an address
16644 as a result of processing an SMTP EXPN command. You might, for example,
16645 want to turn it off on a router for users' &_.forward_& files, while leaving it
16646 on for the system alias file.
16647 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
16650 The use of the SMTP EXPN command is controlled by an ACL (see chapter
16651 &<<CHAPACL>>&). When Exim is running an EXPN command, it is similar to testing
16652 an address with &%-bt%&. Compare VRFY, whose counterpart is &%-bv%&.
16656 .option fail_verify routers boolean false
16657 .cindex "router" "forcing verification failure"
16658 Setting this option has the effect of setting both &%fail_verify_sender%& and
16659 &%fail_verify_recipient%& to the same value.
16663 .option fail_verify_recipient routers boolean false
16664 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
16665 verifying a recipient, verification fails.
16669 .option fail_verify_sender routers boolean false
16670 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
16671 verifying a sender, verification fails.
16675 .option fallback_hosts routers "string list" unset
16676 .cindex "router" "fallback hosts"
16677 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on router"
16678 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
16679 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses. The list separator can be
16680 changed (see section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&), and a port can be specified with
16681 each name or address. In fact, the format of each item is exactly the same as
16682 defined for the list of hosts in a &(manualroute)& router (see section
16683 &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&).
16685 If a router queues an address for a remote transport, this host list is
16686 associated with the address, and used instead of the transport's fallback host
16687 list. If &%hosts_randomize%& is set on the transport, the order of the list is
16688 randomized for each use. See the &%fallback_hosts%& option of the &(smtp)&
16689 transport for further details.
16692 .option group routers string&!! "see below"
16693 .cindex "gid (group id)" "local delivery"
16694 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
16695 .cindex "transport" "local"
16696 .cindex "router" "setting group"
16697 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
16698 specify a group, the group given here is used when running the delivery
16700 The group may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
16701 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
16702 The default is unset, unless &%check_local_user%& is set, when the default
16703 is taken from the password information. See also &%initgroups%& and &%user%&
16704 and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
16708 .option headers_add routers string&!! unset
16709 .cindex "header lines" "adding"
16710 .cindex "router" "adding header lines"
16711 This option specifies a string of text that is expanded at routing time, and
16712 associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router. However, this
16713 option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
16714 the text is used to add header lines at transport time is described in section
16715 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. New header lines are not actually added until the
16716 message is in the process of being transported. This means that references to
16717 header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration do not
16718 &"see"& the added header lines.
16720 The &%headers_add%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%&, but before
16721 &%headers_remove%& and &%transport%&. If the expanded string is empty, or if
16722 the expansion is forced to fail, the option has no effect. Other expansion
16723 failures are treated as configuration errors.
16725 Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
16726 for a router; all listed headers are added.
16728 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_add%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
16729 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
16731 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
16732 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
16733 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
16734 additions are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent routers.
16735 For a &%redirect%& router, if a generated address is the same as the incoming
16736 address, this can lead to duplicate addresses with different header
16737 modifications. Exim does not do duplicate deliveries (except, in certain
16738 circumstances, to pipes -- see section &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined
16739 which of the duplicates is discarded, so this ambiguous situation should be
16740 avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the &%redirect%& router may be of help.
16744 .option headers_remove routers string&!! unset
16745 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
16746 .cindex "router" "removing header lines"
16747 This option specifies a string of text that is expanded at routing time, and
16748 associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router. However, this
16749 option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
16750 the text is used to remove header lines at transport time is described in
16751 section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header lines are not actually removed until
16752 the message is in the process of being transported. This means that references
16753 to header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration still
16754 &"see"& the original header lines.
16756 The &%headers_remove%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%& and
16757 &%headers_add%&, but before &%transport%&. If the expansion is forced to fail,
16758 the option has no effect. Other expansion failures are treated as configuration
16761 Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
16762 for a router; all listed headers are removed.
16764 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_remove%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
16765 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
16767 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
16768 removal requests are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent
16769 routers, and this can lead to problems with duplicates -- see the similar
16770 warning for &%headers_add%& above.
16773 .option ignore_target_hosts routers "host list&!!" unset
16774 .cindex "IP address" "discarding"
16775 .cindex "router" "discarding IP addresses"
16776 Although this option is a host list, it should normally contain IP address
16777 entries rather than names. If any host that is looked up by the router has an
16778 IP address that matches an item in this list, Exim behaves as if that IP
16779 address did not exist. This option allows you to cope with rogue DNS entries
16782 remote.domain.example. A 127.0.0.1
16786 ignore_target_hosts = 127.0.0.1
16788 on the relevant router. If all the hosts found by a &(dnslookup)& router are
16789 discarded in this way, the router declines. In a conventional configuration, an
16790 attempt to mail to such a domain would normally provoke the &"unrouteable
16791 domain"& error, and an attempt to verify an address in the domain would fail.
16792 Similarly, if &%ignore_target_hosts%& is set on an &(ipliteral)& router, the
16793 router declines if presented with one of the listed addresses.
16795 You can use this option to disable the use of IPv4 or IPv6 for mail delivery by
16796 means of the first or the second of the following settings, respectively:
16798 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0/0
16799 ignore_target_hosts = <; 0::0/0
16801 The pattern in the first line matches all IPv4 addresses, whereas the pattern
16802 in the second line matches all IPv6 addresses.
16804 This option may also be useful for ignoring link-local and site-local IPv6
16805 addresses. Because, like all host lists, the value of &%ignore_target_hosts%&
16806 is expanded before use as a list, it is possible to make it dependent on the
16807 domain that is being routed.
16809 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
16810 During its expansion, &$host_address$& is set to the IP address that is being
16813 .option initgroups routers boolean false
16814 .cindex "additional groups"
16815 .cindex "groups" "additional"
16816 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
16817 .cindex "transport" "local"
16818 If the router queues an address for a transport, and this option is true, and
16819 the uid supplied by the router is not overridden by the transport, the
16820 &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport to ensure that
16821 any additional groups associated with the uid are set up. See also &%group%&
16822 and &%user%& and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
16826 .option local_part_prefix routers&!? "string list" unset
16827 .cindex "router" "prefix for local part"
16828 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, used in router"
16829 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the local part starts with
16830 one of the given strings, or &%local_part_prefix_optional%& is true. See
16831 section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions are
16834 The list is scanned from left to right, and the first prefix that matches is
16835 used. A limited form of wildcard is available; if the prefix begins with an
16836 asterisk, it matches the longest possible sequence of arbitrary characters at
16837 the start of the local part. An asterisk should therefore always be followed by
16838 some character that does not occur in normal local parts.
16839 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
16840 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
16841 Wildcarding can be used to set up multiple user mailboxes, as described in
16842 section &<<SECTmulbox>>&.
16844 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
16845 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
16846 During the testing of the &%local_parts%& option, and while the router is
16847 running, the prefix is removed from the local part, and is available in the
16848 expansion variable &$local_part_prefix$&. When a message is being delivered, if
16849 the router accepts the address, this remains true during subsequent delivery by
16850 a transport. In particular, the local part that is transmitted in the RCPT
16851 command for LMTP, SMTP, and BSMTP deliveries has the prefix removed by default.
16852 This behaviour can be overridden by setting &%rcpt_include_affixes%& true on
16853 the relevant transport.
16855 When an address is being verified, &%local_part_prefix%& affects only the
16856 behaviour of the router. If the callout feature of verification is in use, this
16857 means that the full address, including the prefix, will be used during the
16860 The prefix facility is commonly used to handle local parts of the form
16861 &%owner-something%&. Another common use is to support local parts of the form
16862 &%real-username%& to bypass a user's &_.forward_& file &-- helpful when trying
16863 to tell a user their forwarding is broken &-- by placing a router like this one
16864 immediately before the router that handles &_.forward_& files:
16868 local_part_prefix = real-
16870 transport = local_delivery
16872 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
16873 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
16875 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
16876 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
16879 If both &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& are set for a router,
16880 both conditions must be met if not optional. Care must be taken if wildcards
16881 are used in both a prefix and a suffix on the same router. Different
16882 separator characters must be used to avoid ambiguity.
16885 .option local_part_prefix_optional routers boolean false
16886 See &%local_part_prefix%& above.
16890 .option local_part_suffix routers&!? "string list" unset
16891 .cindex "router" "suffix for local part"
16892 .cindex "suffix for local part" "used in router"
16893 This option operates in the same way as &%local_part_prefix%&, except that the
16894 local part must end (rather than start) with the given string, the
16895 &%local_part_suffix_optional%& option determines whether the suffix is
16896 mandatory, and the wildcard * character, if present, must be the last
16897 character of the suffix. This option facility is commonly used to handle local
16898 parts of the form &%something-request%& and multiple user mailboxes of the form
16902 .option local_part_suffix_optional routers boolean false
16903 See &%local_part_suffix%& above.
16907 .option local_parts routers&!? "local part list&!!" unset
16908 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific local parts"
16909 .cindex "local part" "checking in router"
16910 The router is run only if the local part of the address matches the list.
16911 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
16913 section &<<SECTlocparlis>>& for a discussion of local part lists. Because the
16914 string is expanded, it is possible to make it depend on the domain, for
16917 local_parts = dbm;/usr/local/specials/$domain
16919 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
16920 If the match is achieved by a lookup, the data that the lookup returned
16921 for the local part is placed in the variable &$local_part_data$& for use in
16922 expansions of the router's private options. You might use this option, for
16923 example, if you have a large number of local virtual domains, and you want to
16924 send all postmaster mail to the same place without having to set up an alias in
16925 each virtual domain:
16929 local_parts = postmaster
16930 data = postmaster@real.domain.example
16934 .option log_as_local routers boolean "see below"
16935 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
16936 .cindex "delivery" "log line format"
16937 Exim has two logging styles for delivery, the idea being to make local
16938 deliveries stand out more visibly from remote ones. In the &"local"& style, the
16939 recipient address is given just as the local part, without a domain. The use of
16940 this style is controlled by this option. It defaults to true for the &(accept)&
16941 router, and false for all the others. This option applies only when a
16942 router assigns an address to a transport. It has no effect on routers that
16943 redirect addresses.
16947 .option more routers boolean&!! true
16948 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
16949 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
16950 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
16951 fail, the default value for the option (true) is used. Other failures cause
16952 delivery to be deferred.
16954 If this option is set false, and the router declines to handle the address, no
16955 further routers are tried, routing fails, and the address is bounced.
16957 However, if the router explicitly passes an address to the following router by
16958 means of the setting
16962 or otherwise, the setting of &%more%& is ignored. Also, the setting of &%more%&
16963 does not affect the behaviour if one of the precondition tests fails. In that
16964 case, the address is always passed to the next router.
16966 Note that &%address_data%& is not considered to be a precondition. If its
16967 expansion is forced to fail, the router declines, and the value of &%more%&
16968 controls what happens next.
16971 .option pass_on_timeout routers boolean false
16972 .cindex "timeout" "of router"
16973 .cindex "router" "timeout"
16974 If a router times out during a host lookup, it normally causes deferral of the
16975 address. If &%pass_on_timeout%& is set, the address is passed on to the next
16976 router, overriding &%no_more%&. This may be helpful for systems that are
16977 intermittently connected to the Internet, or those that want to pass to a smart
16978 host any messages that cannot immediately be delivered.
16980 There are occasional other temporary errors that can occur while doing DNS
16981 lookups. They are treated in the same way as a timeout, and this option
16982 applies to all of them.
16986 .option pass_router routers string unset
16987 .cindex "router" "go to after &""pass""&"
16988 Routers that recognize the generic &%self%& option (&(dnslookup)&,
16989 &(ipliteral)&, and &(manualroute)&) are able to return &"pass"&, forcing
16990 routing to continue, and overriding a false setting of &%more%&. When one of
16991 these routers returns &"pass"&, the address is normally handed on to the next
16992 router in sequence. This can be changed by setting &%pass_router%& to the name
16993 of another router. However (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router must
16994 be below the current router, to avoid loops. Note that this option applies only
16995 to the special case of &"pass"&. It does not apply when a router returns
16996 &"decline"& because it cannot handle an address.
17000 .option redirect_router routers string unset
17001 .cindex "router" "start at after redirection"
17002 Sometimes an administrator knows that it is pointless to reprocess addresses
17003 generated from alias or forward files with the same router again. For
17004 example, if an alias file translates real names into login ids there is no
17005 point searching the alias file a second time, especially if it is a large file.
17007 The &%redirect_router%& option can be set to the name of any router instance.
17008 It causes the routing of any generated addresses to start at the named router
17009 instead of at the first router. This option has no effect if the router in
17010 which it is set does not generate new addresses.
17014 .option require_files routers&!? "string list&!!" unset
17015 .cindex "file" "requiring for router"
17016 .cindex "router" "requiring file existence"
17017 This option provides a general mechanism for predicating the running of a
17018 router on the existence or non-existence of certain files or directories.
17019 Before running a router, as one of its precondition tests, Exim works its way
17020 through the &%require_files%& list, expanding each item separately.
17022 Because the list is split before expansion, any colons in expansion items must
17023 be doubled, or the facility for using a different list separator must be used.
17024 If any expansion is forced to fail, the item is ignored. Other expansion
17025 failures cause routing of the address to be deferred.
17027 If any expanded string is empty, it is ignored. Otherwise, except as described
17028 below, each string must be a fully qualified file path, optionally preceded by
17029 &"!"&. The paths are passed to the &[stat()]& function to test for the
17030 existence of the files or directories. The router is skipped if any paths not
17031 preceded by &"!"& do not exist, or if any paths preceded by &"!"& do exist.
17034 If &[stat()]& cannot determine whether a file exists or not, delivery of
17035 the message is deferred. This can happen when NFS-mounted filesystems are
17038 This option is checked after the &%domains%&, &%local_parts%&, and &%senders%&
17039 options, so you cannot use it to check for the existence of a file in which to
17040 look up a domain, local part, or sender. (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a
17041 full list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.) However, as
17042 these options are all expanded, you can use the &%exists%& expansion condition
17043 to make such tests. The &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files
17044 that the router may be going to use internally, or which are needed by a
17045 transport (for example &_.procmailrc_&).
17047 During delivery, the &[stat()]& function is run as root, but there is a
17048 facility for some checking of the accessibility of a file by another user.
17049 This is not a proper permissions check, but just a &"rough"& check that
17050 operates as follows:
17052 If an item in a &%require_files%& list does not contain any forward slash
17053 characters, it is taken to be the user (and optional group, separated by a
17054 comma) to be checked for subsequent files in the list. If no group is specified
17055 but the user is specified symbolically, the gid associated with the uid is
17058 require_files = mail:/some/file
17059 require_files = $local_part:$home/.procmailrc
17061 If a user or group name in a &%require_files%& list does not exist, the
17062 &%require_files%& condition fails.
17064 Exim performs the check by scanning along the components of the file path, and
17065 checking the access for the given uid and gid. It checks for &"x"& access on
17066 directories, and &"r"& access on the final file. Note that this means that file
17067 access control lists, if the operating system has them, are ignored.
17069 &*Warning 1*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an
17070 incoming SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. This
17071 may affect the result of a &%require_files%& check. In particular, &[stat()]&
17072 may yield the error EACCES (&"Permission denied"&). This means that the Exim
17073 user is not permitted to read one of the directories on the file's path.
17075 &*Warning 2*&: Even when Exim is running as root while delivering a message,
17076 &[stat()]& can yield EACCES for a file in an NFS directory that is mounted
17077 without root access. In this case, if a check for access by a particular user
17078 is requested, Exim creates a subprocess that runs as that user, and tries the
17079 check again in that process.
17081 The default action for handling an unresolved EACCES is to consider it to
17082 be caused by a configuration error, and routing is deferred because the
17083 existence or non-existence of the file cannot be determined. However, in some
17084 circumstances it may be desirable to treat this condition as if the file did
17085 not exist. If the file name (or the exclamation mark that precedes the file
17086 name for non-existence) is preceded by a plus sign, the EACCES error is treated
17087 as if the file did not exist. For example:
17089 require_files = +/some/file
17091 If the router is not an essential part of verification (for example, it
17092 handles users' &_.forward_& files), another solution is to set the &%verify%&
17093 option false so that the router is skipped when verifying.
17097 .option retry_use_local_part routers boolean "see below"
17098 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
17099 .cindex "local part" "in retry keys"
17100 When a delivery suffers a temporary routing failure, a retry record is created
17101 in Exim's hints database. For addresses whose routing depends only on the
17102 domain, the key for the retry record should not involve the local part, but for
17103 other addresses, both the domain and the local part should be included.
17104 Usually, remote routing is of the former kind, and local routing is of the
17107 This option controls whether the local part is used to form the key for retry
17108 hints for addresses that suffer temporary errors while being handled by this
17109 router. The default value is true for any router that has &%check_local_user%&
17110 set, and false otherwise. Note that this option does not apply to hints keys
17111 for transport delays; they are controlled by a generic transport option of the
17114 The setting of &%retry_use_local_part%& applies only to the router on which it
17115 appears. If the router generates child addresses, they are routed
17116 independently; this setting does not become attached to them.
17120 .option router_home_directory routers string&!! unset
17121 .cindex "router" "home directory for"
17122 .cindex "home directory" "for router"
17124 This option sets a home directory for use while the router is running. (Compare
17125 &%transport_home_directory%&, which sets a home directory for later
17126 transporting.) In particular, if used on a &(redirect)& router, this option
17127 sets a value for &$home$& while a filter is running. The value is expanded;
17128 forced expansion failure causes the option to be ignored &-- other failures
17129 cause the router to defer.
17131 Expansion of &%router_home_directory%& happens immediately after the
17132 &%check_local_user%& test (if configured), before any further expansions take
17134 (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
17136 While the router is running, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the value of
17137 &$home$& that came from &%check_local_user%&.
17139 When a router accepts an address and assigns it to a local transport (including
17140 the cases when a &(redirect)& router generates a pipe, file, or autoreply
17141 delivery), the home directory setting for the transport is taken from the first
17142 of these values that is set:
17145 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
17147 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
17149 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
17151 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
17154 In other words, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the password data for the
17155 router, but not for the transport.
17159 .option self routers string freeze
17160 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
17161 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
17162 This option applies to those routers that use a recipient address to find a
17163 list of remote hosts. Currently, these are the &(dnslookup)&, &(ipliteral)&,
17164 and &(manualroute)& routers.
17165 Certain configurations of the &(queryprogram)& router can also specify a list
17167 Usually such routers are configured to send the message to a remote host via an
17168 &(smtp)& transport. The &%self%& option specifies what happens when the first
17169 host on the list turns out to be the local host.
17170 The way in which Exim checks for the local host is described in section
17171 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
17173 Normally this situation indicates either an error in Exim's configuration (for
17174 example, the router should be configured not to process this domain), or an
17175 error in the DNS (for example, the MX should not point to this host). For this
17176 reason, the default action is to log the incident, defer the address, and
17177 freeze the message. The following alternatives are provided for use in special
17182 Delivery of the message is tried again later, but the message is not frozen.
17184 .vitem "&%reroute%&: <&'domain'&>"
17185 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to
17186 be reprocessed by the routers. No rewriting of headers takes place. This
17187 behaviour is essentially a redirection.
17189 .vitem "&%reroute: rewrite:%& <&'domain'&>"
17190 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to be
17191 reprocessed by the routers. Any headers that contain the original domain are
17196 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
17197 The router passes the address to the next router, or to the router named in the
17198 &%pass_router%& option if it is set. This overrides &%no_more%&. During
17199 subsequent routing and delivery, the variable &$self_hostname$& contains the
17200 name of the local host that the router encountered. This can be used to
17201 distinguish between different cases for hosts with multiple names. The
17207 ensures that only those addresses that routed to the local host are passed on.
17208 Without &%no_more%&, addresses that were declined for other reasons would also
17209 be passed to the next router.
17212 Delivery fails and an error report is generated.
17215 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
17216 The anomaly is ignored and the address is queued for the transport. This
17217 setting should be used with extreme caution. For an &(smtp)& transport, it
17218 makes sense only in cases where the program that is listening on the SMTP port
17219 is not this version of Exim. That is, it must be some other MTA, or Exim with a
17220 different configuration file that handles the domain in another way.
17225 .option senders routers&!? "address list&!!" unset
17226 .cindex "router" "checking senders"
17227 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the message's sender
17228 address matches something on the list.
17229 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
17232 There are issues concerning verification when the running of routers is
17233 dependent on the sender. When Exim is verifying the address in an &%errors_to%&
17234 setting, it sets the sender to the null string. When using the &%-bt%& option
17235 to check a configuration file, it is necessary also to use the &%-f%& option to
17236 set an appropriate sender. For incoming mail, the sender is unset when
17237 verifying the sender, but is available when verifying any recipients. If the
17238 SMTP VRFY command is enabled, it must be used after MAIL if the sender address
17242 .option translate_ip_address routers string&!! unset
17243 .cindex "IP address" "translating"
17244 .cindex "packet radio"
17245 .cindex "router" "IP address translation"
17246 There exist some rare networking situations (for example, packet radio) where
17247 it is helpful to be able to translate IP addresses generated by normal routing
17248 mechanisms into other IP addresses, thus performing a kind of manual IP
17249 routing. This should be done only if the normal IP routing of the TCP/IP stack
17250 is inadequate or broken. Because this is an extremely uncommon requirement, the
17251 code to support this option is not included in the Exim binary unless
17252 SUPPORT_TRANSLATE_IP_ADDRESS=yes is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
17254 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
17255 The &%translate_ip_address%& string is expanded for every IP address generated
17256 by the router, with the generated address set in &$host_address$&. If the
17257 expansion is forced to fail, no action is taken.
17258 For any other expansion error, delivery of the message is deferred.
17259 If the result of the expansion is an IP address, that replaces the original
17260 address; otherwise the result is assumed to be a host name &-- this is looked
17261 up using &[gethostbyname()]& (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) to
17262 produce one or more replacement IP addresses. For example, to subvert all IP
17263 addresses in some specific networks, this could be added to a router:
17265 translate_ip_address = \
17266 ${lookup{${mask:$host_address/26}}lsearch{/some/file}\
17269 The file would contain lines like
17271 10.2.3.128/26 some.host
17272 10.8.4.34/26 10.44.8.15
17274 You should not make use of this facility unless you really understand what you
17279 .option transport routers string&!! unset
17280 This option specifies the transport to be used when a router accepts an address
17281 and sets it up for delivery. A transport is never needed if a router is used
17282 only for verification. The value of the option is expanded at routing time,
17283 after the expansion of &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&, and &%headers_remove%&,
17284 and result must be the name of one of the configured transports. If it is not,
17285 delivery is deferred.
17287 The &%transport%& option is not used by the &(redirect)& router, but it does
17288 have some private options that set up transports for pipe and file deliveries
17289 (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>&).
17293 .option transport_current_directory routers string&!! unset
17294 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
17295 This option associates a current directory with any address that is routed
17296 to a local transport. This can happen either because a transport is
17297 explicitly configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a
17298 file or a pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), this
17299 option string is expanded and is set as the current directory, unless
17300 overridden by a setting on the transport.
17301 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
17302 logged, and delivery is deferred.
17303 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for details of the local delivery
17309 .option transport_home_directory routers string&!! "see below"
17310 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
17311 This option associates a home directory with any address that is routed to a
17312 local transport. This can happen either because a transport is explicitly
17313 configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a file or a
17314 pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), the option
17315 string is expanded and is set as the home directory, unless overridden by a
17316 setting of &%home_directory%& on the transport.
17317 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
17318 logged, and delivery is deferred.
17320 If the transport does not specify a home directory, and
17321 &%transport_home_directory%& is not set for the router, the home directory for
17322 the transport is taken from the password data if &%check_local_user%& is set for
17323 the router. Otherwise it is taken from &%router_home_directory%& if that option
17324 is set; if not, no home directory is set for the transport.
17326 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for further details of the local delivery
17332 .option unseen routers boolean&!! false
17333 .cindex "router" "carrying on after success"
17334 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
17335 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
17336 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
17337 fail, the default value for the option (false) is used. Other failures cause
17338 delivery to be deferred.
17340 When this option is set true, routing does not cease if the router accepts the
17341 address. Instead, a copy of the incoming address is passed to the next router,
17342 overriding a false setting of &%more%&. There is little point in setting
17343 &%more%& false if &%unseen%& is always true, but it may be useful in cases when
17344 the value of &%unseen%& contains expansion items (and therefore, presumably, is
17345 sometimes true and sometimes false).
17347 .cindex "copy of message (&%unseen%& option)"
17348 Setting the &%unseen%& option has a similar effect to the &%unseen%& command
17349 qualifier in filter files. It can be used to cause copies of messages to be
17350 delivered to some other destination, while also carrying out a normal delivery.
17351 In effect, the current address is made into a &"parent"& that has two children
17352 &-- one that is delivered as specified by this router, and a clone that goes on
17353 to be routed further. For this reason, &%unseen%& may not be combined with the
17354 &%one_time%& option in a &(redirect)& router.
17356 &*Warning*&: Header lines added to the address (or specified for removal) by
17357 this router or by previous routers affect the &"unseen"& copy of the message
17358 only. The clone that continues to be processed by further routers starts with
17359 no added headers and none specified for removal. For a &%redirect%& router, if
17360 a generated address is the same as the incoming address, this can lead to
17361 duplicate addresses with different header modifications. Exim does not do
17362 duplicate deliveries (except, in certain circumstances, to pipes -- see section
17363 &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined which of the duplicates is discarded,
17364 so this ambiguous situation should be avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the
17365 &%redirect%& router may be of help.
17367 Unlike the handling of header modifications, any data that was set by the
17368 &%address_data%& option in the current or previous routers &'is'& passed on to
17369 subsequent routers.
17372 .option user routers string&!! "see below"
17373 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
17374 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
17375 .cindex "transport" "local"
17376 .cindex "router" "user for filter processing"
17377 .cindex "filter" "user for processing"
17378 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
17379 specify a user, the user given here is used when running the delivery process.
17380 The user may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
17381 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
17382 This user is also used by the &(redirect)& router when running a filter file.
17383 The default is unset, except when &%check_local_user%& is set. In this case,
17384 the default is taken from the password information. If the user is specified as
17385 a name, and &%group%& is not set, the group associated with the user is used.
17386 See also &%initgroups%& and &%group%& and the discussion in chapter
17387 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
17391 .option verify routers&!? boolean true
17392 Setting this option has the effect of setting &%verify_sender%& and
17393 &%verify_recipient%& to the same value.
17396 .option verify_only routers&!? boolean false
17397 .cindex "EXPN" "with &%verify_only%&"
17399 .cindex "router" "used only when verifying"
17400 If this option is set, the router is used only when verifying an address,
17401 delivering in cutthrough mode or
17402 testing with the &%-bv%& option, not when actually doing a delivery, testing
17403 with the &%-bt%& option, or running the SMTP EXPN command. It can be further
17404 restricted to verifying only senders or recipients by means of
17405 &%verify_sender%& and &%verify_recipient%&.
17407 &*Warning*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an incoming
17408 SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. If the router
17409 accesses any files, you need to make sure that they are accessible to the Exim
17413 .option verify_recipient routers&!? boolean true
17414 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying recipient
17416 delivering in cutthrough mode
17417 or testing recipient verification using &%-bv%&.
17418 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
17422 .option verify_sender routers&!? boolean true
17423 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying sender addresses
17424 or testing sender verification using &%-bvs%&.
17425 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
17427 .ecindex IIDgenoprou1
17428 .ecindex IIDgenoprou2
17435 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17436 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17438 .chapter "The accept router" "CHID4"
17439 .cindex "&(accept)& router"
17440 .cindex "routers" "&(accept)&"
17441 The &(accept)& router has no private options of its own. Unless it is being
17442 used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to
17443 be defined by the generic &%transport%& option. If the preconditions that are
17444 specified by generic options are met, the router accepts the address and queues
17445 it for the given transport. The most common use of this router is for setting
17446 up deliveries to local mailboxes. For example:
17450 domains = mydomain.example
17452 transport = local_delivery
17454 The &%domains%& condition in this example checks the domain of the address, and
17455 &%check_local_user%& checks that the local part is the login of a local user.
17456 When both preconditions are met, the &(accept)& router runs, and queues the
17457 address for the &(local_delivery)& transport.
17464 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17465 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17467 .chapter "The dnslookup router" "CHAPdnslookup"
17468 .scindex IIDdnsrou1 "&(dnslookup)& router"
17469 .scindex IIDdnsrou2 "routers" "&(dnslookup)&"
17470 The &(dnslookup)& router looks up the hosts that handle mail for the
17471 recipient's domain in the DNS. A transport must always be set for this router,
17472 unless &%verify_only%& is set.
17474 If SRV support is configured (see &%check_srv%& below), Exim first searches for
17475 SRV records. If none are found, or if SRV support is not configured,
17476 MX records are looked up. If no MX records exist, address records are sought.
17477 However, &%mx_domains%& can be set to disable the direct use of address
17480 MX records of equal priority are sorted by Exim into a random order. Exim then
17481 looks for address records for the host names obtained from MX or SRV records.
17482 When a host has more than one IP address, they are sorted into a random order,
17483 except that IPv6 addresses are always sorted before IPv4 addresses. If all the
17484 IP addresses found are discarded by a setting of the &%ignore_target_hosts%&
17485 generic option, the router declines.
17487 Unless they have the highest priority (lowest MX value), MX records that point
17488 to the local host, or to any host name that matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&,
17489 are discarded, together with any other MX records of equal or lower priority.
17491 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
17492 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
17493 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(dnslookup)& router"
17494 If the host pointed to by the highest priority MX record, or looked up as an
17495 address record, is the local host, or matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, what
17496 happens is controlled by the generic &%self%& option.
17499 .section "Problems with DNS lookups" "SECTprowitdnsloo"
17500 There have been problems with DNS servers when SRV records are looked up.
17501 Some mis-behaving servers return a DNS error or timeout when a non-existent
17502 SRV record is sought. Similar problems have in the past been reported for
17503 MX records. The global &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& option can help with this
17504 problem, but it is heavy-handed because it is a global option.
17506 For this reason, there are two options, &%srv_fail_domains%& and
17507 &%mx_fail_domains%&, that control what happens when a DNS lookup in a
17508 &(dnslookup)& router results in a DNS failure or a &"try again"& response. If
17509 an attempt to look up an SRV or MX record causes one of these results, and the
17510 domain matches the relevant list, Exim behaves as if the DNS had responded &"no
17511 such record"&. In the case of an SRV lookup, this means that the router
17512 proceeds to look for MX records; in the case of an MX lookup, it proceeds to
17513 look for A or AAAA records, unless the domain matches &%mx_domains%&, in which
17514 case routing fails.
17517 .section "Declining addresses by dnslookup" "SECTdnslookupdecline"
17518 .cindex "&(dnslookup)& router" "declines"
17519 There are a few cases where a &(dnslookup)& router will decline to accept
17520 an address; if such a router is expected to handle "all remaining non-local
17521 domains", then it is important to set &%no_more%&.
17523 Reasons for a &(dnslookup)& router to decline currently include:
17525 The domain does not exist in DNS
17527 The domain exists but the MX record's host part is just "."; this is a common
17528 convention (borrowed from SRV) used to indicate that there is no such service
17529 for this domain and to not fall back to trying A/AAAA records.
17531 Ditto, but for SRV records, when &%check_srv%& is set on this router.
17533 MX record points to a non-existent host.
17535 MX record points to an IP address and the main section option
17536 &%allow_mx_to_ip%& is not set.
17538 MX records exist and point to valid hosts, but all hosts resolve only to
17539 addresses blocked by the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic option on this router.
17541 The domain is not syntactically valid (see also &%allow_utf8_domains%& and
17542 &%dns_check_names_pattern%& for handling one variant of this)
17544 &%check_secondary_mx%& is set on this router but the local host can
17545 not be found in the MX records (see below)
17551 .section "Private options for dnslookup" "SECID118"
17552 .cindex "options" "&(dnslookup)& router"
17553 The private options for the &(dnslookup)& router are as follows:
17555 .option check_secondary_mx dnslookup boolean false
17556 .cindex "MX record" "checking for secondary"
17557 If this option is set, the router declines unless the local host is found in
17558 (and removed from) the list of hosts obtained by MX lookup. This can be used to
17559 process domains for which the local host is a secondary mail exchanger
17560 differently to other domains. The way in which Exim decides whether a host is
17561 the local host is described in section &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
17564 .option check_srv dnslookup string&!! unset
17565 .cindex "SRV record" "enabling use of"
17566 The &(dnslookup)& router supports the use of SRV records (see RFC 2782) in
17567 addition to MX and address records. The support is disabled by default. To
17568 enable SRV support, set the &%check_srv%& option to the name of the service
17569 required. For example,
17573 looks for SRV records that refer to the normal smtp service. The option is
17574 expanded, so the service name can vary from message to message or address
17575 to address. This might be helpful if SRV records are being used for a
17576 submission service. If the expansion is forced to fail, the &%check_srv%&
17577 option is ignored, and the router proceeds to look for MX records in the
17580 When the expansion succeeds, the router searches first for SRV records for
17581 the given service (it assumes TCP protocol). A single SRV record with a
17582 host name that consists of just a single dot indicates &"no such service for
17583 this domain"&; if this is encountered, the router declines. If other kinds of
17584 SRV record are found, they are used to construct a host list for delivery
17585 according to the rules of RFC 2782. MX records are not sought in this case.
17587 When no SRV records are found, MX records (and address records) are sought in
17588 the traditional way. In other words, SRV records take precedence over MX
17589 records, just as MX records take precedence over address records. Note that
17590 this behaviour is not sanctioned by RFC 2782, though a previous draft RFC
17591 defined it. It is apparently believed that MX records are sufficient for email
17592 and that SRV records should not be used for this purpose. However, SRV records
17593 have an additional &"weight"& feature which some people might find useful when
17594 trying to split an SMTP load between hosts of different power.
17596 See section &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& above for a discussion of Exim's behaviour
17597 when there is a DNS lookup error.
17601 .option mx_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
17602 .cindex "MX record" "required to exist"
17603 .cindex "SRV record" "required to exist"
17604 A domain that matches &%mx_domains%& is required to have either an MX or an SRV
17605 record in order to be recognized. (The name of this option could be improved.)
17606 For example, if all the mail hosts in &'fict.example'& are known to have MX
17607 records, except for those in &'discworld.fict.example'&, you could use this
17610 mx_domains = ! *.discworld.fict.example : *.fict.example
17612 This specifies that messages addressed to a domain that matches the list but
17613 has no MX record should be bounced immediately instead of being routed using
17614 the address record.
17617 .option mx_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
17618 If the DNS lookup for MX records for one of the domains in this list causes a
17619 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no MX records were found. See section
17620 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
17625 .option qualify_single dnslookup boolean true
17626 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
17627 .cindex "DNS" "qualifying single-component names"
17628 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DEFNAMES is set for DNS
17629 lookups. Typically, but not standardly, this causes the resolver to qualify
17630 single-component names with the default domain. For example, on a machine
17631 called &'dictionary.ref.example'&, the domain &'thesaurus'& would be changed to
17632 &'thesaurus.ref.example'& inside the resolver. For details of what your
17633 resolver actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and
17638 .option rewrite_headers dnslookup boolean true
17639 .cindex "rewriting" "header lines"
17640 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting"
17641 If the domain name in the address that is being processed is not fully
17642 qualified, it may be expanded to its full form by a DNS lookup. For example, if
17643 an address is specified as &'dormouse@teaparty'&, the domain might be
17644 expanded to &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. Domain expansion can also
17645 occur as a result of setting the &%widen_domains%& option. If
17646 &%rewrite_headers%& is true, all occurrences of the abbreviated domain name in
17647 any &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-to:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&
17648 header lines of the message are rewritten with the full domain name.
17650 This option should be turned off only when it is known that no message is
17651 ever going to be sent outside an environment where the abbreviation makes
17654 When an MX record is looked up in the DNS and matches a wildcard record, name
17655 servers normally return a record containing the name that has been looked up,
17656 making it impossible to detect whether a wildcard was present or not. However,
17657 some name servers have recently been seen to return the wildcard entry. If the
17658 name returned by a DNS lookup begins with an asterisk, it is not used for
17662 .option same_domain_copy_routing dnslookup boolean false
17663 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
17664 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(dnslookup)& router
17665 to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the router
17666 options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
17667 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
17668 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
17669 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
17671 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
17672 domain, and you are using a &(dnslookup)& router which is independent of the
17673 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
17674 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when &(dnslookup)&
17675 routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted addresses in the
17676 message that have the same domain are automatically given the same routing
17677 without processing them independently,
17678 provided the following conditions are met:
17681 No router that processed the address specified &%headers_add%& or
17682 &%headers_remove%&.
17684 The router did not change the address in any way, for example, by &"widening"&
17691 .option search_parents dnslookup boolean false
17692 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
17693 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DNSRCH is set for DNS
17694 lookups. This is different from the &%qualify_single%& option in that it
17695 applies to domains containing dots. Typically, but not standardly, it causes
17696 the resolver to search for the name in the current domain and in parent
17697 domains. For example, on a machine in the &'fict.example'& domain, if looking
17698 up &'teaparty.wonderland'& failed, the resolver would try
17699 &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. For details of what your resolver
17700 actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and &'resolv.conf'&.
17702 Setting this option true can cause problems in domains that have a wildcard MX
17703 record, because any domain that does not have its own MX record matches the
17708 .option srv_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
17709 If the DNS lookup for SRV records for one of the domains in this list causes a
17710 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no SRV records were found. See section
17711 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
17716 .option widen_domains dnslookup "string list" unset
17717 .cindex "domain" "partial; widening"
17718 If a DNS lookup fails and this option is set, each of its strings in turn is
17719 added onto the end of the domain, and the lookup is tried again. For example,
17722 widen_domains = fict.example:ref.example
17724 is set and a lookup of &'klingon.dictionary'& fails,
17725 &'klingon.dictionary.fict.example'& is looked up, and if this fails,
17726 &'klingon.dictionary.ref.example'& is tried. Note that the &%qualify_single%&
17727 and &%search_parents%& options can cause some widening to be undertaken inside
17728 the DNS resolver. &%widen_domains%& is not applied to sender addresses
17729 when verifying, unless &%rewrite_headers%& is false (not the default).
17732 .section "Effect of qualify_single and search_parents" "SECID119"
17733 When a domain from an envelope recipient is changed by the resolver as a result
17734 of the &%qualify_single%& or &%search_parents%& options, Exim rewrites the
17735 corresponding address in the message's header lines unless &%rewrite_headers%&
17736 is set false. Exim then re-routes the address, using the full domain.
17738 These two options affect only the DNS lookup that takes place inside the router
17739 for the domain of the address that is being routed. They do not affect lookups
17740 such as that implied by
17744 that may happen while processing a router precondition before the router is
17745 entered. No widening ever takes place for these lookups.
17746 .ecindex IIDdnsrou1
17747 .ecindex IIDdnsrou2
17757 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17758 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17760 .chapter "The ipliteral router" "CHID5"
17761 .cindex "&(ipliteral)& router"
17762 .cindex "domain literal" "routing"
17763 .cindex "routers" "&(ipliteral)&"
17764 This router has no private options. Unless it is being used purely for
17765 verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to be defined by the
17766 generic &%transport%& option. The router accepts the address if its domain part
17767 takes the form of an RFC 2822 domain literal. For example, the &(ipliteral)&
17768 router handles the address
17772 by setting up delivery to the host with that IP address. IPv4 domain literals
17773 consist of an IPv4 address enclosed in square brackets. IPv6 domain literals
17774 are similar, but the address is preceded by &`ipv6:`&. For example:
17776 postmaster@[ipv6:fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678]
17778 Exim allows &`ipv4:`& before IPv4 addresses, for consistency, and on the
17779 grounds that sooner or later somebody will try it.
17781 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(ipliteral)& router"
17782 If the IP address matches something in &%ignore_target_hosts%&, the router
17783 declines. If an IP literal turns out to refer to the local host, the generic
17784 &%self%& option determines what happens.
17786 The RFCs require support for domain literals; however, their use is
17787 controversial in today's Internet. If you want to use this router, you must
17788 also set the main configuration option &%allow_domain_literals%&. Otherwise,
17789 Exim will not recognize the domain literal syntax in addresses.
17793 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17794 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17796 .chapter "The iplookup router" "CHID6"
17797 .cindex "&(iplookup)& router"
17798 .cindex "routers" "&(iplookup)&"
17799 The &(iplookup)& router was written to fulfil a specific requirement in
17800 Cambridge University (which in fact no longer exists). For this reason, it is
17801 not included in the binary of Exim by default. If you want to include it, you
17804 ROUTER_IPLOOKUP=yes
17806 in your &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file.
17808 The &(iplookup)& router routes an address by sending it over a TCP or UDP
17809 connection to one or more specific hosts. The host can then return the same or
17810 a different address &-- in effect rewriting the recipient address in the
17811 message's envelope. The new address is then passed on to subsequent routers. If
17812 this process fails, the address can be passed on to other routers, or delivery
17813 can be deferred. Since &(iplookup)& is just a rewriting router, a transport
17814 must not be specified for it.
17816 .cindex "options" "&(iplookup)& router"
17817 .option hosts iplookup string unset
17818 This option must be supplied. Its value is a colon-separated list of host
17819 names. The hosts are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
17820 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
17821 and are tried in order until one responds to the query. If none respond, what
17822 happens is controlled by &%optional%&.
17825 .option optional iplookup boolean false
17826 If &%optional%& is true, if no response is obtained from any host, the address
17827 is passed to the next router, overriding &%no_more%&. If &%optional%& is false,
17828 delivery to the address is deferred.
17831 .option port iplookup integer 0
17832 .cindex "port" "&(iplookup)& router"
17833 This option must be supplied. It specifies the port number for the TCP or UDP
17837 .option protocol iplookup string udp
17838 This option can be set to &"udp"& or &"tcp"& to specify which of the two
17839 protocols is to be used.
17842 .option query iplookup string&!! "see below"
17843 This defines the content of the query that is sent to the remote hosts. The
17846 $local_part@$domain $local_part@$domain
17848 The repetition serves as a way of checking that a response is to the correct
17849 query in the default case (see &%response_pattern%& below).
17852 .option reroute iplookup string&!! unset
17853 If this option is not set, the rerouted address is precisely the byte string
17854 returned by the remote host, up to the first white space, if any. If set, the
17855 string is expanded to form the rerouted address. It can include parts matched
17856 in the response by &%response_pattern%& by means of numeric variables such as
17857 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. The variable &$0$& refers to the entire input string,
17858 whether or not a pattern is in use. In all cases, the rerouted address must end
17859 up in the form &'local_part@domain'&.
17862 .option response_pattern iplookup string unset
17863 This option can be set to a regular expression that is applied to the string
17864 returned from the remote host. If the pattern does not match the response, the
17865 router declines. If &%response_pattern%& is not set, no checking of the
17866 response is done, unless the query was defaulted, in which case there is a
17867 check that the text returned after the first white space is the original
17868 address. This checks that the answer that has been received is in response to
17869 the correct question. For example, if the response is just a new domain, the
17870 following could be used:
17872 response_pattern = ^([^@]+)$
17873 reroute = $local_part@$1
17876 .option timeout iplookup time 5s
17877 This specifies the amount of time to wait for a response from the remote
17878 machine. The same timeout is used for the &[connect()]& function for a TCP
17879 call. It does not apply to UDP.
17884 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17885 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17887 .chapter "The manualroute router" "CHID7"
17888 .scindex IIDmanrou1 "&(manualroute)& router"
17889 .scindex IIDmanrou2 "routers" "&(manualroute)&"
17890 .cindex "domain" "manually routing"
17891 The &(manualroute)& router is so-called because it provides a way of manually
17892 routing an address according to its domain. It is mainly used when you want to
17893 route addresses to remote hosts according to your own rules, bypassing the
17894 normal DNS routing that looks up MX records. However, &(manualroute)& can also
17895 route to local transports, a facility that may be useful if you want to save
17896 messages for dial-in hosts in local files.
17898 The &(manualroute)& router compares a list of domain patterns with the domain
17899 it is trying to route. If there is no match, the router declines. Each pattern
17900 has associated with it a list of hosts and some other optional data, which may
17901 include a transport. The combination of a pattern and its data is called a
17902 &"routing rule"&. For patterns that do not have an associated transport, the
17903 generic &%transport%& option must specify a transport, unless the router is
17904 being used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&).
17907 In the case of verification, matching the domain pattern is sufficient for the
17908 router to accept the address. When actually routing an address for delivery,
17909 an address that matches a domain pattern is queued for the associated
17910 transport. If the transport is not a local one, a host list must be associated
17911 with the pattern; IP addresses are looked up for the hosts, and these are
17912 passed to the transport along with the mail address. For local transports, a
17913 host list is optional. If it is present, it is passed in &$host$& as a single
17916 The list of routing rules can be provided as an inline string in
17917 &%route_list%&, or the data can be obtained by looking up the domain in a file
17918 or database by setting &%route_data%&. Only one of these settings may appear in
17919 any one instance of &(manualroute)&. The format of routing rules is described
17920 below, following the list of private options.
17923 .section "Private options for manualroute" "SECTprioptman"
17925 .cindex "options" "&(manualroute)& router"
17926 The private options for the &(manualroute)& router are as follows:
17928 .option host_all_ignored manualroute string defer
17929 See &%host_find_failed%&.
17931 .option host_find_failed manualroute string freeze
17932 This option controls what happens when &(manualroute)& tries to find an IP
17933 address for a host, and the host does not exist. The option can be set to one
17934 of the following values:
17943 The default (&"freeze"&) assumes that this state is a serious configuration
17944 error. The difference between &"pass"& and &"decline"& is that the former
17945 forces the address to be passed to the next router (or the router defined by
17948 overriding &%no_more%&, whereas the latter passes the address to the next
17949 router only if &%more%& is true.
17951 The value &"ignore"& causes Exim to completely ignore a host whose IP address
17952 cannot be found. If all the hosts in the list are ignored, the behaviour is
17953 controlled by the &%host_all_ignored%& option. This takes the same values
17954 as &%host_find_failed%&, except that it cannot be set to &"ignore"&.
17956 The &%host_find_failed%& option applies only to a definite &"does not exist"&
17957 state; if a host lookup gets a temporary error, delivery is deferred unless the
17958 generic &%pass_on_timeout%& option is set.
17961 .option hosts_randomize manualroute boolean false
17962 .cindex "randomized host list"
17963 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
17964 If this option is set, the order of the items in a host list in a routing rule
17965 is randomized each time the list is used, unless an option in the routing rule
17966 overrides (see below). Randomizing the order of a host list can be used to do
17967 crude load sharing. However, if more than one mail address is routed by the
17968 same router to the same host list, the host lists are considered to be the same
17969 (even though they may be randomized into different orders) for the purpose of
17970 deciding whether to batch the deliveries into a single SMTP transaction.
17972 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split
17973 into groups whose order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to
17974 set up MX-like behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an
17975 item that is just &`+`& in the host list. For example:
17977 route_list = * host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
17979 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
17980 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
17981 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored. If a
17982 randomized host list is passed to an &(smtp)& transport that also has
17983 &%hosts_randomize set%&, the list is not re-randomized.
17986 .option route_data manualroute string&!! unset
17987 If this option is set, it must expand to yield the data part of a routing rule.
17988 Typically, the expansion string includes a lookup based on the domain. For
17991 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/etc/routes}}
17993 If the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the
17994 router declines. Other kinds of expansion failure cause delivery to be
17998 .option route_list manualroute "string list" unset
17999 This string is a list of routing rules, in the form defined below. Note that,
18000 unlike most string lists, the items are separated by semicolons. This is so
18001 that they may contain colon-separated host lists.
18004 .option same_domain_copy_routing manualroute boolean false
18005 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
18006 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(manualroute)&
18007 router to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the
18008 router options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
18009 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
18010 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
18011 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
18013 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
18014 domain, and you are using a &(manualroute)& router which is independent of the
18015 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
18016 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when
18017 &(manualroute)& routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted
18018 addresses in the message that have the same domain are automatically given the
18019 same routing without processing them independently. However, this is only done
18020 if &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& are unset.
18025 .section "Routing rules in route_list" "SECID120"
18026 The value of &%route_list%& is a string consisting of a sequence of routing
18027 rules, separated by semicolons. If a semicolon is needed in a rule, it can be
18028 entered as two semicolons. Alternatively, the list separator can be changed as
18029 described (for colon-separated lists) in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
18030 Empty rules are ignored. The format of each rule is
18032 <&'domain pattern'&> <&'list of hosts'&> <&'options'&>
18034 The following example contains two rules, each with a simple domain pattern and
18038 dict.ref.example mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example ; \
18039 thes.ref.example mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
18041 The three parts of a rule are separated by white space. The pattern and the
18042 list of hosts can be enclosed in quotes if necessary, and if they are, the
18043 usual quoting rules apply. Each rule in a &%route_list%& must start with a
18044 single domain pattern, which is the only mandatory item in the rule. The
18045 pattern is in the same format as one item in a domain list (see section
18046 &<<SECTdomainlist>>&),
18047 except that it may not be the name of an interpolated file.
18048 That is, it may be wildcarded, or a regular expression, or a file or database
18049 lookup (with semicolons doubled, because of the use of semicolon as a separator
18050 in a &%route_list%&).
18052 The rules in &%route_list%& are searched in order until one of the patterns
18053 matches the domain that is being routed. The list of hosts and then options are
18054 then used as described below. If there is no match, the router declines. When
18055 &%route_list%& is set, &%route_data%& must not be set.
18059 .section "Routing rules in route_data" "SECID121"
18060 The use of &%route_list%& is convenient when there are only a small number of
18061 routing rules. For larger numbers, it is easier to use a file or database to
18062 hold the routing information, and use the &%route_data%& option instead.
18063 The value of &%route_data%& is a list of hosts, followed by (optional) options.
18064 Most commonly, &%route_data%& is set as a string that contains an
18065 expansion lookup. For example, suppose we place two routing rules in a file
18068 dict.ref.example: mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example
18069 thes.ref.example: mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
18071 This data can be accessed by setting
18073 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/the/file/name}}
18075 Failure of the lookup results in an empty string, causing the router to
18076 decline. However, you do not have to use a lookup in &%route_data%&. The only
18077 requirement is that the result of expanding the string is a list of hosts,
18078 possibly followed by options, separated by white space. The list of hosts must
18079 be enclosed in quotes if it contains white space.
18084 .section "Format of the list of hosts" "SECID122"
18085 A list of hosts, whether obtained via &%route_data%& or &%route_list%&, is
18086 always separately expanded before use. If the expansion fails, the router
18087 declines. The result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list of names
18088 and/or IP addresses, optionally also including ports. The format of each item
18089 in the list is described in the next section. The list separator can be changed
18090 as described in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
18092 If the list of hosts was obtained from a &%route_list%& item, the following
18093 variables are set during its expansion:
18096 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(manualroute)& router"
18097 If the domain was matched against a regular expression, the numeric variables
18098 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set. For example:
18100 route_list = ^domain(\d+) host-$1.text.example
18103 &$0$& is always set to the entire domain.
18105 &$1$& is also set when partial matching is done in a file lookup.
18108 .vindex "&$value$&"
18109 If the pattern that matched the domain was a lookup item, the data that was
18110 looked up is available in the expansion variable &$value$&. For example:
18112 route_list = lsearch;;/some/file.routes $value
18116 Note the doubling of the semicolon in the pattern that is necessary because
18117 semicolon is the default route list separator.
18121 .section "Format of one host item" "SECTformatonehostitem"
18122 Each item in the list of hosts is either a host name or an IP address,
18123 optionally with an attached port number. When no port is given, an IP address
18124 is not enclosed in brackets. When a port is specified, it overrides the port
18125 specification on the transport. The port is separated from the name or address
18126 by a colon. This leads to some complications:
18129 Because colon is the default separator for the list of hosts, either
18130 the colon that specifies a port must be doubled, or the list separator must
18131 be changed. The following two examples have the same effect:
18133 route_list = * "host1.tld::1225 : host2.tld::1226"
18134 route_list = * "<+ host1.tld:1225 + host2.tld:1226"
18137 When IPv6 addresses are involved, it gets worse, because they contain
18138 colons of their own. To make this case easier, it is permitted to
18139 enclose an IP address (either v4 or v6) in square brackets if a port
18140 number follows. For example:
18142 route_list = * "</ [10.1.1.1]:1225 / [::1]:1226"
18146 .section "How the list of hosts is used" "SECThostshowused"
18147 When an address is routed to an &(smtp)& transport by &(manualroute)&, each of
18148 the hosts is tried, in the order specified, when carrying out the SMTP
18149 delivery. However, the order can be changed by setting the &%hosts_randomize%&
18150 option, either on the router (see section &<<SECTprioptman>>& above), or on the
18153 Hosts may be listed by name or by IP address. An unadorned name in the list of
18154 hosts is interpreted as a host name. A name that is followed by &`/MX`& is
18155 interpreted as an indirection to a sublist of hosts obtained by looking up MX
18156 records in the DNS. For example:
18158 route_list = * x.y.z:p.q.r/MX:e.f.g
18160 If this feature is used with a port specifier, the port must come last. For
18163 route_list = * dom1.tld/mx::1225
18165 If the &%hosts_randomize%& option is set, the order of the items in the list is
18166 randomized before any lookups are done. Exim then scans the list; for any name
18167 that is not followed by &`/MX`& it looks up an IP address. If this turns out to
18168 be an interface on the local host and the item is not the first in the list,
18169 Exim discards it and any subsequent items. If it is the first item, what
18170 happens is controlled by the
18171 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(manualroute)& router"
18172 &%self%& option of the router.
18174 A name on the list that is followed by &`/MX`& is replaced with the list of
18175 hosts obtained by looking up MX records for the name. This is always a DNS
18176 lookup; the &%bydns%& and &%byname%& options (see section &<<SECThowoptused>>&
18177 below) are not relevant here. The order of these hosts is determined by the
18178 preference values in the MX records, according to the usual rules. Because
18179 randomizing happens before the MX lookup, it does not affect the order that is
18180 defined by MX preferences.
18182 If the local host is present in the sublist obtained from MX records, but is
18183 not the most preferred host in that list, it and any equally or less
18184 preferred hosts are removed before the sublist is inserted into the main list.
18186 If the local host is the most preferred host in the MX list, what happens
18187 depends on where in the original list of hosts the &`/MX`& item appears. If it
18188 is not the first item (that is, there are previous hosts in the main list),
18189 Exim discards this name and any subsequent items in the main list.
18191 If the MX item is first in the list of hosts, and the local host is the
18192 most preferred host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& option of the
18195 DNS failures when lookup up the MX records are treated in the same way as DNS
18196 failures when looking up IP addresses: &%pass_on_timeout%& and
18197 &%host_find_failed%& are used when relevant.
18199 The generic &%ignore_target_hosts%& option applies to all hosts in the list,
18200 whether obtained from an MX lookup or not.
18204 .section "How the options are used" "SECThowoptused"
18205 The options are a sequence of words; in practice no more than three are ever
18206 present. One of the words can be the name of a transport; this overrides the
18207 &%transport%& option on the router for this particular routing rule only. The
18208 other words (if present) control randomization of the list of hosts on a
18209 per-rule basis, and how the IP addresses of the hosts are to be found when
18210 routing to a remote transport. These options are as follows:
18213 &%randomize%&: randomize the order of the hosts in this list, overriding the
18214 setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
18216 &%no_randomize%&: do not randomize the order of the hosts in this list,
18217 overriding the setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
18219 &%byname%&: use &[getipnodebyname()]& (&[gethostbyname()]& on older systems) to
18220 find IP addresses. This function may ultimately cause a DNS lookup, but it may
18221 also look in &_/etc/hosts_& or other sources of information.
18223 &%bydns%&: look up address records for the hosts directly in the DNS; fail if
18224 no address records are found. If there is a temporary DNS error (such as a
18225 timeout), delivery is deferred.
18230 route_list = domain1 host1:host2:host3 randomize bydns;\
18231 domain2 host4:host5
18233 If neither &%byname%& nor &%bydns%& is given, Exim behaves as follows: First, a
18234 DNS lookup is done. If this yields anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that
18235 result is used. Otherwise, Exim goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]&
18236 or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the result of the lookup is the result of that
18239 &*Warning*&: It has been discovered that on some systems, if a DNS lookup
18240 called via &[getipnodebyname()]& times out, HOST_NOT_FOUND is returned
18241 instead of TRY_AGAIN. That is why the default action is to try a DNS
18242 lookup first. Only if that gives a definite &"no such host"& is the local
18247 If no IP address for a host can be found, what happens is controlled by the
18248 &%host_find_failed%& option.
18251 When an address is routed to a local transport, IP addresses are not looked up.
18252 The host list is passed to the transport in the &$host$& variable.
18256 .section "Manualroute examples" "SECID123"
18257 In some of the examples that follow, the presence of the &%remote_smtp%&
18258 transport, as defined in the default configuration file, is assumed:
18261 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
18262 The &(manualroute)& router can be used to forward all external mail to a
18263 &'smart host'&. If you have set up, in the main part of the configuration, a
18264 named domain list that contains your local domains, for example:
18266 domainlist local_domains = my.domain.example
18268 You can arrange for all other domains to be routed to a smart host by making
18269 your first router something like this:
18272 driver = manualroute
18273 domains = !+local_domains
18274 transport = remote_smtp
18275 route_list = * smarthost.ref.example
18277 This causes all non-local addresses to be sent to the single host
18278 &'smarthost.ref.example'&. If a colon-separated list of smart hosts is given,
18279 they are tried in order
18280 (but you can use &%hosts_randomize%& to vary the order each time).
18281 Another way of configuring the same thing is this:
18284 driver = manualroute
18285 transport = remote_smtp
18286 route_list = !+local_domains smarthost.ref.example
18288 There is no difference in behaviour between these two routers as they stand.
18289 However, they behave differently if &%no_more%& is added to them. In the first
18290 example, the router is skipped if the domain does not match the &%domains%&
18291 precondition; the following router is always tried. If the router runs, it
18292 always matches the domain and so can never decline. Therefore, &%no_more%&
18293 would have no effect. In the second case, the router is never skipped; it
18294 always runs. However, if it doesn't match the domain, it declines. In this case
18295 &%no_more%& would prevent subsequent routers from running.
18298 .cindex "mail hub example"
18299 A &'mail hub'& is a host which receives mail for a number of domains via MX
18300 records in the DNS and delivers it via its own private routing mechanism. Often
18301 the final destinations are behind a firewall, with the mail hub being the one
18302 machine that can connect to machines both inside and outside the firewall. The
18303 &(manualroute)& router is usually used on a mail hub to route incoming messages
18304 to the correct hosts. For a small number of domains, the routing can be inline,
18305 using the &%route_list%& option, but for a larger number a file or database
18306 lookup is easier to manage.
18308 If the domain names are in fact the names of the machines to which the mail is
18309 to be sent by the mail hub, the configuration can be quite simple. For
18313 driver = manualroute
18314 transport = remote_smtp
18315 route_list = *.rhodes.tvs.example $domain
18317 This configuration routes domains that match &`*.rhodes.tvs.example`& to hosts
18318 whose names are the same as the mail domains. A similar approach can be taken
18319 if the host name can be obtained from the domain name by a string manipulation
18320 that the expansion facilities can handle. Otherwise, a lookup based on the
18321 domain can be used to find the host:
18324 driver = manualroute
18325 transport = remote_smtp
18326 route_data = ${lookup {$domain} cdb {/internal/host/routes}}
18328 The result of the lookup must be the name or IP address of the host (or
18329 hosts) to which the address is to be routed. If the lookup fails, the route
18330 data is empty, causing the router to decline. The address then passes to the
18334 .cindex "batched SMTP output example"
18335 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing; example"
18336 You can use &(manualroute)& to deliver messages to pipes or files in batched
18337 SMTP format for onward transportation by some other means. This is one way of
18338 storing mail for a dial-up host when it is not connected. The route list entry
18339 can be as simple as a single domain name in a configuration like this:
18342 driver = manualroute
18343 transport = batchsmtp_appendfile
18344 route_list = saved.domain.example
18346 though often a pattern is used to pick up more than one domain. If there are
18347 several domains or groups of domains with different transport requirements,
18348 different transports can be listed in the routing information:
18351 driver = manualroute
18353 *.saved.domain1.example $domain batch_appendfile; \
18354 *.saved.domain2.example \
18355 ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/domain2/hosts}{$value}fail} \
18358 .vindex "&$domain$&"
18360 The first of these just passes the domain in the &$host$& variable, which
18361 doesn't achieve much (since it is also in &$domain$&), but the second does a
18362 file lookup to find a value to pass, causing the router to decline to handle
18363 the address if the lookup fails.
18366 .cindex "UUCP" "example of router for"
18367 Routing mail directly to UUCP software is a specific case of the use of
18368 &(manualroute)& in a gateway to another mail environment. This is an example of
18369 one way it can be done:
18375 command = /usr/local/bin/uux -r - \
18376 ${substr_-5:$host}!rmail ${local_part}
18377 return_fail_output = true
18382 driver = manualroute
18384 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/usr/local/exim/uucphosts}}
18386 The file &_/usr/local/exim/uucphosts_& contains entries like
18388 darksite.ethereal.example: darksite.UUCP
18390 It can be set up more simply without adding and removing &".UUCP"& but this way
18391 makes clear the distinction between the domain name
18392 &'darksite.ethereal.example'& and the UUCP host name &'darksite'&.
18394 .ecindex IIDmanrou1
18395 .ecindex IIDmanrou2
18404 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18405 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18407 .chapter "The queryprogram router" "CHAPdriverlast"
18408 .scindex IIDquerou1 "&(queryprogram)& router"
18409 .scindex IIDquerou2 "routers" "&(queryprogram)&"
18410 .cindex "routing" "by external program"
18411 The &(queryprogram)& router routes an address by running an external command
18412 and acting on its output. This is an expensive way to route, and is intended
18413 mainly for use in lightly-loaded systems, or for performing experiments.
18414 However, if it is possible to use the precondition options (&%domains%&,
18415 &%local_parts%&, etc) to skip this router for most addresses, it could sensibly
18416 be used in special cases, even on a busy host. There are the following private
18418 .cindex "options" "&(queryprogram)& router"
18420 .option command queryprogram string&!! unset
18421 This option must be set. It specifies the command that is to be run. The
18422 command is split up into a command name and arguments, and then each is
18423 expanded separately (exactly as for a &(pipe)& transport, described in chapter
18424 &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&).
18427 .option command_group queryprogram string unset
18428 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in &(queryprogram)& router"
18429 This option specifies a gid to be set when running the command while routing an
18430 address for deliver. It must be set if &%command_user%& specifies a numerical
18431 uid. If it begins with a digit, it is interpreted as the numerical value of the
18432 gid. Otherwise it is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&.
18435 .option command_user queryprogram string unset
18436 .cindex "uid (user id)" "for &(queryprogram)&"
18437 This option must be set. It specifies the uid which is set when running the
18438 command while routing an address for delivery. If the value begins with a digit,
18439 it is interpreted as the numerical value of the uid. Otherwise, it is looked up
18440 using &[getpwnam()]& to obtain a value for the uid and, if &%command_group%& is
18441 not set, a value for the gid also.
18443 &*Warning:*& Changing uid and gid is possible only when Exim is running as
18444 root, which it does during a normal delivery in a conventional configuration.
18445 However, when an address is being verified during message reception, Exim is
18446 usually running as the Exim user, not as root. If the &(queryprogram)& router
18447 is called from a non-root process, Exim cannot change uid or gid before running
18448 the command. In this circumstance the command runs under the current uid and
18452 .option current_directory queryprogram string /
18453 This option specifies an absolute path which is made the current directory
18454 before running the command.
18457 .option timeout queryprogram time 1h
18458 If the command does not complete within the timeout period, its process group
18459 is killed and the message is frozen. A value of zero time specifies no
18463 The standard output of the command is connected to a pipe, which is read when
18464 the command terminates. It should consist of a single line of output,
18465 containing up to five fields, separated by white space. The maximum length of
18466 the line is 1023 characters. Longer lines are silently truncated. The first
18467 field is one of the following words (case-insensitive):
18470 &'Accept'&: routing succeeded; the remaining fields specify what to do (see
18473 &'Decline'&: the router declines; pass the address to the next router, unless
18474 &%no_more%& is set.
18476 &'Fail'&: routing failed; do not pass the address to any more routers. Any
18477 subsequent text on the line is an error message. If the router is run as part
18478 of address verification during an incoming SMTP message, the message is
18479 included in the SMTP response.
18481 &'Defer'&: routing could not be completed at this time; try again later. Any
18482 subsequent text on the line is an error message which is logged. It is not
18483 included in any SMTP response.
18485 &'Freeze'&: the same as &'defer'&, except that the message is frozen.
18487 &'Pass'&: pass the address to the next router (or the router specified by
18488 &%pass_router%&), overriding &%no_more%&.
18490 &'Redirect'&: the message is redirected. The remainder of the line is a list of
18491 new addresses, which are routed independently, starting with the first router,
18492 or the router specified by &%redirect_router%&, if set.
18495 When the first word is &'accept'&, the remainder of the line consists of a
18496 number of keyed data values, as follows (split into two lines here, to fit on
18499 ACCEPT TRANSPORT=<transport> HOSTS=<list of hosts>
18500 LOOKUP=byname|bydns DATA=<text>
18502 The data items can be given in any order, and all are optional. If no transport
18503 is included, the transport specified by the generic &%transport%& option is
18504 used. The list of hosts and the lookup type are needed only if the transport is
18505 an &(smtp)& transport that does not itself supply a list of hosts.
18507 The format of the list of hosts is the same as for the &(manualroute)& router.
18508 As well as host names and IP addresses with optional port numbers, as described
18509 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&, it may contain names followed by
18510 &`/MX`& to specify sublists of hosts that are obtained by looking up MX records
18511 (see section &<<SECThostshowused>>&).
18513 If the lookup type is not specified, Exim behaves as follows when trying to
18514 find an IP address for each host: First, a DNS lookup is done. If this yields
18515 anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that result is used. Otherwise, Exim
18516 goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]& or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the
18517 result of the lookup is the result of that call.
18519 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
18520 If the DATA field is set, its value is placed in the &$address_data$&
18521 variable. For example, this return line
18523 accept hosts=x1.y.example:x2.y.example data="rule1"
18525 routes the address to the default transport, passing a list of two hosts. When
18526 the transport runs, the string &"rule1"& is in &$address_data$&.
18527 .ecindex IIDquerou1
18528 .ecindex IIDquerou2
18533 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18534 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18536 .chapter "The redirect router" "CHAPredirect"
18537 .scindex IIDredrou1 "&(redirect)& router"
18538 .scindex IIDredrou2 "routers" "&(redirect)&"
18539 .cindex "alias file" "in a &(redirect)& router"
18540 .cindex "address redirection" "&(redirect)& router"
18541 The &(redirect)& router handles several kinds of address redirection. Its most
18542 common uses are for resolving local part aliases from a central alias file
18543 (usually called &_/etc/aliases_&) and for handling users' personal &_.forward_&
18544 files, but it has many other potential uses. The incoming address can be
18545 redirected in several different ways:
18548 It can be replaced by one or more new addresses which are themselves routed
18551 It can be routed to be delivered to a given file or directory.
18553 It can be routed to be delivered to a specified pipe command.
18555 It can cause an automatic reply to be generated.
18557 It can be forced to fail, optionally with a custom error message.
18559 It can be temporarily deferred, optionally with a custom message.
18561 It can be discarded.
18564 The generic &%transport%& option must not be set for &(redirect)& routers.
18565 However, there are some private options which define transports for delivery to
18566 files and pipes, and for generating autoreplies. See the &%file_transport%&,
18567 &%pipe_transport%& and &%reply_transport%& descriptions below.
18571 .section "Redirection data" "SECID124"
18572 The router operates by interpreting a text string which it obtains either by
18573 expanding the contents of the &%data%& option, or by reading the entire
18574 contents of a file whose name is given in the &%file%& option. These two
18575 options are mutually exclusive. The first is commonly used for handling system
18576 aliases, in a configuration like this:
18580 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
18582 If the lookup fails, the expanded string in this example is empty. When the
18583 expansion of &%data%& results in an empty string, the router declines. A forced
18584 expansion failure also causes the router to decline; other expansion failures
18585 cause delivery to be deferred.
18587 A configuration using &%file%& is commonly used for handling users'
18588 &_.forward_& files, like this:
18593 file = $home/.forward
18596 If the file does not exist, or causes no action to be taken (for example, it is
18597 empty or consists only of comments), the router declines. &*Warning*&: This
18598 is not the case when the file contains syntactically valid items that happen to
18599 yield empty addresses, for example, items containing only RFC 2822 address
18604 .section "Forward files and address verification" "SECID125"
18605 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
18606 It is usual to set &%no_verify%& on &(redirect)& routers which handle users'
18607 &_.forward_& files, as in the example above. There are two reasons for this:
18610 When Exim is receiving an incoming SMTP message from a remote host, it is
18611 running under the Exim uid, not as root. Exim is unable to change uid to read
18612 the file as the user, and it may not be able to read it as the Exim user. So in
18613 practice the router may not be able to operate.
18615 However, even when the router can operate, the existence of a &_.forward_& file
18616 is unimportant when verifying an address. What should be checked is whether the
18617 local part is a valid user name or not. Cutting out the redirection processing
18618 saves some resources.
18626 .section "Interpreting redirection data" "SECID126"
18627 .cindex "Sieve filter" "specifying in redirection data"
18628 .cindex "filter" "specifying in redirection data"
18629 The contents of the data string, whether obtained from &%data%& or &%file%&,
18630 can be interpreted in two different ways:
18633 If the &%allow_filter%& option is set true, and the data begins with the text
18634 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, it is interpreted as a list of
18635 &'filtering'& instructions in the form of an Exim or Sieve filter file,
18636 respectively. Details of the syntax and semantics of filter files are described
18637 in a separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&; this
18638 document is intended for use by end users.
18640 Otherwise, the data must be a comma-separated list of redirection items, as
18641 described in the next section.
18644 When a message is redirected to a file (a &"mail folder"&), the file name given
18645 in a non-filter redirection list must always be an absolute path. A filter may
18646 generate a relative path &-- how this is handled depends on the transport's
18647 configuration. See section &<<SECTfildiropt>>& for a discussion of this issue
18648 for the &(appendfile)& transport.
18652 .section "Items in a non-filter redirection list" "SECTitenonfilred"
18653 .cindex "address redirection" "non-filter list items"
18654 When the redirection data is not an Exim or Sieve filter, for example, if it
18655 comes from a conventional alias or forward file, it consists of a list of
18656 addresses, file names, pipe commands, or certain special items (see section
18657 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& below). The special items can be individually enabled or
18658 disabled by means of options whose names begin with &%allow_%& or &%forbid_%&,
18659 depending on their default values. The items in the list are separated by
18660 commas or newlines.
18661 If a comma is required in an item, the entire item must be enclosed in double
18664 Lines starting with a # character are comments, and are ignored, and # may
18665 also appear following a comma, in which case everything between the # and the
18666 next newline character is ignored.
18668 If an item is entirely enclosed in double quotes, these are removed. Otherwise
18669 double quotes are retained because some forms of mail address require their use
18670 (but never to enclose the entire address). In the following description,
18671 &"item"& refers to what remains after any surrounding double quotes have been
18674 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
18675 &*Warning*&: If you use an Exim expansion to construct a redirection address,
18676 and the expansion contains a reference to &$local_part$&, you should make use
18677 of the &%quote_local_part%& expansion operator, in case the local part contains
18678 special characters. For example, to redirect all mail for the domain
18679 &'obsolete.example'&, retaining the existing local part, you could use this
18682 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@newdomain.example
18686 .section "Redirecting to a local mailbox" "SECTredlocmai"
18687 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
18688 .cindex "loop" "while routing, avoidance of"
18689 .cindex "address redirection" "to local mailbox"
18690 A redirection item may safely be the same as the address currently under
18691 consideration. This does not cause a routing loop, because a router is
18692 automatically skipped if any ancestor of the address that is being processed
18693 is the same as the current address and was processed by the current router.
18694 Such an address is therefore passed to the following routers, so it is handled
18695 as if there were no redirection. When making this loop-avoidance test, the
18696 complete local part, including any prefix or suffix, is used.
18698 .cindex "address redirection" "local part without domain"
18699 Specifying the same local part without a domain is a common usage in personal
18700 filter files when the user wants to have messages delivered to the local
18701 mailbox and also forwarded elsewhere. For example, the user whose login is
18702 &'cleo'& might have a &_.forward_& file containing this:
18704 cleo, cleopatra@egypt.example
18706 .cindex "backslash in alias file"
18707 .cindex "alias file" "backslash in"
18708 For compatibility with other MTAs, such unqualified local parts may be
18709 preceded by &"\"&, but this is not a requirement for loop prevention. However,
18710 it does make a difference if more than one domain is being handled
18713 If an item begins with &"\"& and the rest of the item parses as a valid RFC
18714 2822 address that does not include a domain, the item is qualified using the
18715 domain of the incoming address. In the absence of a leading &"\"&, unqualified
18716 addresses are qualified using the value in &%qualify_recipient%&, but you can
18717 force the incoming domain to be used by setting &%qualify_preserve_domain%&.
18719 Care must be taken if there are alias names for local users.
18720 Consider an MTA handling a single local domain where the system alias file
18725 Now suppose that Sam (whose login id is &'spqr'&) wants to save copies of
18726 messages in the local mailbox, and also forward copies elsewhere. He creates
18729 Sam.Reman, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
18731 With these settings, an incoming message addressed to &'Sam.Reman'& fails. The
18732 &(redirect)& router for system aliases does not process &'Sam.Reman'& the
18733 second time round, because it has previously routed it,
18734 and the following routers presumably cannot handle the alias. The forward file
18735 should really contain
18737 spqr, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
18739 but because this is such a common error, the &%check_ancestor%& option (see
18740 below) exists to provide a way to get round it. This is normally set on a
18741 &(redirect)& router that is handling users' &_.forward_& files.
18745 .section "Special items in redirection lists" "SECTspecitredli"
18746 In addition to addresses, the following types of item may appear in redirection
18747 lists (that is, in non-filter redirection data):
18750 .cindex "pipe" "in redirection list"
18751 .cindex "address redirection" "to pipe"
18752 An item is treated as a pipe command if it begins with &"|"& and does not parse
18753 as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. A transport for running the
18754 command must be specified by the &%pipe_transport%& option.
18755 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
18756 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
18758 Single or double quotes can be used for enclosing the individual arguments of
18759 the pipe command; no interpretation of escapes is done for single quotes. If
18760 the command contains a comma character, it is necessary to put the whole item
18761 in double quotes, for example:
18763 "|/some/command ready,steady,go"
18765 since items in redirection lists are terminated by commas. Do not, however,
18766 quote just the command. An item such as
18768 |"/some/command ready,steady,go"
18770 is interpreted as a pipe with a rather strange command name, and no arguments.
18773 Note that the above example assumes that the text comes from a lookup source
18774 of some sort, so that the quotes are part of the data. If composing a
18775 redirect router with a &%data%& option directly specifying this command, the
18776 quotes will be used by the configuration parser to define the extent of one
18777 string, but will not be passed down into the redirect router itself. There
18778 are two main approaches to get around this: escape quotes to be part of the
18779 data itself, or avoid using this mechanism and instead create a custom
18780 transport with the &%command%& option set and reference that transport from
18781 an &%accept%& router.
18785 .cindex "file" "in redirection list"
18786 .cindex "address redirection" "to file"
18787 An item is interpreted as a path name if it begins with &"/"& and does not
18788 parse as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. For example,
18790 /home/world/minbari
18792 is treated as a file name, but
18794 /s=molari/o=babylon/@x400gate.way
18796 is treated as an address. For a file name, a transport must be specified using
18797 the &%file_transport%& option. However, if the generated path name ends with a
18798 forward slash character, it is interpreted as a directory name rather than a
18799 file name, and &%directory_transport%& is used instead.
18801 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
18802 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
18804 .cindex "&_/dev/null_&"
18805 However, if a redirection item is the path &_/dev/null_&, delivery to it is
18806 bypassed at a high level, and the log entry shows &"**bypassed**"&
18807 instead of a transport name. In this case the user and group are not used.
18810 .cindex "included address list"
18811 .cindex "address redirection" "included external list"
18812 If an item is of the form
18814 :include:<path name>
18816 a list of further items is taken from the given file and included at that
18817 point. &*Note*&: Such a file can not be a filter file; it is just an
18818 out-of-line addition to the list. The items in the included list are separated
18819 by commas or newlines and are not subject to expansion. If this is the first
18820 item in an alias list in an &(lsearch)& file, a colon must be used to terminate
18821 the alias name. This example is incorrect:
18823 list1 :include:/opt/lists/list1
18825 It must be given as
18827 list1: :include:/opt/lists/list1
18830 .cindex "address redirection" "to black hole"
18831 Sometimes you want to throw away mail to a particular local part. Making the
18832 &%data%& option expand to an empty string does not work, because that causes
18833 the router to decline. Instead, the alias item
18834 .cindex "black hole"
18835 .cindex "abandoning mail"
18836 &':blackhole:'& can be used. It does what its name implies. No delivery is
18837 done, and no error message is generated. This has the same effect as specifing
18838 &_/dev/null_& as a destination, but it can be independently disabled.
18840 &*Warning*&: If &':blackhole:'& appears anywhere in a redirection list, no
18841 delivery is done for the original local part, even if other redirection items
18842 are present. If you are generating a multi-item list (for example, by reading a
18843 database) and need the ability to provide a no-op item, you must use
18847 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
18848 .cindex "delivery" "forcing deferral"
18849 .cindex "failing delivery" "forcing"
18850 .cindex "deferred delivery, forcing"
18851 .cindex "customizing" "failure message"
18852 An attempt to deliver a particular address can be deferred or forced to fail by
18853 redirection items of the form
18858 respectively. When a redirection list contains such an item, it applies
18859 to the entire redirection; any other items in the list are ignored. Any
18860 text following &':fail:'& or &':defer:'& is placed in the error text
18861 associated with the failure. For example, an alias file might contain:
18863 X.Employee: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
18865 In the case of an address that is being verified from an ACL or as the subject
18867 .cindex "VRFY" "error text, display of"
18868 VRFY command, the text is included in the SMTP error response by
18870 .cindex "EXPN" "error text, display of"
18871 The text is not included in the response to an EXPN command. In non-SMTP cases
18872 the text is included in the error message that Exim generates.
18874 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
18875 By default, Exim sends a 451 SMTP code for a &':defer:'&, and 550 for
18876 &':fail:'&. However, if the message starts with three digits followed by a
18877 space, optionally followed by an extended code of the form &'n.n.n'&, also
18878 followed by a space, and the very first digit is the same as the default error
18879 code, the code from the message is used instead. If the very first digit is
18880 incorrect, a panic error is logged, and the default code is used. You can
18881 suppress the use of the supplied code in a redirect router by setting the
18882 &%forbid_smtp_code%& option true. In this case, any SMTP code is quietly
18885 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
18886 In an ACL, an explicitly provided message overrides the default, but the
18887 default message is available in the variable &$acl_verify_message$& and can
18888 therefore be included in a custom message if this is desired.
18890 Normally the error text is the rest of the redirection list &-- a comma does
18891 not terminate it &-- but a newline does act as a terminator. Newlines are not
18892 normally present in alias expansions. In &(lsearch)& lookups they are removed
18893 as part of the continuation process, but they may exist in other kinds of
18894 lookup and in &':include:'& files.
18896 During routing for message delivery (as opposed to verification), a redirection
18897 containing &':fail:'& causes an immediate failure of the incoming address,
18898 whereas &':defer:'& causes the message to remain on the queue so that a
18899 subsequent delivery attempt can happen at a later time. If an address is
18900 deferred for too long, it will ultimately fail, because the normal retry
18904 .cindex "alias file" "exception to default"
18905 Sometimes it is useful to use a single-key search type with a default (see
18906 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&) to look up aliases. However, there may be a need
18907 for exceptions to the default. These can be handled by aliasing them to
18908 &':unknown:'&. This differs from &':fail:'& in that it causes the &(redirect)&
18909 router to decline, whereas &':fail:'& forces routing to fail. A lookup which
18910 results in an empty redirection list has the same effect.
18914 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECTdupaddr"
18915 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
18916 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
18917 .cindex "pipe" "duplicated"
18918 Exim removes duplicate addresses from the list to which it is delivering, so as
18919 to deliver just one copy to each address. This does not apply to deliveries
18920 routed to pipes by different immediate parent addresses, but an indirect
18921 aliasing scheme of the type
18923 pipe: |/some/command $local_part
18927 does not work with a message that is addressed to both local parts, because
18928 when the second is aliased to the intermediate local part &"pipe"& it gets
18929 discarded as being the same as a previously handled address. However, a scheme
18932 localpart1: |/some/command $local_part
18933 localpart2: |/some/command $local_part
18935 does result in two different pipe deliveries, because the immediate parents of
18936 the pipes are distinct.
18940 .section "Repeated redirection expansion" "SECID128"
18941 .cindex "repeated redirection expansion"
18942 .cindex "address redirection" "repeated for each delivery attempt"
18943 When a message cannot be delivered to all of its recipients immediately,
18944 leading to two or more delivery attempts, redirection expansion is carried out
18945 afresh each time for those addresses whose children were not all previously
18946 delivered. If redirection is being used as a mailing list, this can lead to new
18947 members of the list receiving copies of old messages. The &%one_time%& option
18948 can be used to avoid this.
18951 .section "Errors in redirection lists" "SECID129"
18952 .cindex "address redirection" "errors"
18953 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, a malformed address that causes a parsing
18954 error is skipped, and an entry is written to the main log. This may be useful
18955 for mailing lists that are automatically managed. Otherwise, if an error is
18956 detected while generating the list of new addresses, the original address is
18957 deferred. See also &%syntax_errors_to%&.
18961 .section "Private options for the redirect router" "SECID130"
18963 .cindex "options" "&(redirect)& router"
18964 The private options for the &(redirect)& router are as follows:
18967 .option allow_defer redirect boolean false
18968 Setting this option allows the use of &':defer:'& in non-filter redirection
18969 data, or the &%defer%& command in an Exim filter file.
18972 .option allow_fail redirect boolean false
18973 .cindex "failing delivery" "from filter"
18974 If this option is true, the &':fail:'& item can be used in a redirection list,
18975 and the &%fail%& command may be used in an Exim filter file.
18978 .option allow_filter redirect boolean false
18979 .cindex "filter" "enabling use of"
18980 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling use of"
18981 Setting this option allows Exim to interpret redirection data that starts with
18982 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"& as a set of filtering instructions. There
18983 are some features of Exim filter files that some administrators may wish to
18984 lock out; see the &%forbid_filter_%&&'xxx'& options below.
18986 It is also possible to lock out Exim filters or Sieve filters while allowing
18987 the other type; see &%forbid_exim_filter%& and &%forbid_sieve_filter%&.
18990 The filter is run using the uid and gid set by the generic &%user%& and
18991 &%group%& options. These take their defaults from the password data if
18992 &%check_local_user%& is set, so in the normal case of users' personal filter
18993 files, the filter is run as the relevant user. When &%allow_filter%& is set
18994 true, Exim insists that either &%check_local_user%& or &%user%& is set.
18998 .option allow_freeze redirect boolean false
18999 .cindex "freezing messages" "allowing in filter"
19000 Setting this option allows the use of the &%freeze%& command in an Exim filter.
19001 This command is more normally encountered in system filters, and is disabled by
19002 default for redirection filters because it isn't something you usually want to
19003 let ordinary users do.
19007 .option check_ancestor redirect boolean false
19008 This option is concerned with handling generated addresses that are the same
19009 as some address in the list of redirection ancestors of the current address.
19010 Although it is turned off by default in the code, it is set in the default
19011 configuration file for handling users' &_.forward_& files. It is recommended
19012 for this use of the &(redirect)& router.
19014 When &%check_ancestor%& is set, if a generated address (including the domain)
19015 is the same as any ancestor of the current address, it is replaced by a copy of
19016 the current address. This helps in the case where local part A is aliased to B,
19017 and B has a &_.forward_& file pointing back to A. For example, within a single
19018 domain, the local part &"Joe.Bloggs"& is aliased to &"jb"& and
19019 &_&~jb/.forward_& contains:
19021 \Joe.Bloggs, <other item(s)>
19023 Without the &%check_ancestor%& setting, either local part (&"jb"& or
19024 &"joe.bloggs"&) gets processed once by each router and so ends up as it was
19025 originally. If &"jb"& is the real mailbox name, mail to &"jb"& gets delivered
19026 (having been turned into &"joe.bloggs"& by the &_.forward_& file and back to
19027 &"jb"& by the alias), but mail to &"joe.bloggs"& fails. Setting
19028 &%check_ancestor%& on the &(redirect)& router that handles the &_.forward_&
19029 file prevents it from turning &"jb"& back into &"joe.bloggs"& when that was the
19030 original address. See also the &%repeat_use%& option below.
19033 .option check_group redirect boolean "see below"
19034 When the &%file%& option is used, the group owner of the file is checked only
19035 when this option is set. The permitted groups are those listed in the
19036 &%owngroups%& option, together with the user's default group if
19037 &%check_local_user%& is set. If the file has the wrong group, routing is
19038 deferred. The default setting for this option is true if &%check_local_user%&
19039 is set and the &%modemask%& option permits the group write bit, or if the
19040 &%owngroups%& option is set. Otherwise it is false, and no group check occurs.
19044 .option check_owner redirect boolean "see below"
19045 When the &%file%& option is used, the owner of the file is checked only when
19046 this option is set. If &%check_local_user%& is set, the local user is
19047 permitted; otherwise the owner must be one of those listed in the &%owners%&
19048 option. The default value for this option is true if &%check_local_user%& or
19049 &%owners%& is set. Otherwise the default is false, and no owner check occurs.
19052 .option data redirect string&!! unset
19053 This option is mutually exclusive with &%file%&. One or other of them must be
19054 set, but not both. The contents of &%data%& are expanded, and then used as the
19055 list of forwarding items, or as a set of filtering instructions. If the
19056 expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string or a string that
19057 has no effect (consists entirely of comments), the router declines.
19059 When filtering instructions are used, the string must begin with &"#Exim
19060 filter"&, and all comments in the string, including this initial one, must be
19061 terminated with newline characters. For example:
19063 data = #Exim filter\n\
19064 if $h_to: contains Exim then save $home/mail/exim endif
19066 If you are reading the data from a database where newlines cannot be included,
19067 you can use the &${sg}$& expansion item to turn the escape string of your
19068 choice into a newline.
19071 .option directory_transport redirect string&!! unset
19072 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a directory when a path name
19073 ending with a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
19074 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
19075 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport.
19078 .option file redirect string&!! unset
19079 This option specifies the name of a file that contains the redirection data. It
19080 is mutually exclusive with the &%data%& option. The string is expanded before
19081 use; if the expansion is forced to fail, the router declines. Other expansion
19082 failures cause delivery to be deferred. The result of a successful expansion
19083 must be an absolute path. The entire file is read and used as the redirection
19084 data. If the data is an empty string or a string that has no effect (consists
19085 entirely of comments), the router declines.
19087 .cindex "NFS" "checking for file existence"
19088 If the attempt to open the file fails with a &"does not exist"& error, Exim
19089 runs a check on the containing directory,
19090 unless &%ignore_enotdir%& is true (see below).
19091 If the directory does not appear to exist, delivery is deferred. This can
19092 happen when users' &_.forward_& files are in NFS-mounted directories, and there
19093 is a mount problem. If the containing directory does exist, but the file does
19094 not, the router declines.
19097 .option file_transport redirect string&!! unset
19098 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
19099 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a file when a path name not
19100 ending in a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
19101 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
19102 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport. When
19103 it is running, the file name is in &$address_file$&.
19106 .option filter_prepend_home redirect boolean true
19107 When this option is true, if a &(save)& command in an Exim filter specifies a
19108 relative path, and &$home$& is defined, it is automatically prepended to the
19109 relative path. If this option is set false, this action does not happen. The
19110 relative path is then passed to the transport unmodified.
19113 .option forbid_blackhole redirect boolean false
19114 If this option is true, the &':blackhole:'& item may not appear in a
19118 .option forbid_exim_filter redirect boolean false
19119 If this option is set true, only Sieve filters are permitted when
19120 &%allow_filter%& is true.
19125 .option forbid_file redirect boolean false
19126 .cindex "delivery" "to file; forbidding"
19127 .cindex "Sieve filter" "forbidding delivery to a file"
19128 .cindex "Sieve filter" "&""keep""& facility; disabling"
19129 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address that
19130 specifies delivery to a local file or directory, either from a filter or from a
19131 conventional forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is
19132 set. It applies to Sieve filters as well as to Exim filters, but if true, it
19133 locks out the Sieve's &"keep"& facility.
19136 .option forbid_filter_dlfunc redirect boolean false
19137 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
19138 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
19139 make use of the &%dlfunc%& expansion facility to run dynamically loaded
19142 .option forbid_filter_existstest redirect boolean false
19143 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
19144 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
19145 make use of the &%exists%& condition or the &%stat%& expansion item.
19147 .option forbid_filter_logwrite redirect boolean false
19148 If this option is true, use of the logging facility in Exim filters is not
19149 permitted. Logging is in any case available only if the filter is being run
19150 under some unprivileged uid (which is normally the case for ordinary users'
19151 &_.forward_& files).
19154 .option forbid_filter_lookup redirect boolean false
19155 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
19156 to make use of &%lookup%& items.
19159 .option forbid_filter_perl redirect boolean false
19160 This option has an effect only if Exim is built with embedded Perl support. If
19161 it is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed to make use
19162 of the embedded Perl support.
19165 .option forbid_filter_readfile redirect boolean false
19166 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
19167 to make use of &%readfile%& items.
19170 .option forbid_filter_readsocket redirect boolean false
19171 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
19172 to make use of &%readsocket%& items.
19175 .option forbid_filter_reply redirect boolean false
19176 If this option is true, this router may not generate an automatic reply
19177 message. Automatic replies can be generated only from Exim or Sieve filter
19178 files, not from traditional forward files. This option is forced to be true if
19179 &%one_time%& is set.
19182 .option forbid_filter_run redirect boolean false
19183 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
19184 to make use of &%run%& items.
19187 .option forbid_include redirect boolean false
19188 If this option is true, items of the form
19190 :include:<path name>
19192 are not permitted in non-filter redirection lists.
19195 .option forbid_pipe redirect boolean false
19196 .cindex "delivery" "to pipe; forbidding"
19197 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address which
19198 specifies delivery to a pipe, either from an Exim filter or from a conventional
19199 forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is set.
19202 .option forbid_sieve_filter redirect boolean false
19203 If this option is set true, only Exim filters are permitted when
19204 &%allow_filter%& is true.
19207 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
19208 .option forbid_smtp_code redirect boolean false
19209 If this option is set true, any SMTP error codes that are present at the start
19210 of messages specified for &`:defer:`& or &`:fail:`& are quietly ignored, and
19211 the default codes (451 and 550, respectively) are always used.
19216 .option hide_child_in_errmsg redirect boolean false
19217 .cindex "bounce message" "redirection details; suppressing"
19218 If this option is true, it prevents Exim from quoting a child address if it
19219 generates a bounce or delay message for it. Instead it says &"an address
19220 generated from <&'the top level address'&>"&. Of course, this applies only to
19221 bounces generated locally. If a message is forwarded to another host, &'its'&
19222 bounce may well quote the generated address.
19225 .option ignore_eacces redirect boolean false
19227 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
19228 EACCES error (permission denied), the &(redirect)& router behaves as if the
19229 file did not exist.
19232 .option ignore_enotdir redirect boolean false
19234 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
19235 ENOTDIR error (something on the path is not a directory), the &(redirect)&
19236 router behaves as if the file did not exist.
19238 Setting &%ignore_enotdir%& has another effect as well: When a &(redirect)&
19239 router that has the &%file%& option set discovers that the file does not exist
19240 (the ENOENT error), it tries to &[stat()]& the parent directory, as a check
19241 against unmounted NFS directories. If the parent can not be statted, delivery
19242 is deferred. However, it seems wrong to do this check when &%ignore_enotdir%&
19243 is set, because that option tells Exim to ignore &"something on the path is not
19244 a directory"& (the ENOTDIR error). This is a confusing area, because it seems
19245 that some operating systems give ENOENT where others give ENOTDIR.
19249 .option include_directory redirect string unset
19250 If this option is set, the path names of any &':include:'& items in a
19251 redirection list must start with this directory.
19254 .option modemask redirect "octal integer" 022
19255 This specifies mode bits which must not be set for a file specified by the
19256 &%file%& option. If any of the forbidden bits are set, delivery is deferred.
19259 .option one_time redirect boolean false
19260 .cindex "one-time aliasing/forwarding expansion"
19261 .cindex "alias file" "one-time expansion"
19262 .cindex "forward file" "one-time expansion"
19263 .cindex "mailing lists" "one-time expansion"
19264 .cindex "address redirection" "one-time expansion"
19265 Sometimes the fact that Exim re-evaluates aliases and reprocesses redirection
19266 files each time it tries to deliver a message causes a problem when one or more
19267 of the generated addresses fails be delivered at the first attempt. The problem
19268 is not one of duplicate delivery &-- Exim is clever enough to handle that &--
19269 but of what happens when the redirection list changes during the time that the
19270 message is on Exim's queue. This is particularly true in the case of mailing
19271 lists, where new subscribers might receive copies of messages that were posted
19272 before they subscribed.
19274 If &%one_time%& is set and any addresses generated by the router fail to
19275 deliver at the first attempt, the failing addresses are added to the message as
19276 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
19277 &"delivered"&. Thus, redirection does not happen again at the next delivery
19280 &*Warning 1*&: Any header line addition or removal that is specified by this
19281 router would be lost if delivery did not succeed at the first attempt. For this
19282 reason, the &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& generic options are not
19283 permitted when &%one_time%& is set.
19285 &*Warning 2*&: To ensure that the router generates only addresses (as opposed
19286 to pipe or file deliveries or auto-replies) &%forbid_file%&, &%forbid_pipe%&,
19287 and &%forbid_filter_reply%& are forced to be true when &%one_time%& is set.
19289 &*Warning 3*&: The &%unseen%& generic router option may not be set with
19292 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
19293 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
19294 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if
19295 &%all_parents%& log selector is set. It is expected that &%one_time%& will
19296 typically be used for mailing lists, where there is normally just one level of
19300 .option owners redirect "string list" unset
19301 .cindex "ownership" "alias file"
19302 .cindex "ownership" "forward file"
19303 .cindex "alias file" "ownership"
19304 .cindex "forward file" "ownership"
19305 This specifies a list of permitted owners for the file specified by &%file%&.
19306 This list is in addition to the local user when &%check_local_user%& is set.
19307 See &%check_owner%& above.
19310 .option owngroups redirect "string list" unset
19311 This specifies a list of permitted groups for the file specified by &%file%&.
19312 The list is in addition to the local user's primary group when
19313 &%check_local_user%& is set. See &%check_group%& above.
19316 .option pipe_transport redirect string&!! unset
19317 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
19318 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a pipe when a string
19319 starting with a vertical bar character is specified as a new &"address"&. The
19320 transport used is specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the
19321 name of a configured transport. This should normally be a &(pipe)& transport.
19322 When the transport is run, the pipe command is in &$address_pipe$&.
19325 .option qualify_domain redirect string&!! unset
19326 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
19327 If this option is set, and an unqualified address (one without a domain) is
19328 generated, and that address would normally be qualified by the global setting
19329 in &%qualify_recipient%&, it is instead qualified with the domain specified by
19330 expanding this string. If the expansion fails, the router declines. If you want
19331 to revert to the default, you can have the expansion generate
19332 &$qualify_recipient$&.
19334 This option applies to all unqualified addresses generated by Exim filters,
19335 but for traditional &_.forward_& files, it applies only to addresses that are
19336 not preceded by a backslash. Sieve filters cannot generate unqualified
19339 .option qualify_preserve_domain redirect boolean false
19340 .cindex "domain" "in redirection; preserving"
19341 .cindex "preserving domain in redirection"
19342 .cindex "address redirection" "domain; preserving"
19343 If this option is set, the router's local &%qualify_domain%& option must not be
19344 set (a configuration error occurs if it is). If an unqualified address (one
19345 without a domain) is generated, it is qualified with the domain of the parent
19346 address (the immediately preceding ancestor) instead of the global
19347 &%qualify_recipient%& value. In the case of a traditional &_.forward_& file,
19348 this applies whether or not the address is preceded by a backslash.
19351 .option repeat_use redirect boolean true
19352 If this option is set false, the router is skipped for a child address that has
19353 any ancestor that was routed by this router. This test happens before any of
19354 the other preconditions are tested. Exim's default anti-looping rules skip
19355 only when the ancestor is the same as the current address. See also
19356 &%check_ancestor%& above and the generic &%redirect_router%& option.
19359 .option reply_transport redirect string&!! unset
19360 A &(redirect)& router sets up an automatic reply when a &%mail%& or
19361 &%vacation%& command is used in a filter file. The transport used is specified
19362 by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a configured
19363 transport. This should normally be an &(autoreply)& transport. Other transports
19364 are unlikely to do anything sensible or useful.
19367 .option rewrite redirect boolean true
19368 .cindex "address redirection" "disabling rewriting"
19369 If this option is set false, addresses generated by the router are not
19370 subject to address rewriting. Otherwise, they are treated like new addresses
19371 and are rewritten according to the global rewriting rules.
19374 .option sieve_subaddress redirect string&!! unset
19375 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the
19376 :subaddress part of an address.
19378 .option sieve_useraddress redirect string&!! unset
19379 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the :user part
19380 of an address. However, if it is unset, the entire original local part
19381 (including any prefix or suffix) is used for :user.
19384 .option sieve_vacation_directory redirect string&!! unset
19385 .cindex "Sieve filter" "vacation directory"
19386 To enable the &"vacation"& extension for Sieve filters, you must set
19387 &%sieve_vacation_directory%& to the directory where vacation databases are held
19388 (do not put anything else in that directory), and ensure that the
19389 &%reply_transport%& option refers to an &(autoreply)& transport. Each user
19390 needs their own directory; Exim will create it if necessary.
19394 .option skip_syntax_errors redirect boolean false
19395 .cindex "forward file" "broken"
19396 .cindex "address redirection" "broken files"
19397 .cindex "alias file" "broken"
19398 .cindex "broken alias or forward files"
19399 .cindex "ignoring faulty addresses"
19400 .cindex "skipping faulty addresses"
19401 .cindex "error" "skipping bad syntax"
19402 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, syntactically malformed addresses in
19403 non-filter redirection data are skipped, and each failing address is logged. If
19404 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set, a message is sent to the address it defines,
19405 giving details of the failures. If &%syntax_errors_text%& is set, its contents
19406 are expanded and placed at the head of the error message generated by
19407 &%syntax_errors_to%&. Usually it is appropriate to set &%syntax_errors_to%& to
19408 be the same address as the generic &%errors_to%& option. The
19409 &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is often used when handling mailing lists.
19411 If all the addresses in a redirection list are skipped because of syntax
19412 errors, the router declines to handle the original address, and it is passed to
19413 the following routers.
19415 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set when an Exim filter is interpreted, any syntax
19416 error in the filter causes filtering to be abandoned without any action being
19417 taken. The incident is logged, and the router declines to handle the address,
19418 so it is passed to the following routers.
19420 .cindex "Sieve filter" "syntax errors in"
19421 Syntax errors in a Sieve filter file cause the &"keep"& action to occur. This
19422 action is specified by RFC 3028. The values of &%skip_syntax_errors%&,
19423 &%syntax_errors_to%&, and &%syntax_errors_text%& are not used.
19425 &%skip_syntax_errors%& can be used to specify that errors in users' forward
19426 lists or filter files should not prevent delivery. The &%syntax_errors_to%&
19427 option, used with an address that does not get redirected, can be used to
19428 notify users of these errors, by means of a router like this:
19434 file = $home/.forward
19435 file_transport = address_file
19436 pipe_transport = address_pipe
19437 reply_transport = address_reply
19440 syntax_errors_to = real-$local_part@$domain
19441 syntax_errors_text = \
19442 This is an automatically generated message. An error has\n\
19443 been found in your .forward file. Details of the error are\n\
19444 reported below. While this error persists, you will receive\n\
19445 a copy of this message for every message that is addressed\n\
19446 to you. If your .forward file is a filter file, or if it is\n\
19447 a non-filter file containing no valid forwarding addresses,\n\
19448 a copy of each incoming message will be put in your normal\n\
19449 mailbox. If a non-filter file contains at least one valid\n\
19450 forwarding address, forwarding to the valid addresses will\n\
19451 happen, and those will be the only deliveries that occur.
19453 You also need a router to ensure that local addresses that are prefixed by
19454 &`real-`& are recognized, but not forwarded or filtered. For example, you could
19455 put this immediately before the &(userforward)& router:
19460 local_part_prefix = real-
19461 transport = local_delivery
19463 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
19464 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
19466 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
19467 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
19471 .option syntax_errors_text redirect string&!! unset
19472 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
19475 .option syntax_errors_to redirect string unset
19476 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
19477 .ecindex IIDredrou1
19478 .ecindex IIDredrou2
19485 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19486 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19488 .chapter "Environment for running local transports" "CHAPenvironment" &&&
19489 "Environment for local transports"
19490 .scindex IIDenvlotra1 "local transports" "environment for"
19491 .scindex IIDenvlotra2 "environment for local transports"
19492 .scindex IIDenvlotra3 "transport" "local; environment for"
19493 Local transports handle deliveries to files and pipes. (The &(autoreply)&
19494 transport can be thought of as similar to a pipe.) Exim always runs transports
19495 in subprocesses, under specified uids and gids. Typical deliveries to local
19496 mailboxes run under the uid and gid of the local user.
19498 Exim also sets a specific current directory while running the transport; for
19499 some transports a home directory setting is also relevant. The &(pipe)&
19500 transport is the only one that sets up environment variables; see section
19501 &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for details.
19503 The values used for the uid, gid, and the directories may come from several
19504 different places. In many cases, the router that handles the address associates
19505 settings with that address as a result of its &%check_local_user%&, &%group%&,
19506 or &%user%& options. However, values may also be given in the transport's own
19507 configuration, and these override anything that comes from the router.
19511 .section "Concurrent deliveries" "SECID131"
19512 .cindex "concurrent deliveries"
19513 .cindex "simultaneous deliveries"
19514 If two different messages for the same local recipient arrive more or less
19515 simultaneously, the two delivery processes are likely to run concurrently. When
19516 the &(appendfile)& transport is used to write to a file, Exim applies locking
19517 rules to stop concurrent processes from writing to the same file at the same
19520 However, when you use a &(pipe)& transport, it is up to you to arrange any
19521 locking that is needed. Here is a silly example:
19525 command = /bin/sh -c 'cat >>/some/file'
19527 This is supposed to write the message at the end of the file. However, if two
19528 messages arrive at the same time, the file will be scrambled. You can use the
19529 &%exim_lock%& utility program (see section &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>&) to lock a
19530 file using the same algorithm that Exim itself uses.
19535 .section "Uids and gids" "SECTenvuidgid"
19536 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
19537 .cindex "transport" "local; uid and gid"
19538 All transports have the options &%group%& and &%user%&. If &%group%& is set, it
19539 overrides any group that the router set in the address, even if &%user%& is not
19540 set for the transport. This makes it possible, for example, to run local mail
19541 delivery under the uid of the recipient (set by the router), but in a special
19542 group (set by the transport). For example:
19545 # User/group are set by check_local_user in this router
19549 transport = group_delivery
19552 # This transport overrides the group
19554 driver = appendfile
19555 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
19558 If &%user%& is set for a transport, its value overrides what is set in the
19559 address by the router. If &%user%& is non-numeric and &%group%& is not set, the
19560 gid associated with the user is used. If &%user%& is numeric, &%group%& must be
19563 .oindex "&%initgroups%&"
19564 When the uid is taken from the transport's configuration, the &[initgroups()]&
19565 function is called for the groups associated with that uid if the
19566 &%initgroups%& option is set for the transport. When the uid is not specified
19567 by the transport, but is associated with the address by a router, the option
19568 for calling &[initgroups()]& is taken from the router configuration.
19570 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "uid for"
19571 The &(pipe)& transport contains the special option &%pipe_as_creator%&. If this
19572 is set and &%user%& is not set, the uid of the process that called Exim to
19573 receive the message is used, and if &%group%& is not set, the corresponding
19574 original gid is also used.
19576 This is the detailed preference order for obtaining a gid; the first of the
19577 following that is set is used:
19580 A &%group%& setting of the transport;
19582 A &%group%& setting of the router;
19584 A gid associated with a user setting of the router, either as a result of
19585 &%check_local_user%& or an explicit non-numeric &%user%& setting;
19587 The group associated with a non-numeric &%user%& setting of the transport;
19589 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's gid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set and
19590 the uid is the creator's uid;
19592 The Exim gid if the Exim uid is being used as a default.
19595 If, for example, the user is specified numerically on the router and there are
19596 no group settings, no gid is available. In this situation, an error occurs.
19597 This is different for the uid, for which there always is an ultimate default.
19598 The first of the following that is set is used:
19601 A &%user%& setting of the transport;
19603 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's uid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set;
19605 A &%user%& setting of the router;
19607 A &%check_local_user%& setting of the router;
19612 Of course, an error will still occur if the uid that is chosen is on the
19613 &%never_users%& list.
19619 .section "Current and home directories" "SECID132"
19620 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
19621 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
19622 .cindex "transport" "local; home directory for"
19623 .cindex "transport" "local; current directory for"
19624 Routers may set current and home directories for local transports by means of
19625 the &%transport_current_directory%& and &%transport_home_directory%& options.
19626 However, if the transport's &%current_directory%& or &%home_directory%& options
19627 are set, they override the router's values. In detail, the home directory
19628 for a local transport is taken from the first of these values that is set:
19631 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
19633 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
19635 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
19637 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
19640 The current directory is taken from the first of these values that is set:
19643 The &%current_directory%& option on the transport;
19645 The &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router.
19649 If neither the router nor the transport sets a current directory, Exim uses the
19650 value of the home directory, if it is set. Otherwise it sets the current
19651 directory to &_/_& before running a local transport.
19655 .section "Expansion variables derived from the address" "SECID133"
19656 .vindex "&$domain$&"
19657 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
19658 .vindex "&$original_domain$&"
19659 Normally a local delivery is handling a single address, and in that case the
19660 variables such as &$domain$& and &$local_part$& are set during local
19661 deliveries. However, in some circumstances more than one address may be handled
19662 at once (for example, while writing batch SMTP for onward transmission by some
19663 other means). In this case, the variables associated with the local part are
19664 never set, &$domain$& is set only if all the addresses have the same domain,
19665 and &$original_domain$& is never set.
19666 .ecindex IIDenvlotra1
19667 .ecindex IIDenvlotra2
19668 .ecindex IIDenvlotra3
19676 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19677 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19679 .chapter "Generic options for transports" "CHAPtransportgeneric"
19680 .scindex IIDgenoptra1 "generic options" "transport"
19681 .scindex IIDgenoptra2 "options" "generic; for transports"
19682 .scindex IIDgenoptra3 "transport" "generic options for"
19683 The following generic options apply to all transports:
19686 .option body_only transports boolean false
19687 .cindex "transport" "body only"
19688 .cindex "message" "transporting body only"
19689 .cindex "body of message" "transporting"
19690 If this option is set, the message's headers are not transported. It is
19691 mutually exclusive with &%headers_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)&
19692 or &(pipe)& transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and
19693 &%message_suffix%& should be checked, because this option does not
19694 automatically suppress them.
19697 .option current_directory transports string&!! unset
19698 .cindex "transport" "current directory for"
19699 This specifies the current directory that is to be set while running the
19700 transport, overriding any value that may have been set by the router.
19701 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
19702 logged, and delivery is deferred.
19705 .option disable_logging transports boolean false
19706 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any
19707 deliveries by the transport or for any
19708 transport errors. You should not set this option unless you really, really know
19709 what you are doing.
19712 .option debug_print transports string&!! unset
19713 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
19714 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
19715 option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging output when the
19717 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
19718 output, and Exim carries on processing.
19719 This facility is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
19720 so on when debugging driver configurations. For example, if a &%headers_add%&
19721 option is not working properly, &%debug_print%& could be used to output the
19722 variables it references. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with
19724 The variables &$transport_name$& and &$router_name$& contain the name of the
19725 transport and the router that called it.
19728 .option delivery_date_add transports boolean false
19729 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
19730 If this option is true, a &'Delivery-date:'& header is added to the message.
19731 This gives the actual time the delivery was made. As this is not a standard
19732 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%delivery_date_remove%&) which
19733 requests its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can
19734 safely be resent to other recipients.
19737 .option driver transports string unset
19738 This specifies which of the available transport drivers is to be used.
19739 There is no default, and this option must be set for every transport.
19742 .option envelope_to_add transports boolean false
19743 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
19744 If this option is true, an &'Envelope-to:'& header is added to the message.
19745 This gives the original address(es) in the incoming envelope that caused this
19746 delivery to happen. More than one address may be present if the transport is
19747 configured to handle several addresses at once, or if more than one original
19748 address was redirected to the same final address. As this is not a standard
19749 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%envelope_to_remove%&) which requests
19750 its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be
19751 resent to other recipients.
19754 .option group transports string&!! "Exim group"
19755 .cindex "transport" "group; specifying"
19756 This option specifies a gid for running the transport process, overriding any
19757 value that the router supplies, and also overriding any value associated with
19758 &%user%& (see below).
19761 .option headers_add transports string&!! unset
19762 .cindex "header lines" "adding in transport"
19763 .cindex "transport" "header lines; adding"
19764 This option specifies a string of text that is expanded and added to the header
19765 portion of a message as it is transported, as described in section
19766 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Additional header lines can also be specified by
19767 routers. If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
19768 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
19769 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
19771 Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
19772 for a transport; all listed headers are added.
19776 .option headers_only transports boolean false
19777 .cindex "transport" "header lines only"
19778 .cindex "message" "transporting headers only"
19779 .cindex "header lines" "transporting"
19780 If this option is set, the message's body is not transported. It is mutually
19781 exclusive with &%body_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)& or &(pipe)&
19782 transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& should be
19783 checked, since this option does not automatically suppress them.
19786 .option headers_remove transports string&!! unset
19787 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
19788 .cindex "transport" "header lines; removing"
19789 This option specifies a string that is expanded into a list of header names;
19790 these headers are omitted from the message as it is transported, as described
19791 in section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header removal can also be specified by
19792 routers. If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
19793 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
19794 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
19796 Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
19797 for a router; all listed headers are added.
19801 .option headers_rewrite transports string unset
19802 .cindex "transport" "header lines; rewriting"
19803 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
19804 This option allows addresses in header lines to be rewritten at transport time,
19805 that is, as the message is being copied to its destination. The contents of the
19806 option are a colon-separated list of rewriting rules. Each rule is in exactly
19807 the same form as one of the general rewriting rules that are applied when a
19808 message is received. These are described in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. For
19811 headers_rewrite = a@b c@d f : \
19814 changes &'a@b'& into &'c@d'& in &'From:'& header lines, and &'x@y'& into
19815 &'w@z'& in all address-bearing header lines. The rules are applied to the
19816 header lines just before they are written out at transport time, so they affect
19817 only those copies of the message that pass through the transport. However, only
19818 the message's original header lines, and any that were added by a system
19819 filter, are rewritten. If a router or transport adds header lines, they are not
19820 affected by this option. These rewriting rules are &'not'& applied to the
19821 envelope. You can change the return path using &%return_path%&, but you cannot
19822 change envelope recipients at this time.
19825 .option home_directory transports string&!! unset
19826 .cindex "transport" "home directory for"
19828 This option specifies a home directory setting for a local transport,
19829 overriding any value that may be set by the router. The home directory is
19830 placed in &$home$& while expanding the transport's private options. It is also
19831 used as the current directory if no current directory is set by the
19832 &%current_directory%& option on the transport or the
19833 &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router. If the expansion fails
19834 for any reason, including forced failure, an error is logged, and delivery is
19838 .option initgroups transports boolean false
19839 .cindex "additional groups"
19840 .cindex "groups" "additional"
19841 .cindex "transport" "group; additional"
19842 If this option is true and the uid for the delivery process is provided by the
19843 transport, the &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport
19844 to ensure that any additional groups associated with the uid are set up.
19847 .option message_size_limit transports string&!! 0
19848 .cindex "limit" "message size per transport"
19849 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
19850 .cindex "transport" "message size; limiting"
19851 This option controls the size of messages passed through the transport. It is
19852 expanded before use; the result of the expansion must be a sequence of decimal
19853 digits, optionally followed by K or M. If the expansion fails for any reason,
19854 including forced failure, or if the result is not of the required form,
19855 delivery is deferred. If the value is greater than zero and the size of a
19856 message exceeds this limit, the address is failed. If there is any chance that
19857 the resulting bounce message could be routed to the same transport, you should
19858 ensure that &%return_size_limit%& is less than the transport's
19859 &%message_size_limit%&, as otherwise the bounce message will fail to get
19864 .option rcpt_include_affixes transports boolean false
19865 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, including in envelope"
19866 .cindex "suffix for local part" "including in envelope"
19867 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
19868 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
19869 When this option is false (the default), and an address that has had any
19870 affixes (prefixes or suffixes) removed from the local part is delivered by any
19871 form of SMTP or LMTP, the affixes are not included. For example, if a router
19874 local_part_prefix = *-
19876 routes the address &'abc-xyz@some.domain'& to an SMTP transport, the envelope
19879 RCPT TO:<xyz@some.domain>
19881 This is also the case when an ACL-time callout is being used to verify a
19882 recipient address. However, if &%rcpt_include_affixes%& is set true, the
19883 whole local part is included in the RCPT command. This option applies to BSMTP
19884 deliveries by the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports as well as to the
19885 &(lmtp)& and &(smtp)& transports.
19888 .option retry_use_local_part transports boolean "see below"
19889 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
19890 When a delivery suffers a temporary failure, a retry record is created
19891 in Exim's hints database. For remote deliveries, the key for the retry record
19892 is based on the name and/or IP address of the failing remote host. For local
19893 deliveries, the key is normally the entire address, including both the local
19894 part and the domain. This is suitable for most common cases of local delivery
19895 temporary failure &-- for example, exceeding a mailbox quota should delay only
19896 deliveries to that mailbox, not to the whole domain.
19898 However, in some special cases you may want to treat a temporary local delivery
19899 as a failure associated with the domain, and not with a particular local part.
19900 (For example, if you are storing all mail for some domain in files.) You can do
19901 this by setting &%retry_use_local_part%& false.
19903 For all the local transports, its default value is true. For remote transports,
19904 the default value is false for tidiness, but changing the value has no effect
19905 on a remote transport in the current implementation.
19908 .option return_path transports string&!! unset
19909 .cindex "envelope sender"
19910 .cindex "transport" "return path; changing"
19911 .cindex "return path" "changing in transport"
19912 If this option is set, the string is expanded at transport time and replaces
19913 the existing return path (envelope sender) value in the copy of the message
19914 that is being delivered. An empty return path is permitted. This feature is
19915 designed for remote deliveries, where the value of this option is used in the
19916 SMTP MAIL command. If you set &%return_path%& for a local transport, the
19917 only effect is to change the address that is placed in the &'Return-path:'&
19918 header line, if one is added to the message (see the next option).
19920 &*Note:*& A changed return path is not logged unless you add
19921 &%return_path_on_delivery%& to the log selector.
19923 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
19924 The expansion can refer to the existing value via &$return_path$&. This is
19925 either the message's envelope sender, or an address set by the
19926 &%errors_to%& option on a router. If the expansion is forced to fail, no
19927 replacement occurs; if it fails for another reason, delivery is deferred. This
19928 option can be used to support VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) &-- see
19929 section &<<SECTverp>>&.
19931 &*Note*&: If a delivery error is detected locally, including the case when a
19932 remote server rejects a message at SMTP time, the bounce message is not sent to
19933 the value of this option. It is sent to the previously set errors address.
19934 This defaults to the incoming sender address, but can be changed by setting
19935 &%errors_to%& in a router.
19939 .option return_path_add transports boolean false
19940 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
19941 If this option is true, a &'Return-path:'& header is added to the message.
19942 Although the return path is normally available in the prefix line of BSD
19943 mailboxes, this is commonly not displayed by MUAs, and so the user does not
19944 have easy access to it.
19946 RFC 2821 states that the &'Return-path:'& header is added to a message &"when
19947 the delivery SMTP server makes the final delivery"&. This implies that this
19948 header should not be present in incoming messages. Exim has a configuration
19949 option, &%return_path_remove%&, which requests removal of this header from
19950 incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be resent to other
19954 .option shadow_condition transports string&!! unset
19955 See &%shadow_transport%& below.
19958 .option shadow_transport transports string unset
19959 .cindex "shadow transport"
19960 .cindex "transport" "shadow"
19961 A local transport may set the &%shadow_transport%& option to the name of
19962 another local transport. Shadow remote transports are not supported.
19964 Whenever a delivery to the main transport succeeds, and either
19965 &%shadow_condition%& is unset, or its expansion does not result in the empty
19966 string or one of the strings &"0"& or &"no"& or &"false"&, the message is also
19967 passed to the shadow transport, with the same delivery address or addresses. If
19968 expansion fails, no action is taken except that non-forced expansion failures
19969 cause a log line to be written.
19971 The result of the shadow transport is discarded and does not affect the
19972 subsequent processing of the message. Only a single level of shadowing is
19973 provided; the &%shadow_transport%& option is ignored on any transport when it
19974 is running as a shadow. Options concerned with output from pipes are also
19975 ignored. The log line for the successful delivery has an item added on the end,
19978 ST=<shadow transport name>
19980 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
19981 parentheses afterwards. Shadow transports can be used for a number of different
19982 purposes, including keeping more detailed log information than Exim normally
19983 provides, and implementing automatic acknowledgment policies based on message
19984 headers that some sites insist on.
19987 .option transport_filter transports string&!! unset
19988 .cindex "transport" "filter"
19989 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
19990 This option sets up a filtering (in the Unix shell sense) process for messages
19991 at transport time. It should not be confused with mail filtering as set up by
19992 individual users or via a system filter.
19994 When the message is about to be written out, the command specified by
19995 &%transport_filter%& is started up in a separate, parallel process, and
19996 the entire message, including the header lines, is passed to it on its standard
19997 input (this in fact is done from a third process, to avoid deadlock). The
19998 command must be specified as an absolute path.
20000 The lines of the message that are written to the transport filter are
20001 terminated by newline (&"\n"&). The message is passed to the filter before any
20002 SMTP-specific processing, such as turning &"\n"& into &"\r\n"& and escaping
20003 lines beginning with a dot, and also before any processing implied by the
20004 settings of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& in the &(appendfile)& or
20005 &(pipe)& transports.
20007 The standard error for the filter process is set to the same destination as its
20008 standard output; this is read and written to the message's ultimate
20009 destination. The process that writes the message to the filter, the
20010 filter itself, and the original process that reads the result and delivers it
20011 are all run in parallel, like a shell pipeline.
20013 The filter can perform any transformations it likes, but of course should take
20014 care not to break RFC 2822 syntax. Exim does not check the result, except to
20015 test for a final newline when SMTP is in use. All messages transmitted over
20016 SMTP must end with a newline, so Exim supplies one if it is missing.
20018 .cindex "content scanning" "per user"
20019 A transport filter can be used to provide content-scanning on a per-user basis
20020 at delivery time if the only required effect of the scan is to modify the
20021 message. For example, a content scan could insert a new header line containing
20022 a spam score. This could be interpreted by a filter in the user's MUA. It is
20023 not possible to discard a message at this stage.
20025 .cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
20026 A problem might arise if the filter increases the size of a message that is
20027 being sent down an SMTP connection. If the receiving SMTP server has indicated
20028 support for the SIZE parameter, Exim will have sent the size of the message
20029 at the start of the SMTP session. If what is actually sent is substantially
20030 more, the server might reject the message. This can be worked round by setting
20031 the &%size_addition%& option on the &(smtp)& transport, either to allow for
20032 additions to the message, or to disable the use of SIZE altogether.
20034 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
20035 The value of the &%transport_filter%& option is the command string for starting
20036 the filter, which is run directly from Exim, not under a shell. The string is
20037 parsed by Exim in the same way as a command string for the &(pipe)& transport:
20038 Exim breaks it up into arguments and then expands each argument separately (see
20039 section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&). Any kind of expansion failure causes delivery
20040 to be deferred. The special argument &$pipe_addresses$& is replaced by a number
20041 of arguments, one for each address that applies to this delivery. (This isn't
20042 an ideal name for this feature here, but as it was already implemented for the
20043 &(pipe)& transport, it seemed sensible not to change it.)
20046 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
20047 The expansion variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available when the
20048 transport is a remote one. They contain the name and IP address of the host to
20049 which the message is being sent. For example:
20051 transport_filter = /some/directory/transport-filter.pl \
20052 $host $host_address $sender_address $pipe_addresses
20055 Two problems arise if you want to use more complicated expansion items to
20056 generate transport filter commands, both of which due to the fact that the
20057 command is split up &'before'& expansion.
20059 If an expansion item contains white space, you must quote it, so that it is all
20060 part of the same command item. If the entire option setting is one such
20061 expansion item, you have to take care what kind of quoting you use. For
20064 transport_filter = '/bin/cmd${if eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}}'
20066 This runs the command &(/bin/cmd1)& if the host name is &'a.b.c'&, and
20067 &(/bin/cmd2)& otherwise. If double quotes had been used, they would have been
20068 stripped by Exim when it read the option's value. When the value is used, if
20069 the single quotes were missing, the line would be split into two items,
20070 &`/bin/cmd${if`& and &`eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}`&, and an error would occur when
20071 Exim tried to expand the first one.
20073 Except for the special case of &$pipe_addresses$& that is mentioned above, an
20074 expansion cannot generate multiple arguments, or a command name followed by
20075 arguments. Consider this example:
20077 transport_filter = ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
20078 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
20080 The result of the lookup is interpreted as the name of the command, even
20081 if it contains white space. The simplest way round this is to use a shell:
20083 transport_filter = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
20084 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
20088 The filter process is run under the same uid and gid as the normal delivery.
20089 For remote deliveries this is the Exim uid/gid by default. The command should
20090 normally yield a zero return code. Transport filters are not supposed to fail.
20091 A non-zero code is taken to mean that the transport filter encountered some
20092 serious problem. Delivery of the message is deferred; the message remains on
20093 the queue and is tried again later. It is not possible to cause a message to be
20094 bounced from a transport filter.
20096 If a transport filter is set on an autoreply transport, the original message is
20097 passed through the filter as it is being copied into the newly generated
20098 message, which happens if the &%return_message%& option is set.
20101 .option transport_filter_timeout transports time 5m
20102 .cindex "transport" "filter, timeout"
20103 When Exim is reading the output of a transport filter, it applies a timeout
20104 that can be set by this option. Exceeding the timeout is normally treated as a
20105 temporary delivery failure. However, if a transport filter is used with a
20106 &(pipe)& transport, a timeout in the transport filter is treated in the same
20107 way as a timeout in the pipe command itself. By default, a timeout is a hard
20108 error, but if the &(pipe)& transport's &%timeout_defer%& option is set true, it
20109 becomes a temporary error.
20112 .option user transports string&!! "Exim user"
20113 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
20114 .cindex "transport" "user, specifying"
20115 This option specifies the user under whose uid the delivery process is to be
20116 run, overriding any uid that may have been set by the router. If the user is
20117 given as a name, the uid is looked up from the password data, and the
20118 associated group is taken as the value of the gid to be used if the &%group%&
20121 For deliveries that use local transports, a user and group are normally
20122 specified explicitly or implicitly (for example, as a result of
20123 &%check_local_user%&) by the router or transport.
20125 .cindex "hints database" "access by remote transport"
20126 For remote transports, you should leave this option unset unless you really are
20127 sure you know what you are doing. When a remote transport is running, it needs
20128 to be able to access Exim's hints databases, because each host may have its own
20130 .ecindex IIDgenoptra1
20131 .ecindex IIDgenoptra2
20132 .ecindex IIDgenoptra3
20139 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20140 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20142 .chapter "Address batching in local transports" "CHAPbatching" &&&
20144 .cindex "transport" "local; address batching in"
20145 The only remote transport (&(smtp)&) is normally configured to handle more than
20146 one address at a time, so that when several addresses are routed to the same
20147 remote host, just one copy of the message is sent. Local transports, however,
20148 normally handle one address at a time. That is, a separate instance of the
20149 transport is run for each address that is routed to the transport. A separate
20150 copy of the message is delivered each time.
20152 .cindex "batched local delivery"
20153 .oindex "&%batch_max%&"
20154 .oindex "&%batch_id%&"
20155 In special cases, it may be desirable to handle several addresses at once in a
20156 local transport, for example:
20159 In an &(appendfile)& transport, when storing messages in files for later
20160 delivery by some other means, a single copy of the message with multiple
20161 recipients saves space.
20163 In an &(lmtp)& transport, when delivering over &"local SMTP"& to some process,
20164 a single copy saves time, and is the normal way LMTP is expected to work.
20166 In a &(pipe)& transport, when passing the message
20167 to a scanner program or
20168 to some other delivery mechanism such as UUCP, multiple recipients may be
20172 These three local transports all have the same options for controlling multiple
20173 (&"batched"&) deliveries, namely &%batch_max%& and &%batch_id%&. To save
20174 repeating the information for each transport, these options are described here.
20176 The &%batch_max%& option specifies the maximum number of addresses that can be
20177 delivered together in a single run of the transport. Its default value is one
20178 (no batching). When more than one address is routed to a transport that has a
20179 &%batch_max%& value greater than one, the addresses are delivered in a batch
20180 (that is, in a single run of the transport with multiple recipients), subject
20181 to certain conditions:
20184 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
20185 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$local_part$&, no
20186 batching is possible.
20188 .vindex "&$domain$&"
20189 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$domain$&, only
20190 addresses with the same domain are batched.
20192 .cindex "customizing" "batching condition"
20193 If &%batch_id%& is set, it is expanded for each address, and only those
20194 addresses with the same expanded value are batched. This allows you to specify
20195 customized batching conditions. Failure of the expansion for any reason,
20196 including forced failure, disables batching, but it does not stop the delivery
20199 Batched addresses must also have the same errors address (where to send
20200 delivery errors), the same header additions and removals, the same user and
20201 group for the transport, and if a host list is present, the first host must
20205 In the case of the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports, batching applies
20206 both when the file or pipe command is specified in the transport, and when it
20207 is specified by a &(redirect)& router, but all the batched addresses must of
20208 course be routed to the same file or pipe command. These two transports have an
20209 option called &%use_bsmtp%&, which causes them to deliver the message in
20210 &"batched SMTP"& format, with the envelope represented as SMTP commands. The
20211 &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& options are forced to the values
20214 escape_string = ".."
20216 when batched SMTP is in use. A full description of the batch SMTP mechanism is
20217 given in section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&. The &(lmtp)& transport does not have a
20218 &%use_bsmtp%& option, because it always delivers using the SMTP protocol.
20220 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
20221 If the generic &%envelope_to_add%& option is set for a batching transport, the
20222 &'Envelope-to:'& header that is added to the message contains all the addresses
20223 that are being processed together. If you are using a batching &(appendfile)&
20224 transport without &%use_bsmtp%&, the only way to preserve the recipient
20225 addresses is to set the &%envelope_to_add%& option.
20227 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "with multiple addresses"
20228 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
20229 If you are using a &(pipe)& transport without BSMTP, and setting the
20230 transport's &%command%& option, you can include &$pipe_addresses$& as part of
20231 the command. This is not a true variable; it is a bit of magic that causes each
20232 of the recipient addresses to be inserted into the command as a separate
20233 argument. This provides a way of accessing all the addresses that are being
20234 delivered in the batch. &*Note:*& This is not possible for pipe commands that
20235 are specified by a &(redirect)& router.
20240 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20241 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20243 .chapter "The appendfile transport" "CHAPappendfile"
20244 .scindex IIDapptra1 "&(appendfile)& transport"
20245 .scindex IIDapptra2 "transports" "&(appendfile)&"
20246 .cindex "directory creation"
20247 .cindex "creating directories"
20248 The &(appendfile)& transport delivers a message by appending it to an existing
20249 file, or by creating an entirely new file in a specified directory. Single
20250 files to which messages are appended can be in the traditional Unix mailbox
20251 format, or optionally in the MBX format supported by the Pine MUA and
20252 University of Washington IMAP daemon, &'inter alia'&. When each message is
20253 being delivered as a separate file, &"maildir"& format can optionally be used
20254 to give added protection against failures that happen part-way through the
20255 delivery. A third form of separate-file delivery known as &"mailstore"& is also
20256 supported. For all file formats, Exim attempts to create as many levels of
20257 directory as necessary, provided that &%create_directory%& is set.
20259 The code for the optional formats is not included in the Exim binary by
20260 default. It is necessary to set SUPPORT_MBX, SUPPORT_MAILDIR and/or
20261 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE in &_Local/Makefile_& to have the appropriate code
20264 .cindex "quota" "system"
20265 Exim recognizes system quota errors, and generates an appropriate message. Exim
20266 also supports its own quota control within the transport, for use when the
20267 system facility is unavailable or cannot be used for some reason.
20269 If there is an error while appending to a file (for example, quota exceeded or
20270 partition filled), Exim attempts to reset the file's length and last
20271 modification time back to what they were before. If there is an error while
20272 creating an entirely new file, the new file is removed.
20274 Before appending to a file, a number of security checks are made, and the
20275 file is locked. A detailed description is given below, after the list of
20278 The &(appendfile)& transport is most commonly used for local deliveries to
20279 users' mailboxes. However, it can also be used as a pseudo-remote transport for
20280 putting messages into files for remote delivery by some means other than Exim.
20281 &"Batch SMTP"& format is often used in this case (see the &%use_bsmtp%&
20286 .section "The file and directory options" "SECTfildiropt"
20287 The &%file%& option specifies a single file, to which the message is appended;
20288 the &%directory%& option specifies a directory, in which a new file containing
20289 the message is created. Only one of these two options can be set, and for
20290 normal deliveries to mailboxes, one of them &'must'& be set.
20292 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
20293 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
20294 However, &(appendfile)& is also used for delivering messages to files or
20295 directories whose names (or parts of names) are obtained from alias,
20296 forwarding, or filtering operations (for example, a &%save%& command in a
20297 user's Exim filter). When such a transport is running, &$local_part$& contains
20298 the local part that was aliased or forwarded, and &$address_file$& contains the
20299 name (or partial name) of the file or directory generated by the redirection
20300 operation. There are two cases:
20303 If neither &%file%& nor &%directory%& is set, the redirection operation
20304 must specify an absolute path (one that begins with &`/`&). This is the most
20305 common case when users with local accounts use filtering to sort mail into
20306 different folders. See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the
20307 default configuration. If the path ends with a slash, it is assumed to be the
20308 name of a directory. A delivery to a directory can also be forced by setting
20309 &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%&.
20311 If &%file%& or &%directory%& is set for a delivery from a redirection, it is
20312 used to determine the file or directory name for the delivery. Normally, the
20313 contents of &$address_file$& are used in some way in the string expansion.
20317 .cindex "Sieve filter" "configuring &(appendfile)&"
20318 .cindex "Sieve filter" "relative mailbox path handling"
20319 As an example of the second case, consider an environment where users do not
20320 have home directories. They may be permitted to use Exim filter commands of the
20325 or Sieve filter commands of the form:
20327 require "fileinto";
20328 fileinto "folder23";
20330 In this situation, the expansion of &%file%& or &%directory%& in the transport
20331 must transform the relative path into an appropriate absolute file name. In the
20332 case of Sieve filters, the name &'inbox'& must be handled. It is the name that
20333 is used as a result of a &"keep"& action in the filter. This example shows one
20334 way of handling this requirement:
20336 file = ${if eq{$address_file}{inbox} \
20337 {/var/mail/$local_part} \
20338 {${if eq{${substr_0_1:$address_file}}{/} \
20340 {$home/mail/$address_file} \
20344 With this setting of &%file%&, &'inbox'& refers to the standard mailbox
20345 location, absolute paths are used without change, and other folders are in the
20346 &_mail_& directory within the home directory.
20348 &*Note 1*&: While processing an Exim filter, a relative path such as
20349 &_folder23_& is turned into an absolute path if a home directory is known to
20350 the router. In particular, this is the case if &%check_local_user%& is set. If
20351 you want to prevent this happening at routing time, you can set
20352 &%router_home_directory%& empty. This forces the router to pass the relative
20353 path to the transport.
20355 &*Note 2*&: An absolute path in &$address_file$& is not treated specially;
20356 the &%file%& or &%directory%& option is still used if it is set.
20361 .section "Private options for appendfile" "SECID134"
20362 .cindex "options" "&(appendfile)& transport"
20366 .option allow_fifo appendfile boolean false
20367 .cindex "fifo (named pipe)"
20368 .cindex "named pipe (fifo)"
20369 .cindex "pipe" "named (fifo)"
20370 Setting this option permits delivery to named pipes (FIFOs) as well as to
20371 regular files. If no process is reading the named pipe at delivery time, the
20372 delivery is deferred.
20375 .option allow_symlink appendfile boolean false
20376 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
20377 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
20378 By default, &(appendfile)& will not deliver if the path name for the file is
20379 that of a symbolic link. Setting this option relaxes that constraint, but there
20380 are security issues involved in the use of symbolic links. Be sure you know
20381 what you are doing if you set this. Details of exactly what this option affects
20382 are included in the discussion which follows this list of options.
20385 .option batch_id appendfile string&!! unset
20386 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
20387 However, batching is automatically disabled for &(appendfile)& deliveries that
20388 happen as a result of forwarding or aliasing or other redirection directly to a
20392 .option batch_max appendfile integer 1
20393 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
20396 .option check_group appendfile boolean false
20397 When this option is set, the group owner of the file defined by the &%file%&
20398 option is checked to see that it is the same as the group under which the
20399 delivery process is running. The default setting is false because the default
20400 file mode is 0600, which means that the group is irrelevant.
20403 .option check_owner appendfile boolean true
20404 When this option is set, the owner of the file defined by the &%file%& option
20405 is checked to ensure that it is the same as the user under which the delivery
20406 process is running.
20409 .option check_string appendfile string "see below"
20410 .cindex "&""From""& line"
20411 As &(appendfile)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for
20412 matching &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are
20413 replaced by the contents of &%escape_string%&. The value of &%check_string%& is
20414 a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of any letters it
20415 contains is significant.
20417 If &%use_bsmtp%& is set the values of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%&
20418 are forced to &"."& and &".."& respectively, and any settings in the
20419 configuration are ignored. Otherwise, they default to &"From&~"& and
20420 &">From&~"& when the &%file%& option is set, and unset when any of the
20421 &%directory%&, &%maildir%&, or &%mailstore%& options are set.
20423 The default settings, along with &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, are
20424 suitable for traditional &"BSD"& mailboxes, where a line beginning with
20425 &"From&~"& indicates the start of a new message. All four options need changing
20426 if another format is used. For example, to deliver to mailboxes in MMDF format:
20427 .cindex "MMDF format mailbox"
20428 .cindex "mailbox" "MMDF format"
20430 check_string = "\1\1\1\1\n"
20431 escape_string = "\1\1\1\1 \n"
20432 message_prefix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
20433 message_suffix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
20435 .option create_directory appendfile boolean true
20436 .cindex "directory creation"
20437 When this option is true, Exim attempts to create any missing superior
20438 directories for the file that it is about to write. A created directory's mode
20439 is given by the &%directory_mode%& option.
20441 The group ownership of a newly created directory is highly dependent on the
20442 operating system (and possibly the file system) that is being used. For
20443 example, in Solaris, if the parent directory has the setgid bit set, its group
20444 is propagated to the child; if not, the currently set group is used. However,
20445 in FreeBSD, the parent's group is always used.
20449 .option create_file appendfile string anywhere
20450 This option constrains the location of files and directories that are created
20451 by this transport. It applies to files defined by the &%file%& option and
20452 directories defined by the &%directory%& option. In the case of maildir
20453 delivery, it applies to the top level directory, not the maildir directories
20456 The option must be set to one of the words &"anywhere"&, &"inhome"&, or
20457 &"belowhome"&. In the second and third cases, a home directory must have been
20458 set for the transport. This option is not useful when an explicit file name is
20459 given for normal mailbox deliveries. It is intended for the case when file
20460 names are generated from users' &_.forward_& files. These are usually handled
20461 by an &(appendfile)& transport called &%address_file%&. See also
20462 &%file_must_exist%&.
20465 .option directory appendfile string&!! unset
20466 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%file%& option, but one of &%file%&
20467 or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result of a
20468 redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&).
20470 When &%directory%& is set, the string is expanded, and the message is delivered
20471 into a new file or files in or below the given directory, instead of being
20472 appended to a single mailbox file. A number of different formats are provided
20473 (see &%maildir_format%& and &%mailstore_format%&), and see section
20474 &<<SECTopdir>>& for further details of this form of delivery.
20477 .option directory_file appendfile string&!! "see below"
20479 .vindex "&$inode$&"
20480 When &%directory%& is set, but neither &%maildir_format%& nor
20481 &%mailstore_format%& is set, &(appendfile)& delivers each message into a file
20482 whose name is obtained by expanding this string. The default value is:
20484 q${base62:$tod_epoch}-$inode
20486 This generates a unique name from the current time, in base 62 form, and the
20487 inode of the file. The variable &$inode$& is available only when expanding this
20491 .option directory_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0700
20492 If &(appendfile)& creates any directories as a result of the
20493 &%create_directory%& option, their mode is specified by this option.
20496 .option escape_string appendfile string "see description"
20497 See &%check_string%& above.
20500 .option file appendfile string&!! unset
20501 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%directory%& option, but one of
20502 &%file%& or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result
20503 of a redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&). The &%file%& option
20504 specifies a single file, to which the message is appended. One or more of
20505 &%use_fcntl_lock%&, &%use_flock_lock%&, or &%use_lockfile%& must be set with
20508 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
20509 .cindex "locking files"
20510 .cindex "lock files"
20511 If you are using more than one host to deliver over NFS into the same
20512 mailboxes, you should always use lock files.
20514 The string value is expanded for each delivery, and must yield an absolute
20515 path. The most common settings of this option are variations on one of these
20518 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
20519 file = /home/$local_part/inbox
20522 .cindex "&""sticky""& bit"
20523 In the first example, all deliveries are done into the same directory. If Exim
20524 is configured to use lock files (see &%use_lockfile%& below) it must be able to
20525 create a file in the directory, so the &"sticky"& bit must be turned on for
20526 deliveries to be possible, or alternatively the &%group%& option can be used to
20527 run the delivery under a group id which has write access to the directory.
20531 .option file_format appendfile string unset
20532 .cindex "file" "mailbox; checking existing format"
20533 This option requests the transport to check the format of an existing file
20534 before adding to it. The check consists of matching a specific string at the
20535 start of the file. The value of the option consists of an even number of
20536 colon-separated strings. The first of each pair is the test string, and the
20537 second is the name of a transport. If the transport associated with a matched
20538 string is not the current transport, control is passed over to the other
20539 transport. For example, suppose the standard &(local_delivery)& transport has
20542 file_format = "From : local_delivery :\
20543 \1\1\1\1\n : local_mmdf_delivery"
20545 Mailboxes that begin with &"From"& are still handled by this transport, but if
20546 a mailbox begins with four binary ones followed by a newline, control is passed
20547 to a transport called &%local_mmdf_delivery%&, which presumably is configured
20548 to do the delivery in MMDF format. If a mailbox does not exist or is empty, it
20549 is assumed to match the current transport. If the start of a mailbox doesn't
20550 match any string, or if the transport named for a given string is not defined,
20551 delivery is deferred.
20554 .option file_must_exist appendfile boolean false
20555 If this option is true, the file specified by the &%file%& option must exist.
20556 A temporary error occurs if it does not, causing delivery to be deferred.
20557 If this option is false, the file is created if it does not exist.
20560 .option lock_fcntl_timeout appendfile time 0s
20561 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
20562 .cindex "mailbox" "locking, blocking and non-blocking"
20563 .cindex "locking files"
20564 By default, the &(appendfile)& transport uses non-blocking calls to &[fcntl()]&
20565 when locking an open mailbox file. If the call fails, the delivery process
20566 sleeps for &%lock_interval%& and tries again, up to &%lock_retries%& times.
20567 Non-blocking calls are used so that the file is not kept open during the wait
20568 for the lock; the reason for this is to make it as safe as possible for
20569 deliveries over NFS in the case when processes might be accessing an NFS
20570 mailbox without using a lock file. This should not be done, but
20571 misunderstandings and hence misconfigurations are not unknown.
20573 On a busy system, however, the performance of a non-blocking lock approach is
20574 not as good as using a blocking lock with a timeout. In this case, the waiting
20575 is done inside the system call, and Exim's delivery process acquires the lock
20576 and can proceed as soon as the previous lock holder releases it.
20578 If &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set to a non-zero time, blocking locks, with that
20579 timeout, are used. There may still be some retrying: the maximum number of
20582 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / lock_fcntl_timeout
20584 rounded up to the next whole number. In other words, the total time during
20585 which &(appendfile)& is trying to get a lock is roughly the same, unless
20586 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set very large.
20588 You should consider setting this option if you are getting a lot of delayed
20589 local deliveries because of errors of the form
20591 failed to lock mailbox /some/file (fcntl)
20594 .option lock_flock_timeout appendfile time 0s
20595 This timeout applies to file locking when using &[flock()]& (see
20596 &%use_flock%&); the timeout operates in a similar manner to
20597 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%&.
20600 .option lock_interval appendfile time 3s
20601 This specifies the time to wait between attempts to lock the file. See below
20602 for details of locking.
20605 .option lock_retries appendfile integer 10
20606 This specifies the maximum number of attempts to lock the file. A value of zero
20607 is treated as 1. See below for details of locking.
20610 .option lockfile_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
20611 This specifies the mode of the created lock file, when a lock file is being
20612 used (see &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_mbx_lock%&).
20615 .option lockfile_timeout appendfile time 30m
20616 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
20617 When a lock file is being used (see &%use_lockfile%&), if a lock file already
20618 exists and is older than this value, it is assumed to have been left behind by
20619 accident, and Exim attempts to remove it.
20622 .option mailbox_filecount appendfile string&!! unset
20623 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
20624 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
20625 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
20626 number of files in the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally
20627 followed by K or M. This provides a way of obtaining this information from an
20628 external source that maintains the data.
20631 .option mailbox_size appendfile string&!! unset
20632 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
20633 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
20634 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
20635 size the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally followed by K or M.
20636 This provides a way of obtaining this information from an external source that
20637 maintains the data. This is likely to be helpful for maildir deliveries where
20638 it is computationally expensive to compute the size of a mailbox.
20642 .option maildir_format appendfile boolean false
20643 .cindex "maildir format" "specifying"
20644 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into a new
20645 file, in the &"maildir"& format that is used by other mail software. When the
20646 transport is activated directly from a &(redirect)& router (for example, the
20647 &(address_file)& transport in the default configuration), setting
20648 &%maildir_format%& causes the path received from the router to be treated as a
20649 directory, whether or not it ends with &`/`&. This option is available only if
20650 SUPPORT_MAILDIR is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section
20651 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
20654 .option maildir_quota_directory_regex appendfile string "See below"
20655 .cindex "maildir format" "quota; directories included in"
20656 .cindex "quota" "maildir; directories included in"
20657 This option is relevant only when &%maildir_use_size_file%& is set. It defines
20658 a regular expression for specifying directories, relative to the quota
20659 directory (see &%quota_directory%&), that should be included in the quota
20660 calculation. The default value is:
20662 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\..*)$
20664 This includes the &_cur_& and &_new_& directories, and any maildir++ folders
20665 (directories whose names begin with a dot). If you want to exclude the
20667 folder from the count (as some sites do), you need to change this setting to
20669 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\.(?!Trash).*)$
20671 This uses a negative lookahead in the regular expression to exclude the
20672 directory whose name is &_.Trash_&. When a directory is excluded from quota
20673 calculations, quota processing is bypassed for any messages that are delivered
20674 directly into that directory.
20677 .option maildir_retries appendfile integer 10
20678 This option specifies the number of times to retry when writing a file in
20679 &"maildir"& format. See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
20682 .option maildir_tag appendfile string&!! unset
20683 This option applies only to deliveries in maildir format, and is described in
20684 section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
20687 .option maildir_use_size_file appendfile&!! boolean false
20688 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
20689 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value.
20690 If it is true, it enables support for &_maildirsize_& files. Exim
20691 creates a &_maildirsize_& file in a maildir if one does not exist, taking the
20692 quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If &%quota%& is unset, the
20693 value is zero. See &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& above and section
20694 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
20696 .option maildirfolder_create_regex appendfile string unset
20697 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirfolder_& file"
20698 .cindex "&_maildirfolder_&, creating"
20699 The value of this option is a regular expression. If it is unset, it has no
20700 effect. Otherwise, before a maildir delivery takes place, the pattern is
20701 matched against the name of the maildir directory, that is, the directory
20702 containing the &_new_& and &_tmp_& subdirectories that will be used for the
20703 delivery. If there is a match, Exim checks for the existence of a file called
20704 &_maildirfolder_& in the directory, and creates it if it does not exist.
20705 See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& for more details.
20708 .option mailstore_format appendfile boolean false
20709 .cindex "mailstore format" "specifying"
20710 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into two
20711 new files in &"mailstore"& format. The option is available only if
20712 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section &<<SECTopdir>>&
20713 below for further details.
20716 .option mailstore_prefix appendfile string&!! unset
20717 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
20718 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
20721 .option mailstore_suffix appendfile string&!! unset
20722 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
20723 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
20726 .option mbx_format appendfile boolean false
20727 .cindex "locking files"
20728 .cindex "file" "locking"
20729 .cindex "file" "MBX format"
20730 .cindex "MBX format, specifying"
20731 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
20732 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. If &%mbx_format%& is set with the &%file%& option,
20733 the message is appended to the mailbox file in MBX format instead of
20734 traditional Unix format. This format is supported by Pine4 and its associated
20735 IMAP and POP daemons, by means of the &'c-client'& library that they all use.
20737 &*Note*&: The &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are not
20738 automatically changed by the use of &%mbx_format%&. They should normally be set
20739 empty when using MBX format, so this option almost always appears in this
20746 If none of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration,
20747 &%use_mbx_lock%& is assumed and the other locking options default to false. It
20748 is possible to specify the other kinds of locking with &%mbx_format%&, but
20749 &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_mbx_lock%& are mutually exclusive. MBX locking
20750 interworks with &'c-client'&, providing for shared access to the mailbox. It
20751 should not be used if any program that does not use this form of locking is
20752 going to access the mailbox, nor should it be used if the mailbox file is NFS
20753 mounted, because it works only when the mailbox is accessed from a single host.
20755 If you set &%use_fcntl_lock%& with an MBX-format mailbox, you cannot use
20756 the standard version of &'c-client'&, because as long as it has a mailbox open
20757 (this means for the whole of a Pine or IMAP session), Exim will not be able to
20758 append messages to it.
20761 .option message_prefix appendfile string&!! "see below"
20762 .cindex "&""From""& line"
20763 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
20764 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
20765 in which case it is:
20767 message_prefix = "From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}\
20768 {MAILER-DAEMON}} $tod_bsdinbox\n"
20770 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
20771 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
20773 .option message_suffix appendfile string&!! "see below"
20774 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
20775 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
20776 in which case it is a single newline character. The suffix can be suppressed by
20781 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
20782 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
20784 .option mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
20785 If the output file is created, it is given this mode. If it already exists and
20786 has wider permissions, they are reduced to this mode. If it has narrower
20787 permissions, an error occurs unless &%mode_fail_narrower%& is false. However,
20788 if the delivery is the result of a &%save%& command in a filter file specifying
20789 a particular mode, the mode of the output file is always forced to take that
20790 value, and this option is ignored.
20793 .option mode_fail_narrower appendfile boolean true
20794 This option applies in the case when an existing mailbox file has a narrower
20795 mode than that specified by the &%mode%& option. If &%mode_fail_narrower%& is
20796 true, the delivery is deferred (&"mailbox has the wrong mode"&); otherwise Exim
20797 continues with the delivery attempt, using the existing mode of the file.
20800 .option notify_comsat appendfile boolean false
20801 If this option is true, the &'comsat'& daemon is notified after every
20802 successful delivery to a user mailbox. This is the daemon that notifies logged
20803 on users about incoming mail.
20806 .option quota appendfile string&!! unset
20807 .cindex "quota" "imposed by Exim"
20808 This option imposes a limit on the size of the file to which Exim is appending,
20809 or to the total space used in the directory tree when the &%directory%& option
20810 is set. In the latter case, computation of the space used is expensive, because
20811 all the files in the directory (and any sub-directories) have to be
20812 individually inspected and their sizes summed. (See &%quota_size_regex%& and
20813 &%maildir_use_size_file%& for ways to avoid this in environments where users
20814 have no shell access to their mailboxes).
20816 As there is no interlock against two simultaneous deliveries into a
20817 multi-file mailbox, it is possible for the quota to be overrun in this case.
20818 For single-file mailboxes, of course, an interlock is a necessity.
20820 A file's size is taken as its &'used'& value. Because of blocking effects, this
20821 may be a lot less than the actual amount of disk space allocated to the file.
20822 If the sizes of a number of files are being added up, the rounding effect can
20823 become quite noticeable, especially on systems that have large block sizes.
20824 Nevertheless, it seems best to stick to the &'used'& figure, because this is
20825 the obvious value which users understand most easily.
20827 The value of the option is expanded, and must then be a numerical value
20828 (decimal point allowed), optionally followed by one of the letters K, M, or G,
20829 for kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes. If Exim is running on a system with
20830 large file support (Linux and FreeBSD have this), mailboxes larger than 2G can
20833 &*Note*&: A value of zero is interpreted as &"no quota"&.
20835 The expansion happens while Exim is running as root, before it changes uid for
20836 the delivery. This means that files that are inaccessible to the end user can
20837 be used to hold quota values that are looked up in the expansion. When delivery
20838 fails because this quota is exceeded, the handling of the error is as for
20839 system quota failures.
20841 By default, Exim's quota checking mimics system quotas, and restricts the
20842 mailbox to the specified maximum size, though the value is not accurate to the
20843 last byte, owing to separator lines and additional headers that may get added
20844 during message delivery. When a mailbox is nearly full, large messages may get
20845 refused even though small ones are accepted, because the size of the current
20846 message is added to the quota when the check is made. This behaviour can be
20847 changed by setting &%quota_is_inclusive%& false. When this is done, the check
20848 for exceeding the quota does not include the current message. Thus, deliveries
20849 continue until the quota has been exceeded; thereafter, no further messages are
20850 delivered. See also &%quota_warn_threshold%&.
20853 .option quota_directory appendfile string&!! unset
20854 This option defines the directory to check for quota purposes when delivering
20855 into individual files. The default is the delivery directory, or, if a file
20856 called &_maildirfolder_& exists in a maildir directory, the parent of the
20857 delivery directory.
20860 .option quota_filecount appendfile string&!! 0
20861 This option applies when the &%directory%& option is set. It limits the total
20862 number of files in the directory (compare the inode limit in system quotas). It
20863 can only be used if &%quota%& is also set. The value is expanded; an expansion
20864 failure causes delivery to be deferred. A value of zero is interpreted as
20868 .option quota_is_inclusive appendfile boolean true
20869 See &%quota%& above.
20872 .option quota_size_regex appendfile string unset
20873 This option applies when one of the delivery modes that writes a separate file
20874 for each message is being used. When Exim wants to find the size of one of
20875 these files in order to test the quota, it first checks &%quota_size_regex%&.
20876 If this is set to a regular expression that matches the file name, and it
20877 captures one string, that string is interpreted as a representation of the
20878 file's size. The value of &%quota_size_regex%& is not expanded.
20880 This feature is useful only when users have no shell access to their mailboxes
20881 &-- otherwise they could defeat the quota simply by renaming the files. This
20882 facility can be used with maildir deliveries, by setting &%maildir_tag%& to add
20883 the file length to the file name. For example:
20885 maildir_tag = ,S=$message_size
20886 quota_size_regex = ,S=(\d+)
20888 An alternative to &$message_size$& is &$message_linecount$&, which contains the
20889 number of lines in the message.
20891 The regular expression should not assume that the length is at the end of the
20892 file name (even though &%maildir_tag%& puts it there) because maildir MUAs
20893 sometimes add other information onto the ends of message file names.
20895 Section &<<SECID136>>& contains further information.
20898 .option quota_warn_message appendfile string&!! "see below"
20899 See below for the use of this option. If it is not set when
20900 &%quota_warn_threshold%& is set, it defaults to
20902 quota_warn_message = "\
20903 To: $local_part@$domain\n\
20904 Subject: Your mailbox\n\n\
20905 This message is automatically created \
20906 by mail delivery software.\n\n\
20907 The size of your mailbox has exceeded \
20908 a warning threshold that is\n\
20909 set by the system administrator.\n"
20913 .option quota_warn_threshold appendfile string&!! 0
20914 .cindex "quota" "warning threshold"
20915 .cindex "mailbox" "size warning"
20916 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
20917 This option is expanded in the same way as &%quota%& (see above). If the
20918 resulting value is greater than zero, and delivery of the message causes the
20919 size of the file or total space in the directory tree to cross the given
20920 threshold, a warning message is sent. If &%quota%& is also set, the threshold
20921 may be specified as a percentage of it by following the value with a percent
20925 quota_warn_threshold = 75%
20927 If &%quota%& is not set, a setting of &%quota_warn_threshold%& that ends with a
20928 percent sign is ignored.
20930 The warning message itself is specified by the &%quota_warn_message%& option,
20931 and it must start with a &'To:'& header line containing the recipient(s) of the
20932 warning message. These do not necessarily have to include the recipient(s) of
20933 the original message. A &'Subject:'& line should also normally be supplied. You
20934 can include any other header lines that you want. If you do not include a
20935 &'From:'& line, the default is:
20937 From: Mail Delivery System <mailer-daemon@$qualify_domain_sender>
20939 .oindex &%errors_reply_to%&
20940 If you supply a &'Reply-To:'& line, it overrides the global &%errors_reply_to%&
20943 The &%quota%& option does not have to be set in order to use this option; they
20944 are independent of one another except when the threshold is specified as a
20948 .option use_bsmtp appendfile boolean false
20949 .cindex "envelope sender"
20950 If this option is set true, &(appendfile)& writes messages in &"batch SMTP"&
20951 format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP commands. If
20952 you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages, you can do
20953 so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&
20954 for details of batch SMTP.
20957 .option use_crlf appendfile boolean false
20958 .cindex "carriage return"
20960 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
20961 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
20962 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the file is then an exact image
20963 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
20965 &*Note:*& The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options
20966 (which are used to supply the traditional &"From&~"& and blank line separators
20967 in Berkeley-style mailboxes) are written verbatim, so must contain their own
20968 carriage return characters if these are needed. In cases where these options
20969 have non-empty defaults, the values end with a single linefeed, so they must be
20970 changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
20973 .option use_fcntl_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
20974 This option controls the use of the &[fcntl()]& function to lock a file for
20975 exclusive use when a message is being appended. It is set by default unless
20976 &%use_flock_lock%& is set. Otherwise, it should be turned off only if you know
20977 that all your MUAs use lock file locking. When both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
20978 &%use_flock_lock%& are unset, &%use_lockfile%& must be set.
20981 .option use_flock_lock appendfile boolean false
20982 This option is provided to support the use of &[flock()]& for file locking, for
20983 the few situations where it is needed. Most modern operating systems support
20984 &[fcntl()]& and &[lockf()]& locking, and these two functions interwork with
20985 each other. Exim uses &[fcntl()]& locking by default.
20987 This option is required only if you are using an operating system where
20988 &[flock()]& is used by programs that access mailboxes (typically MUAs), and
20989 where &[flock()]& does not correctly interwork with &[fcntl()]&. You can use
20990 both &[fcntl()]& and &[flock()]& locking simultaneously if you want.
20992 .cindex "Solaris" "&[flock()]& support"
20993 Not all operating systems provide &[flock()]&. Some versions of Solaris do not
20994 have it (and some, I think, provide a not quite right version built on top of
20995 &[lockf()]&). If the OS does not have &[flock()]&, Exim will be built without
20996 the ability to use it, and any attempt to do so will cause a configuration
20999 &*Warning*&: &[flock()]& locks do not work on NFS files (unless &[flock()]&
21000 is just being mapped onto &[fcntl()]& by the OS).
21003 .option use_lockfile appendfile boolean "see below"
21004 If this option is turned off, Exim does not attempt to create a lock file when
21005 appending to a mailbox file. In this situation, the only locking is by
21006 &[fcntl()]&. You should only turn &%use_lockfile%& off if you are absolutely
21007 sure that every MUA that is ever going to look at your users' mailboxes uses
21008 &[fcntl()]& rather than a lock file, and even then only when you are not
21009 delivering over NFS from more than one host.
21011 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
21012 In order to append to an NFS file safely from more than one host, it is
21013 necessary to take out a lock &'before'& opening the file, and the lock file
21014 achieves this. Otherwise, even with &[fcntl()]& locking, there is a risk of
21017 The &%use_lockfile%& option is set by default unless &%use_mbx_lock%& is set.
21018 It is not possible to turn both &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_fcntl_lock%& off,
21019 except when &%mbx_format%& is set.
21022 .option use_mbx_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
21023 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
21024 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Setting the option specifies that special MBX
21025 locking rules be used. It is set by default if &%mbx_format%& is set and none
21026 of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration. The locking rules
21027 are the same as are used by the &'c-client'& library that underlies Pine and
21028 the IMAP4 and POP daemons that come with it (see the discussion below). The
21029 rules allow for shared access to the mailbox. However, this kind of locking
21030 does not work when the mailbox is NFS mounted.
21032 You can set &%use_mbx_lock%& with either (or both) of &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
21033 &%use_flock_lock%& to control what kind of locking is used in implementing the
21034 MBX locking rules. The default is to use &[fcntl()]& if &%use_mbx_lock%& is set
21035 without &%use_fcntl_lock%& or &%use_flock_lock%&.
21040 .section "Operational details for appending" "SECTopappend"
21041 .cindex "appending to a file"
21042 .cindex "file" "appending"
21043 Before appending to a file, the following preparations are made:
21046 If the name of the file is &_/dev/null_&, no action is taken, and a success
21050 .cindex "directory creation"
21051 If any directories on the file's path are missing, Exim creates them if the
21052 &%create_directory%& option is set. A created directory's mode is given by the
21053 &%directory_mode%& option.
21056 If &%file_format%& is set, the format of an existing file is checked. If this
21057 indicates that a different transport should be used, control is passed to that
21061 .cindex "file" "locking"
21062 .cindex "locking files"
21063 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
21064 If &%use_lockfile%& is set, a lock file is built in a way that will work
21065 reliably over NFS, as follows:
21068 Create a &"hitching post"& file whose name is that of the lock file with the
21069 current time, primary host name, and process id added, by opening for writing
21070 as a new file. If this fails with an access error, delivery is deferred.
21072 Close the hitching post file, and hard link it to the lock file name.
21074 If the call to &[link()]& succeeds, creation of the lock file has succeeded.
21075 Unlink the hitching post name.
21077 Otherwise, use &[stat()]& to get information about the hitching post file, and
21078 then unlink hitching post name. If the number of links is exactly two, creation
21079 of the lock file succeeded but something (for example, an NFS server crash and
21080 restart) caused this fact not to be communicated to the &[link()]& call.
21082 If creation of the lock file failed, wait for &%lock_interval%& and try again,
21083 up to &%lock_retries%& times. However, since any program that writes to a
21084 mailbox should complete its task very quickly, it is reasonable to time out old
21085 lock files that are normally the result of user agent and system crashes. If an
21086 existing lock file is older than &%lockfile_timeout%& Exim attempts to unlink
21087 it before trying again.
21091 A call is made to &[lstat()]& to discover whether the main file exists, and if
21092 so, what its characteristics are. If &[lstat()]& fails for any reason other
21093 than non-existence, delivery is deferred.
21096 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
21097 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
21098 If the file does exist and is a symbolic link, delivery is deferred, unless the
21099 &%allow_symlink%& option is set, in which case the ownership of the link is
21100 checked, and then &[stat()]& is called to find out about the real file, which
21101 is then subjected to the checks below. The check on the top-level link
21102 ownership prevents one user creating a link for another's mailbox in a sticky
21103 directory, though allowing symbolic links in this case is definitely not a good
21104 idea. If there is a chain of symbolic links, the intermediate ones are not
21108 If the file already exists but is not a regular file, or if the file's owner
21109 and group (if the group is being checked &-- see &%check_group%& above) are
21110 different from the user and group under which the delivery is running,
21111 delivery is deferred.
21114 If the file's permissions are more generous than specified, they are reduced.
21115 If they are insufficient, delivery is deferred, unless &%mode_fail_narrower%&
21116 is set false, in which case the delivery is tried using the existing
21120 The file's inode number is saved, and the file is then opened for appending.
21121 If this fails because the file has vanished, &(appendfile)& behaves as if it
21122 hadn't existed (see below). For any other failures, delivery is deferred.
21125 If the file is opened successfully, check that the inode number hasn't
21126 changed, that it is still a regular file, and that the owner and permissions
21127 have not changed. If anything is wrong, defer delivery and freeze the message.
21130 If the file did not exist originally, defer delivery if the &%file_must_exist%&
21131 option is set. Otherwise, check that the file is being created in a permitted
21132 directory if the &%create_file%& option is set (deferring on failure), and then
21133 open for writing as a new file, with the O_EXCL and O_CREAT options,
21134 except when dealing with a symbolic link (the &%allow_symlink%& option must be
21135 set). In this case, which can happen if the link points to a non-existent file,
21136 the file is opened for writing using O_CREAT but not O_EXCL, because
21137 that prevents link following.
21140 .cindex "loop" "while file testing"
21141 If opening fails because the file exists, obey the tests given above for
21142 existing files. However, to avoid looping in a situation where the file is
21143 being continuously created and destroyed, the exists/not-exists loop is broken
21144 after 10 repetitions, and the message is then frozen.
21147 If opening fails with any other error, defer delivery.
21150 .cindex "file" "locking"
21151 .cindex "locking files"
21152 Once the file is open, unless both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_flock_lock%&
21153 are false, it is locked using &[fcntl()]& or &[flock()]& or both. If
21154 &%use_mbx_lock%& is false, an exclusive lock is requested in each case.
21155 However, if &%use_mbx_lock%& is true, Exim takes out a shared lock on the open
21156 file, and an exclusive lock on the file whose name is
21158 /tmp/.<device-number>.<inode-number>
21160 using the device and inode numbers of the open mailbox file, in accordance with
21161 the MBX locking rules. This file is created with a mode that is specified by
21162 the &%lockfile_mode%& option.
21164 If Exim fails to lock the file, there are two possible courses of action,
21165 depending on the value of the locking timeout. This is obtained from
21166 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& or &%lock_flock_timeout%&, as appropriate.
21168 If the timeout value is zero, the file is closed, Exim waits for
21169 &%lock_interval%&, and then goes back and re-opens the file as above and tries
21170 to lock it again. This happens up to &%lock_retries%& times, after which the
21171 delivery is deferred.
21173 If the timeout has a value greater than zero, blocking calls to &[fcntl()]& or
21174 &[flock()]& are used (with the given timeout), so there has already been some
21175 waiting involved by the time locking fails. Nevertheless, Exim does not give up
21176 immediately. It retries up to
21178 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / <timeout>
21180 times (rounded up).
21183 At the end of delivery, Exim closes the file (which releases the &[fcntl()]&
21184 and/or &[flock()]& locks) and then deletes the lock file if one was created.
21187 .section "Operational details for delivery to a new file" "SECTopdir"
21188 .cindex "delivery" "to single file"
21189 .cindex "&""From""& line"
21190 When the &%directory%& option is set instead of &%file%&, each message is
21191 delivered into a newly-created file or set of files. When &(appendfile)& is
21192 activated directly from a &(redirect)& router, neither &%file%& nor
21193 &%directory%& is normally set, because the path for delivery is supplied by the
21194 router. (See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the default
21195 configuration.) In this case, delivery is to a new file if either the path name
21196 ends in &`/`&, or the &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%& option is set.
21198 No locking is required while writing the message to a new file, so the various
21199 locking options of the transport are ignored. The &"From"& line that by default
21200 separates messages in a single file is not normally needed, nor is the escaping
21201 of message lines that start with &"From"&, and there is no need to ensure a
21202 newline at the end of each message. Consequently, the default values for
21203 &%check_string%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& are all unset when
21204 any of &%directory%&, &%maildir_format%&, or &%mailstore_format%& is set.
21206 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting, it adds up the sizes of all
21207 the files in the delivery directory by default. However, you can specify a
21208 different directory by setting &%quota_directory%&. Also, for maildir
21209 deliveries (see below) the &_maildirfolder_& convention is honoured.
21212 .cindex "maildir format"
21213 .cindex "mailstore format"
21214 There are three different ways in which delivery to individual files can be
21215 done, controlled by the settings of the &%maildir_format%& and
21216 &%mailstore_format%& options. Note that code to support maildir or mailstore
21217 formats is not included in the binary unless SUPPORT_MAILDIR or
21218 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE, respectively, is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
21220 .cindex "directory creation"
21221 In all three cases an attempt is made to create the directory and any necessary
21222 sub-directories if they do not exist, provided that the &%create_directory%&
21223 option is set (the default). The location of a created directory can be
21224 constrained by setting &%create_file%&. A created directory's mode is given by
21225 the &%directory_mode%& option. If creation fails, or if the
21226 &%create_directory%& option is not set when creation is required, delivery is
21231 .section "Maildir delivery" "SECTmaildirdelivery"
21232 .cindex "maildir format" "description of"
21233 If the &%maildir_format%& option is true, Exim delivers each message by writing
21234 it to a file whose name is &_tmp/<stime>.H<mtime>P<pid>.<host>_& in the
21235 directory that is defined by the &%directory%& option (the &"delivery
21236 directory"&). If the delivery is successful, the file is renamed into the
21237 &_new_& subdirectory.
21239 In the file name, <&'stime'&> is the current time of day in seconds, and
21240 <&'mtime'&> is the microsecond fraction of the time. After a maildir delivery,
21241 Exim checks that the time-of-day clock has moved on by at least one microsecond
21242 before terminating the delivery process. This guarantees uniqueness for the
21243 file name. However, as a precaution, Exim calls &[stat()]& for the file before
21244 opening it. If any response other than ENOENT (does not exist) is given,
21245 Exim waits 2 seconds and tries again, up to &%maildir_retries%& times.
21247 Before Exim carries out a maildir delivery, it ensures that subdirectories
21248 called &_new_&, &_cur_&, and &_tmp_& exist in the delivery directory. If they
21249 do not exist, Exim tries to create them and any superior directories in their
21250 path, subject to the &%create_directory%& and &%create_file%& options. If the
21251 &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& option is set, and the regular expression it
21252 contains matches the delivery directory, Exim also ensures that a file called
21253 &_maildirfolder_& exists in the delivery directory. If a missing directory or
21254 &_maildirfolder_& file cannot be created, delivery is deferred.
21256 These features make it possible to use Exim to create all the necessary files
21257 and directories in a maildir mailbox, including subdirectories for maildir++
21258 folders. Consider this example:
21260 maildir_format = true
21261 directory = /var/mail/$local_part\
21262 ${if eq{$local_part_suffix}{}{}\
21263 {/.${substr_1:$local_part_suffix}}}
21264 maildirfolder_create_regex = /\.[^/]+$
21266 If &$local_part_suffix$& is empty (there was no suffix for the local part),
21267 delivery is into a toplevel maildir with a name like &_/var/mail/pimbo_& (for
21268 the user called &'pimbo'&). The pattern in &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& does
21269 not match this name, so Exim will not look for or create the file
21270 &_/var/mail/pimbo/maildirfolder_&, though it will create
21271 &_/var/mail/pimbo/{cur,new,tmp}_& if necessary.
21273 However, if &$local_part_suffix$& contains &`-eximusers`& (for example),
21274 delivery is into the maildir++ folder &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers_&, which
21275 does match &%maildirfolder_create_regex%&. In this case, Exim will create
21276 &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/maildirfolder_& as well as the three maildir
21277 directories &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/{cur,new,tmp}_&.
21279 &*Warning:*& Take care when setting &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& that it does
21280 not inadvertently match the toplevel maildir directory, because a
21281 &_maildirfolder_& file at top level would completely break quota calculations.
21283 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
21284 .cindex "maildir++"
21285 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting before a maildir delivery, and
21286 &%quota_directory%& is not set, it looks for a file called &_maildirfolder_& in
21287 the maildir directory (alongside &_new_&, &_cur_&, &_tmp_&). If this exists,
21288 Exim assumes the directory is a maildir++ folder directory, which is one level
21289 down from the user's top level mailbox directory. This causes it to start at
21290 the parent directory instead of the current directory when calculating the
21291 amount of space used.
21293 One problem with delivering into a multi-file mailbox is that it is
21294 computationally expensive to compute the size of the mailbox for quota
21295 checking. Various approaches have been taken to reduce the amount of work
21296 needed. The next two sections describe two of them. A third alternative is to
21297 use some external process for maintaining the size data, and use the expansion
21298 of the &%mailbox_size%& option as a way of importing it into Exim.
21303 .section "Using tags to record message sizes" "SECID135"
21304 If &%maildir_tag%& is set, the string is expanded for each delivery.
21305 When the maildir file is renamed into the &_new_& sub-directory, the
21306 tag is added to its name. However, if adding the tag takes the length of the
21307 name to the point where the test &[stat()]& call fails with ENAMETOOLONG,
21308 the tag is dropped and the maildir file is created with no tag.
21311 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
21312 Tags can be used to encode the size of files in their names; see
21313 &%quota_size_regex%& above for an example. The expansion of &%maildir_tag%&
21314 happens after the message has been written. The value of the &$message_size$&
21315 variable is set to the number of bytes actually written. If the expansion is
21316 forced to fail, the tag is ignored, but a non-forced failure causes delivery to
21317 be deferred. The expanded tag may contain any printing characters except &"/"&.
21318 Non-printing characters in the string are ignored; if the resulting string is
21319 empty, it is ignored. If it starts with an alphanumeric character, a leading
21320 colon is inserted; this default has not proven to be the path that popular
21321 maildir implementations have chosen (but changing it in Exim would break
21322 backwards compatibility).
21324 For one common implementation, you might set:
21326 maildir_tag = ,S=${message_size}
21328 but you should check the documentation of the other software to be sure.
21330 It is advisable to also set &%quota_size_regex%& when setting &%maildir_tag%&
21331 as this allows Exim to extract the size from your tag, instead of having to
21332 &[stat()]& each message file.
21335 .section "Using a maildirsize file" "SECID136"
21336 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
21337 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
21338 If &%maildir_use_size_file%& is true, Exim implements the maildir++ rules for
21339 storing quota and message size information in a file called &_maildirsize_&
21340 within the toplevel maildir directory. If this file does not exist, Exim
21341 creates it, setting the quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If
21342 the maildir directory itself does not exist, it is created before any attempt
21343 to write a &_maildirsize_& file.
21345 The &_maildirsize_& file is used to hold information about the sizes of
21346 messages in the maildir, thus speeding up quota calculations. The quota value
21347 in the file is just a cache; if the quota is changed in the transport, the new
21348 value overrides the cached value when the next message is delivered. The cache
21349 is maintained for the benefit of other programs that access the maildir and
21350 need to know the quota.
21352 If the &%quota%& option in the transport is unset or zero, the &_maildirsize_&
21353 file is maintained (with a zero quota setting), but no quota is imposed.
21355 A regular expression is available for controlling which directories in the
21356 maildir participate in quota calculations when a &_maildirsizefile_& is in use.
21357 See the description of the &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& option above for
21361 .section "Mailstore delivery" "SECID137"
21362 .cindex "mailstore format" "description of"
21363 If the &%mailstore_format%& option is true, each message is written as two
21364 files in the given directory. A unique base name is constructed from the
21365 message id and the current delivery process, and the files that are written use
21366 this base name plus the suffixes &_.env_& and &_.msg_&. The &_.env_& file
21367 contains the message's envelope, and the &_.msg_& file contains the message
21368 itself. The base name is placed in the variable &$mailstore_basename$&.
21370 During delivery, the envelope is first written to a file with the suffix
21371 &_.tmp_&. The &_.msg_& file is then written, and when it is complete, the
21372 &_.tmp_& file is renamed as the &_.env_& file. Programs that access messages in
21373 mailstore format should wait for the presence of both a &_.msg_& and a &_.env_&
21374 file before accessing either of them. An alternative approach is to wait for
21375 the absence of a &_.tmp_& file.
21377 The envelope file starts with any text defined by the &%mailstore_prefix%&
21378 option, expanded and terminated by a newline if there isn't one. Then follows
21379 the sender address on one line, then all the recipient addresses, one per line.
21380 There can be more than one recipient only if the &%batch_max%& option is set
21381 greater than one. Finally, &%mailstore_suffix%& is expanded and the result
21382 appended to the file, followed by a newline if it does not end with one.
21384 If expansion of &%mailstore_prefix%& or &%mailstore_suffix%& ends with a forced
21385 failure, it is ignored. Other expansion errors are treated as serious
21386 configuration errors, and delivery is deferred. The variable
21387 &$mailstore_basename$& is available for use during these expansions.
21390 .section "Non-special new file delivery" "SECID138"
21391 If neither &%maildir_format%& nor &%mailstore_format%& is set, a single new
21392 file is created directly in the named directory. For example, when delivering
21393 messages into files in batched SMTP format for later delivery to some host (see
21394 section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&), a setting such as
21396 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
21398 might be used. A message is written to a file with a temporary name, which is
21399 then renamed when the delivery is complete. The final name is obtained by
21400 expanding the contents of the &%directory_file%& option.
21401 .ecindex IIDapptra1
21402 .ecindex IIDapptra2
21409 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21410 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21412 .chapter "The autoreply transport" "CHID8"
21413 .scindex IIDauttra1 "transports" "&(autoreply)&"
21414 .scindex IIDauttra2 "&(autoreply)& transport"
21415 The &(autoreply)& transport is not a true transport in that it does not cause
21416 the message to be transmitted. Instead, it generates a new mail message as an
21417 automatic reply to the incoming message. &'References:'& and
21418 &'Auto-Submitted:'& header lines are included. These are constructed according
21419 to the rules in RFCs 2822 and 3834, respectively.
21421 If the router that passes the message to this transport does not have the
21422 &%unseen%& option set, the original message (for the current recipient) is not
21423 delivered anywhere. However, when the &%unseen%& option is set on the router
21424 that passes the message to this transport, routing of the address continues, so
21425 another router can set up a normal message delivery.
21428 The &(autoreply)& transport is usually run as the result of mail filtering, a
21429 &"vacation"& message being the standard example. However, it can also be run
21430 directly from a router like any other transport. To reduce the possibility of
21431 message cascades, messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport always have
21432 empty envelope sender addresses, like bounce messages.
21434 The parameters of the message to be sent can be specified in the configuration
21435 by options described below. However, these are used only when the address
21436 passed to the transport does not contain its own reply information. When the
21437 transport is run as a consequence of a
21439 or &%vacation%& command in a filter file, the parameters of the message are
21440 supplied by the filter, and passed with the address. The transport's options
21441 that define the message are then ignored (so they are not usually set in this
21442 case). The message is specified entirely by the filter or by the transport; it
21443 is never built from a mixture of options. However, the &%file_optional%&,
21444 &%mode%&, and &%return_message%& options apply in all cases.
21446 &(Autoreply)& is implemented as a local transport. When used as a result of a
21447 command in a user's filter file, &(autoreply)& normally runs under the uid and
21448 gid of the user, and with appropriate current and home directories (see chapter
21449 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&).
21451 There is a subtle difference between routing a message to a &(pipe)& transport
21452 that generates some text to be returned to the sender, and routing it to an
21453 &(autoreply)& transport. This difference is noticeable only if more than one
21454 address from the same message is so handled. In the case of a pipe, the
21455 separate outputs from the different addresses are gathered up and returned to
21456 the sender in a single message, whereas if &(autoreply)& is used, a separate
21457 message is generated for each address that is passed to it.
21459 Non-printing characters are not permitted in the header lines generated for the
21460 message that &(autoreply)& creates, with the exception of newlines that are
21461 immediately followed by white space. If any non-printing characters are found,
21462 the transport defers.
21463 Whether characters with the top bit set count as printing characters or not is
21464 controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& global option.
21466 If any of the generic options for manipulating headers (for example,
21467 &%headers_add%&) are set on an &(autoreply)& transport, they apply to the copy
21468 of the original message that is included in the generated message when
21469 &%return_message%& is set. They do not apply to the generated message itself.
21471 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
21472 If the &(autoreply)& transport receives return code 2 from Exim when it submits
21473 the message, indicating that there were no recipients, it does not treat this
21474 as an error. This means that autoreplies sent to &$sender_address$& when this
21475 is empty (because the incoming message is a bounce message) do not cause
21476 problems. They are just discarded.
21480 .section "Private options for autoreply" "SECID139"
21481 .cindex "options" "&(autoreply)& transport"
21483 .option bcc autoreply string&!! unset
21484 This specifies the addresses that are to receive &"blind carbon copies"& of the
21485 message when the message is specified by the transport.
21488 .option cc autoreply string&!! unset
21489 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'Cc:'& header
21490 when the message is specified by the transport.
21493 .option file autoreply string&!! unset
21494 The contents of the file are sent as the body of the message when the message
21495 is specified by the transport. If both &%file%& and &%text%& are set, the text
21496 string comes first.
21499 .option file_expand autoreply boolean false
21500 If this is set, the contents of the file named by the &%file%& option are
21501 subjected to string expansion as they are added to the message.
21504 .option file_optional autoreply boolean false
21505 If this option is true, no error is generated if the file named by the &%file%&
21506 option or passed with the address does not exist or cannot be read.
21509 .option from autoreply string&!! unset
21510 This specifies the contents of the &'From:'& header when the message is
21511 specified by the transport.
21514 .option headers autoreply string&!! unset
21515 This specifies additional RFC 2822 headers that are to be added to the message
21516 when the message is specified by the transport. Several can be given by using
21517 &"\n"& to separate them. There is no check on the format.
21520 .option log autoreply string&!! unset
21521 This option names a file in which a record of every message sent is logged when
21522 the message is specified by the transport.
21525 .option mode autoreply "octal integer" 0600
21526 If either the log file or the &"once"& file has to be created, this mode is
21530 .option never_mail autoreply "address list&!!" unset
21531 If any run of the transport creates a message with a recipient that matches any
21532 item in the list, that recipient is quietly discarded. If all recipients are
21533 discarded, no message is created. This applies both when the recipients are
21534 generated by a filter and when they are specified in the transport.
21538 .option once autoreply string&!! unset
21539 This option names a file or DBM database in which a record of each &'To:'&
21540 recipient is kept when the message is specified by the transport. &*Note*&:
21541 This does not apply to &'Cc:'& or &'Bcc:'& recipients.
21543 If &%once%& is unset, or is set to an empty string, the message is always sent.
21544 By default, if &%once%& is set to a non-empty file name, the message
21545 is not sent if a potential recipient is already listed in the database.
21546 However, if the &%once_repeat%& option specifies a time greater than zero, the
21547 message is sent if that much time has elapsed since a message was last sent to
21548 this recipient. A setting of zero time for &%once_repeat%& (the default)
21549 prevents a message from being sent a second time &-- in this case, zero means
21552 If &%once_file_size%& is zero, a DBM database is used to remember recipients,
21553 and it is allowed to grow as large as necessary. If &%once_file_size%& is set
21554 greater than zero, it changes the way Exim implements the &%once%& option.
21555 Instead of using a DBM file to record every recipient it sends to, it uses a
21556 regular file, whose size will never get larger than the given value.
21558 In the file, Exim keeps a linear list of recipient addresses and the times at
21559 which they were sent messages. If the file is full when a new address needs to
21560 be added, the oldest address is dropped. If &%once_repeat%& is not set, this
21561 means that a given recipient may receive multiple messages, but at
21562 unpredictable intervals that depend on the rate of turnover of addresses in the
21563 file. If &%once_repeat%& is set, it specifies a maximum time between repeats.
21566 .option once_file_size autoreply integer 0
21567 See &%once%& above.
21570 .option once_repeat autoreply time&!! 0s
21571 See &%once%& above.
21572 After expansion, the value of this option must be a valid time value.
21575 .option reply_to autoreply string&!! unset
21576 This specifies the contents of the &'Reply-To:'& header when the message is
21577 specified by the transport.
21580 .option return_message autoreply boolean false
21581 If this is set, a copy of the original message is returned with the new
21582 message, subject to the maximum size set in the &%return_size_limit%& global
21583 configuration option.
21586 .option subject autoreply string&!! unset
21587 This specifies the contents of the &'Subject:'& header when the message is
21588 specified by the transport. It is tempting to quote the original subject in
21589 automatic responses. For example:
21591 subject = Re: $h_subject:
21593 There is a danger in doing this, however. It may allow a third party to
21594 subscribe your users to an opt-in mailing list, provided that the list accepts
21595 bounce messages as subscription confirmations. Well-managed lists require a
21596 non-bounce message to confirm a subscription, so the danger is relatively
21601 .option text autoreply string&!! unset
21602 This specifies a single string to be used as the body of the message when the
21603 message is specified by the transport. If both &%text%& and &%file%& are set,
21604 the text comes first.
21607 .option to autoreply string&!! unset
21608 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'To:'& header
21609 when the message is specified by the transport.
21610 .ecindex IIDauttra1
21611 .ecindex IIDauttra2
21616 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21617 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21619 .chapter "The lmtp transport" "CHAPLMTP"
21620 .cindex "transports" "&(lmtp)&"
21621 .cindex "&(lmtp)& transport"
21622 .cindex "LMTP" "over a pipe"
21623 .cindex "LMTP" "over a socket"
21624 The &(lmtp)& transport runs the LMTP protocol (RFC 2033) over a pipe to a
21626 or by interacting with a Unix domain socket.
21627 This transport is something of a cross between the &(pipe)& and &(smtp)&
21628 transports. Exim also has support for using LMTP over TCP/IP; this is
21629 implemented as an option for the &(smtp)& transport. Because LMTP is expected
21630 to be of minority interest, the default build-time configure in &_src/EDITME_&
21631 has it commented out. You need to ensure that
21635 .cindex "options" "&(lmtp)& transport"
21636 is present in your &_Local/Makefile_& in order to have the &(lmtp)& transport
21637 included in the Exim binary. The private options of the &(lmtp)& transport are
21640 .option batch_id lmtp string&!! unset
21641 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
21644 .option batch_max lmtp integer 1
21645 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
21646 Most LMTP servers can handle several addresses at once, so it is normally a
21647 good idea to increase this value. See the description of local delivery
21648 batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
21651 .option command lmtp string&!! unset
21652 This option must be set if &%socket%& is not set. The string is a command which
21653 is run in a separate process. It is split up into a command name and list of
21654 arguments, each of which is separately expanded (so expansion cannot change the
21655 number of arguments). The command is run directly, not via a shell. The message
21656 is passed to the new process using the standard input and output to operate the
21659 .option ignore_quota lmtp boolean false
21660 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
21661 If this option is set true, the string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT
21662 commands, provided that the LMTP server has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA
21663 in its response to the LHLO command.
21665 .option socket lmtp string&!! unset
21666 This option must be set if &%command%& is not set. The result of expansion must
21667 be the name of a Unix domain socket. The transport connects to the socket and
21668 delivers the message to it using the LMTP protocol.
21671 .option timeout lmtp time 5m
21672 The transport is aborted if the created process or Unix domain socket does not
21673 respond to LMTP commands or message input within this timeout. Delivery
21674 is deferred, and will be tried again later. Here is an example of a typical
21679 command = /some/local/lmtp/delivery/program
21683 This delivers up to 20 addresses at a time, in a mixture of domains if
21684 necessary, running as the user &'exim'&.
21688 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21689 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21691 .chapter "The pipe transport" "CHAPpipetransport"
21692 .scindex IIDpiptra1 "transports" "&(pipe)&"
21693 .scindex IIDpiptra2 "&(pipe)& transport"
21694 The &(pipe)& transport is used to deliver messages via a pipe to a command
21695 running in another process. One example is the use of &(pipe)& as a
21696 pseudo-remote transport for passing messages to some other delivery mechanism
21697 (such as UUCP). Another is the use by individual users to automatically process
21698 their incoming messages. The &(pipe)& transport can be used in one of the
21702 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
21703 A router routes one address to a transport in the normal way, and the
21704 transport is configured as a &(pipe)& transport. In this case, &$local_part$&
21705 contains the local part of the address (as usual), and the command that is run
21706 is specified by the &%command%& option on the transport.
21708 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
21709 If the &%batch_max%& option is set greater than 1 (the default is 1), the
21710 transport can handle more than one address in a single run. In this case, when
21711 more than one address is routed to the transport, &$local_part$& is not set
21712 (because it is not unique). However, the pseudo-variable &$pipe_addresses$&
21713 (described in section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& below) contains all the addresses
21714 that are routed to the transport.
21716 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
21717 A router redirects an address directly to a pipe command (for example, from an
21718 alias or forward file). In this case, &$address_pipe$& contains the text of the
21719 pipe command, and the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored unless
21720 &%force_command%& is set. If only one address is being transported
21721 (&%batch_max%& is not greater than one, or only one address was redirected to
21722 this pipe command), &$local_part$& contains the local part that was redirected.
21726 The &(pipe)& transport is a non-interactive delivery method. Exim can also
21727 deliver messages over pipes using the LMTP interactive protocol. This is
21728 implemented by the &(lmtp)& transport.
21730 In the case when &(pipe)& is run as a consequence of an entry in a local user's
21731 &_.forward_& file, the command runs under the uid and gid of that user. In
21732 other cases, the uid and gid have to be specified explicitly, either on the
21733 transport or on the router that handles the address. Current and &"home"&
21734 directories are also controllable. See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for
21735 details of the local delivery environment and chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&
21736 for a discussion of local delivery batching.
21739 .section "Concurrent delivery" "SECID140"
21740 If two messages arrive at almost the same time, and both are routed to a pipe
21741 delivery, the two pipe transports may be run concurrently. You must ensure that
21742 any pipe commands you set up are robust against this happening. If the commands
21743 write to a file, the &%exim_lock%& utility might be of use.
21748 .section "Returned status and data" "SECID141"
21749 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "returned data"
21750 If the command exits with a non-zero return code, the delivery is deemed to
21751 have failed, unless either the &%ignore_status%& option is set (in which case
21752 the return code is treated as zero), or the return code is one of those listed
21753 in the &%temp_errors%& option, which are interpreted as meaning &"try again
21754 later"&. In this case, delivery is deferred. Details of a permanent failure are
21755 logged, but are not included in the bounce message, which merely contains
21756 &"local delivery failed"&.
21758 If the command exits on a signal and the &%freeze_signal%& option is set then
21759 the message will be frozen in the queue. If that option is not set, a bounce
21760 will be sent as normal.
21762 If the return code is greater than 128 and the command being run is a shell
21763 script, it normally means that the script was terminated by a signal whose
21764 value is the return code minus 128. The &%freeze_signal%& option does not
21765 apply in this case.
21767 If Exim is unable to run the command (that is, if &[execve()]& fails), the
21768 return code is set to 127. This is the value that a shell returns if it is
21769 asked to run a non-existent command. The wording for the log line suggests that
21770 a non-existent command may be the problem.
21772 The &%return_output%& option can affect the result of a pipe delivery. If it is
21773 set and the command produces any output on its standard output or standard
21774 error streams, the command is considered to have failed, even if it gave a zero
21775 return code or if &%ignore_status%& is set. The output from the command is
21776 included as part of the bounce message. The &%return_fail_output%& option is
21777 similar, except that output is returned only when the command exits with a
21778 failure return code, that is, a value other than zero or a code that matches
21783 .section "How the command is run" "SECThowcommandrun"
21784 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "path for command"
21785 The command line is (by default) broken down into a command name and arguments
21786 by the &(pipe)& transport itself. The &%allow_commands%& and
21787 &%restrict_to_path%& options can be used to restrict the commands that may be
21790 .cindex "quoting" "in pipe command"
21791 Unquoted arguments are delimited by white space. If an argument appears in
21792 double quotes, backslash is interpreted as an escape character in the usual
21793 way. If an argument appears in single quotes, no escaping is done.
21795 String expansion is applied to the command line except when it comes from a
21796 traditional &_.forward_& file (commands from a filter file are expanded). The
21797 expansion is applied to each argument in turn rather than to the whole line.
21798 For this reason, any string expansion item that contains white space must be
21799 quoted so as to be contained within a single argument. A setting such as
21801 command = /some/path ${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}
21803 will not work, because the expansion item gets split between several
21804 arguments. You have to write
21806 command = /some/path "${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}"
21808 to ensure that it is all in one argument. The expansion is done in this way,
21809 argument by argument, so that the number of arguments cannot be changed as a
21810 result of expansion, and quotes or backslashes in inserted variables do not
21811 interact with external quoting. However, this leads to problems if you want to
21812 generate multiple arguments (or the command name plus arguments) from a single
21813 expansion. In this situation, the simplest solution is to use a shell. For
21816 command = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/some/file}}
21819 .cindex "transport" "filter"
21820 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
21821 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
21822 Special handling takes place when an argument consists of precisely the text
21823 &`$pipe_addresses`&. This is not a general expansion variable; the only
21824 place this string is recognized is when it appears as an argument for a pipe or
21825 transport filter command. It causes each address that is being handled to be
21826 inserted in the argument list at that point &'as a separate argument'&. This
21827 avoids any problems with spaces or shell metacharacters, and is of use when a
21828 &(pipe)& transport is handling groups of addresses in a batch.
21830 If &%force_command%& is enabled on the transport, Special handling takes place
21831 for an argument that consists of precisely the text &`$address_pipe`&. It
21832 is handled similarly to &$pipe_addresses$& above. It is expanded and each
21833 argument is inserted in the argument list at that point
21834 &'as a separate argument'&. The &`$address_pipe`& item does not need to be
21835 the only item in the argument; in fact, if it were then &%force_command%&
21836 should behave as a no-op. Rather, it should be used to adjust the command
21837 run while preserving the argument vector separation.
21839 After splitting up into arguments and expansion, the resulting command is run
21840 in a subprocess directly from the transport, &'not'& under a shell. The
21841 message that is being delivered is supplied on the standard input, and the
21842 standard output and standard error are both connected to a single pipe that is
21843 read by Exim. The &%max_output%& option controls how much output the command
21844 may produce, and the &%return_output%& and &%return_fail_output%& options
21845 control what is done with it.
21847 Not running the command under a shell (by default) lessens the security risks
21848 in cases when a command from a user's filter file is built out of data that was
21849 taken from an incoming message. If a shell is required, it can of course be
21850 explicitly specified as the command to be run. However, there are circumstances
21851 where existing commands (for example, in &_.forward_& files) expect to be run
21852 under a shell and cannot easily be modified. To allow for these cases, there is
21853 an option called &%use_shell%&, which changes the way the &(pipe)& transport
21854 works. Instead of breaking up the command line as just described, it expands it
21855 as a single string and passes the result to &_/bin/sh_&. The
21856 &%restrict_to_path%& option and the &$pipe_addresses$& facility cannot be used
21857 with &%use_shell%&, and the whole mechanism is inherently less secure.
21861 .section "Environment variables" "SECTpipeenv"
21862 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
21863 .cindex "environment for pipe transport"
21864 The environment variables listed below are set up when the command is invoked.
21865 This list is a compromise for maximum compatibility with other MTAs. Note that
21866 the &%environment%& option can be used to add additional variables to this
21869 &`DOMAIN `& the domain of the address
21870 &`HOME `& the home directory, if set
21871 &`HOST `& the host name when called from a router (see below)
21872 &`LOCAL_PART `& see below
21873 &`LOCAL_PART_PREFIX `& see below
21874 &`LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX `& see below
21875 &`LOGNAME `& see below
21876 &`MESSAGE_ID `& Exim's local ID for the message
21877 &`PATH `& as specified by the &%path%& option below
21878 &`QUALIFY_DOMAIN `& the sender qualification domain
21879 &`RECIPIENT `& the complete recipient address
21880 &`SENDER `& the sender of the message (empty if a bounce)
21881 &`SHELL `& &`/bin/sh`&
21882 &`TZ `& the value of the &%timezone%& option, if set
21883 &`USER `& see below
21885 When a &(pipe)& transport is called directly from (for example) an &(accept)&
21886 router, LOCAL_PART is set to the local part of the address. When it is
21887 called as a result of a forward or alias expansion, LOCAL_PART is set to
21888 the local part of the address that was expanded. In both cases, any affixes are
21889 removed from the local part, and made available in LOCAL_PART_PREFIX and
21890 LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX, respectively. LOGNAME and USER are set to the
21891 same value as LOCAL_PART for compatibility with other MTAs.
21894 HOST is set only when a &(pipe)& transport is called from a router that
21895 associates hosts with an address, typically when using &(pipe)& as a
21896 pseudo-remote transport. HOST is set to the first host name specified by
21900 If the transport's generic &%home_directory%& option is set, its value is used
21901 for the HOME environment variable. Otherwise, a home directory may be set
21902 by the router's &%transport_home_directory%& option, which defaults to the
21903 user's home directory if &%check_local_user%& is set.
21906 .section "Private options for pipe" "SECID142"
21907 .cindex "options" "&(pipe)& transport"
21911 .option allow_commands pipe "string list&!!" unset
21912 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "permitted commands"
21913 The string is expanded, and is then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
21914 permitted commands. If &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only commands
21915 permitted are those in the &%allow_commands%& list. They need not be absolute
21916 paths; the &%path%& option is still used for relative paths. If
21917 &%restrict_to_path%& is set with &%allow_commands%&, the command must either be
21918 in the &%allow_commands%& list, or a name without any slashes that is found on
21919 the path. In other words, if neither &%allow_commands%& nor
21920 &%restrict_to_path%& is set, there is no restriction on the command, but
21921 otherwise only commands that are permitted by one or the other are allowed. For
21924 allow_commands = /usr/bin/vacation
21926 and &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only permitted command is
21927 &_/usr/bin/vacation_&. The &%allow_commands%& option may not be set if
21928 &%use_shell%& is set.
21931 .option batch_id pipe string&!! unset
21932 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
21935 .option batch_max pipe integer 1
21936 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
21937 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
21940 .option check_string pipe string unset
21941 As &(pipe)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for matching
21942 &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are replaced
21943 by the contents of &%escape_string%&, provided both are set. The value of
21944 &%check_string%& is a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of
21945 any letters it contains is significant. When &%use_bsmtp%& is set, the contents
21946 of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& are forced to values that implement
21947 the SMTP escaping protocol. Any settings made in the configuration file are
21951 .option command pipe string&!! unset
21952 This option need not be set when &(pipe)& is being used to deliver to pipes
21953 obtained directly from address redirections. In other cases, the option must be
21954 set, to provide a command to be run. It need not yield an absolute path (see
21955 the &%path%& option below). The command is split up into separate arguments by
21956 Exim, and each argument is separately expanded, as described in section
21957 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& above.
21960 .option environment pipe string&!! unset
21961 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
21962 .cindex "environment for &(pipe)& transport"
21963 This option is used to add additional variables to the environment in which the
21964 command runs (see section &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for the default list). Its value is
21965 a string which is expanded, and then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
21966 environment settings of the form <&'name'&>=<&'value'&>.
21969 .option escape_string pipe string unset
21970 See &%check_string%& above.
21973 .option freeze_exec_fail pipe boolean false
21974 .cindex "exec failure"
21975 .cindex "failure of exec"
21976 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "failure of exec"
21977 Failure to exec the command in a pipe transport is by default treated like
21978 any other failure while running the command. However, if &%freeze_exec_fail%&
21979 is set, failure to exec is treated specially, and causes the message to be
21980 frozen, whatever the setting of &%ignore_status%&.
21983 .option freeze_signal pipe boolean false
21984 .cindex "signal exit"
21985 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "signal exit"
21986 Normally if the process run by a command in a pipe transport exits on a signal,
21987 a bounce message is sent. If &%freeze_signal%& is set, the message will be
21988 frozen in Exim's queue instead.
21991 .option force_command pipe boolean false
21992 .cindex "force command"
21993 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "force command"
21994 Normally when a router redirects an address directly to a pipe command
21995 the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored. If &%force_command%&
21996 is set, the &%command%& option will used. This is especially
21997 useful for forcing a wrapper or additional argument to be added to the
21998 command. For example:
22000 command = /usr/bin/remote_exec myhost -- $address_pipe
22004 Note that &$address_pipe$& is handled specially in &%command%& when
22005 &%force_command%& is set, expanding out to the original argument vector as
22006 separate items, similarly to a Unix shell &`"$@"`& construct.
22008 .option ignore_status pipe boolean false
22009 If this option is true, the status returned by the subprocess that is set up to
22010 run the command is ignored, and Exim behaves as if zero had been returned.
22011 Otherwise, a non-zero status or termination by signal causes an error return
22012 from the transport unless the status value is one of those listed in
22013 &%temp_errors%&; these cause the delivery to be deferred and tried again later.
22015 &*Note*&: This option does not apply to timeouts, which do not return a status.
22016 See the &%timeout_defer%& option for how timeouts are handled.
22018 .option log_defer_output pipe boolean false
22019 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "logging output"
22020 If this option is set, and the status returned by the command is
22021 one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, delivery was deferred),
22022 and any output was produced, the first line of it is written to the main log.
22025 .option log_fail_output pipe boolean false
22026 If this option is set, and the command returns any output, and also ends with a
22027 return code that is neither zero nor one of the return codes listed in
22028 &%temp_errors%& (that is, the delivery failed), the first line of output is
22029 written to the main log. This option and &%log_output%& are mutually exclusive.
22030 Only one of them may be set.
22034 .option log_output pipe boolean false
22035 If this option is set and the command returns any output, the first line of
22036 output is written to the main log, whatever the return code. This option and
22037 &%log_fail_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
22041 .option max_output pipe integer 20K
22042 This specifies the maximum amount of output that the command may produce on its
22043 standard output and standard error file combined. If the limit is exceeded, the
22044 process running the command is killed. This is intended as a safety measure to
22045 catch runaway processes. The limit is applied independently of the settings of
22046 the options that control what is done with such output (for example,
22047 &%return_output%&). Because of buffering effects, the amount of output may
22048 exceed the limit by a small amount before Exim notices.
22051 .option message_prefix pipe string&!! "see below"
22052 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
22053 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is
22056 From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}{MAILER-DAEMON}}\
22060 .cindex "&%tmail%&"
22061 .cindex "&""From""& line"
22062 This is required by the commonly used &_/usr/bin/vacation_& program.
22063 However, it must &'not'& be present if delivery is to the Cyrus IMAP server,
22064 or to the &%tmail%& local delivery agent. The prefix can be suppressed by
22069 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
22070 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
22073 .option message_suffix pipe string&!! "see below"
22074 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
22075 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is a single newline.
22076 The suffix can be suppressed by setting
22080 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
22081 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
22084 .option path pipe string "see below"
22085 This option specifies the string that is set up in the PATH environment
22086 variable of the subprocess. The default is:
22090 If the &%command%& option does not yield an absolute path name, the command is
22091 sought in the PATH directories, in the usual way. &*Warning*&: This does not
22092 apply to a command specified as a transport filter.
22095 .option permit_coredump pipe boolean false
22096 Normally Exim inhibits core-dumps during delivery. If you have a need to get
22097 a core-dump of a pipe command, enable this command. This enables core-dumps
22098 during delivery and affects both the Exim binary and the pipe command run.
22099 It is recommended that this option remain off unless and until you have a need
22100 for it and that this only be enabled when needed, as the risk of excessive
22101 resource consumption can be quite high. Note also that Exim is typically
22102 installed as a setuid binary and most operating systems will inhibit coredumps
22103 of these by default, so further OS-specific action may be required.
22106 .option pipe_as_creator pipe boolean false
22107 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
22108 If the generic &%user%& option is not set and this option is true, the delivery
22109 process is run under the uid that was in force when Exim was originally called
22110 to accept the message. If the group id is not otherwise set (via the generic
22111 &%group%& option), the gid that was in force when Exim was originally called to
22112 accept the message is used.
22115 .option restrict_to_path pipe boolean false
22116 When this option is set, any command name not listed in &%allow_commands%& must
22117 contain no slashes. The command is searched for only in the directories listed
22118 in the &%path%& option. This option is intended for use in the case when a pipe
22119 command has been generated from a user's &_.forward_& file. This is usually
22120 handled by a &(pipe)& transport called &%address_pipe%&.
22123 .option return_fail_output pipe boolean false
22124 If this option is true, and the command produced any output and ended with a
22125 return code other than zero or one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that
22126 is, the delivery failed), the output is returned in the bounce message.
22127 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is itself a bounce
22128 message), output from the command is discarded. This option and
22129 &%return_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
22133 .option return_output pipe boolean false
22134 If this option is true, and the command produced any output, the delivery is
22135 deemed to have failed whatever the return code from the command, and the output
22136 is returned in the bounce message. Otherwise, the output is just discarded.
22137 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is a bounce message),
22138 output from the command is always discarded, whatever the setting of this
22139 option. This option and &%return_fail_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one
22140 of them may be set.
22144 .option temp_errors pipe "string list" "see below"
22145 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "temporary failure"
22146 This option contains either a colon-separated list of numbers, or a single
22147 asterisk. If &%ignore_status%& is false
22148 and &%return_output%& is not set,
22149 and the command exits with a non-zero return code, the failure is treated as
22150 temporary and the delivery is deferred if the return code matches one of the
22151 numbers, or if the setting is a single asterisk. Otherwise, non-zero return
22152 codes are treated as permanent errors. The default setting contains the codes
22153 defined by EX_TEMPFAIL and EX_CANTCREAT in &_sysexits.h_&. If Exim is
22154 compiled on a system that does not define these macros, it assumes values of 75
22155 and 73, respectively.
22158 .option timeout pipe time 1h
22159 If the command fails to complete within this time, it is killed. This normally
22160 causes the delivery to fail (but see &%timeout_defer%&). A zero time interval
22161 specifies no timeout. In order to ensure that any subprocesses created by the
22162 command are also killed, Exim makes the initial process a process group leader,
22163 and kills the whole process group on a timeout. However, this can be defeated
22164 if one of the processes starts a new process group.
22166 .option timeout_defer pipe boolean false
22167 A timeout in a &(pipe)& transport, either in the command that the transport
22168 runs, or in a transport filter that is associated with it, is by default
22169 treated as a hard error, and the delivery fails. However, if &%timeout_defer%&
22170 is set true, both kinds of timeout become temporary errors, causing the
22171 delivery to be deferred.
22173 .option umask pipe "octal integer" 022
22174 This specifies the umask setting for the subprocess that runs the command.
22177 .option use_bsmtp pipe boolean false
22178 .cindex "envelope sender"
22179 If this option is set true, the &(pipe)& transport writes messages in &"batch
22180 SMTP"& format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP
22181 commands. If you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages,
22182 you can do so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section
22183 &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>& for details of batch SMTP.
22185 .option use_classresources pipe boolean false
22186 .cindex "class resources (BSD)"
22187 This option is available only when Exim is running on FreeBSD, NetBSD, or
22188 BSD/OS. If it is set true, the &[setclassresources()]& function is used to set
22189 resource limits when a &(pipe)& transport is run to perform a delivery. The
22190 limits for the uid under which the pipe is to run are obtained from the login
22194 .option use_crlf pipe boolean false
22195 .cindex "carriage return"
22197 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
22198 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
22199 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the pipe is then an exact image
22200 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
22202 The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are
22203 written verbatim, so must contain their own carriage return characters if these
22204 are needed. When &%use_bsmtp%& is not set, the default values for both
22205 &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& end with a single linefeed, so their
22206 values must be changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
22209 .option use_shell pipe boolean false
22210 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
22211 If this option is set, it causes the command to be passed to &_/bin/sh_&
22212 instead of being run directly from the transport, as described in section
22213 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&. This is less secure, but is needed in some situations
22214 where the command is expected to be run under a shell and cannot easily be
22215 modified. The &%allow_commands%& and &%restrict_to_path%& options, and the
22216 &`$pipe_addresses`& facility are incompatible with &%use_shell%&. The
22217 command is expanded as a single string, and handed to &_/bin/sh_& as data for
22222 .section "Using an external local delivery agent" "SECID143"
22223 .cindex "local delivery" "using an external agent"
22224 .cindex "&'procmail'&"
22225 .cindex "external local delivery"
22226 .cindex "delivery" "&'procmail'&"
22227 .cindex "delivery" "by external agent"
22228 The &(pipe)& transport can be used to pass all messages that require local
22229 delivery to a separate local delivery agent such as &%procmail%&. When doing
22230 this, care must be taken to ensure that the pipe is run under an appropriate
22231 uid and gid. In some configurations one wants this to be a uid that is trusted
22232 by the delivery agent to supply the correct sender of the message. It may be
22233 necessary to recompile or reconfigure the delivery agent so that it trusts an
22234 appropriate user. The following is an example transport and router
22235 configuration for &%procmail%&:
22240 command = /usr/local/bin/procmail -d $local_part
22244 check_string = "From "
22245 escape_string = ">From "
22254 transport = procmail_pipe
22256 In this example, the pipe is run as the local user, but with the group set to
22257 &'mail'&. An alternative is to run the pipe as a specific user such as &'mail'&
22258 or &'exim'&, but in this case you must arrange for &%procmail%& to trust that
22259 user to supply a correct sender address. If you do not specify either a
22260 &%group%& or a &%user%& option, the pipe command is run as the local user. The
22261 home directory is the user's home directory by default.
22263 &*Note*&: The command that the pipe transport runs does &'not'& begin with
22267 as shown in some &%procmail%& documentation, because Exim does not by default
22268 use a shell to run pipe commands.
22271 The next example shows a transport and a router for a system where local
22272 deliveries are handled by the Cyrus IMAP server.
22275 local_delivery_cyrus:
22277 command = /usr/cyrus/bin/deliver \
22278 -m ${substr_1:$local_part_suffix} -- $local_part
22290 local_part_suffix = .*
22291 transport = local_delivery_cyrus
22293 Note the unsetting of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, and the use of
22294 &%return_output%& to cause any text written by Cyrus to be returned to the
22296 .ecindex IIDpiptra1
22297 .ecindex IIDpiptra2
22300 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22301 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22303 .chapter "The smtp transport" "CHAPsmtptrans"
22304 .scindex IIDsmttra1 "transports" "&(smtp)&"
22305 .scindex IIDsmttra2 "&(smtp)& transport"
22306 The &(smtp)& transport delivers messages over TCP/IP connections using the SMTP
22307 or LMTP protocol. The list of hosts to try can either be taken from the address
22308 that is being processed (having been set up by the router), or specified
22309 explicitly for the transport. Timeout and retry processing (see chapter
22310 &<<CHAPretry>>&) is applied to each IP address independently.
22313 .section "Multiple messages on a single connection" "SECID144"
22314 The sending of multiple messages over a single TCP/IP connection can arise in
22318 If a message contains more than &%max_rcpt%& (see below) addresses that are
22319 routed to the same host, more than one copy of the message has to be sent to
22320 that host. In this situation, multiple copies may be sent in a single run of
22321 the &(smtp)& transport over a single TCP/IP connection. (What Exim actually
22322 does when it has too many addresses to send in one message also depends on the
22323 value of the global &%remote_max_parallel%& option. Details are given in
22324 section &<<SECToutSMTPTCP>>&.)
22326 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
22327 When a message has been successfully delivered over a TCP/IP connection, Exim
22328 looks in its hints database to see if there are any other messages awaiting a
22329 connection to the same host. If there are, a new delivery process is started
22330 for one of them, and the current TCP/IP connection is passed on to it. The new
22331 process may in turn send multiple copies and possibly create yet another
22336 For each copy sent over the same TCP/IP connection, a sequence counter is
22337 incremented, and if it ever gets to the value of &%connection_max_messages%&,
22338 no further messages are sent over that connection.
22342 .section "Use of the $host and $host_address variables" "SECID145"
22344 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
22345 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$host$& and
22346 &$host_address$& are the name and IP address of the first host on the host list
22347 passed by the router. However, when the transport is about to connect to a
22348 specific host, and while it is connected to that host, &$host$& and
22349 &$host_address$& are set to the values for that host. These are the values
22350 that are in force when the &%helo_data%&, &%hosts_try_auth%&, &%interface%&,
22351 &%serialize_hosts%&, and the various TLS options are expanded.
22354 .section "Use of $tls_cipher and $tls_peerdn" "usecippeer"
22355 .vindex &$tls_bits$&
22356 .vindex &$tls_cipher$&
22357 .vindex &$tls_peerdn$&
22358 .vindex &$tls_sni$&
22359 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$tls_bits$&,
22360 &$tls_cipher$&, &$tls_peerdn$& and &$tls_sni$&
22361 are the values that were set when the message was received.
22362 These are the values that are used for options that are expanded before any
22363 SMTP connections are made. Just before each connection is made, these four
22364 variables are emptied. If TLS is subsequently started, they are set to the
22365 appropriate values for the outgoing connection, and these are the values that
22366 are in force when any authenticators are run and when the
22367 &%authenticated_sender%& option is expanded.
22369 These variables are deprecated in favour of &$tls_in_cipher$& et. al.
22370 and will be removed in a future release.
22373 .section "Private options for smtp" "SECID146"
22374 .cindex "options" "&(smtp)& transport"
22375 The private options of the &(smtp)& transport are as follows:
22378 .option address_retry_include_sender smtp boolean true
22379 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retrying after"
22380 When an address is delayed because of a 4&'xx'& response to a RCPT command, it
22381 is the combination of sender and recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue
22382 runs until the retry time is reached. You can delay the recipient without
22383 reference to the sender (which is what earlier versions of Exim did), by
22384 setting &%address_retry_include_sender%& false. However, this can lead to
22385 problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT commands.
22387 .option allow_localhost smtp boolean false
22388 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
22389 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
22390 When a host specified in &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& (see below) turns out
22391 to be the local host, or is listed in &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, delivery is
22392 deferred by default. However, if &%allow_localhost%& is set, Exim goes on to do
22393 the delivery anyway. This should be used only in special cases when the
22394 configuration ensures that no looping will result (for example, a differently
22395 configured Exim is listening on the port to which the message is sent).
22398 .option authenticated_sender smtp string&!! unset
22400 When Exim has authenticated as a client, or if &%authenticated_sender_force%&
22401 is true, this option sets a value for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands,
22402 overriding any existing authenticated sender value. If the string expansion is
22403 forced to fail, the option is ignored. Other expansion failures cause delivery
22404 to be deferred. If the result of expansion is an empty string, that is also
22407 The expansion happens after the outgoing connection has been made and TLS
22408 started, if required. This means that the &$host$&, &$host_address$&,
22409 &$tls_out_cipher$&, and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables are set according to the
22410 particular connection.
22412 If the SMTP session is not authenticated, the expansion of
22413 &%authenticated_sender%& still happens (and can cause the delivery to be
22414 deferred if it fails), but no AUTH= item is added to MAIL commands
22415 unless &%authenticated_sender_force%& is true.
22417 This option allows you to use the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode to
22418 deliver mail to Cyrus IMAP and provide the proper local part as the
22419 &"authenticated sender"&, via a setting such as:
22421 authenticated_sender = $local_part
22423 This removes the need for IMAP subfolders to be assigned special ACLs to
22424 allow direct delivery to those subfolders.
22426 Because of expected uses such as that just described for Cyrus (when no
22427 domain is involved), there is no checking on the syntax of the provided
22431 .option authenticated_sender_force smtp boolean false
22432 If this option is set true, the &%authenticated_sender%& option's value
22433 is used for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands, even if Exim has not
22434 authenticated as a client.
22437 .option command_timeout smtp time 5m
22438 This sets a timeout for receiving a response to an SMTP command that has been
22439 sent out. It is also used when waiting for the initial banner line from the
22440 remote host. Its value must not be zero.
22443 .option connect_timeout smtp time 5m
22444 This sets a timeout for the &[connect()]& function, which sets up a TCP/IP call
22445 to a remote host. A setting of zero allows the system timeout (typically
22446 several minutes) to act. To have any effect, the value of this option must be
22447 less than the system timeout. However, it has been observed that on some
22448 systems there is no system timeout, which is why the default value for this
22449 option is 5 minutes, a value recommended by RFC 1123.
22452 .option connection_max_messages smtp integer 500
22453 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
22454 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
22455 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
22456 This controls the maximum number of separate message deliveries that are sent
22457 over a single TCP/IP connection. If the value is zero, there is no limit.
22458 For testing purposes, this value can be overridden by the &%-oB%& command line
22462 .option data_timeout smtp time 5m
22463 This sets a timeout for the transmission of each block in the data portion of
22464 the message. As a result, the overall timeout for a message depends on the size
22465 of the message. Its value must not be zero. See also &%final_timeout%&.
22468 .option delay_after_cutoff smtp boolean true
22469 This option controls what happens when all remote IP addresses for a given
22470 domain have been inaccessible for so long that they have passed their retry
22473 In the default state, if the next retry time has not been reached for any of
22474 them, the address is bounced without trying any deliveries. In other words,
22475 Exim delays retrying an IP address after the final cutoff time until a new
22476 retry time is reached, and can therefore bounce an address without ever trying
22477 a delivery, when machines have been down for a long time. Some people are
22478 unhappy at this prospect, so...
22480 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
22481 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those
22482 IP addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
22483 none, of if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other words, it does not
22484 delay when a new message arrives, but immediately tries those expired IP
22485 addresses that haven't been tried since the message arrived. If there is a
22486 continuous stream of messages for the dead hosts, unsetting
22487 &%delay_after_cutoff%& means that there will be many more attempts to deliver
22491 .option dns_qualify_single smtp boolean true
22492 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used,
22493 and the &%gethostbyname%& option is false,
22494 the RES_DEFNAMES resolver option is set. See the &%qualify_single%& option
22495 in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more details.
22498 .option dns_search_parents smtp boolean false
22499 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used, and the
22500 &%gethostbyname%& option is false, the RES_DNSRCH resolver option is set.
22501 See the &%search_parents%& option in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more
22506 .option dscp smtp string&!! unset
22507 .cindex "DCSP" "outbound"
22508 This option causes the DSCP value associated with a socket to be set to one
22509 of a number of fixed strings or to numeric value.
22510 The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
22511 Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
22512 &`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
22514 The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
22515 (for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
22516 that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
22517 equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
22518 Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
22522 .option fallback_hosts smtp "string list" unset
22523 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
22524 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
22525 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses, optionally also including
22526 port numbers, though the separator can be changed, as described in section
22527 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
22528 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
22529 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&.
22531 Fallback hosts can also be specified on routers, which associate them with the
22532 addresses they process. As for the &%hosts%& option without &%hosts_override%&,
22533 &%fallback_hosts%& specified on the transport is used only if the address does
22534 not have its own associated fallback host list. Unlike &%hosts%&, a setting of
22535 &%fallback_hosts%& on an address is not overridden by &%hosts_override%&.
22536 However, &%hosts_randomize%& does apply to fallback host lists.
22538 If Exim is unable to deliver to any of the hosts for a particular address, and
22539 the errors are not permanent rejections, the address is put on a separate
22540 transport queue with its host list replaced by the fallback hosts, unless the
22541 address was routed via MX records and the current host was in the original MX
22542 list. In that situation, the fallback host list is not used.
22544 Once normal deliveries are complete, the fallback queue is delivered by
22545 re-running the same transports with the new host lists. If several failing
22546 addresses have the same fallback hosts (and &%max_rcpt%& permits it), a single
22547 copy of the message is sent.
22549 The resolution of the host names on the fallback list is controlled by the
22550 &%gethostbyname%& option, as for the &%hosts%& option. Fallback hosts apply
22551 both to cases when the host list comes with the address and when it is taken
22552 from &%hosts%&. This option provides a &"use a smart host only if delivery
22556 .option final_timeout smtp time 10m
22557 This is the timeout that applies while waiting for the response to the final
22558 line containing just &"."& that terminates a message. Its value must not be
22561 .option gethostbyname smtp boolean false
22562 If this option is true when the &%hosts%& and/or &%fallback_hosts%& options are
22563 being used, names are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
22564 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
22565 instead of using the DNS. Of course, that function may in fact use the DNS, but
22566 it may also consult other sources of information such as &_/etc/hosts_&.
22568 .option gnutls_compat_mode smtp boolean unset
22569 This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
22570 server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
22571 implementations of TLS.
22573 .option helo_data smtp string&!! "see below"
22574 .cindex "HELO" "argument, setting"
22575 .cindex "EHLO" "argument, setting"
22576 .cindex "LHLO argument setting"
22577 The value of this option is expanded after a connection to a another host has
22578 been set up. The result is used as the argument for the EHLO, HELO, or LHLO
22579 command that starts the outgoing SMTP or LMTP session. The default value of the
22584 During the expansion, the variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to
22585 the identity of the remote host, and the variables &$sending_ip_address$& and
22586 &$sending_port$& are set to the local IP address and port number that are being
22587 used. These variables can be used to generate different values for different
22588 servers or different local IP addresses. For example, if you want the string
22589 that is used for &%helo_data%& to be obtained by a DNS lookup of the outgoing
22590 interface address, you could use this:
22592 helo_data = ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=$sending_ip_address}{$value}\
22593 {$primary_hostname}}
22595 The use of &%helo_data%& applies both to sending messages and when doing
22598 .option hosts smtp "string list&!!" unset
22599 Hosts are associated with an address by a router such as &(dnslookup)&, which
22600 finds the hosts by looking up the address domain in the DNS, or by
22601 &(manualroute)&, which has lists of hosts in its configuration. However,
22602 email addresses can be passed to the &(smtp)& transport by any router, and not
22603 all of them can provide an associated list of hosts.
22605 The &%hosts%& option specifies a list of hosts to be used if the address being
22606 processed does not have any hosts associated with it. The hosts specified by
22607 &%hosts%& are also used, whether or not the address has its own hosts, if
22608 &%hosts_override%& is set.
22610 The string is first expanded, before being interpreted as a colon-separated
22611 list of host names or IP addresses, possibly including port numbers. The
22612 separator may be changed to something other than colon, as described in section
22613 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
22614 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
22615 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&. However, note that the &`/MX`& facility
22616 of the &(manualroute)& router is not available here.
22618 If the expansion fails, delivery is deferred. Unless the failure was caused by
22619 the inability to complete a lookup, the error is logged to the panic log as
22620 well as the main log. Host names are looked up either by searching directly for
22621 address records in the DNS or by calling &[gethostbyname()]& (or
22622 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available), depending on the setting of the
22623 &%gethostbyname%& option. When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, if a host
22624 that is looked up in the DNS has both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses, both types of
22627 During delivery, the hosts are tried in order, subject to their retry status,
22628 unless &%hosts_randomize%& is set.
22631 .option hosts_avoid_esmtp smtp "host list&!!" unset
22632 .cindex "ESMTP, avoiding use of"
22633 .cindex "HELO" "forcing use of"
22634 .cindex "EHLO" "avoiding use of"
22635 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
22636 This option is for use with broken hosts that announce ESMTP facilities (for
22637 example, PIPELINING) and then fail to implement them properly. When a host
22638 matches &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%&, Exim sends HELO rather than EHLO at the
22639 start of the SMTP session. This means that it cannot use any of the ESMTP
22640 facilities such as AUTH, PIPELINING, SIZE, and STARTTLS.
22643 .option hosts_avoid_pipelining smtp "host list&!!" unset
22644 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
22645 Exim will not use the SMTP PIPELINING extension when delivering to any host
22646 that matches this list, even if the server host advertises PIPELINING support.
22649 .option hosts_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
22650 .cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
22651 Exim will not try to start a TLS session when delivering to any host that
22652 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
22654 .option hosts_verify_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" *
22655 .cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
22656 Exim will not try to start a TLS session for a verify callout,
22657 or when delivering in cutthrough mode,
22658 to any host that matches this list.
22659 Note that the default is to not use TLS.
22662 .option hosts_max_try smtp integer 5
22663 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
22664 .cindex "limit" "number of hosts tried"
22665 .cindex "limit" "number of MX tried"
22666 .cindex "MX record" "maximum tried"
22667 This option limits the number of IP addresses that are tried for any one
22668 delivery in cases where there are temporary delivery errors. Section
22669 &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes in detail how the value of this option is used.
22672 .option hosts_max_try_hardlimit smtp integer 50
22673 This is an additional check on the maximum number of IP addresses that Exim
22674 tries for any one delivery. Section &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes its use and
22679 .option hosts_nopass_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
22680 .cindex "TLS" "passing connection"
22681 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
22682 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
22683 For any host that matches this list, a connection on which a TLS session has
22684 been started will not be passed to a new delivery process for sending another
22685 message on the same connection. See section &<<SECTmulmessam>>& for an
22686 explanation of when this might be needed.
22689 .option hosts_override smtp boolean false
22690 If this option is set and the &%hosts%& option is also set, any hosts that are
22691 attached to the address are ignored, and instead the hosts specified by the
22692 &%hosts%& option are always used. This option does not apply to
22693 &%fallback_hosts%&.
22696 .option hosts_randomize smtp boolean false
22697 .cindex "randomized host list"
22698 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
22699 .cindex "fallback" "randomized hosts"
22700 If this option is set, and either the list of hosts is taken from the
22701 &%hosts%& or the &%fallback_hosts%& option, or the hosts supplied by the router
22702 were not obtained from MX records (this includes fallback hosts from the
22703 router), and were not randomized by the router, the order of trying the hosts
22704 is randomized each time the transport runs. Randomizing the order of a host
22705 list can be used to do crude load sharing.
22707 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split into groups whose
22708 order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to set up MX-like
22709 behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an item that is just
22710 &`+`& in the host list. For example:
22712 hosts = host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
22714 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
22715 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
22716 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored.
22718 .option hosts_require_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
22719 .cindex "authentication" "required by client"
22720 This option provides a list of servers for which authentication must succeed
22721 before Exim will try to transfer a message. If authentication fails for
22722 servers which are not in this list, Exim tries to send unauthenticated. If
22723 authentication fails for one of these servers, delivery is deferred. This
22724 temporary error is detectable in the retry rules, so it can be turned into a
22725 hard failure if required. See also &%hosts_try_auth%&, and chapter
22726 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
22729 .option hosts_require_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
22730 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
22731 Exim will insist on using a TLS session when delivering to any host that
22732 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
22733 &*Note*&: This option affects outgoing mail only. To insist on TLS for
22734 incoming messages, use an appropriate ACL.
22736 .option hosts_try_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
22737 .cindex "authentication" "optional in client"
22738 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
22739 authentication support, Exim will attempt to authenticate as a client when it
22740 connects. If authentication fails, Exim will try to transfer the message
22741 unauthenticated. See also &%hosts_require_auth%&, and chapter
22742 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
22744 .option interface smtp "string list&!!" unset
22745 .cindex "bind IP address"
22746 .cindex "IP address" "binding"
22748 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
22749 This option specifies which interface to bind to when making an outgoing SMTP
22750 call. The value is an IP address, not an interface name such as
22751 &`eth0`&. Do not confuse this with the interface address that was used when a
22752 message was received, which is in &$received_ip_address$&, formerly known as
22753 &$interface_address$&. The name was changed to minimize confusion with the
22754 outgoing interface address. There is no variable that contains an outgoing
22755 interface address because, unless it is set by this option, its value is
22758 During the expansion of the &%interface%& option the variables &$host$& and
22759 &$host_address$& refer to the host to which a connection is about to be made
22760 during the expansion of the string. Forced expansion failure, or an empty
22761 string result causes the option to be ignored. Otherwise, after expansion, the
22762 string must be a list of IP addresses, colon-separated by default, but the
22763 separator can be changed in the usual way. For example:
22765 interface = <; 192.168.123.123 ; 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
22767 The first interface of the correct type (IPv4 or IPv6) is used for the outgoing
22768 connection. If none of them are the correct type, the option is ignored. If
22769 &%interface%& is not set, or is ignored, the system's IP functions choose which
22770 interface to use if the host has more than one.
22773 .option keepalive smtp boolean true
22774 .cindex "keepalive" "on outgoing connection"
22775 This option controls the setting of SO_KEEPALIVE on outgoing TCP/IP socket
22776 connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle connections
22777 periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The other end
22778 of the connection should send a acknowledgment if the connection is still okay
22779 or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing this is
22780 that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of connection
22781 that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without tidying up the
22782 TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several hours to detect
22786 .option lmtp_ignore_quota smtp boolean false
22787 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
22788 If this option is set true when the &%protocol%& option is set to &"lmtp"&, the
22789 string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT commands, provided that the LMTP server
22790 has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA in its response to the LHLO command.
22792 .option max_rcpt smtp integer 100
22793 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of outgoing"
22794 This option limits the number of RCPT commands that are sent in a single
22795 SMTP message transaction. Each set of addresses is treated independently, and
22796 so can cause parallel connections to the same host if &%remote_max_parallel%&
22800 .option multi_domain smtp boolean true
22801 .vindex "&$domain$&"
22802 When this option is set, the &(smtp)& transport can handle a number of
22803 addresses containing a mixture of different domains provided they all resolve
22804 to the same list of hosts. Turning the option off restricts the transport to
22805 handling only one domain at a time. This is useful if you want to use
22806 &$domain$& in an expansion for the transport, because it is set only when there
22807 is a single domain involved in a remote delivery.
22810 .option port smtp string&!! "see below"
22811 .cindex "port" "sending TCP/IP"
22812 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting outgoing port"
22813 This option specifies the TCP/IP port on the server to which Exim connects.
22814 &*Note:*& Do not confuse this with the port that was used when a message was
22815 received, which is in &$received_port$&, formerly known as &$interface_port$&.
22816 The name was changed to minimize confusion with the outgoing port. There is no
22817 variable that contains an outgoing port.
22819 If the value of this option begins with a digit it is taken as a port number;
22820 otherwise it is looked up using &[getservbyname()]&. The default value is
22821 normally &"smtp"&, but if &%protocol%& is set to &"lmtp"&, the default is
22822 &"lmtp"&. If the expansion fails, or if a port number cannot be found, delivery
22827 .option protocol smtp string smtp
22828 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
22829 .cindex "ssmtp protocol" "outbound"
22830 .cindex "TLS" "SSL-on-connect outbound"
22832 If this option is set to &"lmtp"& instead of &"smtp"&, the default value for
22833 the &%port%& option changes to &"lmtp"&, and the transport operates the LMTP
22834 protocol (RFC 2033) instead of SMTP. This protocol is sometimes used for local
22835 deliveries into closed message stores. Exim also has support for running LMTP
22836 over a pipe to a local process &-- see chapter &<<CHAPLMTP>>&.
22838 If this option is set to &"smtps"&, the default vaule for the &%port%& option
22839 changes to &"smtps"&, and the transport initiates TLS immediately after
22840 connecting, as an outbound SSL-on-connect, instead of using STARTTLS to upgrade.
22841 The Internet standards bodies strongly discourage use of this mode.
22844 .option retry_include_ip_address smtp boolean true
22845 Exim normally includes both the host name and the IP address in the key it
22846 constructs for indexing retry data after a temporary delivery failure. This
22847 means that when one of several IP addresses for a host is failing, it gets
22848 tried periodically (controlled by the retry rules), but use of the other IP
22849 addresses is not affected.
22851 However, in some dialup environments hosts are assigned a different IP address
22852 each time they connect. In this situation the use of the IP address as part of
22853 the retry key leads to undesirable behaviour. Setting this option false causes
22854 Exim to use only the host name. This should normally be done on a separate
22855 instance of the &(smtp)& transport, set up specially to handle the dialup
22859 .option serialize_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
22860 .cindex "serializing connections"
22861 .cindex "host" "serializing connections"
22862 Because Exim operates in a distributed manner, if several messages for the same
22863 host arrive at around the same time, more than one simultaneous connection to
22864 the remote host can occur. This is not usually a problem except when there is a
22865 slow link between the hosts. In that situation it may be helpful to restrict
22866 Exim to one connection at a time. This can be done by setting
22867 &%serialize_hosts%& to match the relevant hosts.
22869 .cindex "hints database" "serializing deliveries to a host"
22870 Exim implements serialization by means of a hints database in which a record is
22871 written whenever a process connects to one of the restricted hosts. The record
22872 is deleted when the connection is completed. Obviously there is scope for
22873 records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
22874 guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
22876 If you set up this kind of serialization, you should also arrange to delete the
22877 relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
22878 start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
22879 may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
22880 are used for ETRN serialization.
22883 .option size_addition smtp integer 1024
22884 .cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
22885 .cindex "message" "size issue for transport filter"
22886 .cindex "size" "of message"
22887 .cindex "transport" "filter"
22888 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
22889 If a remote SMTP server indicates that it supports the SIZE option of the
22890 MAIL command, Exim uses this to pass over the message size at the start of
22891 an SMTP transaction. It adds the value of &%size_addition%& to the value it
22892 sends, to allow for headers and other text that may be added during delivery by
22893 configuration options or in a transport filter. It may be necessary to increase
22894 this if a lot of text is added to messages.
22896 Alternatively, if the value of &%size_addition%& is set negative, it disables
22897 the use of the SIZE option altogether.
22900 .option tls_certificate smtp string&!! unset
22901 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate, location of"
22902 .cindex "certificate" "client, location of"
22904 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
22905 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
22906 client's certificate, for possible use when sending a message over an encrypted
22907 connection. The values of &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to the name and
22908 address of the server during the expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for
22911 &*Note*&: This option must be set if you want Exim to be able to use a TLS
22912 certificate when sending messages as a client. The global option of the same
22913 name specifies the certificate for Exim as a server; it is not automatically
22914 assumed that the same certificate should be used when Exim is operating as a
22918 .option tls_crl smtp string&!! unset
22919 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate revocation list"
22920 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for client"
22921 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
22922 be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
22926 .option tls_dh_min_bits smtp integer 1024
22927 .cindex "TLS" "Diffie-Hellman minimum acceptable size"
22928 When establishing a TLS session, if a ciphersuite which uses Diffie-Hellman
22929 key agreement is negotiated, the server will provide a large prime number
22930 for use. This option establishes the minimum acceptable size of that number.
22931 If the parameter offered by the server is too small, then the TLS handshake
22934 Only supported when using GnuTLS.
22938 .option tls_privatekey smtp string&!! unset
22939 .cindex "TLS" "client private key, location of"
22941 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
22942 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
22943 client's private key. This is used when sending a message over an encrypted
22944 connection using a client certificate. The values of &$host$& and
22945 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
22946 expansion. If this option is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the
22947 result is an empty string, the private key is assumed to be in the same file as
22948 the certificate. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
22951 .option tls_require_ciphers smtp string&!! unset
22952 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
22953 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
22955 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
22956 The value of this option must be a list of permitted cipher suites, for use
22957 when setting up an outgoing encrypted connection. (There is a global option of
22958 the same name for controlling incoming connections.) The values of &$host$& and
22959 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
22960 expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS; note that this option
22961 is used in different ways by OpenSSL and GnuTLS (see sections
22962 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&). For GnuTLS, the order of the
22963 ciphers is a preference order.
22967 .option tls_sni smtp string&!! unset
22968 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
22969 .vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
22970 If this option is set then it sets the $tls_out_sni variable and causes any
22971 TLS session to pass this value as the Server Name Indication extension to
22972 the remote side, which can be used by the remote side to select an appropriate
22973 certificate and private key for the session.
22975 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for more information.
22977 Note that for OpenSSL, this feature requires a build of OpenSSL that supports
22983 .option tls_tempfail_tryclear smtp boolean true
22984 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "to STARTTLS"
22985 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and there is a problem in
22986 setting up a TLS session, this option determines whether or not Exim should try
22987 to deliver the message unencrypted. If it is set false, delivery to the
22988 current host is deferred; if there are other hosts, they are tried. If this
22989 option is set true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'&
22990 response to STARTTLS. Also, if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent
22991 TLS negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
22992 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
22996 .option tls_verify_certificates smtp string&!! unset
22997 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
22998 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
23000 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
23001 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file containing
23002 permitted server certificates, for use when setting up an encrypted connection.
23003 Alternatively, if you are using OpenSSL, you can set
23004 &%tls_verify_certificates%& to the name of a directory containing certificate
23005 files. This does not work with GnuTLS; the option must be set to the name of a
23006 single file if you are using GnuTLS. The values of &$host$& and
23007 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
23008 expansion of this option. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
23013 .section "How the limits for the number of hosts to try are used" &&&
23015 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
23016 .cindex "limit" "hosts; maximum number tried"
23017 There are two options that are concerned with the number of hosts that are
23018 tried when an SMTP delivery takes place. They are &%hosts_max_try%& and
23019 &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%&.
23022 The &%hosts_max_try%& option limits the number of hosts that are tried
23023 for a single delivery. However, despite the term &"host"& in its name, the
23024 option actually applies to each IP address independently. In other words, a
23025 multihomed host is treated as several independent hosts, just as it is for
23028 Many of the larger ISPs have multiple MX records which often point to
23029 multihomed hosts. As a result, a list of a dozen or more IP addresses may be
23030 created as a result of routing one of these domains.
23032 Trying every single IP address on such a long list does not seem sensible; if
23033 several at the top of the list fail, it is reasonable to assume there is some
23034 problem that is likely to affect all of them. Roughly speaking, the value of
23035 &%hosts_max_try%& is the maximum number that are tried before deferring the
23036 delivery. However, the logic cannot be quite that simple.
23038 Firstly, IP addresses that are skipped because their retry times have not
23039 arrived do not count, and in addition, addresses that are past their retry
23040 limits are also not counted, even when they are tried. This means that when
23041 some IP addresses are past their retry limits, more than the value of
23042 &%hosts_max_retry%& may be tried. The reason for this behaviour is to ensure
23043 that all IP addresses are considered before timing out an email address (but
23044 see below for an exception).
23046 Secondly, when the &%hosts_max_try%& limit is reached, Exim looks down the host
23047 list to see if there is a subsequent host with a different (higher valued) MX.
23048 If there is, that host is considered next, and the current IP address is used
23049 but not counted. This behaviour helps in the case of a domain with a retry rule
23050 that hardly ever delays any hosts, as is now explained:
23052 Consider the case of a long list of hosts with one MX value, and a few with a
23053 higher MX value. If &%hosts_max_try%& is small (the default is 5) only a few
23054 hosts at the top of the list are tried at first. With the default retry rule,
23055 which specifies increasing retry times, the higher MX hosts are eventually
23056 tried when those at the top of the list are skipped because they have not
23057 reached their retry times.
23059 However, it is common practice to put a fixed short retry time on domains for
23060 large ISPs, on the grounds that their servers are rarely down for very long.
23061 Unfortunately, these are exactly the domains that tend to resolve to long lists
23062 of hosts. The short retry time means that the lowest MX hosts are tried every
23063 time. The attempts may be in a different order because of random sorting, but
23064 without the special MX check, the higher MX hosts would never be tried until
23065 all the lower MX hosts had timed out (which might be several days), because
23066 there are always some lower MX hosts that have reached their retry times. With
23067 the special check, Exim considers at least one IP address from each MX value at
23068 every delivery attempt, even if the &%hosts_max_try%& limit has already been
23071 The above logic means that &%hosts_max_try%& is not a hard limit, and in
23072 particular, Exim normally eventually tries all the IP addresses before timing
23073 out an email address. When &%hosts_max_try%& was implemented, this seemed a
23074 reasonable thing to do. Recently, however, some lunatic DNS configurations have
23075 been set up with hundreds of IP addresses for some domains. It can
23076 take a very long time indeed for an address to time out in these cases.
23078 The &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%& option was added to help with this problem.
23079 Exim never tries more than this number of IP addresses; if it hits this limit
23080 and they are all timed out, the email address is bounced, even though not all
23081 possible IP addresses have been tried.
23082 .ecindex IIDsmttra1
23083 .ecindex IIDsmttra2
23089 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23090 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23092 .chapter "Address rewriting" "CHAPrewrite"
23093 .scindex IIDaddrew "rewriting" "addresses"
23094 There are some circumstances in which Exim automatically rewrites domains in
23095 addresses. The two most common are when an address is given without a domain
23096 (referred to as an &"unqualified address"&) or when an address contains an
23097 abbreviated domain that is expanded by DNS lookup.
23099 Unqualified envelope addresses are accepted only for locally submitted
23100 messages, or for messages that are received from hosts matching
23101 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
23102 appropriate. Unqualified addresses in header lines are qualified if they are in
23103 locally submitted messages, or messages from hosts that are permitted to send
23104 unqualified envelope addresses. Otherwise, unqualified addresses in header
23105 lines are neither qualified nor rewritten.
23107 One situation in which Exim does &'not'& automatically rewrite a domain is
23108 when it is the name of a CNAME record in the DNS. The older RFCs suggest that
23109 such a domain should be rewritten using the &"canonical"& name, and some MTAs
23110 do this. The new RFCs do not contain this suggestion.
23113 .section "Explicitly configured address rewriting" "SECID147"
23114 This chapter describes the rewriting rules that can be used in the
23115 main rewrite section of the configuration file, and also in the generic
23116 &%headers_rewrite%& option that can be set on any transport.
23118 Some people believe that configured address rewriting is a Mortal Sin.
23119 Others believe that life is not possible without it. Exim provides the
23120 facility; you do not have to use it.
23122 The main rewriting rules that appear in the &"rewrite"& section of the
23123 configuration file are applied to addresses in incoming messages, both envelope
23124 addresses and addresses in header lines. Each rule specifies the types of
23125 address to which it applies.
23127 Whether or not addresses in header lines are rewritten depends on the origin of
23128 the headers and the type of rewriting. Global rewriting, that is, rewriting
23129 rules from the rewrite section of the configuration file, is applied only to
23130 those headers that were received with the message. Header lines that are added
23131 by ACLs or by a system filter or by individual routers or transports (which
23132 are specific to individual recipient addresses) are not rewritten by the global
23135 Rewriting at transport time, by means of the &%headers_rewrite%& option,
23136 applies all headers except those added by routers and transports. That is, as
23137 well as the headers that were received with the message, it also applies to
23138 headers that were added by an ACL or a system filter.
23141 In general, rewriting addresses from your own system or domain has some
23142 legitimacy. Rewriting other addresses should be done only with great care and
23143 in special circumstances. The author of Exim believes that rewriting should be
23144 used sparingly, and mainly for &"regularizing"& addresses in your own domains.
23145 Although it can sometimes be used as a routing tool, this is very strongly
23148 There are two commonly encountered circumstances where rewriting is used, as
23149 illustrated by these examples:
23152 The company whose domain is &'hitch.fict.example'& has a number of hosts that
23153 exchange mail with each other behind a firewall, but there is only a single
23154 gateway to the outer world. The gateway rewrites &'*.hitch.fict.example'& as
23155 &'hitch.fict.example'& when sending mail off-site.
23157 A host rewrites the local parts of its own users so that, for example,
23158 &'fp42@hitch.fict.example'& becomes &'Ford.Prefect@hitch.fict.example'&.
23163 .section "When does rewriting happen?" "SECID148"
23164 .cindex "rewriting" "timing of"
23165 .cindex "&ACL;" "rewriting addresses in"
23166 Configured address rewriting can take place at several different stages of a
23167 message's processing.
23169 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
23170 At the start of an ACL for MAIL, the sender address may have been rewritten
23171 by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule (see section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&), but no
23172 ordinary rewrite rules have yet been applied. If, however, the sender address
23173 is verified in the ACL, it is rewritten before verification, and remains
23174 rewritten thereafter. The subsequent value of &$sender_address$& is the
23175 rewritten address. This also applies if sender verification happens in a
23176 RCPT ACL. Otherwise, when the sender address is not verified, it is
23177 rewritten as soon as a message's header lines have been received.
23179 .vindex "&$domain$&"
23180 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
23181 Similarly, at the start of an ACL for RCPT, the current recipient's address
23182 may have been rewritten by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule, but no ordinary
23183 rewrite rules have yet been applied to it. However, the behaviour is different
23184 from the sender address when a recipient is verified. The address is rewritten
23185 for the verification, but the rewriting is not remembered at this stage. The
23186 value of &$local_part$& and &$domain$& after verification are always the same
23187 as they were before (that is, they contain the unrewritten &-- except for
23188 SMTP-time rewriting &-- address).
23190 As soon as a message's header lines have been received, all the envelope
23191 recipient addresses are permanently rewritten, and rewriting is also applied to
23192 the addresses in the header lines (if configured). This happens before adding
23193 any header lines that were specified in MAIL or RCPT ACLs, and
23194 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "address rewriting; timing of"
23195 before the DATA ACL and &[local_scan()]& functions are run.
23197 When an address is being routed, either for delivery or for verification,
23198 rewriting is applied immediately to child addresses that are generated by
23199 redirection, unless &%no_rewrite%& is set on the router.
23201 .cindex "envelope sender" "rewriting at transport time"
23202 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
23203 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting at transport time"
23204 At transport time, additional rewriting of addresses in header lines can be
23205 specified by setting the generic &%headers_rewrite%& option on a transport.
23206 This option contains rules that are identical in form to those in the rewrite
23207 section of the configuration file. They are applied to the original message
23208 header lines and any that were added by ACLs or a system filter. They are not
23209 applied to header lines that are added by routers or the transport.
23211 The outgoing envelope sender can be rewritten by means of the &%return_path%&
23212 transport option. However, it is not possible to rewrite envelope recipients at
23218 .section "Testing the rewriting rules that apply on input" "SECID149"
23219 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
23220 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
23221 Exim's input rewriting configuration appears in a part of the run time
23222 configuration file headed by &"begin rewrite"&. It can be tested by the
23223 &%-brw%& command line option. This takes an address (which can be a full RFC
23224 2822 address) as its argument. The output is a list of how the address would be
23225 transformed by the rewriting rules for each of the different places it might
23226 appear in an incoming message, that is, for each different header and for the
23227 envelope sender and recipient fields. For example,
23229 exim -brw ph10@exim.workshop.example
23231 might produce the output
23233 sender: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
23234 from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
23235 to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
23236 cc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
23237 bcc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
23238 reply-to: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
23239 env-from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
23240 env-to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
23242 which shows that rewriting has been set up for that address when used in any of
23243 the source fields, but not when it appears as a recipient address. At the
23244 present time, there is no equivalent way of testing rewriting rules that are
23245 set for a particular transport.
23248 .section "Rewriting rules" "SECID150"
23249 .cindex "rewriting" "rules"
23250 The rewrite section of the configuration file consists of lines of rewriting
23253 <&'source pattern'&> <&'replacement'&> <&'flags'&>
23255 Rewriting rules that are specified for the &%headers_rewrite%& generic
23256 transport option are given as a colon-separated list. Each item in the list
23257 takes the same form as a line in the main rewriting configuration (except that
23258 any colons must be doubled, of course).
23260 The formats of source patterns and replacement strings are described below.
23261 Each is terminated by white space, unless enclosed in double quotes, in which
23262 case normal quoting conventions apply inside the quotes. The flags are single
23263 characters which may appear in any order. Spaces and tabs between them are
23266 For each address that could potentially be rewritten, the rules are scanned in
23267 order, and replacements for the address from earlier rules can themselves be
23268 replaced by later rules (but see the &"q"& and &"R"& flags).
23270 The order in which addresses are rewritten is undefined, may change between
23271 releases, and must not be relied on, with one exception: when a message is
23272 received, the envelope sender is always rewritten first, before any header
23273 lines are rewritten. For example, the replacement string for a rewrite of an
23274 address in &'To:'& must not assume that the message's address in &'From:'& has
23275 (or has not) already been rewritten. However, a rewrite of &'From:'& may assume
23276 that the envelope sender has already been rewritten.
23278 .vindex "&$domain$&"
23279 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
23280 The variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used in the replacement
23281 string to refer to the address that is being rewritten. Note that lookup-driven
23282 rewriting can be done by a rule of the form
23286 where the lookup key uses &$1$& and &$2$& or &$local_part$& and &$domain$& to
23287 refer to the address that is being rewritten.
23290 .section "Rewriting patterns" "SECID151"
23291 .cindex "rewriting" "patterns"
23292 .cindex "address list" "in a rewriting pattern"
23293 The source pattern in a rewriting rule is any item which may appear in an
23294 address list (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a
23295 single-item address list, which means that it is expanded before being tested
23296 against the address. As always, if you use a regular expression as a pattern,
23297 you must take care to escape dollar and backslash characters, or use the &`\N`&
23298 facility to suppress string expansion within the regular expression.
23300 Domains in patterns should be given in lower case. Local parts in patterns are
23301 case-sensitive. If you want to do case-insensitive matching of local parts, you
23302 can use a regular expression that starts with &`^(?i)`&.
23304 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in rewriting rules"
23305 After matching, the numerical variables &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set,
23306 depending on the type of match which occurred. These can be used in the
23307 replacement string to insert portions of the incoming address. &$0$& always
23308 refers to the complete incoming address. When a regular expression is used, the
23309 numerical variables are set from its capturing subexpressions. For other types
23310 of pattern they are set as follows:
23313 If a local part or domain starts with an asterisk, the numerical variables
23314 refer to the character strings matched by asterisks, with &$1$& associated with
23315 the first asterisk, and &$2$& with the second, if present. For example, if the
23318 *queen@*.fict.example
23320 is matched against the address &'hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example'& then
23322 $0 = hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example
23326 Note that if the local part does not start with an asterisk, but the domain
23327 does, it is &$1$& that contains the wild part of the domain.
23330 If the domain part of the pattern is a partial lookup, the wild and fixed parts
23331 of the domain are placed in the next available numerical variables. Suppose,
23332 for example, that the address &'foo@bar.baz.example'& is processed by a
23333 rewriting rule of the form
23335 &`*@partial-dbm;/some/dbm/file`& <&'replacement string'&>
23337 and the key in the file that matches the domain is &`*.baz.example`&. Then
23343 If the address &'foo@baz.example'& is looked up, this matches the same
23344 wildcard file entry, and in this case &$2$& is set to the empty string, but
23345 &$3$& is still set to &'baz.example'&. If a non-wild key is matched in a
23346 partial lookup, &$2$& is again set to the empty string and &$3$& is set to the
23347 whole domain. For non-partial domain lookups, no numerical variables are set.
23351 .section "Rewriting replacements" "SECID152"
23352 .cindex "rewriting" "replacements"
23353 If the replacement string for a rule is a single asterisk, addresses that
23354 match the pattern and the flags are &'not'& rewritten, and no subsequent
23355 rewriting rules are scanned. For example,
23357 hatta@lookingglass.fict.example * f
23359 specifies that &'hatta@lookingglass.fict.example'& is never to be rewritten in
23362 .vindex "&$domain$&"
23363 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
23364 If the replacement string is not a single asterisk, it is expanded, and must
23365 yield a fully qualified address. Within the expansion, the variables
23366 &$local_part$& and &$domain$& refer to the address that is being rewritten.
23367 Any letters they contain retain their original case &-- they are not lower
23368 cased. The numerical variables are set up according to the type of pattern that
23369 matched the address, as described above. If the expansion is forced to fail by
23370 the presence of &"fail"& in a conditional or lookup item, rewriting by the
23371 current rule is abandoned, but subsequent rules may take effect. Any other
23372 expansion failure causes the entire rewriting operation to be abandoned, and an
23373 entry written to the panic log.
23377 .section "Rewriting flags" "SECID153"
23378 There are three different kinds of flag that may appear on rewriting rules:
23381 Flags that specify which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite: E, F, T, b,
23384 A flag that specifies rewriting at SMTP time: S.
23386 Flags that control the rewriting process: Q, q, R, w.
23389 For rules that are part of the &%headers_rewrite%& generic transport option,
23390 E, F, T, and S are not permitted.
23394 .section "Flags specifying which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite" &&&
23396 .cindex "rewriting" "flags"
23397 If none of the following flag letters, nor the &"S"& flag (see section
23398 &<<SECTrewriteS>>&) are present, a main rewriting rule applies to all headers
23399 and to both the sender and recipient fields of the envelope, whereas a
23400 transport-time rewriting rule just applies to all headers. Otherwise, the
23401 rewriting rule is skipped unless the relevant addresses are being processed.
23403 &`E`& rewrite all envelope fields
23404 &`F`& rewrite the envelope From field
23405 &`T`& rewrite the envelope To field
23406 &`b`& rewrite the &'Bcc:'& header
23407 &`c`& rewrite the &'Cc:'& header
23408 &`f`& rewrite the &'From:'& header
23409 &`h`& rewrite all headers
23410 &`r`& rewrite the &'Reply-To:'& header
23411 &`s`& rewrite the &'Sender:'& header
23412 &`t`& rewrite the &'To:'& header
23414 "All headers" means all of the headers listed above that can be selected
23415 individually, plus their &'Resent-'& versions. It does not include
23416 other headers such as &'Subject:'& etc.
23418 You should be particularly careful about rewriting &'Sender:'& headers, and
23419 restrict this to special known cases in your own domains.
23422 .section "The SMTP-time rewriting flag" "SECTrewriteS"
23423 .cindex "SMTP" "rewriting malformed addresses"
23424 .cindex "RCPT" "rewriting argument of"
23425 .cindex "MAIL" "rewriting argument of"
23426 The rewrite flag &"S"& specifies a rewrite of incoming envelope addresses at
23427 SMTP time, as soon as an address is received in a MAIL or RCPT command, and
23428 before any other processing; even before syntax checking. The pattern is
23429 required to be a regular expression, and it is matched against the whole of the
23430 data for the command, including any surrounding angle brackets.
23432 .vindex "&$domain$&"
23433 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
23434 This form of rewrite rule allows for the handling of addresses that are not
23435 compliant with RFCs 2821 and 2822 (for example, &"bang paths"& in batched SMTP
23436 input). Because the input is not required to be a syntactically valid address,
23437 the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are not available during the
23438 expansion of the replacement string. The result of rewriting replaces the
23439 original address in the MAIL or RCPT command.
23442 .section "Flags controlling the rewriting process" "SECID155"
23443 There are four flags which control the way the rewriting process works. These
23444 take effect only when a rule is invoked, that is, when the address is of the
23445 correct type (matches the flags) and matches the pattern:
23448 If the &"Q"& flag is set on a rule, the rewritten address is permitted to be an
23449 unqualified local part. It is qualified with &%qualify_recipient%&. In the
23450 absence of &"Q"& the rewritten address must always include a domain.
23452 If the &"q"& flag is set on a rule, no further rewriting rules are considered,
23453 even if no rewriting actually takes place because of a &"fail"& in the
23454 expansion. The &"q"& flag is not effective if the address is of the wrong type
23455 (does not match the flags) or does not match the pattern.
23457 The &"R"& flag causes a successful rewriting rule to be re-applied to the new
23458 address, up to ten times. It can be combined with the &"q"& flag, to stop
23459 rewriting once it fails to match (after at least one successful rewrite).
23461 .cindex "rewriting" "whole addresses"
23462 When an address in a header is rewritten, the rewriting normally applies only
23463 to the working part of the address, with any comments and RFC 2822 &"phrase"&
23464 left unchanged. For example, rewriting might change
23466 From: Ford Prefect <fp42@restaurant.hitch.fict.example>
23470 From: Ford Prefect <prefectf@hitch.fict.example>
23473 Sometimes there is a need to replace the whole address item, and this can be
23474 done by adding the flag letter &"w"& to a rule. If this is set on a rule that
23475 causes an address in a header line to be rewritten, the entire address is
23476 replaced, not just the working part. The replacement must be a complete RFC
23477 2822 address, including the angle brackets if necessary. If text outside angle
23478 brackets contains a character whose value is greater than 126 or less than 32
23479 (except for tab), the text is encoded according to RFC 2047. The character set
23480 is taken from &%headers_charset%&, which defaults to ISO-8859-1.
23482 When the &"w"& flag is set on a rule that causes an envelope address to be
23483 rewritten, all but the working part of the replacement address is discarded.
23487 .section "Rewriting examples" "SECID156"
23488 Here is an example of the two common rewriting paradigms:
23490 *@*.hitch.fict.example $1@hitch.fict.example
23491 *@hitch.fict.example ${lookup{$1}dbm{/etc/realnames}\
23492 {$value}fail}@hitch.fict.example bctfrF
23494 Note the use of &"fail"& in the lookup expansion in the second rule, forcing
23495 the string expansion to fail if the lookup does not succeed. In this context it
23496 has the effect of leaving the original address unchanged, but Exim goes on to
23497 consider subsequent rewriting rules, if any, because the &"q"& flag is not
23498 present in that rule. An alternative to &"fail"& would be to supply &$1$&
23499 explicitly, which would cause the rewritten address to be the same as before,
23500 at the cost of a small bit of processing. Not supplying either of these is an
23501 error, since the rewritten address would then contain no local part.
23503 The first example above replaces the domain with a superior, more general
23504 domain. This may not be desirable for certain local parts. If the rule
23506 root@*.hitch.fict.example *
23508 were inserted before the first rule, rewriting would be suppressed for the
23509 local part &'root'& at any domain ending in &'hitch.fict.example'&.
23511 Rewriting can be made conditional on a number of tests, by making use of
23512 &${if$& in the expansion item. For example, to apply a rewriting rule only to
23513 messages that originate outside the local host:
23515 *@*.hitch.fict.example "${if !eq {$sender_host_address}{}\
23516 {$1@hitch.fict.example}fail}"
23518 The replacement string is quoted in this example because it contains white
23521 .cindex "rewriting" "bang paths"
23522 .cindex "bang paths" "rewriting"
23523 Exim does not handle addresses in the form of &"bang paths"&. If it sees such
23524 an address it treats it as an unqualified local part which it qualifies with
23525 the local qualification domain (if the source of the message is local or if the
23526 remote host is permitted to send unqualified addresses). Rewriting can
23527 sometimes be used to handle simple bang paths with a fixed number of
23528 components. For example, the rule
23530 \N^([^!]+)!(.*)@your.domain.example$\N $2@$1
23532 rewrites a two-component bang path &'host.name!user'& as the domain address
23533 &'user@host.name'&. However, there is a security implication in using this as
23534 a global rewriting rule for envelope addresses. It can provide a backdoor
23535 method for using your system as a relay, because the incoming addresses appear
23536 to be local. If the bang path addresses are received via SMTP, it is safer to
23537 use the &"S"& flag to rewrite them as they are received, so that relay checking
23538 can be done on the rewritten addresses.
23545 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23546 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23548 .chapter "Retry configuration" "CHAPretry"
23549 .scindex IIDretconf1 "retry" "configuration, description of"
23550 .scindex IIDregconf2 "configuration file" "retry section"
23551 The &"retry"& section of the runtime configuration file contains a list of
23552 retry rules that control how often Exim tries to deliver messages that cannot
23553 be delivered at the first attempt. If there are no retry rules (the section is
23554 empty or not present), there are no retries. In this situation, temporary
23555 errors are treated as permanent. The default configuration contains a single,
23556 general-purpose retry rule (see section &<<SECID57>>&). The &%-brt%& command
23557 line option can be used to test which retry rule will be used for a given
23558 address, domain and error.
23560 The most common cause of retries is temporary failure to deliver to a remote
23561 host because the host is down, or inaccessible because of a network problem.
23562 Exim's retry processing in this case is applied on a per-host (strictly, per IP
23563 address) basis, not on a per-message basis. Thus, if one message has recently
23564 been delayed, delivery of a new message to the same host is not immediately
23565 tried, but waits for the host's retry time to arrive. If the &%retry_defer%&
23566 log selector is set, the message
23567 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
23568 &"retry time not reached"& is written to the main log whenever a delivery is
23569 skipped for this reason. Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& contains more details of
23570 the handling of errors during remote deliveries.
23572 Retry processing applies to routing as well as to delivering, except as covered
23573 in the next paragraph. The retry rules do not distinguish between these
23574 actions. It is not possible, for example, to specify different behaviour for
23575 failures to route the domain &'snark.fict.example'& and failures to deliver to
23576 the host &'snark.fict.example'&. I didn't think anyone would ever need this
23577 added complication, so did not implement it. However, although they share the
23578 same retry rule, the actual retry times for routing and transporting a given
23579 domain are maintained independently.
23581 When a delivery is not part of a queue run (typically an immediate delivery on
23582 receipt of a message), the routers are always run, and local deliveries are
23583 always attempted, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for better
23584 behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example, causing
23585 quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file). If such a delivery
23586 suffers a temporary failure, the retry data is updated as normal, and
23587 subsequent delivery attempts from queue runs occur only when the retry time for
23588 the local address is reached.
23590 .section "Changing retry rules" "SECID157"
23591 If you change the retry rules in your configuration, you should consider
23592 whether or not to delete the retry data that is stored in Exim's spool area in
23593 files with names like &_db/retry_&. Deleting any of Exim's hints files is
23594 always safe; that is why they are called &"hints"&.
23596 The hints retry data contains suggested retry times based on the previous
23597 rules. In the case of a long-running problem with a remote host, it might
23598 record the fact that the host has timed out. If your new rules increase the
23599 timeout time for such a host, you should definitely remove the old retry data
23600 and let Exim recreate it, based on the new rules. Otherwise Exim might bounce
23601 messages that it should now be retaining.
23605 .section "Format of retry rules" "SECID158"
23606 .cindex "retry" "rules"
23607 Each retry rule occupies one line and consists of three or four parts,
23608 separated by white space: a pattern, an error name, an optional list of sender
23609 addresses, and a list of retry parameters. The pattern and sender lists must be
23610 enclosed in double quotes if they contain white space. The rules are searched
23611 in order until one is found where the pattern, error name, and sender list (if
23612 present) match the failing host or address, the error that occurred, and the
23613 message's sender, respectively.
23616 The pattern is any single item that may appear in an address list (see section
23617 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a one-item address list,
23618 which means that it is expanded before being tested against the address that
23619 has been delayed. A negated address list item is permitted. Address
23620 list processing treats a plain domain name as if it were preceded by &"*@"&,
23621 which makes it possible for many retry rules to start with just a domain. For
23624 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
23626 provides a rule for any address in the &'lookingglass.fict.example'& domain,
23629 alice@lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
23631 applies only to temporary failures involving the local part &%alice%&.
23632 In practice, almost all rules start with a domain name pattern without a local
23635 .cindex "regular expressions" "in retry rules"
23636 &*Warning*&: If you use a regular expression in a retry rule pattern, it
23637 must match a complete address, not just a domain, because that is how regular
23638 expressions work in address lists.
23640 &`^\Nxyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Wrong%&
23641 &`^\N[^@]+@xyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Right%&
23645 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for address errors" "SECID159"
23646 When Exim is looking for a retry rule after a routing attempt has failed (for
23647 example, after a DNS timeout), each line in the retry configuration is tested
23648 against the complete address only if &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the
23649 router. Otherwise, only the domain is used, except when matching against a
23650 regular expression, when the local part of the address is replaced with &"*"&.
23651 A domain on its own can match a domain pattern, or a pattern that starts with
23652 &"*@"&. By default, &%retry_use_local_part%& is true for routers where
23653 &%check_local_user%& is true, and false for other routers.
23655 Similarly, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a local delivery has
23656 failed (for example, after a mailbox full error), each line in the retry
23657 configuration is tested against the complete address only if
23658 &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the transport (it defaults true for all
23661 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retry rules for"
23662 However, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a remote delivery attempt
23663 suffers an address error (a 4&'xx'& SMTP response for a recipient address), the
23664 whole address is always used as the key when searching the retry rules. The
23665 rule that is found is used to create a retry time for the combination of the
23666 failing address and the message's sender. It is the combination of sender and
23667 recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue runs until its retry time is
23668 reached. You can delay the recipient without regard to the sender by setting
23669 &%address_retry_include_sender%& false in the &(smtp)& transport but this can
23670 lead to problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT
23675 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for host and message errors" &&&
23677 For a temporary error that is not related to an individual address (for
23678 example, a connection timeout), each line in the retry configuration is checked
23679 twice. First, the name of the remote host is used as a domain name (preceded by
23680 &"*@"& when matching a regular expression). If this does not match the line,
23681 the domain from the email address is tried in a similar fashion. For example,
23682 suppose the MX records for &'a.b.c.example'& are
23684 a.b.c.example MX 5 x.y.z.example
23688 and the retry rules are
23690 p.q.r.example * F,24h,30m;
23691 a.b.c.example * F,4d,45m;
23693 and a delivery to the host &'x.y.z.example'& suffers a connection failure. The
23694 first rule matches neither the host nor the domain, so Exim looks at the second
23695 rule. This does not match the host, but it does match the domain, so it is used
23696 to calculate the retry time for the host &'x.y.z.example'&. Meanwhile, Exim
23697 tries to deliver to &'p.q.r.example'&. If this also suffers a host error, the
23698 first retry rule is used, because it matches the host.
23700 In other words, temporary failures to deliver to host &'p.q.r.example'& use the
23701 first rule to determine retry times, but for all the other hosts for the domain
23702 &'a.b.c.example'&, the second rule is used. The second rule is also used if
23703 routing to &'a.b.c.example'& suffers a temporary failure.
23705 &*Note*&: The host name is used when matching the patterns, not its IP address.
23706 However, if a message is routed directly to an IP address without the use of a
23707 host name, for example, if a &(manualroute)& router contains a setting such as:
23709 route_list = *.a.example 192.168.34.23
23711 then the &"host name"& that is used when searching for a retry rule is the
23712 textual form of the IP address.
23714 .section "Retry rules for specific errors" "SECID161"
23715 .cindex "retry" "specific errors; specifying"
23716 The second field in a retry rule is the name of a particular error, or an
23717 asterisk, which matches any error. The errors that can be tested for are:
23720 .vitem &%auth_failed%&
23721 Authentication failed when trying to send to a host in the
23722 &%hosts_require_auth%& list in an &(smtp)& transport.
23724 .vitem &%data_4xx%&
23725 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing DATA command, either immediately
23726 after the command, or after sending the message's data.
23728 .vitem &%mail_4xx%&
23729 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing MAIL command.
23731 .vitem &%rcpt_4xx%&
23732 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing RCPT command.
23735 For the three 4&'xx'& errors, either the first or both of the x's can be given
23736 as specific digits, for example: &`mail_45x`& or &`rcpt_436`&. For example, to
23737 recognize 452 errors given to RCPT commands for addresses in a certain domain,
23738 and have retries every ten minutes with a one-hour timeout, you could set up a
23739 retry rule of this form:
23741 the.domain.name rcpt_452 F,1h,10m
23743 These errors apply to both outgoing SMTP (the &(smtp)& transport) and outgoing
23744 LMTP (either the &(lmtp)& transport, or the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode).
23747 .vitem &%lost_connection%&
23748 A server unexpectedly closed the SMTP connection. There may, of course,
23749 legitimate reasons for this (host died, network died), but if it repeats a lot
23750 for the same host, it indicates something odd.
23752 .vitem &%refused_MX%&
23753 A connection to a host obtained from an MX record was refused.
23755 .vitem &%refused_A%&
23756 A connection to a host not obtained from an MX record was refused.
23759 A connection was refused.
23761 .vitem &%timeout_connect_MX%&
23762 A connection attempt to a host obtained from an MX record timed out.
23764 .vitem &%timeout_connect_A%&
23765 A connection attempt to a host not obtained from an MX record timed out.
23767 .vitem &%timeout_connect%&
23768 A connection attempt timed out.
23770 .vitem &%timeout_MX%&
23771 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host
23772 obtained from an MX record.
23774 .vitem &%timeout_A%&
23775 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host not
23776 obtained from an MX record.
23779 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session.
23781 .vitem &%tls_required%&
23782 The server was required to use TLS (it matched &%hosts_require_tls%& in the
23783 &(smtp)& transport), but either did not offer TLS, or it responded with 4&'xx'&
23784 to STARTTLS, or there was a problem setting up the TLS connection.
23787 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
23790 .vitem &%quota_%&<&'time'&>
23791 .cindex "quota" "error testing in retry rule"
23792 .cindex "retry" "quota error testing"
23793 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
23794 transport, and the mailbox has not been accessed for <&'time'&>. For example,
23795 &'quota_4d'& applies to a quota error when the mailbox has not been accessed
23799 .cindex "mailbox" "time of last read"
23800 The idea of &%quota_%&<&'time'&> is to make it possible to have shorter
23801 timeouts when the mailbox is full and is not being read by its owner. Ideally,
23802 it should be based on the last time that the user accessed the mailbox.
23803 However, it is not always possible to determine this. Exim uses the following
23807 If the mailbox is a single file, the time of last access (the &"atime"&) is
23808 used. As no new messages are being delivered (because the mailbox is over
23809 quota), Exim does not access the file, so this is the time of last user access.
23811 .cindex "maildir format" "time of last read"
23812 For a maildir delivery, the time of last modification of the &_new_&
23813 subdirectory is used. As the mailbox is over quota, no new files are created in
23814 the &_new_& subdirectory, because no new messages are being delivered. Any
23815 change to the &_new_& subdirectory is therefore assumed to be the result of an
23816 MUA moving a new message to the &_cur_& directory when it is first read. The
23817 time that is used is therefore the last time that the user read a new message.
23819 For other kinds of multi-file mailbox, the time of last access cannot be
23820 obtained, so a retry rule that uses this type of error field is never matched.
23823 The quota errors apply both to system-enforced quotas and to Exim's own quota
23824 mechanism in the &(appendfile)& transport. The &'quota'& error also applies
23825 when a local delivery is deferred because a partition is full (the ENOSPC
23830 .section "Retry rules for specified senders" "SECID162"
23831 .cindex "retry" "rules; sender-specific"
23832 You can specify retry rules that apply only when the failing message has a
23833 specific sender. In particular, this can be used to define retry rules that
23834 apply only to bounce messages. The third item in a retry rule can be of this
23837 &`senders=`&<&'address list'&>
23839 The retry timings themselves are then the fourth item. For example:
23841 * rcpt_4xx senders=: F,1h,30m
23843 matches recipient 4&'xx'& errors for bounce messages sent to any address at any
23844 host. If the address list contains white space, it must be enclosed in quotes.
23847 a.domain rcpt_452 senders="xb.dom : yc.dom" G,8h,10m,1.5
23849 &*Warning*&: This facility can be unhelpful if it is used for host errors
23850 (which do not depend on the recipient). The reason is that the sender is used
23851 only to match the retry rule. Once the rule has been found for a host error,
23852 its contents are used to set a retry time for the host, and this will apply to
23853 all messages, not just those with specific senders.
23855 When testing retry rules using &%-brt%&, you can supply a sender using the
23856 &%-f%& command line option, like this:
23858 exim -f "" -brt user@dom.ain
23860 If you do not set &%-f%& with &%-brt%&, a retry rule that contains a senders
23861 list is never matched.
23867 .section "Retry parameters" "SECID163"
23868 .cindex "retry" "parameters in rules"
23869 The third (or fourth, if a senders list is present) field in a retry rule is a
23870 sequence of retry parameter sets, separated by semicolons. Each set consists of
23872 <&'letter'&>,<&'cutoff time'&>,<&'arguments'&>
23874 The letter identifies the algorithm for computing a new retry time; the cutoff
23875 time is the time beyond which this algorithm no longer applies, and the
23876 arguments vary the algorithm's action. The cutoff time is measured from the
23877 time that the first failure for the domain (combined with the local part if
23878 relevant) was detected, not from the time the message was received.
23880 .cindex "retry" "algorithms"
23881 .cindex "retry" "fixed intervals"
23882 .cindex "retry" "increasing intervals"
23883 .cindex "retry" "random intervals"
23884 The available algorithms are:
23887 &'F'&: retry at fixed intervals. There is a single time parameter specifying
23890 &'G'&: retry at geometrically increasing intervals. The first argument
23891 specifies a starting value for the interval, and the second a multiplier, which
23892 is used to increase the size of the interval at each retry.
23894 &'H'&: retry at randomized intervals. The arguments are as for &'G'&. For each
23895 retry, the previous interval is multiplied by the factor in order to get a
23896 maximum for the next interval. The minimum interval is the first argument of
23897 the parameter, and an actual interval is chosen randomly between them. Such a
23898 rule has been found to be helpful in cluster configurations when all the
23899 members of the cluster restart at once, and may therefore synchronize their
23900 queue processing times.
23903 When computing the next retry time, the algorithm definitions are scanned in
23904 order until one whose cutoff time has not yet passed is reached. This is then
23905 used to compute a new retry time that is later than the current time. In the
23906 case of fixed interval retries, this simply means adding the interval to the
23907 current time. For geometrically increasing intervals, retry intervals are
23908 computed from the rule's parameters until one that is greater than the previous
23909 interval is found. The main configuration variable
23910 .cindex "limit" "retry interval"
23911 .cindex "retry" "interval, maximum"
23912 .oindex "&%retry_interval_max%&"
23913 &%retry_interval_max%& limits the maximum interval between retries. It
23914 cannot be set greater than &`24h`&, which is its default value.
23916 A single remote domain may have a number of hosts associated with it, and each
23917 host may have more than one IP address. Retry algorithms are selected on the
23918 basis of the domain name, but are applied to each IP address independently. If,
23919 for example, a host has two IP addresses and one is unusable, Exim will
23920 generate retry times for it and will not try to use it until its next retry
23921 time comes. Thus the good IP address is likely to be tried first most of the
23924 .cindex "hints database" "use for retrying"
23925 Retry times are hints rather than promises. Exim does not make any attempt to
23926 run deliveries exactly at the computed times. Instead, a queue runner process
23927 starts delivery processes for delayed messages periodically, and these attempt
23928 new deliveries only for those addresses that have passed their next retry time.
23929 If a new message arrives for a deferred address, an immediate delivery attempt
23930 occurs only if the address has passed its retry time. In the absence of new
23931 messages, the minimum time between retries is the interval between queue runner
23932 processes. There is not much point in setting retry times of five minutes if
23933 your queue runners happen only once an hour, unless there are a significant
23934 number of incoming messages (which might be the case on a system that is
23935 sending everything to a smart host, for example).
23937 The data in the retry hints database can be inspected by using the
23938 &'exim_dumpdb'& or &'exim_fixdb'& utility programs (see chapter
23939 &<<CHAPutils>>&). The latter utility can also be used to change the data. The
23940 &'exinext'& utility script can be used to find out what the next retry times
23941 are for the hosts associated with a particular mail domain, and also for local
23942 deliveries that have been deferred.
23945 .section "Retry rule examples" "SECID164"
23946 Here are some example retry rules:
23948 alice@wonderland.fict.example quota_5d F,7d,3h
23949 wonderland.fict.example quota_5d
23950 wonderland.fict.example * F,1h,15m; G,2d,1h,2;
23951 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
23952 * refused_A F,2h,20m;
23953 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,5d,8h
23955 The first rule sets up special handling for mail to
23956 &'alice@wonderland.fict.example'& when there is an over-quota error and the
23957 mailbox has not been read for at least 5 days. Retries continue every three
23958 hours for 7 days. The second rule handles over-quota errors for all other local
23959 parts at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; the absence of a local part has the same
23960 effect as supplying &"*@"&. As no retry algorithms are supplied, messages that
23961 fail are bounced immediately if the mailbox has not been read for at least 5
23964 The third rule handles all other errors at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; retries
23965 happen every 15 minutes for an hour, then with geometrically increasing
23966 intervals until two days have passed since a delivery first failed. After the
23967 first hour there is a delay of one hour, then two hours, then four hours, and
23968 so on (this is a rather extreme example).
23970 The fourth rule controls retries for the domain &'lookingglass.fict.example'&.
23971 They happen every 30 minutes for 24 hours only. The remaining two rules handle
23972 all other domains, with special action for connection refusal from hosts that
23973 were not obtained from an MX record.
23975 The final rule in a retry configuration should always have asterisks in the
23976 first two fields so as to provide a general catch-all for any addresses that do
23977 not have their own special handling. This example tries every 15 minutes for 2
23978 hours, then with intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
23979 1.5 up to 16 hours, then every 8 hours up to 5 days.
23983 .section "Timeout of retry data" "SECID165"
23984 .cindex "timeout" "of retry data"
23985 .oindex "&%retry_data_expire%&"
23986 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
23987 .cindex "retry" "timeout of data"
23988 Exim timestamps the data that it writes to its retry hints database. When it
23989 consults the data during a delivery it ignores any that is older than the value
23990 set in &%retry_data_expire%& (default 7 days). If, for example, a host hasn't
23991 been tried for 7 days, Exim will try to deliver to it immediately a message
23992 arrives, and if that fails, it will calculate a retry time as if it were
23993 failing for the first time.
23995 This improves the behaviour for messages routed to rarely-used hosts such as MX
23996 backups. If such a host was down at one time, and happens to be down again when
23997 Exim tries a month later, using the old retry data would imply that it had been
23998 down all the time, which is not a justified assumption.
24000 If a host really is permanently dead, this behaviour causes a burst of retries
24001 every now and again, but only if messages routed to it are rare. If there is a
24002 message at least once every 7 days the retry data never expires.
24007 .section "Long-term failures" "SECID166"
24008 .cindex "delivery failure, long-term"
24009 .cindex "retry" "after long-term failure"
24010 Special processing happens when an email address has been failing for so long
24011 that the cutoff time for the last algorithm is reached. For example, using the
24012 default retry rule:
24014 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
24016 the cutoff time is four days. Reaching the retry cutoff is independent of how
24017 long any specific message has been failing; it is the length of continuous
24018 failure for the recipient address that counts.
24020 When the cutoff time is reached for a local delivery, or for all the IP
24021 addresses associated with a remote delivery, a subsequent delivery failure
24022 causes Exim to give up on the address, and a bounce message is generated.
24023 In order to cater for new messages that use the failing address, a next retry
24024 time is still computed from the final algorithm, and is used as follows:
24026 For local deliveries, one delivery attempt is always made for any subsequent
24027 messages. If this delivery fails, the address fails immediately. The
24028 post-cutoff retry time is not used.
24030 If the delivery is remote, there are two possibilities, controlled by the
24031 .oindex "&%delay_after_cutoff%&"
24032 &%delay_after_cutoff%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. The option is true by
24033 default. Until the post-cutoff retry time for one of the IP addresses is
24034 reached, the failing email address is bounced immediately, without a delivery
24035 attempt taking place. After that time, one new delivery attempt is made to
24036 those IP addresses that are past their retry times, and if that still fails,
24037 the address is bounced and new retry times are computed.
24039 In other words, when all the hosts for a given email address have been failing
24040 for a long time, Exim bounces rather then defers until one of the hosts' retry
24041 times is reached. Then it tries once, and bounces if that attempt fails. This
24042 behaviour ensures that few resources are wasted in repeatedly trying to deliver
24043 to a broken destination, but if the host does recover, Exim will eventually
24046 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
24047 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those IP
24048 addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
24049 no suitable IP addresses, or if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other
24050 words, it does not delay when a new message arrives, but tries the expired
24051 addresses immediately, unless they have been tried since the message arrived.
24052 If there is a continuous stream of messages for the failing domains, setting
24053 &%delay_after_cutoff%& false means that there will be many more attempts to
24054 deliver to permanently failing IP addresses than when &%delay_after_cutoff%& is
24057 .section "Deliveries that work intermittently" "SECID167"
24058 .cindex "retry" "intermittently working deliveries"
24059 Some additional logic is needed to cope with cases where a host is
24060 intermittently available, or when a message has some attribute that prevents
24061 its delivery when others to the same address get through. In this situation,
24062 because some messages are successfully delivered, the &"retry clock"& for the
24063 host or address keeps getting reset by the successful deliveries, and so
24064 failing messages remain on the queue for ever because the cutoff time is never
24067 Two exceptional actions are applied to prevent this happening. The first
24068 applies to errors that are related to a message rather than a remote host.
24069 Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& has a discussion of the different kinds of error;
24070 examples of message-related errors are 4&'xx'& responses to MAIL or DATA
24071 commands, and quota failures. For this type of error, if a message's arrival
24072 time is earlier than the &"first failed"& time for the error, the earlier time
24073 is used when scanning the retry rules to decide when to try next and when to
24074 time out the address.
24076 The exceptional second action applies in all cases. If a message has been on
24077 the queue for longer than the cutoff time of any applicable retry rule for a
24078 given address, a delivery is attempted for that address, even if it is not yet
24079 time, and if this delivery fails, the address is timed out. A new retry time is
24080 not computed in this case, so that other messages for the same address are
24081 considered immediately.
24082 .ecindex IIDretconf1
24083 .ecindex IIDregconf2
24090 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24091 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24093 .chapter "SMTP authentication" "CHAPSMTPAUTH"
24094 .scindex IIDauthconf1 "SMTP" "authentication configuration"
24095 .scindex IIDauthconf2 "authentication"
24096 The &"authenticators"& section of Exim's run time configuration is concerned
24097 with SMTP authentication. This facility is an extension to the SMTP protocol,
24098 described in RFC 2554, which allows a client SMTP host to authenticate itself
24099 to a server. This is a common way for a server to recognize clients that are
24100 permitted to use it as a relay. SMTP authentication is not of relevance to the
24101 transfer of mail between servers that have no managerial connection with each
24104 .cindex "AUTH" "description of"
24105 Very briefly, the way SMTP authentication works is as follows:
24108 The server advertises a number of authentication &'mechanisms'& in response to
24109 the client's EHLO command.
24111 The client issues an AUTH command, naming a specific mechanism. The command
24112 may, optionally, contain some authentication data.
24114 The server may issue one or more &'challenges'&, to which the client must send
24115 appropriate responses. In simple authentication mechanisms, the challenges are
24116 just prompts for user names and passwords. The server does not have to issue
24117 any challenges &-- in some mechanisms the relevant data may all be transmitted
24118 with the AUTH command.
24120 The server either accepts or denies authentication.
24122 If authentication succeeds, the client may optionally make use of the AUTH
24123 option on the MAIL command to pass an authenticated sender in subsequent
24124 mail transactions. Authentication lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
24127 If authentication fails, the client may give up, or it may try a different
24128 authentication mechanism, or it may try transferring mail over the
24129 unauthenticated connection.
24132 If you are setting up a client, and want to know which authentication
24133 mechanisms the server supports, you can use Telnet to connect to port 25 (the
24134 SMTP port) on the server, and issue an EHLO command. The response to this
24135 includes the list of supported mechanisms. For example:
24137 &`$ `&&*&`telnet server.example 25`&*&
24138 &`Trying 192.168.34.25...`&
24139 &`Connected to server.example.`&
24140 &`Escape character is '^]'.`&
24141 &`220 server.example ESMTP Exim 4.20 ...`&
24142 &*&`ehlo client.example`&*&
24143 &`250-server.example Hello client.example [10.8.4.5]`&
24144 &`250-SIZE 52428800`&
24149 The second-last line of this example output shows that the server supports
24150 authentication using the PLAIN mechanism. In Exim, the different authentication
24151 mechanisms are configured by specifying &'authenticator'& drivers. Like the
24152 routers and transports, which authenticators are included in the binary is
24153 controlled by build-time definitions. The following are currently available,
24154 included by setting
24157 AUTH_CYRUS_SASL=yes
24160 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
24164 in &_Local/Makefile_&, respectively. The first of these supports the CRAM-MD5
24165 authentication mechanism (RFC 2195), and the second provides an interface to
24166 the Cyrus SASL authentication library.
24167 The third is an interface to Dovecot's authentication system, delegating the
24168 work via a socket interface.
24169 The fourth provides an interface to the GNU SASL authentication library, which
24170 provides mechanisms but typically not data sources.
24171 The fifth provides direct access to Heimdal GSSAPI, geared for Kerberos, but
24172 supporting setting a server keytab.
24173 The sixth can be configured to support
24174 the PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) or the LOGIN mechanism, which is
24175 not formally documented, but used by several MUAs. The seventh authenticator
24176 supports Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& mechanism.
24178 The authenticators are configured using the same syntax as other drivers (see
24179 section &<<SECTfordricon>>&). If no authenticators are required, no
24180 authentication section need be present in the configuration file. Each
24181 authenticator can in principle have both server and client functions. When Exim
24182 is receiving SMTP mail, it is acting as a server; when it is sending out
24183 messages over SMTP, it is acting as a client. Authenticator configuration
24184 options are provided for use in both these circumstances.
24186 To make it clear which options apply to which situation, the prefixes
24187 &%server_%& and &%client_%& are used on option names that are specific to
24188 either the server or the client function, respectively. Server and client
24189 functions are disabled if none of their options are set. If an authenticator is
24190 to be used for both server and client functions, a single definition, using
24191 both sets of options, is required. For example:
24195 public_name = CRAM-MD5
24196 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret1}fail}
24198 client_secret = secret2
24200 The &%server_%& option is used when Exim is acting as a server, and the
24201 &%client_%& options when it is acting as a client.
24203 Descriptions of the individual authenticators are given in subsequent chapters.
24204 The remainder of this chapter covers the generic options for the
24205 authenticators, followed by general discussion of the way authentication works
24208 &*Beware:*& the meaning of &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, ... varies on a per-driver and
24209 per-mechanism basis. Please read carefully to determine which variables hold
24210 account labels such as usercodes and which hold passwords or other
24211 authenticating data.
24213 Note that some mechanisms support two different identifiers for accounts: the
24214 &'authentication id'& and the &'authorization id'&. The contractions &'authn'&
24215 and &'authz'& are commonly encountered. The American spelling is standard here.
24216 Conceptually, authentication data such as passwords are tied to the identifier
24217 used to authenticate; servers may have rules to permit one user to act as a
24218 second user, so that after login the session is treated as though that second
24219 user had logged in. That second user is the &'authorization id'&. A robust
24220 configuration might confirm that the &'authz'& field is empty or matches the
24221 &'authn'& field. Often this is just ignored. The &'authn'& can be considered
24222 as verified data, the &'authz'& as an unverified request which the server might
24225 A &'realm'& is a text string, typically a domain name, presented by a server
24226 to a client to help it select an account and credentials to use. In some
24227 mechanisms, the client and server provably agree on the realm, but clients
24228 typically can not treat the realm as secure data to be blindly trusted.
24232 .section "Generic options for authenticators" "SECID168"
24233 .cindex "authentication" "generic options"
24234 .cindex "options" "generic; for authenticators"
24236 .option client_condition authenticators string&!! unset
24237 When Exim is authenticating as a client, it skips any authenticator whose
24238 &%client_condition%& expansion yields &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&. This can be
24239 used, for example, to skip plain text authenticators when the connection is not
24240 encrypted by a setting such as:
24242 client_condition = ${if !eq{$tls_out_cipher}{}}
24246 .option client_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
24247 When client authentication succeeds, this condition is expanded; the
24248 result is used in the log lines for outbound messasges.
24249 Typically it will be the user name used for authentication.
24252 .option driver authenticators string unset
24253 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available
24254 authenticators is to be used.
24257 .option public_name authenticators string unset
24258 This option specifies the name of the authentication mechanism that the driver
24259 implements, and by which it is known to the outside world. These names should
24260 contain only upper case letters, digits, underscores, and hyphens (RFC 2222),
24261 but Exim in fact matches them caselessly. If &%public_name%& is not set, it
24262 defaults to the driver's instance name.
24265 .option server_advertise_condition authenticators string&!! unset
24266 When a server is about to advertise an authentication mechanism, the condition
24267 is expanded. If it yields the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the
24268 mechanism is not advertised.
24269 If the expansion fails, the mechanism is not advertised. If the failure was not
24270 forced, and was not caused by a lookup defer, the incident is logged.
24271 See section &<<SECTauthexiser>>& below for further discussion.
24274 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
24275 This option must be set for a &%plaintext%& server authenticator, where it
24276 is used directly to control authentication. See section &<<SECTplainserver>>&
24279 For the &(gsasl)& authenticator, this option is required for various
24280 mechanisms; see chapter &<<CHAPgsasl>>& for details.
24282 For the other authenticators, &%server_condition%& can be used as an additional
24283 authentication or authorization mechanism that is applied after the other
24284 authenticator conditions succeed. If it is set, it is expanded when the
24285 authenticator would otherwise return a success code. If the expansion is forced
24286 to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary
24287 error code to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty
24288 string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
24289 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds. For any
24290 other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded string as
24294 .option server_debug_print authenticators string&!! unset
24295 If this option is set and authentication debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%&
24296 command line option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging
24297 output when the authenticator is run as a server. This can help with checking
24298 out the values of variables.
24299 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
24300 output, and Exim carries on processing.
24303 .option server_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
24304 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
24305 When an Exim server successfully authenticates a client, this string is
24306 expanded using data from the authentication, and preserved for any incoming
24307 messages in the variable &$authenticated_id$&. It is also included in the log
24308 lines for incoming messages. For example, a user/password authenticator
24309 configuration might preserve the user name that was used to authenticate, and
24310 refer to it subsequently during delivery of the message.
24311 If expansion fails, the option is ignored.
24314 .option server_mail_auth_condition authenticators string&!! unset
24315 This option allows a server to discard authenticated sender addresses supplied
24316 as part of MAIL commands in SMTP connections that are authenticated by the
24317 driver on which &%server_mail_auth_condition%& is set. The option is not used
24318 as part of the authentication process; instead its (unexpanded) value is
24319 remembered for later use.
24320 How it is used is described in the following section.
24326 .section "The AUTH parameter on MAIL commands" "SECTauthparamail"
24327 .cindex "authentication" "sender; authenticated"
24328 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
24329 When a client supplied an AUTH= item on a MAIL command, Exim applies
24330 the following checks before accepting it as the authenticated sender of the
24334 If the connection is not using extended SMTP (that is, HELO was used rather
24335 than EHLO), the use of AUTH= is a syntax error.
24337 If the value of the AUTH= parameter is &"<>"&, it is ignored.
24339 .vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
24340 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is defined, the ACL it specifies is run. While it is
24341 running, the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is set to the value obtained
24342 from the AUTH= parameter. If the ACL does not yield &"accept"&, the value of
24343 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. The &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& ACL may not
24344 return &"drop"& or &"discard"&. If it defers, a temporary error code (451) is
24345 given for the MAIL command.
24347 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is not defined, the value of the AUTH= parameter
24348 is accepted and placed in &$authenticated_sender$& only if the client has
24351 If the AUTH= value was accepted by either of the two previous rules, and
24352 the client has authenticated, and the authenticator has a setting for the
24353 &%server_mail_auth_condition%&, the condition is checked at this point. The
24354 valued that was saved from the authenticator is expanded. If the expansion
24355 fails, or yields an empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the value of
24356 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. If the expansion yields any other value,
24357 the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is retained and passed on with the
24362 When &$authenticated_sender$& is set for a message, it is passed on to other
24363 hosts to which Exim authenticates as a client. Do not confuse this value with
24364 &$authenticated_id$&, which is a string obtained from the authentication
24365 process, and which is not usually a complete email address.
24367 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
24368 Whenever an AUTH= value is ignored, the incident is logged. The ACL for
24369 MAIL, if defined, is run after AUTH= is accepted or ignored. It can
24370 therefore make use of &$authenticated_sender$&. The converse is not true: the
24371 value of &$sender_address$& is not yet set up when the &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&
24376 .section "Authentication on an Exim server" "SECTauthexiser"
24377 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim server"
24378 When Exim receives an EHLO command, it advertises the public names of those
24379 authenticators that are configured as servers, subject to the following
24383 The client host must match &%auth_advertise_hosts%& (default *).
24385 It the &%server_advertise_condition%& option is set, its expansion must not
24386 yield the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&.
24389 The order in which the authenticators are defined controls the order in which
24390 the mechanisms are advertised.
24392 Some mail clients (for example, some versions of Netscape) require the user to
24393 provide a name and password for authentication whenever AUTH is advertised,
24394 even though authentication may not in fact be needed (for example, Exim may be
24395 set up to allow unconditional relaying from the client by an IP address check).
24396 You can make such clients more friendly by not advertising AUTH to them.
24397 For example, if clients on the 10.9.8.0/24 network are permitted (by the ACL
24398 that runs for RCPT) to relay without authentication, you should set
24400 auth_advertise_hosts = ! 10.9.8.0/24
24402 so that no authentication mechanisms are advertised to them.
24404 The &%server_advertise_condition%& controls the advertisement of individual
24405 authentication mechanisms. For example, it can be used to restrict the
24406 advertisement of a particular mechanism to encrypted connections, by a setting
24409 server_advertise_condition = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{no}{yes}}
24411 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
24412 If the session is encrypted, &$tls_in_cipher$& is not empty, and so the expansion
24413 yields &"yes"&, which allows the advertisement to happen.
24415 When an Exim server receives an AUTH command from a client, it rejects it
24416 immediately if AUTH was not advertised in response to an earlier EHLO
24417 command. This is the case if
24420 The client host does not match &%auth_advertise_hosts%&; or
24422 No authenticators are configured with server options; or
24424 Expansion of &%server_advertise_condition%& blocked the advertising of all the
24425 server authenticators.
24429 Otherwise, Exim runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_auth%& in order
24430 to decide whether to accept the command. If &%acl_smtp_auth%& is not set,
24431 AUTH is accepted from any client host.
24433 If AUTH is not rejected by the ACL, Exim searches its configuration for a
24434 server authentication mechanism that was advertised in response to EHLO and
24435 that matches the one named in the AUTH command. If it finds one, it runs
24436 the appropriate authentication protocol, and authentication either succeeds or
24437 fails. If there is no matching advertised mechanism, the AUTH command is
24438 rejected with a 504 error.
24440 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
24441 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
24442 When a message is received from an authenticated host, the value of
24443 &$received_protocol$& is set to &"esmtpa"& or &"esmtpsa"& instead of &"esmtp"&
24444 or &"esmtps"&, and &$sender_host_authenticated$& contains the name (not the
24445 public name) of the authenticator driver that successfully authenticated the
24446 client from which the message was received. This variable is empty if there was
24447 no successful authentication.
24452 .section "Testing server authentication" "SECID169"
24453 .cindex "authentication" "testing a server"
24454 .cindex "AUTH" "testing a server"
24455 .cindex "base64 encoding" "creating authentication test data"
24456 Exim's &%-bh%& option can be useful for testing server authentication
24457 configurations. The data for the AUTH command has to be sent using base64
24458 encoding. A quick way to produce such data for testing is the following Perl
24462 printf ("%s", encode_base64(eval "\"$ARGV[0]\""));
24464 .cindex "binary zero" "in authentication data"
24465 This interprets its argument as a Perl string, and then encodes it. The
24466 interpretation as a Perl string allows binary zeros, which are required for
24467 some kinds of authentication, to be included in the data. For example, a
24468 command line to run this script on such data might be
24470 encode '\0user\0password'
24472 Note the use of single quotes to prevent the shell interpreting the
24473 backslashes, so that they can be interpreted by Perl to specify characters
24474 whose code value is zero.
24476 &*Warning 1*&: If either of the user or password strings starts with an octal
24477 digit, you must use three zeros instead of one after the leading backslash. If
24478 you do not, the octal digit that starts your string will be incorrectly
24479 interpreted as part of the code for the first character.
24481 &*Warning 2*&: If there are characters in the strings that Perl interprets
24482 specially, you must use a Perl escape to prevent them being misinterpreted. For
24483 example, a command such as
24485 encode '\0user@domain.com\0pas$$word'
24487 gives an incorrect answer because of the unescaped &"@"& and &"$"& characters.
24489 If you have the &%mimencode%& command installed, another way to do produce
24490 base64-encoded strings is to run the command
24492 echo -e -n `\0user\0password' | mimencode
24494 The &%-e%& option of &%echo%& enables the interpretation of backslash escapes
24495 in the argument, and the &%-n%& option specifies no newline at the end of its
24496 output. However, not all versions of &%echo%& recognize these options, so you
24497 should check your version before relying on this suggestion.
24501 .section "Authentication by an Exim client" "SECID170"
24502 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim client"
24503 The &(smtp)& transport has two options called &%hosts_require_auth%& and
24504 &%hosts_try_auth%&. When the &(smtp)& transport connects to a server that
24505 announces support for authentication, and the host matches an entry in either
24506 of these options, Exim (as a client) tries to authenticate as follows:
24509 For each authenticator that is configured as a client, in the order in which
24510 they are defined in the configuration, it searches the authentication
24511 mechanisms announced by the server for one whose name matches the public name
24512 of the authenticator.
24515 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
24516 When it finds one that matches, it runs the authenticator's client code. The
24517 variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available for any string expansions
24518 that the client might do. They are set to the server's name and IP address. If
24519 any expansion is forced to fail, the authentication attempt is abandoned, and
24520 Exim moves on to the next authenticator. Otherwise an expansion failure causes
24521 delivery to be deferred.
24523 If the result of the authentication attempt is a temporary error or a timeout,
24524 Exim abandons trying to send the message to the host for the moment. It will
24525 try again later. If there are any backup hosts available, they are tried in the
24528 If the response to authentication is a permanent error (5&'xx'& code), Exim
24529 carries on searching the list of authenticators and tries another one if
24530 possible. If all authentication attempts give permanent errors, or if there are
24531 no attempts because no mechanisms match (or option expansions force failure),
24532 what happens depends on whether the host matches &%hosts_require_auth%& or
24533 &%hosts_try_auth%&. In the first case, a temporary error is generated, and
24534 delivery is deferred. The error can be detected in the retry rules, and thereby
24535 turned into a permanent error if you wish. In the second case, Exim tries to
24536 deliver the message unauthenticated.
24539 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
24540 When Exim has authenticated itself to a remote server, it adds the AUTH
24541 parameter to the MAIL commands it sends, if it has an authenticated sender for
24542 the message. If the message came from a remote host, the authenticated sender
24543 is the one that was receiving on an incoming MAIL command, provided that the
24544 incoming connection was authenticated and the &%server_mail_auth%& condition
24545 allowed the authenticated sender to be retained. If a local process calls Exim
24546 to send a message, the sender address that is built from the login name and
24547 &%qualify_domain%& is treated as authenticated. However, if the
24548 &%authenticated_sender%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it overrides
24549 the authenticated sender that was received with the message.
24550 .ecindex IIDauthconf1
24551 .ecindex IIDauthconf2
24558 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24559 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24561 .chapter "The plaintext authenticator" "CHAPplaintext"
24562 .scindex IIDplaiauth1 "&(plaintext)& authenticator"
24563 .scindex IIDplaiauth2 "authenticators" "&(plaintext)&"
24564 The &(plaintext)& authenticator can be configured to support the PLAIN and
24565 LOGIN authentication mechanisms, both of which transfer authentication data as
24566 plain (unencrypted) text (though base64 encoded). The use of plain text is a
24567 security risk; you are strongly advised to insist on the use of SMTP encryption
24568 (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&) if you use the PLAIN or LOGIN mechanisms. If you do
24569 use unencrypted plain text, you should not use the same passwords for SMTP
24570 connections as you do for login accounts.
24572 .section "Plaintext options" "SECID171"
24573 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (server)"
24574 When configured as a server, &(plaintext)& uses the following options:
24576 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
24577 This is actually a global authentication option, but it must be set in order to
24578 configure the &(plaintext)& driver as a server. Its use is described below.
24580 .option server_prompts plaintext string&!! unset
24581 The contents of this option, after expansion, must be a colon-separated list of
24582 prompt strings. If expansion fails, a temporary authentication rejection is
24585 .section "Using plaintext in a server" "SECTplainserver"
24586 .cindex "AUTH" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
24587 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
24588 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" &&&
24589 "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
24590 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
24591 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
24593 When running as a server, &(plaintext)& performs the authentication test by
24594 expanding a string. The data sent by the client with the AUTH command, or in
24595 response to subsequent prompts, is base64 encoded, and so may contain any byte
24596 values when decoded. If any data is supplied with the command, it is treated as
24597 a list of strings, separated by NULs (binary zeros), the first three of which
24598 are placed in the expansion variables &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, and &$auth3$&
24599 (neither LOGIN nor PLAIN uses more than three strings).
24601 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the values are also placed in
24602 the expansion variables &$1$&, &$2$&, and &$3$&. However, the use of these
24603 variables for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in
24604 string expansions that also use them for other things.
24606 If there are more strings in &%server_prompts%& than the number of strings
24607 supplied with the AUTH command, the remaining prompts are used to obtain more
24608 data. Each response from the client may be a list of NUL-separated strings.
24610 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
24611 Once a sufficient number of data strings have been received,
24612 &%server_condition%& is expanded. If the expansion is forced to fail,
24613 authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary error code
24614 to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty string,
24615 &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
24616 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds and the
24617 generic &%server_set_id%& option is expanded and saved in &$authenticated_id$&.
24618 For any other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded
24619 string as the error text, and the failed id saved in
24620 &$authenticated_fail_id$&.
24622 &*Warning*&: If you use a lookup in the expansion to find the user's
24623 password, be sure to make the authentication fail if the user is unknown.
24624 There are good and bad examples at the end of the next section.
24628 .section "The PLAIN authentication mechanism" "SECID172"
24629 .cindex "PLAIN authentication mechanism"
24630 .cindex "authentication" "PLAIN mechanism"
24631 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
24632 The PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) specifies that three strings be
24633 sent as one item of data (that is, one combined string containing two NUL
24634 separators). The data is sent either as part of the AUTH command, or
24635 subsequently in response to an empty prompt from the server.
24637 The second and third strings are a user name and a corresponding password.
24638 Using a single fixed user name and password as an example, this could be
24639 configured as follows:
24643 public_name = PLAIN
24645 server_condition = \
24646 ${if and {{eq{$auth2}{username}}{eq{$auth3}{mysecret}}}}
24647 server_set_id = $auth2
24649 Note that the default result strings from &%if%& (&"true"& or an empty string)
24650 are exactly what we want here, so they need not be specified. Obviously, if the
24651 password contains expansion-significant characters such as dollar, backslash,
24652 or closing brace, they have to be escaped.
24654 The &%server_prompts%& setting specifies a single, empty prompt (empty items at
24655 the end of a string list are ignored). If all the data comes as part of the
24656 AUTH command, as is commonly the case, the prompt is not used. This
24657 authenticator is advertised in the response to EHLO as
24661 and a client host can authenticate itself by sending the command
24663 AUTH PLAIN AHVzZXJuYW1lAG15c2VjcmV0
24665 As this contains three strings (more than the number of prompts), no further
24666 data is required from the client. Alternatively, the client may just send
24670 to initiate authentication, in which case the server replies with an empty
24671 prompt. The client must respond with the combined data string.
24673 The data string is base64 encoded, as required by the RFC. This example,
24674 when decoded, is <&'NUL'&>&`username`&<&'NUL'&>&`mysecret`&, where <&'NUL'&>
24675 represents a zero byte. This is split up into three strings, the first of which
24676 is empty. The &%server_condition%& option in the authenticator checks that the
24677 second two are &`username`& and &`mysecret`& respectively.
24679 Having just one fixed user name and password, as in this example, is not very
24680 realistic, though for a small organization with only a handful of
24681 authenticating clients it could make sense.
24683 A more sophisticated instance of this authenticator could use the user name in
24684 &$auth2$& to look up a password in a file or database, and maybe do an encrypted
24685 comparison (see &%crypteq%& in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). Here is a example of
24686 this approach, where the passwords are looked up in a DBM file. &*Warning*&:
24687 This is an incorrect example:
24689 server_condition = \
24690 ${if eq{$auth3}{${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}}}}
24692 The expansion uses the user name (&$auth2$&) as the key to look up a password,
24693 which it then compares to the supplied password (&$auth3$&). Why is this example
24694 incorrect? It works fine for existing users, but consider what happens if a
24695 non-existent user name is given. The lookup fails, but as no success/failure
24696 strings are given for the lookup, it yields an empty string. Thus, to defeat
24697 the authentication, all a client has to do is to supply a non-existent user
24698 name and an empty password. The correct way of writing this test is:
24700 server_condition = ${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}\
24701 {${if eq{$value}{$auth3}}} {false}}
24703 In this case, if the lookup succeeds, the result is checked; if the lookup
24704 fails, &"false"& is returned and authentication fails. If &%crypteq%& is being
24705 used instead of &%eq%&, the first example is in fact safe, because &%crypteq%&
24706 always fails if its second argument is empty. However, the second way of
24707 writing the test makes the logic clearer.
24710 .section "The LOGIN authentication mechanism" "SECID173"
24711 .cindex "LOGIN authentication mechanism"
24712 .cindex "authentication" "LOGIN mechanism"
24713 The LOGIN authentication mechanism is not documented in any RFC, but is in use
24714 in a number of programs. No data is sent with the AUTH command. Instead, a
24715 user name and password are supplied separately, in response to prompts. The
24716 plaintext authenticator can be configured to support this as in this example:
24720 public_name = LOGIN
24721 server_prompts = User Name : Password
24722 server_condition = \
24723 ${if and {{eq{$auth1}{username}}{eq{$auth2}{mysecret}}}}
24724 server_set_id = $auth1
24726 Because of the way plaintext operates, this authenticator accepts data supplied
24727 with the AUTH command (in contravention of the specification of LOGIN), but
24728 if the client does not supply it (as is the case for LOGIN clients), the prompt
24729 strings are used to obtain two data items.
24731 Some clients are very particular about the precise text of the prompts. For
24732 example, Outlook Express is reported to recognize only &"Username:"& and
24733 &"Password:"&. Here is an example of a LOGIN authenticator that uses those
24734 strings. It uses the &%ldapauth%& expansion condition to check the user
24735 name and password by binding to an LDAP server:
24739 public_name = LOGIN
24740 server_prompts = Username:: : Password::
24741 server_condition = ${if and{{ \
24744 user="uid=${quote_ldap_dn:$auth1},ou=people,o=example.org" \
24745 pass=${quote:$auth2} \
24746 ldap://ldap.example.org/} }} }
24747 server_set_id = uid=$auth1,ou=people,o=example.org
24749 We have to check that the username is not empty before using it, because LDAP
24750 does not permit empty DN components. We must also use the &%quote_ldap_dn%&
24751 operator to correctly quote the DN for authentication. However, the basic
24752 &%quote%& operator, rather than any of the LDAP quoting operators, is the
24753 correct one to use for the password, because quoting is needed only to make
24754 the password conform to the Exim syntax. At the LDAP level, the password is an
24755 uninterpreted string.
24758 .section "Support for different kinds of authentication" "SECID174"
24759 A number of string expansion features are provided for the purpose of
24760 interfacing to different ways of user authentication. These include checking
24761 traditionally encrypted passwords from &_/etc/passwd_& (or equivalent), PAM,
24762 Radius, &%ldapauth%&, &'pwcheck'&, and &'saslauthd'&. For details see section
24768 .section "Using plaintext in a client" "SECID175"
24769 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (client)"
24770 The &(plaintext)& authenticator has two client options:
24772 .option client_ignore_invalid_base64 plaintext boolean false
24773 If the client receives a server prompt that is not a valid base64 string,
24774 authentication is abandoned by default. However, if this option is set true,
24775 the error in the challenge is ignored and the client sends the response as
24778 .option client_send plaintext string&!! unset
24779 The string is a colon-separated list of authentication data strings. Each
24780 string is independently expanded before being sent to the server. The first
24781 string is sent with the AUTH command; any more strings are sent in response
24782 to prompts from the server. Before each string is expanded, the value of the
24783 most recent prompt is placed in the next &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable, starting
24784 with &$auth1$& for the first prompt. Up to three prompts are stored in this
24785 way. Thus, the prompt that is received in response to sending the first string
24786 (with the AUTH command) can be used in the expansion of the second string, and
24787 so on. If an invalid base64 string is received when
24788 &%client_ignore_invalid_base64%& is set, an empty string is put in the
24789 &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable.
24791 &*Note*&: You cannot use expansion to create multiple strings, because
24792 splitting takes priority and happens first.
24794 Because the PLAIN authentication mechanism requires NUL (binary zero) bytes in
24795 the data, further processing is applied to each string before it is sent. If
24796 there are any single circumflex characters in the string, they are converted to
24797 NULs. Should an actual circumflex be required as data, it must be doubled in
24800 This is an example of a client configuration that implements the PLAIN
24801 authentication mechanism with a fixed user name and password:
24805 public_name = PLAIN
24806 client_send = ^username^mysecret
24808 The lack of colons means that the entire text is sent with the AUTH
24809 command, with the circumflex characters converted to NULs. A similar example
24810 that uses the LOGIN mechanism is:
24814 public_name = LOGIN
24815 client_send = : username : mysecret
24817 The initial colon means that the first string is empty, so no data is sent with
24818 the AUTH command itself. The remaining strings are sent in response to
24820 .ecindex IIDplaiauth1
24821 .ecindex IIDplaiauth2
24826 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24827 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24829 .chapter "The cram_md5 authenticator" "CHID9"
24830 .scindex IIDcramauth1 "&(cram_md5)& authenticator"
24831 .scindex IIDcramauth2 "authenticators" "&(cram_md5)&"
24832 .cindex "CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism"
24833 .cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5 mechanism"
24834 The CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism is described in RFC 2195. The server
24835 sends a challenge string to the client, and the response consists of a user
24836 name and the CRAM-MD5 digest of the challenge string combined with a secret
24837 string (password) which is known to both server and client. Thus, the secret
24838 is not sent over the network as plain text, which makes this authenticator more
24839 secure than &(plaintext)&. However, the downside is that the secret has to be
24840 available in plain text at either end.
24843 .section "Using cram_md5 as a server" "SECID176"
24844 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (server)"
24845 This authenticator has one server option, which must be set to configure the
24846 authenticator as a server:
24848 .option server_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
24849 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(cram_md5)& authenticator"
24850 When the server receives the client's response, the user name is placed in
24851 the expansion variable &$auth1$&, and &%server_secret%& is expanded to
24852 obtain the password for that user. The server then computes the CRAM-MD5 digest
24853 that the client should have sent, and checks that it received the correct
24854 string. If the expansion of &%server_secret%& is forced to fail, authentication
24855 fails. If the expansion fails for some other reason, a temporary error code is
24856 returned to the client.
24858 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed
24859 in &$1$&. However, the use of this variables for this purpose is now
24860 deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use
24861 numeric variables for other things.
24863 For example, the following authenticator checks that the user name given by the
24864 client is &"ph10"&, and if so, uses &"secret"& as the password. For any other
24865 user name, authentication fails.
24869 public_name = CRAM-MD5
24870 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret}fail}
24871 server_set_id = $auth1
24873 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
24874 If authentication succeeds, the setting of &%server_set_id%& preserves the user
24875 name in &$authenticated_id$&. A more typical configuration might look up the
24876 secret string in a file, using the user name as the key. For example:
24880 public_name = CRAM-MD5
24881 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/authpwd}\
24883 server_set_id = $auth1
24885 Note that this expansion explicitly forces failure if the lookup fails
24886 because &$auth1$& contains an unknown user name.
24888 As another example, if you wish to re-use a Cyrus SASL sasldb2 file without
24889 using the relevant libraries, you need to know the realm to specify in the
24890 lookup and then ask for the &"userPassword"& attribute for that user in that
24895 public_name = CRAM-MD5
24896 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1:mail.example.org:userPassword}\
24897 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}}
24898 server_set_id = $auth1
24901 .section "Using cram_md5 as a client" "SECID177"
24902 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (client)"
24903 When used as a client, the &(cram_md5)& authenticator has two options:
24907 .option client_name cram_md5 string&!! "the primary host name"
24908 This string is expanded, and the result used as the user name data when
24909 computing the response to the server's challenge.
24912 .option client_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
24913 This option must be set for the authenticator to work as a client. Its value is
24914 expanded and the result used as the secret string when computing the response.
24918 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
24919 Different user names and secrets can be used for different servers by referring
24920 to &$host$& or &$host_address$& in the options. Forced failure of either
24921 expansion string is treated as an indication that this authenticator is not
24922 prepared to handle this case. Exim moves on to the next configured client
24923 authenticator. Any other expansion failure causes Exim to give up trying to
24924 send the message to the current server.
24926 A simple example configuration of a &(cram_md5)& authenticator, using fixed
24931 public_name = CRAM-MD5
24933 client_secret = secret
24935 .ecindex IIDcramauth1
24936 .ecindex IIDcramauth2
24940 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24941 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24943 .chapter "The cyrus_sasl authenticator" "CHID10"
24944 .scindex IIDcyrauth1 "&(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator"
24945 .scindex IIDcyrauth2 "authenticators" "&(cyrus_sasl)&"
24946 .cindex "Cyrus" "SASL library"
24948 The code for this authenticator was provided by Matthew Byng-Maddick of A L
24949 Digital Ltd (&url(http://www.aldigital.co.uk)).
24951 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides server support for the Cyrus SASL
24952 library implementation of the RFC 2222 (&"Simple Authentication and Security
24953 Layer"&). This library supports a number of authentication mechanisms,
24954 including PLAIN and LOGIN, but also several others that Exim does not support
24955 directly. In particular, there is support for Kerberos authentication.
24957 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides a gatewaying mechanism directly to
24958 the Cyrus interface, so if your Cyrus library can do, for example, CRAM-MD5,
24959 then so can the &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator. By default it uses the public
24960 name of the driver to determine which mechanism to support.
24962 Where access to some kind of secret file is required, for example in GSSAPI
24963 or CRAM-MD5, it is worth noting that the authenticator runs as the Exim
24964 user, and that the Cyrus SASL library has no way of escalating privileges
24965 by default. You may also find you need to set environment variables,
24966 depending on the driver you are using.
24968 The application name provided by Exim is &"exim"&, so various SASL options may
24969 be set in &_exim.conf_& in your SASL directory. If you are using GSSAPI for
24970 Kerberos, note that because of limitations in the GSSAPI interface,
24971 changing the server keytab might need to be communicated down to the Kerberos
24972 layer independently. The mechanism for doing so is dependent upon the Kerberos
24975 For example, for older releases of Heimdal, the environment variable KRB5_KTNAME
24976 may be set to point to an alternative keytab file. Exim will pass this
24977 variable through from its own inherited environment when started as root or the
24978 Exim user. The keytab file needs to be readable by the Exim user.
24979 With newer releases of Heimdal, a setuid Exim may cause Heimdal to discard the
24980 environment variable. In practice, for those releases, the Cyrus authenticator
24981 is not a suitable interface for GSSAPI (Kerberos) support. Instead, consider
24982 the &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator, described in chapter &<<CHAPheimdalgss>>&
24985 .section "Using cyrus_sasl as a server" "SECID178"
24986 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator has four private options. It puts the username
24987 (on a successful authentication) into &$auth1$&. For compatibility with
24988 previous releases of Exim, the username is also placed in &$1$&. However, the
24989 use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to
24990 confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables for other
24994 .option server_hostname cyrus_sasl string&!! "see below"
24995 This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
24996 library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&. It is up to the underlying
24997 SASL plug-in what it does with this data.
25000 .option server_mech cyrus_sasl string "see below"
25001 This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
25002 default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
25003 you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
25007 driver = cyrus_sasl
25008 public_name = X-ANYTHING
25009 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
25010 server_set_id = $auth1
25013 .option server_realm cyrus_sasl string&!! unset
25014 This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
25017 .option server_service cyrus_sasl string &`smtp`&
25018 This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
25021 For straightforward cases, you do not need to set any of the authenticator's
25022 private options. All you need to do is to specify an appropriate mechanism as
25023 the public name. Thus, if you have a SASL library that supports CRAM-MD5 and
25024 PLAIN, you could have two authenticators as follows:
25027 driver = cyrus_sasl
25028 public_name = CRAM-MD5
25029 server_set_id = $auth1
25032 driver = cyrus_sasl
25033 public_name = PLAIN
25034 server_set_id = $auth2
25036 Cyrus SASL does implement the LOGIN authentication method, even though it is
25037 not a standard method. It is disabled by default in the source distribution,
25038 but it is present in many binary distributions.
25039 .ecindex IIDcyrauth1
25040 .ecindex IIDcyrauth2
25045 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25046 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25047 .chapter "The dovecot authenticator" "CHAPdovecot"
25048 .scindex IIDdcotauth1 "&(dovecot)& authenticator"
25049 .scindex IIDdcotauth2 "authenticators" "&(dovecot)&"
25050 This authenticator is an interface to the authentication facility of the
25051 Dovecot POP/IMAP server, which can support a number of authentication methods.
25052 If you are using Dovecot to authenticate POP/IMAP clients, it might be helpful
25053 to use the same mechanisms for SMTP authentication. This is a server
25054 authenticator only. There is only one option:
25056 .option server_socket dovecot string unset
25058 This option must specify the socket that is the interface to Dovecot
25059 authentication. The &%public_name%& option must specify an authentication
25060 mechanism that Dovecot is configured to support. You can have several
25061 authenticators for different mechanisms. For example:
25065 public_name = PLAIN
25066 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
25067 server_set_id = $auth2
25072 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
25073 server_set_id = $auth1
25075 If the SMTP connection is encrypted, or if &$sender_host_address$& is equal to
25076 &$received_ip_address$& (that is, the connection is local), the &"secured"&
25077 option is passed in the Dovecot authentication command. If, for a TLS
25078 connection, a client certificate has been verified, the &"valid-client-cert"&
25079 option is passed. When authentication succeeds, the identity of the user
25080 who authenticated is placed in &$auth1$&.
25081 .ecindex IIDdcotauth1
25082 .ecindex IIDdcotauth2
25085 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25086 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25087 .chapter "The gsasl authenticator" "CHAPgsasl"
25088 .scindex IIDgsaslauth1 "&(gsasl)& authenticator"
25089 .scindex IIDgsaslauth2 "authenticators" "&(gsasl)&"
25090 .cindex "authentication" "GNU SASL"
25091 .cindex "authentication" "SASL"
25092 .cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
25093 .cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
25094 .cindex "authentication" "PLAIN"
25095 .cindex "authentication" "LOGIN"
25096 .cindex "authentication" "DIGEST-MD5"
25097 .cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5"
25098 .cindex "authentication" "SCRAM-SHA-1"
25099 The &(gsasl)& authenticator provides server integration for the GNU SASL
25100 library and the mechanisms it provides. This is new as of the 4.80 release
25101 and there are a few areas where the library does not let Exim smoothly
25102 scale to handle future authentication mechanisms, so no guarantee can be
25103 made that any particular new authentication mechanism will be supported
25104 without code changes in Exim.
25107 .option server_channelbinding gsasl boolean false
25108 Some authentication mechanisms are able to use external context at both ends
25109 of the session to bind the authentication to that context, and fail the
25110 authentication process if that context differs. Specifically, some TLS
25111 ciphersuites can provide identifying information about the cryptographic
25114 This means that certificate identity and verification becomes a non-issue,
25115 as a man-in-the-middle attack will cause the correct client and server to
25116 see different identifiers and authentication will fail.
25118 This is currently only supported when using the GnuTLS library. This is
25119 only usable by mechanisms which support "channel binding"; at time of
25120 writing, that's the SCRAM family.
25122 This defaults off to ensure smooth upgrade across Exim releases, in case
25123 this option causes some clients to start failing. Some future release
25124 of Exim may switch the default to be true.
25127 .option server_hostname gsasl string&!! "see below"
25128 This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
25129 library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
25130 Some mechanisms will use this data.
25133 .option server_mech gsasl string "see below"
25134 This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
25135 default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
25136 you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
25141 public_name = X-ANYTHING
25142 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
25143 server_set_id = $auth1
25147 .option server_password gsasl string&!! unset
25148 Various mechanisms need access to the cleartext password on the server, so
25149 that proof-of-possession can be demonstrated on the wire, without sending
25150 the password itself.
25152 The data available for lookup varies per mechanism.
25153 In all cases, &$auth1$& is set to the &'authentication id'&.
25154 The &$auth2$& variable will always be the &'authorization id'& (&'authz'&)
25155 if available, else the empty string.
25156 The &$auth3$& variable will always be the &'realm'& if available,
25157 else the empty string.
25159 A forced failure will cause authentication to defer.
25161 If using this option, it may make sense to set the &%server_condition%&
25162 option to be simply "true".
25165 .option server_realm gsasl string&!! unset
25166 This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
25167 Some mechanisms will use this data.
25170 .option server_scram_iter gsasl string&!! unset
25171 This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
25172 &$auth1$& is not available at evaluation time.
25173 (This may change, as we receive feedback on use)
25176 .option server_scram_salt gsasl string&!! unset
25177 This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
25178 &$auth1$& is not available at evaluation time.
25179 (This may change, as we receive feedback on use)
25182 .option server_service gsasl string &`smtp`&
25183 This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
25184 Some mechanisms will use this data.
25187 .section "&(gsasl)& auth variables" "SECTgsaslauthvar"
25188 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
25189 These may be set when evaluating specific options, as detailed above.
25190 They will also be set when evaluating &%server_condition%&.
25192 Unless otherwise stated below, the &(gsasl)& integration will use the following
25193 meanings for these variables:
25196 .vindex "&$auth1$&"
25197 &$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&
25199 .vindex "&$auth2$&"
25200 &$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&
25202 .vindex "&$auth3$&"
25203 &$auth3$&: the &'realm'&
25206 On a per-mechanism basis:
25209 .cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
25210 EXTERNAL: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'authorization id'&;
25211 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
25213 .cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
25214 ANONYMOUS: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'anonymous token'&;
25215 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
25217 .cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
25218 GSSAPI: &$auth1$& will be set to the &'GSSAPI Display Name'&;
25219 &$auth2$& will be set to the &'authorization id'&,
25220 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
25223 An &'anonymous token'& is something passed along as an unauthenticated
25224 identifier; this is analogous to FTP anonymous authentication passing an
25225 email address, or software-identifier@, as the "password".
25228 An example showing the password having the realm specified in the callback
25229 and demonstrating a Cyrus SASL to GSASL migration approach is:
25231 gsasl_cyrusless_crammd5:
25233 public_name = CRAM-MD5
25234 server_realm = imap.example.org
25235 server_password = ${lookup{$auth1:$auth3:userPassword}\
25236 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
25237 server_set_id = ${quote:$auth1}
25238 server_condition = yes
25242 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25243 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25245 .chapter "The heimdal_gssapi authenticator" "CHAPheimdalgss"
25246 .scindex IIDheimdalgssauth1 "&(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator"
25247 .scindex IIDheimdalgssauth2 "authenticators" "&(heimdal_gssapi)&"
25248 .cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
25249 .cindex "authentication" "Kerberos"
25250 The &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator provides server integration for the
25251 Heimdal GSSAPI/Kerberos library, permitting Exim to set a keytab pathname
25254 .option server_hostname heimdal_gssapi string&!! "see below"
25255 This option selects the hostname that is used, with &%server_service%&,
25256 for constructing the GSS server name, as a &'GSS_C_NT_HOSTBASED_SERVICE'&
25257 identifier. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
25259 .option server_keytab heimdal_gssapi string&!! unset
25260 If set, then Heimdal will not use the system default keytab (typically
25261 &_/etc/krb5.keytab_&) but instead the pathname given in this option.
25262 The value should be a pathname, with no &"file:"& prefix.
25264 .option server_service heimdal_gssapi string&!! "smtp"
25265 This option specifies the service identifier used, in conjunction with
25266 &%server_hostname%&, for building the identifer for finding credentials
25270 .section "&(heimdal_gssapi)& auth variables" "SECTheimdalgssauthvar"
25271 Beware that these variables will typically include a realm, thus will appear
25272 to be roughly like an email address already. The &'authzid'& in &$auth2$& is
25273 not verified, so a malicious client can set it to anything.
25275 The &$auth1$& field should be safely trustable as a value from the Key
25276 Distribution Center. Note that these are not quite email addresses.
25277 Each identifier is for a role, and so the left-hand-side may include a
25278 role suffix. For instance, &"joe/admin@EXAMPLE.ORG"&.
25280 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
25282 .vindex "&$auth1$&"
25283 &$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&, set to the GSS Display Name.
25285 .vindex "&$auth2$&"
25286 &$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&, sent within SASL encapsulation after
25287 authentication. If that was empty, this will also be set to the
25292 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25293 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25295 .chapter "The spa authenticator" "CHAPspa"
25296 .scindex IIDspaauth1 "&(spa)& authenticator"
25297 .scindex IIDspaauth2 "authenticators" "&(spa)&"
25298 .cindex "authentication" "Microsoft Secure Password"
25299 .cindex "authentication" "NTLM"
25300 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
25301 .cindex "NTLM authentication"
25302 The &(spa)& authenticator provides client support for Microsoft's &'Secure
25303 Password Authentication'& mechanism,
25304 which is also sometimes known as NTLM (NT LanMan). The code for client side of
25305 this authenticator was contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux, and much of it is
25306 taken from the Samba project (&url(http://www.samba.org)). The code for the
25307 server side was subsequently contributed by Tom Kistner. The mechanism works as
25311 After the AUTH command has been accepted, the client sends an SPA
25312 authentication request based on the user name and optional domain.
25314 The server sends back a challenge.
25316 The client builds a challenge response which makes use of the user's password
25317 and sends it to the server, which then accepts or rejects it.
25320 Encryption is used to protect the password in transit.
25324 .section "Using spa as a server" "SECID179"
25325 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (server)"
25326 The &(spa)& authenticator has just one server option:
25328 .option server_password spa string&!! unset
25329 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(spa)& authenticator"
25330 This option is expanded, and the result must be the cleartext password for the
25331 authenticating user, whose name is at this point in &$auth1$&. For
25332 compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed in
25333 &$1$&. However, the use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as
25334 it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables
25335 for other things. For example:
25340 server_password = \
25341 ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/exim/spa_clearpass}{$value}fail}
25343 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
25344 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
25350 .section "Using spa as a client" "SECID180"
25351 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (client)"
25352 The &(spa)& authenticator has the following client options:
25356 .option client_domain spa string&!! unset
25357 This option specifies an optional domain for the authentication.
25360 .option client_password spa string&!! unset
25361 This option specifies the user's password, and must be set.
25364 .option client_username spa string&!! unset
25365 This option specifies the user name, and must be set. Here is an example of a
25366 configuration of this authenticator for use with the mail servers at
25372 client_username = msn/msn_username
25373 client_password = msn_plaintext_password
25374 client_domain = DOMAIN_OR_UNSET
25376 .ecindex IIDspaauth1
25377 .ecindex IIDspaauth2
25383 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25384 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25386 .chapter "Encrypted SMTP connections using TLS/SSL" "CHAPTLS" &&&
25387 "Encrypted SMTP connections"
25388 .scindex IIDencsmtp1 "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
25389 .scindex IIDencsmtp2 "SMTP" "encryption"
25390 .cindex "TLS" "on SMTP connection"
25393 Support for TLS (Transport Layer Security), formerly known as SSL (Secure
25394 Sockets Layer), is implemented by making use of the OpenSSL library or the
25395 GnuTLS library (Exim requires GnuTLS release 1.0 or later). There is no
25396 cryptographic code in the Exim distribution itself for implementing TLS. In
25397 order to use this feature you must install OpenSSL or GnuTLS, and then build a
25398 version of Exim that includes TLS support (see section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&).
25399 You also need to understand the basic concepts of encryption at a managerial
25400 level, and in particular, the way that public keys, private keys, and
25401 certificates are used.
25403 RFC 3207 defines how SMTP connections can make use of encryption. Once a
25404 connection is established, the client issues a STARTTLS command. If the
25405 server accepts this, the client and the server negotiate an encryption
25406 mechanism. If the negotiation succeeds, the data that subsequently passes
25407 between them is encrypted.
25409 Exim's ACLs can detect whether the current SMTP session is encrypted or not,
25410 and if so, what cipher suite is in use, whether the client supplied a
25411 certificate, and whether or not that certificate was verified. This makes it
25412 possible for an Exim server to deny or accept certain commands based on the
25415 &*Warning*&: Certain types of firewall and certain anti-virus products can
25416 disrupt TLS connections. You need to turn off SMTP scanning for these products
25417 in order to get TLS to work.
25421 .section "Support for the legacy &""ssmtp""& (aka &""smtps""&) protocol" &&&
25423 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
25424 .cindex "smtps protocol"
25425 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
25426 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
25427 Early implementations of encrypted SMTP used a different TCP port from normal
25428 SMTP, and expected an encryption negotiation to start immediately, instead of
25429 waiting for a STARTTLS command from the client using the standard SMTP
25430 port. The protocol was called &"ssmtp"& or &"smtps"&, and port 465 was
25431 allocated for this purpose.
25433 This approach was abandoned when encrypted SMTP was standardized, but there are
25434 still some legacy clients that use it. Exim supports these clients by means of
25435 the &%tls_on_connect_ports%& global option. Its value must be a list of port
25436 numbers; the most common use is expected to be:
25438 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
25440 The port numbers specified by this option apply to all SMTP connections, both
25441 via the daemon and via &'inetd'&. You still need to specify all the ports that
25442 the daemon uses (by setting &%daemon_smtp_ports%& or &%local_interfaces%& or
25443 the &%-oX%& command line option) because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not add
25444 an extra port &-- rather, it specifies different behaviour on a port that is
25447 There is also a &%-tls-on-connect%& command line option. This overrides
25448 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&; it forces the legacy behaviour for all ports.
25455 .section "OpenSSL vs GnuTLS" "SECTopenvsgnu"
25456 .cindex "TLS" "OpenSSL &'vs'& GnuTLS"
25457 The first TLS support in Exim was implemented using OpenSSL. Support for GnuTLS
25458 followed later, when the first versions of GnuTLS were released. To build Exim
25459 to use GnuTLS, you need to set
25463 in Local/Makefile, in addition to
25467 You must also set TLS_LIBS and TLS_INCLUDE appropriately, so that the
25468 include files and libraries for GnuTLS can be found.
25470 There are some differences in usage when using GnuTLS instead of OpenSSL:
25473 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must contain the name of a file, not the
25474 name of a directory (for OpenSSL it can be either).
25476 The default value for &%tls_dhparam%& differs for historical reasons.
25478 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
25479 .vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
25480 Distinguished Name (DN) strings reported by the OpenSSL library use a slash for
25481 separating fields; GnuTLS uses commas, in accordance with RFC 2253. This
25482 affects the value of the &$tls_in_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables.
25484 OpenSSL identifies cipher suites using hyphens as separators, for example:
25485 DES-CBC3-SHA. GnuTLS historically used underscores, for example:
25486 RSA_ARCFOUR_SHA. What is more, OpenSSL complains if underscores are present
25487 in a cipher list. To make life simpler, Exim changes underscores to hyphens
25488 for OpenSSL and passes the string unchanged to GnuTLS (expecting the library
25489 to handle its own older variants) when processing lists of cipher suites in the
25490 &%tls_require_ciphers%& options (the global option and the &(smtp)& transport
25493 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& options operate differently, as described in the
25494 sections &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
25497 The &%tls_dh_min_bits%& SMTP transport option is only honoured by GnuTLS.
25498 When using OpenSSL, this option is ignored.
25499 (If an API is found to let OpenSSL be configured in this way,
25500 let the Exim Maintainers know and we'll likely use it).
25503 Some other recently added features may only be available in one or the other.
25504 This should be documented with the feature. If the documentation does not
25505 explicitly state that the feature is infeasible in the other TLS
25506 implementation, then patches are welcome.
25510 .section "GnuTLS parameter computation" "SECTgnutlsparam"
25511 This section only applies if &%tls_dhparam%& is set to &`historic`& or to
25512 an explicit path; if the latter, then the text about generation still applies,
25513 but not the chosen filename.
25514 By default, as of Exim 4.80 a hard-coded D-H prime is used.
25515 See the documentation of &%tls_dhparam%& for more information.
25517 GnuTLS uses D-H parameters that may take a substantial amount of time
25518 to compute. It is unreasonable to re-compute them for every TLS session.
25519 Therefore, Exim keeps this data in a file in its spool directory, called
25520 &_gnutls-params-NNNN_& for some value of NNNN, corresponding to the number
25522 The file is owned by the Exim user and is readable only by
25523 its owner. Every Exim process that start up GnuTLS reads the D-H
25524 parameters from this file. If the file does not exist, the first Exim process
25525 that needs it computes the data and writes it to a temporary file which is
25526 renamed once it is complete. It does not matter if several Exim processes do
25527 this simultaneously (apart from wasting a few resources). Once a file is in
25528 place, new Exim processes immediately start using it.
25530 For maximum security, the parameters that are stored in this file should be
25531 recalculated periodically, the frequency depending on your paranoia level.
25532 If you are avoiding using the fixed D-H primes published in RFCs, then you
25533 are concerned about some advanced attacks and will wish to do this; if you do
25534 not regenerate then you might as well stick to the standard primes.
25536 Arranging this is easy in principle; just delete the file when you want new
25537 values to be computed. However, there may be a problem. The calculation of new
25538 parameters needs random numbers, and these are obtained from &_/dev/random_&.
25539 If the system is not very active, &_/dev/random_& may delay returning data
25540 until enough randomness (entropy) is available. This may cause Exim to hang for
25541 a substantial amount of time, causing timeouts on incoming connections.
25543 The solution is to generate the parameters externally to Exim. They are stored
25544 in &_gnutls-params-N_& in PEM format, which means that they can be
25545 generated externally using the &(certtool)& command that is part of GnuTLS.
25547 To replace the parameters with new ones, instead of deleting the file
25548 and letting Exim re-create it, you can generate new parameters using
25549 &(certtool)& and, when this has been done, replace Exim's cache file by
25550 renaming. The relevant commands are something like this:
25553 [ look for file; assume gnutls-params-2236 is the most recent ]
25556 # chown exim:exim new-params
25557 # chmod 0600 new-params
25558 # certtool --generate-dh-params --bits 2236 >>new-params
25559 # openssl dhparam -noout -text -in new-params | head
25560 [ check the first line, make sure it's not more than 2236;
25561 if it is, then go back to the start ("rm") and repeat
25562 until the size generated is at most the size requested ]
25563 # chmod 0400 new-params
25564 # mv new-params gnutls-params-2236
25566 If Exim never has to generate the parameters itself, the possibility of
25567 stalling is removed.
25569 The filename changed in Exim 4.80, to gain the -bits suffix. The value which
25570 Exim will choose depends upon the version of GnuTLS in use. For older GnuTLS,
25571 the value remains hard-coded in Exim as 1024. As of GnuTLS 2.12.x, there is
25572 a way for Exim to ask for the "normal" number of bits for D-H public-key usage,
25573 and Exim does so. This attempt to remove Exim from TLS policy decisions
25574 failed, as GnuTLS 2.12 returns a value higher than the current hard-coded limit
25575 of the NSS library. Thus Exim gains the &%tls_dh_max_bits%& global option,
25576 which applies to all D-H usage, client or server. If the value returned by
25577 GnuTLS is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then the value will be clamped down
25578 to &%tls_dh_max_bits%&. The default value has been set at the current NSS
25579 limit, which is still much higher than Exim historically used.
25581 The filename and bits used will change as the GnuTLS maintainers change the
25582 value for their parameter &`GNUTLS_SEC_PARAM_NORMAL`&, as clamped by
25583 &%tls_dh_max_bits%&. At the time of writing (mid 2012), GnuTLS 2.12 recommends
25584 2432 bits, while NSS is limited to 2236 bits.
25586 In fact, the requested value will be *lower* than &%tls_dh_max_bits%&, to
25587 increase the chance of the generated prime actually being within acceptable
25588 bounds, as GnuTLS has been observed to overshoot. Note the check step in the
25589 procedure above. There is no sane procedure available to Exim to double-check
25590 the size of the generated prime, so it might still be too large.
25593 .section "Requiring specific ciphers in OpenSSL" "SECTreqciphssl"
25594 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers (OpenSSL)"
25595 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "OpenSSL"
25596 There is a function in the OpenSSL library that can be passed a list of cipher
25597 suites before the cipher negotiation takes place. This specifies which ciphers
25598 are acceptable. The list is colon separated and may contain names like
25599 DES-CBC3-SHA. Exim passes the expanded value of &%tls_require_ciphers%&
25600 directly to this function call.
25601 Many systems will install the OpenSSL manual-pages, so you may have
25602 &'ciphers(1)'& available to you.
25603 The following quotation from the OpenSSL
25604 documentation specifies what forms of item are allowed in the cipher string:
25607 It can consist of a single cipher suite such as RC4-SHA.
25609 It can represent a list of cipher suites containing a certain algorithm,
25610 or cipher suites of a certain type. For example SHA1 represents all
25611 ciphers suites using the digest algorithm SHA1 and SSLv3 represents all
25614 Lists of cipher suites can be combined in a single cipher string using
25615 the + character. This is used as a logical and operation. For example
25616 SHA1+DES represents all cipher suites containing the SHA1 and the DES
25620 Each cipher string can be optionally preceded by one of the characters &`!`&,
25623 If &`!`& is used, the ciphers are permanently deleted from the list. The
25624 ciphers deleted can never reappear in the list even if they are explicitly
25627 If &`-`& is used, the ciphers are deleted from the list, but some or all
25628 of the ciphers can be added again by later options.
25630 If &`+`& is used, the ciphers are moved to the end of the list. This
25631 option does not add any new ciphers; it just moves matching existing ones.
25634 If none of these characters is present, the string is interpreted as
25635 a list of ciphers to be appended to the current preference list. If the list
25636 includes any ciphers already present they will be ignored: that is, they will
25637 not be moved to the end of the list.
25640 The OpenSSL &'ciphers(1)'& command may be used to test the results of a given
25643 # note single-quotes to get ! past any shell history expansion
25644 $ openssl ciphers 'HIGH:!MD5:!SHA1'
25647 This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
25648 there's probably no identity verification anyway, but ups the ante on the
25649 submission ports where the administrator might have some influence on the
25650 choice of clients used:
25652 # OpenSSL variant; see man ciphers(1)
25653 tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
25660 .section "Requiring specific ciphers or other parameters in GnuTLS" &&&
25662 .cindex "GnuTLS" "specifying parameters for"
25663 .cindex "TLS" "specifying ciphers (GnuTLS)"
25664 .cindex "TLS" "specifying key exchange methods (GnuTLS)"
25665 .cindex "TLS" "specifying MAC algorithms (GnuTLS)"
25666 .cindex "TLS" "specifying protocols (GnuTLS)"
25667 .cindex "TLS" "specifying priority string (GnuTLS)"
25668 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "GnuTLS"
25669 The GnuTLS library allows the caller to provide a "priority string", documented
25670 as part of the &[gnutls_priority_init]& function. This is very similar to the
25671 ciphersuite specification in OpenSSL.
25673 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is treated as the GnuTLS priority string.
25675 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is available both as an global option,
25676 controlling how Exim behaves as a server, and also as an option of the
25677 &(smtp)& transport, controlling how Exim behaves as a client. In both cases
25678 the value is string expanded. The resulting string is not an Exim list and
25679 the string is given to the GnuTLS library, so that Exim does not need to be
25680 aware of future feature enhancements of GnuTLS.
25682 Documentation of the strings accepted may be found in the GnuTLS manual, under
25683 "Priority strings". This is online as
25684 &url(http://www.gnutls.org/manual/html_node/Priority-Strings.html),
25685 but beware that this relates to GnuTLS 3, which may be newer than the version
25686 installed on your system. If you are using GnuTLS 3,
25687 &url(http://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Listing-the-ciphersuites-in-a-priority-string, then the example code)
25688 on that site can be used to test a given string.
25690 Prior to Exim 4.80, an older API of GnuTLS was used, and Exim supported three
25691 additional options, "&%gnutls_require_kx%&", "&%gnutls_require_mac%&" and
25692 "&%gnutls_require_protocols%&". &%tls_require_ciphers%& was an Exim list.
25694 This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
25695 there's probably no identity verification anyway, and lowers security further
25696 by increasing compatibility; but this ups the ante on the submission ports
25697 where the administrator might have some influence on the choice of clients
25701 tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
25707 .section "Configuring an Exim server to use TLS" "SECID182"
25708 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim server"
25709 When Exim has been built with TLS support, it advertises the availability of
25710 the STARTTLS command to client hosts that match &%tls_advertise_hosts%&,
25711 but not to any others. The default value of this option is unset, which means
25712 that STARTTLS is not advertised at all. This default is chosen because you
25713 need to set some other options in order to make TLS available, and also it is
25714 sensible for systems that want to use TLS only as a client.
25716 If a client issues a STARTTLS command and there is some configuration
25717 problem in the server, the command is rejected with a 454 error. If the client
25718 persists in trying to issue SMTP commands, all except QUIT are rejected
25721 554 Security failure
25723 If a STARTTLS command is issued within an existing TLS session, it is
25724 rejected with a 554 error code.
25726 To enable TLS operations on a server, you must set &%tls_advertise_hosts%& to
25727 match some hosts. You can, of course, set it to * to match all hosts.
25728 However, this is not all you need to do. TLS sessions to a server won't work
25729 without some further configuration at the server end.
25731 It is rumoured that all existing clients that support TLS/SSL use RSA
25732 encryption. To make this work you need to set, in the server,
25734 tls_certificate = /some/file/name
25735 tls_privatekey = /some/file/name
25737 These options are, in fact, expanded strings, so you can make them depend on
25738 the identity of the client that is connected if you wish. The first file
25739 contains the server's X509 certificate, and the second contains the private key
25740 that goes with it. These files need to be readable by the Exim user, and must
25741 always be given as full path names. They can be the same file if both the
25742 certificate and the key are contained within it. If &%tls_privatekey%& is not
25743 set, or if its expansion is forced to fail or results in an empty string, this
25744 is assumed to be the case. The certificate file may also contain intermediate
25745 certificates that need to be sent to the client to enable it to authenticate
25746 the server's certificate.
25748 If you do not understand about certificates and keys, please try to find a
25749 source of this background information, which is not Exim-specific. (There are a
25750 few comments below in section &<<SECTcerandall>>&.)
25752 &*Note*&: These options do not apply when Exim is operating as a client &--
25753 they apply only in the case of a server. If you need to use a certificate in an
25754 Exim client, you must set the options of the same names in an &(smtp)&
25757 With just these options, an Exim server will be able to use TLS. It does not
25758 require the client to have a certificate (but see below for how to insist on
25759 this). There is one other option that may be needed in other situations. If
25761 tls_dhparam = /some/file/name
25763 is set, the SSL library is initialized for the use of Diffie-Hellman ciphers
25764 with the parameters contained in the file.
25765 Set this to &`none`& to disable use of DH entirely, by making no prime
25770 This may also be set to a string identifying a standard prime to be used for
25771 DH; if it is set to &`default`& or, for OpenSSL, is unset, then the prime
25772 used is &`ike23`&. There are a few standard primes available, see the
25773 documentation for &%tls_dhparam%& for the complete list.
25779 for a way of generating file data.
25781 The strings supplied for these three options are expanded every time a client
25782 host connects. It is therefore possible to use different certificates and keys
25783 for different hosts, if you so wish, by making use of the client's IP address
25784 in &$sender_host_address$& to control the expansion. If a string expansion is
25785 forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the option is not set.
25787 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
25788 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
25789 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
25790 The variable &$tls_in_cipher$& is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated for
25791 an incoming TLS connection. It is included in the &'Received:'& header of an
25792 incoming message (by default &-- you can, of course, change this), and it is
25793 also included in the log line that records a message's arrival, keyed by
25794 &"X="&, unless the &%tls_cipher%& log selector is turned off. The &%encrypted%&
25795 condition can be used to test for specific cipher suites in ACLs.
25797 Once TLS has been established, the ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands
25798 can check the name of the cipher suite and vary their actions accordingly. The
25799 cipher suite names vary, depending on which TLS library is being used. For
25800 example, OpenSSL uses the name DES-CBC3-SHA for the cipher suite which in other
25801 contexts is known as TLS_RSA_WITH_3DES_EDE_CBC_SHA. Check the OpenSSL or GnuTLS
25802 documentation for more details.
25804 For outgoing SMTP deliveries, &$tls_out_cipher$& is used and logged
25805 (again depending on the &%tls_cipher%& log selector).
25808 .section "Requesting and verifying client certificates" "SECID183"
25809 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
25810 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
25811 If you want an Exim server to request a certificate when negotiating a TLS
25812 session with a client, you must set either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or
25813 &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. You can, of course, set either of them to * to
25814 apply to all TLS connections. For any host that matches one of these options,
25815 Exim requests a certificate as part of the setup of the TLS session. The
25816 contents of the certificate are verified by comparing it with a list of
25817 expected certificates. These must be available in a file or,
25818 for OpenSSL only (not GnuTLS), a directory, identified by
25819 &%tls_verify_certificates%&.
25821 A file can contain multiple certificates, concatenated end to end. If a
25824 each certificate must be in a separate file, with a name (or a symbolic link)
25825 of the form <&'hash'&>.0, where <&'hash'&> is a hash value constructed from the
25826 certificate. You can compute the relevant hash by running the command
25828 openssl x509 -hash -noout -in /cert/file
25830 where &_/cert/file_& contains a single certificate.
25832 The difference between &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is
25833 what happens if the client does not supply a certificate, or if the certificate
25834 does not match any of the certificates in the collection named by
25835 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. If the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&, the
25836 attempt to set up a TLS session is aborted, and the incoming connection is
25837 dropped. If the client matches &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, the (encrypted) SMTP
25838 session continues. ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands can detect the
25839 fact that no certificate was verified, and vary their actions accordingly. For
25840 example, you can insist on a certificate before accepting a message for
25841 relaying, but not when the message is destined for local delivery.
25843 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
25844 When a client supplies a certificate (whether it verifies or not), the value of
25845 the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the variable
25846 &$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing of the message.
25848 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
25849 Because it is often a long text string, it is not included in the log line or
25850 &'Received:'& header by default. You can arrange for it to be logged, keyed by
25851 &"DN="&, by setting the &%tls_peerdn%& log selector, and you can use
25852 &%received_header_text%& to change the &'Received:'& header. When no
25853 certificate is supplied, &$tls_in_peerdn$& is empty.
25856 .section "Revoked certificates" "SECID184"
25857 .cindex "TLS" "revoked certificates"
25858 .cindex "revocation list"
25859 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list"
25860 Certificate issuing authorities issue Certificate Revocation Lists (CRLs) when
25861 certificates are revoked. If you have such a list, you can pass it to an Exim
25862 server using the global option called &%tls_crl%& and to an Exim client using
25863 an identically named option for the &(smtp)& transport. In each case, the value
25864 of the option is expanded and must then be the name of a file that contains a
25868 .section "Configuring an Exim client to use TLS" "SECID185"
25869 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
25870 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
25871 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
25872 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim client"
25873 The &%tls_cipher%& and &%tls_peerdn%& log selectors apply to outgoing SMTP
25874 deliveries as well as to incoming, the latter one causing logging of the
25875 server certificate's DN. The remaining client configuration for TLS is all
25876 within the &(smtp)& transport.
25878 It is not necessary to set any options to have TLS work in the &(smtp)&
25879 transport. If Exim is built with TLS support, and TLS is advertised by a
25880 server, the &(smtp)& transport always tries to start a TLS session. However,
25881 this can be prevented by setting &%hosts_avoid_tls%& (an option of the
25882 transport) to a list of server hosts for which TLS should not be used.
25884 If you do not want Exim to attempt to send messages unencrypted when an attempt
25885 to set up an encrypted connection fails in any way, you can set
25886 &%hosts_require_tls%& to a list of hosts for which encryption is mandatory. For
25887 those hosts, delivery is always deferred if an encrypted connection cannot be
25888 set up. If there are any other hosts for the address, they are tried in the
25891 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, Exim may try to deliver
25892 the message unencrypted. It always does this if the response to STARTTLS is
25893 a 5&'xx'& code. For a temporary error code, or for a failure to negotiate a TLS
25894 session after a success response code, what happens is controlled by the
25895 &%tls_tempfail_tryclear%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. If it is false,
25896 delivery to this host is deferred, and other hosts (if available) are tried. If
25897 it is true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'& response to
25898 STARTTLS, and if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent TLS
25899 negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
25900 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
25903 The &%tls_certificate%& and &%tls_privatekey%& options of the &(smtp)&
25904 transport provide the client with a certificate, which is passed to the server
25905 if it requests it. If the server is Exim, it will request a certificate only if
25906 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& matches the client.
25908 If the &%tls_verify_certificates%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it
25909 must name a file or,
25910 for OpenSSL only (not GnuTLS), a directory, that contains a collection of
25911 expected server certificates. The client verifies the server's certificate
25912 against this collection, taking into account any revoked certificates that are
25913 in the list defined by &%tls_crl%&.
25916 &%tls_require_ciphers%& is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it must contain a
25917 list of permitted cipher suites. If either of these checks fails, delivery to
25918 the current host is abandoned, and the &(smtp)& transport tries to deliver to
25919 alternative hosts, if any.
25922 These options must be set in the &(smtp)& transport for Exim to use TLS when it
25923 is operating as a client. Exim does not assume that a server certificate (set
25924 by the global options of the same name) should also be used when operating as a
25928 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
25929 All the TLS options in the &(smtp)& transport are expanded before use, with
25930 &$host$& and &$host_address$& containing the name and address of the server to
25931 which the client is connected. Forced failure of an expansion causes Exim to
25932 behave as if the relevant option were unset.
25934 .vindex &$tls_out_bits$&
25935 .vindex &$tls_out_cipher$&
25936 .vindex &$tls_out_peerdn$&
25937 .vindex &$tls_out_sni$&
25938 Before an SMTP connection is established, the
25939 &$tls_out_bits$&, &$tls_out_cipher$&, &$tls_out_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_sni$&
25940 variables are emptied. (Until the first connection, they contain the values
25941 that were set when the message was received.) If STARTTLS is subsequently
25942 successfully obeyed, these variables are set to the relevant values for the
25943 outgoing connection.
25947 .section "Use of TLS Server Name Indication" "SECTtlssni"
25948 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
25949 .vindex "&$tls_in_sni$&"
25950 .oindex "&%tls_in_sni%&"
25951 With TLS1.0 or above, there is an extension mechanism by which extra
25952 information can be included at various points in the protocol. One of these
25953 extensions, documented in RFC 6066 (and before that RFC 4366) is
25954 &"Server Name Indication"&, commonly &"SNI"&. This extension is sent by the
25955 client in the initial handshake, so that the server can examine the servername
25956 within and possibly choose to use different certificates and keys (and more)
25959 This is analagous to HTTP's &"Host:"& header, and is the main mechanism by
25960 which HTTPS-enabled web-sites can be virtual-hosted, many sites to one IP
25963 With SMTP to MX, there are the same problems here as in choosing the identity
25964 against which to validate a certificate: you can't rely on insecure DNS to
25965 provide the identity which you then cryptographically verify. So this will
25966 be of limited use in that environment.
25968 With SMTP to Submission, there is a well-defined hostname which clients are
25969 connecting to and can validate certificates against. Thus clients &*can*&
25970 choose to include this information in the TLS negotiation. If this becomes
25971 wide-spread, then hosters can choose to present different certificates to
25972 different clients. Or even negotiate different cipher suites.
25974 The &%tls_sni%& option on an SMTP transport is an expanded string; the result,
25975 if not empty, will be sent on a TLS session as part of the handshake. There's
25976 nothing more to it. Choosing a sensible value not derived insecurely is the
25977 only point of caution. The &$tls_out_sni$& variable will be set to this string
25978 for the lifetime of the client connection (including during authentication).
25980 Except during SMTP client sessions, if &$tls_in_sni$& is set then it is a string
25981 received from a client.
25982 It can be logged with the &%log_selector%& item &`+tls_sni`&.
25984 If the string &`tls_in_sni`& appears in the main section's &%tls_certificate%&
25985 option (prior to expansion) then the following options will be re-expanded
25986 during TLS session handshake, to permit alternative values to be chosen:
25989 .vindex "&%tls_certificate%&"
25990 &%tls_certificate%&
25992 .vindex "&%tls_crl%&"
25995 .vindex "&%tls_privatekey%&"
25998 .vindex "&%tls_verify_certificates%&"
25999 &%tls_verify_certificates%&
26002 Great care should be taken to deal with matters of case, various injection
26003 attacks in the string (&`../`& or SQL), and ensuring that a valid filename
26004 can always be referenced; it is important to remember that &$tls_sni$& is
26005 arbitrary unverified data provided prior to authentication.
26007 The Exim developers are proceeding cautiously and so far no other TLS options
26010 When Exim is built againt OpenSSL, OpenSSL must have been built with support
26011 for TLS Extensions. This holds true for OpenSSL 1.0.0+ and 0.9.8+ with
26012 enable-tlsext in EXTRACONFIGURE. If you invoke &(openssl s_client -h)& and
26013 see &`-servername`& in the output, then OpenSSL has support.
26015 When Exim is built against GnuTLS, SNI support is available as of GnuTLS
26016 0.5.10. (Its presence predates the current API which Exim uses, so if Exim
26017 built, then you have SNI support).
26021 .section "Multiple messages on the same encrypted TCP/IP connection" &&&
26023 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries with TLS"
26024 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
26025 Exim sends multiple messages down the same TCP/IP connection by starting up
26026 an entirely new delivery process for each message, passing the socket from
26027 one process to the next. This implementation does not fit well with the use
26028 of TLS, because there is quite a lot of state information associated with a TLS
26029 connection, not just a socket identification. Passing all the state information
26030 to a new process is not feasible. Consequently, Exim shuts down an existing TLS
26031 session before passing the socket to a new process. The new process may then
26032 try to start a new TLS session, and if successful, may try to re-authenticate
26033 if AUTH is in use, before sending the next message.
26035 The RFC is not clear as to whether or not an SMTP session continues in clear
26036 after TLS has been shut down, or whether TLS may be restarted again later, as
26037 just described. However, if the server is Exim, this shutdown and
26038 reinitialization works. It is not known which (if any) other servers operate
26039 successfully if the client closes a TLS session and continues with unencrypted
26040 SMTP, but there are certainly some that do not work. For such servers, Exim
26041 should not pass the socket to another process, because the failure of the
26042 subsequent attempt to use it would cause Exim to record a temporary host error,
26043 and delay other deliveries to that host.
26045 To test for this case, Exim sends an EHLO command to the server after
26046 closing down the TLS session. If this fails in any way, the connection is
26047 closed instead of being passed to a new delivery process, but no retry
26048 information is recorded.
26050 There is also a manual override; you can set &%hosts_nopass_tls%& on the
26051 &(smtp)& transport to match those hosts for which Exim should not pass
26052 connections to new processes if TLS has been used.
26057 .section "Certificates and all that" "SECTcerandall"
26058 .cindex "certificate" "references to discussion"
26059 In order to understand fully how TLS works, you need to know about
26060 certificates, certificate signing, and certificate authorities. This is not the
26061 place to give a tutorial, especially as I do not know very much about it
26062 myself. Some helpful introduction can be found in the FAQ for the SSL addition
26063 to Apache, currently at
26065 &url(http://www.modssl.org/docs/2.7/ssl_faq.html#ToC24)
26067 Other parts of the &'modssl'& documentation are also helpful, and have
26068 links to further files.
26069 Eric Rescorla's book, &'SSL and TLS'&, published by Addison-Wesley (ISBN
26070 0-201-61598-3), contains both introductory and more in-depth descriptions.
26071 Some sample programs taken from the book are available from
26073 &url(http://www.rtfm.com/openssl-examples/)
26077 .section "Certificate chains" "SECID186"
26078 The file named by &%tls_certificate%& may contain more than one
26079 certificate. This is useful in the case where the certificate that is being
26080 sent is validated by an intermediate certificate which the other end does
26081 not have. Multiple certificates must be in the correct order in the file.
26082 First the host's certificate itself, then the first intermediate
26083 certificate to validate the issuer of the host certificate, then the next
26084 intermediate certificate to validate the issuer of the first intermediate
26085 certificate, and so on, until finally (optionally) the root certificate.
26086 The root certificate must already be trusted by the recipient for
26087 validation to succeed, of course, but if it's not preinstalled, sending the
26088 root certificate along with the rest makes it available for the user to
26089 install if the receiving end is a client MUA that can interact with a user.
26092 .section "Self-signed certificates" "SECID187"
26093 .cindex "certificate" "self-signed"
26094 You can create a self-signed certificate using the &'req'& command provided
26095 with OpenSSL, like this:
26096 . ==== Do not shorten the duration here without reading and considering
26097 . ==== the text below. Please leave it at 9999 days.
26099 openssl req -x509 -newkey rsa:1024 -keyout file1 -out file2 \
26102 &_file1_& and &_file2_& can be the same file; the key and the certificate are
26103 delimited and so can be identified independently. The &%-days%& option
26104 specifies a period for which the certificate is valid. The &%-nodes%& option is
26105 important: if you do not set it, the key is encrypted with a passphrase
26106 that you are prompted for, and any use that is made of the key causes more
26107 prompting for the passphrase. This is not helpful if you are going to use
26108 this certificate and key in an MTA, where prompting is not possible.
26110 . ==== I expect to still be working 26 years from now. The less technical
26111 . ==== debt I create, in terms of storing up trouble for my later years, the
26112 . ==== happier I will be then. We really have reached the point where we
26113 . ==== should start, at the very least, provoking thought and making folks
26114 . ==== pause before proceeding, instead of leaving all the fixes until two
26115 . ==== years before 2^31 seconds after the 1970 Unix epoch.
26117 NB: we are now past the point where 9999 days takes us past the 32-bit Unix
26118 epoch. If your system uses unsigned time_t (most do) and is 32-bit, then
26119 the above command might produce a date in the past. Think carefully about
26120 the lifetime of the systems you're deploying, and either reduce the duration
26121 of the certificate or reconsider your platform deployment. (At time of
26122 writing, reducing the duration is the most likely choice, but the inexorable
26123 progression of time takes us steadily towards an era where this will not
26124 be a sensible resolution).
26126 A self-signed certificate made in this way is sufficient for testing, and
26127 may be adequate for all your requirements if you are mainly interested in
26128 encrypting transfers, and not in secure identification.
26130 However, many clients require that the certificate presented by the server be a
26131 user (also called &"leaf"& or &"site"&) certificate, and not a self-signed
26132 certificate. In this situation, the self-signed certificate described above
26133 must be installed on the client host as a trusted root &'certification
26134 authority'& (CA), and the certificate used by Exim must be a user certificate
26135 signed with that self-signed certificate.
26137 For information on creating self-signed CA certificates and using them to sign
26138 user certificates, see the &'General implementation overview'& chapter of the
26139 Open-source PKI book, available online at
26140 &url(http://ospkibook.sourceforge.net/).
26141 .ecindex IIDencsmtp1
26142 .ecindex IIDencsmtp2
26146 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26147 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26149 .chapter "Access control lists" "CHAPACL"
26150 .scindex IIDacl "&ACL;" "description"
26151 .cindex "control of incoming mail"
26152 .cindex "message" "controlling incoming"
26153 .cindex "policy control" "access control lists"
26154 Access Control Lists (ACLs) are defined in a separate section of the run time
26155 configuration file, headed by &"begin acl"&. Each ACL definition starts with a
26156 name, terminated by a colon. Here is a complete ACL section that contains just
26157 one very small ACL:
26161 accept hosts = one.host.only
26163 You can have as many lists as you like in the ACL section, and the order in
26164 which they appear does not matter. The lists are self-terminating.
26166 The majority of ACLs are used to control Exim's behaviour when it receives
26167 certain SMTP commands. This applies both to incoming TCP/IP connections, and
26168 when a local process submits a message using SMTP by specifying the &%-bs%&
26169 option. The most common use is for controlling which recipients are accepted
26170 in incoming messages. In addition, you can define an ACL that is used to check
26171 local non-SMTP messages. The default configuration file contains an example of
26172 a realistic ACL for checking RCPT commands. This is discussed in chapter
26173 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
26176 .section "Testing ACLs" "SECID188"
26177 The &%-bh%& command line option provides a way of testing your ACL
26178 configuration locally by running a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
26179 The host &'relay-test.mail-abuse.org'& provides a service for checking your
26180 relaying configuration (see section &<<SECTcheralcon>>& for more details).
26184 .section "Specifying when ACLs are used" "SECID189"
26185 .cindex "&ACL;" "options for specifying"
26186 In order to cause an ACL to be used, you have to name it in one of the relevant
26187 options in the main part of the configuration. These options are:
26188 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
26189 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
26190 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
26191 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
26192 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
26193 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
26194 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
26195 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
26196 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
26197 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
26198 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
26199 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
26200 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
26201 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
26204 .irow &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
26205 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
26206 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL at start of non-SMTP message"
26207 .irow &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
26208 .irow &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for start of SMTP connection"
26209 .irow &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL after DATA is complete"
26210 .irow &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
26211 .irow &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
26212 .irow &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for HELO or EHLO"
26213 .irow &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
26214 .irow &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL"
26215 .irow &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for content-scanning MIME parts"
26216 .irow &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
26217 .irow &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL at start of DATA command"
26218 .irow &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
26219 .irow &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
26220 .irow &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
26221 .irow &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
26224 For example, if you set
26226 acl_smtp_rcpt = small_acl
26228 the little ACL defined above is used whenever Exim receives a RCPT command
26229 in an SMTP dialogue. The majority of policy tests on incoming messages can be
26230 done when RCPT commands arrive. A rejection of RCPT should cause the
26231 sending MTA to give up on the recipient address contained in the RCPT
26232 command, whereas rejection at other times may cause the client MTA to keep on
26233 trying to deliver the message. It is therefore recommended that you do as much
26234 testing as possible at RCPT time.
26237 .section "The non-SMTP ACLs" "SECID190"
26238 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
26239 The non-SMTP ACLs apply to all non-interactive incoming messages, that is, they
26240 apply to batched SMTP as well as to non-SMTP messages. (Batched SMTP is not
26241 really SMTP.) Many of the ACL conditions (for example, host tests, and tests on
26242 the state of the SMTP connection such as encryption and authentication) are not
26243 relevant and are forbidden in these ACLs. However, the sender and recipients
26244 are known, so the &%senders%& and &%sender_domains%& conditions and the
26245 &$sender_address$& and &$recipients$& variables can be used. Variables such as
26246 &$authenticated_sender$& are also available. You can specify added header lines
26247 in any of these ACLs.
26249 The &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACL is run right at the start of receiving a
26250 non-SMTP message, before any of the message has been read. (This is the
26251 analogue of the &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL for SMTP input.) In the case of
26252 batched SMTP input, it runs after the DATA command has been reached. The
26253 result of this ACL is ignored; it cannot be used to reject a message. If you
26254 really need to, you could set a value in an ACL variable here and reject based
26255 on that in the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL. However, this ACL can be used to set
26256 controls, and in particular, it can be used to set
26258 control = suppress_local_fixups
26260 This cannot be used in the other non-SMTP ACLs because by the time they are
26261 run, it is too late.
26263 The &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with the
26264 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
26266 The &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL is run just before the &[local_scan()]& function. Any
26267 kind of rejection is treated as permanent, because there is no way of sending a
26268 temporary error for these kinds of message.
26271 .section "The SMTP connect ACL" "SECID191"
26272 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
26273 .oindex &%smtp_banner%&
26274 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& happens at the start of an SMTP
26275 session, after the test specified by &%host_reject_connection%& (which is now
26276 an anomaly) and any TCP Wrappers testing (if configured). If the connection is
26277 accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%& modifier, the contents of
26278 the message override the banner message that is otherwise specified by the
26279 &%smtp_banner%& option.
26282 .section "The EHLO/HELO ACL" "SECID192"
26283 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
26284 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
26285 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_helo%& happens when the client issues an
26286 EHLO or HELO command, after the tests specified by &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%&,
26287 &%helo_allow_chars%&, &%helo_verify_hosts%&, and &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&.
26288 Note that a client may issue more than one EHLO or HELO command in an SMTP
26289 session, and indeed is required to issue a new EHLO or HELO after successfully
26290 setting up encryption following a STARTTLS command.
26292 If the command is accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%&
26293 modifier, the message may not contain more than one line (it will be truncated
26294 at the first newline and a panic logged if it does). Such a message cannot
26295 affect the EHLO options that are listed on the second and subsequent lines of
26299 .section "The DATA ACLs" "SECID193"
26300 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
26301 Two ACLs are associated with the DATA command, because it is two-stage
26302 command, with two responses being sent to the client.
26303 When the DATA command is received, the ACL defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&
26304 is obeyed. This gives you control after all the RCPT commands, but before
26305 the message itself is received. It offers the opportunity to give a negative
26306 response to the DATA command before the data is transmitted. Header lines
26307 added by MAIL or RCPT ACLs are not visible at this time, but any that
26308 are defined here are visible when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run.
26310 You cannot test the contents of the message, for example, to verify addresses
26311 in the headers, at RCPT time or when the DATA command is received. Such
26312 tests have to appear in the ACL that is run after the message itself has been
26313 received, before the final response to the DATA command is sent. This is
26314 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%&, which is the second ACL that is
26315 associated with the DATA command.
26317 For both of these ACLs, it is not possible to reject individual recipients. An
26318 error response rejects the entire message. Unfortunately, it is known that some
26319 MTAs do not treat hard (5&'xx'&) responses to the DATA command (either
26320 before or after the data) correctly &-- they keep the message on their queues
26321 and try again later, but that is their problem, though it does waste some of
26324 The &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run after both the &%acl_smtp_dkim%& and
26325 the &%acl_smtp_mime%& ACLs.
26328 .section "The SMTP DKIM ACL" "SECTDKIMACL"
26329 The &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with DKIM support
26330 enabled (which is the default).
26332 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_dkim%& happens after a message has been
26333 received, and is executed for each DKIM signature found in a message. If not
26334 otherwise specified, the default action is to accept.
26336 This ACL is evaluated before &%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&.
26338 For details on the operation of DKIM, see chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>&.
26341 .section "The SMTP MIME ACL" "SECID194"
26342 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& option is available only when Exim is compiled with the
26343 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
26345 This ACL is evaluated after &%acl_smtp_dkim%& but before &%acl_smtp_data%&.
26348 .section "The QUIT ACL" "SECTQUITACL"
26349 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
26350 The ACL for the SMTP QUIT command is anomalous, in that the outcome of the ACL
26351 does not affect the response code to QUIT, which is always 221. Thus, the ACL
26352 does not in fact control any access. For this reason, the only verbs that are
26353 permitted are &%accept%& and &%warn%&.
26355 This ACL can be used for tasks such as custom logging at the end of an SMTP
26356 session. For example, you can use ACL variables in other ACLs to count
26357 messages, recipients, etc., and log the totals at QUIT time using one or
26358 more &%logwrite%& modifiers on a &%warn%& verb.
26360 &*Warning*&: Only the &$acl_c$&&'x'& variables can be used for this, because
26361 the &$acl_m$&&'x'& variables are reset at the end of each incoming message.
26363 You do not need to have a final &%accept%&, but if you do, you can use a
26364 &%message%& modifier to specify custom text that is sent as part of the 221
26367 This ACL is run only for a &"normal"& QUIT. For certain kinds of disastrous
26368 failure (for example, failure to open a log file, or when Exim is bombing out
26369 because it has detected an unrecoverable error), all SMTP commands from the
26370 client are given temporary error responses until QUIT is received or the
26371 connection is closed. In these special cases, the QUIT ACL does not run.
26374 .section "The not-QUIT ACL" "SECTNOTQUITACL"
26375 .vindex &$acl_smtp_notquit$&
26376 The not-QUIT ACL, specified by &%acl_smtp_notquit%&, is run in most cases when
26377 an SMTP session ends without sending QUIT. However, when Exim itself is in bad
26378 trouble, such as being unable to write to its log files, this ACL is not run,
26379 because it might try to do things (such as write to log files) that make the
26380 situation even worse.
26382 Like the QUIT ACL, this ACL is provided to make it possible to do customized
26383 logging or to gather statistics, and its outcome is ignored. The &%delay%&
26384 modifier is forbidden in this ACL, and the only permitted verbs are &%accept%&
26387 .vindex &$smtp_notquit_reason$&
26388 When the not-QUIT ACL is running, the variable &$smtp_notquit_reason$& is set
26389 to a string that indicates the reason for the termination of the SMTP
26390 connection. The possible values are:
26392 .irow &`acl-drop`& "Another ACL issued a &%drop%& command"
26393 .irow &`bad-commands`& "Too many unknown or non-mail commands"
26394 .irow &`command-timeout`& "Timeout while reading SMTP commands"
26395 .irow &`connection-lost`& "The SMTP connection has been lost"
26396 .irow &`data-timeout`& "Timeout while reading message data"
26397 .irow &`local-scan-error`& "The &[local_scan()]& function crashed"
26398 .irow &`local-scan-timeout`& "The &[local_scan()]& function timed out"
26399 .irow &`signal-exit`& "SIGTERM or SIGINT"
26400 .irow &`synchronization-error`& "SMTP synchronization error"
26401 .irow &`tls-failed`& "TLS failed to start"
26403 In most cases when an SMTP connection is closed without having received QUIT,
26404 Exim sends an SMTP response message before actually closing the connection.
26405 With the exception of the &`acl-drop`& case, the default message can be
26406 overridden by the &%message%& modifier in the not-QUIT ACL. In the case of a
26407 &%drop%& verb in another ACL, it is the message from the other ACL that is
26411 .section "Finding an ACL to use" "SECID195"
26412 .cindex "&ACL;" "finding which to use"
26413 The value of an &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& option is expanded before use, so
26414 you can use different ACLs in different circumstances. For example,
26416 acl_smtp_rcpt = ${if ={25}{$interface_port} \
26417 {acl_check_rcpt} {acl_check_rcpt_submit} }
26419 In the default configuration file there are some example settings for
26420 providing an RFC 4409 message submission service on port 587 and a
26421 non-standard &"smtps"& service on port 465. You can use a string
26422 expansion like this to choose an ACL for MUAs on these ports which is
26423 more appropriate for this purpose than the default ACL on port 25.
26425 The expanded string does not have to be the name of an ACL in the
26426 configuration file; there are other possibilities. Having expanded the
26427 string, Exim searches for an ACL as follows:
26430 If the string begins with a slash, Exim uses it as a file name, and reads its
26431 contents as an ACL. The lines are processed in the same way as lines in the
26432 Exim configuration file. In particular, continuation lines are supported, blank
26433 lines are ignored, as are lines whose first non-whitespace character is &"#"&.
26434 If the file does not exist or cannot be read, an error occurs (typically
26435 causing a temporary failure of whatever caused the ACL to be run). For example:
26437 acl_smtp_data = /etc/acls/\
26438 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch\
26439 {/etc/acllist}{$value}{default}}
26441 This looks up an ACL file to use on the basis of the host's IP address, falling
26442 back to a default if the lookup fails. If an ACL is successfully read from a
26443 file, it is retained in memory for the duration of the Exim process, so that it
26444 can be re-used without having to re-read the file.
26446 If the string does not start with a slash, and does not contain any spaces,
26447 Exim searches the ACL section of the configuration for an ACL whose name
26448 matches the string.
26450 If no named ACL is found, or if the string contains spaces, Exim parses
26451 the string as an inline ACL. This can save typing in cases where you just
26452 want to have something like
26454 acl_smtp_vrfy = accept
26456 in order to allow free use of the VRFY command. Such a string may contain
26457 newlines; it is processed in the same way as an ACL that is read from a file.
26463 .section "ACL return codes" "SECID196"
26464 .cindex "&ACL;" "return codes"
26465 Except for the QUIT ACL, which does not affect the SMTP return code (see
26466 section &<<SECTQUITACL>>& above), the result of running an ACL is either
26467 &"accept"& or &"deny"&, or, if some test cannot be completed (for example, if a
26468 database is down), &"defer"&. These results cause 2&'xx'&, 5&'xx'&, and 4&'xx'&
26469 return codes, respectively, to be used in the SMTP dialogue. A fourth return,
26470 &"error"&, occurs when there is an error such as invalid syntax in the ACL.
26471 This also causes a 4&'xx'& return code.
26473 For the non-SMTP ACL, &"defer"& and &"error"& are treated in the same way as
26474 &"deny"&, because there is no mechanism for passing temporary errors to the
26475 submitters of non-SMTP messages.
26478 ACLs that are relevant to message reception may also return &"discard"&. This
26479 has the effect of &"accept"&, but causes either the entire message or an
26480 individual recipient address to be discarded. In other words, it is a
26481 blackholing facility. Use it with care.
26483 If the ACL for MAIL returns &"discard"&, all recipients are discarded, and no
26484 ACL is run for subsequent RCPT commands. The effect of &"discard"& in a
26485 RCPT ACL is to discard just the one recipient address. If there are no
26486 recipients left when the message's data is received, the DATA ACL is not
26487 run. A &"discard"& return from the DATA or the non-SMTP ACL discards all the
26488 remaining recipients. The &"discard"& return is not permitted for the
26489 &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL.
26492 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "when all recipients discarded"
26493 The &[local_scan()]& function is always run, even if there are no remaining
26494 recipients; it may create new recipients.
26498 .section "Unset ACL options" "SECID197"
26499 .cindex "&ACL;" "unset options"
26500 The default actions when any of the &%acl_%&&'xxx'& options are unset are not
26501 all the same. &*Note*&: These defaults apply only when the relevant ACL is
26502 not defined at all. For any defined ACL, the default action when control
26503 reaches the end of the ACL statements is &"deny"&.
26505 For &%acl_smtp_quit%& and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& there is no default because
26506 these two are ACLs that are used only for their side effects. They cannot be
26507 used to accept or reject anything.
26509 For &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_smtp_auth%&, &%acl_smtp_connect%&,
26510 &%acl_smtp_data%&, &%acl_smtp_helo%&, &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&,
26511 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, and &%acl_smtp_starttls%&, the action
26512 when the ACL is not defined is &"accept"&.
26514 For the others (&%acl_smtp_etrn%&, &%acl_smtp_expn%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, and
26515 &%acl_smtp_vrfy%&), the action when the ACL is not defined is &"deny"&.
26516 This means that &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& must be defined in order to receive any
26517 messages over an SMTP connection. For an example, see the ACL in the default
26518 configuration file.
26523 .section "Data for message ACLs" "SECID198"
26524 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for message ACL"
26526 .vindex &$local_part$&
26527 .vindex &$sender_address$&
26528 .vindex &$sender_host_address$&
26529 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
26530 When a MAIL or RCPT ACL, or either of the DATA ACLs, is running, the variables
26531 that contain information about the host and the message's sender (for example,
26532 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_address$&) are set, and can be used in ACL
26533 statements. In the case of RCPT (but not MAIL or DATA), &$domain$& and
26534 &$local_part$& are set from the argument address. The entire SMTP command
26535 is available in &$smtp_command$&.
26537 When an ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL is running, the variables that
26538 contain information about the host are set, but &$sender_address$& is not yet
26539 set. Section &<<SECTauthparamail>>& contains a discussion of this parameter and
26542 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
26543 The &$message_size$& variable is set to the value of the SIZE parameter on
26544 the MAIL command at MAIL, RCPT and pre-data time, or to -1 if
26545 that parameter is not given. The value is updated to the true message size by
26546 the time the final DATA ACL is run (after the message data has been
26549 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
26550 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
26551 The &$rcpt_count$& variable increases by one for each RCPT command received.
26552 The &$recipients_count$& variable increases by one each time a RCPT command is
26553 accepted, so while an ACL for RCPT is being processed, it contains the number
26554 of previously accepted recipients. At DATA time (for both the DATA ACLs),
26555 &$rcpt_count$& contains the total number of RCPT commands, and
26556 &$recipients_count$& contains the total number of accepted recipients.
26562 .section "Data for non-message ACLs" "SECTdatfornon"
26563 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for non-message ACL"
26564 .vindex &$smtp_command_argument$&
26565 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
26566 When an ACL is being run for AUTH, EHLO, ETRN, EXPN, HELO, STARTTLS, or VRFY,
26567 the remainder of the SMTP command line is placed in &$smtp_command_argument$&,
26568 and the entire SMTP command is available in &$smtp_command$&.
26569 These variables can be tested using a &%condition%& condition. For example,
26570 here is an ACL for use with AUTH, which insists that either the session is
26571 encrypted, or the CRAM-MD5 authentication method is used. In other words, it
26572 does not permit authentication methods that use cleartext passwords on
26573 unencrypted connections.
26576 accept encrypted = *
26577 accept condition = ${if eq{${uc:$smtp_command_argument}}\
26579 deny message = TLS encryption or CRAM-MD5 required
26581 (Another way of applying this restriction is to arrange for the authenticators
26582 that use cleartext passwords not to be advertised when the connection is not
26583 encrypted. You can use the generic &%server_advertise_condition%& authenticator
26584 option to do this.)
26588 .section "Format of an ACL" "SECID199"
26589 .cindex "&ACL;" "format of"
26590 .cindex "&ACL;" "verbs, definition of"
26591 An individual ACL consists of a number of statements. Each statement starts
26592 with a verb, optionally followed by a number of conditions and &"modifiers"&.
26593 Modifiers can change the way the verb operates, define error and log messages,
26594 set variables, insert delays, and vary the processing of accepted messages.
26596 If all the conditions are met, the verb is obeyed. The same condition may be
26597 used (with different arguments) more than once in the same statement. This
26598 provides a means of specifying an &"and"& conjunction between conditions. For
26601 deny dnslists = list1.example
26602 dnslists = list2.example
26604 If there are no conditions, the verb is always obeyed. Exim stops evaluating
26605 the conditions and modifiers when it reaches a condition that fails. What
26606 happens then depends on the verb (and in one case, on a special modifier). Not
26607 all the conditions make sense at every testing point. For example, you cannot
26608 test a sender address in the ACL that is run for a VRFY command.
26611 .section "ACL verbs" "SECID200"
26612 The ACL verbs are as follows:
26615 .cindex "&%accept%& ACL verb"
26616 &%accept%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"accept"&. If any
26617 of the conditions are not met, what happens depends on whether &%endpass%&
26618 appears among the conditions (for syntax see below). If the failing condition
26619 is before &%endpass%&, control is passed to the next ACL statement; if it is
26620 after &%endpass%&, the ACL returns &"deny"&. Consider this statement, used to
26621 check a RCPT command:
26623 accept domains = +local_domains
26627 If the recipient domain does not match the &%domains%& condition, control
26628 passes to the next statement. If it does match, the recipient is verified, and
26629 the command is accepted if verification succeeds. However, if verification
26630 fails, the ACL yields &"deny"&, because the failing condition is after
26633 The &%endpass%& feature has turned out to be confusing to many people, so its
26634 use is not recommended nowadays. It is always possible to rewrite an ACL so
26635 that &%endpass%& is not needed, and it is no longer used in the default
26638 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier" "with &%accept%&"
26639 If a &%message%& modifier appears on an &%accept%& statement, its action
26640 depends on whether or not &%endpass%& is present. In the absence of &%endpass%&
26641 (when an &%accept%& verb either accepts or passes control to the next
26642 statement), &%message%& can be used to vary the message that is sent when an
26643 SMTP command is accepted. For example, in a RCPT ACL you could have:
26645 &`accept `&<&'some conditions'&>
26646 &` message = OK, I will allow you through today`&
26648 You can specify an SMTP response code, optionally followed by an &"extended
26649 response code"& at the start of the message, but the first digit must be the
26650 same as would be sent by default, which is 2 for an &%accept%& verb.
26652 If &%endpass%& is present in an &%accept%& statement, &%message%& specifies
26653 an error message that is used when access is denied. This behaviour is retained
26654 for backward compatibility, but current &"best practice"& is to avoid the use
26659 .cindex "&%defer%& ACL verb"
26660 &%defer%&: If all the conditions are true, the ACL returns &"defer"& which, in
26661 an SMTP session, causes a 4&'xx'& response to be given. For a non-SMTP ACL,
26662 &%defer%& is the same as &%deny%&, because there is no way of sending a
26663 temporary error. For a RCPT command, &%defer%& is much the same as using a
26664 &(redirect)& router and &`:defer:`& while verifying, but the &%defer%& verb can
26665 be used in any ACL, and even for a recipient it might be a simpler approach.
26669 .cindex "&%deny%& ACL verb"
26670 &%deny%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. If any of
26671 the conditions are not met, control is passed to the next ACL statement. For
26674 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
26676 rejects commands from hosts that are on a DNS black list.
26680 .cindex "&%discard%& ACL verb"
26681 &%discard%&: This verb behaves like &%accept%&, except that it returns
26682 &"discard"& from the ACL instead of &"accept"&. It is permitted only on ACLs
26683 that are concerned with receiving messages. When all the conditions are true,
26684 the sending entity receives a &"success"& response. However, &%discard%& causes
26685 recipients to be discarded. If it is used in an ACL for RCPT, just the one
26686 recipient is discarded; if used for MAIL, DATA or in the non-SMTP ACL, all the
26687 message's recipients are discarded. Recipients that are discarded before DATA
26688 do not appear in the log line when the &%received_recipients%& log selector is set.
26690 If the &%log_message%& modifier is set when &%discard%& operates,
26691 its contents are added to the line that is automatically written to the log.
26692 The &%message%& modifier operates exactly as it does for &%accept%&.
26696 .cindex "&%drop%& ACL verb"
26697 &%drop%&: This verb behaves like &%deny%&, except that an SMTP connection is
26698 forcibly closed after the 5&'xx'& error message has been sent. For example:
26700 drop message = I don't take more than 20 RCPTs
26701 condition = ${if > {$rcpt_count}{20}}
26703 There is no difference between &%deny%& and &%drop%& for the connect-time ACL.
26704 The connection is always dropped after sending a 550 response.
26707 .cindex "&%require%& ACL verb"
26708 &%require%&: If all the conditions are met, control is passed to the next ACL
26709 statement. If any of the conditions are not met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. For
26710 example, when checking a RCPT command,
26712 require message = Sender did not verify
26715 passes control to subsequent statements only if the message's sender can be
26716 verified. Otherwise, it rejects the command. Note the positioning of the
26717 &%message%& modifier, before the &%verify%& condition. The reason for this is
26718 discussed in section &<<SECTcondmodproc>>&.
26721 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
26722 &%warn%&: If all the conditions are true, a line specified by the
26723 &%log_message%& modifier is written to Exim's main log. Control always passes
26724 to the next ACL statement. If any condition is false, the log line is not
26725 written. If an identical log line is requested several times in the same
26726 message, only one copy is actually written to the log. If you want to force
26727 duplicates to be written, use the &%logwrite%& modifier instead.
26729 If &%log_message%& is not present, a &%warn%& verb just checks its conditions
26730 and obeys any &"immediate"& modifiers (such as &%control%&, &%set%&,
26731 &%logwrite%&, &%add_header%&, and &%remove_header%&) that appear before the
26732 first failing condition. There is more about adding header lines in section
26733 &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
26735 If any condition on a &%warn%& statement cannot be completed (that is, there is
26736 some sort of defer), the log line specified by &%log_message%& is not written.
26737 This does not include the case of a forced failure from a lookup, which
26738 is considered to be a successful completion. After a defer, no further
26739 conditions or modifiers in the &%warn%& statement are processed. The incident
26740 is logged, and the ACL continues to be processed, from the next statement
26744 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
26745 When one of the &%warn%& conditions is an address verification that fails, the
26746 text of the verification failure message is in &$acl_verify_message$&. If you
26747 want this logged, you must set it up explicitly. For example:
26749 warn !verify = sender
26750 log_message = sender verify failed: $acl_verify_message
26754 At the end of each ACL there is an implicit unconditional &%deny%&.
26756 As you can see from the examples above, the conditions and modifiers are
26757 written one to a line, with the first one on the same line as the verb, and
26758 subsequent ones on following lines. If you have a very long condition, you can
26759 continue it onto several physical lines by the usual backslash continuation
26760 mechanism. It is conventional to align the conditions vertically.
26764 .section "ACL variables" "SECTaclvariables"
26765 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables"
26766 There are some special variables that can be set during ACL processing. They
26767 can be used to pass information between different ACLs, different invocations
26768 of the same ACL in the same SMTP connection, and between ACLs and the routers,
26769 transports, and filters that are used to deliver a message. The names of these
26770 variables must begin with &$acl_c$& or &$acl_m$&, followed either by a digit or
26771 an underscore, but the remainder of the name can be any sequence of
26772 alphanumeric characters and underscores that you choose. There is no limit on
26773 the number of ACL variables. The two sets act as follows:
26775 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_c$& persist
26776 throughout an SMTP connection. They are never reset. Thus, a value that is set
26777 while receiving one message is still available when receiving the next message
26778 on the same SMTP connection.
26780 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_m$& persist only
26781 while a message is being received. They are reset afterwards. They are also
26782 reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting up a TLS session.
26785 When a message is accepted, the current values of all the ACL variables are
26786 preserved with the message and are subsequently made available at delivery
26787 time. The ACL variables are set by a modifier called &%set%&. For example:
26789 accept hosts = whatever
26790 set acl_m4 = some value
26791 accept authenticated = *
26792 set acl_c_auth = yes
26794 &*Note*&: A leading dollar sign is not used when naming a variable that is to
26795 be set. If you want to set a variable without taking any action, you can use a
26796 &%warn%& verb without any other modifiers or conditions.
26798 .oindex &%strict_acl_vars%&
26799 What happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL variable is
26800 referenced depends on the setting of the &%strict_acl_vars%& option. If it is
26801 false (the default), an empty string is substituted; if it is true, an
26802 error is generated.
26804 Versions of Exim before 4.64 have a limited set of numbered variables, but
26805 their names are compatible, so there is no problem with upgrading.
26808 .section "Condition and modifier processing" "SECTcondmodproc"
26809 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; processing"
26810 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; processing"
26811 An exclamation mark preceding a condition negates its result. For example:
26813 deny domains = *.dom.example
26814 !verify = recipient
26816 causes the ACL to return &"deny"& if the recipient domain ends in
26817 &'dom.example'& and the recipient address cannot be verified. Sometimes
26818 negation can be used on the right-hand side of a condition. For example, these
26819 two statements are equivalent:
26821 deny hosts = !192.168.3.4
26822 deny !hosts = 192.168.3.4
26824 However, for many conditions (&%verify%& being a good example), only left-hand
26825 side negation of the whole condition is possible.
26827 The arguments of conditions and modifiers are expanded. A forced failure
26828 of an expansion causes a condition to be ignored, that is, it behaves as if the
26829 condition is true. Consider these two statements:
26831 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
26832 {/some/file}{$value}fail}
26833 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
26834 {/some/file}{$value}{}}
26836 Each attempts to look up a list of acceptable senders. If the lookup succeeds,
26837 the returned list is searched, but if the lookup fails the behaviour is
26838 different in the two cases. The &%fail%& in the first statement causes the
26839 condition to be ignored, leaving no further conditions. The &%accept%& verb
26840 therefore succeeds. The second statement, however, generates an empty list when
26841 the lookup fails. No sender can match an empty list, so the condition fails,
26842 and therefore the &%accept%& also fails.
26844 ACL modifiers appear mixed in with conditions in ACL statements. Some of them
26845 specify actions that are taken as the conditions for a statement are checked;
26846 others specify text for messages that are used when access is denied or a
26847 warning is generated. The &%control%& modifier affects the way an incoming
26848 message is handled.
26850 The positioning of the modifiers in an ACL statement is important, because the
26851 processing of a verb ceases as soon as its outcome is known. Only those
26852 modifiers that have already been encountered will take effect. For example,
26853 consider this use of the &%message%& modifier:
26855 require message = Can't verify sender
26857 message = Can't verify recipient
26859 message = This message cannot be used
26861 If sender verification fails, Exim knows that the result of the statement is
26862 &"deny"&, so it goes no further. The first &%message%& modifier has been seen,
26863 so its text is used as the error message. If sender verification succeeds, but
26864 recipient verification fails, the second message is used. If recipient
26865 verification succeeds, the third message becomes &"current"&, but is never used
26866 because there are no more conditions to cause failure.
26868 For the &%deny%& verb, on the other hand, it is always the last &%message%&
26869 modifier that is used, because all the conditions must be true for rejection to
26870 happen. Specifying more than one &%message%& modifier does not make sense, and
26871 the message can even be specified after all the conditions. For example:
26874 !senders = *@my.domain.example
26875 message = Invalid sender from client host
26877 The &"deny"& result does not happen until the end of the statement is reached,
26878 by which time Exim has set up the message.
26882 .section "ACL modifiers" "SECTACLmodi"
26883 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; list of"
26884 The ACL modifiers are as follows:
26887 .vitem &*add_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
26888 This modifier specifies one or more header lines that are to be added to an
26889 incoming message, assuming, of course, that the message is ultimately
26890 accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
26892 .vitem &*continue*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
26893 .cindex "&%continue%& ACL modifier"
26894 .cindex "database" "updating in ACL"
26895 This modifier does nothing of itself, and processing of the ACL always
26896 continues with the next condition or modifier. The value of &%continue%& is in
26897 the side effects of expanding its argument. Typically this could be used to
26898 update a database. It is really just a syntactic tidiness, to avoid having to
26899 write rather ugly lines like this:
26901 &`condition = ${if eq{0}{`&<&'some expansion'&>&`}{true}{true}}`&
26903 Instead, all you need is
26905 &`continue = `&<&'some expansion'&>
26908 .vitem &*control*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
26909 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
26910 This modifier affects the subsequent processing of the SMTP connection or of an
26911 incoming message that is accepted. The effect of the first type of control
26912 lasts for the duration of the connection, whereas the effect of the second type
26913 lasts only until the current message has been received. The message-specific
26914 controls always apply to the whole message, not to individual recipients,
26915 even if the &%control%& modifier appears in a RCPT ACL.
26917 As there are now quite a few controls that can be applied, they are described
26918 separately in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. The &%control%& modifier can be used
26919 in several different ways. For example:
26921 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
26922 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. That comment applies only
26923 . ==== when xmlto and fop are used; formatting with sdop gets it right either
26927 It can be at the end of an &%accept%& statement:
26929 accept ...some conditions
26930 control = queue_only
26932 In this case, the control is applied when this statement yields &"accept"&, in
26933 other words, when the conditions are all true.
26936 It can be in the middle of an &%accept%& statement:
26938 accept ...some conditions...
26939 control = queue_only
26940 ...some more conditions...
26942 If the first set of conditions are true, the control is applied, even if the
26943 statement does not accept because one of the second set of conditions is false.
26944 In this case, some subsequent statement must yield &"accept"& for the control
26948 It can be used with &%warn%& to apply the control, leaving the
26949 decision about accepting or denying to a subsequent verb. For
26952 warn ...some conditions...
26956 This example of &%warn%& does not contain &%message%&, &%log_message%&, or
26957 &%logwrite%&, so it does not add anything to the message and does not write a
26961 If you want to apply a control unconditionally, you can use it with a
26962 &%require%& verb. For example:
26964 require control = no_multiline_responses
26968 .vitem &*delay*&&~=&~<&'time'&>
26969 .cindex "&%delay%& ACL modifier"
26971 This modifier may appear in any ACL except notquit. It causes Exim to wait for
26972 the time interval before proceeding. However, when testing Exim using the
26973 &%-bh%& option, the delay is not actually imposed (an appropriate message is
26974 output instead). The time is given in the usual Exim notation, and the delay
26975 happens as soon as the modifier is processed. In an SMTP session, pending
26976 output is flushed before the delay is imposed.
26978 Like &%control%&, &%delay%& can be used with &%accept%& or &%deny%&, for
26981 deny ...some conditions...
26984 The delay happens if all the conditions are true, before the statement returns
26985 &"deny"&. Compare this with:
26988 ...some conditions...
26990 which waits for 30s before processing the conditions. The &%delay%& modifier
26991 can also be used with &%warn%& and together with &%control%&:
26993 warn ...some conditions...
26999 If &%delay%& is encountered when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use,
27000 responses to several commands are no longer buffered and sent in one packet (as
27001 they would normally be) because all output is flushed before imposing the
27002 delay. This optimization is disabled so that a number of small delays do not
27003 appear to the client as one large aggregated delay that might provoke an
27004 unwanted timeout. You can, however, disable output flushing for &%delay%& by
27005 using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_delay_flush%&.
27009 .cindex "&%endpass%& ACL modifier"
27010 This modifier, which has no argument, is recognized only in &%accept%& and
27011 &%discard%& statements. It marks the boundary between the conditions whose
27012 failure causes control to pass to the next statement, and the conditions whose
27013 failure causes the ACL to return &"deny"&. This concept has proved to be
27014 confusing to some people, so the use of &%endpass%& is no longer recommended as
27015 &"best practice"&. See the description of &%accept%& above for more details.
27018 .vitem &*log_message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
27019 .cindex "&%log_message%& ACL modifier"
27020 This modifier sets up a message that is used as part of the log message if the
27021 ACL denies access or a &%warn%& statement's conditions are true. For example:
27023 require log_message = wrong cipher suite $tls_in_cipher
27024 encrypted = DES-CBC3-SHA
27026 &%log_message%& is also used when recipients are discarded by &%discard%&. For
27029 &`discard `&<&'some conditions'&>
27030 &` log_message = Discarded $local_part@$domain because...`&
27032 When access is denied, &%log_message%& adds to any underlying error message
27033 that may exist because of a condition failure. For example, while verifying a
27034 recipient address, a &':fail:'& redirection might have already set up a
27037 The message may be defined before the conditions to which it applies, because
27038 the string expansion does not happen until Exim decides that access is to be
27039 denied. This means that any variables that are set by the condition are
27040 available for inclusion in the message. For example, the &$dnslist_$&<&'xxx'&>
27041 variables are set after a DNS black list lookup succeeds. If the expansion of
27042 &%log_message%& fails, or if the result is an empty string, the modifier is
27045 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
27046 If you want to use a &%warn%& statement to log the result of an address
27047 verification, you can use &$acl_verify_message$& to include the verification
27050 If &%log_message%& is used with a &%warn%& statement, &"Warning:"& is added to
27051 the start of the logged message. If the same warning log message is requested
27052 more than once while receiving a single email message, only one copy is
27053 actually logged. If you want to log multiple copies, use &%logwrite%& instead
27054 of &%log_message%&. In the absence of &%log_message%& and &%logwrite%&, nothing
27055 is logged for a successful &%warn%& statement.
27057 If &%log_message%& is not present and there is no underlying error message (for
27058 example, from the failure of address verification), but &%message%& is present,
27059 the &%message%& text is used for logging rejections. However, if any text for
27060 logging contains newlines, only the first line is logged. In the absence of
27061 both &%log_message%& and &%message%&, a default built-in message is used for
27062 logging rejections.
27065 .vitem "&*log_reject_target*&&~=&~<&'log name list'&>"
27066 .cindex "&%log_reject_target%& ACL modifier"
27067 .cindex "logging in ACL" "specifying which log"
27068 This modifier makes it possible to specify which logs are used for messages
27069 about ACL rejections. Its argument is a colon-separated list of words that can
27070 be &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"&. The default is &`main:reject`&. The list
27071 may be empty, in which case a rejection is not logged at all. For example, this
27072 ACL fragment writes no logging information when access is denied:
27074 &`deny `&<&'some conditions'&>
27075 &` log_reject_target =`&
27077 This modifier can be used in SMTP and non-SMTP ACLs. It applies to both
27078 permanent and temporary rejections. Its effect lasts for the rest of the
27082 .vitem &*logwrite*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
27083 .cindex "&%logwrite%& ACL modifier"
27084 .cindex "logging in ACL" "immediate"
27085 This modifier writes a message to a log file as soon as it is encountered when
27086 processing an ACL. (Compare &%log_message%&, which, except in the case of
27087 &%warn%& and &%discard%&, is used only if the ACL statement denies
27088 access.) The &%logwrite%& modifier can be used to log special incidents in
27091 &`accept `&<&'some special conditions'&>
27092 &` control = freeze`&
27093 &` logwrite = froze message because ...`&
27095 By default, the message is written to the main log. However, it may begin
27096 with a colon, followed by a comma-separated list of log names, and then
27097 another colon, to specify exactly which logs are to be written. For
27100 logwrite = :main,reject: text for main and reject logs
27101 logwrite = :panic: text for panic log only
27105 .vitem &*message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
27106 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier"
27107 This modifier sets up a text string that is expanded and used as a response
27108 message when an ACL statement terminates the ACL with an &"accept"&, &"deny"&,
27109 or &"defer"& response. (In the case of the &%accept%& and &%discard%& verbs,
27110 there is some complication if &%endpass%& is involved; see the description of
27111 &%accept%& for details.)
27113 The expansion of the message happens at the time Exim decides that the ACL is
27114 to end, not at the time it processes &%message%&. If the expansion fails, or
27115 generates an empty string, the modifier is ignored. Here is an example where
27116 &%message%& must be specified first, because the ACL ends with a rejection if
27117 the &%hosts%& condition fails:
27119 require message = Host not recognized
27122 (Once a condition has failed, no further conditions or modifiers are
27125 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
27126 .oindex "&%smtp_banner%&
27127 For ACLs that are triggered by SMTP commands, the message is returned as part
27128 of the SMTP response. The use of &%message%& with &%accept%& (or &%discard%&)
27129 is meaningful only for SMTP, as no message is returned when a non-SMTP message
27130 is accepted. In the case of the connect ACL, accepting with a message modifier
27131 overrides the value of &%smtp_banner%&. For the EHLO/HELO ACL, a customized
27132 accept message may not contain more than one line (otherwise it will be
27133 truncated at the first newline and a panic logged), and it cannot affect the
27136 When SMTP is involved, the message may begin with an overriding response code,
27137 consisting of three digits optionally followed by an &"extended response code"&
27138 of the form &'n.n.n'&, each code being followed by a space. For example:
27140 deny message = 599 1.2.3 Host not welcome
27141 hosts = 192.168.34.0/24
27143 The first digit of the supplied response code must be the same as would be sent
27144 by default. A panic occurs if it is not. Exim uses a 550 code when it denies
27145 access, but for the predata ACL, note that the default success code is 354, not
27148 Notwithstanding the previous paragraph, for the QUIT ACL, unlike the others,
27149 the message modifier cannot override the 221 response code.
27151 The text in a &%message%& modifier is literal; any quotes are taken as
27152 literals, but because the string is expanded, backslash escapes are processed
27153 anyway. If the message contains newlines, this gives rise to a multi-line SMTP
27156 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
27157 If &%message%& is used on a statement that verifies an address, the message
27158 specified overrides any message that is generated by the verification process.
27159 However, the original message is available in the variable
27160 &$acl_verify_message$&, so you can incorporate it into your message if you
27161 wish. In particular, if you want the text from &%:fail:%& items in &(redirect)&
27162 routers to be passed back as part of the SMTP response, you should either not
27163 use a &%message%& modifier, or make use of &$acl_verify_message$&.
27165 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, a &%message%& modifier that
27166 is used with a &%warn%& verb behaves in a similar way to the &%add_header%&
27167 modifier, but this usage is now deprecated. However, &%message%& acts only when
27168 all the conditions are true, wherever it appears in an ACL command, whereas
27169 &%add_header%& acts as soon as it is encountered. If &%message%& is used with
27170 &%warn%& in an ACL that is not concerned with receiving a message, it has no
27174 .vitem &*remove_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
27175 This modifier specifies one or more header names in a colon-separated list
27176 that are to be removed from an incoming message, assuming, of course, that
27177 the message is ultimately accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTremoveheadacl>>&.
27180 .vitem &*set*&&~<&'acl_name'&>&~=&~<&'value'&>
27181 .cindex "&%set%& ACL modifier"
27182 This modifier puts a value into one of the ACL variables (see section
27183 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&).
27186 .vitem &*udpsend*&&~=&~<&'parameters'&>
27187 This modifier sends a UDP packet, for purposes such as statistics
27188 collection or behaviour monitoring. The parameters are expanded, and
27189 the result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list consisting
27190 of a destination server, port number, and the packet contents. The
27191 server can be specified as a host name or IPv4 or IPv6 address. The
27192 separator can be changed with the usual angle bracket syntax. For
27193 example, you might want to collect information on which hosts connect
27196 udpsend = <; 2001:dB8::dead:beef ; 1234 ;\
27197 $tod_zulu $sender_host_address
27205 .section "Use of the control modifier" "SECTcontrols"
27206 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
27207 The &%control%& modifier supports the following settings:
27210 .vitem &*control&~=&~allow_auth_unadvertised*&
27211 This modifier allows a client host to use the SMTP AUTH command even when it
27212 has not been advertised in response to EHLO. Furthermore, because there are
27213 apparently some really broken clients that do this, Exim will accept AUTH after
27214 HELO (rather than EHLO) when this control is set. It should be used only if you
27215 really need it, and you should limit its use to those broken clients that do
27216 not work without it. For example:
27218 warn hosts = 192.168.34.25
27219 control = allow_auth_unadvertised
27221 Normally, when an Exim server receives an AUTH command, it checks the name of
27222 the authentication mechanism that is given in the command to ensure that it
27223 matches an advertised mechanism. When this control is set, the check that a
27224 mechanism has been advertised is bypassed. Any configured mechanism can be used
27225 by the client. This control is permitted only in the connection and HELO ACLs.
27228 .vitem &*control&~=&~caseful_local_part*& &&&
27229 &*control&~=&~caselower_local_part*&
27230 .cindex "&ACL;" "case of local part in"
27231 .cindex "case of local parts"
27232 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
27233 These two controls are permitted only in the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
27234 (that is, during RCPT processing). By default, the contents of &$local_part$&
27235 are lower cased before ACL processing. If &"caseful_local_part"& is specified,
27236 any uppercase letters in the original local part are restored in &$local_part$&
27237 for the rest of the ACL, or until a control that sets &"caselower_local_part"&
27240 These controls affect only the current recipient. Moreover, they apply only to
27241 local part handling that takes place directly in the ACL (for example, as a key
27242 in lookups). If a test to verify the recipient is obeyed, the case-related
27243 handling of the local part during the verification is controlled by the router
27244 configuration (see the &%caseful_local_part%& generic router option).
27246 This facility could be used, for example, to add a spam score to local parts
27247 containing upper case letters. For example, using &$acl_m4$& to accumulate the
27250 warn control = caseful_local_part
27251 set acl_m4 = ${eval:\
27253 ${if match{$local_part}{[A-Z]}{1}{0}}\
27255 control = caselower_local_part
27257 Notice that we put back the lower cased version afterwards, assuming that
27258 is what is wanted for subsequent tests.
27262 .vitem &*control&~=&~cutthrough_delivery*&
27263 .cindex "&ACL;" "cutthrough routing"
27264 .cindex "cutthrough" "requesting"
27265 This option requests delivery be attempted while the item is being received.
27266 It is usable in the RCPT ACL and valid only for single-recipient mails forwarded
27267 from one SMTP connection to another. If a recipient-verify callout connection is
27268 requested in the same ACL it is held open and used for the data, otherwise one is made
27269 after the ACL completes. Note that routers are used in verify mode.
27271 Should the ultimate destination system positively accept or reject the mail,
27272 a corresponding indication is given to the source system and nothing is queued.
27273 If there is a temporary error the item is queued for later delivery in the
27274 usual fashion. If the item is successfully delivered in cutthrough mode the log line
27275 is tagged with ">>" rather than "=>" and appears before the acceptance "<="
27278 Delivery in this mode avoids the generation of a bounce mail to a (possibly faked)
27279 sender when the destination system is doing content-scan based rejection.
27284 .vitem &*control&~=&~debug/*&<&'options'&>
27285 .cindex "&ACL;" "enabling debug logging"
27286 .cindex "debugging" "enabling from an ACL"
27287 This control turns on debug logging, almost as though Exim had been invoked
27288 with &`-d`&, with the output going to a new logfile, by default called
27289 &'debuglog'&. The filename can be adjusted with the &'tag'& option, which
27290 may access any variables already defined. The logging may be adjusted with
27291 the &'opts'& option, which takes the same values as the &`-d`& command-line
27292 option. Some examples (which depend on variables that don't exist in all
27296 control = debug/tag=.$sender_host_address
27297 control = debug/opts=+expand+acl
27298 control = debug/tag=.$message_exim_id/opts=+expand
27304 .vitem &*control&~=&~dkim_disable_verify*&
27305 .cindex "disable DKIM verify"
27306 .cindex "DKIM" "disable verify"
27307 This control turns off DKIM verification processing entirely. For details on
27308 the operation and configuration of DKIM, see chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>&.
27313 .vitem &*control&~=&~dscp/*&<&'value'&>
27314 .cindex "&ACL;" "setting DSCP value"
27315 .cindex "DSCP" "inbound"
27316 This option causes the DSCP value associated with the socket for the inbound
27317 connection to be adjusted to a given value, given as one of a number of fixed
27318 strings or to numeric value.
27319 The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
27320 Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
27321 &`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
27323 The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
27324 (for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
27325 that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
27326 equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
27327 Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
27331 .vitem &*control&~=&~enforce_sync*& &&&
27332 &*control&~=&~no_enforce_sync*&
27333 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
27334 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
27335 These controls make it possible to be selective about when SMTP synchronization
27336 is enforced. The global option &%smtp_enforce_sync%& specifies the initial
27337 state of the switch (it is true by default). See the description of this option
27338 in chapter &<<CHAPmainconfig>>& for details of SMTP synchronization checking.
27340 The effect of these two controls lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
27341 connection. They can appear in any ACL except the one for the non-SMTP
27342 messages. The most straightforward place to put them is in the ACL defined by
27343 &%acl_smtp_connect%&, which is run at the start of an incoming SMTP connection,
27344 before the first synchronization check. The expected use is to turn off the
27345 synchronization checks for badly-behaved hosts that you nevertheless need to
27349 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakedefer/*&<&'message'&>
27350 .cindex "fake defer"
27351 .cindex "defer, fake"
27352 This control works in exactly the same way as &%fakereject%& (described below)
27353 except that it causes an SMTP 450 response after the message data instead of a
27354 550 response. You must take care when using &%fakedefer%& because it causes the
27355 messages to be duplicated when the sender retries. Therefore, you should not
27356 use &%fakedefer%& if the message is to be delivered normally.
27358 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakereject/*&<&'message'&>
27359 .cindex "fake rejection"
27360 .cindex "rejection, fake"
27361 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and DATA ACLs, in other
27362 words, only when an SMTP message is being received. If Exim accepts the
27363 message, instead the final 250 response, a 550 rejection message is sent.
27364 However, Exim proceeds to deliver the message as normal. The control applies
27365 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
27366 the same SMTP connection.
27368 The text for the 550 response is taken from the &%control%& modifier. If no
27369 message is supplied, the following is used:
27371 550-Your message has been rejected but is being
27372 550-kept for evaluation.
27373 550-If it was a legitimate message, it may still be
27374 550 delivered to the target recipient(s).
27376 This facility should be used with extreme caution.
27378 .vitem &*control&~=&~freeze*&
27379 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing in ACL"
27380 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
27381 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
27382 it is placed on Exim's queue and frozen. The control applies only to the
27383 current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the same
27386 This modifier can optionally be followed by &`/no_tell`&. If the global option
27387 &%freeze_tell%& is set, it is ignored for the current message (that is, nobody
27388 is told about the freezing), provided all the &*control=freeze*& modifiers that
27389 are obeyed for the current message have the &`/no_tell`& option.
27391 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_delay_flush*&
27392 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for delay"
27393 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before implementing a delay in an ACL, to
27394 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
27395 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%delay%& modifier,
27396 disables such output flushing.
27398 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_callout_flush*&
27399 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
27400 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before performing a callout in an ACL, to
27401 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
27402 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%verify%& condition
27403 that causes the callout, disables such output flushing.
27405 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_mbox_unspool*&
27406 This control is available when Exim is compiled with the content scanning
27407 extension. Content scanning may require a copy of the current message, or parts
27408 of it, to be written in &"mbox format"& to a spool file, for passing to a virus
27409 or spam scanner. Normally, such copies are deleted when they are no longer
27410 needed. If this control is set, the copies are not deleted. The control applies
27411 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
27412 the same SMTP connection. It is provided for debugging purposes and is unlikely
27413 to be useful in production.
27415 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_multiline_responses*&
27416 .cindex "multiline responses, suppressing"
27417 This control is permitted for any ACL except the one for non-SMTP messages.
27418 It seems that there are broken clients in use that cannot handle multiline
27419 SMTP responses, despite the fact that RFC 821 defined them over 20 years ago.
27421 If this control is set, multiline SMTP responses from ACL rejections are
27422 suppressed. One way of doing this would have been to put out these responses as
27423 one long line. However, RFC 2821 specifies a maximum of 512 bytes per response
27424 (&"use multiline responses for more"& it says &-- ha!), and some of the
27425 responses might get close to that. So this facility, which is after all only a
27426 sop to broken clients, is implemented by doing two very easy things:
27429 Extra information that is normally output as part of a rejection caused by
27430 sender verification failure is omitted. Only the final line (typically &"sender
27431 verification failed"&) is sent.
27433 If a &%message%& modifier supplies a multiline response, only the first
27437 The setting of the switch can, of course, be made conditional on the
27438 calling host. Its effect lasts until the end of the SMTP connection.
27440 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_pipelining*&
27441 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
27442 This control turns off the advertising of the PIPELINING extension to SMTP in
27443 the current session. To be useful, it must be obeyed before Exim sends its
27444 response to an EHLO command. Therefore, it should normally appear in an ACL
27445 controlled by &%acl_smtp_connect%& or &%acl_smtp_helo%&. See also
27446 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
27448 .vitem &*control&~=&~queue_only*&
27449 .oindex "&%queue_only%&"
27450 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
27451 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
27452 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
27453 it is placed on Exim's queue and left there for delivery by a subsequent queue
27454 runner. No immediate delivery process is started. In other words, it has the
27455 effect as the &%queue_only%& global option. However, the control applies only
27456 to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the
27457 same SMTP connection.
27459 .vitem &*control&~=&~submission/*&<&'options'&>
27460 .cindex "message" "submission"
27461 .cindex "submission mode"
27462 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and start of data ACLs (the
27463 latter is the one defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&). Setting it tells Exim that
27464 the current message is a submission from a local MUA. In this case, Exim
27465 operates in &"submission mode"&, and applies certain fixups to the message if
27466 necessary. For example, it adds a &'Date:'& header line if one is not present.
27467 This control is not permitted in the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL, because that is too
27468 late (the message has already been created).
27470 Chapter &<<CHAPmsgproc>>& describes the processing that Exim applies to
27471 messages. Section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>& covers the processing that happens in
27472 submission mode; the available options for this control are described there.
27473 The control applies only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones
27474 that may be received in the same SMTP connection.
27476 .vitem &*control&~=&~suppress_local_fixups*&
27477 .cindex "submission fixups, suppressing"
27478 This control applies to locally submitted (non TCP/IP) messages, and is the
27479 complement of &`control = submission`&. It disables the fixups that are
27480 normally applied to locally-submitted messages. Specifically:
27483 Any &'Sender:'& header line is left alone (in this respect, it is a
27484 dynamic version of &%local_sender_retain%&).
27486 No &'Message-ID:'&, &'From:'&, or &'Date:'& header lines are added.
27488 There is no check that &'From:'& corresponds to the actual sender.
27491 This control may be useful when a remotely-originated message is accepted,
27492 passed to some scanning program, and then re-submitted for delivery. It can be
27493 used only in the &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
27494 and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs, because it has to be set before the message's
27497 &*Note:*& This control applies only to the current message, not to any others
27498 that are being submitted at the same time using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.
27502 .section "Summary of message fixup control" "SECTsummesfix"
27503 All four possibilities for message fixups can be specified:
27506 Locally submitted, fixups applied: the default.
27508 Locally submitted, no fixups applied: use
27509 &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&.
27511 Remotely submitted, no fixups applied: the default.
27513 Remotely submitted, fixups applied: use &`control = submission`&.
27518 .section "Adding header lines in ACLs" "SECTaddheadacl"
27519 .cindex "header lines" "adding in an ACL"
27520 .cindex "header lines" "position of added lines"
27521 .cindex "&%add_header%& ACL modifier"
27522 The &%add_header%& modifier can be used to add one or more extra header lines
27523 to an incoming message, as in this example:
27525 warn dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
27526 dialup.mail-abuse.org
27527 add_header = X-blacklisted-at: $dnslist_domain
27529 The &%add_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
27530 MIME, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
27531 receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
27532 &%add_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%add_header%& with
27533 any ACL verb, including &%deny%& (though this is potentially useful only in a
27536 Leading and trailing newlines are removed from
27537 the data for the &%add_header%& modifier; if it then
27538 contains one or more newlines that
27539 are not followed by a space or a tab, it is assumed to contain multiple header
27540 lines. Each one is checked for valid syntax; &`X-ACL-Warn:`& is added to the
27541 front of any line that is not a valid header line.
27543 Added header lines are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
27544 They are added to the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
27545 However, if an identical header line is requested more than once, only one copy
27546 is actually added to the message. Further header lines may be accumulated
27547 during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are added to the message, again
27548 with duplicates suppressed. Thus, it is possible to add two identical header
27549 lines to an SMTP message, but only if one is added before DATA and one after.
27550 In the case of non-SMTP messages, new headers are accumulated during the
27551 non-SMTP ACLs, and are added to the message after all the ACLs have run. If a
27552 message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP ACL, all added header lines
27553 are included in the entry that is written to the reject log.
27555 .cindex "header lines" "added; visibility of"
27556 Header lines are not visible in string expansions
27558 until they are added to the
27559 message. It follows that header lines defined in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata
27560 ACLs are not visible until the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs are run. Similarly,
27561 header lines that are added by the DATA or MIME ACLs are not visible in those
27562 ACLs. Because of this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of
27563 passing data between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do
27564 this, you can use ACL variables, as described in section
27565 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
27567 The list of headers yet to be added is given by the &%$headers_added%& variable.
27569 The &%add_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
27570 processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
27572 &`accept add_header = ADDED: some text`&
27573 &` `&<&'some condition'&>
27575 &`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
27576 &` add_header = ADDED: some text`&
27578 In the first case, the header line is always added, whether or not the
27579 condition is true. In the second case, the header line is added only if the
27580 condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%add_header%& may occur in the same
27581 ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails are
27584 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
27585 For compatibility with previous versions of Exim, a &%message%& modifier for a
27586 &%warn%& verb acts in the same way as &%add_header%&, except that it takes
27587 effect only if all the conditions are true, even if it appears before some of
27588 them. Furthermore, only the last occurrence of &%message%& is honoured. This
27589 usage of &%message%& is now deprecated. If both &%add_header%& and &%message%&
27590 are present on a &%warn%& verb, both are processed according to their
27593 By default, new header lines are added to a message at the end of the existing
27594 header lines. However, you can specify that any particular header line should
27595 be added right at the start (before all the &'Received:'& lines), immediately
27596 after the first block of &'Received:'& lines, or immediately before any line
27597 that is not a &'Received:'& or &'Resent-something:'& header.
27599 This is done by specifying &":at_start:"&, &":after_received:"&, or
27600 &":at_start_rfc:"& (or, for completeness, &":at_end:"&) before the text of the
27601 header line, respectively. (Header text cannot start with a colon, as there has
27602 to be a header name first.) For example:
27604 warn add_header = \
27605 :after_received:X-My-Header: something or other...
27607 If more than one header line is supplied in a single &%add_header%& modifier,
27608 each one is treated independently and can therefore be placed differently. If
27609 you add more than one line at the start, or after the Received: block, they end
27610 up in reverse order.
27612 &*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
27613 added in an ACL. It does NOT work for header lines that are added in a
27614 system filter or in a router or transport.
27618 .section "Removing header lines in ACLs" "SECTremoveheadacl"
27619 .cindex "header lines" "removing in an ACL"
27620 .cindex "header lines" "position of removed lines"
27621 .cindex "&%remove_header%& ACL modifier"
27622 The &%remove_header%& modifier can be used to remove one or more header lines
27623 from an incoming message, as in this example:
27625 warn message = Remove internal headers
27626 remove_header = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
27628 The &%remove_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
27629 MIME, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
27630 receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
27631 &%remove_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%remove_header%&
27632 with any ACL verb, including &%deny%&, though this is really not useful for
27633 any verb that doesn't result in a delivered message.
27635 More than one header can be removed at the same time by using a colon separated
27636 list of header names. The header matching is case insensitive. Wildcards are
27637 not permitted, nor is list expansion performed, so you cannot use hostlists to
27638 create a list of headers, however both connection and message variable expansion
27639 are performed (&%$acl_c_*%& and &%$acl_m_*%&), illustrated in this example:
27641 warn hosts = +internal_hosts
27642 set acl_c_ihdrs = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
27643 warn message = Remove internal headers
27644 remove_header = $acl_c_ihdrs
27646 Removed header lines are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
27647 They are removed from the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
27648 There is no harm in attempting to remove the same header twice nor is removing
27649 a non-existent header. Further header lines to be removed may be accumulated
27650 during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are removed from the message,
27651 if present. In the case of non-SMTP messages, headers to be removed are
27652 accumulated during the non-SMTP ACLs, and are removed from the message after
27653 all the ACLs have run. If a message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP
27654 ACL, there really is no effect because there is no logging of what headers
27655 would have been removed.
27657 .cindex "header lines" "removed; visibility of"
27658 Header lines are not visible in string expansions until the DATA phase when it
27659 is received. Any header lines removed in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs are
27660 not visible in the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs. Similarly, header lines that are
27661 removed by the DATA or MIME ACLs are still visible in those ACLs. Because of
27662 this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of controlling data
27663 passed between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do this,
27664 you should instead use ACL variables, as described in section
27665 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
27667 The &%remove_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
27668 processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
27670 &`accept remove_header = X-Internal`&
27671 &` `&<&'some condition'&>
27673 &`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
27674 &` remove_header = X-Internal`&
27676 In the first case, the header line is always removed, whether or not the
27677 condition is true. In the second case, the header line is removed only if the
27678 condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%remove_header%& may occur in the
27679 same ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails
27682 &*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
27683 present during ACL processing. It does NOT remove header lines that are added
27684 in a system filter or in a router or transport.
27690 .section "ACL conditions" "SECTaclconditions"
27691 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; list of"
27692 Some of the conditions listed in this section are available only when Exim is
27693 compiled with the content-scanning extension. They are included here briefly
27694 for completeness. More detailed descriptions can be found in the discussion on
27695 content scanning in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
27697 Not all conditions are relevant in all circumstances. For example, testing
27698 senders and recipients does not make sense in an ACL that is being run as the
27699 result of the arrival of an ETRN command, and checks on message headers can be
27700 done only in the ACLs specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& and &%acl_not_smtp%&. You
27701 can use the same condition (with different parameters) more than once in the
27702 same ACL statement. This provides a way of specifying an &"and"& conjunction.
27703 The conditions are as follows:
27707 .vitem &*acl&~=&~*&<&'name&~of&~acl&~or&~ACL&~string&~or&~file&~name&~'&>
27708 .cindex "&ACL;" "nested"
27709 .cindex "&ACL;" "indirect"
27710 .cindex "&ACL;" "arguments"
27711 .cindex "&%acl%& ACL condition"
27712 The possible values of the argument are the same as for the
27713 &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& options. The named or inline ACL is run. If it returns
27714 &"accept"& the condition is true; if it returns &"deny"& the condition is
27715 false. If it returns &"defer"&, the current ACL returns &"defer"& unless the
27716 condition is on a &%warn%& verb. In that case, a &"defer"& return makes the
27717 condition false. This means that further processing of the &%warn%& verb
27718 ceases, but processing of the ACL continues.
27720 If the argument is a named ACL, up to nine space-separated optional values
27721 can be appended; they appear within the called ACL in $acl_arg1 to $acl_arg9,
27722 and $acl_narg is set to the count of values.
27723 Previous values of these variables are restored after the call returns.
27724 The name and values are expanded separately.
27726 If the nested &%acl%& returns &"drop"& and the outer condition denies access,
27727 the connection is dropped. If it returns &"discard"&, the verb must be
27728 &%accept%& or &%discard%&, and the action is taken immediately &-- no further
27729 conditions are tested.
27731 ACLs may be nested up to 20 deep; the limit exists purely to catch runaway
27732 loops. This condition allows you to use different ACLs in different
27733 circumstances. For example, different ACLs can be used to handle RCPT commands
27734 for different local users or different local domains.
27736 .vitem &*authenticated&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
27737 .cindex "&%authenticated%& ACL condition"
27738 .cindex "authentication" "ACL checking"
27739 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for authentication"
27740 If the SMTP connection is not authenticated, the condition is false. Otherwise,
27741 the name of the authenticator is tested against the list. To test for
27742 authentication by any authenticator, you can set
27747 .vitem &*condition&~=&~*&<&'string'&>
27748 .cindex "&%condition%& ACL condition"
27749 .cindex "customizing" "ACL condition"
27750 .cindex "&ACL;" "customized test"
27751 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing, customized"
27752 This feature allows you to make up custom conditions. If the result of
27753 expanding the string is an empty string, the number zero, or one of the strings
27754 &"no"& or &"false"&, the condition is false. If the result is any non-zero
27755 number, or one of the strings &"yes"& or &"true"&, the condition is true. For
27756 any other value, some error is assumed to have occurred, and the ACL returns
27757 &"defer"&. However, if the expansion is forced to fail, the condition is
27758 ignored. The effect is to treat it as true, whether it is positive or
27761 .vitem &*decode&~=&~*&<&'location'&>
27762 .cindex "&%decode%& ACL condition"
27763 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
27764 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
27765 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be decoded into a file.
27766 If all goes well, the condition is true. It is false only if there are
27767 problems such as a syntax error or a memory shortage. For more details, see
27768 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
27770 .vitem &*demime&~=&~*&<&'extension&~list'&>
27771 .cindex "&%demime%& ACL condition"
27772 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
27773 content-scanning extension. Its use is described in section
27774 &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
27776 .vitem &*dnslists&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~domain&~names&~and&~other&~data'&>
27777 .cindex "&%dnslists%& ACL condition"
27778 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
27779 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
27780 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
27781 This condition checks for entries in DNS black lists. These are also known as
27782 &"RBL lists"&, after the original Realtime Blackhole List, but note that the
27783 use of the lists at &'mail-abuse.org'& now carries a charge. There are too many
27784 different variants of this condition to describe briefly here. See sections
27785 &<<SECTmorednslists>>&&--&<<SECTmorednslistslast>>& for details.
27787 .vitem &*domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
27788 .cindex "&%domains%& ACL condition"
27789 .cindex "domain" "ACL checking"
27790 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient domain"
27791 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
27792 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the domain
27793 of the recipient address is in the domain list. If percent-hack processing is
27794 enabled, it is done before this test is done. If the check succeeds with a
27795 lookup, the result of the lookup is placed in &$domain_data$& until the next
27798 &*Note carefully*& (because many people seem to fall foul of this): you cannot
27799 use &%domains%& in a DATA ACL.
27802 .vitem &*encrypted&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
27803 .cindex "&%encrypted%& ACL condition"
27804 .cindex "encryption" "checking in an ACL"
27805 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for encryption"
27806 If the SMTP connection is not encrypted, the condition is false. Otherwise, the
27807 name of the cipher suite in use is tested against the list. To test for
27808 encryption without testing for any specific cipher suite(s), set
27814 .vitem &*hosts&~=&~*&<&'host&~list'&>
27815 .cindex "&%hosts%& ACL condition"
27816 .cindex "host" "ACL checking"
27817 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing the client host"
27818 This condition tests that the calling host matches the host list. If you have
27819 name lookups or wildcarded host names and IP addresses in the same host list,
27820 you should normally put the IP addresses first. For example, you could have:
27822 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
27824 The lookup in this example uses the host name for its key. This is implied by
27825 the lookup type &"dbm"&. (For a host address lookup you would use &"net-dbm"&
27826 and it wouldn't matter which way round you had these two items.)
27828 The reason for the problem with host names lies in the left-to-right way that
27829 Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses without doing any DNS lookups,
27830 but when it reaches an item that requires a host name, it fails if it cannot
27831 find a host name to compare with the pattern. If the above list is given in the
27832 opposite order, the &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be
27833 found, even if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
27835 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
27836 address even if the name lookup fails, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
27838 accept hosts = dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
27839 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
27841 The default action on failing to find the host name is to assume that the host
27842 is not in the list, so the first &%accept%& statement fails. The second
27843 statement can then check the IP address.
27845 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
27846 If a &%hosts%& condition is satisfied by means of a lookup, the result
27847 of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
27848 allows you, for example, to set up a statement like this:
27850 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
27851 message = $host_data
27853 which gives a custom error message for each denied host.
27855 .vitem &*local_parts&~=&~*&<&'local&~part&~list'&>
27856 .cindex "&%local_parts%& ACL condition"
27857 .cindex "local part" "ACL checking"
27858 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a local part"
27859 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
27860 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the local
27861 part of the recipient address is in the list. If percent-hack processing is
27862 enabled, it is done before this test. If the check succeeds with a lookup, the
27863 result of the lookup is placed in &$local_part_data$&, which remains set until
27864 the next &%local_parts%& test.
27866 .vitem &*malware&~=&~*&<&'option'&>
27867 .cindex "&%malware%& ACL condition"
27868 .cindex "&ACL;" "virus scanning"
27869 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for viruses"
27870 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
27871 content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for
27872 viruses. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
27874 .vitem &*mime_regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
27875 .cindex "&%mime_regex%& ACL condition"
27876 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
27877 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
27878 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
27879 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be scanned for a match
27880 with any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter
27883 .vitem &*ratelimit&~=&~*&<&'parameters'&>
27884 .cindex "rate limiting"
27885 This condition can be used to limit the rate at which a user or host submits
27886 messages. Details are given in section &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
27888 .vitem &*recipients&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
27889 .cindex "&%recipients%& ACL condition"
27890 .cindex "recipient" "ACL checking"
27891 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient"
27892 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks the entire
27893 recipient address against a list of recipients.
27895 .vitem &*regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
27896 .cindex "&%regex%& ACL condition"
27897 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
27898 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
27899 content-scanning extension, and is available only in the DATA, MIME, and
27900 non-SMTP ACLs. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for a match with
27901 any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
27903 .vitem &*sender_domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
27904 .cindex "&%sender_domains%& ACL condition"
27905 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
27906 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender domain"
27907 .vindex "&$domain$&"
27908 .vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
27909 This condition tests the domain of the sender of the message against the given
27910 domain list. &*Note*&: The domain of the sender address is in
27911 &$sender_address_domain$&. It is &'not'& put in &$domain$& during the testing
27912 of this condition. This is an exception to the general rule for testing domain
27913 lists. It is done this way so that, if this condition is used in an ACL for a
27914 RCPT command, the recipient's domain (which is in &$domain$&) can be used to
27915 influence the sender checking.
27917 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
27918 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
27920 .vitem &*senders&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
27921 .cindex "&%senders%& ACL condition"
27922 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
27923 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender"
27924 This condition tests the sender of the message against the given list. To test
27925 for a bounce message, which has an empty sender, set
27929 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
27930 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
27932 .vitem &*spam&~=&~*&<&'username'&>
27933 .cindex "&%spam%& ACL condition"
27934 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for spam"
27935 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
27936 content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned by
27937 SpamAssassin. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
27939 .vitem &*verify&~=&~certificate*&
27940 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
27941 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
27942 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
27943 .cindex "&ACL;" "certificate verification"
27944 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a TLS certificate"
27945 This condition is true in an SMTP session if the session is encrypted, and a
27946 certificate was received from the client, and the certificate was verified. The
27947 server requests a certificate only if the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&
27948 or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
27950 .vitem &*verify&~=&~csa*&
27951 .cindex "CSA verification"
27952 This condition checks whether the sending host (the client) is authorized to
27953 send email. Details of how this works are given in section
27954 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
27956 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_sender/*&<&'options'&>
27957 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
27958 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender in the header"
27959 .cindex "header lines" "verifying the sender in"
27960 .cindex "sender" "verifying in header"
27961 .cindex "verifying" "sender in header"
27962 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
27963 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
27964 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks that there is a verifiable address in at least one
27965 of the &'Sender:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, or &'From:'& header lines. Such an address
27966 is loosely thought of as a &"sender"& address (hence the name of the test).
27967 However, an address that appears in one of these headers need not be an address
27968 that accepts bounce messages; only sender addresses in envelopes are required
27969 to accept bounces. Therefore, if you use the callout option on this check, you
27970 might want to arrange for a non-empty address in the MAIL command.
27972 Details of address verification and the options are given later, starting at
27973 section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& (callouts are described in section
27974 &<<SECTcallver>>&). You can combine this condition with the &%senders%&
27975 condition to restrict it to bounce messages only:
27978 message = A valid sender header is required for bounces
27979 !verify = header_sender
27982 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_syntax*&
27983 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
27984 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header syntax"
27985 .cindex "header lines" "verifying syntax"
27986 .cindex "verifying" "header syntax"
27987 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
27988 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
27989 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks the syntax of all header lines that can contain
27990 lists of addresses (&'Sender:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&,
27991 and &'Bcc:'&). Unqualified addresses (local parts without domains) are
27992 permitted only in locally generated messages and from hosts that match
27993 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
27996 Note that this condition is a syntax check only. However, a common spamming
27997 ploy used to be to send syntactically invalid headers such as
28001 and this condition can be used to reject such messages, though they are not as
28002 common as they used to be.
28004 .vitem &*verify&~=&~helo*&
28005 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
28006 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying HELO/EHLO"
28007 .cindex "HELO" "verifying"
28008 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying"
28009 .cindex "verifying" "EHLO"
28010 .cindex "verifying" "HELO"
28011 This condition is true if a HELO or EHLO command has been received from the
28012 client host, and its contents have been verified. If there has been no previous
28013 attempt to verify the HELO/EHLO contents, it is carried out when this
28014 condition is encountered. See the description of the &%helo_verify_hosts%& and
28015 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& options for details of how to request verification
28016 independently of this condition.
28018 For SMTP input that does not come over TCP/IP (the &%-bs%& command line
28019 option), this condition is always true.
28022 .vitem &*verify&~=&~not_blind*&
28023 .cindex "verifying" "not blind"
28024 .cindex "bcc recipients, verifying none"
28025 This condition checks that there are no blind (bcc) recipients in the message.
28026 Every envelope recipient must appear either in a &'To:'& header line or in a
28027 &'Cc:'& header line for this condition to be true. Local parts are checked
28028 case-sensitively; domains are checked case-insensitively. If &'Resent-To:'& or
28029 &'Resent-Cc:'& header lines exist, they are also checked. This condition can be
28030 used only in a DATA or non-SMTP ACL.
28032 There are, of course, many legitimate messages that make use of blind (bcc)
28033 recipients. This check should not be used on its own for blocking messages.
28036 .vitem &*verify&~=&~recipient/*&<&'options'&>
28037 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
28038 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying recipient"
28039 .cindex "recipient" "verifying"
28040 .cindex "verifying" "recipient"
28041 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
28042 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It verifies the current
28043 recipient. Details of address verification are given later, starting at section
28044 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. After a recipient has been verified, the value
28045 of &$address_data$& is the last value that was set while routing the address.
28046 This applies even if the verification fails. When an address that is being
28047 verified is redirected to a single address, verification continues with the new
28048 address, and in that case, the subsequent value of &$address_data$& is the
28049 value for the child address.
28051 .vitem &*verify&~=&~reverse_host_lookup*&
28052 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
28053 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying host reverse lookup"
28054 .cindex "host" "verifying reverse lookup"
28055 This condition ensures that a verified host name has been looked up from the IP
28056 address of the client host. (This may have happened already if the host name
28057 was needed for checking a host list, or if the host matched &%host_lookup%&.)
28058 Verification ensures that the host name obtained from a reverse DNS lookup, or
28059 one of its aliases, does, when it is itself looked up in the DNS, yield the
28060 original IP address.
28062 If this condition is used for a locally generated message (that is, when there
28063 is no client host involved), it always succeeds.
28065 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender/*&<&'options'&>
28066 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
28067 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender"
28068 .cindex "sender" "verifying"
28069 .cindex "verifying" "sender"
28070 This condition is relevant only after a MAIL or RCPT command, or after a
28071 message has been received (the &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs). If
28072 the message's sender is empty (that is, this is a bounce message), the
28073 condition is true. Otherwise, the sender address is verified.
28075 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
28076 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
28077 If there is data in the &$address_data$& variable at the end of routing, its
28078 value is placed in &$sender_address_data$& at the end of verification. This
28079 value can be used in subsequent conditions and modifiers in the same ACL
28080 statement. It does not persist after the end of the current statement. If you
28081 want to preserve the value for longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
28083 Details of verification are given later, starting at section
28084 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. Exim caches the result of sender verification,
28085 to avoid doing it more than once per message.
28087 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender=*&<&'address'&>&*/*&<&'options'&>
28088 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
28089 This is a variation of the previous option, in which a modified address is
28090 verified as a sender.
28095 .section "Using DNS lists" "SECTmorednslists"
28096 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
28097 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
28098 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
28099 In its simplest form, the &%dnslists%& condition tests whether the calling host
28100 is on at least one of a number of DNS lists by looking up the inverted IP
28101 address in one or more DNS domains. (Note that DNS list domains are not mail
28102 domains, so the &`+`& syntax for named lists doesn't work - it is used for
28103 special options instead.) For example, if the calling host's IP
28104 address is 192.168.62.43, and the ACL statement is
28106 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org : \
28107 dialups.mail-abuse.org
28109 the following records are looked up:
28111 43.62.168.192.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
28112 43.62.168.192.dialups.mail-abuse.org
28114 As soon as Exim finds an existing DNS record, processing of the list stops.
28115 Thus, multiple entries on the list provide an &"or"& conjunction. If you want
28116 to test that a host is on more than one list (an &"and"& conjunction), you can
28117 use two separate conditions:
28119 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
28120 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
28122 If a DNS lookup times out or otherwise fails to give a decisive answer, Exim
28123 behaves as if the host does not match the list item, that is, as if the DNS
28124 record does not exist. If there are further items in the DNS list, they are
28127 This is usually the required action when &%dnslists%& is used with &%deny%&
28128 (which is the most common usage), because it prevents a DNS failure from
28129 blocking mail. However, you can change this behaviour by putting one of the
28130 following special items in the list:
28132 &`+include_unknown `& behave as if the item is on the list
28133 &`+exclude_unknown `& behave as if the item is not on the list (default)
28134 &`+defer_unknown `& give a temporary error
28136 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
28137 .cindex "&`+exclude_unknown`&"
28138 .cindex "&`+defer_unknown`&"
28139 Each of these applies to any subsequent items on the list. For example:
28141 deny dnslists = +defer_unknown : foo.bar.example
28143 Testing the list of domains stops as soon as a match is found. If you want to
28144 warn for one list and block for another, you can use two different statements:
28146 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
28147 warn message = X-Warn: sending host is on dialups list
28148 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
28150 DNS list lookups are cached by Exim for the duration of the SMTP session,
28151 so a lookup based on the IP address is done at most once for any incoming
28152 connection. Exim does not share information between multiple incoming
28153 connections (but your local name server cache should be active).
28157 .section "Specifying the IP address for a DNS list lookup" "SECID201"
28158 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by explicit IP address"
28159 By default, the IP address that is used in a DNS list lookup is the IP address
28160 of the calling host. However, you can specify another IP address by listing it
28161 after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example:
28163 deny dnslists = black.list.tld/192.168.1.2
28165 This feature is not very helpful with explicit IP addresses; it is intended for
28166 use with IP addresses that are looked up, for example, the IP addresses of the
28167 MX hosts or nameservers of an email sender address. For an example, see section
28168 &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>& below.
28173 .section "DNS lists keyed on domain names" "SECID202"
28174 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by domain name"
28175 There are some lists that are keyed on domain names rather than inverted IP
28176 addresses (see for example the &'domain based zones'& link at
28177 &url(http://www.rfc-ignorant.org/)). No reversing of components is used
28178 with these lists. You can change the name that is looked up in a DNS list by
28179 listing it after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example,
28181 deny message = Sender's domain is listed at $dnslist_domain
28182 dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
28184 This particular example is useful only in ACLs that are obeyed after the
28185 RCPT or DATA commands, when a sender address is available. If (for
28186 example) the message's sender is &'user@tld.example'& the name that is looked
28187 up by this example is
28189 tld.example.dsn.rfc-ignorant.org
28191 A single &%dnslists%& condition can contain entries for both names and IP
28192 addresses. For example:
28194 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
28195 dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
28197 The first item checks the sending host's IP address; the second checks a domain
28198 name. The whole condition is true if either of the DNS lookups succeeds.
28203 .section "Multiple explicit keys for a DNS list" "SECTmulkeyfor"
28204 .cindex "DNS list" "multiple keys for"
28205 The syntax described above for looking up explicitly-defined values (either
28206 names or IP addresses) in a DNS blacklist is a simplification. After the domain
28207 name for the DNS list, what follows the slash can in fact be a list of items.
28208 As with all lists in Exim, the default separator is a colon. However, because
28209 this is a sublist within the list of DNS blacklist domains, it is necessary
28210 either to double the separators like this:
28212 dnslists = black.list.tld/name.1::name.2
28214 or to change the separator character, like this:
28216 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;name.1;name.2
28218 If an item in the list is an IP address, it is inverted before the DNS
28219 blacklist domain is appended. If it is not an IP address, no inversion
28220 occurs. Consider this condition:
28222 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;192.168.1.2;a.domain
28224 The DNS lookups that occur are:
28226 2.1.168.192.black.list.tld
28227 a.domain.black.list.tld
28229 Once a DNS record has been found (that matches a specific IP return
28230 address, if specified &-- see section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>&), no further lookups
28231 are done. If there is a temporary DNS error, the rest of the sublist of domains
28232 or IP addresses is tried. A temporary error for the whole dnslists item occurs
28233 only if no other DNS lookup in this sublist succeeds. In other words, a
28234 successful lookup for any of the items in the sublist overrides a temporary
28235 error for a previous item.
28237 The ability to supply a list of items after the slash is in some sense just a
28238 syntactic convenience. These two examples have the same effect:
28240 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain : black.list.tld/b.domain
28241 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain::b.domain
28243 However, when the data for the list is obtained from a lookup, the second form
28244 is usually much more convenient. Consider this example:
28246 deny message = The mail servers for the domain \
28247 $sender_address_domain \
28248 are listed at $dnslist_domain ($dnslist_value); \
28250 dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org/<|${lookup dnsdb {>|a=<|\
28251 ${lookup dnsdb {>|mxh=\
28252 $sender_address_domain} }} }
28254 Note the use of &`>|`& in the dnsdb lookup to specify the separator for
28255 multiple DNS records. The inner dnsdb lookup produces a list of MX hosts
28256 and the outer dnsdb lookup finds the IP addresses for these hosts. The result
28257 of expanding the condition might be something like this:
28259 dnslists = sbl.spahmaus.org/<|192.168.2.3|192.168.5.6|...
28261 Thus, this example checks whether or not the IP addresses of the sender
28262 domain's mail servers are on the Spamhaus black list.
28264 The key that was used for a successful DNS list lookup is put into the variable
28265 &$dnslist_matched$& (see section &<<SECID204>>&).
28270 .section "Data returned by DNS lists" "SECID203"
28271 .cindex "DNS list" "data returned from"
28272 DNS lists are constructed using address records in the DNS. The original RBL
28273 just used the address 127.0.0.1 on the right hand side of each record, but the
28274 RBL+ list and some other lists use a number of values with different meanings.
28275 The values used on the RBL+ list are:
28279 127.1.0.3 DUL and RBL
28281 127.1.0.5 RSS and RBL
28282 127.1.0.6 RSS and DUL
28283 127.1.0.7 RSS and DUL and RBL
28285 Section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>& below describes how you can distinguish between
28286 different values. Some DNS lists may return more than one address record;
28287 see section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>& for details of how they are checked.
28290 .section "Variables set from DNS lists" "SECID204"
28291 .cindex "expansion" "variables, set from DNS list"
28292 .cindex "DNS list" "variables set from"
28293 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
28294 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
28295 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
28296 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
28297 When an entry is found in a DNS list, the variable &$dnslist_domain$& contains
28298 the name of the overall domain that matched (for example,
28299 &`spamhaus.example`&), &$dnslist_matched$& contains the key within that domain
28300 (for example, &`192.168.5.3`&), and &$dnslist_value$& contains the data from
28301 the DNS record. When the key is an IP address, it is not reversed in
28302 &$dnslist_matched$& (though it is, of course, in the actual lookup). In simple
28303 cases, for example:
28305 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example
28307 the key is also available in another variable (in this case,
28308 &$sender_host_address$&). In more complicated cases, however, this is not true.
28309 For example, using a data lookup (as described in section &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>&)
28310 might generate a dnslists lookup like this:
28312 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example/<|192.168.1.2|192.168.6.7|...
28314 If this condition succeeds, the value in &$dnslist_matched$& might be
28315 &`192.168.6.7`& (for example).
28317 If more than one address record is returned by the DNS lookup, all the IP
28318 addresses are included in &$dnslist_value$&, separated by commas and spaces.
28319 The variable &$dnslist_text$& contains the contents of any associated TXT
28320 record. For lists such as RBL+ the TXT record for a merged entry is often not
28321 very meaningful. See section &<<SECTmordetinf>>& for a way of obtaining more
28324 You can use the DNS list variables in &%message%& or &%log_message%& modifiers
28325 &-- although these appear before the condition in the ACL, they are not
28326 expanded until after it has failed. For example:
28328 deny hosts = !+local_networks
28329 message = $sender_host_address is listed \
28331 dnslists = rbl-plus.mail-abuse.example
28336 .section "Additional matching conditions for DNS lists" "SECTaddmatcon"
28337 .cindex "DNS list" "matching specific returned data"
28338 You can add an equals sign and an IP address after a &%dnslists%& domain name
28339 in order to restrict its action to DNS records with a matching right hand side.
28342 deny dnslists = rblplus.mail-abuse.org=127.0.0.2
28344 rejects only those hosts that yield 127.0.0.2. Without this additional data,
28345 any address record is considered to be a match. For the moment, we assume
28346 that the DNS lookup returns just one record. Section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>&
28347 describes how multiple records are handled.
28349 More than one IP address may be given for checking, using a comma as a
28350 separator. These are alternatives &-- if any one of them matches, the
28351 &%dnslists%& condition is true. For example:
28353 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
28355 If you want to specify a constraining address list and also specify names or IP
28356 addresses to be looked up, the constraining address list must be specified
28357 first. For example:
28359 deny dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org\
28360 =127.0.0.2/$sender_address_domain
28363 If the character &`&&`& is used instead of &`=`&, the comparison for each
28364 listed IP address is done by a bitwise &"and"& instead of by an equality test.
28365 In other words, the listed addresses are used as bit masks. The comparison is
28366 true if all the bits in the mask are present in the address that is being
28367 tested. For example:
28369 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.3
28371 matches if the address is &'x.x.x.'&3, &'x.x.x.'&7, &'x.x.x.'&11, etc. If you
28372 want to test whether one bit or another bit is present (as opposed to both
28373 being present), you must use multiple values. For example:
28375 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
28377 matches if the final component of the address is an odd number or two times
28382 .section "Negated DNS matching conditions" "SECID205"
28383 You can supply a negative list of IP addresses as part of a &%dnslists%&
28386 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
28388 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
28389 IP address yielded by the list is either 127.0.0.2 or 127.0.0.3"&,
28391 deny dnslists = a.b.c!=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
28393 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
28394 IP address yielded by the list is not 127.0.0.2 and not 127.0.0.3"&. In other
28395 words, the result of the test is inverted if an exclamation mark appears before
28396 the &`=`& (or the &`&&`&) sign.
28398 &*Note*&: This kind of negation is not the same as negation in a domain,
28399 host, or address list (which is why the syntax is different).
28401 If you are using just one list, the negation syntax does not gain you much. The
28402 previous example is precisely equivalent to
28404 deny dnslists = a.b.c
28405 !dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
28407 However, if you are using multiple lists, the negation syntax is clearer.
28408 Consider this example:
28410 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
28412 dnsbl.njabl.org!=127.0.0.3 : \
28415 Using only positive lists, this would have to be:
28417 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
28419 deny dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org
28420 !dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org=127.0.0.3
28421 deny dnslists = relays.ordb.org
28423 which is less clear, and harder to maintain.
28428 .section "Handling multiple DNS records from a DNS list" "SECThanmuldnsrec"
28429 A DNS lookup for a &%dnslists%& condition may return more than one DNS record,
28430 thereby providing more than one IP address. When an item in a &%dnslists%& list
28431 is followed by &`=`& or &`&&`& and a list of IP addresses, in order to restrict
28432 the match to specific results from the DNS lookup, there are two ways in which
28433 the checking can be handled. For example, consider the condition:
28435 dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.1
28437 What happens if the DNS lookup for the incoming IP address yields both
28438 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2 by means of two separate DNS records? Is the
28439 condition true because at least one given value was found, or is it false
28440 because at least one of the found values was not listed? And how does this
28441 affect negated conditions? Both possibilities are provided for with the help of
28442 additional separators &`==`& and &`=&&`&.
28445 If &`=`& or &`&&`& is used, the condition is true if any one of the looked up
28446 IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. For the example above, the
28447 condition is true because 127.0.0.1 matches.
28449 If &`==`& or &`=&&`& is used, the condition is true only if every one of the
28450 looked up IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. If the condition is
28453 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1
28455 and the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
28456 false because 127.0.0.2 is not listed. You would need to have:
28458 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1,127.0.0.2
28460 for the condition to be true.
28463 When &`!`& is used to negate IP address matching, it inverts the result, giving
28464 the precise opposite of the behaviour above. Thus:
28466 If &`!=`& or &`!&&`& is used, the condition is true if none of the looked up IP
28467 addresses matches one of the listed addresses. Consider:
28469 dnslists = a.b.c!&0.0.0.1
28471 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
28472 false because 127.0.0.1 matches.
28474 If &`!==`& or &`!=&&`& is used, the condition is true if there is at least one
28475 looked up IP address that does not match. Consider:
28477 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1
28479 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
28480 true, because 127.0.0.2 does not match. You would need to have:
28482 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
28484 for the condition to be false.
28486 When the DNS lookup yields only a single IP address, there is no difference
28487 between &`=`& and &`==`& and between &`&&`& and &`=&&`&.
28492 .section "Detailed information from merged DNS lists" "SECTmordetinf"
28493 .cindex "DNS list" "information from merged"
28494 When the facility for restricting the matching IP values in a DNS list is used,
28495 the text from the TXT record that is set in &$dnslist_text$& may not reflect
28496 the true reason for rejection. This happens when lists are merged and the IP
28497 address in the A record is used to distinguish them; unfortunately there is
28498 only one TXT record. One way round this is not to use merged lists, but that
28499 can be inefficient because it requires multiple DNS lookups where one would do
28500 in the vast majority of cases when the host of interest is not on any of the
28503 A less inefficient way of solving this problem is available. If
28504 two domain names, comma-separated, are given, the second is used first to
28505 do an initial check, making use of any IP value restrictions that are set.
28506 If there is a match, the first domain is used, without any IP value
28507 restrictions, to get the TXT record. As a byproduct of this, there is also
28508 a check that the IP being tested is indeed on the first list. The first
28509 domain is the one that is put in &$dnslist_domain$&. For example:
28512 rejected because $sender_host_address is blacklisted \
28513 at $dnslist_domain\n$dnslist_text
28515 sbl.spamhaus.org,sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org=127.0.0.2 : \
28516 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
28518 For the first blacklist item, this starts by doing a lookup in
28519 &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'& and testing for a 127.0.0.2 return. If there is a
28520 match, it then looks in &'sbl.spamhaus.org'&, without checking the return
28521 value, and as long as something is found, it looks for the corresponding TXT
28522 record. If there is no match in &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'&, nothing more is done.
28523 The second blacklist item is processed similarly.
28525 If you are interested in more than one merged list, the same list must be
28526 given several times, but because the results of the DNS lookups are cached,
28527 the DNS calls themselves are not repeated. For example:
28529 reject dnslists = \
28530 http.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.2 : \
28531 socks.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.3 : \
28532 misc.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.4 : \
28533 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
28535 In this case there is one lookup in &'dnsbl.sorbs.net'&, and if none of the IP
28536 values matches (or if no record is found), this is the only lookup that is
28537 done. Only if there is a match is one of the more specific lists consulted.
28541 .section "DNS lists and IPv6" "SECTmorednslistslast"
28542 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS black lists"
28543 .cindex "DNS list" "IPv6 usage"
28544 If Exim is asked to do a dnslist lookup for an IPv6 address, it inverts it
28545 nibble by nibble. For example, if the calling host's IP address is
28546 3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031, Exim might look up
28548 1.3.0.c.a.0.0.2.0.0.8.0.a.0.0.0.0.0.a.0.f.6.3.8.
28549 f.f.f.f.e.f.f.3.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
28551 (split over two lines here to fit on the page). Unfortunately, some of the DNS
28552 lists contain wildcard records, intended for IPv4, that interact badly with
28553 IPv6. For example, the DNS entry
28555 *.3.some.list.example. A 127.0.0.1
28557 is probably intended to put the entire 3.0.0.0/8 IPv4 network on the list.
28558 Unfortunately, it also matches the entire 3::/4 IPv6 network.
28560 You can exclude IPv6 addresses from DNS lookups by making use of a suitable
28561 &%condition%& condition, as in this example:
28563 deny condition = ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}}
28564 dnslists = some.list.example
28567 .section "Rate limiting incoming messages" "SECTratelimiting"
28568 .cindex "rate limiting" "client sending"
28569 .cindex "limiting client sending rates"
28570 .oindex "&%smtp_ratelimit_*%&"
28571 The &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can be used to measure and control the rate at
28572 which clients can send email. This is more powerful than the
28573 &%smtp_ratelimit_*%& options, because those options control the rate of
28574 commands in a single SMTP session only, whereas the &%ratelimit%& condition
28575 works across all connections (concurrent and sequential) from the same client
28576 host. The syntax of the &%ratelimit%& condition is:
28578 &`ratelimit =`& <&'m'&> &`/`& <&'p'&> &`/`& <&'options'&> &`/`& <&'key'&>
28580 If the average client sending rate is less than &'m'& messages per time
28581 period &'p'& then the condition is false; otherwise it is true.
28583 As a side-effect, the &%ratelimit%& condition sets the expansion variable
28584 &$sender_rate$& to the client's computed rate, &$sender_rate_limit$& to the
28585 configured value of &'m'&, and &$sender_rate_period$& to the configured value
28588 The parameter &'p'& is the smoothing time constant, in the form of an Exim
28589 time interval, for example, &`8h`& for eight hours. A larger time constant
28590 means that it takes Exim longer to forget a client's past behaviour. The
28591 parameter &'m'& is the maximum number of messages that a client is permitted to
28592 send in each time interval. It also specifies the number of messages permitted
28593 in a fast burst. By increasing both &'m'& and &'p'& but keeping &'m/p'&
28594 constant, you can allow a client to send more messages in a burst without
28595 changing its long-term sending rate limit. Conversely, if &'m'& and &'p'& are
28596 both small, messages must be sent at an even rate.
28598 There is a script in &_util/ratelimit.pl_& which extracts sending rates from
28599 log files, to assist with choosing appropriate settings for &'m'& and &'p'&
28600 when deploying the &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. The script prints usage
28601 instructions when it is run with no arguments.
28603 The key is used to look up the data for calculating the client's average
28604 sending rate. This data is stored in Exim's spool directory, alongside the
28605 retry and other hints databases. The default key is &$sender_host_address$&,
28606 which means Exim computes the sending rate of each client host IP address.
28607 By changing the key you can change how Exim identifies clients for the purpose
28608 of ratelimiting. For example, to limit the sending rate of each authenticated
28609 user, independent of the computer they are sending from, set the key to
28610 &$authenticated_id$&. You must ensure that the lookup key is meaningful; for
28611 example, &$authenticated_id$& is only meaningful if the client has
28612 authenticated (which you can check with the &%authenticated%& ACL condition).
28614 The lookup key does not have to identify clients: If you want to limit the
28615 rate at which a recipient receives messages, you can use the key
28616 &`$local_part@$domain`& with the &%per_rcpt%& option (see below) in a RCPT
28619 Each &%ratelimit%& condition can have up to four options. A &%per_*%& option
28620 specifies what Exim measures the rate of, for example messages or recipients
28621 or bytes. You can adjust the measurement using the &%unique=%& and/or
28622 &%count=%& options. You can also control when Exim updates the recorded rate
28623 using a &%strict%&, &%leaky%&, or &%readonly%& option. The options are
28624 separated by a slash, like the other parameters. They may appear in any order.
28626 Internally, Exim appends the smoothing constant &'p'& onto the lookup key with
28627 any options that alter the meaning of the stored data. The limit &'m'& is not
28628 stored, so you can alter the configured maximum rate and Exim will still
28629 remember clients' past behaviour. If you change the &%per_*%& mode or add or
28630 remove the &%unique=%& option, the lookup key changes so Exim will forget past
28631 behaviour. The lookup key is not affected by changes to the update mode and
28632 the &%count=%& option.
28635 .section "Ratelimit options for what is being measured" "ratoptmea"
28636 .cindex "rate limiting" "per_* options"
28637 The &%per_conn%& option limits the client's connection rate. It is not
28638 normally used in the &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&, or
28639 &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs.
28641 The &%per_mail%& option limits the client's rate of sending messages. This is
28642 the default if none of the &%per_*%& options is specified. It can be used in
28643 &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_mime%&,
28644 &%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_not_smtp%&.
28646 The &%per_byte%& option limits the sender's email bandwidth. It can be used in
28647 the same ACLs as the &%per_mail%& option, though it is best to use this option
28648 in the &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs; if it is
28649 used in an earlier ACL, Exim relies on the SIZE parameter given by the client
28650 in its MAIL command, which may be inaccurate or completely missing. You can
28651 follow the limit &'m'& in the configuration with K, M, or G to specify limits
28652 in kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes, respectively.
28654 The &%per_rcpt%& option causes Exim to limit the rate at which recipients are
28655 accepted. It can be used in the &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
28656 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& ACLs. In
28657 &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& the rate is updated one recipient at a time; in the other
28658 ACLs the rate is updated with the total recipient count in one go. Note that
28659 in either case the rate limiting engine will see a message with many
28660 recipients as a large high-speed burst.
28662 The &%per_addr%& option is like the &%per_rcpt%& option, except it counts the
28663 number of different recipients that the client has sent messages to in the
28664 last time period. That is, if the client repeatedly sends messages to the same
28665 recipient, its measured rate is not increased. This option can only be used in
28668 The &%per_cmd%& option causes Exim to recompute the rate every time the
28669 condition is processed. This can be used to limit the rate of any SMTP
28670 command. If it is used in multiple ACLs it can limit the aggregate rate of
28671 multiple different commands.
28673 The &%count=%& option can be used to alter how much Exim adds to the client's
28674 measured rate. For example, the &%per_byte%& option is equivalent to
28675 &`per_mail/count=$message_size`&. If there is no &%count=%& option, Exim
28676 increases the measured rate by one (except for the &%per_rcpt%& option in ACLs
28677 other than &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&). The count does not have to be an integer.
28679 The &%unique=%& option is described in section &<<ratoptuniq>>& below.
28682 .section "Ratelimit update modes" "ratoptupd"
28683 .cindex "rate limiting" "reading data without updating"
28684 You can specify one of three options with the &%ratelimit%& condition to
28685 control when its database is updated. This section describes the &%readonly%&
28686 mode, and the next section describes the &%strict%& and &%leaky%& modes.
28688 If the &%ratelimit%& condition is used in &%readonly%& mode, Exim looks up a
28689 previously-computed rate to check against the limit.
28691 For example, you can test the client's sending rate and deny it access (when
28692 it is too fast) in the connect ACL. If the client passes this check then it
28693 can go on to send a message, in which case its recorded rate will be updated
28694 in the MAIL ACL. Subsequent connections from the same client will check this
28698 deny ratelimit = 100 / 5m / readonly
28699 log_message = RATE CHECK: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
28700 (max $sender_rate_limit)
28703 warn ratelimit = 100 / 5m / strict
28704 log_message = RATE UPDATE: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
28705 (max $sender_rate_limit)
28708 If Exim encounters multiple &%ratelimit%& conditions with the same key when
28709 processing a message then it may increase the client's measured rate more than
28710 it should. For example, this will happen if you check the &%per_rcpt%& option
28711 in both &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&. However it's OK to check the
28712 same &%ratelimit%& condition multiple times in the same ACL. You can avoid any
28713 multiple update problems by using the &%readonly%& option on later ratelimit
28716 The &%per_*%& options described above do not make sense in some ACLs. If you
28717 use a &%per_*%& option in an ACL where it is not normally permitted then the
28718 update mode defaults to &%readonly%& and you cannot specify the &%strict%& or
28719 &%leaky%& modes. In other ACLs the default update mode is &%leaky%& (see the
28720 next section) so you must specify the &%readonly%& option explicitly.
28723 .section "Ratelimit options for handling fast clients" "ratoptfast"
28724 .cindex "rate limiting" "strict and leaky modes"
28725 If a client's average rate is greater than the maximum, the rate limiting
28726 engine can react in two possible ways, depending on the presence of the
28727 &%strict%& or &%leaky%& update modes. This is independent of the other
28728 counter-measures (such as rejecting the message) that may be specified by the
28731 The &%leaky%& (default) option means that the client's recorded rate is not
28732 updated if it is above the limit. The effect of this is that Exim measures the
28733 client's average rate of successfully sent email, which cannot be greater than
28734 the maximum allowed. If the client is over the limit it may suffer some
28735 counter-measures (as specified in the ACL), but it will still be able to send
28736 email at the configured maximum rate, whatever the rate of its attempts. This
28737 is generally the better choice if you have clients that retry automatically.
28738 For example, it does not prevent a sender with an over-aggressive retry rate
28739 from getting any email through.
28741 The &%strict%& option means that the client's recorded rate is always
28742 updated. The effect of this is that Exim measures the client's average rate
28743 of attempts to send email, which can be much higher than the maximum it is
28744 actually allowed. If the client is over the limit it may be subjected to
28745 counter-measures by the ACL. It must slow down and allow sufficient time to
28746 pass that its computed rate falls below the maximum before it can send email
28747 again. The time (the number of smoothing periods) it must wait and not
28748 attempt to send mail can be calculated with this formula:
28750 ln(peakrate/maxrate)
28754 .section "Limiting the rate of different events" "ratoptuniq"
28755 .cindex "rate limiting" "counting unique events"
28756 The &%ratelimit%& &%unique=%& option controls a mechanism for counting the
28757 rate of different events. For example, the &%per_addr%& option uses this
28758 mechanism to count the number of different recipients that the client has
28759 sent messages to in the last time period; it is equivalent to
28760 &`per_rcpt/unique=$local_part@$domain`&. You could use this feature to
28761 measure the rate that a client uses different sender addresses with the
28762 options &`per_mail/unique=$sender_address`&.
28764 For each &%ratelimit%& key Exim stores the set of &%unique=%& values that it
28765 has seen for that key. The whole set is thrown away when it is older than the
28766 rate smoothing period &'p'&, so each different event is counted at most once
28767 per period. In the &%leaky%& update mode, an event that causes the client to
28768 go over the limit is not added to the set, in the same way that the client's
28769 recorded rate is not updated in the same situation.
28771 When you combine the &%unique=%& and &%readonly%& options, the specific
28772 &%unique=%& value is ignored, and Exim just retrieves the client's stored
28775 The &%unique=%& mechanism needs more space in the ratelimit database than the
28776 other &%ratelimit%& options in order to store the event set. The number of
28777 unique values is potentially as large as the rate limit, so the extra space
28778 required increases with larger limits.
28780 The uniqueification is not perfect: there is a small probability that Exim
28781 will think a new event has happened before. If the sender's rate is less than
28782 the limit, Exim should be more than 99.9% correct. However in &%strict%& mode
28783 the measured rate can go above the limit, in which case Exim may under-count
28784 events by a significant margin. Fortunately, if the rate is high enough (2.7
28785 times the limit) that the false positive rate goes above 9%, then Exim will
28786 throw away the over-full event set before the measured rate falls below the
28787 limit. Therefore the only harm should be that exceptionally high sending rates
28788 are logged incorrectly; any countermeasures you configure will be as effective
28792 .section "Using rate limiting" "useratlim"
28793 Exim's other ACL facilities are used to define what counter-measures are taken
28794 when the rate limit is exceeded. This might be anything from logging a warning
28795 (for example, while measuring existing sending rates in order to define
28796 policy), through time delays to slow down fast senders, up to rejecting the
28797 message. For example:
28799 # Log all senders' rates
28800 warn ratelimit = 0 / 1h / strict
28801 log_message = Sender rate $sender_rate / $sender_rate_period
28803 # Slow down fast senders; note the need to truncate $sender_rate
28804 # at the decimal point.
28805 warn ratelimit = 100 / 1h / per_rcpt / strict
28806 delay = ${eval: ${sg{$sender_rate}{[.].*}{}} - \
28807 $sender_rate_limit }s
28809 # Keep authenticated users under control
28810 deny authenticated = *
28811 ratelimit = 100 / 1d / strict / $authenticated_id
28813 # System-wide rate limit
28814 defer message = Sorry, too busy. Try again later.
28815 ratelimit = 10 / 1s / $primary_hostname
28817 # Restrict incoming rate from each host, with a default
28818 # set using a macro and special cases looked up in a table.
28819 defer message = Sender rate exceeds $sender_rate_limit \
28820 messages per $sender_rate_period
28821 ratelimit = ${lookup {$sender_host_address} \
28822 cdb {DB/ratelimits.cdb} \
28823 {$value} {RATELIMIT} }
28825 &*Warning*&: If you have a busy server with a lot of &%ratelimit%& tests,
28826 especially with the &%per_rcpt%& option, you may suffer from a performance
28827 bottleneck caused by locking on the ratelimit hints database. Apart from
28828 making your ACLs less complicated, you can reduce the problem by using a
28829 RAM disk for Exim's hints directory (usually &_/var/spool/exim/db/_&). However
28830 this means that Exim will lose its hints data after a reboot (including retry
28831 hints, the callout cache, and ratelimit data).
28835 .section "Address verification" "SECTaddressverification"
28836 .cindex "verifying address" "options for"
28837 .cindex "policy control" "address verification"
28838 Several of the &%verify%& conditions described in section
28839 &<<SECTaclconditions>>& cause addresses to be verified. Section
28840 &<<SECTsenaddver>>& discusses the reporting of sender verification failures.
28841 The verification conditions can be followed by options that modify the
28842 verification process. The options are separated from the keyword and from each
28843 other by slashes, and some of them contain parameters. For example:
28845 verify = sender/callout
28846 verify = recipient/defer_ok/callout=10s,defer_ok
28848 The first stage of address verification, which always happens, is to run the
28849 address through the routers, in &"verify mode"&. Routers can detect the
28850 difference between verification and routing for delivery, and their actions can
28851 be varied by a number of generic options such as &%verify%& and &%verify_only%&
28852 (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). If routing fails, verification fails.
28853 The available options are as follows:
28856 If the &%callout%& option is specified, successful routing to one or more
28857 remote hosts is followed by a &"callout"& to those hosts as an additional
28858 check. Callouts and their sub-options are discussed in the next section.
28860 If there is a defer error while doing verification routing, the ACL
28861 normally returns &"defer"&. However, if you include &%defer_ok%& in the
28862 options, the condition is forced to be true instead. Note that this is a main
28863 verification option as well as a suboption for callouts.
28865 The &%no_details%& option is covered in section &<<SECTsenaddver>>&, which
28866 discusses the reporting of sender address verification failures.
28868 The &%success_on_redirect%& option causes verification always to succeed
28869 immediately after a successful redirection. By default, if a redirection
28870 generates just one address, that address is also verified. See further
28871 discussion in section &<<SECTredirwhilveri>>&.
28874 .cindex "verifying address" "differentiating failures"
28875 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
28876 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
28877 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
28878 After an address verification failure, &$acl_verify_message$& contains the
28879 error message that is associated with the failure. It can be preserved by
28882 warn !verify = sender
28883 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
28885 If you are writing your own custom rejection message or log message when
28886 denying access, you can use this variable to include information about the
28887 verification failure.
28889 In addition, &$sender_verify_failure$& or &$recipient_verify_failure$& (as
28890 appropriate) contains one of the following words:
28893 &%qualify%&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
28894 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
28896 &%route%&: Routing failed.
28898 &%mail%&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection
28899 occurred at or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial
28900 connection, HELO, or MAIL).
28902 &%recipient%&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
28904 &%postmaster%&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
28907 The main use of these variables is expected to be to distinguish between
28908 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT in callouts.
28913 .section "Callout verification" "SECTcallver"
28914 .cindex "verifying address" "by callout"
28915 .cindex "callout" "verification"
28916 .cindex "SMTP" "callout verification"
28917 For non-local addresses, routing verifies the domain, but is unable to do any
28918 checking of the local part. There are situations where some means of verifying
28919 the local part is desirable. One way this can be done is to make an SMTP
28920 &'callback'& to a delivery host for the sender address or a &'callforward'& to
28921 a subsequent host for a recipient address, to see if the host accepts the
28922 address. We use the term &'callout'& to cover both cases. Note that for a
28923 sender address, the callback is not to the client host that is trying to
28924 deliver the message, but to one of the hosts that accepts incoming mail for the
28927 Exim does not do callouts by default. If you want them to happen, you must
28928 request them by setting appropriate options on the &%verify%& condition, as
28929 described below. This facility should be used with care, because it can add a
28930 lot of resource usage to the cost of verifying an address. However, Exim does
28931 cache the results of callouts, which helps to reduce the cost. Details of
28932 caching are in section &<<SECTcallvercache>>&.
28934 Recipient callouts are usually used only between hosts that are controlled by
28935 the same administration. For example, a corporate gateway host could use
28936 callouts to check for valid recipients on an internal mailserver. A successful
28937 callout does not guarantee that a real delivery to the address would succeed;
28938 on the other hand, a failing callout does guarantee that a delivery would fail.
28940 If the &%callout%& option is present on a condition that verifies an address, a
28941 second stage of verification occurs if the address is successfully routed to
28942 one or more remote hosts. The usual case is routing by a &(dnslookup)& or a
28943 &(manualroute)& router, where the router specifies the hosts. However, if a
28944 router that does not set up hosts routes to an &(smtp)& transport with a
28945 &%hosts%& setting, the transport's hosts are used. If an &(smtp)& transport has
28946 &%hosts_override%& set, its hosts are always used, whether or not the router
28947 supplies a host list.
28949 The port that is used is taken from the transport, if it is specified and is a
28950 remote transport. (For routers that do verification only, no transport need be
28951 specified.) Otherwise, the default SMTP port is used. If a remote transport
28952 specifies an outgoing interface, this is used; otherwise the interface is not
28953 specified. Likewise, the text that is used for the HELO command is taken from
28954 the transport's &%helo_data%& option; if there is no transport, the value of
28955 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is used.
28957 For a sender callout check, Exim makes SMTP connections to the remote hosts, to
28958 test whether a bounce message could be delivered to the sender address. The
28959 following SMTP commands are sent:
28961 &`HELO `&<&'local host name'&>
28963 &`RCPT TO:`&<&'the address to be tested'&>
28966 LHLO is used instead of HELO if the transport's &%protocol%& option is
28969 The callout may use EHLO, AUTH and/or STARTTLS given appropriate option
28972 A recipient callout check is similar. By default, it also uses an empty address
28973 for the sender. This default is chosen because most hosts do not make use of
28974 the sender address when verifying a recipient. Using the same address means
28975 that a single cache entry can be used for each recipient. Some sites, however,
28976 do make use of the sender address when verifying. These are catered for by the
28977 &%use_sender%& and &%use_postmaster%& options, described in the next section.
28979 If the response to the RCPT command is a 2&'xx'& code, the verification
28980 succeeds. If it is 5&'xx'&, the verification fails. For any other condition,
28981 Exim tries the next host, if any. If there is a problem with all the remote
28982 hosts, the ACL yields &"defer"&, unless the &%defer_ok%& parameter of the
28983 &%callout%& option is given, in which case the condition is forced to succeed.
28985 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
28986 A callout may take a little time. For this reason, Exim normally flushes SMTP
28987 output before performing a callout in an ACL, to avoid unexpected timeouts in
28988 clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use. The flushing can be
28989 disabled by using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_callout_flush%&.
28994 .section "Additional parameters for callouts" "CALLaddparcall"
28995 .cindex "callout" "additional parameters for"
28996 The &%callout%& option can be followed by an equals sign and a number of
28997 optional parameters, separated by commas. For example:
28999 verify = recipient/callout=10s,defer_ok
29001 The old syntax, which had &%callout_defer_ok%& and &%check_postmaster%& as
29002 separate verify options, is retained for backwards compatibility, but is now
29003 deprecated. The additional parameters for &%callout%& are as follows:
29007 .vitem <&'a&~time&~interval'&>
29008 .cindex "callout" "timeout, specifying"
29009 This specifies the timeout that applies for the callout attempt to each host.
29012 verify = sender/callout=5s
29014 The default is 30 seconds. The timeout is used for each response from the
29015 remote host. It is also used for the initial connection, unless overridden by
29016 the &%connect%& parameter.
29019 .vitem &*connect&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
29020 .cindex "callout" "connection timeout, specifying"
29021 This parameter makes it possible to set a different (usually smaller) timeout
29022 for making the SMTP connection. For example:
29024 verify = sender/callout=5s,connect=1s
29026 If not specified, this timeout defaults to the general timeout value.
29028 .vitem &*defer_ok*&
29029 .cindex "callout" "defer, action on"
29030 When this parameter is present, failure to contact any host, or any other kind
29031 of temporary error, is treated as success by the ACL. However, the cache is not
29032 updated in this circumstance.
29034 .vitem &*fullpostmaster*&
29035 .cindex "callout" "full postmaster check"
29036 This operates like the &%postmaster%& option (see below), but if the check for
29037 &'postmaster@domain'& fails, it tries just &'postmaster'&, without a domain, in
29038 accordance with the specification in RFC 2821. The RFC states that the
29039 unqualified address &'postmaster'& should be accepted.
29042 .vitem &*mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
29043 .cindex "callout" "sender when verifying header"
29044 When verifying addresses in header lines using the &%header_sender%&
29045 verification option, Exim behaves by default as if the addresses are envelope
29046 sender addresses from a message. Callout verification therefore tests to see
29047 whether a bounce message could be delivered, by using an empty address in the
29048 MAIL command. However, it is arguable that these addresses might never be used
29049 as envelope senders, and could therefore justifiably reject bounce messages
29050 (empty senders). The &%mailfrom%& callout parameter allows you to specify what
29051 address to use in the MAIL command. For example:
29053 require verify = header_sender/callout=mailfrom=abcd@x.y.z
29055 This parameter is available only for the &%header_sender%& verification option.
29058 .vitem &*maxwait&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
29059 .cindex "callout" "overall timeout, specifying"
29060 This parameter sets an overall timeout for performing a callout verification.
29063 verify = sender/callout=5s,maxwait=30s
29065 This timeout defaults to four times the callout timeout for individual SMTP
29066 commands. The overall timeout applies when there is more than one host that can
29067 be tried. The timeout is checked before trying the next host. This prevents
29068 very long delays if there are a large number of hosts and all are timing out
29069 (for example, when network connections are timing out).
29072 .vitem &*no_cache*&
29073 .cindex "callout" "cache, suppressing"
29074 .cindex "caching callout, suppressing"
29075 When this parameter is given, the callout cache is neither read nor updated.
29077 .vitem &*postmaster*&
29078 .cindex "callout" "postmaster; checking"
29079 When this parameter is set, a successful callout check is followed by a similar
29080 check for the local part &'postmaster'& at the same domain. If this address is
29081 rejected, the callout fails (but see &%fullpostmaster%& above). The result of
29082 the postmaster check is recorded in a cache record; if it is a failure, this is
29083 used to fail subsequent callouts for the domain without a connection being
29084 made, until the cache record expires.
29086 .vitem &*postmaster_mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
29087 The postmaster check uses an empty sender in the MAIL command by default.
29088 You can use this parameter to do a postmaster check using a different address.
29091 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=abc@x.y.z
29093 If both &%postmaster%& and &%postmaster_mailfrom%& are present, the rightmost
29094 one overrides. The &%postmaster%& parameter is equivalent to this example:
29096 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=
29098 &*Warning*&: The caching arrangements for postmaster checking do not take
29099 account of the sender address. It is assumed that either the empty address or
29100 a fixed non-empty address will be used. All that Exim remembers is that the
29101 postmaster check for the domain succeeded or failed.
29105 .cindex "callout" "&""random""& check"
29106 When this parameter is set, before doing the normal callout check, Exim does a
29107 check for a &"random"& local part at the same domain. The local part is not
29108 really random &-- it is defined by the expansion of the option
29109 &%callout_random_local_part%&, which defaults to
29111 $primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
29113 The idea here is to try to determine whether the remote host accepts all local
29114 parts without checking. If it does, there is no point in doing callouts for
29115 specific local parts. If the &"random"& check succeeds, the result is saved in
29116 a cache record, and used to force the current and subsequent callout checks to
29117 succeed without a connection being made, until the cache record expires.
29119 .vitem &*use_postmaster*&
29120 .cindex "callout" "sender for recipient check"
29121 This parameter applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
29123 deny !verify = recipient/callout=use_postmaster
29125 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
29126 It causes a non-empty postmaster address to be used in the MAIL command when
29127 performing the callout for the recipient, and also for a &"random"& check if
29128 that is configured. The local part of the address is &`postmaster`& and the
29129 domain is the contents of &$qualify_domain$&.
29131 .vitem &*use_sender*&
29132 This option applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
29134 require verify = recipient/callout=use_sender
29136 It causes the message's actual sender address to be used in the MAIL
29137 command when performing the callout, instead of an empty address. There is no
29138 need to use this option unless you know that the called hosts make use of the
29139 sender when checking recipients. If used indiscriminately, it reduces the
29140 usefulness of callout caching.
29143 If you use any of the parameters that set a non-empty sender for the MAIL
29144 command (&%mailfrom%&, &%postmaster_mailfrom%&, &%use_postmaster%&, or
29145 &%use_sender%&), you should think about possible loops. Recipient checking is
29146 usually done between two hosts that are under the same management, and the host
29147 that receives the callouts is not normally configured to do callouts itself.
29148 Therefore, it is normally safe to use &%use_postmaster%& or &%use_sender%& in
29149 these circumstances.
29151 However, if you use a non-empty sender address for a callout to an arbitrary
29152 host, there is the likelihood that the remote host will itself initiate a
29153 callout check back to your host. As it is checking what appears to be a message
29154 sender, it is likely to use an empty address in MAIL, thus avoiding a
29155 callout loop. However, to be on the safe side it would be best to set up your
29156 own ACLs so that they do not do sender verification checks when the recipient
29157 is the address you use for header sender or postmaster callout checking.
29159 Another issue to think about when using non-empty senders for callouts is
29160 caching. When you set &%mailfrom%& or &%use_sender%&, the cache record is keyed
29161 by the sender/recipient combination; thus, for any given recipient, many more
29162 actual callouts are performed than when an empty sender or postmaster is used.
29167 .section "Callout caching" "SECTcallvercache"
29168 .cindex "hints database" "callout cache"
29169 .cindex "callout" "cache, description of"
29170 .cindex "caching" "callout"
29171 Exim caches the results of callouts in order to reduce the amount of resources
29172 used, unless you specify the &%no_cache%& parameter with the &%callout%&
29173 option. A hints database called &"callout"& is used for the cache. Two
29174 different record types are used: one records the result of a callout check for
29175 a specific address, and the other records information that applies to the
29176 entire domain (for example, that it accepts the local part &'postmaster'&).
29178 When an original callout fails, a detailed SMTP error message is given about
29179 the failure. However, for subsequent failures use the cache data, this message
29182 The expiry times for negative and positive address cache records are
29183 independent, and can be set by the global options &%callout_negative_expire%&
29184 (default 2h) and &%callout_positive_expire%& (default 24h), respectively.
29186 If a host gives a negative response to an SMTP connection, or rejects any
29187 commands up to and including
29191 (but not including the MAIL command with a non-empty address),
29192 any callout attempt is bound to fail. Exim remembers such failures in a
29193 domain cache record, which it uses to fail callouts for the domain without
29194 making new connections, until the domain record times out. There are two
29195 separate expiry times for domain cache records:
29196 &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& (default 3h) and
29197 &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& (default 7d).
29199 Domain records expire when the negative expiry time is reached if callouts
29200 cannot be made for the domain, or if the postmaster check failed.
29201 Otherwise, they expire when the positive expiry time is reached. This
29202 ensures that, for example, a host that stops accepting &"random"& local parts
29203 will eventually be noticed.
29205 The callout caching mechanism is based on the domain of the address that is
29206 being tested. If the domain routes to several hosts, it is assumed that their
29207 behaviour will be the same.
29211 .section "Sender address verification reporting" "SECTsenaddver"
29212 .cindex "verifying" "suppressing error details"
29213 See section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& for a general discussion of
29214 verification. When sender verification fails in an ACL, the details of the
29215 failure are given as additional output lines before the 550 response to the
29216 relevant SMTP command (RCPT or DATA). For example, if sender callout is in use,
29219 MAIL FROM:<xyz@abc.example>
29221 RCPT TO:<pqr@def.example>
29222 550-Verification failed for <xyz@abc.example>
29223 550-Called: 192.168.34.43
29224 550-Sent: RCPT TO:<xyz@abc.example>
29225 550-Response: 550 Unknown local part xyz in <xyz@abc.example>
29226 550 Sender verification failed
29228 If more than one RCPT command fails in the same way, the details are given
29229 only for the first of them. However, some administrators do not want to send
29230 out this much information. You can suppress the details by adding
29231 &`/no_details`& to the ACL statement that requests sender verification. For
29234 verify = sender/no_details
29237 .section "Redirection while verifying" "SECTredirwhilveri"
29238 .cindex "verifying" "redirection while"
29239 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
29240 A dilemma arises when a local address is redirected by aliasing or forwarding
29241 during verification: should the generated addresses themselves be verified,
29242 or should the successful expansion of the original address be enough to verify
29243 it? By default, Exim takes the following pragmatic approach:
29246 When an incoming address is redirected to just one child address, verification
29247 continues with the child address, and if that fails to verify, the original
29248 verification also fails.
29250 When an incoming address is redirected to more than one child address,
29251 verification does not continue. A success result is returned.
29254 This seems the most reasonable behaviour for the common use of aliasing as a
29255 way of redirecting different local parts to the same mailbox. It means, for
29256 example, that a pair of alias entries of the form
29259 aw123: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
29261 work as expected, with both local parts causing verification failure. When a
29262 redirection generates more than one address, the behaviour is more like a
29263 mailing list, where the existence of the alias itself is sufficient for
29264 verification to succeed.
29266 It is possible, however, to change the default behaviour so that all successful
29267 redirections count as successful verifications, however many new addresses are
29268 generated. This is specified by the &%success_on_redirect%& verification
29269 option. For example:
29271 require verify = recipient/success_on_redirect/callout=10s
29273 In this example, verification succeeds if a router generates a new address, and
29274 the callout does not occur, because no address was routed to a remote host.
29276 When verification is being tested via the &%-bv%& option, the treatment of
29277 redirections is as just described, unless the &%-v%& or any debugging option is
29278 also specified. In that case, full verification is done for every generated
29279 address and a report is output for each of them.
29283 .section "Client SMTP authorization (CSA)" "SECTverifyCSA"
29284 .cindex "CSA" "verifying"
29285 Client SMTP Authorization is a system that allows a site to advertise
29286 which machines are and are not permitted to send email. This is done by placing
29287 special SRV records in the DNS; these are looked up using the client's HELO
29288 domain. At the time of writing, CSA is still an Internet Draft. Client SMTP
29289 Authorization checks in Exim are performed by the ACL condition:
29293 This fails if the client is not authorized. If there is a DNS problem, or if no
29294 valid CSA SRV record is found, or if the client is authorized, the condition
29295 succeeds. These three cases can be distinguished using the expansion variable
29296 &$csa_status$&, which can take one of the values &"fail"&, &"defer"&,
29297 &"unknown"&, or &"ok"&. The condition does not itself defer because that would
29298 be likely to cause problems for legitimate email.
29300 The error messages produced by the CSA code include slightly more
29301 detail. If &$csa_status$& is &"defer"&, this may be because of problems
29302 looking up the CSA SRV record, or problems looking up the CSA target
29303 address record. There are four reasons for &$csa_status$& being &"fail"&:
29306 The client's host name is explicitly not authorized.
29308 The client's IP address does not match any of the CSA target IP addresses.
29310 The client's host name is authorized but it has no valid target IP addresses
29311 (for example, the target's addresses are IPv6 and the client is using IPv4).
29313 The client's host name has no CSA SRV record but a parent domain has asserted
29314 that all subdomains must be explicitly authorized.
29317 The &%csa%& verification condition can take an argument which is the domain to
29318 use for the DNS query. The default is:
29320 verify = csa/$sender_helo_name
29322 This implementation includes an extension to CSA. If the query domain
29323 is an address literal such as [192.0.2.95], or if it is a bare IP
29324 address, Exim searches for CSA SRV records in the reverse DNS as if
29325 the HELO domain was (for example) &'95.2.0.192.in-addr.arpa'&. Therefore it is
29328 verify = csa/$sender_host_address
29330 In fact, this is the check that Exim performs if the client does not say HELO.
29331 This extension can be turned off by setting the main configuration option
29332 &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& to be false.
29334 If a CSA SRV record is not found for the domain itself, a search
29335 is performed through its parent domains for a record which might be
29336 making assertions about subdomains. The maximum depth of this search is limited
29337 using the main configuration option &%dns_csa_search_limit%&, which is 5 by
29338 default. Exim does not look for CSA SRV records in a top level domain, so the
29339 default settings handle HELO domains as long as seven
29340 (&'hostname.five.four.three.two.one.com'&). This encompasses the vast majority
29341 of legitimate HELO domains.
29343 The &'dnsdb'& lookup also has support for CSA. Although &'dnsdb'& also supports
29344 direct SRV lookups, this is not sufficient because of the extra parent domain
29345 search behaviour of CSA, and (as with PTR lookups) &'dnsdb'& also turns IP
29346 addresses into lookups in the reverse DNS space. The result of a successful
29349 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
29351 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
29352 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
29353 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
29358 .section "Bounce address tag validation" "SECTverifyPRVS"
29359 .cindex "BATV, verifying"
29360 Bounce address tag validation (BATV) is a scheme whereby the envelope senders
29361 of outgoing messages have a cryptographic, timestamped &"tag"& added to them.
29362 Genuine incoming bounce messages should therefore always be addressed to
29363 recipients that have a valid tag. This scheme is a way of detecting unwanted
29364 bounce messages caused by sender address forgeries (often called &"collateral
29365 spam"&), because the recipients of such messages do not include valid tags.
29367 There are two expansion items to help with the implementation of the BATV
29368 &"prvs"& (private signature) scheme in an Exim configuration. This scheme signs
29369 the original envelope sender address by using a simple key to add a hash of the
29370 address and some time-based randomizing information. The &%prvs%& expansion
29371 item creates a signed address, and the &%prvscheck%& expansion item checks one.
29372 The syntax of these expansion items is described in section
29373 &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
29375 As an example, suppose the secret per-address keys are stored in an MySQL
29376 database. A query to look up the key for an address could be defined as a macro
29379 PRVSCHECK_SQL = ${lookup mysql{SELECT secret FROM batv_prvs \
29380 WHERE sender='${quote_mysql:$prvscheck_address}'\
29383 Suppose also that the senders who make use of BATV are defined by an address
29384 list called &%batv_senders%&. Then, in the ACL for RCPT commands, you could
29387 # Bounces: drop unsigned addresses for BATV senders
29388 deny message = This address does not send an unsigned reverse path
29390 recipients = +batv_senders
29392 # Bounces: In case of prvs-signed address, check signature.
29393 deny message = Invalid reverse path signature.
29395 condition = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}\
29396 {PRVSCHECK_SQL}{1}}
29397 !condition = $prvscheck_result
29399 The first statement rejects recipients for bounce messages that are addressed
29400 to plain BATV sender addresses, because it is known that BATV senders do not
29401 send out messages with plain sender addresses. The second statement rejects
29402 recipients that are prvs-signed, but with invalid signatures (either because
29403 the key is wrong, or the signature has timed out).
29405 A non-prvs-signed address is not rejected by the second statement, because the
29406 &%prvscheck%& expansion yields an empty string if its first argument is not a
29407 prvs-signed address, thus causing the &%condition%& condition to be false. If
29408 the first argument is a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the yield is
29409 the third string (in this case &"1"&), whether or not the cryptographic and
29410 timeout checks succeed. The &$prvscheck_result$& variable contains the result
29411 of the checks (empty for failure, &"1"& for success).
29413 There is one more issue you must consider when implementing prvs-signing:
29414 you have to ensure that the routers accept prvs-signed addresses and
29415 deliver them correctly. The easiest way to handle this is to use a &(redirect)&
29416 router to remove the signature with a configuration along these lines:
29420 data = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}{PRVSCHECK_SQL}}
29422 This works because, if the third argument of &%prvscheck%& is empty, the result
29423 of the expansion of a prvs-signed address is the decoded value of the original
29424 address. This router should probably be the first of your routers that handles
29427 To create BATV-signed addresses in the first place, a transport of this form
29430 external_smtp_batv:
29432 return_path = ${prvs {$return_path} \
29433 {${lookup mysql{SELECT \
29434 secret FROM batv_prvs WHERE \
29435 sender='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'} \
29438 If no key can be found for the existing return path, no signing takes place.
29442 .section "Using an ACL to control relaying" "SECTrelaycontrol"
29443 .cindex "&ACL;" "relay control"
29444 .cindex "relaying" "control by ACL"
29445 .cindex "policy control" "relay control"
29446 An MTA is said to &'relay'& a message if it receives it from some host and
29447 delivers it directly to another host as a result of a remote address contained
29448 within it. Redirecting a local address via an alias or forward file and then
29449 passing the message on to another host is not relaying,
29450 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
29451 but a redirection as a result of the &"percent hack"& is.
29453 Two kinds of relaying exist, which are termed &"incoming"& and &"outgoing"&.
29454 A host which is acting as a gateway or an MX backup is concerned with incoming
29455 relaying from arbitrary hosts to a specific set of domains. On the other hand,
29456 a host which is acting as a smart host for a number of clients is concerned
29457 with outgoing relaying from those clients to the Internet at large. Often the
29458 same host is fulfilling both functions,
29460 . as illustrated in the diagram below,
29462 but in principle these two kinds of relaying are entirely independent. What is
29463 not wanted is the transmission of mail from arbitrary remote hosts through your
29464 system to arbitrary domains.
29467 You can implement relay control by means of suitable statements in the ACL that
29468 runs for each RCPT command. For convenience, it is often easiest to use
29469 Exim's named list facility to define the domains and hosts involved. For
29470 example, suppose you want to do the following:
29473 Deliver a number of domains to mailboxes on the local host (or process them
29474 locally in some other way). Let's say these are &'my.dom1.example'& and
29475 &'my.dom2.example'&.
29477 Relay mail for a number of other domains for which you are the secondary MX.
29478 These might be &'friend1.example'& and &'friend2.example'&.
29480 Relay mail from the hosts on your local LAN, to whatever domains are involved.
29481 Suppose your LAN is 192.168.45.0/24.
29485 In the main part of the configuration, you put the following definitions:
29487 domainlist local_domains = my.dom1.example : my.dom2.example
29488 domainlist relay_to_domains = friend1.example : friend2.example
29489 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.45.0/24
29491 Now you can use these definitions in the ACL that is run for every RCPT
29495 accept domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
29496 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
29498 The first statement accepts any RCPT command that contains an address in
29499 the local or relay domains. For any other domain, control passes to the second
29500 statement, which accepts the command only if it comes from one of the relay
29501 hosts. In practice, you will probably want to make your ACL more sophisticated
29502 than this, for example, by including sender and recipient verification. The
29503 default configuration includes a more comprehensive example, which is described
29504 in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
29508 .section "Checking a relay configuration" "SECTcheralcon"
29509 .cindex "relaying" "checking control of"
29510 You can check the relay characteristics of your configuration in the same way
29511 that you can test any ACL behaviour for an incoming SMTP connection, by using
29512 the &%-bh%& option to run a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
29514 For specifically testing for unwanted relaying, the host
29515 &'relay-test.mail-abuse.org'& provides a useful service. If you telnet to this
29516 host from the host on which Exim is running, using the normal telnet port, you
29517 will see a normal telnet connection message and then quite a long delay. Be
29518 patient. The remote host is making an SMTP connection back to your host, and
29519 trying a number of common probes to test for open relay vulnerability. The
29520 results of the tests will eventually appear on your terminal.
29525 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29526 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29528 .chapter "Content scanning at ACL time" "CHAPexiscan"
29529 .scindex IIDcosca "content scanning" "at ACL time"
29530 The extension of Exim to include content scanning at ACL time, formerly known
29531 as &"exiscan"&, was originally implemented as a patch by Tom Kistner. The code
29532 was integrated into the main source for Exim release 4.50, and Tom continues to
29533 maintain it. Most of the wording of this chapter is taken from Tom's
29536 It is also possible to scan the content of messages at other times. The
29537 &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) allows for content
29538 scanning after all the ACLs have run. A transport filter can be used to scan
29539 messages at delivery time (see the &%transport_filter%& option, described in
29540 chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
29542 If you want to include the ACL-time content-scanning features when you compile
29543 Exim, you need to arrange for WITH_CONTENT_SCAN to be defined in your
29544 &_Local/Makefile_&. When you do that, the Exim binary is built with:
29547 Two additional ACLs (&%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&) that are run
29548 for all MIME parts for SMTP and non-SMTP messages, respectively.
29550 Additional ACL conditions and modifiers: &%decode%&, &%malware%&,
29551 &%mime_regex%&, &%regex%&, and &%spam%&. These can be used in the ACL that is
29552 run at the end of message reception (the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL).
29554 An additional control feature (&"no_mbox_unspool"&) that saves spooled copies
29555 of messages, or parts of messages, for debugging purposes.
29557 Additional expansion variables that are set in the new ACL and by the new
29560 Two new main configuration options: &%av_scanner%& and &%spamd_address%&.
29563 There is another content-scanning configuration option for &_Local/Makefile_&,
29564 called WITH_OLD_DEMIME. If this is set, the old, deprecated &%demime%& ACL
29565 condition is compiled, in addition to all the other content-scanning features.
29567 Content-scanning is continually evolving, and new features are still being
29568 added. While such features are still unstable and liable to incompatible
29569 changes, they are made available in Exim by setting options whose names begin
29570 EXPERIMENTAL_ in &_Local/Makefile_&. Such features are not documented in
29571 this manual. You can find out about them by reading the file called
29572 &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
29574 All the content-scanning facilities work on a MBOX copy of the message that is
29575 temporarily created in a file called:
29577 <&'spool_directory'&>&`/scan/`&<&'message_id'&>/<&'message_id'&>&`.eml`&
29579 The &_.eml_& extension is a friendly hint to virus scanners that they can
29580 expect an MBOX-like structure inside that file. The file is created when the
29581 first content scanning facility is called. Subsequent calls to content
29582 scanning conditions open the same file again. The directory is recursively
29583 removed when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL has finished running, unless
29585 control = no_mbox_unspool
29587 has been encountered. When the MIME ACL decodes files, they are put into the
29588 same directory by default.
29592 .section "Scanning for viruses" "SECTscanvirus"
29593 .cindex "virus scanning"
29594 .cindex "content scanning" "for viruses"
29595 .cindex "content scanning" "the &%malware%& condition"
29596 The &%malware%& ACL condition lets you connect virus scanner software to Exim.
29597 It supports a &"generic"& interface to scanners called via the shell, and
29598 specialized interfaces for &"daemon"& type virus scanners, which are resident
29599 in memory and thus are much faster.
29602 .oindex "&%av_scanner%&"
29603 You can set the &%av_scanner%& option in first part of the Exim configuration
29604 file to specify which scanner to use, together with any additional options that
29605 are needed. The basic syntax is as follows:
29607 &`av_scanner = <`&&'scanner-type'&&`>:<`&&'option1'&&`>:<`&&'option2'&&`>:[...]`&
29609 If you do not set &%av_scanner%&, it defaults to
29611 av_scanner = sophie:/var/run/sophie
29613 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
29614 before use. The following scanner types are supported in this release:
29617 .vitem &%aveserver%&
29618 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
29619 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 5. You can get a trial version
29620 at &url(http://www.kaspersky.com). This scanner type takes one option,
29621 which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket. The default is shown in this
29624 av_scanner = aveserver:/var/run/aveserver
29629 .cindex "virus scanners" "clamd"
29630 This daemon-type scanner is GPL and free. You can get it at
29631 &url(http://www.clamav.net/). Some older versions of clamd do not seem to
29632 unpack MIME containers, so it used to be recommended to unpack MIME attachments
29633 in the MIME ACL. This no longer believed to be necessary. One option is
29634 required: either the path and name of a UNIX socket file, or a hostname or IP
29635 number, and a port, separated by space, as in the second of these examples:
29637 av_scanner = clamd:/opt/clamd/socket
29638 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234
29639 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234:local
29641 If the value of av_scanner points to a UNIX socket file or contains the local
29642 keyword, then the ClamAV interface will pass a filename containing the data
29643 to be scanned, which will should normally result in less I/O happening and be
29644 more efficient. Normally in the TCP case, the data is streamed to ClamAV as
29645 Exim does not assume that there is a common filesystem with the remote host.
29646 There is an option WITH_OLD_CLAMAV_STREAM in &_src/EDITME_& available, should
29647 you be running a version of ClamAV prior to 0.95.
29648 If the option is unset, the default is &_/tmp/clamd_&. Thanks to David Saez for
29649 contributing the code for this scanner.
29652 .cindex "virus scanners" "command line interface"
29653 This is the keyword for the generic command line scanner interface. It can be
29654 used to attach virus scanners that are invoked from the shell. This scanner
29655 type takes 3 mandatory options:
29658 The full path and name of the scanner binary, with all command line options,
29659 and a placeholder (&`%s`&) for the directory to scan.
29662 A regular expression to match against the STDOUT and STDERR output of the
29663 virus scanner. If the expression matches, a virus was found. You must make
29664 absolutely sure that this expression matches on &"virus found"&. This is called
29665 the &"trigger"& expression.
29668 Another regular expression, containing exactly one pair of parentheses, to
29669 match the name of the virus found in the scanners output. This is called the
29670 &"name"& expression.
29673 For example, Sophos Sweep reports a virus on a line like this:
29675 Virus 'W32/Magistr-B' found in file ./those.bat
29677 For the trigger expression, we can match the phrase &"found in file"&. For the
29678 name expression, we want to extract the W32/Magistr-B string, so we can match
29679 for the single quotes left and right of it. Altogether, this makes the
29680 configuration setting:
29682 av_scanner = cmdline:\
29683 /path/to/sweep -ss -all -rec -archive %s:\
29684 found in file:'(.+)'
29687 .cindex "virus scanners" "DrWeb"
29688 The DrWeb daemon scanner (&url(http://www.sald.com/)) interface takes one
29689 argument, either a full path to a UNIX socket, or an IP address and port
29690 separated by white space, as in these examples:
29692 av_scanner = drweb:/var/run/drwebd.sock
29693 av_scanner = drweb:192.168.2.20 31337
29695 If you omit the argument, the default path &_/usr/local/drweb/run/drwebd.sock_&
29696 is used. Thanks to Alex Miller for contributing the code for this scanner.
29699 .cindex "virus scanners" "F-Secure"
29700 The F-Secure daemon scanner (&url(http://www.f-secure.com)) takes one
29701 argument which is the path to a UNIX socket. For example:
29703 av_scanner = fsecure:/path/to/.fsav
29705 If no argument is given, the default is &_/var/run/.fsav_&. Thanks to Johan
29706 Thelmen for contributing the code for this scanner.
29708 .vitem &%kavdaemon%&
29709 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
29710 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 4. This version of the
29711 Kaspersky scanner is outdated. Please upgrade (see &%aveserver%& above). This
29712 scanner type takes one option, which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket.
29715 av_scanner = kavdaemon:/opt/AVP/AvpCtl
29717 The default path is &_/var/run/AvpCtl_&.
29720 .cindex "virus scanners" "mksd"
29721 This is a daemon type scanner that is aimed mainly at Polish users, though some
29722 parts of documentation are now available in English. You can get it at
29723 &url(http://linux.mks.com.pl/). The only option for this scanner type is
29724 the maximum number of processes used simultaneously to scan the attachments,
29725 provided that the demime facility is employed and also provided that mksd has
29726 been run with at least the same number of child processes. For example:
29728 av_scanner = mksd:2
29730 You can safely omit this option (the default value is 1).
29733 .cindex "virus scanners" "Sophos and Sophie"
29734 Sophie is a daemon that uses Sophos' &%libsavi%& library to scan for viruses.
29735 You can get Sophie at &url(http://www.clanfield.info/sophie/). The only option
29736 for this scanner type is the path to the UNIX socket that Sophie uses for
29737 client communication. For example:
29739 av_scanner = sophie:/tmp/sophie
29741 The default path is &_/var/run/sophie_&, so if you are using this, you can omit
29745 When &%av_scanner%& is correctly set, you can use the &%malware%& condition in
29746 the DATA ACL. &*Note*&: You cannot use the &%malware%& condition in the MIME
29749 The &%av_scanner%& option is expanded each time &%malware%& is called. This
29750 makes it possible to use different scanners. See further below for an example.
29751 The &%malware%& condition caches its results, so when you use it multiple times
29752 for the same message, the actual scanning process is only carried out once.
29753 However, using expandable items in &%av_scanner%& disables this caching, in
29754 which case each use of the &%malware%& condition causes a new scan of the
29757 The &%malware%& condition takes a right-hand argument that is expanded before
29758 use. It can then be one of
29761 &"true"&, &"*"&, or &"1"&, in which case the message is scanned for viruses.
29762 The condition succeeds if a virus was found, and fail otherwise. This is the
29765 &"false"& or &"0"& or an empty string, in which case no scanning is done and
29766 the condition fails immediately.
29768 A regular expression, in which case the message is scanned for viruses. The
29769 condition succeeds if a virus is found and its name matches the regular
29770 expression. This allows you to take special actions on certain types of virus.
29773 You can append &`/defer_ok`& to the &%malware%& condition to accept messages
29774 even if there is a problem with the virus scanner. Otherwise, such a problem
29775 causes the ACL to defer.
29777 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
29778 When a virus is found, the condition sets up an expansion variable called
29779 &$malware_name$& that contains the name of the virus. You can use it in a
29780 &%message%& modifier that specifies the error returned to the sender, and/or in
29783 If your virus scanner cannot unpack MIME and TNEF containers itself, you should
29784 use the &%demime%& condition (see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&) before the
29785 &%malware%& condition.
29787 Beware the interaction of Exim's &%message_size_limit%& with any size limits
29788 imposed by your anti-virus scanner.
29790 Here is a very simple scanning example:
29792 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
29796 The next example accepts messages when there is a problem with the scanner:
29798 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
29800 malware = */defer_ok
29802 The next example shows how to use an ACL variable to scan with both sophie and
29803 aveserver. It assumes you have set:
29805 av_scanner = $acl_m0
29807 in the main Exim configuration.
29809 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
29810 set acl_m0 = sophie
29813 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
29814 set acl_m0 = aveserver
29819 .section "Scanning with SpamAssassin" "SECTscanspamass"
29820 .cindex "content scanning" "for spam"
29821 .cindex "spam scanning"
29822 .cindex "SpamAssassin"
29823 The &%spam%& ACL condition calls SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon to get a spam
29824 score and a report for the message. You can get SpamAssassin at
29825 &url(http://www.spamassassin.org), or, if you have a working Perl
29826 installation, you can use CPAN by running:
29828 perl -MCPAN -e 'install Mail::SpamAssassin'
29830 SpamAssassin has its own set of configuration files. Please review its
29831 documentation to see how you can tweak it. The default installation should work
29834 .oindex "&%spamd_address%&"
29835 After having installed and configured SpamAssassin, start the &%spamd%& daemon.
29836 By default, it listens on 127.0.0.1, TCP port 783. If you use another host or
29837 port for &%spamd%&, you must set the &%spamd_address%& option in the global
29838 part of the Exim configuration as follows (example):
29840 spamd_address = 192.168.99.45 387
29842 You do not need to set this option if you use the default. As of version 2.60,
29843 &%spamd%& also supports communication over UNIX sockets. If you want to use
29844 these, supply &%spamd_address%& with an absolute file name instead of a
29847 spamd_address = /var/run/spamd_socket
29849 You can have multiple &%spamd%& servers to improve scalability. These can
29850 reside on other hardware reachable over the network. To specify multiple
29851 &%spamd%& servers, put multiple address/port pairs in the &%spamd_address%&
29852 option, separated with colons:
29854 spamd_address = 192.168.2.10 783 : \
29855 192.168.2.11 783 : \
29858 Up to 32 &%spamd%& servers are supported. The servers are queried in a random
29859 fashion. When a server fails to respond to the connection attempt, all other
29860 servers are tried until one succeeds. If no server responds, the &%spam%&
29863 &*Warning*&: It is not possible to use the UNIX socket connection method with
29864 multiple &%spamd%& servers.
29866 The &%spamd_address%& variable is expanded before use if it starts with
29867 a dollar sign. In this case, the expansion may return a string that is
29868 used as the list so that multiple spamd servers can be the result of an
29871 .section "Calling SpamAssassin from an Exim ACL" "SECID206"
29872 Here is a simple example of the use of the &%spam%& condition in a DATA ACL:
29874 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
29877 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition specifies a name. This is
29878 relevant if you have set up multiple SpamAssassin profiles. If you do not want
29879 to scan using a specific profile, but rather use the SpamAssassin system-wide
29880 default profile, you can scan for an unknown name, or simply use &"nobody"&.
29881 However, you must put something on the right-hand side.
29883 The name allows you to use per-domain or per-user antispam profiles in
29884 principle, but this is not straightforward in practice, because a message may
29885 have multiple recipients, not necessarily all in the same domain. Because the
29886 &%spam%& condition has to be called from a DATA ACL in order to be able to
29887 read the contents of the message, the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$&
29890 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition is expanded before being used, so
29891 you can put lookups or conditions there. When the right-hand side evaluates to
29892 &"0"& or &"false"&, no scanning is done and the condition fails immediately.
29895 Scanning with SpamAssassin uses a lot of resources. If you scan every message,
29896 large ones may cause significant performance degradation. As most spam messages
29897 are quite small, it is recommended that you do not scan the big ones. For
29900 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
29901 condition = ${if < {$message_size}{10K}}
29905 The &%spam%& condition returns true if the threshold specified in the user's
29906 SpamAssassin profile has been matched or exceeded. If you want to use the
29907 &%spam%& condition for its side effects (see the variables below), you can make
29908 it always return &"true"& by appending &`:true`& to the username.
29910 .cindex "spam scanning" "returned variables"
29911 When the &%spam%& condition is run, it sets up a number of expansion
29912 variables. These variables are saved with the received message, thus they are
29913 available for use at delivery time.
29916 .vitem &$spam_score$&
29917 The spam score of the message, for example &"3.4"& or &"30.5"&. This is useful
29918 for inclusion in log or reject messages.
29920 .vitem &$spam_score_int$&
29921 The spam score of the message, multiplied by ten, as an integer value. For
29922 example &"34"& or &"305"&. It may appear to disagree with &$spam_score$&
29923 because &$spam_score$& is rounded and &$spam_score_int$& is truncated.
29924 The integer value is useful for numeric comparisons in conditions.
29926 .vitem &$spam_bar$&
29927 A string consisting of a number of &"+"& or &"-"& characters, representing the
29928 integer part of the spam score value. A spam score of 4.4 would have a
29929 &$spam_bar$& value of &"++++"&. This is useful for inclusion in warning
29930 headers, since MUAs can match on such strings.
29932 .vitem &$spam_report$&
29933 A multiline text table, containing the full SpamAssassin report for the
29934 message. Useful for inclusion in headers or reject messages.
29937 The &%spam%& condition caches its results unless expansion in
29938 spamd_address was used. If you call it again with the same user name, it
29939 does not scan again, but rather returns the same values as before.
29941 The &%spam%& condition returns DEFER if there is any error while running
29942 the message through SpamAssassin or if the expansion of spamd_address
29943 failed. If you want to treat DEFER as FAIL (to pass on to the next ACL
29944 statement block), append &`/defer_ok`& to the right-hand side of the
29945 spam condition, like this:
29947 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
29948 spam = joe/defer_ok
29950 This causes messages to be accepted even if there is a problem with &%spamd%&.
29952 Here is a longer, commented example of the use of the &%spam%&
29955 # put headers in all messages (no matter if spam or not)
29956 warn spam = nobody:true
29957 add_header = X-Spam-Score: $spam_score ($spam_bar)
29958 add_header = X-Spam-Report: $spam_report
29960 # add second subject line with *SPAM* marker when message
29961 # is over threshold
29963 add_header = Subject: *SPAM* $h_Subject:
29965 # reject spam at high scores (> 12)
29966 deny message = This message scored $spam_score spam points.
29968 condition = ${if >{$spam_score_int}{120}{1}{0}}
29973 .section "Scanning MIME parts" "SECTscanmimepart"
29974 .cindex "content scanning" "MIME parts"
29975 .cindex "MIME content scanning"
29976 .oindex "&%acl_smtp_mime%&"
29977 .oindex "&%acl_not_smtp_mime%&"
29978 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& global option specifies an ACL that is called once for
29979 each MIME part of an SMTP message, including multipart types, in the sequence
29980 of their position in the message. Similarly, the &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& option
29981 specifies an ACL that is used for the MIME parts of non-SMTP messages. These
29982 options may both refer to the same ACL if you want the same processing in both
29985 These ACLs are called (possibly many times) just before the &%acl_smtp_data%&
29986 ACL in the case of an SMTP message, or just before the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL in
29987 the case of a non-SMTP message. However, a MIME ACL is called only if the
29988 message contains a &'Content-Type:'& header line. When a call to a MIME
29989 ACL does not yield &"accept"&, ACL processing is aborted and the appropriate
29990 result code is sent to the client. In the case of an SMTP message, the
29991 &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is not called when this happens.
29993 You cannot use the &%malware%& or &%spam%& conditions in a MIME ACL; these can
29994 only be used in the DATA or non-SMTP ACLs. However, you can use the &%regex%&
29995 condition to match against the raw MIME part. You can also use the
29996 &%mime_regex%& condition to match against the decoded MIME part (see section
29997 &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
29999 At the start of a MIME ACL, a number of variables are set from the header
30000 information for the relevant MIME part. These are described below. The contents
30001 of the MIME part are not by default decoded into a disk file except for MIME
30002 parts whose content-type is &"message/rfc822"&. If you want to decode a MIME
30003 part into a disk file, you can use the &%decode%& condition. The general
30006 &`decode = [/`&<&'path'&>&`/]`&<&'filename'&>
30008 The right hand side is expanded before use. After expansion,
30012 &"0"& or &"false"&, in which case no decoding is done.
30014 The string &"default"&. In that case, the file is put in the temporary
30015 &"default"& directory <&'spool_directory'&>&_/scan/_&<&'message_id'&>&_/_& with
30016 a sequential file name consisting of the message id and a sequence number. The
30017 full path and name is available in &$mime_decoded_filename$& after decoding.
30019 A full path name starting with a slash. If the full name is an existing
30020 directory, it is used as a replacement for the default directory. The filename
30021 is then sequentially assigned. If the path does not exist, it is used as
30022 the full path and file name.
30024 If the string does not start with a slash, it is used as the
30025 filename, and the default path is then used.
30027 The &%decode%& condition normally succeeds. It is only false for syntax
30028 errors or unusual circumstances such as memory shortages. You can easily decode
30029 a file with its original, proposed filename using
30031 decode = $mime_filename
30033 However, you should keep in mind that &$mime_filename$& might contain
30034 anything. If you place files outside of the default path, they are not
30035 automatically unlinked.
30037 For RFC822 attachments (these are messages attached to messages, with a
30038 content-type of &"message/rfc822"&), the ACL is called again in the same manner
30039 as for the primary message, only that the &$mime_is_rfc822$& expansion
30040 variable is set (see below). Attached messages are always decoded to disk
30041 before being checked, and the files are unlinked once the check is done.
30043 The MIME ACL supports the &%regex%& and &%mime_regex%& conditions. These can be
30044 used to match regular expressions against raw and decoded MIME parts,
30045 respectively. They are described in section &<<SECTscanregex>>&.
30047 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "returned variables"
30048 The following list describes all expansion variables that are
30049 available in the MIME ACL:
30052 .vitem &$mime_boundary$&
30053 If the current part is a multipart (see &$mime_is_multipart$&) below, it should
30054 have a boundary string, which is stored in this variable. If the current part
30055 has no boundary parameter in the &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable
30056 contains the empty string.
30058 .vitem &$mime_charset$&
30059 This variable contains the character set identifier, if one was found in the
30060 &'Content-Type:'& header. Examples for charset identifiers are:
30066 Please note that this value is not normalized, so you should do matches
30067 case-insensitively.
30069 .vitem &$mime_content_description$&
30070 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Description:'&
30071 header. It can contain a human-readable description of the parts content. Some
30072 implementations repeat the filename for attachments here, but they are usually
30073 only used for display purposes.
30075 .vitem &$mime_content_disposition$&
30076 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Disposition:'&
30077 header. You can expect strings like &"attachment"& or &"inline"& here.
30079 .vitem &$mime_content_id$&
30080 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-ID:'& header.
30081 This is a unique ID that can be used to reference a part from another part.
30083 .vitem &$mime_content_size$&
30084 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
30085 successfully run. It contains the size of the decoded part in kilobytes. The
30086 size is always rounded up to full kilobytes, so only a completely empty part
30087 has a &$mime_content_size$& of zero.
30089 .vitem &$mime_content_transfer_encoding$&
30090 This variable contains the normalized content of the
30091 &'Content-transfer-encoding:'& header. This is a symbolic name for an encoding
30092 type. Typical values are &"base64"& and &"quoted-printable"&.
30094 .vitem &$mime_content_type$&
30095 If the MIME part has a &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains its
30096 value, lowercased, and without any options (like &"name"& or &"charset"&). Here
30097 are some examples of popular MIME types, as they may appear in this variable:
30101 application/octet-stream
30105 If the MIME part has no &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains the
30108 .vitem &$mime_decoded_filename$&
30109 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
30110 successfully run. It contains the full path and file name of the file
30111 containing the decoded data.
30116 .vitem &$mime_filename$&
30117 This is perhaps the most important of the MIME variables. It contains a
30118 proposed filename for an attachment, if one was found in either the
30119 &'Content-Type:'& or &'Content-Disposition:'& headers. The filename will be
30120 RFC2047 decoded, but no additional sanity checks are done. If no filename was
30121 found, this variable contains the empty string.
30123 .vitem &$mime_is_coverletter$&
30124 This variable attempts to differentiate the &"cover letter"& of an e-mail from
30125 attached data. It can be used to clamp down on flashy or unnecessarily encoded
30126 content in the cover letter, while not restricting attachments at all.
30128 The variable contains 1 (true) for a MIME part believed to be part of the
30129 cover letter, and 0 (false) for an attachment. At present, the algorithm is as
30133 The outermost MIME part of a message is always a cover letter.
30136 If a multipart/alternative or multipart/related MIME part is a cover letter,
30137 so are all MIME subparts within that multipart.
30140 If any other multipart is a cover letter, the first subpart is a cover letter,
30141 and the rest are attachments.
30144 All parts contained within an attachment multipart are attachments.
30147 As an example, the following will ban &"HTML mail"& (including that sent with
30148 alternative plain text), while allowing HTML files to be attached. HTML
30149 coverletter mail attached to non-HMTL coverletter mail will also be allowed:
30151 deny message = HTML mail is not accepted here
30152 !condition = $mime_is_rfc822
30153 condition = $mime_is_coverletter
30154 condition = ${if eq{$mime_content_type}{text/html}{1}{0}}
30156 .vitem &$mime_is_multipart$&
30157 This variable has the value 1 (true) when the current part has the main type
30158 &"multipart"&, for example &"multipart/alternative"& or &"multipart/mixed"&.
30159 Since multipart entities only serve as containers for other parts, you may not
30160 want to carry out specific actions on them.
30162 .vitem &$mime_is_rfc822$&
30163 This variable has the value 1 (true) if the current part is not a part of the
30164 checked message itself, but part of an attached message. Attached message
30165 decoding is fully recursive.
30167 .vitem &$mime_part_count$&
30168 This variable is a counter that is raised for each processed MIME part. It
30169 starts at zero for the very first part (which is usually a multipart). The
30170 counter is per-message, so it is reset when processing RFC822 attachments (see
30171 &$mime_is_rfc822$&). The counter stays set after &%acl_smtp_mime%& is
30172 complete, so you can use it in the DATA ACL to determine the number of MIME
30173 parts of a message. For non-MIME messages, this variable contains the value -1.
30178 .section "Scanning with regular expressions" "SECTscanregex"
30179 .cindex "content scanning" "with regular expressions"
30180 .cindex "regular expressions" "content scanning with"
30181 You can specify your own custom regular expression matches on the full body of
30182 the message, or on individual MIME parts.
30184 The &%regex%& condition takes one or more regular expressions as arguments and
30185 matches them against the full message (when called in the DATA ACL) or a raw
30186 MIME part (when called in the MIME ACL). The &%regex%& condition matches
30187 linewise, with a maximum line length of 32K characters. That means you cannot
30188 have multiline matches with the &%regex%& condition.
30190 The &%mime_regex%& condition can be called only in the MIME ACL. It matches up
30191 to 32K of decoded content (the whole content at once, not linewise). If the
30192 part has not been decoded with the &%decode%& modifier earlier in the ACL, it
30193 is decoded automatically when &%mime_regex%& is executed (using default path
30194 and filename values). If the decoded data is larger than 32K, only the first
30195 32K characters are checked.
30197 The regular expressions are passed as a colon-separated list. To include a
30198 literal colon, you must double it. Since the whole right-hand side string is
30199 expanded before being used, you must also escape dollar signs and backslashes
30200 with more backslashes, or use the &`\N`& facility to disable expansion.
30201 Here is a simple example that contains two regular expressions:
30203 deny message = contains blacklisted regex ($regex_match_string)
30204 regex = [Mm]ortgage : URGENT BUSINESS PROPOSAL
30206 The conditions returns true if any one of the regular expressions matches. The
30207 &$regex_match_string$& expansion variable is then set up and contains the
30208 matching regular expression.
30210 &*Warning*&: With large messages, these conditions can be fairly
30216 .section "The demime condition" "SECTdemimecond"
30217 .cindex "content scanning" "MIME checking"
30218 .cindex "MIME content scanning"
30219 The &%demime%& ACL condition provides MIME unpacking, sanity checking and file
30220 extension blocking. It is usable only in the DATA and non-SMTP ACLs. The
30221 &%demime%& condition uses a simpler interface to MIME decoding than the MIME
30222 ACL functionality, but provides no additional facilities. Please note that this
30223 condition is deprecated and kept only for backward compatibility. You must set
30224 the WITH_OLD_DEMIME option in &_Local/Makefile_& at build time to be able to
30225 use the &%demime%& condition.
30227 The &%demime%& condition unpacks MIME containers in the message. It detects
30228 errors in MIME containers and can match file extensions found in the message
30229 against a list. Using this facility produces files containing the unpacked MIME
30230 parts of the message in the temporary scan directory. If you do antivirus
30231 scanning, it is recommended that you use the &%demime%& condition before the
30232 antivirus (&%malware%&) condition.
30234 On the right-hand side of the &%demime%& condition you can pass a
30235 colon-separated list of file extensions that it should match against. For
30238 deny message = Found blacklisted file attachment
30239 demime = vbs:com:bat:pif:prf:lnk
30241 If one of the file extensions is found, the condition is true, otherwise it is
30242 false. If there is a temporary error while demimeing (for example, &"disk
30243 full"&), the condition defers, and the message is temporarily rejected (unless
30244 the condition is on a &%warn%& verb).
30246 The right-hand side is expanded before being treated as a list, so you can have
30247 conditions and lookups there. If it expands to an empty string, &"false"&, or
30248 zero (&"0"&), no demimeing is done and the condition is false.
30250 The &%demime%& condition set the following variables:
30253 .vitem &$demime_errorlevel$&
30254 .vindex "&$demime_errorlevel$&"
30255 When an error is detected in a MIME container, this variable contains the
30256 severity of the error, as an integer number. The higher the value, the more
30257 severe the error (the current maximum value is 3). If this variable is unset or
30258 zero, no error occurred.
30260 .vitem &$demime_reason$&
30261 .vindex "&$demime_reason$&"
30262 When &$demime_errorlevel$& is greater than zero, this variable contains a
30263 human-readable text string describing the MIME error that occurred.
30267 .vitem &$found_extension$&
30268 .vindex "&$found_extension$&"
30269 When the &%demime%& condition is true, this variable contains the file
30270 extension it found.
30273 Both &$demime_errorlevel$& and &$demime_reason$& are set by the first call of
30274 the &%demime%& condition, and are not changed on subsequent calls.
30276 If you do not want to check for file extensions, but rather use the &%demime%&
30277 condition for unpacking or error checking purposes, pass &"*"& as the
30278 right-hand side value. Here is a more elaborate example of how to use this
30281 # Reject messages with serious MIME container errors
30282 deny message = Found MIME error ($demime_reason).
30284 condition = ${if >{$demime_errorlevel}{2}{1}{0}}
30286 # Reject known virus spreading file extensions.
30287 # Accepting these is pretty much braindead.
30288 deny message = contains $found_extension file (blacklisted).
30289 demime = com:vbs:bat:pif:scr
30291 # Freeze .exe and .doc files. Postmaster can
30292 # examine them and eventually thaw them.
30293 deny log_message = Another $found_extension file.
30302 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30303 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30305 .chapter "Adding a local scan function to Exim" "CHAPlocalscan" &&&
30306 "Local scan function"
30307 .scindex IIDlosca "&[local_scan()]& function" "description of"
30308 .cindex "customizing" "input scan using C function"
30309 .cindex "policy control" "by local scan function"
30310 In these days of email worms, viruses, and ever-increasing spam, some sites
30311 want to apply a lot of checking to messages before accepting them.
30313 The content scanning extension (chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&) has facilities for
30314 passing messages to external virus and spam scanning software. You can also do
30315 a certain amount in Exim itself through string expansions and the &%condition%&
30316 condition in the ACL that runs after the SMTP DATA command or the ACL for
30317 non-SMTP messages (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), but this has its limitations.
30319 To allow for further customization to a site's own requirements, there is the
30320 possibility of linking Exim with a private message scanning function, written
30321 in C. If you want to run code that is written in something other than C, you
30322 can of course use a little C stub to call it.
30324 The local scan function is run once for every incoming message, at the point
30325 when Exim is just about to accept the message.
30326 It can therefore be used to control non-SMTP messages from local processes as
30327 well as messages arriving via SMTP.
30329 Exim applies a timeout to calls of the local scan function, and there is an
30330 option called &%local_scan_timeout%& for setting it. The default is 5 minutes.
30331 Zero means &"no timeout"&.
30332 Exim also sets up signal handlers for SIGSEGV, SIGILL, SIGFPE, and SIGBUS
30333 before calling the local scan function, so that the most common types of crash
30334 are caught. If the timeout is exceeded or one of those signals is caught, the
30335 incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP message.
30336 For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a non-zero
30337 code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
30341 .section "Building Exim to use a local scan function" "SECID207"
30342 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "building Exim to use"
30343 To make use of the local scan function feature, you must tell Exim where your
30344 function is before building Exim, by setting LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE in your
30345 &_Local/Makefile_&. A recommended place to put it is in the &_Local_&
30346 directory, so you might set
30348 LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE=Local/local_scan.c
30350 for example. The function must be called &[local_scan()]&. It is called by
30351 Exim after it has received a message, when the success return code is about to
30352 be sent. This is after all the ACLs have been run. The return code from your
30353 function controls whether the message is actually accepted or not. There is a
30354 commented template function (that just accepts the message) in the file
30355 _src/local_scan.c_.
30357 If you want to make use of Exim's run time configuration file to set options
30358 for your &[local_scan()]& function, you must also set
30360 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
30362 in &_Local/Makefile_& (see section &<<SECTconoptloc>>& below).
30367 .section "API for local_scan()" "SECTapiforloc"
30368 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "API description"
30369 You must include this line near the start of your code:
30371 #include "local_scan.h"
30373 This header file defines a number of variables and other values, and the
30374 prototype for the function itself. Exim is coded to use unsigned char values
30375 almost exclusively, and one of the things this header defines is a shorthand
30376 for &`unsigned char`& called &`uschar`&.
30377 It also contains the following macro definitions, to simplify casting character
30378 strings and pointers to character strings:
30380 #define CS (char *)
30381 #define CCS (const char *)
30382 #define CSS (char **)
30383 #define US (unsigned char *)
30384 #define CUS (const unsigned char *)
30385 #define USS (unsigned char **)
30387 The function prototype for &[local_scan()]& is:
30389 extern int local_scan(int fd, uschar **return_text);
30391 The arguments are as follows:
30394 &%fd%& is a file descriptor for the file that contains the body of the message
30395 (the -D file). The file is open for reading and writing, but updating it is not
30396 recommended. &*Warning*&: You must &'not'& close this file descriptor.
30398 The descriptor is positioned at character 19 of the file, which is the first
30399 character of the body itself, because the first 19 characters are the message
30400 id followed by &`-D`& and a newline. If you rewind the file, you should use the
30401 macro SPOOL_DATA_START_OFFSET to reset to the start of the data, just in
30402 case this changes in some future version.
30404 &%return_text%& is an address which you can use to return a pointer to a text
30405 string at the end of the function. The value it points to on entry is NULL.
30408 The function must return an &%int%& value which is one of the following macros:
30411 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&
30412 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
30413 The message is accepted. If you pass back a string of text, it is saved with
30414 the message, and made available in the variable &$local_scan_data$&. No
30415 newlines are permitted (if there are any, they are turned into spaces) and the
30416 maximum length of text is 1000 characters.
30418 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_FREEZE`&
30419 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
30420 queued without immediate delivery, and is frozen.
30422 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_QUEUE`&
30423 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
30424 queued without immediate delivery.
30426 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT`&
30427 The message is rejected; the returned text is used as an error message which is
30428 passed back to the sender and which is also logged. Newlines are permitted &--
30429 they cause a multiline response for SMTP rejections, but are converted to
30430 &`\n`& in log lines. If no message is given, &"Administrative prohibition"& is
30433 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT`&
30434 The message is temporarily rejected; the returned text is used as an error
30435 message as for LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT. If no message is given, &"Temporary local
30438 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
30439 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, except that the header of the rejected
30440 message is not written to the reject log. It has the effect of unsetting the
30441 &%rejected_header%& log selector for just this rejection. If
30442 &%rejected_header%& is already unset (see the discussion of the
30443 &%log_selection%& option in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&), this code is the
30444 same as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
30446 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
30447 This code is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT in the same way that
30448 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
30451 If the message is not being received by interactive SMTP, rejections are
30452 reported by writing to &%stderr%& or by sending an email, as configured by the
30453 &%-oe%& command line options.
30457 .section "Configuration options for local_scan()" "SECTconoptloc"
30458 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "configuration options"
30459 It is possible to have option settings in the main configuration file
30460 that set values in static variables in the &[local_scan()]& module. If you
30461 want to do this, you must have the line
30463 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
30465 in your &_Local/Makefile_& when you build Exim. (This line is in
30466 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&, commented out). Then, in the &[local_scan()]& source
30467 file, you must define static variables to hold the option values, and a table
30470 The table must be a vector called &%local_scan_options%&, of type
30471 &`optionlist`&. Each entry is a triplet, consisting of a name, an option type,
30472 and a pointer to the variable that holds the value. The entries must appear in
30473 alphabetical order. Following &%local_scan_options%& you must also define a
30474 variable called &%local_scan_options_count%& that contains the number of
30475 entries in the table. Here is a short example, showing two kinds of option:
30477 static int my_integer_option = 42;
30478 static uschar *my_string_option = US"a default string";
30480 optionlist local_scan_options[] = {
30481 { "my_integer", opt_int, &my_integer_option },
30482 { "my_string", opt_stringptr, &my_string_option }
30485 int local_scan_options_count =
30486 sizeof(local_scan_options)/sizeof(optionlist);
30488 The values of the variables can now be changed from Exim's runtime
30489 configuration file by including a local scan section as in this example:
30493 my_string = some string of text...
30495 The available types of option data are as follows:
30498 .vitem &*opt_bool*&
30499 This specifies a boolean (true/false) option. The address should point to a
30500 variable of type &`BOOL`&, which will be set to TRUE or FALSE, which are macros
30501 that are defined as &"1"& and &"0"&, respectively. If you want to detect
30502 whether such a variable has been set at all, you can initialize it to
30503 TRUE_UNSET. (BOOL variables are integers underneath, so can hold more than two
30506 .vitem &*opt_fixed*&
30507 This specifies a fixed point number, such as is used for load averages.
30508 The address should point to a variable of type &`int`&. The value is stored
30509 multiplied by 1000, so, for example, 1.4142 is truncated and stored as 1414.
30512 This specifies an integer; the address should point to a variable of type
30513 &`int`&. The value may be specified in any of the integer formats accepted by
30516 .vitem &*opt_mkint*&
30517 This is the same as &%opt_int%&, except that when such a value is output in a
30518 &%-bP%& listing, if it is an exact number of kilobytes or megabytes, it is
30519 printed with the suffix K or M.
30521 .vitem &*opt_octint*&
30522 This also specifies an integer, but the value is always interpreted as an
30523 octal integer, whether or not it starts with the digit zero, and it is
30524 always output in octal.
30526 .vitem &*opt_stringptr*&
30527 This specifies a string value; the address must be a pointer to a
30528 variable that points to a string (for example, of type &`uschar *`&).
30530 .vitem &*opt_time*&
30531 This specifies a time interval value. The address must point to a variable of
30532 type &`int`&. The value that is placed there is a number of seconds.
30535 If the &%-bP%& command line option is followed by &`local_scan`&, Exim prints
30536 out the values of all the &[local_scan()]& options.
30540 .section "Available Exim variables" "SECID208"
30541 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim variables"
30542 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of C variables. These
30543 are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to release.
30544 Note, however, that you can obtain the value of any Exim expansion variable,
30545 including &$recipients$&, by calling &'expand_string()'&. The exported
30546 C variables are as follows:
30549 .vitem &*int&~body_linecount*&
30550 This variable contains the number of lines in the message's body.
30552 .vitem &*int&~body_zerocount*&
30553 This variable contains the number of binary zero bytes in the message's body.
30555 .vitem &*unsigned&~int&~debug_selector*&
30556 This variable is set to zero when no debugging is taking place. Otherwise, it
30557 is a bitmap of debugging selectors. Two bits are identified for use in
30558 &[local_scan()]&; they are defined as macros:
30561 The &`D_v`& bit is set when &%-v%& was present on the command line. This is a
30562 testing option that is not privileged &-- any caller may set it. All the
30563 other selector bits can be set only by admin users.
30566 The &`D_local_scan`& bit is provided for use by &[local_scan()]&; it is set
30567 by the &`+local_scan`& debug selector. It is not included in the default set
30571 Thus, to write to the debugging output only when &`+local_scan`& has been
30572 selected, you should use code like this:
30574 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
30575 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
30577 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string_message*&
30578 After a failing call to &'expand_string()'& (returned value NULL), the
30579 variable &%expand_string_message%& contains the error message, zero-terminated.
30581 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_list*&
30582 A pointer to a chain of header lines. The &%header_line%& structure is
30585 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_last*&
30586 A pointer to the last of the header lines.
30588 .vitem &*uschar&~*headers_charset*&
30589 The value of the &%headers_charset%& configuration option.
30591 .vitem &*BOOL&~host_checking*&
30592 This variable is TRUE during a host checking session that is initiated by the
30593 &%-bh%& command line option.
30595 .vitem &*uschar&~*interface_address*&
30596 The IP address of the interface that received the message, as a string. This
30597 is NULL for locally submitted messages.
30599 .vitem &*int&~interface_port*&
30600 The port on which this message was received. When testing with the &%-bh%&
30601 command line option, the value of this variable is -1 unless a port has been
30602 specified via the &%-oMi%& option.
30604 .vitem &*uschar&~*message_id*&
30605 This variable contains Exim's message id for the incoming message (the value of
30606 &$message_exim_id$&) as a zero-terminated string.
30608 .vitem &*uschar&~*received_protocol*&
30609 The name of the protocol by which the message was received.
30611 .vitem &*int&~recipients_count*&
30612 The number of accepted recipients.
30614 .vitem &*recipient_item&~*recipients_list*&
30615 .cindex "recipient" "adding in local scan"
30616 .cindex "recipient" "removing in local scan"
30617 The list of accepted recipients, held in a vector of length
30618 &%recipients_count%&. The &%recipient_item%& structure is discussed below. You
30619 can add additional recipients by calling &'receive_add_recipient()'& (see
30620 below). You can delete recipients by removing them from the vector and
30621 adjusting the value in &%recipients_count%&. In particular, by setting
30622 &%recipients_count%& to zero you remove all recipients. If you then return the
30623 value &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&, the message is accepted, but immediately
30624 blackholed. To replace the recipients, you can set &%recipients_count%& to zero
30625 and then call &'receive_add_recipient()'& as often as needed.
30627 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_address*&
30628 The envelope sender address. For bounce messages this is the empty string.
30630 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_address*&
30631 The IP address of the sending host, as a string. This is NULL for
30632 locally-submitted messages.
30634 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_authenticated*&
30635 The name of the authentication mechanism that was used, or NULL if the message
30636 was not received over an authenticated SMTP connection.
30638 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_name*&
30639 The name of the sending host, if known.
30641 .vitem &*int&~sender_host_port*&
30642 The port on the sending host.
30644 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_input*&
30645 This variable is TRUE for all SMTP input, including BSMTP.
30647 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_batched_input*&
30648 This variable is TRUE for BSMTP input.
30650 .vitem &*int&~store_pool*&
30651 The contents of this variable control which pool of memory is used for new
30652 requests. See section &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& for details.
30656 .section "Structure of header lines" "SECID209"
30657 The &%header_line%& structure contains the members listed below.
30658 You can add additional header lines by calling the &'header_add()'& function
30659 (see below). You can cause header lines to be ignored (deleted) by setting
30664 .vitem &*struct&~header_line&~*next*&
30665 A pointer to the next header line, or NULL for the last line.
30667 .vitem &*int&~type*&
30668 A code identifying certain headers that Exim recognizes. The codes are printing
30669 characters, and are documented in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>& of this manual.
30670 Notice in particular that any header line whose type is * is not transmitted
30671 with the message. This flagging is used for header lines that have been
30672 rewritten, or are to be removed (for example, &'Envelope-sender:'& header
30673 lines.) Effectively, * means &"deleted"&.
30675 .vitem &*int&~slen*&
30676 The number of characters in the header line, including the terminating and any
30679 .vitem &*uschar&~*text*&
30680 A pointer to the text of the header. It always ends with a newline, followed by
30681 a zero byte. Internal newlines are preserved.
30686 .section "Structure of recipient items" "SECID210"
30687 The &%recipient_item%& structure contains these members:
30690 .vitem &*uschar&~*address*&
30691 This is a pointer to the recipient address as it was received.
30693 .vitem &*int&~pno*&
30694 This is used in later Exim processing when top level addresses are created by
30695 the &%one_time%& option. It is not relevant at the time &[local_scan()]& is run
30696 and must always contain -1 at this stage.
30698 .vitem &*uschar&~*errors_to*&
30699 If this value is not NULL, bounce messages caused by failing to deliver to the
30700 recipient are sent to the address it contains. In other words, it overrides the
30701 envelope sender for this one recipient. (Compare the &%errors_to%& generic
30702 router option.) If a &[local_scan()]& function sets an &%errors_to%& field to
30703 an unqualified address, Exim qualifies it using the domain from
30704 &%qualify_recipient%&. When &[local_scan()]& is called, the &%errors_to%& field
30705 is NULL for all recipients.
30710 .section "Available Exim functions" "SECID211"
30711 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim functions"
30712 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of Exim functions.
30713 These are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to
30717 .vitem "&*pid_t&~child_open(uschar&~**argv,&~uschar&~**envp,&~int&~newumask,&&&
30718 &~int&~*infdptr,&~int&~*outfdptr, &~&~BOOL&~make_leader)*&"
30720 This function creates a child process that runs the command specified by
30721 &%argv%&. The environment for the process is specified by &%envp%&, which can
30722 be NULL if no environment variables are to be passed. A new umask is supplied
30723 for the process in &%newumask%&.
30725 Pipes to the standard input and output of the new process are set up
30726 and returned to the caller via the &%infdptr%& and &%outfdptr%& arguments. The
30727 standard error is cloned to the standard output. If there are any file
30728 descriptors &"in the way"& in the new process, they are closed. If the final
30729 argument is TRUE, the new process is made into a process group leader.
30731 The function returns the pid of the new process, or -1 if things go wrong.
30733 .vitem &*int&~child_close(pid_t&~pid,&~int&~timeout)*&
30734 This function waits for a child process to terminate, or for a timeout (in
30735 seconds) to expire. A timeout value of zero means wait as long as it takes. The
30736 return value is as follows:
30741 The process terminated by a normal exit and the value is the process
30747 The process was terminated by a signal and the value is the negation of the
30753 The process timed out.
30757 The was some other error in wait(); &%errno%& is still set.
30760 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim(int&~*fd)*&
30761 This function provide you with a means of submitting a new message to
30762 Exim. (Of course, you can also call &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& yourself if you
30763 want, but this packages it all up for you.) The function creates a pipe,
30764 forks a subprocess that is running
30766 exim -t -oem -oi -f <>
30768 and returns to you (via the &`int *`& argument) a file descriptor for the pipe
30769 that is connected to the standard input. The yield of the function is the PID
30770 of the subprocess. You can then write a message to the file descriptor, with
30771 recipients in &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and/or &'Bcc:'& header lines.
30773 When you have finished, call &'child_close()'& to wait for the process to
30774 finish and to collect its ending status. A timeout value of zero is usually
30775 fine in this circumstance. Unless you have made a mistake with the recipient
30776 addresses, you should get a return code of zero.
30779 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim2(int&~*fd,&~uschar&~*sender,&~uschar&~&&&
30780 *sender_authentication)*&
30781 This function is a more sophisticated version of &'child_open()'&. The command
30784 &`exim -t -oem -oi -f `&&'sender'&&` -oMas `&&'sender_authentication'&
30786 The third argument may be NULL, in which case the &%-oMas%& option is omitted.
30789 .vitem &*void&~debug_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
30790 This is Exim's debugging function, with arguments as for &'(printf()'&. The
30791 output is written to the standard error stream. If no debugging is selected,
30792 calls to &'debug_printf()'& have no effect. Normally, you should make calls
30793 conditional on the &`local_scan`& debug selector by coding like this:
30795 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
30796 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
30799 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string(uschar&~*string)*&
30800 This is an interface to Exim's string expansion code. The return value is the
30801 expanded string, or NULL if there was an expansion failure.
30802 The C variable &%expand_string_message%& contains an error message after an
30803 expansion failure. If expansion does not change the string, the return value is
30804 the pointer to the input string. Otherwise, the return value points to a new
30805 block of memory that was obtained by a call to &'store_get()'&. See section
30806 &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& below for a discussion of memory handling.
30808 .vitem &*void&~header_add(int&~type,&~char&~*format,&~...)*&
30809 This function allows you to an add additional header line at the end of the
30810 existing ones. The first argument is the type, and should normally be a space
30811 character. The second argument is a format string and any number of
30812 substitution arguments as for &[sprintf()]&. You may include internal newlines
30813 if you want, and you must ensure that the string ends with a newline.
30815 .vitem "&*void&~header_add_at_position(BOOL&~after,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
30816 BOOL&~topnot,&~int&~type,&~char&~*format, &~&~...)*&"
30817 This function adds a new header line at a specified point in the header
30818 chain. The header itself is specified as for &'header_add()'&.
30820 If &%name%& is NULL, the new header is added at the end of the chain if
30821 &%after%& is true, or at the start if &%after%& is false. If &%name%& is not
30822 NULL, the header lines are searched for the first non-deleted header that
30823 matches the name. If one is found, the new header is added before it if
30824 &%after%& is false. If &%after%& is true, the new header is added after the
30825 found header and any adjacent subsequent ones with the same name (even if
30826 marked &"deleted"&). If no matching non-deleted header is found, the &%topnot%&
30827 option controls where the header is added. If it is true, addition is at the
30828 top; otherwise at the bottom. Thus, to add a header after all the &'Received:'&
30829 headers, or at the top if there are no &'Received:'& headers, you could use
30831 header_add_at_position(TRUE, US"Received", TRUE,
30832 ' ', "X-xxx: ...");
30834 Normally, there is always at least one non-deleted &'Received:'& header, but
30835 there may not be if &%received_header_text%& expands to an empty string.
30838 .vitem &*void&~header_remove(int&~occurrence,&~uschar&~*name)*&
30839 This function removes header lines. If &%occurrence%& is zero or negative, all
30840 occurrences of the header are removed. If occurrence is greater than zero, that
30841 particular instance of the header is removed. If no header(s) can be found that
30842 match the specification, the function does nothing.
30845 .vitem "&*BOOL&~header_testname(header_line&~*hdr,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
30846 int&~length,&~BOOL&~notdel)*&"
30847 This function tests whether the given header has the given name. It is not just
30848 a string comparison, because white space is permitted between the name and the
30849 colon. If the &%notdel%& argument is true, a false return is forced for all
30850 &"deleted"& headers; otherwise they are not treated specially. For example:
30852 if (header_testname(h, US"X-Spam", 6, TRUE)) ...
30854 .vitem &*uschar&~*lss_b64encode(uschar&~*cleartext,&~int&~length)*&
30855 .cindex "base64 encoding" "functions for &[local_scan()]& use"
30856 This function base64-encodes a string, which is passed by address and length.
30857 The text may contain bytes of any value, including zero. The result is passed
30858 back in dynamic memory that is obtained by calling &'store_get()'&. It is
30861 .vitem &*int&~lss_b64decode(uschar&~*codetext,&~uschar&~**cleartext)*&
30862 This function decodes a base64-encoded string. Its arguments are a
30863 zero-terminated base64-encoded string and the address of a variable that is set
30864 to point to the result, which is in dynamic memory. The length of the decoded
30865 string is the yield of the function. If the input is invalid base64 data, the
30866 yield is -1. A zero byte is added to the end of the output string to make it
30867 easy to interpret as a C string (assuming it contains no zeros of its own). The
30868 added zero byte is not included in the returned count.
30870 .vitem &*int&~lss_match_domain(uschar&~*domain,&~uschar&~*list)*&
30871 This function checks for a match in a domain list. Domains are always
30872 matched caselessly. The return value is one of the following:
30874 &`OK `& match succeeded
30875 &`FAIL `& match failed
30876 &`DEFER `& match deferred
30878 DEFER is usually caused by some kind of lookup defer, such as the
30879 inability to contact a database.
30881 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_local_part(uschar&~*localpart,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
30883 This function checks for a match in a local part list. The third argument
30884 controls case-sensitivity. The return values are as for
30885 &'lss_match_domain()'&.
30887 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_address(uschar&~*address,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
30889 This function checks for a match in an address list. The third argument
30890 controls the case-sensitivity of the local part match. The domain is always
30891 matched caselessly. The return values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&.
30893 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_host(uschar&~*host_name,&~uschar&~*host_address,&~&&&
30895 This function checks for a match in a host list. The most common usage is
30898 lss_match_host(sender_host_name, sender_host_address, ...)
30900 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
30901 An empty address field matches an empty item in the host list. If the host name
30902 is NULL, the name corresponding to &$sender_host_address$& is automatically
30903 looked up if a host name is required to match an item in the list. The return
30904 values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&, but in addition, &'lss_match_host()'&
30905 returns ERROR in the case when it had to look up a host name, but the lookup
30908 .vitem "&*void&~log_write(unsigned&~int&~selector,&~int&~which,&~char&~&&&
30910 This function writes to Exim's log files. The first argument should be zero (it
30911 is concerned with &%log_selector%&). The second argument can be &`LOG_MAIN`& or
30912 &`LOG_REJECT`& or &`LOG_PANIC`& or the inclusive &"or"& of any combination of
30913 them. It specifies to which log or logs the message is written. The remaining
30914 arguments are a format and relevant insertion arguments. The string should not
30915 contain any newlines, not even at the end.
30918 .vitem &*void&~receive_add_recipient(uschar&~*address,&~int&~pno)*&
30919 This function adds an additional recipient to the message. The first argument
30920 is the recipient address. If it is unqualified (has no domain), it is qualified
30921 with the &%qualify_recipient%& domain. The second argument must always be -1.
30923 This function does not allow you to specify a private &%errors_to%& address (as
30924 described with the structure of &%recipient_item%& above), because it pre-dates
30925 the addition of that field to the structure. However, it is easy to add such a
30926 value afterwards. For example:
30928 receive_add_recipient(US"monitor@mydom.example", -1);
30929 recipients_list[recipients_count-1].errors_to =
30930 US"postmaster@mydom.example";
30933 .vitem &*BOOL&~receive_remove_recipient(uschar&~*recipient)*&
30934 This is a convenience function to remove a named recipient from the list of
30935 recipients. It returns true if a recipient was removed, and false if no
30936 matching recipient could be found. The argument must be a complete email
30943 .vitem "&*uschar&~rfc2047_decode(uschar&~*string,&~BOOL&~lencheck,&&&
30944 &~uschar&~*target,&~int&~zeroval,&~int&~*lenptr, &~&~uschar&~**error)*&"
30945 This function decodes strings that are encoded according to RFC 2047. Typically
30946 these are the contents of header lines. First, each &"encoded word"& is decoded
30947 from the Q or B encoding into a byte-string. Then, if provided with the name of
30948 a charset encoding, and if the &[iconv()]& function is available, an attempt is
30949 made to translate the result to the named character set. If this fails, the
30950 binary string is returned with an error message.
30952 The first argument is the string to be decoded. If &%lencheck%& is TRUE, the
30953 maximum MIME word length is enforced. The third argument is the target
30954 encoding, or NULL if no translation is wanted.
30956 .cindex "binary zero" "in RFC 2047 decoding"
30957 .cindex "RFC 2047" "binary zero in"
30958 If a binary zero is encountered in the decoded string, it is replaced by the
30959 contents of the &%zeroval%& argument. For use with Exim headers, the value must
30960 not be 0 because header lines are handled as zero-terminated strings.
30962 The function returns the result of processing the string, zero-terminated; if
30963 &%lenptr%& is not NULL, the length of the result is set in the variable to
30964 which it points. When &%zeroval%& is 0, &%lenptr%& should not be NULL.
30966 If an error is encountered, the function returns NULL and uses the &%error%&
30967 argument to return an error message. The variable pointed to by &%error%& is
30968 set to NULL if there is no error; it may be set non-NULL even when the function
30969 returns a non-NULL value if decoding was successful, but there was a problem
30973 .vitem &*int&~smtp_fflush(void)*&
30974 This function is used in conjunction with &'smtp_printf()'&, as described
30977 .vitem &*void&~smtp_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
30978 The arguments of this function are like &[printf()]&; it writes to the SMTP
30979 output stream. You should use this function only when there is an SMTP output
30980 stream, that is, when the incoming message is being received via interactive
30981 SMTP. This is the case when &%smtp_input%& is TRUE and &%smtp_batched_input%&
30982 is FALSE. If you want to test for an incoming message from another host (as
30983 opposed to a local process that used the &%-bs%& command line option), you can
30984 test the value of &%sender_host_address%&, which is non-NULL when a remote host
30987 If an SMTP TLS connection is established, &'smtp_printf()'& uses the TLS
30988 output function, so it can be used for all forms of SMTP connection.
30990 Strings that are written by &'smtp_printf()'& from within &[local_scan()]&
30991 must start with an appropriate response code: 550 if you are going to return
30992 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, 451 if you are going to return
30993 LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT, and 250 otherwise. Because you are writing the
30994 initial lines of a multi-line response, the code must be followed by a hyphen
30995 to indicate that the line is not the final response line. You must also ensure
30996 that the lines you write terminate with CRLF. For example:
30998 smtp_printf("550-this is some extra info\r\n");
30999 return LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT;
31001 Note that you can also create multi-line responses by including newlines in
31002 the data returned via the &%return_text%& argument. The added value of using
31003 &'smtp_printf()'& is that, for instance, you could introduce delays between
31004 multiple output lines.
31006 The &'smtp_printf()'& function does not return any error indication, because it
31007 does not automatically flush pending output, and therefore does not test
31008 the state of the stream. (In the main code of Exim, flushing and error
31009 detection is done when Exim is ready for the next SMTP input command.) If
31010 you want to flush the output and check for an error (for example, the
31011 dropping of a TCP/IP connection), you can call &'smtp_fflush()'&, which has no
31012 arguments. It flushes the output stream, and returns a non-zero value if there
31015 .vitem &*void&~*store_get(int)*&
31016 This function accesses Exim's internal store (memory) manager. It gets a new
31017 chunk of memory whose size is given by the argument. Exim bombs out if it ever
31018 runs out of memory. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
31020 .vitem &*void&~*store_get_perm(int)*&
31021 This function is like &'store_get()'&, but it always gets memory from the
31022 permanent pool. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
31024 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copy(uschar&~*string)*&
31027 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copyn(uschar&~*string,&~int&~length)*&
31030 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_sprintf(char&~*format,&~...)*&
31031 These three functions create strings using Exim's dynamic memory facilities.
31032 The first makes a copy of an entire string. The second copies up to a maximum
31033 number of characters, indicated by the second argument. The third uses a format
31034 and insertion arguments to create a new string. In each case, the result is a
31035 pointer to a new string in the current memory pool. See the next section for
31041 .section "More about Exim's memory handling" "SECTmemhanloc"
31042 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "memory handling"
31043 No function is provided for freeing memory, because that is never needed.
31044 The dynamic memory that Exim uses when receiving a message is automatically
31045 recycled if another message is received by the same process (this applies only
31046 to incoming SMTP connections &-- other input methods can supply only one
31047 message at a time). After receiving the last message, a reception process
31050 Because it is recycled, the normal dynamic memory cannot be used for holding
31051 data that must be preserved over a number of incoming messages on the same SMTP
31052 connection. However, Exim in fact uses two pools of dynamic memory; the second
31053 one is not recycled, and can be used for this purpose.
31055 If you want to allocate memory that remains available for subsequent messages
31056 in the same SMTP connection, you should set
31058 store_pool = POOL_PERM
31060 before calling the function that does the allocation. There is no need to
31061 restore the value if you do not need to; however, if you do want to revert to
31062 the normal pool, you can either restore the previous value of &%store_pool%& or
31063 set it explicitly to POOL_MAIN.
31065 The pool setting applies to all functions that get dynamic memory, including
31066 &'expand_string()'&, &'store_get()'&, and the &'string_xxx()'& functions.
31067 There is also a convenience function called &'store_get_perm()'& that gets a
31068 block of memory from the permanent pool while preserving the value of
31075 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31076 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31078 .chapter "System-wide message filtering" "CHAPsystemfilter"
31079 .scindex IIDsysfil1 "filter" "system filter"
31080 .scindex IIDsysfil2 "filtering all mail"
31081 .scindex IIDsysfil3 "system filter"
31082 The previous chapters (on ACLs and the local scan function) describe checks
31083 that can be applied to messages before they are accepted by a host. There is
31084 also a mechanism for checking messages once they have been received, but before
31085 they are delivered. This is called the &'system filter'&.
31087 The system filter operates in a similar manner to users' filter files, but it
31088 is run just once per message (however many recipients the message has).
31089 It should not normally be used as a substitute for routing, because &%deliver%&
31090 commands in a system router provide new envelope recipient addresses.
31091 The system filter must be an Exim filter. It cannot be a Sieve filter.
31093 The system filter is run at the start of a delivery attempt, before any routing
31094 is done. If a message fails to be completely delivered at the first attempt,
31095 the system filter is run again at the start of every retry.
31096 If you want your filter to do something only once per message, you can make use
31097 of the &%first_delivery%& condition in an &%if%& command in the filter to
31098 prevent it happening on retries.
31100 .vindex "&$domain$&"
31101 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
31102 &*Warning*&: Because the system filter runs just once, variables that are
31103 specific to individual recipient addresses, such as &$local_part$& and
31104 &$domain$&, are not set, and the &"personal"& condition is not meaningful. If
31105 you want to run a centrally-specified filter for each recipient address
31106 independently, you can do so by setting up a suitable &(redirect)& router, as
31107 described in section &<<SECTperaddfil>>& below.
31110 .section "Specifying a system filter" "SECID212"
31111 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
31112 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
31113 The name of the file that contains the system filter must be specified by
31114 setting &%system_filter%&. If you want the filter to run under a uid and gid
31115 other than root, you must also set &%system_filter_user%& and
31116 &%system_filter_group%& as appropriate. For example:
31118 system_filter = /etc/mail/exim.filter
31119 system_filter_user = exim
31121 If a system filter generates any deliveries directly to files or pipes (via the
31122 &%save%& or &%pipe%& commands), transports to handle these deliveries must be
31123 specified by setting &%system_filter_file_transport%& and
31124 &%system_filter_pipe_transport%&, respectively. Similarly,
31125 &%system_filter_reply_transport%& must be set to handle any messages generated
31126 by the &%reply%& command.
31129 .section "Testing a system filter" "SECID213"
31130 You can run simple tests of a system filter in the same way as for a user
31131 filter, but you should use &%-bF%& rather than &%-bf%&, so that features that
31132 are permitted only in system filters are recognized.
31134 If you want to test the combined effect of a system filter and a user filter,
31135 you can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command line.
31139 .section "Contents of a system filter" "SECID214"
31140 The language used to specify system filters is the same as for users' filter
31141 files. It is described in the separate end-user document &'Exim's interface to
31142 mail filtering'&. However, there are some additional features that are
31143 available only in system filters; these are described in subsequent sections.
31144 If they are encountered in a user's filter file or when testing with &%-bf%&,
31147 .cindex "frozen messages" "manual thaw; testing in filter"
31148 There are two special conditions which, though available in users' filter
31149 files, are designed for use in system filters. The condition &%first_delivery%&
31150 is true only for the first attempt at delivering a message, and
31151 &%manually_thawed%& is true only if the message has been frozen, and
31152 subsequently thawed by an admin user. An explicit forced delivery counts as a
31153 manual thaw, but thawing as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& setting does not.
31155 &*Warning*&: If a system filter uses the &%first_delivery%& condition to
31156 specify an &"unseen"& (non-significant) delivery, and that delivery does not
31157 succeed, it will not be tried again.
31158 If you want Exim to retry an unseen delivery until it succeeds, you should
31159 arrange to set it up every time the filter runs.
31161 When a system filter finishes running, the values of the variables &$n0$& &--
31162 &$n9$& are copied into &$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$& and are thereby made available to
31163 users' filter files. Thus a system filter can, for example, set up &"scores"&
31164 to which users' filter files can refer.
31168 .section "Additional variable for system filters" "SECID215"
31169 .vindex "&$recipients$&"
31170 The expansion variable &$recipients$&, containing a list of all the recipients
31171 of the message (separated by commas and white space), is available in system
31172 filters. It is not available in users' filters for privacy reasons.
31176 .section "Defer, freeze, and fail commands for system filters" "SECID216"
31177 .cindex "freezing messages"
31178 .cindex "message" "freezing"
31179 .cindex "message" "forced failure"
31180 .cindex "&%fail%&" "in system filter"
31181 .cindex "&%freeze%& in system filter"
31182 .cindex "&%defer%& in system filter"
31183 There are three extra commands (&%defer%&, &%freeze%& and &%fail%&) which are
31184 always available in system filters, but are not normally enabled in users'
31185 filters. (See the &%allow_defer%&, &%allow_freeze%& and &%allow_fail%& options
31186 for the &(redirect)& router.) These commands can optionally be followed by the
31187 word &%text%& and a string containing an error message, for example:
31189 fail text "this message looks like spam to me"
31191 The keyword &%text%& is optional if the next character is a double quote.
31193 The &%defer%& command defers delivery of the original recipients of the
31194 message. The &%fail%& command causes all the original recipients to be failed,
31195 and a bounce message to be created. The &%freeze%& command suspends all
31196 delivery attempts for the original recipients. In all cases, any new deliveries
31197 that are specified by the filter are attempted as normal after the filter has
31200 The &%freeze%& command is ignored if the message has been manually unfrozen and
31201 not manually frozen since. This means that automatic freezing by a system
31202 filter can be used as a way of checking out suspicious messages. If a message
31203 is found to be all right, manually unfreezing it allows it to be delivered.
31205 .cindex "log" "&%fail%& command log line"
31206 .cindex "&%fail%&" "log line; reducing"
31207 The text given with a fail command is used as part of the bounce message as
31208 well as being written to the log. If the message is quite long, this can fill
31209 up a lot of log space when such failures are common. To reduce the size of the
31210 log message, Exim interprets the text in a special way if it starts with the
31211 two characters &`<<`& and contains &`>>`& later. The text between these two
31212 strings is written to the log, and the rest of the text is used in the bounce
31213 message. For example:
31215 fail "<<filter test 1>>Your message is rejected \
31216 because it contains attachments that we are \
31217 not prepared to receive."
31220 .cindex "loop" "caused by &%fail%&"
31221 Take great care with the &%fail%& command when basing the decision to fail on
31222 the contents of the message, because the bounce message will of course include
31223 the contents of the original message and will therefore trigger the &%fail%&
31224 command again (causing a mail loop) unless steps are taken to prevent this.
31225 Testing the &%error_message%& condition is one way to prevent this. You could
31228 if $message_body contains "this is spam" and not error_message
31229 then fail text "spam is not wanted here" endif
31231 though of course that might let through unwanted bounce messages. The
31232 alternative is clever checking of the body and/or headers to detect bounces
31233 generated by the filter.
31235 The interpretation of a system filter file ceases after a
31237 &%freeze%&, or &%fail%& command is obeyed. However, any deliveries that were
31238 set up earlier in the filter file are honoured, so you can use a sequence such
31244 to send a specified message when the system filter is freezing (or deferring or
31245 failing) a message. The normal deliveries for the message do not, of course,
31250 .section "Adding and removing headers in a system filter" "SECTaddremheasys"
31251 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in system filter"
31252 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in system filter"
31253 .cindex "filter" "header lines; adding/removing"
31254 Two filter commands that are available only in system filters are:
31256 headers add <string>
31257 headers remove <string>
31259 The argument for the &%headers add%& is a string that is expanded and then
31260 added to the end of the message's headers. It is the responsibility of the
31261 filter maintainer to make sure it conforms to RFC 2822 syntax. Leading white
31262 space is ignored, and if the string is otherwise empty, or if the expansion is
31263 forced to fail, the command has no effect.
31265 You can use &"\n"& within the string, followed by white space, to specify
31266 continued header lines. More than one header may be added in one command by
31267 including &"\n"& within the string without any following white space. For
31270 headers add "X-header-1: ....\n \
31271 continuation of X-header-1 ...\n\
31274 Note that the header line continuation white space after the first newline must
31275 be placed before the backslash that continues the input string, because white
31276 space after input continuations is ignored.
31278 The argument for &%headers remove%& is a colon-separated list of header names.
31279 This command applies only to those headers that are stored with the message;
31280 those that are added at delivery time (such as &'Envelope-To:'& and
31281 &'Return-Path:'&) cannot be removed by this means. If there is more than one
31282 header with the same name, they are all removed.
31284 The &%headers%& command in a system filter makes an immediate change to the set
31285 of header lines that was received with the message (with possible additions
31286 from ACL processing). Subsequent commands in the system filter operate on the
31287 modified set, which also forms the basis for subsequent message delivery.
31288 Unless further modified during routing or transporting, this set of headers is
31289 used for all recipients of the message.
31291 During routing and transporting, the variables that refer to the contents of
31292 header lines refer only to those lines that are in this set. Thus, header lines
31293 that are added by a system filter are visible to users' filter files and to all
31294 routers and transports. This contrasts with the manipulation of header lines by
31295 routers and transports, which is not immediate, but which instead is saved up
31296 until the message is actually being written (see section
31297 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&).
31299 If the message is not delivered at the first attempt, header lines that were
31300 added by the system filter are stored with the message, and so are still
31301 present at the next delivery attempt. Header lines that were removed are still
31302 present, but marked &"deleted"& so that they are not transported with the
31303 message. For this reason, it is usual to make the &%headers%& command
31304 conditional on &%first_delivery%& so that the set of header lines is not
31305 modified more than once.
31307 Because header modification in a system filter acts immediately, you have to
31308 use an indirect approach if you want to modify the contents of a header line.
31311 headers add "Old-Subject: $h_subject:"
31312 headers remove "Subject"
31313 headers add "Subject: new subject (was: $h_old-subject:)"
31314 headers remove "Old-Subject"
31319 .section "Setting an errors address in a system filter" "SECID217"
31320 .cindex "envelope sender"
31321 In a system filter, if a &%deliver%& command is followed by
31323 errors_to <some address>
31325 in order to change the envelope sender (and hence the error reporting) for that
31326 delivery, any address may be specified. (In a user filter, only the current
31327 user's address can be set.) For example, if some mail is being monitored, you
31330 unseen deliver monitor@spying.example errors_to root@local.example
31332 to take a copy which would not be sent back to the normal error reporting
31333 address if its delivery failed.
31337 .section "Per-address filtering" "SECTperaddfil"
31338 .vindex "&$domain$&"
31339 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
31340 In contrast to the system filter, which is run just once per message for each
31341 delivery attempt, it is also possible to set up a system-wide filtering
31342 operation that runs once for each recipient address. In this case, variables
31343 such as &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used, and indeed, the choice of
31344 filter file could be made dependent on them. This is an example of a router
31345 which implements such a filter:
31350 domains = +local_domains
31351 file = /central/filters/$local_part
31356 The filter is run in a separate process under its own uid. Therefore, either
31357 &%check_local_user%& must be set (as above), in which case the filter is run as
31358 the local user, or the &%user%& option must be used to specify which user to
31359 use. If both are set, &%user%& overrides.
31361 Care should be taken to ensure that none of the commands in the filter file
31362 specify a significant delivery if the message is to go on to be delivered to
31363 its intended recipient. The router will not then claim to have dealt with the
31364 address, so it will be passed on to subsequent routers to be delivered in the
31366 .ecindex IIDsysfil1
31367 .ecindex IIDsysfil2
31368 .ecindex IIDsysfil3
31375 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31376 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31378 .chapter "Message processing" "CHAPmsgproc"
31379 .scindex IIDmesproc "message" "general processing"
31380 Exim performs various transformations on the sender and recipient addresses of
31381 all messages that it handles, and also on the messages' header lines. Some of
31382 these are optional and configurable, while others always take place. All of
31383 this processing, except rewriting as a result of routing, and the addition or
31384 removal of header lines while delivering, happens when a message is received,
31385 before it is placed on Exim's queue.
31387 Some of the automatic processing takes place by default only for
31388 &"locally-originated"& messages. This adjective is used to describe messages
31389 that are not received over TCP/IP, but instead are passed to an Exim process on
31390 its standard input. This includes the interactive &"local SMTP"& case that is
31391 set up by the &%-bs%& command line option.
31393 &*Note*&: Messages received over TCP/IP on the loopback interface (127.0.0.1
31394 or ::1) are not considered to be locally-originated. Exim does not treat the
31395 loopback interface specially in any way.
31397 If you want the loopback interface to be treated specially, you must ensure
31398 that there are appropriate entries in your ACLs.
31403 .section "Submission mode for non-local messages" "SECTsubmodnon"
31404 .cindex "message" "submission"
31405 .cindex "submission mode"
31406 Processing that happens automatically for locally-originated messages (unless
31407 &%suppress_local_fixups%& is set) can also be requested for messages that are
31408 received over TCP/IP. The term &"submission mode"& is used to describe this
31409 state. Submission mode is set by the modifier
31411 control = submission
31413 in a MAIL, RCPT, or pre-data ACL for an incoming message (see sections
31414 &<<SECTACLmodi>>& and &<<SECTcontrols>>&). This makes Exim treat the message as
31415 a local submission, and is normally used when the source of the message is
31416 known to be an MUA running on a client host (as opposed to an MTA). For
31417 example, to set submission mode for messages originating on the IPv4 loopback
31418 interface, you could include the following in the MAIL ACL:
31420 warn hosts = 127.0.0.1
31421 control = submission
31423 .cindex "&%sender_retain%& submission option"
31424 There are some options that can be used when setting submission mode. A slash
31425 is used to separate options. For example:
31427 control = submission/sender_retain
31429 Specifying &%sender_retain%& has the effect of setting &%local_sender_retain%&
31430 true and &%local_from_check%& false for the current incoming message. The first
31431 of these allows an existing &'Sender:'& header in the message to remain, and
31432 the second suppresses the check to ensure that &'From:'& matches the
31433 authenticated sender. With this setting, Exim still fixes up messages by adding
31434 &'Date:'& and &'Message-ID:'& header lines if they are missing, but makes no
31435 attempt to check sender authenticity in header lines.
31437 When &%sender_retain%& is not set, a submission mode setting may specify a
31438 domain to be used when generating a &'From:'& or &'Sender:'& header line. For
31441 control = submission/domain=some.domain
31443 The domain may be empty. How this value is used is described in sections
31444 &<<SECTthefrohea>>& and &<<SECTthesenhea>>&. There is also a &%name%& option
31445 that allows you to specify the user's full name for inclusion in a created
31446 &'Sender:'& or &'From:'& header line. For example:
31448 accept authenticated = *
31449 control = submission/domain=wonderland.example/\
31450 name=${lookup {$authenticated_id} \
31451 lsearch {/etc/exim/namelist}}
31453 Because the name may contain any characters, including slashes, the &%name%&
31454 option must be given last. The remainder of the string is used as the name. For
31455 the example above, if &_/etc/exim/namelist_& contains:
31457 bigegg: Humpty Dumpty
31459 then when the sender has authenticated as &'bigegg'&, the generated &'Sender:'&
31462 Sender: Humpty Dumpty <bigegg@wonderland.example>
31464 .cindex "return path" "in submission mode"
31465 By default, submission mode forces the return path to the same address as is
31466 used to create the &'Sender:'& header. However, if &%sender_retain%& is
31467 specified, the return path is also left unchanged.
31469 &*Note*&: The changes caused by submission mode take effect after the predata
31470 ACL. This means that any sender checks performed before the fix-ups use the
31471 untrusted sender address specified by the user, not the trusted sender address
31472 specified by submission mode. Although this might be slightly unexpected, it
31473 does mean that you can configure ACL checks to spot that a user is trying to
31474 spoof another's address.
31476 .section "Line endings" "SECTlineendings"
31477 .cindex "line endings"
31478 .cindex "carriage return"
31480 RFC 2821 specifies that CRLF (two characters: carriage-return, followed by
31481 linefeed) is the line ending for messages transmitted over the Internet using
31482 SMTP over TCP/IP. However, within individual operating systems, different
31483 conventions are used. For example, Unix-like systems use just LF, but others
31484 use CRLF or just CR.
31486 Exim was designed for Unix-like systems, and internally, it stores messages
31487 using the system's convention of a single LF as a line terminator. When
31488 receiving a message, all line endings are translated to this standard format.
31489 Originally, it was thought that programs that passed messages directly to an
31490 MTA within an operating system would use that system's convention. Experience
31491 has shown that this is not the case; for example, there are Unix applications
31492 that use CRLF in this circumstance. For this reason, and for compatibility with
31493 other MTAs, the way Exim handles line endings for all messages is now as
31497 LF not preceded by CR is treated as a line ending.
31499 CR is treated as a line ending; if it is immediately followed by LF, the LF
31502 The sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate an incoming SMTP message,
31503 nor a local message in the state where a line containing only a dot is a
31506 If a bare CR is encountered within a header line, an extra space is added after
31507 the line terminator so as not to end the header line. The reasoning behind this
31508 is that bare CRs in header lines are most likely either to be mistakes, or
31509 people trying to play silly games.
31511 If the first header line received in a message ends with CRLF, a subsequent
31512 bare LF in a header line is treated in the same way as a bare CR in a header
31520 .section "Unqualified addresses" "SECID218"
31521 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
31522 .cindex "address" "qualification"
31523 By default, Exim expects every envelope address it receives from an external
31524 host to be fully qualified. Unqualified addresses cause negative responses to
31525 SMTP commands. However, because SMTP is used as a means of transporting
31526 messages from MUAs running on personal workstations, there is sometimes a
31527 requirement to accept unqualified addresses from specific hosts or IP networks.
31529 Exim has two options that separately control which hosts may send unqualified
31530 sender or recipient addresses in SMTP commands, namely
31531 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&. In both
31532 cases, if an unqualified address is accepted, it is qualified by adding the
31533 value of &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate.
31535 .oindex "&%qualify_domain%&"
31536 .oindex "&%qualify_recipient%&"
31537 Unqualified addresses in header lines are automatically qualified for messages
31538 that are locally originated, unless the &%-bnq%& option is given on the command
31539 line. For messages received over SMTP, unqualified addresses in header lines
31540 are qualified only if unqualified addresses are permitted in SMTP commands. In
31541 other words, such qualification is also controlled by
31542 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
31547 .section "The UUCP From line" "SECID219"
31548 .cindex "&""From""& line"
31549 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
31550 .cindex "sender" "address"
31551 .oindex "&%uucp_from_pattern%&"
31552 .oindex "&%uucp_from_sender%&"
31553 .cindex "envelope sender"
31554 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
31555 Messages that have come from UUCP (and some other applications) often begin
31556 with a line containing the envelope sender and a timestamp, following the word
31557 &"From"&. Examples of two common formats are:
31559 From a.oakley@berlin.mus Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
31560 From f.butler@berlin.mus Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
31562 This line precedes the RFC 2822 header lines. For compatibility with Sendmail,
31563 Exim recognizes such lines at the start of messages that are submitted to it
31564 via the command line (that is, on the standard input). It does not recognize
31565 such lines in incoming SMTP messages, unless the sending host matches
31566 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& or the &%-bs%& option was used for a local message
31567 and &%ignore_fromline_local%& is set. The recognition is controlled by a
31568 regular expression that is defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%& option, whose
31569 default value matches the two common cases shown above and puts the address
31570 that follows &"From"& into &$1$&.
31572 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &""From ""& line handling"
31573 When the caller of Exim for a non-SMTP message that contains a &"From"& line is
31574 a trusted user, the message's sender address is constructed by expanding the
31575 contents of &%uucp_sender_address%&, whose default value is &"$1"&. This is
31576 then parsed as an RFC 2822 address. If there is no domain, the local part is
31577 qualified with &%qualify_domain%& unless it is the empty string. However, if
31578 the command line &%-f%& option is used, it overrides the &"From"& line.
31580 If the caller of Exim is not trusted, the &"From"& line is recognized, but the
31581 sender address is not changed. This is also the case for incoming SMTP messages
31582 that are permitted to contain &"From"& lines.
31584 Only one &"From"& line is recognized. If there is more than one, the second is
31585 treated as a data line that starts the body of the message, as it is not valid
31586 as a header line. This also happens if a &"From"& line is present in an
31587 incoming SMTP message from a source that is not permitted to send them.
31591 .section "Resent- header lines" "SECID220"
31592 .cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines"
31593 RFC 2822 makes provision for sets of header lines starting with the string
31594 &`Resent-`& to be added to a message when it is resent by the original
31595 recipient to somebody else. These headers are &'Resent-Date:'&,
31596 &'Resent-From:'&, &'Resent-Sender:'&, &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&,
31597 &'Resent-Bcc:'& and &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The RFC says:
31600 &'Resent fields are strictly informational. They MUST NOT be used in the normal
31601 processing of replies or other such automatic actions on messages.'&
31604 This leaves things a bit vague as far as other processing actions such as
31605 address rewriting are concerned. Exim treats &%Resent-%& header lines as
31609 A &'Resent-From:'& line that just contains the login id of the submitting user
31610 is automatically rewritten in the same way as &'From:'& (see below).
31612 If there's a rewriting rule for a particular header line, it is also applied to
31613 &%Resent-%& header lines of the same type. For example, a rule that rewrites
31614 &'From:'& also rewrites &'Resent-From:'&.
31616 For local messages, if &'Sender:'& is removed on input, &'Resent-Sender:'& is
31619 For a locally-submitted message,
31620 if there are any &%Resent-%& header lines but no &'Resent-Date:'&,
31621 &'Resent-From:'&, or &'Resent-Message-Id:'&, they are added as necessary. It is
31622 the contents of &'Resent-Message-Id:'& (rather than &'Message-Id:'&) which are
31623 included in log lines in this case.
31625 The logic for adding &'Sender:'& is duplicated for &'Resent-Sender:'& when any
31626 &%Resent-%& header lines are present.
31632 .section "The Auto-Submitted: header line" "SECID221"
31633 Whenever Exim generates an autoreply, a bounce, or a delay warning message, it
31634 includes the header line:
31636 Auto-Submitted: auto-replied
31639 .section "The Bcc: header line" "SECID222"
31640 .cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
31641 If Exim is called with the &%-t%& option, to take recipient addresses from a
31642 message's header, it removes any &'Bcc:'& header line that may exist (after
31643 extracting its addresses). If &%-t%& is not present on the command line, any
31644 existing &'Bcc:'& is not removed.
31647 .section "The Date: header line" "SECID223"
31648 .cindex "&'Date:'& header line"
31649 If a locally-generated or submission-mode message has no &'Date:'& header line,
31650 Exim adds one, using the current date and time, unless the
31651 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control has been specified.
31653 .section "The Delivery-date: header line" "SECID224"
31654 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
31655 .oindex "&%delivery_date_remove%&"
31656 &'Delivery-date:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header
31657 set. Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See
31658 the generic &%delivery_date_add%& transport option.) They should not be present
31659 in messages in transit. If the &%delivery_date_remove%& configuration option is
31660 set (the default), Exim removes &'Delivery-date:'& header lines from incoming
31664 .section "The Envelope-to: header line" "SECID225"
31665 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
31666 .oindex "&%envelope_to_remove%&"
31667 &'Envelope-to:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header set.
31668 Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See the
31669 generic &%envelope_to_add%& transport option.) They should not be present in
31670 messages in transit. If the &%envelope_to_remove%& configuration option is set
31671 (the default), Exim removes &'Envelope-to:'& header lines from incoming
31675 .section "The From: header line" "SECTthefrohea"
31676 .cindex "&'From:'& header line"
31677 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
31678 .cindex "message" "submission"
31679 .cindex "submission mode"
31680 If a submission-mode message does not contain a &'From:'& header line, Exim
31681 adds one if either of the following conditions is true:
31684 The envelope sender address is not empty (that is, this is not a bounce
31685 message). The added header line copies the envelope sender address.
31687 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
31688 The SMTP session is authenticated and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty.
31690 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
31691 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
31692 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
31694 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local
31695 part is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
31697 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
31698 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
31702 A non-empty envelope sender takes precedence.
31704 If a locally-generated incoming message does not contain a &'From:'& header
31705 line, and the &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds one
31706 containing the sender's address. The calling user's login name and full name
31707 are used to construct the address, as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
31708 They are obtained from the password data by calling &[getpwuid()]& (but see the
31709 &%unknown_login%& configuration option). The address is qualified with
31710 &%qualify_domain%&.
31712 For compatibility with Sendmail, if an incoming, non-SMTP message has a
31713 &'From:'& header line containing just the unqualified login name of the calling
31714 user, this is replaced by an address containing the user's login name and full
31715 name as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
31718 .section "The Message-ID: header line" "SECID226"
31719 .cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
31720 .cindex "message" "submission"
31721 .oindex "&%message_id_header_text%&"
31722 If a locally-generated or submission-mode incoming message does not contain a
31723 &'Message-ID:'& or &'Resent-Message-ID:'& header line, and the
31724 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds a suitable header line
31725 to the message. If there are any &'Resent-:'& headers in the message, it
31726 creates &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The id is constructed from Exim's internal
31727 message id, preceded by the letter E to ensure it starts with a letter, and
31728 followed by @ and the primary host name. Additional information can be included
31729 in this header line by setting the &%message_id_header_text%& and/or
31730 &%message_id_header_domain%& options.
31733 .section "The Received: header line" "SECID227"
31734 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line"
31735 A &'Received:'& header line is added at the start of every message. The
31736 contents are defined by the &%received_header_text%& configuration option, and
31737 Exim automatically adds a semicolon and a timestamp to the configured string.
31739 The &'Received:'& header is generated as soon as the message's header lines
31740 have been received. At this stage, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header
31741 line is the time that the message started to be received. This is the value
31742 that is seen by the DATA ACL and by the &[local_scan()]& function.
31744 Once a message is accepted, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header line is
31745 changed to the time of acceptance, which is (apart from a small delay while the
31746 -H spool file is written) the earliest time at which delivery could start.
31749 .section "The References: header line" "SECID228"
31750 .cindex "&'References:'& header line"
31751 Messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport include a &'References:'&
31752 header line. This is constructed according to the rules that are described in
31753 section 3.64 of RFC 2822 (which states that replies should contain such a
31754 header line), and section 3.14 of RFC 3834 (which states that automatic
31755 responses are not different in this respect). However, because some mail
31756 processing software does not cope well with very long header lines, no more
31757 than 12 message IDs are copied from the &'References:'& header line in the
31758 incoming message. If there are more than 12, the first one and then the final
31759 11 are copied, before adding the message ID of the incoming message.
31763 .section "The Return-path: header line" "SECID229"
31764 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
31765 .oindex "&%return_path_remove%&"
31766 &'Return-path:'& header lines are defined as something an MTA may insert when
31767 it does the final delivery of messages. (See the generic &%return_path_add%&
31768 transport option.) Therefore, they should not be present in messages in
31769 transit. If the &%return_path_remove%& configuration option is set (the
31770 default), Exim removes &'Return-path:'& header lines from incoming messages.
31774 .section "The Sender: header line" "SECTthesenhea"
31775 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
31776 .cindex "message" "submission"
31777 For a locally-originated message from an untrusted user, Exim may remove an
31778 existing &'Sender:'& header line, and it may add a new one. You can modify
31779 these actions by setting the &%local_sender_retain%& option true, the
31780 &%local_from_check%& option false, or by using the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
31783 When a local message is received from an untrusted user and
31784 &%local_from_check%& is true (the default), and the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
31785 control has not been set, a check is made to see if the address given in the
31786 &'From:'& header line is the correct (local) sender of the message. The address
31787 that is expected has the login name as the local part and the value of
31788 &%qualify_domain%& as the domain. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part can
31789 be permitted by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%&
31790 appropriately. If &'From:'& does not contain the correct sender, a &'Sender:'&
31791 line is added to the message.
31793 If you set &%local_from_check%& false, this checking does not occur. However,
31794 the removal of an existing &'Sender:'& line still happens, unless you also set
31795 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true. It is not possible to set both of these
31796 options true at the same time.
31798 .cindex "submission mode"
31799 By default, no processing of &'Sender:'& header lines is done for messages
31800 received over TCP/IP or for messages submitted by trusted users. However, when
31801 a message is received over TCP/IP in submission mode, and &%sender_retain%& is
31802 not specified on the submission control, the following processing takes place:
31804 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
31805 First, any existing &'Sender:'& lines are removed. Then, if the SMTP session is
31806 authenticated, and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty, a sender address is
31807 created as follows:
31810 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
31811 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
31812 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
31814 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local part
31815 is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
31817 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
31818 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
31821 This address is compared with the address in the &'From:'& header line. If they
31822 are different, a &'Sender:'& header line containing the created address is
31823 added. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part in &'From:'& can be permitted
31824 by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& appropriately.
31826 .cindex "return path" "created from &'Sender:'&"
31827 &*Note*&: Whenever a &'Sender:'& header line is created, the return path for
31828 the message (the envelope sender address) is changed to be the same address,
31829 except in the case of submission mode when &%sender_retain%& is specified.
31833 .section "Adding and removing header lines in routers and transports" &&&
31834 "SECTheadersaddrem"
31835 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in router or transport"
31836 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in router or transport"
31837 When a message is delivered, the addition and removal of header lines can be
31838 specified in a system filter, or on any of the routers and transports that
31839 process the message. Section &<<SECTaddremheasys>>& contains details about
31840 modifying headers in a system filter. Header lines can also be added in an ACL
31841 as a message is received (see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
31843 In contrast to what happens in a system filter, header modifications that are
31844 specified on routers and transports apply only to the particular recipient
31845 addresses that are being processed by those routers and transports. These
31846 changes do not actually take place until a copy of the message is being
31847 transported. Therefore, they do not affect the basic set of header lines, and
31848 they do not affect the values of the variables that refer to header lines.
31850 &*Note*&: In particular, this means that any expansions in the configuration of
31851 the transport cannot refer to the modified header lines, because such
31852 expansions all occur before the message is actually transported.
31854 For both routers and transports, the result of expanding a &%headers_add%&
31855 option must be in the form of one or more RFC 2822 header lines, separated by
31856 newlines (coded as &"\n"&). For example:
31858 headers_add = X-added-header: added by $primary_hostname\n\
31859 X-added-second: another added header line
31861 Exim does not check the syntax of these added header lines.
31863 Multiple &%headers_add%& options for a single router or transport can be
31864 specified; the values will be concatenated (with a separating newline
31865 added) before expansion.
31867 The result of expanding &%headers_remove%& must consist of a colon-separated
31868 list of header names. This is confusing, because header names themselves are
31869 often terminated by colons. In this case, the colons are the list separators,
31870 not part of the names. For example:
31872 headers_remove = return-receipt-to:acknowledge-to
31875 Multiple &%headers_remove%& options for a single router or transport can be
31876 specified; the values will be concatenated (with a separating colon
31877 added) before expansion.
31879 When &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%& is specified on a router, its value
31880 is expanded at routing time, and then associated with all addresses that are
31881 accepted by that router, and also with any new addresses that it generates. If
31882 an address passes through several routers as a result of aliasing or
31883 forwarding, the changes are cumulative.
31885 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
31886 However, this does not apply to multiple routers that result from the use of
31887 the &%unseen%& option. Any header modifications that were specified by the
31888 &"unseen"& router or its predecessors apply only to the &"unseen"& delivery.
31890 Addresses that end up with different &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%&
31891 settings cannot be delivered together in a batch, so a transport is always
31892 dealing with a set of addresses that have the same header-processing
31895 The transport starts by writing the original set of header lines that arrived
31896 with the message, possibly modified by the system filter. As it writes out
31897 these lines, it consults the list of header names that were attached to the
31898 recipient address(es) by &%headers_remove%& options in routers, and it also
31899 consults the transport's own &%headers_remove%& option. Header lines whose
31900 names are on either of these lists are not written out. If there are multiple
31901 instances of any listed header, they are all skipped.
31903 After the remaining original header lines have been written, new header
31904 lines that were specified by routers' &%headers_add%& options are written, in
31905 the order in which they were attached to the address. These are followed by any
31906 header lines specified by the transport's &%headers_add%& option.
31908 This way of handling header line modifications in routers and transports has
31909 the following consequences:
31912 The original set of header lines, possibly modified by the system filter,
31913 remains &"visible"&, in the sense that the &$header_$&&'xxx'& variables refer
31914 to it, at all times.
31916 Header lines that are added by a router's
31917 &%headers_add%& option are not accessible by means of the &$header_$&&'xxx'&
31918 expansion syntax in subsequent routers or the transport.
31920 Conversely, header lines that are specified for removal by &%headers_remove%&
31921 in a router remain visible to subsequent routers and the transport.
31923 Headers added to an address by &%headers_add%& in a router cannot be removed by
31924 a later router or by a transport.
31926 An added header can refer to the contents of an original header that is to be
31927 removed, even it has the same name as the added header. For example:
31929 headers_remove = subject
31930 headers_add = Subject: new subject (was: $h_subject:)
31934 &*Warning*&: The &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& options cannot be used
31935 for a &(redirect)& router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
31941 .section "Constructed addresses" "SECTconstr"
31942 .cindex "address" "constructed"
31943 .cindex "constructed address"
31944 When Exim constructs a sender address for a locally-generated message, it uses
31947 <&'user name'&>&~&~<&'login'&&`@`&&'qualify_domain'&>
31951 Zaphod Beeblebrox <zaphod@end.univ.example>
31953 The user name is obtained from the &%-F%& command line option if set, or
31954 otherwise by looking up the calling user by &[getpwuid()]& and extracting the
31955 &"gecos"& field from the password entry. If the &"gecos"& field contains an
31956 ampersand character, this is replaced by the login name with the first letter
31957 upper cased, as is conventional in a number of operating systems. See the
31958 &%gecos_name%& option for a way to tailor the handling of the &"gecos"& field.
31959 The &%unknown_username%& option can be used to specify user names in cases when
31960 there is no password file entry.
31963 In all cases, the user name is made to conform to RFC 2822 by quoting all or
31964 parts of it if necessary. In addition, if it contains any non-printing
31965 characters, it is encoded as described in RFC 2047, which defines a way of
31966 including non-ASCII characters in header lines. The value of the
31967 &%headers_charset%& option specifies the name of the encoding that is used (the
31968 characters are assumed to be in this encoding). The setting of
31969 &%print_topbitchars%& controls whether characters with the top bit set (that
31970 is, with codes greater than 127) count as printing characters or not.
31974 .section "Case of local parts" "SECID230"
31975 .cindex "case of local parts"
31976 .cindex "local part" "case of"
31977 RFC 2822 states that the case of letters in the local parts of addresses cannot
31978 be assumed to be non-significant. Exim preserves the case of local parts of
31979 addresses, but by default it uses a lower-cased form when it is routing,
31980 because on most Unix systems, usernames are in lower case and case-insensitive
31981 routing is required. However, any particular router can be made to use the
31982 original case for local parts by setting the &%caseful_local_part%& generic
31985 .cindex "mixed-case login names"
31986 If you must have mixed-case user names on your system, the best way to proceed,
31987 assuming you want case-independent handling of incoming email, is to set up
31988 your first router to convert incoming local parts in your domains to the
31989 correct case by means of a file lookup. For example:
31993 domains = +local_domains
31994 data = ${lookup{$local_part}cdb\
31995 {/etc/usercased.cdb}{$value}fail}\
31998 For this router, the local part is forced to lower case by the default action
31999 (&%caseful_local_part%& is not set). The lower-cased local part is used to look
32000 up a new local part in the correct case. If you then set &%caseful_local_part%&
32001 on any subsequent routers which process your domains, they will operate on
32002 local parts with the correct case in a case-sensitive manner.
32006 .section "Dots in local parts" "SECID231"
32007 .cindex "dot" "in local part"
32008 .cindex "local part" "dots in"
32009 RFC 2822 forbids empty components in local parts. That is, an unquoted local
32010 part may not begin or end with a dot, nor have two consecutive dots in the
32011 middle. However, it seems that many MTAs do not enforce this, so Exim permits
32012 empty components for compatibility.
32016 .section "Rewriting addresses" "SECID232"
32017 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
32018 Rewriting of sender and recipient addresses, and addresses in headers, can
32019 happen automatically, or as the result of configuration options, as described
32020 in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. The headers that may be affected by this are
32021 &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&.
32023 Automatic rewriting includes qualification, as mentioned above. The other case
32024 in which it can happen is when an incomplete non-local domain is given. The
32025 routing process may cause this to be expanded into the full domain name. For
32026 example, a header such as
32030 might get rewritten as
32032 To: hare@teaparty.wonderland.fict.example
32034 Rewriting as a result of routing is the one kind of message processing that
32035 does not happen at input time, as it cannot be done until the address has
32038 Strictly, one should not do &'any'& deliveries of a message until all its
32039 addresses have been routed, in case any of the headers get changed as a
32040 result of routing. However, doing this in practice would hold up many
32041 deliveries for unreasonable amounts of time, just because one address could not
32042 immediately be routed. Exim therefore does not delay other deliveries when
32043 routing of one or more addresses is deferred.
32044 .ecindex IIDmesproc
32048 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32049 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32051 .chapter "SMTP processing" "CHAPSMTP"
32052 .scindex IIDsmtpproc1 "SMTP" "processing details"
32053 .scindex IIDsmtpproc2 "LMTP" "processing details"
32054 Exim supports a number of different ways of using the SMTP protocol, and its
32055 LMTP variant, which is an interactive protocol for transferring messages into a
32056 closed mail store application. This chapter contains details of how SMTP is
32057 processed. For incoming mail, the following are available:
32060 SMTP over TCP/IP (Exim daemon or &'inetd'&);
32062 SMTP over the standard input and output (the &%-bs%& option);
32064 Batched SMTP on the standard input (the &%-bS%& option).
32067 For mail delivery, the following are available:
32070 SMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport);
32072 LMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport with the &%protocol%& option set to
32075 LMTP over a pipe to a process running in the local host (the &(lmtp)&
32078 Batched SMTP to a file or pipe (the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports with
32079 the &%use_bsmtp%& option set).
32082 &'Batched SMTP'& is the name for a process in which batches of messages are
32083 stored in or read from files (or pipes), in a format in which SMTP commands are
32084 used to contain the envelope information.
32088 .section "Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP" "SECToutSMTPTCP"
32089 .cindex "SMTP" "outgoing over TCP/IP"
32090 .cindex "outgoing SMTP over TCP/IP"
32091 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
32092 .cindex "outgoing LMTP over TCP/IP"
32095 .cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
32096 Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP is implemented by the &(smtp)& transport.
32097 The &%protocol%& option selects which protocol is to be used, but the actual
32098 processing is the same in both cases.
32100 If, in response to its EHLO command, Exim is told that the SIZE
32101 parameter is supported, it adds SIZE=<&'n'&> to each subsequent MAIL
32102 command. The value of <&'n'&> is the message size plus the value of the
32103 &%size_addition%& option (default 1024) to allow for additions to the message
32104 such as per-transport header lines, or changes made in a
32105 .cindex "transport" "filter"
32106 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
32107 transport filter. If &%size_addition%& is set negative, the use of SIZE is
32110 If the remote server advertises support for PIPELINING, Exim uses the
32111 pipelining extension to SMTP (RFC 2197) to reduce the number of TCP/IP packets
32112 required for the transaction.
32114 If the remote server advertises support for the STARTTLS command, and Exim
32115 was built to support TLS encryption, it tries to start a TLS session unless the
32116 server matches &%hosts_avoid_tls%&. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for more details.
32117 Either a match in that or &%hosts_verify_avoid_tls%& apply when the transport
32118 is called for verification.
32120 If the remote server advertises support for the AUTH command, Exim scans
32121 the authenticators configuration for any suitable client settings, as described
32122 in chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&.
32124 .cindex "carriage return"
32126 Responses from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
32127 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters, so in
32128 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
32131 If a message contains a number of different addresses, all those with the same
32132 characteristics (for example, the same envelope sender) that resolve to the
32133 same set of hosts, in the same order, are sent in a single SMTP transaction,
32134 even if they are for different domains, unless there are more than the setting
32135 of the &%max_rcpt%&s option in the &(smtp)& transport allows, in which case
32136 they are split into groups containing no more than &%max_rcpt%&s addresses
32137 each. If &%remote_max_parallel%& is greater than one, such groups may be sent
32138 in parallel sessions. The order of hosts with identical MX values is not
32139 significant when checking whether addresses can be batched in this way.
32141 When the &(smtp)& transport suffers a temporary failure that is not
32142 message-related, Exim updates its transport-specific database, which contains
32143 records indexed by host name that remember which messages are waiting for each
32144 particular host. It also updates the retry database with new retry times.
32146 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
32147 Exim's retry hints are based on host name plus IP address, so if one address of
32148 a multi-homed host is broken, it will soon be skipped most of the time.
32149 See the next section for more detail about error handling.
32151 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
32152 .cindex "SMTP" "batching over TCP/IP"
32153 When a message is successfully delivered over a TCP/IP SMTP connection, Exim
32154 looks in the hints database for the transport to see if there are any queued
32155 messages waiting for the host to which it is connected. If it finds one, it
32156 creates a new Exim process using the &%-MC%& option (which can only be used by
32157 a process running as root or the Exim user) and passes the TCP/IP socket to it
32158 so that it can deliver another message using the same socket. The new process
32159 does only those deliveries that are routed to the connected host, and may in
32160 turn pass the socket on to a third process, and so on.
32162 The &%connection_max_messages%& option of the &(smtp)& transport can be used to
32163 limit the number of messages sent down a single TCP/IP connection.
32165 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
32166 The second and subsequent messages delivered down an existing connection are
32167 identified in the main log by the addition of an asterisk after the closing
32168 square bracket of the IP address.
32173 .section "Errors in outgoing SMTP" "SECToutSMTPerr"
32174 .cindex "error" "in outgoing SMTP"
32175 .cindex "SMTP" "errors in outgoing"
32176 .cindex "host" "error"
32177 Three different kinds of error are recognized for outgoing SMTP: host errors,
32178 message errors, and recipient errors.
32181 .vitem "&*Host errors*&"
32182 A host error is not associated with a particular message or with a
32183 particular recipient of a message. The host errors are:
32186 Connection refused or timed out,
32188 Any error response code on connection,
32190 Any error response code to EHLO or HELO,
32192 Loss of connection at any time, except after &"."&,
32194 I/O errors at any time,
32196 Timeouts during the session, other than in response to MAIL, RCPT or
32197 the &"."& at the end of the data.
32200 For a host error, a permanent error response on connection, or in response to
32201 EHLO, causes all addresses routed to the host to be failed. Any other host
32202 error causes all addresses to be deferred, and retry data to be created for the
32203 host. It is not tried again, for any message, until its retry time arrives. If
32204 the current set of addresses are not all delivered in this run (to some
32205 alternative host), the message is added to the list of those waiting for this
32206 host, so if it is still undelivered when a subsequent successful delivery is
32207 made to the host, it will be sent down the same SMTP connection.
32209 .vitem "&*Message errors*&"
32210 .cindex "message" "error"
32211 A message error is associated with a particular message when sent to a
32212 particular host, but not with a particular recipient of the message. The
32213 message errors are:
32216 Any error response code to MAIL, DATA, or the &"."& that terminates
32219 Timeout after MAIL,
32221 Timeout or loss of connection after the &"."& that terminates the data. A
32222 timeout after the DATA command itself is treated as a host error, as is loss of
32223 connection at any other time.
32226 For a message error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes all addresses
32227 to be failed, and a delivery error report to be returned to the sender. A
32228 temporary error response (4&'xx'&), or one of the timeouts, causes all
32229 addresses to be deferred. Retry data is not created for the host, but instead,
32230 a retry record for the combination of host plus message id is created. The
32231 message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. This ensures
32232 that the failing message will not be sent to this host again until the retry
32233 time arrives. However, other messages that are routed to the host are not
32234 affected, so if it is some property of the message that is causing the error,
32235 it will not stop the delivery of other mail.
32237 If the remote host specified support for the SIZE parameter in its response
32238 to EHLO, Exim adds SIZE=&'nnn'& to the MAIL command, so an
32239 over-large message will cause a message error because the error arrives as a
32242 .vitem "&*Recipient errors*&"
32243 .cindex "recipient" "error"
32244 A recipient error is associated with a particular recipient of a message. The
32245 recipient errors are:
32248 Any error response to RCPT,
32250 Timeout after RCPT.
32253 For a recipient error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes the
32254 recipient address to be failed, and a bounce message to be returned to the
32255 sender. A temporary error response (4&'xx'&) or a timeout causes the failing
32256 address to be deferred, and routing retry data to be created for it. This is
32257 used to delay processing of the address in subsequent queue runs, until its
32258 routing retry time arrives. This applies to all messages, but because it
32259 operates only in queue runs, one attempt will be made to deliver a new message
32260 to the failing address before the delay starts to operate. This ensures that,
32261 if the failure is really related to the message rather than the recipient
32262 (&"message too big for this recipient"& is a possible example), other messages
32263 have a chance of getting delivered. If a delivery to the address does succeed,
32264 the retry information gets cleared, so all stuck messages get tried again, and
32265 the retry clock is reset.
32267 The message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. Use of the
32268 host for other messages is unaffected, and except in the case of a timeout,
32269 other recipients are processed independently, and may be successfully delivered
32270 in the current SMTP session. After a timeout it is of course impossible to
32271 proceed with the session, so all addresses get deferred. However, those other
32272 than the one that failed do not suffer any subsequent retry delays. Therefore,
32273 if one recipient is causing trouble, the others have a chance of getting
32274 through when a subsequent delivery attempt occurs before the failing
32275 recipient's retry time.
32278 In all cases, if there are other hosts (or IP addresses) available for the
32279 current set of addresses (for example, from multiple MX records), they are
32280 tried in this run for any undelivered addresses, subject of course to their
32281 own retry data. In other words, recipient error retry data does not take effect
32282 until the next delivery attempt.
32284 Some hosts have been observed to give temporary error responses to every
32285 MAIL command at certain times (&"insufficient space"& has been seen). It
32286 would be nice if such circumstances could be recognized, and defer data for the
32287 host itself created, but this is not possible within the current Exim design.
32288 What actually happens is that retry data for every (host, message) combination
32291 The reason that timeouts after MAIL and RCPT are treated specially is that
32292 these can sometimes arise as a result of the remote host's verification
32293 procedures. Exim makes this assumption, and treats them as if a temporary error
32294 response had been received. A timeout after &"."& is treated specially because
32295 it is known that some broken implementations fail to recognize the end of the
32296 message if the last character of the last line is a binary zero. Thus, it is
32297 helpful to treat this case as a message error.
32299 Timeouts at other times are treated as host errors, assuming a problem with the
32300 host, or the connection to it. If a timeout after MAIL, RCPT,
32301 or &"."& is really a connection problem, the assumption is that at the next try
32302 the timeout is likely to occur at some other point in the dialogue, causing it
32303 then to be treated as a host error.
32305 There is experimental evidence that some MTAs drop the connection after the
32306 terminating &"."& if they do not like the contents of the message for some
32307 reason, in contravention of the RFC, which indicates that a 5&'xx'& response
32308 should be given. That is why Exim treats this case as a message rather than a
32309 host error, in order not to delay other messages to the same host.
32314 .section "Incoming SMTP messages over TCP/IP" "SECID233"
32315 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming over TCP/IP"
32316 .cindex "incoming SMTP over TCP/IP"
32319 Incoming SMTP messages can be accepted in one of two ways: by running a
32320 listening daemon, or by using &'inetd'&. In the latter case, the entry in
32321 &_/etc/inetd.conf_& should be like this:
32323 smtp stream tcp nowait exim /opt/exim/bin/exim in.exim -bs
32325 Exim distinguishes between this case and the case of a locally running user
32326 agent using the &%-bs%& option by checking whether or not the standard input is
32327 a socket. When it is, either the port must be privileged (less than 1024), or
32328 the caller must be root or the Exim user. If any other user passes a socket
32329 with an unprivileged port number, Exim prints a message on the standard error
32330 stream and exits with an error code.
32332 By default, Exim does not make a log entry when a remote host connects or
32333 disconnects (either via the daemon or &'inetd'&), unless the disconnection is
32334 unexpected. It can be made to write such log entries by setting the
32335 &%smtp_connection%& log selector.
32337 .cindex "carriage return"
32339 Commands from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
32340 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters. In
32341 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
32343 Furthermore, because common code is used for receiving messages from all
32344 sources, a CR on its own is also interpreted as a line terminator. However, the
32345 sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate incoming SMTP data.
32347 .cindex "EHLO" "invalid data"
32348 .cindex "HELO" "invalid data"
32349 One area that sometimes gives rise to problems concerns the EHLO or
32350 HELO commands. Some clients send syntactically invalid versions of these
32351 commands, which Exim rejects by default. (This is nothing to do with verifying
32352 the data that is sent, so &%helo_verify_hosts%& is not relevant.) You can tell
32353 Exim not to apply a syntax check by setting &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& to
32354 match the broken hosts that send invalid commands.
32356 .cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
32357 .cindex "MAIL" "SIZE option"
32358 The amount of disk space available is checked whenever SIZE is received on
32359 a MAIL command, independently of whether &%message_size_limit%& or
32360 &%check_spool_space%& is configured, unless &%smtp_check_spool_space%& is set
32361 false. A temporary error is given if there is not enough space. If
32362 &%check_spool_space%& is set, the check is for that amount of space plus the
32363 value given with SIZE, that is, it checks that the addition of the incoming
32364 message will not reduce the space below the threshold.
32366 When a message is successfully received, Exim includes the local message id in
32367 its response to the final &"."& that terminates the data. If the remote host
32368 logs this text it can help with tracing what has happened to a message.
32370 The Exim daemon can limit the number of simultaneous incoming connections it is
32371 prepared to handle (see the &%smtp_accept_max%& option). It can also limit the
32372 number of simultaneous incoming connections from a single remote host (see the
32373 &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& option). Additional connection attempts are
32374 rejected using the SMTP temporary error code 421.
32376 The Exim daemon does not rely on the SIGCHLD signal to detect when a
32377 subprocess has finished, as this can get lost at busy times. Instead, it looks
32378 for completed subprocesses every time it wakes up. Provided there are other
32379 things happening (new incoming calls, starts of queue runs), completed
32380 processes will be noticed and tidied away. On very quiet systems you may
32381 sometimes see a &"defunct"& Exim process hanging about. This is not a problem;
32382 it will be noticed when the daemon next wakes up.
32384 When running as a daemon, Exim can reserve some SMTP slots for specific hosts,
32385 and can also be set up to reject SMTP calls from non-reserved hosts at times of
32386 high system load &-- for details see the &%smtp_accept_reserve%&,
32387 &%smtp_load_reserve%&, and &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& options. The load check
32388 applies in both the daemon and &'inetd'& cases.
32390 Exim normally starts a delivery process for each message received, though this
32391 can be varied by means of the &%-odq%& command line option and the
32392 &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_file%&, and &%queue_only_load%& options. The
32393 number of simultaneously running delivery processes started in this way from
32394 SMTP input can be limited by the &%smtp_accept_queue%& and
32395 &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& options. When either limit is reached,
32396 subsequently received messages are just put on the input queue without starting
32397 a delivery process.
32399 The controls that involve counts of incoming SMTP calls (&%smtp_accept_max%&,
32400 &%smtp_accept_queue%&, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&) are not available when Exim is
32401 started up from the &'inetd'& daemon, because in that case each connection is
32402 handled by an entirely independent Exim process. Control by load average is,
32403 however, available with &'inetd'&.
32405 Exim can be configured to verify addresses in incoming SMTP commands as they
32406 are received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details. It can also be configured
32407 to rewrite addresses at this time &-- before any syntax checking is done. See
32408 section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&.
32410 Exim can also be configured to limit the rate at which a client host submits
32411 MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session. See the
32412 &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& option.
32416 .section "Unrecognized SMTP commands" "SECID234"
32417 .cindex "SMTP" "unrecognized commands"
32418 If Exim receives more than &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& unrecognized SMTP
32419 commands during a single SMTP connection, it drops the connection after sending
32420 the error response to the last command. The default value for
32421 &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& is 3. This is a defence against some kinds of
32422 abuse that subvert web servers into making connections to SMTP ports; in these
32423 circumstances, a number of non-SMTP lines are sent first.
32426 .section "Syntax and protocol errors in SMTP commands" "SECID235"
32427 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors"
32428 .cindex "SMTP" "protocol errors"
32429 A syntax error is detected if an SMTP command is recognized, but there is
32430 something syntactically wrong with its data, for example, a malformed email
32431 address in a RCPT command. Protocol errors include invalid command
32432 sequencing such as RCPT before MAIL. If Exim receives more than
32433 &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& such commands during a single SMTP connection, it
32434 drops the connection after sending the error response to the last command. The
32435 default value for &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& is 3. This is a defence against
32436 broken clients that loop sending bad commands (yes, it has been seen).
32440 .section "Use of non-mail SMTP commands" "SECID236"
32441 .cindex "SMTP" "non-mail commands"
32442 The &"non-mail"& SMTP commands are those other than MAIL, RCPT, and
32443 DATA. Exim counts such commands, and drops the connection if there are too
32444 many of them in a single SMTP session. This action catches some
32445 denial-of-service attempts and things like repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
32446 client looping sending EHLO. The global option &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
32447 defines what &"too many"& means. Its default value is 10.
32449 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
32450 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
32451 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
32452 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
32453 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
32456 The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately following
32457 STARTTLS is also not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than MAIL,
32458 RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
32460 You can control which hosts are subject to the limit set by
32461 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& by setting
32462 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&. The default value is &`*`&, which makes
32463 the limit apply to all hosts. This option means that you can exclude any
32464 specific badly-behaved hosts that you have to live with.
32469 .section "The VRFY and EXPN commands" "SECID237"
32470 When Exim receives a VRFY or EXPN command on a TCP/IP connection, it
32471 runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& or &%acl_smtp_expn%& (as
32472 appropriate) in order to decide whether the command should be accepted or not.
32473 If no ACL is defined, the command is rejected.
32475 .cindex "VRFY" "processing"
32476 When VRFY is accepted, it runs exactly the same code as when Exim is
32477 called with the &%-bv%& option.
32479 .cindex "EXPN" "processing"
32480 When EXPN is accepted, a single-level expansion of the address is done.
32481 EXPN is treated as an &"address test"& (similar to the &%-bt%& option) rather
32482 than a verification (the &%-bv%& option). If an unqualified local part is given
32483 as the argument to EXPN, it is qualified with &%qualify_domain%&. Rejections
32484 of VRFY and EXPN commands are logged on the main and reject logs, and
32485 VRFY verification failures are logged on the main log for consistency with
32490 .section "The ETRN command" "SECTETRN"
32491 .cindex "ETRN" "processing"
32492 RFC 1985 describes an SMTP command called ETRN that is designed to
32493 overcome the security problems of the TURN command (which has fallen into
32494 disuse). When Exim receives an ETRN command on a TCP/IP connection, it runs
32495 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_etrn%& in order to decide whether the command
32496 should be accepted or not. If no ACL is defined, the command is rejected.
32498 The ETRN command is concerned with &"releasing"& messages that are awaiting
32499 delivery to certain hosts. As Exim does not organize its message queue by host,
32500 the only form of ETRN that is supported by default is the one where the
32501 text starts with the &"#"& prefix, in which case the remainder of the text is
32502 specific to the SMTP server. A valid ETRN command causes a run of Exim with
32503 the &%-R%& option to happen, with the remainder of the ETRN text as its
32504 argument. For example,
32512 which causes a delivery attempt on all messages with undelivered addresses
32513 containing the text &"brigadoon"&. When &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set (the
32514 default), Exim prevents the simultaneous execution of more than one queue run
32515 for the same argument string as a result of an ETRN command. This stops
32516 a misbehaving client from starting more than one queue runner at once.
32518 .cindex "hints database" "ETRN serialization"
32519 Exim implements the serialization by means of a hints database in which a
32520 record is written whenever a process is started by ETRN, and deleted when
32521 the process completes. However, Exim does not keep the SMTP session waiting for
32522 the ETRN process to complete. Once ETRN is accepted, the client is sent
32523 a &"success"& return code. Obviously there is scope for hints records to get
32524 left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To guard against this,
32525 Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
32527 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
32528 For more control over what ETRN does, the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option can
32529 used. This specifies a command that is run whenever ETRN is received,
32530 whatever the form of its argument. For
32533 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
32534 $sender_host_address
32536 .vindex "&$domain$&"
32537 The string is split up into arguments which are independently expanded. The
32538 expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the argument of the ETRN command,
32539 and no syntax checking is done on the contents of this argument. Exim does not
32540 wait for the command to complete, so its status code is not checked. Exim runs
32541 under its own uid and gid when receiving incoming SMTP, so it is not possible
32542 for it to change them before running the command.
32546 .section "Incoming local SMTP" "SECID238"
32547 .cindex "SMTP" "local incoming"
32548 Some user agents use SMTP to pass messages to their local MTA using the
32549 standard input and output, as opposed to passing the envelope on the command
32550 line and writing the message to the standard input. This is supported by the
32551 &%-bs%& option. This form of SMTP is handled in the same way as incoming
32552 messages over TCP/IP (including the use of ACLs), except that the envelope
32553 sender given in a MAIL command is ignored unless the caller is trusted. In
32554 an ACL you can detect this form of SMTP input by testing for an empty host
32555 identification. It is common to have this as the first line in the ACL that
32556 runs for RCPT commands:
32560 This accepts SMTP messages from local processes without doing any other tests.
32564 .section "Outgoing batched SMTP" "SECTbatchSMTP"
32565 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing"
32566 .cindex "batched SMTP output"
32567 Both the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports can be used for handling
32568 batched SMTP. Each has an option called &%use_bsmtp%& which causes messages to
32569 be output in BSMTP format. No SMTP responses are possible for this form of
32570 delivery. All it is doing is using SMTP commands as a way of transmitting the
32571 envelope along with the message.
32573 The message is written to the file or pipe preceded by the SMTP commands
32574 MAIL and RCPT, and followed by a line containing a single dot. Lines in
32575 the message that start with a dot have an extra dot added. The SMTP command
32576 HELO is not normally used. If it is required, the &%message_prefix%& option
32577 can be used to specify it.
32579 Because &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& are both local transports, they accept only
32580 one recipient address at a time by default. However, you can arrange for them
32581 to handle several addresses at once by setting the &%batch_max%& option. When
32582 this is done for BSMTP, messages may contain multiple RCPT commands. See
32583 chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>& for more details.
32586 When one or more addresses are routed to a BSMTP transport by a router that
32587 sets up a host list, the name of the first host on the list is available to the
32588 transport in the variable &$host$&. Here is an example of such a transport and
32593 driver = manualroute
32594 transport = smtp_appendfile
32595 route_list = domain.example batch.host.example
32599 driver = appendfile
32600 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
32605 This causes messages addressed to &'domain.example'& to be written in BSMTP
32606 format to &_/var/bsmtp/batch.host.example_&, with only a single copy of each
32607 message (unless there are more than 1000 recipients).
32611 .section "Incoming batched SMTP" "SECTincomingbatchedSMTP"
32612 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
32613 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
32614 The &%-bS%& command line option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by
32615 reading SMTP on the standard input, but to generate no responses. If the caller
32616 is trusted, the senders in the MAIL commands are believed; otherwise the
32617 sender is always the caller of Exim. Unqualified senders and receivers are not
32618 rejected (there seems little point) but instead just get qualified. HELO
32619 and EHLO act as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN and HELP, act
32620 as NOOP; QUIT quits.
32622 Minimal policy checking is done for BSMTP input. Only the non-SMTP
32623 ACL is run in the same way as for non-SMTP local input.
32625 If an error is detected while reading a message, including a missing &"."& at
32626 the end, Exim gives up immediately. It writes details of the error to the
32627 standard output in a stylized way that the calling program should be able to
32628 make some use of automatically, for example:
32630 554 Unexpected end of file
32631 Transaction started in line 10
32632 Error detected in line 14
32634 It writes a more verbose version, for human consumption, to the standard error
32637 An error was detected while processing a file of BSMTP input.
32638 The error message was:
32640 501 '>' missing at end of address
32642 The SMTP transaction started in line 10.
32643 The error was detected in line 12.
32644 The SMTP command at fault was:
32646 rcpt to:<malformed@in.com.plete
32648 1 previous message was successfully processed.
32649 The rest of the batch was abandoned.
32651 The return code from Exim is zero only if there were no errors. It is 1 if some
32652 messages were accepted before an error was detected, and 2 if no messages were
32654 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc1
32655 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc2
32659 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32660 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32662 .chapter "Customizing bounce and warning messages" "CHAPemsgcust" &&&
32663 "Customizing messages"
32664 When a message fails to be delivered, or remains on the queue for more than a
32665 configured amount of time, Exim sends a message to the original sender, or
32666 to an alternative configured address. The text of these messages is built into
32667 the code of Exim, but it is possible to change it, either by adding a single
32668 string, or by replacing each of the paragraphs by text supplied in a file.
32670 The &'From:'& and &'To:'& header lines are automatically generated; you can
32671 cause a &'Reply-To:'& line to be added by setting the &%errors_reply_to%&
32672 option. Exim also adds the line
32674 Auto-Submitted: auto-generated
32676 to all warning and bounce messages,
32679 .section "Customizing bounce messages" "SECID239"
32680 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
32681 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
32682 If &%bounce_message_text%& is set, its contents are included in the default
32683 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
32684 delivery software."& The string is not expanded. It is not used if
32685 &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
32687 When &%bounce_message_file%& is set, it must point to a template file for
32688 constructing error messages. The file consists of a series of text items,
32689 separated by lines consisting of exactly four asterisks. If the file cannot be
32690 opened, default text is used and a message is written to the main and panic
32691 logs. If any text item in the file is empty, default text is used for that
32694 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
32695 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
32696 Each item of text that is read from the file is expanded, and there are two
32697 expansion variables which can be of use here: &$bounce_recipient$& is set to
32698 the recipient of an error message while it is being created, and
32699 &$bounce_return_size_limit$& contains the value of the &%return_size_limit%&
32700 option, rounded to a whole number.
32702 The items must appear in the file in the following order:
32705 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
32706 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
32708 The second item forms the start of the error message. After it, Exim lists the
32709 failing addresses with their error messages.
32711 The third item is used to introduce any text from pipe transports that is to be
32712 returned to the sender. It is omitted if there is no such text.
32714 The fourth item is used to introduce the copy of the message that is returned
32715 as part of the error report.
32717 The fifth item is added after the fourth one if the returned message is
32718 truncated because it is bigger than &%return_size_limit%&.
32720 The sixth item is added after the copy of the original message.
32723 The default state (&%bounce_message_file%& unset) is equivalent to the
32724 following file, in which the sixth item is empty. The &'Subject:'& and some
32725 other lines have been split in order to fit them on the page:
32727 Subject: Mail delivery failed
32728 ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
32729 {: returning message to sender}}
32731 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
32733 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
32734 {that you sent }{sent by
32738 }}could not be delivered to all of its recipients.
32739 This is a permanent error. The following address(es) failed:
32741 The following text was generated during the delivery attempt(s):
32743 ------ This is a copy of the message, including all the headers.
32746 ------ The body of the message is $message_size characters long;
32748 ------ $bounce_return_size_limit or so are included here.
32751 .section "Customizing warning messages" "SECTcustwarn"
32752 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
32753 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
32754 The option &%warn_message_file%& can be pointed at a template file for use when
32755 warnings about message delays are created. In this case there are only three
32759 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
32760 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
32762 The second item forms the start of the warning message. After it, Exim lists
32763 the delayed addresses.
32765 The third item then ends the message.
32768 The default state is equivalent to the following file, except that some lines
32769 have been split here, in order to fit them on the page:
32771 Subject: Warning: message $message_exim_id delayed
32772 $warn_message_delay
32774 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
32776 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$warn_message_recipients}
32777 {that you sent }{sent by
32781 }}has not been delivered to all of its recipients after
32782 more than $warn_message_delay on the queue on $primary_hostname.
32784 The message identifier is: $message_exim_id
32785 The subject of the message is: $h_subject
32786 The date of the message is: $h_date
32788 The following address(es) have not yet been delivered:
32790 No action is required on your part. Delivery attempts will
32791 continue for some time, and this warning may be repeated at
32792 intervals if the message remains undelivered. Eventually the
32793 mail delivery software will give up, and when that happens,
32794 the message will be returned to you.
32796 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
32797 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
32798 However, in the default state the subject and date lines are omitted if no
32799 appropriate headers exist. During the expansion of this file,
32800 &$warn_message_delay$& is set to the delay time in one of the forms &"<&'n'&>
32801 minutes"& or &"<&'n'&> hours"&, and &$warn_message_recipients$& contains a list
32802 of recipients for the warning message. There may be more than one if there are
32803 multiple addresses with different &%errors_to%& settings on the routers that
32809 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32810 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32812 .chapter "Some common configuration settings" "CHAPcomconreq"
32813 This chapter discusses some configuration settings that seem to be fairly
32814 common. More examples and discussion can be found in the Exim book.
32818 .section "Sending mail to a smart host" "SECID240"
32819 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
32820 If you want to send all mail for non-local domains to a &"smart host"&, you
32821 should replace the default &(dnslookup)& router with a router which does the
32822 routing explicitly:
32824 send_to_smart_host:
32825 driver = manualroute
32826 route_list = !+local_domains smart.host.name
32827 transport = remote_smtp
32829 You can use the smart host's IP address instead of the name if you wish.
32830 If you are using Exim only to submit messages to a smart host, and not for
32831 receiving incoming messages, you can arrange for it to do the submission
32832 synchronously by setting the &%mua_wrapper%& option (see chapter
32833 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&).
32838 .section "Using Exim to handle mailing lists" "SECTmailinglists"
32839 .cindex "mailing lists"
32840 Exim can be used to run simple mailing lists, but for large and/or complicated
32841 requirements, the use of additional specialized mailing list software such as
32842 Majordomo or Mailman is recommended.
32844 The &(redirect)& router can be used to handle mailing lists where each list
32845 is maintained in a separate file, which can therefore be managed by an
32846 independent manager. The &%domains%& router option can be used to run these
32847 lists in a separate domain from normal mail. For example:
32851 domains = lists.example
32852 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
32855 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
32858 This router is skipped for domains other than &'lists.example'&. For addresses
32859 in that domain, it looks for a file that matches the local part. If there is no
32860 such file, the router declines, but because &%no_more%& is set, no subsequent
32861 routers are tried, and so the whole delivery fails.
32863 The &%forbid_pipe%& and &%forbid_file%& options prevent a local part from being
32864 expanded into a file name or a pipe delivery, which is usually inappropriate in
32867 .oindex "&%errors_to%&"
32868 The &%errors_to%& option specifies that any delivery errors caused by addresses
32869 taken from a mailing list are to be sent to the given address rather than the
32870 original sender of the message. However, before acting on this, Exim verifies
32871 the error address, and ignores it if verification fails.
32873 For example, using the configuration above, mail sent to
32874 &'dicts@lists.example'& is passed on to those addresses contained in
32875 &_/usr/lists/dicts_&, with error reports directed to
32876 &'dicts-request@lists.example'&, provided that this address can be verified.
32877 There could be a file called &_/usr/lists/dicts-request_& containing
32878 the address(es) of this particular list's manager(s), but other approaches,
32879 such as setting up an earlier router (possibly using the &%local_part_prefix%&
32880 or &%local_part_suffix%& options) to handle addresses of the form
32881 &%owner-%&&'xxx'& or &%xxx-%&&'request'&, are also possible.
32885 .section "Syntax errors in mailing lists" "SECID241"
32886 .cindex "mailing lists" "syntax errors in"
32887 If an entry in redirection data contains a syntax error, Exim normally defers
32888 delivery of the original address. That means that a syntax error in a mailing
32889 list holds up all deliveries to the list. This may not be appropriate when a
32890 list is being maintained automatically from data supplied by users, and the
32891 addresses are not rigorously checked.
32893 If the &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is set, the &(redirect)& router just skips
32894 entries that fail to parse, noting the incident in the log. If in addition
32895 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set to a verifiable address, a message is sent to it
32896 whenever a broken address is skipped. It is usually appropriate to set
32897 &%syntax_errors_to%& to the same address as &%errors_to%&.
32901 .section "Re-expansion of mailing lists" "SECID242"
32902 .cindex "mailing lists" "re-expansion of"
32903 Exim remembers every individual address to which a message has been delivered,
32904 in order to avoid duplication, but it normally stores only the original
32905 recipient addresses with a message. If all the deliveries to a mailing list
32906 cannot be done at the first attempt, the mailing list is re-expanded when the
32907 delivery is next tried. This means that alterations to the list are taken into
32908 account at each delivery attempt, so addresses that have been added to
32909 the list since the message arrived will therefore receive a copy of the
32910 message, even though it pre-dates their subscription.
32912 If this behaviour is felt to be undesirable, the &%one_time%& option can be set
32913 on the &(redirect)& router. If this is done, any addresses generated by the
32914 router that fail to deliver at the first attempt are added to the message as
32915 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
32916 &"delivered"&. Thus, expansion of the mailing list does not happen again at the
32917 subsequent delivery attempts. The disadvantage of this is that if any of the
32918 failing addresses are incorrect, correcting them in the file has no effect on
32919 pre-existing messages.
32921 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
32922 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
32923 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if the
32924 &%all_parents%& selector is set, but for mailing lists there is normally only
32925 one level of expansion anyway.
32929 .section "Closed mailing lists" "SECID243"
32930 .cindex "mailing lists" "closed"
32931 The examples so far have assumed open mailing lists, to which anybody may
32932 send mail. It is also possible to set up closed lists, where mail is accepted
32933 from specified senders only. This is done by making use of the generic
32934 &%senders%& option to restrict the router that handles the list.
32936 The following example uses the same file as a list of recipients and as a list
32937 of permitted senders. It requires three routers:
32941 domains = lists.example
32942 local_part_suffix = -request
32943 file = /usr/lists/$local_part$local_part_suffix
32948 domains = lists.example
32949 senders = ${if exists {/usr/lists/$local_part}\
32950 {lsearch;/usr/lists/$local_part}{*}}
32951 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
32954 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
32959 domains = lists.example
32961 data = :fail: $local_part@lists.example is a closed mailing list
32963 All three routers have the same &%domains%& setting, so for any other domains,
32964 they are all skipped. The first router runs only if the local part ends in
32965 &%-request%&. It handles messages to the list manager(s) by means of an open
32968 The second router runs only if the &%senders%& precondition is satisfied. It
32969 checks for the existence of a list that corresponds to the local part, and then
32970 checks that the sender is on the list by means of a linear search. It is
32971 necessary to check for the existence of the file before trying to search it,
32972 because otherwise Exim thinks there is a configuration error. If the file does
32973 not exist, the expansion of &%senders%& is *, which matches all senders. This
32974 means that the router runs, but because there is no list, declines, and
32975 &%no_more%& ensures that no further routers are run. The address fails with an
32976 &"unrouteable address"& error.
32978 The third router runs only if the second router is skipped, which happens when
32979 a mailing list exists, but the sender is not on it. This router forcibly fails
32980 the address, giving a suitable error message.
32985 .section "Variable Envelope Return Paths (VERP)" "SECTverp"
32987 .cindex "Variable Envelope Return Paths"
32988 .cindex "envelope sender"
32989 Variable Envelope Return Paths &-- see &url(http://cr.yp.to/proto/verp.txt) &--
32990 are a way of helping mailing list administrators discover which subscription
32991 address is the cause of a particular delivery failure. The idea is to encode
32992 the original recipient address in the outgoing envelope sender address, so that
32993 if the message is forwarded by another host and then subsequently bounces, the
32994 original recipient can be extracted from the recipient address of the bounce.
32996 .oindex &%errors_to%&
32997 .oindex &%return_path%&
32998 Envelope sender addresses can be modified by Exim using two different
32999 facilities: the &%errors_to%& option on a router (as shown in previous mailing
33000 list examples), or the &%return_path%& option on a transport. The second of
33001 these is effective only if the message is successfully delivered to another
33002 host; it is not used for errors detected on the local host (see the description
33003 of &%return_path%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&). Here is an example
33004 of the use of &%return_path%& to implement VERP on an &(smtp)& transport:
33010 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
33011 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
33013 This has the effect of rewriting the return path (envelope sender) on outgoing
33014 SMTP messages, if the local part of the original return path ends in
33015 &"-request"&, and the domain is &'your.dom.example'&. The rewriting inserts the
33016 local part and domain of the recipient into the return path. Suppose, for
33017 example, that a message whose return path has been set to
33018 &'somelist-request@your.dom.example'& is sent to
33019 &'subscriber@other.dom.example'&. In the transport, the return path is
33022 somelist-request+subscriber=other.dom.example@your.dom.example
33024 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
33025 For this to work, you must tell Exim to send multiple copies of messages that
33026 have more than one recipient, so that each copy has just one recipient. This is
33027 achieved by setting &%max_rcpt%& to 1. Without this, a single copy of a message
33028 might be sent to several different recipients in the same domain, in which case
33029 &$local_part$& is not available in the transport, because it is not unique.
33031 Unless your host is doing nothing but mailing list deliveries, you should
33032 probably use a separate transport for the VERP deliveries, so as not to use
33033 extra resources in making one-per-recipient copies for other deliveries. This
33034 can easily be done by expanding the &%transport%& option in the router:
33038 domains = ! +local_domains
33040 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
33041 {verp_smtp}{remote_smtp}}
33044 If you want to change the return path using &%errors_to%& in a router instead
33045 of using &%return_path%& in the transport, you need to set &%errors_to%& on all
33046 routers that handle mailing list addresses. This will ensure that all delivery
33047 errors, including those detected on the local host, are sent to the VERP
33050 On a host that does no local deliveries and has no manual routing, only the
33051 &(dnslookup)& router needs to be changed. A special transport is not needed for
33052 SMTP deliveries. Every mailing list recipient has its own return path value,
33053 and so Exim must hand them to the transport one at a time. Here is an example
33054 of a &(dnslookup)& router that implements VERP:
33058 domains = ! +local_domains
33059 transport = remote_smtp
33061 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}}
33062 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
33065 Before you start sending out messages with VERPed return paths, you must also
33066 configure Exim to accept the bounce messages that come back to those paths.
33067 Typically this is done by setting a &%local_part_suffix%& option for a
33068 router, and using this to route the messages to wherever you want to handle
33071 The overhead incurred in using VERP depends very much on the size of the
33072 message, the number of recipient addresses that resolve to the same remote
33073 host, and the speed of the connection over which the message is being sent. If
33074 a lot of addresses resolve to the same host and the connection is slow, sending
33075 a separate copy of the message for each address may take substantially longer
33076 than sending a single copy with many recipients (for which VERP cannot be
33084 .section "Virtual domains" "SECTvirtualdomains"
33085 .cindex "virtual domains"
33086 .cindex "domain" "virtual"
33087 The phrase &'virtual domain'& is unfortunately used with two rather different
33091 A domain for which there are no real mailboxes; all valid local parts are
33092 aliases for other email addresses. Common examples are organizational
33093 top-level domains and &"vanity"& domains.
33095 One of a number of independent domains that are all handled by the same host,
33096 with mailboxes on that host, but where the mailbox owners do not necessarily
33097 have login accounts on that host.
33100 The first usage is probably more common, and does seem more &"virtual"& than
33101 the second. This kind of domain can be handled in Exim with a straightforward
33102 aliasing router. One approach is to create a separate alias file for each
33103 virtual domain. Exim can test for the existence of the alias file to determine
33104 whether the domain exists. The &(dsearch)& lookup type is useful here, leading
33105 to a router of this form:
33109 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/virtual
33110 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/mail/virtual/$domain}}
33113 The &%domains%& option specifies that the router is to be skipped, unless there
33114 is a file in the &_/etc/mail/virtual_& directory whose name is the same as the
33115 domain that is being processed. When the router runs, it looks up the local
33116 part in the file to find a new address (or list of addresses). The &%no_more%&
33117 setting ensures that if the lookup fails (leading to &%data%& being an empty
33118 string), Exim gives up on the address without trying any subsequent routers.
33120 This one router can handle all the virtual domains because the alias file names
33121 follow a fixed pattern. Permissions can be arranged so that appropriate people
33122 can edit the different alias files. A successful aliasing operation results in
33123 a new envelope recipient address, which is then routed from scratch.
33125 The other kind of &"virtual"& domain can also be handled in a straightforward
33126 way. One approach is to create a file for each domain containing a list of
33127 valid local parts, and use it in a router like this:
33131 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/domains
33132 local_parts = lsearch;/etc/mail/domains/$domain
33133 transport = my_mailboxes
33135 The address is accepted if there is a file for the domain, and the local part
33136 can be found in the file. The &%domains%& option is used to check for the
33137 file's existence because &%domains%& is tested before the &%local_parts%&
33138 option (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). You cannot use &%require_files%&,
33139 because that option is tested after &%local_parts%&. The transport is as
33143 driver = appendfile
33144 file = /var/mail/$domain/$local_part
33147 This uses a directory of mailboxes for each domain. The &%user%& setting is
33148 required, to specify which uid is to be used for writing to the mailboxes.
33150 The configuration shown here is just one example of how you might support this
33151 requirement. There are many other ways this kind of configuration can be set
33152 up, for example, by using a database instead of separate files to hold all the
33153 information about the domains.
33157 .section "Multiple user mailboxes" "SECTmulbox"
33158 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
33159 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
33160 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
33161 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
33162 Heavy email users often want to operate with multiple mailboxes, into which
33163 incoming mail is automatically sorted. A popular way of handling this is to
33164 allow users to use multiple sender addresses, so that replies can easily be
33165 identified. Users are permitted to add prefixes or suffixes to their local
33166 parts for this purpose. The wildcard facility of the generic router options
33167 &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& can be used for this. For
33168 example, consider this router:
33173 file = $home/.forward
33174 local_part_suffix = -*
33175 local_part_suffix_optional
33178 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
33179 It runs a user's &_.forward_& file for all local parts of the form
33180 &'username-*'&. Within the filter file the user can distinguish different
33181 cases by testing the variable &$local_part_suffix$&. For example:
33183 if $local_part_suffix contains -special then
33184 save /home/$local_part/Mail/special
33187 If the filter file does not exist, or does not deal with such addresses, they
33188 fall through to subsequent routers, and, assuming no subsequent use of the
33189 &%local_part_suffix%& option is made, they presumably fail. Thus, users have
33190 control over which suffixes are valid.
33192 Alternatively, a suffix can be used to trigger the use of a different
33193 &_.forward_& file &-- which is the way a similar facility is implemented in
33199 file = $home/.forward$local_part_suffix
33200 local_part_suffix = -*
33201 local_part_suffix_optional
33204 If there is no suffix, &_.forward_& is used; if the suffix is &'-special'&, for
33205 example, &_.forward-special_& is used. Once again, if the appropriate file
33206 does not exist, or does not deal with the address, it is passed on to
33207 subsequent routers, which could, if required, look for an unqualified
33208 &_.forward_& file to use as a default.
33212 .section "Simplified vacation processing" "SECID244"
33213 .cindex "vacation processing"
33214 The traditional way of running the &'vacation'& program is for a user to set up
33215 a pipe command in a &_.forward_& file
33216 (see section &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for syntax details).
33217 This is prone to error by inexperienced users. There are two features of Exim
33218 that can be used to make this process simpler for users:
33221 A local part prefix such as &"vacation-"& can be specified on a router which
33222 can cause the message to be delivered directly to the &'vacation'& program, or
33223 alternatively can use Exim's &(autoreply)& transport. The contents of a user's
33224 &_.forward_& file are then much simpler. For example:
33226 spqr, vacation-spqr
33229 The &%require_files%& generic router option can be used to trigger a
33230 vacation delivery by checking for the existence of a certain file in the
33231 user's home directory. The &%unseen%& generic option should also be used, to
33232 ensure that the original delivery also proceeds. In this case, all the user has
33233 to do is to create a file called, say, &_.vacation_&, containing a vacation
33237 Another advantage of both these methods is that they both work even when the
33238 use of arbitrary pipes by users is locked out.
33242 .section "Taking copies of mail" "SECID245"
33243 .cindex "message" "copying every"
33244 Some installations have policies that require archive copies of all messages to
33245 be made. A single copy of each message can easily be taken by an appropriate
33246 command in a system filter, which could, for example, use a different file for
33247 each day's messages.
33249 There is also a shadow transport mechanism that can be used to take copies of
33250 messages that are successfully delivered by local transports, one copy per
33251 delivery. This could be used, &'inter alia'&, to implement automatic
33252 notification of delivery by sites that insist on doing such things.
33256 .section "Intermittently connected hosts" "SECID246"
33257 .cindex "intermittently connected hosts"
33258 It has become quite common (because it is cheaper) for hosts to connect to the
33259 Internet periodically rather than remain connected all the time. The normal
33260 arrangement is that mail for such hosts accumulates on a system that is
33261 permanently connected.
33263 Exim was designed for use on permanently connected hosts, and so it is not
33264 particularly well-suited to use in an intermittently connected environment.
33265 Nevertheless there are some features that can be used.
33268 .section "Exim on the upstream server host" "SECID247"
33269 It is tempting to arrange for incoming mail for the intermittently connected
33270 host to remain on Exim's queue until the client connects. However, this
33271 approach does not scale very well. Two different kinds of waiting message are
33272 being mixed up in the same queue &-- those that cannot be delivered because of
33273 some temporary problem, and those that are waiting for their destination host
33274 to connect. This makes it hard to manage the queue, as well as wasting
33275 resources, because each queue runner scans the entire queue.
33277 A better approach is to separate off those messages that are waiting for an
33278 intermittently connected host. This can be done by delivering these messages
33279 into local files in batch SMTP, &"mailstore"&, or other envelope-preserving
33280 format, from where they are transmitted by other software when their
33281 destination connects. This makes it easy to collect all the mail for one host
33282 in a single directory, and to apply local timeout rules on a per-message basis
33285 On a very small scale, leaving the mail on Exim's queue can be made to work. If
33286 you are doing this, you should configure Exim with a long retry period for the
33287 intermittent host. For example:
33289 cheshire.wonderland.fict.example * F,5d,24h
33291 This stops a lot of failed delivery attempts from occurring, but Exim remembers
33292 which messages it has queued up for that host. Once the intermittent host comes
33293 online, forcing delivery of one message (either by using the &%-M%& or &%-R%&
33294 options, or by using the ETRN SMTP command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&)
33295 causes all the queued up messages to be delivered, often down a single SMTP
33296 connection. While the host remains connected, any new messages get delivered
33299 If the connecting hosts do not have fixed IP addresses, that is, if a host is
33300 issued with a different IP address each time it connects, Exim's retry
33301 mechanisms on the holding host get confused, because the IP address is normally
33302 used as part of the key string for holding retry information. This can be
33303 avoided by unsetting &%retry_include_ip_address%& on the &(smtp)& transport.
33304 Since this has disadvantages for permanently connected hosts, it is best to
33305 arrange a separate transport for the intermittently connected ones.
33309 .section "Exim on the intermittently connected client host" "SECID248"
33310 The value of &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& should probably be
33311 increased, or even set to zero (that is, disabled) on the intermittently
33312 connected host, so that all incoming messages down a single connection get
33313 delivered immediately.
33315 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
33316 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
33317 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
33318 Mail waiting to be sent from an intermittently connected host will probably
33319 not have been routed, because without a connection DNS lookups are not
33320 possible. This means that if a normal queue run is done at connection time,
33321 each message is likely to be sent in a separate SMTP session. This can be
33322 avoided by starting the queue run with a command line option beginning with
33323 &%-qq%& instead of &%-q%&. In this case, the queue is scanned twice. In the
33324 first pass, routing is done but no deliveries take place. The second pass is a
33325 normal queue run; since all the messages have been previously routed, those
33326 destined for the same host are likely to get sent as multiple deliveries in a
33327 single SMTP connection.
33331 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33332 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33334 .chapter "Using Exim as a non-queueing client" "CHAPnonqueueing" &&&
33335 "Exim as a non-queueing client"
33336 .cindex "client, non-queueing"
33337 .cindex "smart host" "suppressing queueing"
33338 On a personal computer, it is a common requirement for all
33339 email to be sent to a &"smart host"&. There are plenty of MUAs that can be
33340 configured to operate that way, for all the popular operating systems.
33341 However, there are some MUAs for Unix-like systems that cannot be so
33342 configured: they submit messages using the command line interface of
33343 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. Furthermore, utility programs such as &'cron'& submit
33346 If the personal computer runs continuously, there is no problem, because it can
33347 run a conventional MTA that handles delivery to the smart host, and deal with
33348 any delays via its queueing mechanism. However, if the computer does not run
33349 continuously or runs different operating systems at different times, queueing
33350 email is not desirable.
33352 There is therefore a requirement for something that can provide the
33353 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& interface but deliver messages to a smart host without
33354 any queueing or retrying facilities. Furthermore, the delivery to the smart
33355 host should be synchronous, so that if it fails, the sending MUA is immediately
33356 informed. In other words, we want something that extends an MUA that submits
33357 to a local MTA via the command line so that it behaves like one that submits
33358 to a remote smart host using TCP/SMTP.
33360 There are a number of applications (for example, there is one called &'ssmtp'&)
33361 that do this job. However, people have found them to be lacking in various
33362 ways. For instance, you might want to allow aliasing and forwarding to be done
33363 before sending a message to the smart host.
33365 Exim already had the necessary infrastructure for doing this job. Just a few
33366 tweaks were needed to make it behave as required, though it is somewhat of an
33367 overkill to use a fully-featured MTA for this purpose.
33369 .oindex "&%mua_wrapper%&"
33370 There is a Boolean global option called &%mua_wrapper%&, defaulting false.
33371 Setting &%mua_wrapper%& true causes Exim to run in a special mode where it
33372 assumes that it is being used to &"wrap"& a command-line MUA in the manner
33373 just described. As well as setting &%mua_wrapper%&, you also need to provide a
33374 compatible router and transport configuration. Typically there will be just one
33375 router and one transport, sending everything to a smart host.
33377 When run in MUA wrapping mode, the behaviour of Exim changes in the
33381 A daemon cannot be run, nor will Exim accept incoming messages from &'inetd'&.
33382 In other words, the only way to submit messages is via the command line.
33384 Each message is synchronously delivered as soon as it is received (&%-odi%& is
33385 assumed). All queueing options (&%queue_only%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
33386 &%control%& in an ACL, etc.) are quietly ignored. The Exim reception process
33387 does not finish until the delivery attempt is complete. If the delivery is
33388 successful, a zero return code is given.
33390 Address redirection is permitted, but the final routing for all addresses must
33391 be to the same remote transport, and to the same list of hosts. Furthermore,
33392 the return address (envelope sender) must be the same for all recipients, as
33393 must any added or deleted header lines. In other words, it must be possible to
33394 deliver the message in a single SMTP transaction, however many recipients there
33397 If these conditions are not met, or if routing any address results in a
33398 failure or defer status, or if Exim is unable to deliver all the recipients
33399 successfully to one of the smart hosts, delivery of the entire message fails.
33401 Because no queueing is allowed, all failures are treated as permanent; there
33402 is no distinction between 4&'xx'& and 5&'xx'& SMTP response codes from the
33403 smart host. Furthermore, because only a single yes/no response can be given to
33404 the caller, it is not possible to deliver to some recipients and not others. If
33405 there is an error (temporary or permanent) for any recipient, all are failed.
33407 If more than one smart host is listed, Exim will try another host after a
33408 connection failure or a timeout, in the normal way. However, if this kind of
33409 failure happens for all the hosts, the delivery fails.
33411 When delivery fails, an error message is written to the standard error stream
33412 (as well as to Exim's log), and Exim exits to the caller with a return code
33413 value 1. The message is expunged from Exim's spool files. No bounce messages
33414 are ever generated.
33416 No retry data is maintained, and any retry rules are ignored.
33418 A number of Exim options are overridden: &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced
33419 true, &%max_rcpt%& in the &(smtp)& transport is forced to &"unlimited"&,
33420 &%remote_max_parallel%& is forced to one, and fallback hosts are ignored.
33423 The overall effect is that Exim makes a single synchronous attempt to deliver
33424 the message, failing if there is any kind of problem. Because no local
33425 deliveries are done and no daemon can be run, Exim does not need root
33426 privilege. It should be possible to run it setuid to &'exim'& instead of setuid
33427 to &'root'&. See section &<<SECTrunexiwitpri>>& for a general discussion about
33428 the advantages and disadvantages of running without root privilege.
33433 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33434 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33436 .chapter "Log files" "CHAPlog"
33437 .scindex IIDloggen "log" "general description"
33438 .cindex "log" "types of"
33439 Exim writes three different logs, referred to as the main log, the reject log,
33444 The main log records the arrival of each message and each delivery in a single
33445 line in each case. The format is as compact as possible, in an attempt to keep
33446 down the size of log files. Two-character flag sequences make it easy to pick
33447 out these lines. A number of other events are recorded in the main log. Some of
33448 them are optional, in which case the &%log_selector%& option controls whether
33449 they are included or not. A Perl script called &'eximstats'&, which does simple
33450 analysis of main log files, is provided in the Exim distribution (see section
33451 &<<SECTmailstat>>&).
33453 .cindex "reject log"
33454 The reject log records information from messages that are rejected as a result
33455 of a configuration option (that is, for policy reasons).
33456 The first line of each rejection is a copy of the line that is also written to
33457 the main log. Then, if the message's header has been read at the time the log
33458 is written, its contents are written to this log. Only the original header
33459 lines are available; header lines added by ACLs are not logged. You can use the
33460 reject log to check that your policy controls are working correctly; on a busy
33461 host this may be easier than scanning the main log for rejection messages. You
33462 can suppress the writing of the reject log by setting &%write_rejectlog%&
33465 .cindex "panic log"
33466 .cindex "system log"
33467 When certain serious errors occur, Exim writes entries to its panic log. If the
33468 error is sufficiently disastrous, Exim bombs out afterwards. Panic log entries
33469 are usually written to the main log as well, but can get lost amid the mass of
33470 other entries. The panic log should be empty under normal circumstances. It is
33471 therefore a good idea to check it (or to have a &'cron'& script check it)
33472 regularly, in order to become aware of any problems. When Exim cannot open its
33473 panic log, it tries as a last resort to write to the system log (syslog). This
33474 is opened with LOG_PID+LOG_CONS and the facility code of LOG_MAIL. The
33475 message itself is written at priority LOG_CRIT.
33478 Every log line starts with a timestamp, in the format shown in the following
33479 example. Note that many of the examples shown in this chapter are line-wrapped.
33480 In the log file, this would be all on one line:
33482 2001-09-16 16:09:47 SMTP connection from [127.0.0.1] closed
33485 By default, the timestamps are in the local timezone. There are two
33486 ways of changing this:
33489 You can set the &%timezone%& option to a different time zone; in particular, if
33494 the timestamps will be in UTC (aka GMT).
33496 If you set &%log_timezone%& true, the time zone is added to the timestamp, for
33499 2003-04-25 11:17:07 +0100 Start queue run: pid=12762
33503 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
33504 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
33505 Exim does not include its process id in log lines by default, but you can
33506 request that it does so by specifying the &`pid`& log selector (see section
33507 &<<SECTlogselector>>&). When this is set, the process id is output, in square
33508 brackets, immediately after the time and date.
33513 .section "Where the logs are written" "SECTwhelogwri"
33514 .cindex "log" "destination"
33515 .cindex "log" "to file"
33516 .cindex "log" "to syslog"
33518 The logs may be written to local files, or to syslog, or both. However, it
33519 should be noted that many syslog implementations use UDP as a transport, and
33520 are therefore unreliable in the sense that messages are not guaranteed to
33521 arrive at the loghost, nor is the ordering of messages necessarily maintained.
33522 It has also been reported that on large log files (tens of megabytes) you may
33523 need to tweak syslog to prevent it syncing the file with each write &-- on
33524 Linux this has been seen to make syslog take 90% plus of CPU time.
33526 The destination for Exim's logs is configured by setting LOG_FILE_PATH in
33527 &_Local/Makefile_& or by setting &%log_file_path%& in the run time
33528 configuration. This latter string is expanded, so it can contain, for example,
33529 references to the host name:
33531 log_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim_%slog
33533 It is generally advisable, however, to set the string in &_Local/Makefile_&
33534 rather than at run time, because then the setting is available right from the
33535 start of Exim's execution. Otherwise, if there's something it wants to log
33536 before it has read the configuration file (for example, an error in the
33537 configuration file) it will not use the path you want, and may not be able to
33540 The value of LOG_FILE_PATH or &%log_file_path%& is a colon-separated
33541 list, currently limited to at most two items. This is one option where the
33542 facility for changing a list separator may not be used. The list must always be
33543 colon-separated. If an item in the list is &"syslog"& then syslog is used;
33544 otherwise the item must either be an absolute path, containing &`%s`& at the
33545 point where &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"& is to be inserted, or be empty,
33546 implying the use of a default path.
33548 When Exim encounters an empty item in the list, it searches the list defined by
33549 LOG_FILE_PATH, and uses the first item it finds that is neither empty nor
33550 &"syslog"&. This means that an empty item in &%log_file_path%& can be used to
33551 mean &"use the path specified at build time"&. It no such item exists, log
33552 files are written in the &_log_& subdirectory of the spool directory. This is
33553 equivalent to the setting:
33555 log_file_path = $spool_directory/log/%slog
33557 If you do not specify anything at build time or run time, that is where the
33560 A log file path may also contain &`%D`& or &`%M`& if datestamped log file names
33561 are in use &-- see section &<<SECTdatlogfil>>& below.
33563 Here are some examples of possible settings:
33565 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog `& syslog only
33566 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=:syslog `& syslog and default path
33567 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog : /usr/log/exim_%s `& syslog and specified path
33568 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=/usr/log/exim_%s `& specified path only
33570 If there are more than two paths in the list, the first is used and a panic
33575 .section "Logging to local files that are periodically &""cycled""&" "SECID285"
33576 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
33577 .cindex "cycling logs"
33578 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
33579 .cindex "log" "local files; writing to"
33580 Some operating systems provide centralized and standardized methods for cycling
33581 log files. For those that do not, a utility script called &'exicyclog'& is
33582 provided (see section &<<SECTcyclogfil>>&). This renames and compresses the
33583 main and reject logs each time it is called. The maximum number of old logs to
33584 keep can be set. It is suggested this script is run as a daily &'cron'& job.
33586 An Exim delivery process opens the main log when it first needs to write to it,
33587 and it keeps the file open in case subsequent entries are required &-- for
33588 example, if a number of different deliveries are being done for the same
33589 message. However, remote SMTP deliveries can take a long time, and this means
33590 that the file may be kept open long after it is renamed if &'exicyclog'& or
33591 something similar is being used to rename log files on a regular basis. To
33592 ensure that a switch of log files is noticed as soon as possible, Exim calls
33593 &[stat()]& on the main log's name before reusing an open file, and if the file
33594 does not exist, or its inode has changed, the old file is closed and Exim
33595 tries to open the main log from scratch. Thus, an old log file may remain open
33596 for quite some time, but no Exim processes should write to it once it has been
33601 .section "Datestamped log files" "SECTdatlogfil"
33602 .cindex "log" "datestamped files"
33603 Instead of cycling the main and reject log files by renaming them
33604 periodically, some sites like to use files whose names contain a datestamp,
33605 for example, &_mainlog-20031225_&. The datestamp is in the form &_yyyymmdd_& or
33606 &_yyyymm_&. Exim has support for this way of working. It is enabled by setting
33607 the &%log_file_path%& option to a path that includes &`%D`& or &`%M`& at the
33608 point where the datestamp is required. For example:
33610 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%slog-%D
33611 log_file_path = /var/log/exim-%s-%D.log
33612 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%D-%slog
33613 log_file_path = /var/log/exim/%s.%M
33615 As before, &`%s`& is replaced by &"main"& or &"reject"&; the following are
33616 examples of names generated by the above examples:
33618 /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog-20021225
33619 /var/log/exim-reject-20021225.log
33620 /var/spool/exim/log/20021225-mainlog
33621 /var/log/exim/main.200212
33623 When this form of log file is specified, Exim automatically switches to new
33624 files at midnight. It does not make any attempt to compress old logs; you
33625 will need to write your own script if you require this. You should not
33626 run &'exicyclog'& with this form of logging.
33628 The location of the panic log is also determined by &%log_file_path%&, but it
33629 is not datestamped, because rotation of the panic log does not make sense.
33630 When generating the name of the panic log, &`%D`& or &`%M`& are removed from
33631 the string. In addition, if it immediately follows a slash, a following
33632 non-alphanumeric character is removed; otherwise a preceding non-alphanumeric
33633 character is removed. Thus, the four examples above would give these panic
33636 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
33637 /var/log/exim-panic.log
33638 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
33639 /var/log/exim/panic
33643 .section "Logging to syslog" "SECID249"
33644 .cindex "log" "syslog; writing to"
33645 The use of syslog does not change what Exim logs or the format of its messages,
33646 except in one respect. If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on
33647 Exim's log lines are omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. Apart from
33648 that, the same strings are written to syslog as to log files. The syslog
33649 &"facility"& is set to LOG_MAIL, and the program name to &"exim"&
33650 by default, but you can change these by setting the &%syslog_facility%& and
33651 &%syslog_processname%& options, respectively. If Exim was compiled with
33652 SYSLOG_LOG_PID set in &_Local/Makefile_& (this is the default in
33653 &_src/EDITME_&), then, on systems that permit it (all except ULTRIX), the
33654 LOG_PID flag is set so that the &[syslog()]& call adds the pid as well as
33655 the time and host name to each line.
33656 The three log streams are mapped onto syslog priorities as follows:
33659 &'mainlog'& is mapped to LOG_INFO
33661 &'rejectlog'& is mapped to LOG_NOTICE
33663 &'paniclog'& is mapped to LOG_ALERT
33666 Many log lines are written to both &'mainlog'& and &'rejectlog'&, and some are
33667 written to both &'mainlog'& and &'paniclog'&, so there will be duplicates if
33668 these are routed by syslog to the same place. You can suppress this duplication
33669 by setting &%syslog_duplication%& false.
33671 Exim's log lines can sometimes be very long, and some of its &'rejectlog'&
33672 entries contain multiple lines when headers are included. To cope with both
33673 these cases, entries written to syslog are split into separate &[syslog()]&
33674 calls at each internal newline, and also after a maximum of
33675 870 data characters. (This allows for a total syslog line length of 1024, when
33676 additions such as timestamps are added.) If you are running a syslog
33677 replacement that can handle lines longer than the 1024 characters allowed by
33678 RFC 3164, you should set
33680 SYSLOG_LONG_LINES=yes
33682 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. That stops Exim from splitting long
33683 lines, but it still splits at internal newlines in &'reject'& log entries.
33685 To make it easy to re-assemble split lines later, each component of a split
33686 entry starts with a string of the form [<&'n'&>/<&'m'&>] or [<&'n'&>\<&'m'&>]
33687 where <&'n'&> is the component number and <&'m'&> is the total number of
33688 components in the entry. The / delimiter is used when the line was split
33689 because it was too long; if it was split because of an internal newline, the \
33690 delimiter is used. For example, supposing the length limit to be 50 instead of
33691 870, the following would be the result of a typical rejection message to
33692 &'mainlog'& (LOG_INFO), each line in addition being preceded by the time, host
33693 name, and pid as added by syslog:
33695 [1/5] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected from
33696 [2/5] [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' header
33697 [3/5] when scanning for sender: missing or malformed lo
33698 [4/5] cal part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam.exa
33701 The same error might cause the following lines to be written to &"rejectlog"&
33704 [1/18] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected fro
33705 [2/18] m [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' head
33706 [3/18] er when scanning for sender: missing or malformed
33707 [4/18] local part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam
33709 [6\18] Recipients: ph10@some.domain.cam.example
33710 [7\18] P Received: from [127.0.0.1] (ident=ph10)
33711 [8\18] by xxxxx.cam.example with smtp (Exim 4.00)
33712 [9\18] id 16RdAL-0006pc-00
33713 [10/18] for ph10@cam.example; Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:
33714 [11\18] 09:43 +0100
33716 [13\18] Subject: this is a test header
33717 [18\18] X-something: this is another header
33718 [15/18] I Message-Id: <E16RdAL-0006pc-00@xxxxx.cam.examp
33721 [18/18] Date: Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:09:43 +0100
33723 Log lines that are neither too long nor contain newlines are written to syslog
33724 without modification.
33726 If only syslog is being used, the Exim monitor is unable to provide a log tail
33727 display, unless syslog is routing &'mainlog'& to a file on the local host and
33728 the environment variable EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set to tell the monitor
33733 .section "Log line flags" "SECID250"
33734 One line is written to the main log for each message received, and for each
33735 successful, unsuccessful, and delayed delivery. These lines can readily be
33736 picked out by the distinctive two-character flags that immediately follow the
33737 timestamp. The flags are:
33739 &`<=`& message arrival
33740 &`=>`& normal message delivery
33741 &`->`& additional address in same delivery
33742 &`>>`& cutthrough message delivery
33743 &`*>`& delivery suppressed by &%-N%&
33744 &`**`& delivery failed; address bounced
33745 &`==`& delivery deferred; temporary problem
33749 .section "Logging message reception" "SECID251"
33750 .cindex "log" "reception line"
33751 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
33752 message received is shown in the basic example below, which is split over
33753 several lines in order to fit it on the page:
33755 2002-10-31 08:57:53 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 <= kryten@dwarf.fict.example
33756 H=mailer.fict.example [192.168.123.123] U=exim
33757 P=smtp S=5678 id=<incoming message id>
33759 The address immediately following &"<="& is the envelope sender address. A
33760 bounce message is shown with the sender address &"<>"&, and if it is locally
33761 generated, this is followed by an item of the form
33765 which is a reference to the message that caused the bounce to be sent.
33769 For messages from other hosts, the H and U fields identify the remote host and
33770 record the RFC 1413 identity of the user that sent the message, if one was
33771 received. The number given in square brackets is the IP address of the sending
33772 host. If there is a single, unparenthesized host name in the H field, as
33773 above, it has been verified to correspond to the IP address (see the
33774 &%host_lookup%& option). If the name is in parentheses, it was the name quoted
33775 by the remote host in the SMTP HELO or EHLO command, and has not been
33776 verified. If verification yields a different name to that given for HELO or
33777 EHLO, the verified name appears first, followed by the HELO or EHLO
33778 name in parentheses.
33780 Misconfigured hosts (and mail forgers) sometimes put an IP address, with or
33781 without brackets, in the HELO or EHLO command, leading to entries in
33782 the log containing text like these examples:
33784 H=(10.21.32.43) [192.168.8.34]
33785 H=([10.21.32.43]) [192.168.8.34]
33787 This can be confusing. Only the final address in square brackets can be relied
33790 For locally generated messages (that is, messages not received over TCP/IP),
33791 the H field is omitted, and the U field contains the login name of the caller
33794 .cindex "authentication" "logging"
33795 .cindex "AUTH" "logging"
33796 For all messages, the P field specifies the protocol used to receive the
33797 message. This is the value that is stored in &$received_protocol$&. In the case
33798 of incoming SMTP messages, the value indicates whether or not any SMTP
33799 extensions (ESMTP), encryption, or authentication were used. If the SMTP
33800 session was encrypted, there is an additional X field that records the cipher
33801 suite that was used.
33803 The protocol is set to &"esmtpsa"& or &"esmtpa"& for messages received from
33804 hosts that have authenticated themselves using the SMTP AUTH command. The first
33805 value is used when the SMTP connection was encrypted (&"secure"&). In this case
33806 there is an additional item A= followed by the name of the authenticator that
33807 was used. If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's
33808 &%server_set_id%& option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the
33809 authenticator name.
33811 .cindex "size" "of message"
33812 The id field records the existing message id, if present. The size of the
33813 received message is given by the S field. When the message is delivered,
33814 headers may be removed or added, so that the size of delivered copies of the
33815 message may not correspond with this value (and indeed may be different to each
33818 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
33819 data when a message is received. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
33823 .section "Logging deliveries" "SECID252"
33824 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
33825 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
33826 delivery is shown in one of the examples below, for local and remote
33827 deliveries, respectively. Each example has been split into two lines in order
33828 to fit it on the page:
33830 2002-10-31 08:59:13 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 => marv
33831 <marv@hitch.fict.example> R=localuser T=local_delivery
33832 2002-10-31 09:00:10 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 =>
33833 monk@holistic.fict.example R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp
33834 H=holistic.fict.example [192.168.234.234]
33836 For ordinary local deliveries, the original address is given in angle brackets
33837 after the final delivery address, which might be a pipe or a file. If
33838 intermediate address(es) exist between the original and the final address, the
33839 last of these is given in parentheses after the final address. The R and T
33840 fields record the router and transport that were used to process the address.
33842 If SMTP AUTH was used for the delivery there is an additional item A=
33843 followed by the name of the authenticator that was used.
33844 If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's &%client_set_id%&
33845 option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the authenticator name.
33847 If a shadow transport was run after a successful local delivery, the log line
33848 for the successful delivery has an item added on the end, of the form
33850 &`ST=<`&&'shadow transport name'&&`>`&
33852 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
33853 parentheses afterwards.
33855 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
33856 When more than one address is included in a single delivery (for example, two
33857 SMTP RCPT commands in one transaction) the second and subsequent addresses are
33858 flagged with &`->`& instead of &`=>`&. When two or more messages are delivered
33859 down a single SMTP connection, an asterisk follows the IP address in the log
33860 lines for the second and subsequent messages.
33862 .cindex "delivery" "cutthrough; logging"
33863 .cindex "cutthrough" "logging"
33864 When delivery is done in cutthrough mode it is flagged with &`>>`& and the log
33865 line precedes the reception line, since cutthrough waits for a possible
33866 rejection from the destination in case it can reject the sourced item.
33868 The generation of a reply message by a filter file gets logged as a
33869 &"delivery"& to the addressee, preceded by &">"&.
33871 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
33872 data when a message is delivered. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
33875 .section "Discarded deliveries" "SECID253"
33876 .cindex "discarded messages"
33877 .cindex "message" "discarded"
33878 .cindex "delivery" "discarded; logging"
33879 When a message is discarded as a result of the command &"seen finish"& being
33880 obeyed in a filter file which generates no deliveries, a log entry of the form
33882 2002-12-10 00:50:49 16auJc-0001UB-00 => discarded
33883 <low.club@bridge.example> R=userforward
33885 is written, to record why no deliveries are logged. When a message is discarded
33886 because it is aliased to &":blackhole:"& the log line is like this:
33888 1999-03-02 09:44:33 10HmaX-0005vi-00 => :blackhole:
33889 <hole@nowhere.example> R=blackhole_router
33893 .section "Deferred deliveries" "SECID254"
33894 When a delivery is deferred, a line of the following form is logged:
33896 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 == marvin@endrest.example
33897 R=dnslookup T=smtp defer (146): Connection refused
33899 In the case of remote deliveries, the error is the one that was given for the
33900 last IP address that was tried. Details of individual SMTP failures are also
33901 written to the log, so the above line would be preceded by something like
33903 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 Failed to connect to
33904 mail1.endrest.example [192.168.239.239]: Connection refused
33906 When a deferred address is skipped because its retry time has not been reached,
33907 a message is written to the log, but this can be suppressed by setting an
33908 appropriate value in &%log_selector%&.
33912 .section "Delivery failures" "SECID255"
33913 .cindex "delivery" "failure; logging"
33914 If a delivery fails because an address cannot be routed, a line of the
33915 following form is logged:
33917 1995-12-19 16:20:23 0tRiQz-0002Q5-00 ** jim@trek99.example
33918 <jim@trek99.example>: unknown mail domain
33920 If a delivery fails at transport time, the router and transport are shown, and
33921 the response from the remote host is included, as in this example:
33923 2002-07-11 07:14:17 17SXDU-000189-00 ** ace400@pb.example
33924 R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp: SMTP error from remote mailer
33925 after pipelined RCPT TO:<ace400@pb.example>: host
33926 pbmail3.py.example [192.168.63.111]: 553 5.3.0
33927 <ace400@pb.example>...Addressee unknown
33929 The word &"pipelined"& indicates that the SMTP PIPELINING extension was being
33930 used. See &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%& in the &(smtp)& transport for a way of
33931 disabling PIPELINING. The log lines for all forms of delivery failure are
33932 flagged with &`**`&.
33936 .section "Fake deliveries" "SECID256"
33937 .cindex "delivery" "fake; logging"
33938 If a delivery does not actually take place because the &%-N%& option has been
33939 used to suppress it, a normal delivery line is written to the log, except that
33940 &"=>"& is replaced by &"*>"&.
33944 .section "Completion" "SECID257"
33947 2002-10-31 09:00:11 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 Completed
33949 is written to the main log when a message is about to be removed from the spool
33950 at the end of its processing.
33955 .section "Summary of Fields in Log Lines" "SECID258"
33956 .cindex "log" "summary of fields"
33957 A summary of the field identifiers that are used in log lines is shown in
33958 the following table:
33960 &`A `& authenticator name (and optional id and sender)
33961 &`C `& SMTP confirmation on delivery
33962 &` `& command list for &"no mail in SMTP session"&
33963 &`CV `& certificate verification status
33964 &`D `& duration of &"no mail in SMTP session"&
33965 &`DN `& distinguished name from peer certificate
33966 &`DT `& on &`=>`& lines: time taken for a delivery
33967 &`F `& sender address (on delivery lines)
33968 &`H `& host name and IP address
33969 &`I `& local interface used
33970 &`id `& message id for incoming message
33971 &`P `& on &`<=`& lines: protocol used
33972 &` `& on &`=>`& and &`**`& lines: return path
33973 &`QT `& on &`=>`& lines: time spent on queue so far
33974 &` `& on &"Completed"& lines: time spent on queue
33975 &`R `& on &`<=`& lines: reference for local bounce
33976 &` `& on &`=>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: router name
33977 &`S `& size of message
33978 &`ST `& shadow transport name
33979 &`T `& on &`<=`& lines: message subject (topic)
33980 &` `& on &`=>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: transport name
33981 &`U `& local user or RFC 1413 identity
33982 &`X `& TLS cipher suite
33986 .section "Other log entries" "SECID259"
33987 Various other types of log entry are written from time to time. Most should be
33988 self-explanatory. Among the more common are:
33991 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
33992 &'retry time not reached'&&~&~An address previously suffered a temporary error
33993 during routing or local delivery, and the time to retry has not yet arrived.
33994 This message is not written to an individual message log file unless it happens
33995 during the first delivery attempt.
33997 &'retry time not reached for any host'&&~&~An address previously suffered
33998 temporary errors during remote delivery, and the retry time has not yet arrived
33999 for any of the hosts to which it is routed.
34001 .cindex "spool directory" "file locked"
34002 &'spool file locked'&&~&~An attempt to deliver a message cannot proceed because
34003 some other Exim process is already working on the message. This can be quite
34004 common if queue running processes are started at frequent intervals. The
34005 &'exiwhat'& utility script can be used to find out what Exim processes are
34008 .cindex "error" "ignored"
34009 &'error ignored'&&~&~There are several circumstances that give rise to this
34012 Exim failed to deliver a bounce message whose age was greater than
34013 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. The bounce was discarded.
34015 A filter file set up a delivery using the &"noerror"& option, and the delivery
34016 failed. The delivery was discarded.
34018 A delivery set up by a router configured with
34019 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
34020 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
34024 failed. The delivery was discarded.
34032 .section "Reducing or increasing what is logged" "SECTlogselector"
34033 .cindex "log" "selectors"
34034 By setting the &%log_selector%& global option, you can disable some of Exim's
34035 default logging, or you can request additional logging. The value of
34036 &%log_selector%& is made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. For
34039 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
34041 The list of optional log items is in the following table, with the default
34042 selection marked by asterisks:
34044 &` 8bitmime `& received 8BITMIME status
34045 &`*acl_warn_skipped `& skipped &%warn%& statement in ACL
34046 &` address_rewrite `& address rewriting
34047 &` all_parents `& all parents in => lines
34048 &` arguments `& command line arguments
34049 &`*connection_reject `& connection rejections
34050 &`*delay_delivery `& immediate delivery delayed
34051 &` deliver_time `& time taken to perform delivery
34052 &` delivery_size `& add &`S=`&&'nnn'& to => lines
34053 &`*dnslist_defer `& defers of DNS list (aka RBL) lookups
34054 &`*etrn `& ETRN commands
34055 &`*host_lookup_failed `& as it says
34056 &` ident_timeout `& timeout for ident connection
34057 &` incoming_interface `& incoming interface on <= lines
34058 &` incoming_port `& incoming port on <= lines
34059 &`*lost_incoming_connection `& as it says (includes timeouts)
34060 &` outgoing_port `& add remote port to => lines
34061 &`*queue_run `& start and end queue runs
34062 &` queue_time `& time on queue for one recipient
34063 &` queue_time_overall `& time on queue for whole message
34064 &` pid `& Exim process id
34065 &` received_recipients `& recipients on <= lines
34066 &` received_sender `& sender on <= lines
34067 &`*rejected_header `& header contents on reject log
34068 &`*retry_defer `& &"retry time not reached"&
34069 &` return_path_on_delivery `& put return path on => and ** lines
34070 &` sender_on_delivery `& add sender to => lines
34071 &`*sender_verify_fail `& sender verification failures
34072 &`*size_reject `& rejection because too big
34073 &`*skip_delivery `& delivery skipped in a queue run
34074 &`*smtp_confirmation `& SMTP confirmation on => lines
34075 &` smtp_connection `& SMTP connections
34076 &` smtp_incomplete_transaction`& incomplete SMTP transactions
34077 &` smtp_mailauth `& AUTH argument to MAIL commands
34078 &` smtp_no_mail `& session with no MAIL commands
34079 &` smtp_protocol_error `& SMTP protocol errors
34080 &` smtp_syntax_error `& SMTP syntax errors
34081 &` subject `& contents of &'Subject:'& on <= lines
34082 &` tls_certificate_verified `& certificate verification status
34083 &`*tls_cipher `& TLS cipher suite on <= and => lines
34084 &` tls_peerdn `& TLS peer DN on <= and => lines
34085 &` tls_sni `& TLS SNI on <= lines
34086 &` unknown_in_list `& DNS lookup failed in list match
34088 &` all `& all of the above
34090 More details on each of these items follows:
34094 .cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
34095 &%8bitmime%&: This causes Exim to log any 8BITMIME status of received messages,
34096 which may help in tracking down interoperability issues with ancient MTAs
34097 that are not 8bit clean. This is added to the &"<="& line, tagged with
34098 &`M8S=`& and a value of &`0`&, &`7`& or &`8`&, corresponding to "not given",
34099 &`7BIT`& and &`8BITMIME`& respectively.
34101 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb" "log when skipping"
34102 &%acl_warn_skipped%&: When an ACL &%warn%& statement is skipped because one of
34103 its conditions cannot be evaluated, a log line to this effect is written if
34104 this log selector is set.
34106 .cindex "log" "rewriting"
34107 .cindex "rewriting" "logging"
34108 &%address_rewrite%&: This applies both to global rewrites and per-transport
34109 rewrites, but not to rewrites in filters run as an unprivileged user (because
34110 such users cannot access the log).
34112 .cindex "log" "full parentage"
34113 &%all_parents%&: Normally only the original and final addresses are logged on
34114 delivery lines; with this selector, intermediate parents are given in
34115 parentheses between them.
34117 .cindex "log" "Exim arguments"
34118 .cindex "Exim arguments, logging"
34119 &%arguments%&: This causes Exim to write the arguments with which it was called
34120 to the main log, preceded by the current working directory. This is a debugging
34121 feature, added to make it easier to find out how certain MUAs call
34122 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. The logging does not happen if Exim has given up root
34123 privilege because it was called with the &%-C%& or &%-D%& options. Arguments
34124 that are empty or that contain white space are quoted. Non-printing characters
34125 are shown as escape sequences. This facility cannot log unrecognized arguments,
34126 because the arguments are checked before the configuration file is read. The
34127 only way to log such cases is to interpose a script such as &_util/logargs.sh_&
34128 between the caller and Exim.
34130 .cindex "log" "connection rejections"
34131 &%connection_reject%&: A log entry is written whenever an incoming SMTP
34132 connection is rejected, for whatever reason.
34134 .cindex "log" "delayed delivery"
34135 .cindex "delayed delivery, logging"
34136 &%delay_delivery%&: A log entry is written whenever a delivery process is not
34137 started for an incoming message because the load is too high or too many
34138 messages were received on one connection. Logging does not occur if no delivery
34139 process is started because &%queue_only%& is set or &%-odq%& was used.
34141 .cindex "log" "delivery duration"
34142 &%deliver_time%&: For each delivery, the amount of real time it has taken to
34143 perform the actual delivery is logged as DT=<&'time'&>, for example, &`DT=1s`&.
34145 .cindex "log" "message size on delivery"
34146 .cindex "size" "of message"
34147 &%delivery_size%&: For each delivery, the size of message delivered is added to
34148 the &"=>"& line, tagged with S=.
34150 .cindex "log" "dnslist defer"
34151 .cindex "DNS list" "logging defer"
34152 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
34153 &%dnslist_defer%&: A log entry is written if an attempt to look up a host in a
34154 DNS black list suffers a temporary error.
34156 .cindex "log" "ETRN commands"
34157 .cindex "ETRN" "logging"
34158 &%etrn%&: Every valid ETRN command that is received is logged, before the ACL
34159 is run to determine whether or not it is actually accepted. An invalid ETRN
34160 command, or one received within a message transaction is not logged by this
34161 selector (see &%smtp_syntax_error%& and &%smtp_protocol_error%&).
34163 .cindex "log" "host lookup failure"
34164 &%host_lookup_failed%&: When a lookup of a host's IP addresses fails to find
34165 any addresses, or when a lookup of an IP address fails to find a host name, a
34166 log line is written. This logging does not apply to direct DNS lookups when
34167 routing email addresses, but it does apply to &"byname"& lookups.
34169 .cindex "log" "ident timeout"
34170 .cindex "RFC 1413" "logging timeout"
34171 &%ident_timeout%&: A log line is written whenever an attempt to connect to a
34172 client's ident port times out.
34174 .cindex "log" "incoming interface"
34175 .cindex "interface" "logging"
34176 &%incoming_interface%&: The interface on which a message was received is added
34177 to the &"<="& line as an IP address in square brackets, tagged by I= and
34178 followed by a colon and the port number. The local interface and port are also
34179 added to other SMTP log lines, for example &"SMTP connection from"&, and to
34182 .cindex "log" "incoming remote port"
34183 .cindex "port" "logging remote"
34184 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging incoming remote port"
34185 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
34186 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
34187 &%incoming_port%&: The remote port number from which a message was received is
34188 added to log entries and &'Received:'& header lines, following the IP address
34189 in square brackets, and separated from it by a colon. This is implemented by
34190 changing the value that is put in the &$sender_fullhost$& and
34191 &$sender_rcvhost$& variables. Recording the remote port number has become more
34192 important with the widening use of NAT (see RFC 2505).
34194 .cindex "log" "dropped connection"
34195 &%lost_incoming_connection%&: A log line is written when an incoming SMTP
34196 connection is unexpectedly dropped.
34198 .cindex "log" "outgoing remote port"
34199 .cindex "port" "logging outgoint remote"
34200 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging ougtoing remote port"
34201 &%outgoing_port%&: The remote port number is added to delivery log lines (those
34202 containing => tags) following the IP address. This option is not included in
34203 the default setting, because for most ordinary configurations, the remote port
34204 number is always 25 (the SMTP port).
34206 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
34207 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
34208 &%pid%&: The current process id is added to every log line, in square brackets,
34209 immediately after the time and date.
34211 .cindex "log" "queue run"
34212 .cindex "queue runner" "logging"
34213 &%queue_run%&: The start and end of every queue run are logged.
34215 .cindex "log" "queue time"
34216 &%queue_time%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on the
34217 local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on delivery (&`=>`&) lines, for example,
34218 &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the message, so it
34219 includes reception time as well as the delivery time for the current address.
34220 This means that it may be longer than the difference between the arrival and
34221 delivery log line times, because the arrival log line is not written until the
34222 message has been successfully received.
34224 &%queue_time_overall%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on
34225 the local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on &"Completed"& lines, for
34226 example, &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the
34227 message, so it includes reception time as well as the total delivery time.
34229 .cindex "log" "recipients"
34230 &%received_recipients%&: The recipients of a message are listed in the main log
34231 as soon as the message is received. The list appears at the end of the log line
34232 that is written when a message is received, preceded by the word &"for"&. The
34233 addresses are listed after they have been qualified, but before any rewriting
34235 Recipients that were discarded by an ACL for MAIL or RCPT do not appear
34238 .cindex "log" "sender reception"
34239 &%received_sender%&: The unrewritten original sender of a message is added to
34240 the end of the log line that records the message's arrival, after the word
34241 &"from"& (before the recipients if &%received_recipients%& is also set).
34243 .cindex "log" "header lines for rejection"
34244 &%rejected_header%&: If a message's header has been received at the time a
34245 rejection is written to the reject log, the complete header is added to the
34246 log. Header logging can be turned off individually for messages that are
34247 rejected by the &[local_scan()]& function (see section &<<SECTapiforloc>>&).
34249 .cindex "log" "retry defer"
34250 &%retry_defer%&: A log line is written if a delivery is deferred because a
34251 retry time has not yet been reached. However, this &"retry time not reached"&
34252 message is always omitted from individual message logs after the first delivery
34255 .cindex "log" "return path"
34256 &%return_path_on_delivery%&: The return path that is being transmitted with
34257 the message is included in delivery and bounce lines, using the tag P=.
34258 This is omitted if no delivery actually happens, for example, if routing fails,
34259 or if delivery is to &_/dev/null_& or to &`:blackhole:`&.
34261 .cindex "log" "sender on delivery"
34262 &%sender_on_delivery%&: The message's sender address is added to every delivery
34263 and bounce line, tagged by F= (for &"from"&).
34264 This is the original sender that was received with the message; it is not
34265 necessarily the same as the outgoing return path.
34267 .cindex "log" "sender verify failure"
34268 &%sender_verify_fail%&: If this selector is unset, the separate log line that
34269 gives details of a sender verification failure is not written. Log lines for
34270 the rejection of SMTP commands contain just &"sender verify failed"&, so some
34273 .cindex "log" "size rejection"
34274 &%size_reject%&: A log line is written whenever a message is rejected because
34277 .cindex "log" "frozen messages; skipped"
34278 .cindex "frozen messages" "logging skipping"
34279 &%skip_delivery%&: A log line is written whenever a message is skipped during a
34280 queue run because it is frozen or because another process is already delivering
34282 .cindex "&""spool file is locked""&"
34283 The message that is written is &"spool file is locked"&.
34285 .cindex "log" "smtp confirmation"
34286 .cindex "SMTP" "logging confirmation"
34287 &%smtp_confirmation%&: The response to the final &"."& in the SMTP dialogue for
34288 outgoing messages is added to delivery log lines in the form &`C=`&<&'text'&>.
34289 A number of MTAs (including Exim) return an identifying string in this
34292 .cindex "log" "SMTP connections"
34293 .cindex "SMTP" "logging connections"
34294 &%smtp_connection%&: A log line is written whenever an SMTP connection is
34295 established or closed, unless the connection is from a host that matches
34296 &%hosts_connection_nolog%&. (In contrast, &%lost_incoming_connection%& applies
34297 only when the closure is unexpected.) This applies to connections from local
34298 processes that use &%-bs%& as well as to TCP/IP connections. If a connection is
34299 dropped in the middle of a message, a log line is always written, whether or
34300 not this selector is set, but otherwise nothing is written at the start and end
34301 of connections unless this selector is enabled.
34303 For TCP/IP connections to an Exim daemon, the current number of connections is
34304 included in the log message for each new connection, but note that the count is
34305 reset if the daemon is restarted.
34306 Also, because connections are closed (and the closure is logged) in
34307 subprocesses, the count may not include connections that have been closed but
34308 whose termination the daemon has not yet noticed. Thus, while it is possible to
34309 match up the opening and closing of connections in the log, the value of the
34310 logged counts may not be entirely accurate.
34312 .cindex "log" "SMTP transaction; incomplete"
34313 .cindex "SMTP" "logging incomplete transactions"
34314 &%smtp_incomplete_transaction%&: When a mail transaction is aborted by
34315 RSET, QUIT, loss of connection, or otherwise, the incident is logged,
34316 and the message sender plus any accepted recipients are included in the log
34317 line. This can provide evidence of dictionary attacks.
34319 .cindex "log" "non-MAIL SMTP sessions"
34320 .cindex "MAIL" "logging session without"
34321 &%smtp_no_mail%&: A line is written to the main log whenever an accepted SMTP
34322 connection terminates without having issued a MAIL command. This includes both
34323 the case when the connection is dropped, and the case when QUIT is used. It
34324 does not include cases where the connection is rejected right at the start (by
34325 an ACL, or because there are too many connections, or whatever). These cases
34326 already have their own log lines.
34328 The log line that is written contains the identity of the client in the usual
34329 way, followed by D= and a time, which records the duration of the connection.
34330 If the connection was authenticated, this fact is logged exactly as it is for
34331 an incoming message, with an A= item. If the connection was encrypted, CV=,
34332 DN=, and X= items may appear as they do for an incoming message, controlled by
34333 the same logging options.
34335 Finally, if any SMTP commands were issued during the connection, a C= item
34336 is added to the line, listing the commands that were used. For example,
34340 shows that the client issued QUIT straight after EHLO. If there were fewer
34341 than 20 commands, they are all listed. If there were more than 20 commands,
34342 the last 20 are listed, preceded by &"..."&. However, with the default
34343 setting of 10 for &%smtp_accep_max_nonmail%&, the connection will in any case
34344 have been aborted before 20 non-mail commands are processed.
34346 &%smtp_mailauth%&: A third subfield with the authenticated sender,
34347 colon-separated, is appended to the A= item for a message arrival or delivery
34348 log line, if an AUTH argument to the SMTP MAIL command (see &<<SECTauthparamail>>&)
34349 was accepted or used.
34351 .cindex "log" "SMTP protocol error"
34352 .cindex "SMTP" "logging protocol error"
34353 &%smtp_protocol_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP protocol error
34354 encountered. Exim does not have perfect detection of all protocol errors
34355 because of transmission delays and the use of pipelining. If PIPELINING has
34356 been advertised to a client, an Exim server assumes that the client will use
34357 it, and therefore it does not count &"expected"& errors (for example, RCPT
34358 received after rejecting MAIL) as protocol errors.
34360 .cindex "SMTP" "logging syntax errors"
34361 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors; logging"
34362 .cindex "SMTP" "unknown command; logging"
34363 .cindex "log" "unknown SMTP command"
34364 .cindex "log" "SMTP syntax error"
34365 &%smtp_syntax_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP syntax error
34366 encountered. An unrecognized command is treated as a syntax error. For an
34367 external connection, the host identity is given; for an internal connection
34368 using &%-bs%& the sender identification (normally the calling user) is given.
34370 .cindex "log" "subject"
34371 .cindex "subject, logging"
34372 &%subject%&: The subject of the message is added to the arrival log line,
34373 preceded by &"T="& (T for &"topic"&, since S is already used for &"size"&).
34374 Any MIME &"words"& in the subject are decoded. The &%print_topbitchars%& option
34375 specifies whether characters with values greater than 127 should be logged
34376 unchanged, or whether they should be rendered as escape sequences.
34378 .cindex "log" "certificate verification"
34379 &%tls_certificate_verified%&: An extra item is added to <= and => log lines
34380 when TLS is in use. The item is &`CV=yes`& if the peer's certificate was
34381 verified, and &`CV=no`& if not.
34383 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
34384 .cindex "TLS" "logging cipher"
34385 &%tls_cipher%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
34386 connection, the cipher suite used is added to the log line, preceded by X=.
34388 .cindex "log" "TLS peer DN"
34389 .cindex "TLS" "logging peer DN"
34390 &%tls_peerdn%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
34391 connection, and a certificate is supplied by the remote host, the peer DN is
34392 added to the log line, preceded by DN=.
34394 .cindex "log" "TLS SNI"
34395 .cindex "TLS" "logging SNI"
34396 &%tls_sni%&: When a message is received over an encrypted connection, and
34397 the remote host provided the Server Name Indication extension, the SNI is
34398 added to the log line, preceded by SNI=.
34400 .cindex "log" "DNS failure in list"
34401 &%unknown_in_list%&: This setting causes a log entry to be written when the
34402 result of a list match is failure because a DNS lookup failed.
34406 .section "Message log" "SECID260"
34407 .cindex "message" "log file for"
34408 .cindex "log" "message log; description of"
34409 .cindex "&_msglog_& directory"
34410 .oindex "&%preserve_message_logs%&"
34411 In addition to the general log files, Exim writes a log file for each message
34412 that it handles. The names of these per-message logs are the message ids, and
34413 they are kept in the &_msglog_& sub-directory of the spool directory. Each
34414 message log contains copies of the log lines that apply to the message. This
34415 makes it easier to inspect the status of an individual message without having
34416 to search the main log. A message log is deleted when processing of the message
34417 is complete, unless &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, but this should be used
34418 only with great care because they can fill up your disk very quickly.
34420 On a heavily loaded system, it may be desirable to disable the use of
34421 per-message logs, in order to reduce disk I/O. This can be done by setting the
34422 &%message_logs%& option false.
34428 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34429 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34431 .chapter "Exim utilities" "CHAPutils"
34432 .scindex IIDutils "utilities"
34433 A number of utility scripts and programs are supplied with Exim and are
34434 described in this chapter. There is also the Exim Monitor, which is covered in
34435 the next chapter. The utilities described here are:
34437 .itable none 0 0 3 7* left 15* left 40* left
34438 .irow &<<SECTfinoutwha>>& &'exiwhat'& &&&
34439 "list what Exim processes are doing"
34440 .irow &<<SECTgreptheque>>& &'exiqgrep'& "grep the queue"
34441 .irow &<<SECTsumtheque>>& &'exiqsumm'& "summarize the queue"
34442 .irow &<<SECTextspeinf>>& &'exigrep'& "search the main log"
34443 .irow &<<SECTexipick>>& &'exipick'& "select messages on &&&
34445 .irow &<<SECTcyclogfil>>& &'exicyclog'& "cycle (rotate) log files"
34446 .irow &<<SECTmailstat>>& &'eximstats'& &&&
34447 "extract statistics from the log"
34448 .irow &<<SECTcheckaccess>>& &'exim_checkaccess'& &&&
34449 "check address acceptance from given IP"
34450 .irow &<<SECTdbmbuild>>& &'exim_dbmbuild'& "build a DBM file"
34451 .irow &<<SECTfinindret>>& &'exinext'& "extract retry information"
34452 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_dumpdb'& "dump a hints database"
34453 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_tidydb'& "clean up a hints database"
34454 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_fixdb'& "patch a hints database"
34455 .irow &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>& &'exim_lock'& "lock a mailbox file"
34458 Another utility that might be of use to sites with many MTAs is Tom Kistner's
34459 &'exilog'&. It provides log visualizations across multiple Exim servers. See
34460 &url(http://duncanthrax.net/exilog/) for details.
34465 .section "Finding out what Exim processes are doing (exiwhat)" "SECTfinoutwha"
34466 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
34467 .cindex "process, querying"
34469 On operating systems that can restart a system call after receiving a signal
34470 (most modern OS), an Exim process responds to the SIGUSR1 signal by writing
34471 a line describing what it is doing to the file &_exim-process.info_& in the
34472 Exim spool directory. The &'exiwhat'& script sends the signal to all Exim
34473 processes it can find, having first emptied the file. It then waits for one
34474 second to allow the Exim processes to react before displaying the results. In
34475 order to run &'exiwhat'& successfully you have to have sufficient privilege to
34476 send the signal to the Exim processes, so it is normally run as root.
34478 &*Warning*&: This is not an efficient process. It is intended for occasional
34479 use by system administrators. It is not sensible, for example, to set up a
34480 script that sends SIGUSR1 signals to Exim processes at short intervals.
34483 Unfortunately, the &'ps'& command that &'exiwhat'& uses to find Exim processes
34484 varies in different operating systems. Not only are different options used,
34485 but the format of the output is different. For this reason, there are some
34486 system configuration options that configure exactly how &'exiwhat'& works. If
34487 it doesn't seem to be working for you, check the following compile-time
34490 &`EXIWHAT_PS_CMD `& the command for running &'ps'&
34491 &`EXIWHAT_PS_ARG `& the argument for &'ps'&
34492 &`EXIWHAT_EGREP_ARG `& the argument for &'egrep'& to select from &'ps'& output
34493 &`EXIWHAT_KILL_ARG `& the argument for the &'kill'& command
34495 An example of typical output from &'exiwhat'& is
34497 164 daemon: -q1h, listening on port 25
34498 10483 running queue: waiting for 0tAycK-0002ij-00 (10492)
34499 10492 delivering 0tAycK-0002ij-00 to mail.ref.example
34500 [10.19.42.42] (editor@ref.example)
34501 10592 handling incoming call from [192.168.243.242]
34502 10628 accepting a local non-SMTP message
34504 The first number in the output line is the process number. The third line has
34505 been split here, in order to fit it on the page.
34509 .section "Selective queue listing (exiqgrep)" "SECTgreptheque"
34510 .cindex "&'exiqgrep'&"
34511 .cindex "queue" "grepping"
34512 This utility is a Perl script contributed by Matt Hubbard. It runs
34516 to obtain a queue listing with undelivered recipients only, and then greps the
34517 output to select messages that match given criteria. The following selection
34518 options are available:
34521 .vitem &*-f*&&~<&'regex'&>
34522 Match the sender address using a case-insensitive search. The field that is
34523 tested is enclosed in angle brackets, so you can test for bounce messages with
34527 .vitem &*-r*&&~<&'regex'&>
34528 Match a recipient address using a case-insensitve search. The field that is
34529 tested is not enclosed in angle brackets.
34531 .vitem &*-s*&&~<&'regex'&>
34532 Match against the size field.
34534 .vitem &*-y*&&~<&'seconds'&>
34535 Match messages that are younger than the given time.
34537 .vitem &*-o*&&~<&'seconds'&>
34538 Match messages that are older than the given time.
34541 Match only frozen messages.
34544 Match only non-frozen messages.
34547 The following options control the format of the output:
34551 Display only the count of matching messages.
34554 Long format &-- display the full message information as output by Exim. This is
34558 Display message ids only.
34561 Brief format &-- one line per message.
34564 Display messages in reverse order.
34567 There is one more option, &%-h%&, which outputs a list of options.
34571 .section "Summarizing the queue (exiqsumm)" "SECTsumtheque"
34572 .cindex "&'exiqsumm'&"
34573 .cindex "queue" "summary"
34574 The &'exiqsumm'& utility is a Perl script which reads the output of &`exim
34575 -bp`& and produces a summary of the messages on the queue. Thus, you use it by
34576 running a command such as
34578 exim -bp | exiqsumm
34580 The output consists of one line for each domain that has messages waiting for
34581 it, as in the following example:
34583 3 2322 74m 66m msn.com.example
34585 Each line lists the number of pending deliveries for a domain, their total
34586 volume, and the length of time that the oldest and the newest messages have
34587 been waiting. Note that the number of pending deliveries is greater than the
34588 number of messages when messages have more than one recipient.
34590 A summary line is output at the end. By default the output is sorted on the
34591 domain name, but &'exiqsumm'& has the options &%-a%& and &%-c%&, which cause
34592 the output to be sorted by oldest message and by count of messages,
34593 respectively. There are also three options that split the messages for each
34594 domain into two or more subcounts: &%-b%& separates bounce messages, &%-f%&
34595 separates frozen messages, and &%-s%& separates messages according to their
34598 The output of &'exim -bp'& contains the original addresses in the message, so
34599 this also applies to the output from &'exiqsumm'&. No domains from addresses
34600 generated by aliasing or forwarding are included (unless the &%one_time%&
34601 option of the &(redirect)& router has been used to convert them into &"top
34602 level"& addresses).
34607 .section "Extracting specific information from the log (exigrep)" &&&
34609 .cindex "&'exigrep'&"
34610 .cindex "log" "extracts; grepping for"
34611 The &'exigrep'& utility is a Perl script that searches one or more main log
34612 files for entries that match a given pattern. When it finds a match, it
34613 extracts all the log entries for the relevant message, not just those that
34614 match the pattern. Thus, &'exigrep'& can extract complete log entries for a
34615 given message, or all mail for a given user, or for a given host, for example.
34616 The input files can be in Exim log format or syslog format.
34617 If a matching log line is not associated with a specific message, it is
34618 included in &'exigrep'&'s output without any additional lines. The usage is:
34620 &`exigrep [-t<`&&'n'&&`>] [-I] [-l] [-v] <`&&'pattern'&&`> [<`&&'log file'&&`>] ...`&
34622 If no log file names are given on the command line, the standard input is read.
34624 The &%-t%& argument specifies a number of seconds. It adds an additional
34625 condition for message selection. Messages that are complete are shown only if
34626 they spent more than <&'n'&> seconds on the queue.
34628 By default, &'exigrep'& does case-insensitive matching. The &%-I%& option
34629 makes it case-sensitive. This may give a performance improvement when searching
34630 large log files. Without &%-I%&, the Perl pattern matches use Perl's &`/i`&
34631 option; with &%-I%& they do not. In both cases it is possible to change the
34632 case sensitivity within the pattern by using &`(?i)`& or &`(?-i)`&.
34634 The &%-l%& option means &"literal"&, that is, treat all characters in the
34635 pattern as standing for themselves. Otherwise the pattern must be a Perl
34636 regular expression.
34638 The &%-v%& option inverts the matching condition. That is, a line is selected
34639 if it does &'not'& match the pattern.
34641 If the location of a &'zcat'& command is known from the definition of
34642 ZCAT_COMMAND in &_Local/Makefile_&, &'exigrep'& automatically passes any file
34643 whose name ends in COMPRESS_SUFFIX through &'zcat'& as it searches it.
34646 .section "Selecting messages by various criteria (exipick)" "SECTexipick"
34647 .cindex "&'exipick'&"
34648 John Jetmore's &'exipick'& utility is included in the Exim distribution. It
34649 lists messages from the queue according to a variety of criteria. For details
34650 of &'exipick'&'s facilities, visit the web page at
34651 &url(http://www.exim.org/eximwiki/ToolExipickManPage) or run &'exipick'& with
34652 the &%--help%& option.
34655 .section "Cycling log files (exicyclog)" "SECTcyclogfil"
34656 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
34657 .cindex "cycling logs"
34658 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
34659 The &'exicyclog'& script can be used to cycle (rotate) &'mainlog'& and
34660 &'rejectlog'& files. This is not necessary if only syslog is being used, or if
34661 you are using log files with datestamps in their names (see section
34662 &<<SECTdatlogfil>>&). Some operating systems have their own standard mechanisms
34663 for log cycling, and these can be used instead of &'exicyclog'& if preferred.
34664 There are two command line options for &'exicyclog'&:
34666 &%-k%& <&'count'&> specifies the number of log files to keep, overriding the
34667 default that is set when Exim is built. The default default is 10.
34669 &%-l%& <&'path'&> specifies the log file path, in the same format as Exim's
34670 &%log_file_path%& option (for example, &`/var/log/exim_%slog`&), again
34671 overriding the script's default, which is to find the setting from Exim's
34675 Each time &'exicyclog'& is run the file names get &"shuffled down"& by one. If
34676 the main log file name is &_mainlog_& (the default) then when &'exicyclog'& is
34677 run &_mainlog_& becomes &_mainlog.01_&, the previous &_mainlog.01_& becomes
34678 &_mainlog.02_& and so on, up to the limit that is set in the script or by the
34679 &%-k%& option. Log files whose numbers exceed the limit are discarded. Reject
34680 logs are handled similarly.
34682 If the limit is greater than 99, the script uses 3-digit numbers such as
34683 &_mainlog.001_&, &_mainlog.002_&, etc. If you change from a number less than 99
34684 to one that is greater, or &'vice versa'&, you will have to fix the names of
34685 any existing log files.
34687 If no &_mainlog_& file exists, the script does nothing. Files that &"drop off"&
34688 the end are deleted. All files with numbers greater than 01 are compressed,
34689 using a compression command which is configured by the COMPRESS_COMMAND
34690 setting in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is usual to run &'exicyclog'& daily from a
34691 root &%crontab%& entry of the form
34693 1 0 * * * su exim -c /usr/exim/bin/exicyclog
34695 assuming you have used the name &"exim"& for the Exim user. You can run
34696 &'exicyclog'& as root if you wish, but there is no need.
34700 .section "Mail statistics (eximstats)" "SECTmailstat"
34701 .cindex "statistics"
34702 .cindex "&'eximstats'&"
34703 A Perl script called &'eximstats'& is provided for extracting statistical
34704 information from log files. The output is either plain text, or HTML.
34705 Exim log files are also supported by the &'Lire'& system produced by the
34706 LogReport Foundation &url(http://www.logreport.org).
34708 The &'eximstats'& script has been hacked about quite a bit over time. The
34709 latest version is the result of some extensive revision by Steve Campbell. A
34710 lot of information is given by default, but there are options for suppressing
34711 various parts of it. Following any options, the arguments to the script are a
34712 list of files, which should be main log files. For example:
34714 eximstats -nr /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog.01
34716 By default, &'eximstats'& extracts information about the number and volume of
34717 messages received from or delivered to various hosts. The information is sorted
34718 both by message count and by volume, and the top fifty hosts in each category
34719 are listed on the standard output. Similar information, based on email
34720 addresses or domains instead of hosts can be requested by means of various
34721 options. For messages delivered and received locally, similar statistics are
34722 also produced per user.
34724 The output also includes total counts and statistics about delivery errors, and
34725 histograms showing the number of messages received and deliveries made in each
34726 hour of the day. A delivery with more than one address in its envelope (for
34727 example, an SMTP transaction with more than one RCPT command) is counted
34728 as a single delivery by &'eximstats'&.
34730 Though normally more deliveries than receipts are reported (as messages may
34731 have multiple recipients), it is possible for &'eximstats'& to report more
34732 messages received than delivered, even though the queue is empty at the start
34733 and end of the period in question. If an incoming message contains no valid
34734 recipients, no deliveries are recorded for it. A bounce message is handled as
34735 an entirely separate message.
34737 &'eximstats'& always outputs a grand total summary giving the volume and number
34738 of messages received and deliveries made, and the number of hosts involved in
34739 each case. It also outputs the number of messages that were delayed (that is,
34740 not completely delivered at the first attempt), and the number that had at
34741 least one address that failed.
34743 The remainder of the output is in sections that can be independently disabled
34744 or modified by various options. It consists of a summary of deliveries by
34745 transport, histograms of messages received and delivered per time interval
34746 (default per hour), information about the time messages spent on the queue,
34747 a list of relayed messages, lists of the top fifty sending hosts, local
34748 senders, destination hosts, and destination local users by count and by volume,
34749 and a list of delivery errors that occurred.
34751 The relay information lists messages that were actually relayed, that is, they
34752 came from a remote host and were directly delivered to some other remote host,
34753 without being processed (for example, for aliasing or forwarding) locally.
34755 There are quite a few options for &'eximstats'& to control exactly what it
34756 outputs. These are documented in the Perl script itself, and can be extracted
34757 by running the command &(perldoc)& on the script. For example:
34759 perldoc /usr/exim/bin/eximstats
34762 .section "Checking access policy (exim_checkaccess)" "SECTcheckaccess"
34763 .cindex "&'exim_checkaccess'&"
34764 .cindex "policy control" "checking access"
34765 .cindex "checking access"
34766 The &%-bh%& command line argument allows you to run a fake SMTP session with
34767 debugging output, in order to check what Exim is doing when it is applying
34768 policy controls to incoming SMTP mail. However, not everybody is sufficiently
34769 familiar with the SMTP protocol to be able to make full use of &%-bh%&, and
34770 sometimes you just want to answer the question &"Does this address have
34771 access?"& without bothering with any further details.
34773 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%&. It takes
34774 two arguments, an IP address and an email address:
34776 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example
34778 The utility runs a call to Exim with the &%-bh%& option, to test whether the
34779 given email address would be accepted in a RCPT command in a TCP/IP
34780 connection from the host with the given IP address. The output of the utility
34781 is either the word &"accepted"&, or the SMTP error response, for example:
34784 550 Relay not permitted
34786 When running this test, the utility uses &`<>`& as the envelope sender address
34787 for the MAIL command, but you can change this by providing additional
34788 options. These are passed directly to the Exim command. For example, to specify
34789 that the test is to be run with the sender address &'himself@there.example'&
34792 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example \
34793 -f himself@there.example
34795 Note that these additional Exim command line items must be given after the two
34796 mandatory arguments.
34798 Because the &%exim_checkaccess%& uses &%-bh%&, it does not perform callouts
34799 while running its checks. You can run checks that include callouts by using
34800 &%-bhc%&, but this is not yet available in a &"packaged"& form.
34804 .section "Making DBM files (exim_dbmbuild)" "SECTdbmbuild"
34805 .cindex "DBM" "building dbm files"
34806 .cindex "building DBM files"
34807 .cindex "&'exim_dbmbuild'&"
34808 .cindex "lower casing"
34809 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
34810 The &'exim_dbmbuild'& program reads an input file containing keys and data in
34811 the format used by the &(lsearch)& lookup (see section
34812 &<<SECTsinglekeylookups>>&). It writes a DBM file using the lower-cased alias
34813 names as keys and the remainder of the information as data. The lower-casing
34814 can be prevented by calling the program with the &%-nolc%& option.
34816 A terminating zero is included as part of the key string. This is expected by
34817 the &(dbm)& lookup type. However, if the option &%-nozero%& is given,
34818 &'exim_dbmbuild'& creates files without terminating zeroes in either the key
34819 strings or the data strings. The &(dbmnz)& lookup type can be used with such
34822 The program requires two arguments: the name of the input file (which can be a
34823 single hyphen to indicate the standard input), and the name of the output file.
34824 It creates the output under a temporary name, and then renames it if all went
34828 If the native DB interface is in use (USE_DB is set in a compile-time
34829 configuration file &-- this is common in free versions of Unix) the two file
34830 names must be different, because in this mode the Berkeley DB functions create
34831 a single output file using exactly the name given. For example,
34833 exim_dbmbuild /etc/aliases /etc/aliases.db
34835 reads the system alias file and creates a DBM version of it in
34836 &_/etc/aliases.db_&.
34838 In systems that use the &'ndbm'& routines (mostly proprietary versions of
34839 Unix), two files are used, with the suffixes &_.dir_& and &_.pag_&. In this
34840 environment, the suffixes are added to the second argument of
34841 &'exim_dbmbuild'&, so it can be the same as the first. This is also the case
34842 when the Berkeley functions are used in compatibility mode (though this is not
34843 recommended), because in that case it adds a &_.db_& suffix to the file name.
34845 If a duplicate key is encountered, the program outputs a warning, and when it
34846 finishes, its return code is 1 rather than zero, unless the &%-noduperr%&
34847 option is used. By default, only the first of a set of duplicates is used &--
34848 this makes it compatible with &(lsearch)& lookups. There is an option
34849 &%-lastdup%& which causes it to use the data for the last duplicate instead.
34850 There is also an option &%-nowarn%&, which stops it listing duplicate keys to
34851 &%stderr%&. For other errors, where it doesn't actually make a new file, the
34857 .section "Finding individual retry times (exinext)" "SECTfinindret"
34858 .cindex "retry" "times"
34859 .cindex "&'exinext'&"
34860 A utility called &'exinext'& (mostly a Perl script) provides the ability to
34861 fish specific information out of the retry database. Given a mail domain (or a
34862 complete address), it looks up the hosts for that domain, and outputs any retry
34863 information for the hosts or for the domain. At present, the retry information
34864 is obtained by running &'exim_dumpdb'& (see below) and post-processing the
34865 output. For example:
34867 $ exinext piglet@milne.fict.example
34868 kanga.milne.example:192.168.8.1 error 146: Connection refused
34869 first failed: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
34870 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
34871 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 15:02:34
34872 roo.milne.example:192.168.8.3 error 146: Connection refused
34873 first failed: 20-Jan-1996 13:12:08
34874 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 11:42:03
34875 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 19:42:03
34876 past final cutoff time
34878 You can also give &'exinext'& a local part, without a domain, and it
34879 will give any retry information for that local part in your default domain.
34880 A message id can be used to obtain retry information pertaining to a specific
34881 message. This exists only when an attempt to deliver a message to a remote host
34882 suffers a message-specific error (see section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>&).
34883 &'exinext'& is not particularly efficient, but then it is not expected to be
34886 The &'exinext'& utility calls Exim to find out information such as the location
34887 of the spool directory. The utility has &%-C%& and &%-D%& options, which are
34888 passed on to the &'exim'& commands. The first specifies an alternate Exim
34889 configuration file, and the second sets macros for use within the configuration
34890 file. These features are mainly to help in testing, but might also be useful in
34891 environments where more than one configuration file is in use.
34895 .section "Hints database maintenance" "SECThindatmai"
34896 .cindex "hints database" "maintenance"
34897 .cindex "maintaining Exim's hints database"
34898 Three utility programs are provided for maintaining the DBM files that Exim
34899 uses to contain its delivery hint information. Each program requires two
34900 arguments. The first specifies the name of Exim's spool directory, and the
34901 second is the name of the database it is to operate on. These are as follows:
34904 &'retry'&: the database of retry information
34906 &'wait-'&<&'transport name'&>: databases of information about messages waiting
34909 &'callout'&: the callout cache
34911 &'ratelimit'&: the data for implementing the ratelimit ACL condition
34913 &'misc'&: other hints data
34916 The &'misc'& database is used for
34919 Serializing ETRN runs (when &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set)
34921 Serializing delivery to a specific host (when &%serialize_hosts%& is set in an
34922 &(smtp)& transport)
34927 .section "exim_dumpdb" "SECID261"
34928 .cindex "&'exim_dumpdb'&"
34929 The entire contents of a database are written to the standard output by the
34930 &'exim_dumpdb'& program, which has no options or arguments other than the
34931 spool and database names. For example, to dump the retry database:
34933 exim_dumpdb /var/spool/exim retry
34935 Two lines of output are produced for each entry:
34937 T:mail.ref.example:192.168.242.242 146 77 Connection refused
34938 31-Oct-1995 12:00:12 02-Nov-1995 12:21:39 02-Nov-1995 20:21:39 *
34940 The first item on the first line is the key of the record. It starts with one
34941 of the letters R, or T, depending on whether it refers to a routing or
34942 transport retry. For a local delivery, the next part is the local address; for
34943 a remote delivery it is the name of the remote host, followed by its failing IP
34944 address (unless &%retry_include_ip_address%& is set false on the &(smtp)&
34945 transport). If the remote port is not the standard one (port 25), it is added
34946 to the IP address. Then there follows an error code, an additional error code,
34947 and a textual description of the error.
34949 The three times on the second line are the time of first failure, the time of
34950 the last delivery attempt, and the computed time for the next attempt. The line
34951 ends with an asterisk if the cutoff time for the last retry rule has been
34954 Each output line from &'exim_dumpdb'& for the &'wait-xxx'& databases
34955 consists of a host name followed by a list of ids for messages that are or were
34956 waiting to be delivered to that host. If there are a very large number for any
34957 one host, continuation records, with a sequence number added to the host name,
34958 may be seen. The data in these records is often out of date, because a message
34959 may be routed to several alternative hosts, and Exim makes no effort to keep
34964 .section "exim_tidydb" "SECID262"
34965 .cindex "&'exim_tidydb'&"
34966 The &'exim_tidydb'& utility program is used to tidy up the contents of a hints
34967 database. If run with no options, it removes all records that are more than 30
34968 days old. The age is calculated from the date and time that the record was last
34969 updated. Note that, in the case of the retry database, it is &'not'& the time
34970 since the first delivery failure. Information about a host that has been down
34971 for more than 30 days will remain in the database, provided that the record is
34972 updated sufficiently often.
34974 The cutoff date can be altered by means of the &%-t%& option, which must be
34975 followed by a time. For example, to remove all records older than a week from
34976 the retry database:
34978 exim_tidydb -t 7d /var/spool/exim retry
34980 Both the &'wait-xxx'& and &'retry'& databases contain items that involve
34981 message ids. In the former these appear as data in records keyed by host &--
34982 they were messages that were waiting for that host &-- and in the latter they
34983 are the keys for retry information for messages that have suffered certain
34984 types of error. When &'exim_tidydb'& is run, a check is made to ensure that
34985 message ids in database records are those of messages that are still on the
34986 queue. Message ids for messages that no longer exist are removed from
34987 &'wait-xxx'& records, and if this leaves any records empty, they are deleted.
34988 For the &'retry'& database, records whose keys are non-existent message ids are
34989 removed. The &'exim_tidydb'& utility outputs comments on the standard output
34990 whenever it removes information from the database.
34992 Certain records are automatically removed by Exim when they are no longer
34993 needed, but others are not. For example, if all the MX hosts for a domain are
34994 down, a retry record is created for each one. If the primary MX host comes back
34995 first, its record is removed when Exim successfully delivers to it, but the
34996 records for the others remain because Exim has not tried to use those hosts.
34998 It is important, therefore, to run &'exim_tidydb'& periodically on all the
34999 hints databases. You should do this at a quiet time of day, because it requires
35000 a database to be locked (and therefore inaccessible to Exim) while it does its
35001 work. Removing records from a DBM file does not normally make the file smaller,
35002 but all the common DBM libraries are able to re-use the space that is released.
35003 After an initial phase of increasing in size, the databases normally reach a
35004 point at which they no longer get any bigger, as long as they are regularly
35007 &*Warning*&: If you never run &'exim_tidydb'&, the space used by the hints
35008 databases is likely to keep on increasing.
35013 .section "exim_fixdb" "SECID263"
35014 .cindex "&'exim_fixdb'&"
35015 The &'exim_fixdb'& program is a utility for interactively modifying databases.
35016 Its main use is for testing Exim, but it might also be occasionally useful for
35017 getting round problems in a live system. It has no options, and its interface
35018 is somewhat crude. On entry, it prompts for input with a right angle-bracket. A
35019 key of a database record can then be entered, and the data for that record is
35022 If &"d"& is typed at the next prompt, the entire record is deleted. For all
35023 except the &'retry'& database, that is the only operation that can be carried
35024 out. For the &'retry'& database, each field is output preceded by a number, and
35025 data for individual fields can be changed by typing the field number followed
35026 by new data, for example:
35030 resets the time of the next delivery attempt. Time values are given as a
35031 sequence of digit pairs for year, month, day, hour, and minute. Colons can be
35032 used as optional separators.
35037 .section "Mailbox maintenance (exim_lock)" "SECTmailboxmaint"
35038 .cindex "mailbox" "maintenance"
35039 .cindex "&'exim_lock'&"
35040 .cindex "locking mailboxes"
35041 The &'exim_lock'& utility locks a mailbox file using the same algorithm as
35042 Exim. For a discussion of locking issues, see section &<<SECTopappend>>&.
35043 &'Exim_lock'& can be used to prevent any modification of a mailbox by Exim or
35044 a user agent while investigating a problem. The utility requires the name of
35045 the file as its first argument. If the locking is successful, the second
35046 argument is run as a command (using C's &[system()]& function); if there is no
35047 second argument, the value of the SHELL environment variable is used; if this
35048 is unset or empty, &_/bin/sh_& is run. When the command finishes, the mailbox
35049 is unlocked and the utility ends. The following options are available:
35053 Use &[fcntl()]& locking on the open mailbox.
35056 Use &[flock()]& locking on the open mailbox, provided the operating system
35059 .vitem &%-interval%&
35060 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets the
35061 interval to sleep between retries (default 3).
35063 .vitem &%-lockfile%&
35064 Create a lock file before opening the mailbox.
35067 Lock the mailbox using MBX rules.
35070 Suppress verification output.
35072 .vitem &%-retries%&
35073 This must be followed by a number; it sets the number of times to try to get
35074 the lock (default 10).
35076 .vitem &%-restore_time%&
35077 This option causes &%exim_lock%& to restore the modified and read times to the
35078 locked file before exiting. This allows you to access a locked mailbox (for
35079 example, to take a backup copy) without disturbing the times that the user
35082 .vitem &%-timeout%&
35083 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets a
35084 timeout to be used with a blocking &[fcntl()]& lock. If it is not set (the
35085 default), a non-blocking call is used.
35088 Generate verbose output.
35091 If none of &%-fcntl%&, &%-flock%&, &%-lockfile%& or &%-mbx%& are given, the
35092 default is to create a lock file and also to use &[fcntl()]& locking on the
35093 mailbox, which is the same as Exim's default. The use of &%-flock%& or
35094 &%-fcntl%& requires that the file be writeable; the use of &%-lockfile%&
35095 requires that the directory containing the file be writeable. Locking by lock
35096 file does not last for ever; Exim assumes that a lock file is expired if it is
35097 more than 30 minutes old.
35099 The &%-mbx%& option can be used with either or both of &%-fcntl%& or
35100 &%-flock%&. It assumes &%-fcntl%& by default. MBX locking causes a shared lock
35101 to be taken out on the open mailbox, and an exclusive lock on the file
35102 &_/tmp/.n.m_& where &'n'& and &'m'& are the device number and inode
35103 number of the mailbox file. When the locking is released, if an exclusive lock
35104 can be obtained for the mailbox, the file in &_/tmp_& is deleted.
35106 The default output contains verification of the locking that takes place. The
35107 &%-v%& option causes some additional information to be given. The &%-q%& option
35108 suppresses all output except error messages.
35112 exim_lock /var/spool/mail/spqr
35114 runs an interactive shell while the file is locked, whereas
35116 &`exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr <<End`&
35117 <&'some commands'&>
35120 runs a specific non-interactive sequence of commands while the file is locked,
35121 suppressing all verification output. A single command can be run by a command
35124 exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr \
35125 "cp /var/spool/mail/spqr /some/where"
35127 Note that if a command is supplied, it must be entirely contained within the
35128 second argument &-- hence the quotes.
35132 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35133 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35135 .chapter "The Exim monitor" "CHAPeximon"
35136 .scindex IIDeximon "Exim monitor" "description"
35137 .cindex "X-windows"
35138 .cindex "&'eximon'&"
35139 .cindex "Local/eximon.conf"
35140 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
35141 The Exim monitor is an application which displays in an X window information
35142 about the state of Exim's queue and what Exim is doing. An admin user can
35143 perform certain operations on messages from this GUI interface; however all
35144 such facilities are also available from the command line, and indeed, the
35145 monitor itself makes use of the command line to perform any actions requested.
35149 .section "Running the monitor" "SECID264"
35150 The monitor is started by running the script called &'eximon'&. This is a shell
35151 script that sets up a number of environment variables, and then runs the
35152 binary called &_eximon.bin_&. The default appearance of the monitor window can
35153 be changed by editing the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file created by editing
35154 &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&. Comments in that file describe what the various
35155 parameters are for.
35157 The parameters that get built into the &'eximon'& script can be overridden for
35158 a particular invocation by setting up environment variables of the same names,
35159 preceded by &`EXIMON_`&. For example, a shell command such as
35161 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH=400 eximon
35163 (in a Bourne-compatible shell) runs &'eximon'& with an overriding setting of
35164 the LOG_DEPTH parameter. If EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set in the environment, it
35165 overrides the Exim log file configuration. This makes it possible to have
35166 &'eximon'& tailing log data that is written to syslog, provided that MAIL.INFO
35167 syslog messages are routed to a file on the local host.
35169 X resources can be used to change the appearance of the window in the normal
35170 way. For example, a resource setting of the form
35172 Eximon*background: gray94
35174 changes the colour of the background to light grey rather than white. The
35175 stripcharts are drawn with both the data lines and the reference lines in
35176 black. This means that the reference lines are not visible when on top of the
35177 data. However, their colour can be changed by setting a resource called
35178 &"highlight"& (an odd name, but that's what the Athena stripchart widget uses).
35179 For example, if your X server is running Unix, you could set up lighter
35180 reference lines in the stripcharts by obeying
35183 Eximon*highlight: gray
35186 .cindex "admin user"
35187 In order to see the contents of messages on the queue, and to operate on them,
35188 &'eximon'& must either be run as root or by an admin user.
35190 The command-line parameters of &'eximon'& are passed to &_eximon.bin_& and may
35191 contain X11 resource parameters interpreted by the X11 library. In addition,
35192 if the first parameter starts with the string "gdb" then it is removed and the
35193 binary is invoked under gdb (the parameter is used as the gdb command-name, so
35194 versioned variants of gdb can be invoked).
35196 The monitor's window is divided into three parts. The first contains one or
35197 more stripcharts and two action buttons, the second contains a &"tail"& of the
35198 main log file, and the third is a display of the queue of messages awaiting
35199 delivery, with two more action buttons. The following sections describe these
35200 different parts of the display.
35205 .section "The stripcharts" "SECID265"
35206 .cindex "stripchart"
35207 The first stripchart is always a count of messages on the queue. Its name can
35208 be configured by setting QUEUE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
35209 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file. The remaining stripcharts are defined in the
35210 configuration script by regular expression matches on log file entries, making
35211 it possible to display, for example, counts of messages delivered to certain
35212 hosts or using certain transports. The supplied defaults display counts of
35213 received and delivered messages, and of local and SMTP deliveries. The default
35214 period between stripchart updates is one minute; this can be adjusted by a
35215 parameter in the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
35217 The stripchart displays rescale themselves automatically as the value they are
35218 displaying changes. There are always 10 horizontal lines in each chart; the
35219 title string indicates the value of each division when it is greater than one.
35220 For example, &"x2"& means that each division represents a value of 2.
35222 It is also possible to have a stripchart which shows the percentage fullness of
35223 a particular disk partition, which is useful when local deliveries are confined
35224 to a single partition.
35226 .cindex "&%statvfs%& function"
35227 This relies on the availability of the &[statvfs()]& function or equivalent in
35228 the operating system. Most, but not all versions of Unix that support Exim have
35229 this. For this particular stripchart, the top of the chart always represents
35230 100%, and the scale is given as &"x10%"&. This chart is configured by setting
35231 SIZE_STRIPCHART and (optionally) SIZE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
35232 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
35237 .section "Main action buttons" "SECID266"
35238 .cindex "size" "of monitor window"
35239 .cindex "Exim monitor" "window size"
35240 .cindex "window size"
35241 Below the stripcharts there is an action button for quitting the monitor. Next
35242 to this is another button marked &"Size"&. They are placed here so that
35243 shrinking the window to its default minimum size leaves just the queue count
35244 stripchart and these two buttons visible. Pressing the &"Size"& button causes
35245 the window to expand to its maximum size, unless it is already at the maximum,
35246 in which case it is reduced to its minimum.
35248 When expanding to the maximum, if the window cannot be fully seen where it
35249 currently is, it is moved back to where it was the last time it was at full
35250 size. When it is expanding from its minimum size, the old position is
35251 remembered, and next time it is reduced to the minimum it is moved back there.
35253 The idea is that you can keep a reduced window just showing one or two
35254 stripcharts at a convenient place on your screen, easily expand it to show
35255 the full window when required, and just as easily put it back to what it was.
35256 The idea is copied from what the &'twm'& window manager does for its
35257 &'f.fullzoom'& action. The minimum size of the window can be changed by setting
35258 the MIN_HEIGHT and MIN_WIDTH values in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
35260 Normally, the monitor starts up with the window at its full size, but it can be
35261 built so that it starts up with the window at its smallest size, by setting
35262 START_SMALL=yes in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
35266 .section "The log display" "SECID267"
35267 .cindex "log" "tail of; in monitor"
35268 The second section of the window is an area in which a display of the tail of
35269 the main log is maintained.
35270 To save space on the screen, the timestamp on each log line is shortened by
35271 removing the date and, if &%log_timezone%& is set, the timezone.
35272 The log tail is not available when the only destination for logging data is
35273 syslog, unless the syslog lines are routed to a local file whose name is passed
35274 to &'eximon'& via the EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH environment variable.
35276 The log sub-window has a scroll bar at its lefthand side which can be used to
35277 move back to look at earlier text, and the up and down arrow keys also have a
35278 scrolling effect. The amount of log that is kept depends on the setting of
35279 LOG_BUFFER in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, which specifies the amount of memory
35280 to use. When this is full, the earlier 50% of data is discarded &-- this is
35281 much more efficient than throwing it away line by line. The sub-window also has
35282 a horizontal scroll bar for accessing the ends of long log lines. This is the
35283 only means of horizontal scrolling; the right and left arrow keys are not
35284 available. Text can be cut from this part of the window using the mouse in the
35285 normal way. The size of this subwindow is controlled by parameters in the
35286 configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
35288 Searches of the text in the log window can be carried out by means of the ^R
35289 and ^S keystrokes, which default to a reverse and a forward search,
35290 respectively. The search covers only the text that is displayed in the window.
35291 It cannot go further back up the log.
35293 The point from which the search starts is indicated by a caret marker. This is
35294 normally at the end of the text in the window, but can be positioned explicitly
35295 by pointing and clicking with the left mouse button, and is moved automatically
35296 by a successful search. If new text arrives in the window when it is scrolled
35297 back, the caret remains where it is, but if the window is not scrolled back,
35298 the caret is moved to the end of the new text.
35300 Pressing ^R or ^S pops up a window into which the search text can be typed.
35301 There are buttons for selecting forward or reverse searching, for carrying out
35302 the search, and for cancelling. If the &"Search"& button is pressed, the search
35303 happens and the window remains so that further searches can be done. If the
35304 &"Return"& key is pressed, a single search is done and the window is closed. If
35305 ^C is typed the search is cancelled.
35307 The searching facility is implemented using the facilities of the Athena text
35308 widget. By default this pops up a window containing both &"search"& and
35309 &"replace"& options. In order to suppress the unwanted &"replace"& portion for
35310 eximon, a modified version of the &%TextPop%& widget is distributed with Exim.
35311 However, the linkers in BSDI and HP-UX seem unable to handle an externally
35312 provided version of &%TextPop%& when the remaining parts of the text widget
35313 come from the standard libraries. The compile-time option EXIMON_TEXTPOP can be
35314 unset to cut out the modified &%TextPop%&, making it possible to build Eximon
35315 on these systems, at the expense of having unwanted items in the search popup
35320 .section "The queue display" "SECID268"
35321 .cindex "queue" "display in monitor"
35322 The bottom section of the monitor window contains a list of all messages that
35323 are on the queue, which includes those currently being received or delivered,
35324 as well as those awaiting delivery. The size of this subwindow is controlled by
35325 parameters in the configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&, and the frequency
35326 at which it is updated is controlled by another parameter in the same file &--
35327 the default is 5 minutes, since queue scans can be quite expensive. However,
35328 there is an &"Update"& action button just above the display which can be used
35329 to force an update of the queue display at any time.
35331 When a host is down for some time, a lot of pending mail can build up for it,
35332 and this can make it hard to deal with other messages on the queue. To help
35333 with this situation there is a button next to &"Update"& called &"Hide"&. If
35334 pressed, a dialogue box called &"Hide addresses ending with"& is put up. If you
35335 type anything in here and press &"Return"&, the text is added to a chain of
35336 such texts, and if every undelivered address in a message matches at least one
35337 of the texts, the message is not displayed.
35339 If there is an address that does not match any of the texts, all the addresses
35340 are displayed as normal. The matching happens on the ends of addresses so, for
35341 example, &'cam.ac.uk'& specifies all addresses in Cambridge, while
35342 &'xxx@foo.com.example'& specifies just one specific address. When any hiding
35343 has been set up, a button called &"Unhide"& is displayed. If pressed, it
35344 cancels all hiding. Also, to ensure that hidden messages do not get forgotten,
35345 a hide request is automatically cancelled after one hour.
35347 While the dialogue box is displayed, you can't press any buttons or do anything
35348 else to the monitor window. For this reason, if you want to cut text from the
35349 queue display to use in the dialogue box, you have to do the cutting before
35350 pressing the &"Hide"& button.
35352 The queue display contains, for each unhidden queued message, the length of
35353 time it has been on the queue, the size of the message, the message id, the
35354 message sender, and the first undelivered recipient, all on one line. If it is
35355 a bounce message, the sender is shown as &"<>"&. If there is more than one
35356 recipient to which the message has not yet been delivered, subsequent ones are
35357 listed on additional lines, up to a maximum configured number, following which
35358 an ellipsis is displayed. Recipients that have already received the message are
35361 .cindex "frozen messages" "display"
35362 If a message is frozen, an asterisk is displayed at the left-hand side.
35364 The queue display has a vertical scroll bar, and can also be scrolled by means
35365 of the arrow keys. Text can be cut from it using the mouse in the normal way.
35366 The text searching facilities, as described above for the log window, are also
35367 available, but the caret is always moved to the end of the text when the queue
35368 display is updated.
35372 .section "The queue menu" "SECID269"
35373 .cindex "queue" "menu in monitor"
35374 If the &%shift%& key is held down and the left button is clicked when the mouse
35375 pointer is over the text for any message, an action menu pops up, and the first
35376 line of the queue display for the message is highlighted. This does not affect
35379 If you want to use some other event for popping up the menu, you can set the
35380 MENU_EVENT parameter in &_Local/eximon.conf_& to change the default, or
35381 set EXIMON_MENU_EVENT in the environment before starting the monitor. The
35382 value set in this parameter is a standard X event description. For example, to
35383 run eximon using &%ctrl%& rather than &%shift%& you could use
35385 EXIMON_MENU_EVENT='Ctrl<Btn1Down>' eximon
35387 The title of the menu is the message id, and it contains entries which act as
35391 &'message log'&: The contents of the message log for the message are displayed
35392 in a new text window.
35394 &'headers'&: Information from the spool file that contains the envelope
35395 information and headers is displayed in a new text window. See chapter
35396 &<<CHAPspool>>& for a description of the format of spool files.
35398 &'body'&: The contents of the spool file containing the body of the message are
35399 displayed in a new text window. There is a default limit of 20,000 bytes to the
35400 amount of data displayed. This can be changed by setting the BODY_MAX
35401 option at compile time, or the EXIMON_BODY_MAX option at run time.
35403 &'deliver message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-M%& option to request
35404 delivery of the message. This causes an automatic thaw if the message is
35405 frozen. The &%-v%& option is also set, and the output from Exim is displayed in
35406 a new text window. The delivery is run in a separate process, to avoid holding
35407 up the monitor while the delivery proceeds.
35409 &'freeze message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mf%& option to request
35410 that the message be frozen.
35412 .cindex "thawing messages"
35413 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
35414 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
35415 &'thaw message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mt%& option to request
35416 that the message be thawed.
35418 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
35419 &'give up on msg'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mg%& option to request
35420 that Exim gives up trying to deliver the message. A bounce message is generated
35421 for any remaining undelivered addresses.
35423 &'remove message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mrm%& option to request
35424 that the message be deleted from the system without generating a bounce
35427 &'add recipient'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address can
35428 be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
35429 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
35430 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
35431 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mar%& option to request that an
35432 additional recipient be added to the message, unless the entry box is empty, in
35433 which case no action is taken.
35435 &'mark delivered'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address
35436 can be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
35437 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
35438 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
35439 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mmd%& option to mark the given
35440 recipient address as already delivered, unless the entry box is empty, in which
35441 case no action is taken.
35443 &'mark all delivered'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mmad%& option to
35444 mark all recipient addresses as already delivered.
35446 &'edit sender'&: A dialog box is displayed initialized with the current
35447 sender's address. Pressing RETURN causes a call to Exim to be made using the
35448 &%-Mes%& option to replace the sender address, unless the entry box is empty,
35449 in which case no action is taken. If you want to set an empty sender (as in
35450 bounce messages), you must specify it as &"<>"&. Otherwise, if the address is
35451 not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&,
35452 the address is qualified with that domain.
35455 When a delivery is forced, a window showing the &%-v%& output is displayed. In
35456 other cases when a call to Exim is made, if there is any output from Exim (in
35457 particular, if the command fails) a window containing the command and the
35458 output is displayed. Otherwise, the results of the action are normally apparent
35459 from the log and queue displays. However, if you set ACTION_OUTPUT=yes in
35460 &_Local/eximon.conf_&, a window showing the Exim command is always opened, even
35461 if no output is generated.
35463 The queue display is automatically updated for actions such as freezing and
35464 thawing, unless ACTION_QUEUE_UPDATE=no has been set in
35465 &_Local/eximon.conf_&. In this case the &"Update"& button has to be used to
35466 force an update of the display after one of these actions.
35468 In any text window that is displayed as result of a menu action, the normal
35469 cut-and-paste facility is available, and searching can be carried out using ^R
35470 and ^S, as described above for the log tail window.
35477 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35478 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35480 .chapter "Security considerations" "CHAPsecurity"
35481 .scindex IIDsecurcon "security" "discussion of"
35482 This chapter discusses a number of issues concerned with security, some of
35483 which are also covered in other parts of this manual.
35485 For reasons that this author does not understand, some people have promoted
35486 Exim as a &"particularly secure"& mailer. Perhaps it is because of the
35487 existence of this chapter in the documentation. However, the intent of the
35488 chapter is simply to describe the way Exim works in relation to certain
35489 security concerns, not to make any specific claims about the effectiveness of
35490 its security as compared with other MTAs.
35492 What follows is a description of the way Exim is supposed to be. Best efforts
35493 have been made to try to ensure that the code agrees with the theory, but an
35494 absence of bugs can never be guaranteed. Any that are reported will get fixed
35495 as soon as possible.
35498 .section "Building a more &""hardened""& Exim" "SECID286"
35499 .cindex "security" "build-time features"
35500 There are a number of build-time options that can be set in &_Local/Makefile_&
35501 to create Exim binaries that are &"harder"& to attack, in particular by a rogue
35502 Exim administrator who does not have the root password, or by someone who has
35503 penetrated the Exim (but not the root) account. These options are as follows:
35506 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be set to a string that is required to match the
35507 start of any file names used with the &%-C%& option. When it is set, these file
35508 names are also not allowed to contain the sequence &"/../"&. (However, if the
35509 value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of CONFIGURE_FILE in
35510 &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as usual.) There is no
35511 default setting for &%ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX%&.
35513 If the permitted configuration files are confined to a directory to
35514 which only root has access, this guards against someone who has broken
35515 into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
35516 configuration file, and using it to break into other accounts.
35519 If a non-trusted configuration file (i.e. not the default configuration file
35520 or one which is trusted by virtue of being listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST
35521 file) is specified with &%-C%&, or if macros are given with &%-D%& (but see
35522 the next item), then root privilege is retained only if the caller of Exim is
35523 root. This locks out the possibility of testing a configuration using &%-C%&
35524 right through message reception and delivery, even if the caller is root. The
35525 reception works, but by that time, Exim is running as the Exim user, so when
35526 it re-execs to regain privilege for the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes
35527 privilege to be lost. However, root can test reception and delivery using two
35531 The WHITELIST_D_MACROS build option declares some macros to be safe to override
35532 with &%-D%& if the real uid is one of root, the Exim run-time user or the
35533 CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined. The potential impact of this option is limited by
35534 requiring the run-time value supplied to &%-D%& to match a regex that errs on
35535 the restrictive side. Requiring build-time selection of safe macros is onerous
35536 but this option is intended solely as a transition mechanism to permit
35537 previously-working configurations to continue to work after release 4.73.
35539 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined, the use of the &%-D%& command line option
35542 FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a colon-separated list of users that are
35543 never to be used for any deliveries. This is like the &%never_users%& runtime
35544 option, but it cannot be overridden; the runtime option adds additional users
35545 to the list. The default setting is &"root"&; this prevents a non-root user who
35546 is permitted to modify the runtime file from using Exim as a way to get root.
35551 .section "Root privilege" "SECID270"
35553 .cindex "root privilege"
35554 The Exim binary is normally setuid to root, which means that it gains root
35555 privilege (runs as root) when it starts execution. In some special cases (for
35556 example, when the daemon is not in use and there are no local deliveries), it
35557 may be possible to run Exim setuid to some user other than root. This is
35558 discussed in the next section. However, in most installations, root privilege
35559 is required for two things:
35562 To set up a socket connected to the standard SMTP port (25) when initialising
35563 the listening daemon. If Exim is run from &'inetd'&, this privileged action is
35566 To be able to change uid and gid in order to read users' &_.forward_& files and
35567 perform local deliveries as the receiving user or as specified in the
35571 It is not necessary to be root to do any of the other things Exim does, such as
35572 receiving messages and delivering them externally over SMTP, and it is
35573 obviously more secure if Exim does not run as root except when necessary.
35574 For this reason, a user and group for Exim to use must be defined in
35575 &_Local/Makefile_&. These are known as &"the Exim user"& and &"the Exim
35576 group"&. Their values can be changed by the run time configuration, though this
35577 is not recommended. Often a user called &'exim'& is used, but some sites use
35578 &'mail'& or another user name altogether.
35580 Exim uses &[setuid()]& whenever it gives up root privilege. This is a permanent
35581 abdication; the process cannot regain root afterwards. Prior to release 4.00,
35582 &[seteuid()]& was used in some circumstances, but this is no longer the case.
35584 After a new Exim process has interpreted its command line options, it changes
35585 uid and gid in the following cases:
35590 If the &%-C%& option is used to specify an alternate configuration file, or if
35591 the &%-D%& option is used to define macro values for the configuration, and the
35592 calling process is not running as root, the uid and gid are changed to those of
35593 the calling process.
35594 However, if DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the &%-D%&
35595 option may not be used at all.
35596 If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, then some macro values
35597 can be supplied if the calling process is running as root, the Exim run-time
35598 user or CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined.
35603 If the expansion test option (&%-be%&) or one of the filter testing options
35604 (&%-bf%& or &%-bF%&) are used, the uid and gid are changed to those of the
35607 If the process is not a daemon process or a queue runner process or a delivery
35608 process or a process for testing address routing (started with &%-bt%&), the
35609 uid and gid are changed to the Exim user and group. This means that Exim always
35610 runs under its own uid and gid when receiving messages. This also applies when
35611 testing address verification
35614 (the &%-bv%& option) and testing incoming message policy controls (the &%-bh%&
35617 For a daemon, queue runner, delivery, or address testing process, the uid
35618 remains as root at this stage, but the gid is changed to the Exim group.
35621 The processes that initially retain root privilege behave as follows:
35624 A daemon process changes the gid to the Exim group and the uid to the Exim
35625 user after setting up one or more listening sockets. The &[initgroups()]&
35626 function is called, so that if the Exim user is in any additional groups, they
35627 will be used during message reception.
35629 A queue runner process retains root privilege throughout its execution. Its
35630 job is to fork a controlled sequence of delivery processes.
35632 A delivery process retains root privilege throughout most of its execution,
35633 but any actual deliveries (that is, the transports themselves) are run in
35634 subprocesses which always change to a non-root uid and gid. For local
35635 deliveries this is typically the uid and gid of the owner of the mailbox; for
35636 remote deliveries, the Exim uid and gid are used. Once all the delivery
35637 subprocesses have been run, a delivery process changes to the Exim uid and gid
35638 while doing post-delivery tidying up such as updating the retry database and
35639 generating bounce and warning messages.
35641 While the recipient addresses in a message are being routed, the delivery
35642 process runs as root. However, if a user's filter file has to be processed,
35643 this is done in a subprocess that runs under the individual user's uid and
35644 gid. A system filter is run as root unless &%system_filter_user%& is set.
35646 A process that is testing addresses (the &%-bt%& option) runs as root so that
35647 the routing is done in the same environment as a message delivery.
35653 .section "Running Exim without privilege" "SECTrunexiwitpri"
35654 .cindex "privilege, running without"
35655 .cindex "unprivileged running"
35656 .cindex "root privilege" "running without"
35657 Some installations like to run Exim in an unprivileged state for more of its
35658 operation, for added security. Support for this mode of operation is provided
35659 by the global option &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. When this is set, the uid and
35660 gid are changed to the Exim user and group at the start of a delivery process
35661 (and also queue runner and address testing processes). This means that address
35662 routing is no longer run as root, and the deliveries themselves cannot change
35666 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
35667 Leaving the binary setuid to root, but setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%& means
35668 that the daemon can still be started in the usual way, and it can respond
35669 correctly to SIGHUP because the re-invocation regains root privilege.
35671 An alternative approach is to make Exim setuid to the Exim user and also setgid
35672 to the Exim group. If you do this, the daemon must be started from a root
35673 process. (Calling Exim from a root process makes it behave in the way it does
35674 when it is setuid root.) However, the daemon cannot restart itself after a
35675 SIGHUP signal because it cannot regain privilege.
35677 It is still useful to set &%deliver_drop_privilege%& in this case, because it
35678 stops Exim from trying to re-invoke itself to do a delivery after a message has
35679 been received. Such a re-invocation is a waste of resources because it has no
35682 If restarting the daemon is not an issue (for example, if &%mua_wrapper%& is
35683 set, or &'inetd'& is being used instead of a daemon), having the binary setuid
35684 to the Exim user seems a clean approach, but there is one complication:
35686 In this style of operation, Exim is running with the real uid and gid set to
35687 those of the calling process, and the effective uid/gid set to Exim's values.
35688 Ideally, any association with the calling process' uid/gid should be dropped,
35689 that is, the real uid/gid should be reset to the effective values so as to
35690 discard any privileges that the caller may have. While some operating systems
35691 have a function that permits this action for a non-root effective uid, quite a
35692 number of them do not. Because of this lack of standardization, Exim does not
35693 address this problem at this time.
35695 For this reason, the recommended approach for &"mostly unprivileged"& running
35696 is to keep the Exim binary setuid to root, and to set
35697 &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. This also has the advantage of allowing a daemon to
35698 be used in the most straightforward way.
35700 If you configure Exim not to run delivery processes as root, there are a
35701 number of restrictions on what you can do:
35704 You can deliver only as the Exim user/group. You should explicitly use the
35705 &%user%& and &%group%& options to override routers or local transports that
35706 normally deliver as the recipient. This makes sure that configurations that
35707 work in this mode function the same way in normal mode. Any implicit or
35708 explicit specification of another user causes an error.
35710 Use of &_.forward_& files is severely restricted, such that it is usually
35711 not worthwhile to include them in the configuration.
35713 Users who wish to use &_.forward_& would have to make their home directory and
35714 the file itself accessible to the Exim user. Pipe and append-to-file entries,
35715 and their equivalents in Exim filters, cannot be used. While they could be
35716 enabled in the Exim user's name, that would be insecure and not very useful.
35718 Unless the local user mailboxes are all owned by the Exim user (possible in
35719 some POP3 or IMAP-only environments):
35722 They must be owned by the Exim group and be writeable by that group. This
35723 implies you must set &%mode%& in the appendfile configuration, as well as the
35724 mode of the mailbox files themselves.
35726 You must set &%no_check_owner%&, since most or all of the files will not be
35727 owned by the Exim user.
35729 You must set &%file_must_exist%&, because Exim cannot set the owner correctly
35730 on a newly created mailbox when unprivileged. This also implies that new
35731 mailboxes need to be created manually.
35736 These restrictions severely restrict what can be done in local deliveries.
35737 However, there are no restrictions on remote deliveries. If you are running a
35738 gateway host that does no local deliveries, setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%&
35739 gives more security at essentially no cost.
35741 If you are using the &%mua_wrapper%& facility (see chapter
35742 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&), &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced to be true.
35747 .section "Delivering to local files" "SECID271"
35748 Full details of the checks applied by &(appendfile)& before it writes to a file
35749 are given in chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
35753 .section "Running local commands" "SECTsecconslocalcmds"
35754 There are a number of ways in which an administrator can configure Exim to run
35755 commands based upon received, untrustworthy, data. Further, in some
35756 configurations a user who can control a &_.forward_& file can also arrange to
35757 run commands. Configuration to check includes, but is not limited to:
35760 Use of &%use_shell%& in the pipe transport: various forms of shell command
35761 injection may be possible with this option present. It is dangerous and should
35762 be used only with considerable caution. Consider constraints which whitelist
35763 allowed characters in a variable which is to be used in a pipe transport that
35764 has &%use_shell%& enabled.
35766 A number of options such as &%forbid_filter_run%&, &%forbid_filter_perl%&,
35767 &%forbid_filter_dlfunc%& and so forth which restrict facilities available to
35768 &_.forward_& files in a redirect router. If Exim is running on a central mail
35769 hub to which ordinary users do not have shell access, but home directories are
35770 NFS mounted (for instance) then administrators should review the list of these
35771 forbid options available, and should bear in mind that the options that may
35772 need forbidding can change as new features are added between releases.
35774 The &%${run...}%& expansion item does not use a shell by default, but
35775 administrators can configure use of &_/bin/sh_& as part of the command.
35776 Such invocations should be viewed with prejudicial suspicion.
35778 Administrators who use embedded Perl are advised to explore how Perl's
35779 taint checking might apply to their usage.
35781 Use of &%${expand...}%& is somewhat analagous to shell's eval builtin and
35782 administrators are well advised to view its use with suspicion, in case (for
35783 instance) it allows a local-part to contain embedded Exim directives.
35785 Use of &%${match_local_part...}%& and friends becomes more dangerous if
35786 Exim was built with EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS defined: the second string in
35787 each can reference arbitrary lists and files, rather than just being a list
35789 The EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option was added and set false by default because of
35790 real-world security vulnerabilities caused by its use with untrustworthy data
35791 injected in, for SQL injection attacks.
35792 Consider the use of the &%inlisti%& expansion condition instead.
35797 .section "IPv4 source routing" "SECID272"
35798 .cindex "source routing" "in IP packets"
35799 .cindex "IP source routing"
35800 Many operating systems suppress IP source-routed packets in the kernel, but
35801 some cannot be made to do this, so Exim does its own check. It logs incoming
35802 IPv4 source-routed TCP calls, and then drops them. Things are all different in
35803 IPv6. No special checking is currently done.
35807 .section "The VRFY, EXPN, and ETRN commands in SMTP" "SECID273"
35808 Support for these SMTP commands is disabled by default. If required, they can
35809 be enabled by defining suitable ACLs.
35814 .section "Privileged users" "SECID274"
35815 .cindex "trusted users"
35816 .cindex "admin user"
35817 .cindex "privileged user"
35818 .cindex "user" "trusted"
35819 .cindex "user" "admin"
35820 Exim recognizes two sets of users with special privileges. Trusted users are
35821 able to submit new messages to Exim locally, but supply their own sender
35822 addresses and information about a sending host. For other users submitting
35823 local messages, Exim sets up the sender address from the uid, and doesn't
35824 permit a remote host to be specified.
35827 However, an untrusted user is permitted to use the &%-f%& command line option
35828 in the special form &%-f <>%& to indicate that a delivery failure for the
35829 message should not cause an error report. This affects the message's envelope,
35830 but it does not affect the &'Sender:'& header. Untrusted users may also be
35831 permitted to use specific forms of address with the &%-f%& option by setting
35832 the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option.
35834 Trusted users are used to run processes that receive mail messages from some
35835 other mail domain and pass them on to Exim for delivery either locally, or over
35836 the Internet. Exim trusts a caller that is running as root, as the Exim user,
35837 as any user listed in the &%trusted_users%& configuration option, or under any
35838 group listed in the &%trusted_groups%& option.
35840 Admin users are permitted to do things to the messages on Exim's queue. They
35841 can freeze or thaw messages, cause them to be returned to their senders, remove
35842 them entirely, or modify them in various ways. In addition, admin users can run
35843 the Exim monitor and see all the information it is capable of providing, which
35844 includes the contents of files on the spool.
35848 By default, the use of the &%-M%& and &%-q%& options to cause Exim to attempt
35849 delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users. This
35850 restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%no_prod_requires_admin%& option.
35851 Similarly, the use of &%-bp%& (and its variants) to list the contents of the
35852 queue is also restricted to admin users. This restriction can be relaxed by
35853 setting &%no_queue_list_requires_admin%&.
35855 Exim recognizes an admin user if the calling process is running as root or as
35856 the Exim user or if any of the groups associated with the calling process is
35857 the Exim group. It is not necessary actually to be running under the Exim
35858 group. However, if admin users who are not root or the Exim user are to access
35859 the contents of files on the spool via the Exim monitor (which runs
35860 unprivileged), Exim must be built to allow group read access to its spool
35865 .section "Spool files" "SECID275"
35866 .cindex "spool directory" "files"
35867 Exim's spool directory and everything it contains is owned by the Exim user and
35868 set to the Exim group. The mode for spool files is defined in the
35869 &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file, and defaults to 0640. This means that
35870 any user who is a member of the Exim group can access these files.
35874 .section "Use of argv[0]" "SECID276"
35875 Exim examines the last component of &%argv[0]%&, and if it matches one of a set
35876 of specific strings, Exim assumes certain options. For example, calling Exim
35877 with the last component of &%argv[0]%& set to &"rsmtp"& is exactly equivalent
35878 to calling it with the option &%-bS%&. There are no security implications in
35883 .section "Use of %f formatting" "SECID277"
35884 The only use made of &"%f"& by Exim is in formatting load average values. These
35885 are actually stored in integer variables as 1000 times the load average.
35886 Consequently, their range is limited and so therefore is the length of the
35891 .section "Embedded Exim path" "SECID278"
35892 Exim uses its own path name, which is embedded in the code, only when it needs
35893 to re-exec in order to regain root privilege. Therefore, it is not root when it
35894 does so. If some bug allowed the path to get overwritten, it would lead to an
35895 arbitrary program's being run as exim, not as root.
35899 .section "Dynamic module directory" "SECTdynmoddir"
35900 Any dynamically loadable modules must be installed into the directory
35901 defined in &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& in &_Local/Makefile_& for Exim to permit
35905 .section "Use of sprintf()" "SECID279"
35906 .cindex "&[sprintf()]&"
35907 A large number of occurrences of &"sprintf"& in the code are actually calls to
35908 &'string_sprintf()'&, a function that returns the result in malloc'd store.
35909 The intermediate formatting is done into a large fixed buffer by a function
35910 that runs through the format string itself, and checks the length of each
35911 conversion before performing it, thus preventing buffer overruns.
35913 The remaining uses of &[sprintf()]& happen in controlled circumstances where
35914 the output buffer is known to be sufficiently long to contain the converted
35919 .section "Use of debug_printf() and log_write()" "SECID280"
35920 Arbitrary strings are passed to both these functions, but they do their
35921 formatting by calling the function &'string_vformat()'&, which runs through
35922 the format string itself, and checks the length of each conversion.
35926 .section "Use of strcat() and strcpy()" "SECID281"
35927 These are used only in cases where the output buffer is known to be large
35928 enough to hold the result.
35929 .ecindex IIDsecurcon
35934 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35935 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35937 .chapter "Format of spool files" "CHAPspool"
35938 .scindex IIDforspo1 "format" "spool files"
35939 .scindex IIDforspo2 "spool directory" "format of files"
35940 .scindex IIDforspo3 "spool files" "format of"
35941 .cindex "spool files" "editing"
35942 A message on Exim's queue consists of two files, whose names are the message id
35943 followed by -D and -H, respectively. The data portion of the message is kept in
35944 the -D file on its own. The message's envelope, status, and headers are all
35945 kept in the -H file, whose format is described in this chapter. Each of these
35946 two files contains the final component of its own name as its first line. This
35947 is insurance against disk crashes where the directory is lost but the files
35948 themselves are recoverable.
35950 Some people are tempted into editing -D files in order to modify messages. You
35951 need to be extremely careful if you do this; it is not recommended and you are
35952 on your own if you do it. Here are some of the pitfalls:
35955 You must ensure that Exim does not try to deliver the message while you are
35956 fiddling with it. The safest way is to take out a write lock on the -D file,
35957 which is what Exim itself does, using &[fcntl()]&. If you update the file in
35958 place, the lock will be retained. If you write a new file and rename it, the
35959 lock will be lost at the instant of rename.
35961 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
35962 If you change the number of lines in the file, the value of
35963 &$body_linecount$&, which is stored in the -H file, will be incorrect. At
35964 present, this value is not used by Exim, but there is no guarantee that this
35965 will always be the case.
35967 If the message is in MIME format, you must take care not to break it.
35969 If the message is cryptographically signed, any change will invalidate the
35972 All in all, modifying -D files is fraught with danger.
35974 Files whose names end with -J may also be seen in the &_input_& directory (or
35975 its subdirectories when &%split_spool_directory%& is set). These are journal
35976 files, used to record addresses to which the message has been delivered during
35977 the course of a delivery attempt. If there are still undelivered recipients at
35978 the end, the -H file is updated, and the -J file is deleted. If, however, there
35979 is some kind of crash (for example, a power outage) before this happens, the -J
35980 file remains in existence. When Exim next processes the message, it notices the
35981 -J file and uses it to update the -H file before starting the next delivery
35984 .section "Format of the -H file" "SECID282"
35985 .cindex "uid (user id)" "in spool file"
35986 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in spool file"
35987 The second line of the -H file contains the login name for the uid of the
35988 process that called Exim to read the message, followed by the numerical uid and
35989 gid. For a locally generated message, this is normally the user who sent the
35990 message. For a message received over TCP/IP via the daemon, it is
35991 normally the Exim user.
35993 The third line of the file contains the address of the message's sender as
35994 transmitted in the envelope, contained in angle brackets. The sender address is
35995 empty for bounce messages. For incoming SMTP mail, the sender address is given
35996 in the MAIL command. For locally generated mail, the sender address is
35997 created by Exim from the login name of the current user and the configured
35998 &%qualify_domain%&. However, this can be overridden by the &%-f%& option or a
35999 leading &"From&~"& line if the caller is trusted, or if the supplied address is
36000 &"<>"& or an address that matches &%untrusted_set_senders%&.
36002 The fourth line contains two numbers. The first is the time that the message
36003 was received, in the conventional Unix form &-- the number of seconds since the
36004 start of the epoch. The second number is a count of the number of messages
36005 warning of delayed delivery that have been sent to the sender.
36007 There follow a number of lines starting with a hyphen. These can appear in any
36008 order, and are omitted when not relevant:
36011 .vitem "&%-acl%&&~<&'number'&>&~<&'length'&>"
36012 This item is obsolete, and is not generated from Exim release 4.61 onwards;
36013 &%-aclc%& and &%-aclm%& are used instead. However, &%-acl%& is still
36014 recognized, to provide backward compatibility. In the old format, a line of
36015 this form is present for every ACL variable that is not empty. The number
36016 identifies the variable; the &%acl_c%&&*x*& variables are numbered 0&--9 and
36017 the &%acl_m%&&*x*& variables are numbered 10&--19. The length is the length of
36018 the data string for the variable. The string itself starts at the beginning of
36019 the next line, and is followed by a newline character. It may contain internal
36022 .vitem "&%-aclc%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
36023 A line of this form is present for every ACL connection variable that is
36024 defined. Note that there is a space between &%-aclc%& and the rest of the name.
36025 The length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
36026 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
36027 character. It may contain internal newlines.
36029 .vitem "&%-aclm%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
36030 A line of this form is present for every ACL message variable that is defined.
36031 Note that there is a space between &%-aclm%& and the rest of the name. The
36032 length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
36033 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
36034 character. It may contain internal newlines.
36036 .vitem "&%-active_hostname%&&~<&'hostname'&>"
36037 This is present if, when the message was received over SMTP, the value of
36038 &$smtp_active_hostname$& was different to the value of &$primary_hostname$&.
36040 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_recipient%&
36041 This is present if unqualified recipient addresses are permitted in header
36042 lines (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at
36043 transport time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote
36044 messages from hosts that match &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
36046 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_sender%&
36047 This is present if unqualified sender addresses are permitted in header lines
36048 (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at transport
36049 time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote messages from
36050 hosts that match &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
36052 .vitem "&%-auth_id%&&~<&'text'&>"
36053 The id information for a message received on an authenticated SMTP connection
36054 &-- the value of the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
36056 .vitem "&%-auth_sender%&&~<&'address'&>"
36057 The address of an authenticated sender &-- the value of the
36058 &$authenticated_sender$& variable.
36060 .vitem "&%-body_linecount%&&~<&'number'&>"
36061 This records the number of lines in the body of the message, and is always
36064 .vitem "&%-body_zerocount%&&~<&'number'&>"
36065 This records the number of binary zero bytes in the body of the message, and is
36066 present if the number is greater than zero.
36068 .vitem &%-deliver_firsttime%&
36069 This is written when a new message is first added to the spool. When the spool
36070 file is updated after a deferral, it is omitted.
36072 .vitem "&%-frozen%&&~<&'time'&>"
36073 .cindex "frozen messages" "spool data"
36074 The message is frozen, and the freezing happened at <&'time'&>.
36076 .vitem "&%-helo_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
36077 This records the host name as specified by a remote host in a HELO or EHLO
36080 .vitem "&%-host_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
36081 This records the IP address of the host from which the message was received and
36082 the remote port number that was used. It is omitted for locally generated
36085 .vitem "&%-host_auth%&&~<&'text'&>"
36086 If the message was received on an authenticated SMTP connection, this records
36087 the name of the authenticator &-- the value of the
36088 &$sender_host_authenticated$& variable.
36090 .vitem &%-host_lookup_failed%&
36091 This is present if an attempt to look up the sending host's name from its IP
36092 address failed. It corresponds to the &$host_lookup_failed$& variable.
36094 .vitem "&%-host_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
36095 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
36096 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
36097 This records the name of the remote host from which the message was received,
36098 if the host name was looked up from the IP address when the message was being
36099 received. It is not present if no reverse lookup was done.
36101 .vitem "&%-ident%&&~<&'text'&>"
36102 For locally submitted messages, this records the login of the originating user,
36103 unless it was a trusted user and the &%-oMt%& option was used to specify an
36104 ident value. For messages received over TCP/IP, this records the ident string
36105 supplied by the remote host, if any.
36107 .vitem "&%-interface_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
36108 This records the IP address of the local interface and the port number through
36109 which a message was received from a remote host. It is omitted for locally
36110 generated messages.
36113 The message is from a local sender.
36115 .vitem &%-localerror%&
36116 The message is a locally-generated bounce message.
36118 .vitem "&%-local_scan%&&~<&'string'&>"
36119 This records the data string that was returned by the &[local_scan()]& function
36120 when the message was received &-- the value of the &$local_scan_data$&
36121 variable. It is omitted if no data was returned.
36123 .vitem &%-manual_thaw%&
36124 The message was frozen but has been thawed manually, that is, by an explicit
36125 Exim command rather than via the auto-thaw process.
36128 A testing delivery process was started using the &%-N%& option to suppress any
36129 actual deliveries, but delivery was deferred. At any further delivery attempts,
36132 .vitem &%-received_protocol%&
36133 This records the value of the &$received_protocol$& variable, which contains
36134 the name of the protocol by which the message was received.
36136 .vitem &%-sender_set_untrusted%&
36137 The envelope sender of this message was set by an untrusted local caller (used
36138 to ensure that the caller is displayed in queue listings).
36140 .vitem "&%-spam_score_int%&&~<&'number'&>"
36141 If a message was scanned by SpamAssassin, this is present. It records the value
36142 of &$spam_score_int$&.
36144 .vitem &%-tls_certificate_verified%&
36145 A TLS certificate was received from the client that sent this message, and the
36146 certificate was verified by the server.
36148 .vitem "&%-tls_cipher%&&~<&'cipher name'&>"
36149 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, this records the
36150 name of the cipher suite that was used.
36152 .vitem "&%-tls_peerdn%&&~<&'peer DN'&>"
36153 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, and a certificate
36154 was received from the client, this records the Distinguished Name from that
36158 Following the options there is a list of those addresses to which the message
36159 is not to be delivered. This set of addresses is initialized from the command
36160 line when the &%-t%& option is used and &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%&
36161 is set; otherwise it starts out empty. Whenever a successful delivery is made,
36162 the address is added to this set. The addresses are kept internally as a
36163 balanced binary tree, and it is a representation of that tree which is written
36164 to the spool file. If an address is expanded via an alias or forward file, the
36165 original address is added to the tree when deliveries to all its child
36166 addresses are complete.
36168 If the tree is empty, there is a single line in the spool file containing just
36169 the text &"XX"&. Otherwise, each line consists of two letters, which are either
36170 Y or N, followed by an address. The address is the value for the node of the
36171 tree, and the letters indicate whether the node has a left branch and/or a
36172 right branch attached to it, respectively. If branches exist, they immediately
36173 follow. Here is an example of a three-node tree:
36175 YY darcy@austen.fict.example
36176 NN alice@wonderland.fict.example
36177 NN editor@thesaurus.ref.example
36179 After the non-recipients tree, there is a list of the message's recipients.
36180 This is a simple list, preceded by a count. It includes all the original
36181 recipients of the message, including those to whom the message has already been
36182 delivered. In the simplest case, the list contains one address per line. For
36186 editor@thesaurus.ref.example
36187 darcy@austen.fict.example
36189 alice@wonderland.fict.example
36191 However, when a child address has been added to the top-level addresses as a
36192 result of the use of the &%one_time%& option on a &(redirect)& router, each
36193 line is of the following form:
36195 <&'top-level address'&> <&'errors_to address'&> &&&
36196 <&'length'&>,<&'parent number'&>#<&'flag bits'&>
36198 The 01 flag bit indicates the presence of the three other fields that follow
36199 the top-level address. Other bits may be used in future to support additional
36200 fields. The <&'parent number'&> is the offset in the recipients list of the
36201 original parent of the &"one time"& address. The first two fields are the
36202 envelope sender that is associated with this address and its length. If the
36203 length is zero, there is no special envelope sender (there are then two space
36204 characters in the line). A non-empty field can arise from a &(redirect)& router
36205 that has an &%errors_to%& setting.
36208 A blank line separates the envelope and status information from the headers
36209 which follow. A header may occupy several lines of the file, and to save effort
36210 when reading it in, each header is preceded by a number and an identifying
36211 character. The number is the number of characters in the header, including any
36212 embedded newlines and the terminating newline. The character is one of the
36216 .row <&'blank'&> "header in which Exim has no special interest"
36217 .row &`B`& "&'Bcc:'& header"
36218 .row &`C`& "&'Cc:'& header"
36219 .row &`F`& "&'From:'& header"
36220 .row &`I`& "&'Message-id:'& header"
36221 .row &`P`& "&'Received:'& header &-- P for &""postmark""&"
36222 .row &`R`& "&'Reply-To:'& header"
36223 .row &`S`& "&'Sender:'& header"
36224 .row &`T`& "&'To:'& header"
36225 .row &`*`& "replaced or deleted header"
36228 Deleted or replaced (rewritten) headers remain in the spool file for debugging
36229 purposes. They are not transmitted when the message is delivered. Here is a
36230 typical set of headers:
36232 111P Received: by hobbit.fict.example with local (Exim 4.00)
36233 id 14y9EI-00026G-00; Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
36234 049 Message-Id: <E14y9EI-00026G-00@hobbit.fict.example>
36235 038* X-rewrote-sender: bb@hobbit.fict.example
36236 042* From: Bilbo Baggins <bb@hobbit.fict.example>
36237 049F From: Bilbo Baggins <B.Baggins@hobbit.fict.example>
36238 099* To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation,
36239 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
36240 104T To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation.example,
36241 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
36242 038 Date: Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
36244 The asterisked headers indicate that the envelope sender, &'From:'& header, and
36245 &'To:'& header have been rewritten, the last one because routing expanded the
36246 unqualified domain &'foundation'&.
36247 .ecindex IIDforspo1
36248 .ecindex IIDforspo2
36249 .ecindex IIDforspo3
36251 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36252 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36254 .chapter "Support for DKIM (DomainKeys Identified Mail)" "CHAPdkim" &&&
36258 DKIM is a mechanism by which messages sent by some entity can be provably
36259 linked to a domain which that entity controls. It permits reputation to
36260 be tracked on a per-domain basis, rather than merely upon source IP address.
36261 DKIM is documented in RFC 4871.
36263 Since version 4.70, DKIM support is compiled into Exim by default. It can be
36264 disabled by setting DISABLE_DKIM=yes in Local/Makefile.
36266 Exim's DKIM implementation allows to
36268 Sign outgoing messages: This function is implemented in the SMTP transport.
36269 It can co-exist with all other Exim features, including transport filters.
36271 Verify signatures in incoming messages: This is implemented by an additional
36272 ACL (acl_smtp_dkim), which can be called several times per message, with
36273 different signature contexts.
36276 In typical Exim style, the verification implementation does not include any
36277 default "policy". Instead it enables you to build your own policy using
36278 Exim's standard controls.
36280 Please note that verification of DKIM signatures in incoming mail is turned
36281 on by default for logging purposes. For each signature in incoming email,
36282 exim will log a line displaying the most important signature details, and the
36283 signature status. Here is an example (with line-breaks added for clarity):
36285 2009-09-09 10:22:28 1MlIRf-0003LU-U3 DKIM:
36286 d=facebookmail.com s=q1-2009b
36287 c=relaxed/relaxed a=rsa-sha1
36288 i=@facebookmail.com t=1252484542 [verification succeeded]
36290 You might want to turn off DKIM verification processing entirely for internal
36291 or relay mail sources. To do that, set the &%dkim_disable_verify%& ACL
36292 control modifier. This should typically be done in the RCPT ACL, at points
36293 where you accept mail from relay sources (internal hosts or authenticated
36297 .section "Signing outgoing messages" "SECID513"
36298 .cindex "DKIM" "signing"
36300 Signing is implemented by setting private options on the SMTP transport.
36301 These options take (expandable) strings as arguments.
36303 .option dkim_domain smtp string&!! unset
36305 The domain you want to sign with. The result of this expanded
36306 option is put into the &%$dkim_domain%& expansion variable.
36308 .option dkim_selector smtp string&!! unset
36310 This sets the key selector string. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& expansion
36311 variable to look up a matching selector. The result is put in the expansion
36312 variable &%$dkim_selector%& which should be used in the &%dkim_private_key%&
36313 option along with &%$dkim_domain%&.
36315 .option dkim_private_key smtp string&!! unset
36317 This sets the private key to use. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and
36318 &%$dkim_selector%& expansion variables to determine the private key to use.
36319 The result can either
36321 be a valid RSA private key in ASCII armor, including line breaks.
36323 start with a slash, in which case it is treated as a file that contains
36326 be "0", "false" or the empty string, in which case the message will not
36327 be signed. This case will not result in an error, even if &%dkim_strict%&
36331 .option dkim_canon smtp string&!! unset
36333 This option sets the canonicalization method used when signing a message.
36334 The DKIM RFC currently supports two methods: "simple" and "relaxed".
36335 The option defaults to "relaxed" when unset. Note: the current implementation
36336 only supports using the same canonicalization method for both headers and body.
36338 .option dkim_strict smtp string&!! unset
36340 This option defines how Exim behaves when signing a message that
36341 should be signed fails for some reason. When the expansion evaluates to
36342 either "1" or "true", Exim will defer. Otherwise Exim will send the message
36343 unsigned. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and &%$dkim_selector%& expansion
36346 .option dkim_sign_headers smtp string&!! unset
36348 When set, this option must expand to (or be specified as) a colon-separated
36349 list of header names. Headers with these names will be included in the message
36350 signature. When unspecified, the header names recommended in RFC4871 will be
36354 .section "Verifying DKIM signatures in incoming mail" "SECID514"
36355 .cindex "DKIM" "verification"
36357 Verification of DKIM signatures in incoming email is implemented via the
36358 &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL. By default, this ACL is called once for each
36359 syntactically(!) correct signature in the incoming message.
36361 To evaluate the signature in the ACL a large number of expansion variables
36362 containing the signature status and its details are set up during the
36363 runtime of the ACL.
36365 Calling the ACL only for existing signatures is not sufficient to build
36366 more advanced policies. For that reason, the global option
36367 &%dkim_verify_signers%&, and a global expansion variable
36368 &%$dkim_signers%& exist.
36370 The global option &%dkim_verify_signers%& can be set to a colon-separated
36371 list of DKIM domains or identities for which the ACL &%acl_smtp_dkim%& is
36372 called. It is expanded when the message has been received. At this point,
36373 the expansion variable &%$dkim_signers%& already contains a colon-separated
36374 list of signer domains and identities for the message. When
36375 &%dkim_verify_signers%& is not specified in the main configuration,
36378 dkim_verify_signers = $dkim_signers
36380 This leads to the default behaviour of calling &%acl_smtp_dkim%& for each
36381 DKIM signature in the message. Current DKIM verifiers may want to explicitly
36382 call the ACL for known domains or identities. This would be achieved as follows:
36384 dkim_verify_signers = paypal.com:ebay.com:$dkim_signers
36386 This would result in &%acl_smtp_dkim%& always being called for "paypal.com"
36387 and "ebay.com", plus all domains and identities that have signatures in the message.
36388 You can also be more creative in constructing your policy. For example:
36390 dkim_verify_signers = $sender_address_domain:$dkim_signers
36393 If a domain or identity is listed several times in the (expanded) value of
36394 &%dkim_verify_signers%&, the ACL is only called once for that domain or identity.
36397 Inside the &%acl_smtp_dkim%&, the following expansion variables are
36398 available (from most to least important):
36402 .vitem &%$dkim_cur_signer%&
36403 The signer that is being evaluated in this ACL run. This can be a domain or
36404 an identity. This is one of the list items from the expanded main option
36405 &%dkim_verify_signers%& (see above).
36406 .vitem &%$dkim_verify_status%&
36407 A string describing the general status of the signature. One of
36409 &%none%&: There is no signature in the message for the current domain or
36410 identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
36412 &%invalid%&: The signature could not be verified due to a processing error.
36413 More detail is available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
36415 &%fail%&: Verification of the signature failed. More detail is
36416 available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
36418 &%pass%&: The signature passed verification. It is valid.
36420 .vitem &%$dkim_verify_reason%&
36421 A string giving a litte bit more detail when &%$dkim_verify_status%& is either
36422 "fail" or "invalid". One of
36424 &%pubkey_unavailable%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public
36425 key for the domain could not be retrieved. This may be a temporary problem.
36427 &%pubkey_syntax%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public key
36428 record for the domain is syntactically invalid.
36430 &%bodyhash_mismatch%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The calculated
36431 body hash does not match the one specified in the signature header. This
36432 means that the message body was modified in transit.
36434 &%signature_incorrect%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The signature
36435 could not be verified. This may mean that headers were modified,
36436 re-written or otherwise changed in a way which is incompatible with
36437 DKIM verification. It may of course also mean that the signature is forged.
36439 .vitem &%$dkim_domain%&
36440 The signing domain. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated if there is
36441 an actual signature in the message for the current domain or identity (as
36442 reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
36443 .vitem &%$dkim_identity%&
36444 The signing identity, if present. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated
36445 if there is an actual signature in the message for the current domain or
36446 identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
36447 .vitem &%$dkim_selector%&
36448 The key record selector string.
36449 .vitem &%$dkim_algo%&
36450 The algorithm used. One of 'rsa-sha1' or 'rsa-sha256'.
36451 .vitem &%$dkim_canon_body%&
36452 The body canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
36453 .vitem &%dkim_canon_headers%&
36454 The header canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
36455 .vitem &%$dkim_copiedheaders%&
36456 A transcript of headers and their values which are included in the signature
36457 (copied from the 'z=' tag of the signature).
36458 .vitem &%$dkim_bodylength%&
36459 The number of signed body bytes. If zero ("0"), the body is unsigned. If no
36460 limit was set by the signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes sure
36461 that this variable always expands to an integer value.
36462 .vitem &%$dkim_created%&
36463 UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signature was created.
36464 When this was not specified by the signer, "0" is returned.
36465 .vitem &%$dkim_expires%&
36466 UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signer wants the
36467 signature to be treated as "expired". When this was not specified by the
36468 signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes it possible to do useful
36469 integer size comparisons against this value.
36470 .vitem &%$dkim_headernames%&
36471 A colon-separated list of names of headers included in the signature.
36472 .vitem &%$dkim_key_testing%&
36473 "1" if the key record has the "testing" flag set, "0" if not.
36474 .vitem &%$dkim_key_nosubdomains%&
36475 "1" if the key record forbids subdomaining, "0" otherwise.
36476 .vitem &%$dkim_key_srvtype%&
36477 Service type (tag s=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
36479 .vitem &%$dkim_key_granularity%&
36480 Key granularity (tag g=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
36482 .vitem &%$dkim_key_notes%&
36483 Notes from the key record (tag n=).
36486 In addition, two ACL conditions are provided:
36489 .vitem &%dkim_signers%&
36490 ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of domains or identities
36491 for a match against the domain or identity that the ACL is currently verifying
36492 (reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&). This is typically used to restrict an ACL
36493 verb to a group of domains or identities. For example:
36496 # Warn when Mail purportedly from GMail has no signature at all
36497 warn log_message = GMail sender without DKIM signature
36498 sender_domains = gmail.com
36499 dkim_signers = gmail.com
36503 .vitem &%dkim_status%&
36504 ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of possible DKIM verification
36505 results against the actual result of verification. This is typically used
36506 to restrict an ACL verb to a list of verification outcomes, for example:
36509 deny message = Mail from Paypal with invalid/missing signature
36510 sender_domains = paypal.com:paypal.de
36511 dkim_signers = paypal.com:paypal.de
36512 dkim_status = none:invalid:fail
36515 The possible status keywords are: 'none','invalid','fail' and 'pass'. Please
36516 see the documentation of the &%$dkim_verify_status%& expansion variable above
36517 for more information of what they mean.
36520 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36521 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36523 .chapter "Adding new drivers or lookup types" "CHID13" &&&
36524 "Adding drivers or lookups"
36525 .cindex "adding drivers"
36526 .cindex "new drivers, adding"
36527 .cindex "drivers" "adding new"
36528 The following actions have to be taken in order to add a new router, transport,
36529 authenticator, or lookup type to Exim:
36532 Choose a name for the driver or lookup type that does not conflict with any
36533 existing name; I will use &"newdriver"& in what follows.
36535 Add to &_src/EDITME_& the line:
36537 <&'type'&>&`_NEWDRIVER=yes`&
36539 where <&'type'&> is ROUTER, TRANSPORT, AUTH, or LOOKUP. If the
36540 code is not to be included in the binary by default, comment this line out. You
36541 should also add any relevant comments about the driver or lookup type.
36543 Add to &_src/config.h.defaults_& the line:
36545 #define <type>_NEWDRIVER
36548 Edit &_src/drtables.c_&, adding conditional code to pull in the private header
36549 and create a table entry as is done for all the other drivers and lookup types.
36551 Edit &_scripts/lookups-Makefile_& if this is a new lookup; there is a for-loop
36552 near the bottom, ranging the &`name_mod`& variable over a list of all lookups.
36553 Add your &`NEWDRIVER`& to that list.
36554 As long as the dynamic module would be named &_newdriver.so_&, you can use the
36555 simple form that most lookups have.
36557 Edit &_Makefile_& in the appropriate sub-directory (&_src/routers_&,
36558 &_src/transports_&, &_src/auths_&, or &_src/lookups_&); add a line for the new
36559 driver or lookup type and add it to the definition of OBJ.
36561 Create &_newdriver.h_& and &_newdriver.c_& in the appropriate sub-directory of
36564 Edit &_scripts/MakeLinks_& and add commands to link the &_.h_& and &_.c_& files
36565 as for other drivers and lookups.
36568 Then all you need to do is write the code! A good way to start is to make a
36569 proforma by copying an existing module of the same type, globally changing all
36570 occurrences of the name, and cutting out most of the code. Note that any
36571 options you create must be listed in alphabetical order, because the tables are
36572 searched using a binary chop procedure.
36574 There is a &_README_& file in each of the sub-directories of &_src_& describing
36575 the interface that is expected.
36580 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36581 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36583 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36584 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
36585 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
36586 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
36588 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36593 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle;"
36594 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle;"
36598 .makeindex "Options index" "option"
36599 .makeindex "Variables index" "variable"
36600 .makeindex "Concept index" "concept"
36603 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36604 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////